f5edb4b16f873784625468d36b939739ac837539
[bpt/emacs.git] / src / xdisp.c
1 /* Display generation from window structure and buffer text.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1985-1988, 1993-1995, 1997-2012 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
6
7 GNU Emacs is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
19
20 /* New redisplay written by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>.
21
22 Redisplay.
23
24 Emacs separates the task of updating the display from code
25 modifying global state, e.g. buffer text. This way functions
26 operating on buffers don't also have to be concerned with updating
27 the display.
28
29 Updating the display is triggered by the Lisp interpreter when it
30 decides it's time to do it. This is done either automatically for
31 you as part of the interpreter's command loop or as the result of
32 calling Lisp functions like `sit-for'. The C function `redisplay'
33 in xdisp.c is the only entry into the inner redisplay code.
34
35 The following diagram shows how redisplay code is invoked. As you
36 can see, Lisp calls redisplay and vice versa. Under window systems
37 like X, some portions of the redisplay code are also called
38 asynchronously during mouse movement or expose events. It is very
39 important that these code parts do NOT use the C library (malloc,
40 free) because many C libraries under Unix are not reentrant. They
41 may also NOT call functions of the Lisp interpreter which could
42 change the interpreter's state. If you don't follow these rules,
43 you will encounter bugs which are very hard to explain.
44
45 +--------------+ redisplay +----------------+
46 | Lisp machine |---------------->| Redisplay code |<--+
47 +--------------+ (xdisp.c) +----------------+ |
48 ^ | |
49 +----------------------------------+ |
50 Don't use this path when called |
51 asynchronously! |
52 |
53 expose_window (asynchronous) |
54 |
55 X expose events -----+
56
57 What does redisplay do? Obviously, it has to figure out somehow what
58 has been changed since the last time the display has been updated,
59 and to make these changes visible. Preferably it would do that in
60 a moderately intelligent way, i.e. fast.
61
62 Changes in buffer text can be deduced from window and buffer
63 structures, and from some global variables like `beg_unchanged' and
64 `end_unchanged'. The contents of the display are additionally
65 recorded in a `glyph matrix', a two-dimensional matrix of glyph
66 structures. Each row in such a matrix corresponds to a line on the
67 display, and each glyph in a row corresponds to a column displaying
68 a character, an image, or what else. This matrix is called the
69 `current glyph matrix' or `current matrix' in redisplay
70 terminology.
71
72 For buffer parts that have been changed since the last update, a
73 second glyph matrix is constructed, the so called `desired glyph
74 matrix' or short `desired matrix'. Current and desired matrix are
75 then compared to find a cheap way to update the display, e.g. by
76 reusing part of the display by scrolling lines.
77
78 You will find a lot of redisplay optimizations when you start
79 looking at the innards of redisplay. The overall goal of all these
80 optimizations is to make redisplay fast because it is done
81 frequently. Some of these optimizations are implemented by the
82 following functions:
83
84 . try_cursor_movement
85
86 This function tries to update the display if the text in the
87 window did not change and did not scroll, only point moved, and
88 it did not move off the displayed portion of the text.
89
90 . try_window_reusing_current_matrix
91
92 This function reuses the current matrix of a window when text
93 has not changed, but the window start changed (e.g., due to
94 scrolling).
95
96 . try_window_id
97
98 This function attempts to redisplay a window by reusing parts of
99 its existing display. It finds and reuses the part that was not
100 changed, and redraws the rest.
101
102 . try_window
103
104 This function performs the full redisplay of a single window
105 assuming that its fonts were not changed and that the cursor
106 will not end up in the scroll margins. (Loading fonts requires
107 re-adjustment of dimensions of glyph matrices, which makes this
108 method impossible to use.)
109
110 These optimizations are tried in sequence (some can be skipped if
111 it is known that they are not applicable). If none of the
112 optimizations were successful, redisplay calls redisplay_windows,
113 which performs a full redisplay of all windows.
114
115 Desired matrices.
116
117 Desired matrices are always built per Emacs window. The function
118 `display_line' is the central function to look at if you are
119 interested. It constructs one row in a desired matrix given an
120 iterator structure containing both a buffer position and a
121 description of the environment in which the text is to be
122 displayed. But this is too early, read on.
123
124 Characters and pixmaps displayed for a range of buffer text depend
125 on various settings of buffers and windows, on overlays and text
126 properties, on display tables, on selective display. The good news
127 is that all this hairy stuff is hidden behind a small set of
128 interface functions taking an iterator structure (struct it)
129 argument.
130
131 Iteration over things to be displayed is then simple. It is
132 started by initializing an iterator with a call to init_iterator,
133 passing it the buffer position where to start iteration. For
134 iteration over strings, pass -1 as the position to init_iterator,
135 and call reseat_to_string when the string is ready, to initialize
136 the iterator for that string. Thereafter, calls to
137 get_next_display_element fill the iterator structure with relevant
138 information about the next thing to display. Calls to
139 set_iterator_to_next move the iterator to the next thing.
140
141 Besides this, an iterator also contains information about the
142 display environment in which glyphs for display elements are to be
143 produced. It has fields for the width and height of the display,
144 the information whether long lines are truncated or continued, a
145 current X and Y position, and lots of other stuff you can better
146 see in dispextern.h.
147
148 Glyphs in a desired matrix are normally constructed in a loop
149 calling get_next_display_element and then PRODUCE_GLYPHS. The call
150 to PRODUCE_GLYPHS will fill the iterator structure with pixel
151 information about the element being displayed and at the same time
152 produce glyphs for it. If the display element fits on the line
153 being displayed, set_iterator_to_next is called next, otherwise the
154 glyphs produced are discarded. The function display_line is the
155 workhorse of filling glyph rows in the desired matrix with glyphs.
156 In addition to producing glyphs, it also handles line truncation
157 and continuation, word wrap, and cursor positioning (for the
158 latter, see also set_cursor_from_row).
159
160 Frame matrices.
161
162 That just couldn't be all, could it? What about terminal types not
163 supporting operations on sub-windows of the screen? To update the
164 display on such a terminal, window-based glyph matrices are not
165 well suited. To be able to reuse part of the display (scrolling
166 lines up and down), we must instead have a view of the whole
167 screen. This is what `frame matrices' are for. They are a trick.
168
169 Frames on terminals like above have a glyph pool. Windows on such
170 a frame sub-allocate their glyph memory from their frame's glyph
171 pool. The frame itself is given its own glyph matrices. By
172 coincidence---or maybe something else---rows in window glyph
173 matrices are slices of corresponding rows in frame matrices. Thus
174 writing to window matrices implicitly updates a frame matrix which
175 provides us with the view of the whole screen that we originally
176 wanted to have without having to move many bytes around. To be
177 honest, there is a little bit more done, but not much more. If you
178 plan to extend that code, take a look at dispnew.c. The function
179 build_frame_matrix is a good starting point.
180
181 Bidirectional display.
182
183 Bidirectional display adds quite some hair to this already complex
184 design. The good news are that a large portion of that hairy stuff
185 is hidden in bidi.c behind only 3 interfaces. bidi.c implements a
186 reordering engine which is called by set_iterator_to_next and
187 returns the next character to display in the visual order. See
188 commentary on bidi.c for more details. As far as redisplay is
189 concerned, the effect of calling bidi_move_to_visually_next, the
190 main interface of the reordering engine, is that the iterator gets
191 magically placed on the buffer or string position that is to be
192 displayed next. In other words, a linear iteration through the
193 buffer/string is replaced with a non-linear one. All the rest of
194 the redisplay is oblivious to the bidi reordering.
195
196 Well, almost oblivious---there are still complications, most of
197 them due to the fact that buffer and string positions no longer
198 change monotonously with glyph indices in a glyph row. Moreover,
199 for continued lines, the buffer positions may not even be
200 monotonously changing with vertical positions. Also, accounting
201 for face changes, overlays, etc. becomes more complex because
202 non-linear iteration could potentially skip many positions with
203 changes, and then cross them again on the way back...
204
205 One other prominent effect of bidirectional display is that some
206 paragraphs of text need to be displayed starting at the right
207 margin of the window---the so-called right-to-left, or R2L
208 paragraphs. R2L paragraphs are displayed with R2L glyph rows,
209 which have their reversed_p flag set. The bidi reordering engine
210 produces characters in such rows starting from the character which
211 should be the rightmost on display. PRODUCE_GLYPHS then reverses
212 the order, when it fills up the glyph row whose reversed_p flag is
213 set, by prepending each new glyph to what is already there, instead
214 of appending it. When the glyph row is complete, the function
215 extend_face_to_end_of_line fills the empty space to the left of the
216 leftmost character with special glyphs, which will display as,
217 well, empty. On text terminals, these special glyphs are simply
218 blank characters. On graphics terminals, there's a single stretch
219 glyph of a suitably computed width. Both the blanks and the
220 stretch glyph are given the face of the background of the line.
221 This way, the terminal-specific back-end can still draw the glyphs
222 left to right, even for R2L lines.
223
224 Bidirectional display and character compositions
225
226 Some scripts cannot be displayed by drawing each character
227 individually, because adjacent characters change each other's shape
228 on display. For example, Arabic and Indic scripts belong to this
229 category.
230
231 Emacs display supports this by providing "character compositions",
232 most of which is implemented in composite.c. During the buffer
233 scan that delivers characters to PRODUCE_GLYPHS, if the next
234 character to be delivered is a composed character, the iteration
235 calls composition_reseat_it and next_element_from_composition. If
236 they succeed to compose the character with one or more of the
237 following characters, the whole sequence of characters that where
238 composed is recorded in the `struct composition_it' object that is
239 part of the buffer iterator. The composed sequence could produce
240 one or more font glyphs (called "grapheme clusters") on the screen.
241 Each of these grapheme clusters is then delivered to PRODUCE_GLYPHS
242 in the direction corresponding to the current bidi scan direction
243 (recorded in the scan_dir member of the `struct bidi_it' object
244 that is part of the buffer iterator). In particular, if the bidi
245 iterator currently scans the buffer backwards, the grapheme
246 clusters are delivered back to front. This reorders the grapheme
247 clusters as appropriate for the current bidi context. Note that
248 this means that the grapheme clusters are always stored in the
249 LGSTRING object (see composite.c) in the logical order.
250
251 Moving an iterator in bidirectional text
252 without producing glyphs
253
254 Note one important detail mentioned above: that the bidi reordering
255 engine, driven by the iterator, produces characters in R2L rows
256 starting at the character that will be the rightmost on display.
257 As far as the iterator is concerned, the geometry of such rows is
258 still left to right, i.e. the iterator "thinks" the first character
259 is at the leftmost pixel position. The iterator does not know that
260 PRODUCE_GLYPHS reverses the order of the glyphs that the iterator
261 delivers. This is important when functions from the move_it_*
262 family are used to get to certain screen position or to match
263 screen coordinates with buffer coordinates: these functions use the
264 iterator geometry, which is left to right even in R2L paragraphs.
265 This works well with most callers of move_it_*, because they need
266 to get to a specific column, and columns are still numbered in the
267 reading order, i.e. the rightmost character in a R2L paragraph is
268 still column zero. But some callers do not get well with this; a
269 notable example is mouse clicks that need to find the character
270 that corresponds to certain pixel coordinates. See
271 buffer_posn_from_coords in dispnew.c for how this is handled. */
272
273 #include <config.h>
274 #include <stdio.h>
275 #include <limits.h>
276 #include <setjmp.h>
277
278 #include "lisp.h"
279 #include "keyboard.h"
280 #include "frame.h"
281 #include "window.h"
282 #include "termchar.h"
283 #include "dispextern.h"
284 #include "character.h"
285 #include "buffer.h"
286 #include "charset.h"
287 #include "indent.h"
288 #include "commands.h"
289 #include "keymap.h"
290 #include "macros.h"
291 #include "disptab.h"
292 #include "termhooks.h"
293 #include "termopts.h"
294 #include "intervals.h"
295 #include "coding.h"
296 #include "process.h"
297 #include "region-cache.h"
298 #include "font.h"
299 #include "fontset.h"
300 #include "blockinput.h"
301
302 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
303 #include "xterm.h"
304 #endif
305 #ifdef WINDOWSNT
306 #include "w32term.h"
307 #endif
308 #ifdef HAVE_NS
309 #include "nsterm.h"
310 #endif
311 #ifdef USE_GTK
312 #include "gtkutil.h"
313 #endif
314
315 #include "font.h"
316
317 #ifndef FRAME_X_OUTPUT
318 #define FRAME_X_OUTPUT(f) ((f)->output_data.x)
319 #endif
320
321 #define INFINITY 10000000
322
323 Lisp_Object Qoverriding_local_map, Qoverriding_terminal_local_map;
324 Lisp_Object Qwindow_scroll_functions;
325 static Lisp_Object Qwindow_text_change_functions;
326 static Lisp_Object Qredisplay_end_trigger_functions;
327 Lisp_Object Qinhibit_point_motion_hooks;
328 static Lisp_Object QCeval, QCpropertize;
329 Lisp_Object QCfile, QCdata;
330 static Lisp_Object Qfontified;
331 static Lisp_Object Qgrow_only;
332 static Lisp_Object Qinhibit_eval_during_redisplay;
333 static Lisp_Object Qbuffer_position, Qposition, Qobject;
334 static Lisp_Object Qright_to_left, Qleft_to_right;
335
336 /* Cursor shapes */
337 Lisp_Object Qbar, Qhbar, Qbox, Qhollow;
338
339 /* Pointer shapes */
340 static Lisp_Object Qarrow, Qhand;
341 Lisp_Object Qtext;
342
343 /* Holds the list (error). */
344 static Lisp_Object list_of_error;
345
346 static Lisp_Object Qfontification_functions;
347
348 static Lisp_Object Qwrap_prefix;
349 static Lisp_Object Qline_prefix;
350
351 /* Non-nil means don't actually do any redisplay. */
352
353 Lisp_Object Qinhibit_redisplay;
354
355 /* Names of text properties relevant for redisplay. */
356
357 Lisp_Object Qdisplay;
358
359 Lisp_Object Qspace, QCalign_to;
360 static Lisp_Object QCrelative_width, QCrelative_height;
361 Lisp_Object Qleft_margin, Qright_margin;
362 static Lisp_Object Qspace_width, Qraise;
363 static Lisp_Object Qslice;
364 Lisp_Object Qcenter;
365 static Lisp_Object Qmargin, Qpointer;
366 static Lisp_Object Qline_height;
367
368 /* These setters are used only in this file, so they can be private. */
369 static inline void
370 wset_base_line_number (struct window *w, Lisp_Object val)
371 {
372 w->base_line_number = val;
373 }
374 static inline void
375 wset_base_line_pos (struct window *w, Lisp_Object val)
376 {
377 w->base_line_pos = val;
378 }
379 static inline void
380 wset_column_number_displayed (struct window *w, Lisp_Object val)
381 {
382 w->column_number_displayed = val;
383 }
384 static inline void
385 wset_region_showing (struct window *w, Lisp_Object val)
386 {
387 w->region_showing = val;
388 }
389
390 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
391
392 /* Test if overflow newline into fringe. Called with iterator IT
393 at or past right window margin, and with IT->current_x set. */
394
395 #define IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE(IT) \
396 (!NILP (Voverflow_newline_into_fringe) \
397 && FRAME_WINDOW_P ((IT)->f) \
398 && ((IT)->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L \
399 ? (WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH ((IT)->w) > 0) \
400 : (WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH ((IT)->w) > 0)) \
401 && (IT)->current_x == (IT)->last_visible_x \
402 && (IT)->line_wrap != WORD_WRAP)
403
404 #else /* !HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
405 #define IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE(it) 0
406 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
407
408 /* Test if the display element loaded in IT, or the underlying buffer
409 or string character, is a space or a TAB character. This is used
410 to determine where word wrapping can occur. */
411
412 #define IT_DISPLAYING_WHITESPACE(it) \
413 ((it->what == IT_CHARACTER && (it->c == ' ' || it->c == '\t')) \
414 || ((STRINGP (it->string) \
415 && (SREF (it->string, IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it)) == ' ' \
416 || SREF (it->string, IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it)) == '\t')) \
417 || (it->s \
418 && (it->s[IT_BYTEPOS (*it)] == ' ' \
419 || it->s[IT_BYTEPOS (*it)] == '\t')) \
420 || (IT_BYTEPOS (*it) < ZV_BYTE \
421 && (*BYTE_POS_ADDR (IT_BYTEPOS (*it)) == ' ' \
422 || *BYTE_POS_ADDR (IT_BYTEPOS (*it)) == '\t')))) \
423
424 /* Name of the face used to highlight trailing whitespace. */
425
426 static Lisp_Object Qtrailing_whitespace;
427
428 /* Name and number of the face used to highlight escape glyphs. */
429
430 static Lisp_Object Qescape_glyph;
431
432 /* Name and number of the face used to highlight non-breaking spaces. */
433
434 static Lisp_Object Qnobreak_space;
435
436 /* The symbol `image' which is the car of the lists used to represent
437 images in Lisp. Also a tool bar style. */
438
439 Lisp_Object Qimage;
440
441 /* The image map types. */
442 Lisp_Object QCmap;
443 static Lisp_Object QCpointer;
444 static Lisp_Object Qrect, Qcircle, Qpoly;
445
446 /* Tool bar styles */
447 Lisp_Object Qboth, Qboth_horiz, Qtext_image_horiz;
448
449 /* Non-zero means print newline to stdout before next mini-buffer
450 message. */
451
452 int noninteractive_need_newline;
453
454 /* Non-zero means print newline to message log before next message. */
455
456 static int message_log_need_newline;
457
458 /* Three markers that message_dolog uses.
459 It could allocate them itself, but that causes trouble
460 in handling memory-full errors. */
461 static Lisp_Object message_dolog_marker1;
462 static Lisp_Object message_dolog_marker2;
463 static Lisp_Object message_dolog_marker3;
464 \f
465 /* The buffer position of the first character appearing entirely or
466 partially on the line of the selected window which contains the
467 cursor; <= 0 if not known. Set by set_cursor_from_row, used for
468 redisplay optimization in redisplay_internal. */
469
470 static struct text_pos this_line_start_pos;
471
472 /* Number of characters past the end of the line above, including the
473 terminating newline. */
474
475 static struct text_pos this_line_end_pos;
476
477 /* The vertical positions and the height of this line. */
478
479 static int this_line_vpos;
480 static int this_line_y;
481 static int this_line_pixel_height;
482
483 /* X position at which this display line starts. Usually zero;
484 negative if first character is partially visible. */
485
486 static int this_line_start_x;
487
488 /* The smallest character position seen by move_it_* functions as they
489 move across display lines. Used to set MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS of
490 hscrolled lines, see display_line. */
491
492 static struct text_pos this_line_min_pos;
493
494 /* Buffer that this_line_.* variables are referring to. */
495
496 static struct buffer *this_line_buffer;
497
498
499 /* Values of those variables at last redisplay are stored as
500 properties on `overlay-arrow-position' symbol. However, if
501 Voverlay_arrow_position is a marker, last-arrow-position is its
502 numerical position. */
503
504 static Lisp_Object Qlast_arrow_position, Qlast_arrow_string;
505
506 /* Alternative overlay-arrow-string and overlay-arrow-bitmap
507 properties on a symbol in overlay-arrow-variable-list. */
508
509 static Lisp_Object Qoverlay_arrow_string, Qoverlay_arrow_bitmap;
510
511 Lisp_Object Qmenu_bar_update_hook;
512
513 /* Nonzero if an overlay arrow has been displayed in this window. */
514
515 static int overlay_arrow_seen;
516
517 /* Number of windows showing the buffer of the selected window (or
518 another buffer with the same base buffer). keyboard.c refers to
519 this. */
520
521 int buffer_shared;
522
523 /* Vector containing glyphs for an ellipsis `...'. */
524
525 static Lisp_Object default_invis_vector[3];
526
527 /* This is the window where the echo area message was displayed. It
528 is always a mini-buffer window, but it may not be the same window
529 currently active as a mini-buffer. */
530
531 Lisp_Object echo_area_window;
532
533 /* List of pairs (MESSAGE . MULTIBYTE). The function save_message
534 pushes the current message and the value of
535 message_enable_multibyte on the stack, the function restore_message
536 pops the stack and displays MESSAGE again. */
537
538 static Lisp_Object Vmessage_stack;
539
540 /* Nonzero means multibyte characters were enabled when the echo area
541 message was specified. */
542
543 static int message_enable_multibyte;
544
545 /* Nonzero if we should redraw the mode lines on the next redisplay. */
546
547 int update_mode_lines;
548
549 /* Nonzero if window sizes or contents have changed since last
550 redisplay that finished. */
551
552 int windows_or_buffers_changed;
553
554 /* Nonzero means a frame's cursor type has been changed. */
555
556 int cursor_type_changed;
557
558 /* Nonzero after display_mode_line if %l was used and it displayed a
559 line number. */
560
561 static int line_number_displayed;
562
563 /* The name of the *Messages* buffer, a string. */
564
565 static Lisp_Object Vmessages_buffer_name;
566
567 /* Current, index 0, and last displayed echo area message. Either
568 buffers from echo_buffers, or nil to indicate no message. */
569
570 Lisp_Object echo_area_buffer[2];
571
572 /* The buffers referenced from echo_area_buffer. */
573
574 static Lisp_Object echo_buffer[2];
575
576 /* A vector saved used in with_area_buffer to reduce consing. */
577
578 static Lisp_Object Vwith_echo_area_save_vector;
579
580 /* Non-zero means display_echo_area should display the last echo area
581 message again. Set by redisplay_preserve_echo_area. */
582
583 static int display_last_displayed_message_p;
584
585 /* Nonzero if echo area is being used by print; zero if being used by
586 message. */
587
588 static int message_buf_print;
589
590 /* The symbol `inhibit-menubar-update' and its DEFVAR_BOOL variable. */
591
592 static Lisp_Object Qinhibit_menubar_update;
593 static Lisp_Object Qmessage_truncate_lines;
594
595 /* Set to 1 in clear_message to make redisplay_internal aware
596 of an emptied echo area. */
597
598 static int message_cleared_p;
599
600 /* A scratch glyph row with contents used for generating truncation
601 glyphs. Also used in direct_output_for_insert. */
602
603 #define MAX_SCRATCH_GLYPHS 100
604 static struct glyph_row scratch_glyph_row;
605 static struct glyph scratch_glyphs[MAX_SCRATCH_GLYPHS];
606
607 /* Ascent and height of the last line processed by move_it_to. */
608
609 static int last_max_ascent, last_height;
610
611 /* Non-zero if there's a help-echo in the echo area. */
612
613 int help_echo_showing_p;
614
615 /* If >= 0, computed, exact values of mode-line and header-line height
616 to use in the macros CURRENT_MODE_LINE_HEIGHT and
617 CURRENT_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT. */
618
619 int current_mode_line_height, current_header_line_height;
620
621 /* The maximum distance to look ahead for text properties. Values
622 that are too small let us call compute_char_face and similar
623 functions too often which is expensive. Values that are too large
624 let us call compute_char_face and alike too often because we
625 might not be interested in text properties that far away. */
626
627 #define TEXT_PROP_DISTANCE_LIMIT 100
628
629 /* SAVE_IT and RESTORE_IT are called when we save a snapshot of the
630 iterator state and later restore it. This is needed because the
631 bidi iterator on bidi.c keeps a stacked cache of its states, which
632 is really a singleton. When we use scratch iterator objects to
633 move around the buffer, we can cause the bidi cache to be pushed or
634 popped, and therefore we need to restore the cache state when we
635 return to the original iterator. */
636 #define SAVE_IT(ITCOPY,ITORIG,CACHE) \
637 do { \
638 if (CACHE) \
639 bidi_unshelve_cache (CACHE, 1); \
640 ITCOPY = ITORIG; \
641 CACHE = bidi_shelve_cache (); \
642 } while (0)
643
644 #define RESTORE_IT(pITORIG,pITCOPY,CACHE) \
645 do { \
646 if (pITORIG != pITCOPY) \
647 *(pITORIG) = *(pITCOPY); \
648 bidi_unshelve_cache (CACHE, 0); \
649 CACHE = NULL; \
650 } while (0)
651
652 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
653
654 /* Non-zero means print traces of redisplay if compiled with
655 GLYPH_DEBUG defined. */
656
657 int trace_redisplay_p;
658
659 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
660
661 #ifdef DEBUG_TRACE_MOVE
662 /* Non-zero means trace with TRACE_MOVE to stderr. */
663 int trace_move;
664
665 #define TRACE_MOVE(x) if (trace_move) fprintf x; else (void) 0
666 #else
667 #define TRACE_MOVE(x) (void) 0
668 #endif
669
670 static Lisp_Object Qauto_hscroll_mode;
671
672 /* Buffer being redisplayed -- for redisplay_window_error. */
673
674 static struct buffer *displayed_buffer;
675
676 /* Value returned from text property handlers (see below). */
677
678 enum prop_handled
679 {
680 HANDLED_NORMALLY,
681 HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS,
682 HANDLED_OVERLAY_STRING_CONSUMED,
683 HANDLED_RETURN
684 };
685
686 /* A description of text properties that redisplay is interested
687 in. */
688
689 struct props
690 {
691 /* The name of the property. */
692 Lisp_Object *name;
693
694 /* A unique index for the property. */
695 enum prop_idx idx;
696
697 /* A handler function called to set up iterator IT from the property
698 at IT's current position. Value is used to steer handle_stop. */
699 enum prop_handled (*handler) (struct it *it);
700 };
701
702 static enum prop_handled handle_face_prop (struct it *);
703 static enum prop_handled handle_invisible_prop (struct it *);
704 static enum prop_handled handle_display_prop (struct it *);
705 static enum prop_handled handle_composition_prop (struct it *);
706 static enum prop_handled handle_overlay_change (struct it *);
707 static enum prop_handled handle_fontified_prop (struct it *);
708
709 /* Properties handled by iterators. */
710
711 static struct props it_props[] =
712 {
713 {&Qfontified, FONTIFIED_PROP_IDX, handle_fontified_prop},
714 /* Handle `face' before `display' because some sub-properties of
715 `display' need to know the face. */
716 {&Qface, FACE_PROP_IDX, handle_face_prop},
717 {&Qdisplay, DISPLAY_PROP_IDX, handle_display_prop},
718 {&Qinvisible, INVISIBLE_PROP_IDX, handle_invisible_prop},
719 {&Qcomposition, COMPOSITION_PROP_IDX, handle_composition_prop},
720 {NULL, 0, NULL}
721 };
722
723 /* Value is the position described by X. If X is a marker, value is
724 the marker_position of X. Otherwise, value is X. */
725
726 #define COERCE_MARKER(X) (MARKERP ((X)) ? Fmarker_position (X) : (X))
727
728 /* Enumeration returned by some move_it_.* functions internally. */
729
730 enum move_it_result
731 {
732 /* Not used. Undefined value. */
733 MOVE_UNDEFINED,
734
735 /* Move ended at the requested buffer position or ZV. */
736 MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV,
737
738 /* Move ended at the requested X pixel position. */
739 MOVE_X_REACHED,
740
741 /* Move within a line ended at the end of a line that must be
742 continued. */
743 MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED,
744
745 /* Move within a line ended at the end of a line that would
746 be displayed truncated. */
747 MOVE_LINE_TRUNCATED,
748
749 /* Move within a line ended at a line end. */
750 MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR
751 };
752
753 /* This counter is used to clear the face cache every once in a while
754 in redisplay_internal. It is incremented for each redisplay.
755 Every CLEAR_FACE_CACHE_COUNT full redisplays, the face cache is
756 cleared. */
757
758 #define CLEAR_FACE_CACHE_COUNT 500
759 static int clear_face_cache_count;
760
761 /* Similarly for the image cache. */
762
763 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
764 #define CLEAR_IMAGE_CACHE_COUNT 101
765 static int clear_image_cache_count;
766
767 /* Null glyph slice */
768 static struct glyph_slice null_glyph_slice = { 0, 0, 0, 0 };
769 #endif
770
771 /* Non-zero while redisplay_internal is in progress. */
772
773 int redisplaying_p;
774
775 static Lisp_Object Qinhibit_free_realized_faces;
776 static Lisp_Object Qmode_line_default_help_echo;
777
778 /* If a string, XTread_socket generates an event to display that string.
779 (The display is done in read_char.) */
780
781 Lisp_Object help_echo_string;
782 Lisp_Object help_echo_window;
783 Lisp_Object help_echo_object;
784 ptrdiff_t help_echo_pos;
785
786 /* Temporary variable for XTread_socket. */
787
788 Lisp_Object previous_help_echo_string;
789
790 /* Platform-independent portion of hourglass implementation. */
791
792 /* Non-zero means an hourglass cursor is currently shown. */
793 int hourglass_shown_p;
794
795 /* If non-null, an asynchronous timer that, when it expires, displays
796 an hourglass cursor on all frames. */
797 struct atimer *hourglass_atimer;
798
799 /* Name of the face used to display glyphless characters. */
800 Lisp_Object Qglyphless_char;
801
802 /* Symbol for the purpose of Vglyphless_char_display. */
803 static Lisp_Object Qglyphless_char_display;
804
805 /* Method symbols for Vglyphless_char_display. */
806 static Lisp_Object Qhex_code, Qempty_box, Qthin_space, Qzero_width;
807
808 /* Default pixel width of `thin-space' display method. */
809 #define THIN_SPACE_WIDTH 1
810
811 /* Default number of seconds to wait before displaying an hourglass
812 cursor. */
813 #define DEFAULT_HOURGLASS_DELAY 1
814
815 \f
816 /* Function prototypes. */
817
818 static void setup_for_ellipsis (struct it *, int);
819 static void set_iterator_to_next (struct it *, int);
820 static void mark_window_display_accurate_1 (struct window *, int);
821 static int single_display_spec_string_p (Lisp_Object, Lisp_Object);
822 static int display_prop_string_p (Lisp_Object, Lisp_Object);
823 static int cursor_row_p (struct glyph_row *);
824 static int redisplay_mode_lines (Lisp_Object, int);
825 static char *decode_mode_spec_coding (Lisp_Object, char *, int);
826
827 static Lisp_Object get_it_property (struct it *it, Lisp_Object prop);
828
829 static void handle_line_prefix (struct it *);
830
831 static void pint2str (char *, int, ptrdiff_t);
832 static void pint2hrstr (char *, int, ptrdiff_t);
833 static struct text_pos run_window_scroll_functions (Lisp_Object,
834 struct text_pos);
835 static void reconsider_clip_changes (struct window *, struct buffer *);
836 static int text_outside_line_unchanged_p (struct window *,
837 ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t);
838 static void store_mode_line_noprop_char (char);
839 static int store_mode_line_noprop (const char *, int, int);
840 static void handle_stop (struct it *);
841 static void handle_stop_backwards (struct it *, ptrdiff_t);
842 static void vmessage (const char *, va_list) ATTRIBUTE_FORMAT_PRINTF (1, 0);
843 static void ensure_echo_area_buffers (void);
844 static Lisp_Object unwind_with_echo_area_buffer (Lisp_Object);
845 static Lisp_Object with_echo_area_buffer_unwind_data (struct window *);
846 static int with_echo_area_buffer (struct window *, int,
847 int (*) (ptrdiff_t, Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t),
848 ptrdiff_t, Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t);
849 static void clear_garbaged_frames (void);
850 static int current_message_1 (ptrdiff_t, Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t);
851 static void pop_message (void);
852 static int truncate_message_1 (ptrdiff_t, Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t);
853 static void set_message (const char *, Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t, int);
854 static int set_message_1 (ptrdiff_t, Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t);
855 static int display_echo_area (struct window *);
856 static int display_echo_area_1 (ptrdiff_t, Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t);
857 static int resize_mini_window_1 (ptrdiff_t, Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t);
858 static Lisp_Object unwind_redisplay (Lisp_Object);
859 static int string_char_and_length (const unsigned char *, int *);
860 static struct text_pos display_prop_end (struct it *, Lisp_Object,
861 struct text_pos);
862 static int compute_window_start_on_continuation_line (struct window *);
863 static void insert_left_trunc_glyphs (struct it *);
864 static struct glyph_row *get_overlay_arrow_glyph_row (struct window *,
865 Lisp_Object);
866 static void extend_face_to_end_of_line (struct it *);
867 static int append_space_for_newline (struct it *, int);
868 static int cursor_row_fully_visible_p (struct window *, int, int);
869 static int try_scrolling (Lisp_Object, int, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t, int, int);
870 static int try_cursor_movement (Lisp_Object, struct text_pos, int *);
871 static int trailing_whitespace_p (ptrdiff_t);
872 static intmax_t message_log_check_duplicate (ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t);
873 static void push_it (struct it *, struct text_pos *);
874 static void iterate_out_of_display_property (struct it *);
875 static void pop_it (struct it *);
876 static void sync_frame_with_window_matrix_rows (struct window *);
877 static void select_frame_for_redisplay (Lisp_Object);
878 static void redisplay_internal (void);
879 static int echo_area_display (int);
880 static void redisplay_windows (Lisp_Object);
881 static void redisplay_window (Lisp_Object, int);
882 static Lisp_Object redisplay_window_error (Lisp_Object);
883 static Lisp_Object redisplay_window_0 (Lisp_Object);
884 static Lisp_Object redisplay_window_1 (Lisp_Object);
885 static int set_cursor_from_row (struct window *, struct glyph_row *,
886 struct glyph_matrix *, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t,
887 int, int);
888 static int update_menu_bar (struct frame *, int, int);
889 static int try_window_reusing_current_matrix (struct window *);
890 static int try_window_id (struct window *);
891 static int display_line (struct it *);
892 static int display_mode_lines (struct window *);
893 static int display_mode_line (struct window *, enum face_id, Lisp_Object);
894 static int display_mode_element (struct it *, int, int, int, Lisp_Object, Lisp_Object, int);
895 static int store_mode_line_string (const char *, Lisp_Object, int, int, int, Lisp_Object);
896 static const char *decode_mode_spec (struct window *, int, int, Lisp_Object *);
897 static void display_menu_bar (struct window *);
898 static ptrdiff_t display_count_lines (ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t,
899 ptrdiff_t *);
900 static int display_string (const char *, Lisp_Object, Lisp_Object,
901 ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t, struct it *, int, int, int, int);
902 static void compute_line_metrics (struct it *);
903 static void run_redisplay_end_trigger_hook (struct it *);
904 static int get_overlay_strings (struct it *, ptrdiff_t);
905 static int get_overlay_strings_1 (struct it *, ptrdiff_t, int);
906 static void next_overlay_string (struct it *);
907 static void reseat (struct it *, struct text_pos, int);
908 static void reseat_1 (struct it *, struct text_pos, int);
909 static void back_to_previous_visible_line_start (struct it *);
910 void reseat_at_previous_visible_line_start (struct it *);
911 static void reseat_at_next_visible_line_start (struct it *, int);
912 static int next_element_from_ellipsis (struct it *);
913 static int next_element_from_display_vector (struct it *);
914 static int next_element_from_string (struct it *);
915 static int next_element_from_c_string (struct it *);
916 static int next_element_from_buffer (struct it *);
917 static int next_element_from_composition (struct it *);
918 static int next_element_from_image (struct it *);
919 static int next_element_from_stretch (struct it *);
920 static void load_overlay_strings (struct it *, ptrdiff_t);
921 static int init_from_display_pos (struct it *, struct window *,
922 struct display_pos *);
923 static void reseat_to_string (struct it *, const char *,
924 Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t, int, int);
925 static int get_next_display_element (struct it *);
926 static enum move_it_result
927 move_it_in_display_line_to (struct it *, ptrdiff_t, int,
928 enum move_operation_enum);
929 void move_it_vertically_backward (struct it *, int);
930 static void init_to_row_start (struct it *, struct window *,
931 struct glyph_row *);
932 static int init_to_row_end (struct it *, struct window *,
933 struct glyph_row *);
934 static void back_to_previous_line_start (struct it *);
935 static int forward_to_next_line_start (struct it *, int *, struct bidi_it *);
936 static struct text_pos string_pos_nchars_ahead (struct text_pos,
937 Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t);
938 static struct text_pos string_pos (ptrdiff_t, Lisp_Object);
939 static struct text_pos c_string_pos (ptrdiff_t, const char *, int);
940 static ptrdiff_t number_of_chars (const char *, int);
941 static void compute_stop_pos (struct it *);
942 static void compute_string_pos (struct text_pos *, struct text_pos,
943 Lisp_Object);
944 static int face_before_or_after_it_pos (struct it *, int);
945 static ptrdiff_t next_overlay_change (ptrdiff_t);
946 static int handle_display_spec (struct it *, Lisp_Object, Lisp_Object,
947 Lisp_Object, struct text_pos *, ptrdiff_t, int);
948 static int handle_single_display_spec (struct it *, Lisp_Object,
949 Lisp_Object, Lisp_Object,
950 struct text_pos *, ptrdiff_t, int, int);
951 static int underlying_face_id (struct it *);
952 static int in_ellipses_for_invisible_text_p (struct display_pos *,
953 struct window *);
954
955 #define face_before_it_pos(IT) face_before_or_after_it_pos ((IT), 1)
956 #define face_after_it_pos(IT) face_before_or_after_it_pos ((IT), 0)
957
958 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
959
960 static void x_consider_frame_title (Lisp_Object);
961 static int tool_bar_lines_needed (struct frame *, int *);
962 static void update_tool_bar (struct frame *, int);
963 static void build_desired_tool_bar_string (struct frame *f);
964 static int redisplay_tool_bar (struct frame *);
965 static void display_tool_bar_line (struct it *, int);
966 static void notice_overwritten_cursor (struct window *,
967 enum glyph_row_area,
968 int, int, int, int);
969 static void append_stretch_glyph (struct it *, Lisp_Object,
970 int, int, int);
971
972
973 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
974
975 static void produce_special_glyphs (struct it *, enum display_element_type);
976 static void show_mouse_face (Mouse_HLInfo *, enum draw_glyphs_face);
977 static int coords_in_mouse_face_p (struct window *, int, int);
978
979
980 \f
981 /***********************************************************************
982 Window display dimensions
983 ***********************************************************************/
984
985 /* Return the bottom boundary y-position for text lines in window W.
986 This is the first y position at which a line cannot start.
987 It is relative to the top of the window.
988
989 This is the height of W minus the height of a mode line, if any. */
990
991 int
992 window_text_bottom_y (struct window *w)
993 {
994 int height = WINDOW_TOTAL_HEIGHT (w);
995
996 if (WINDOW_WANTS_MODELINE_P (w))
997 height -= CURRENT_MODE_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
998 return height;
999 }
1000
1001 /* Return the pixel width of display area AREA of window W. AREA < 0
1002 means return the total width of W, not including fringes to
1003 the left and right of the window. */
1004
1005 int
1006 window_box_width (struct window *w, int area)
1007 {
1008 int cols = XFASTINT (w->total_cols);
1009 int pixels = 0;
1010
1011 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
1012 {
1013 cols -= WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w);
1014
1015 if (area == TEXT_AREA)
1016 {
1017 if (INTEGERP (w->left_margin_cols))
1018 cols -= XFASTINT (w->left_margin_cols);
1019 if (INTEGERP (w->right_margin_cols))
1020 cols -= XFASTINT (w->right_margin_cols);
1021 pixels = -WINDOW_TOTAL_FRINGE_WIDTH (w);
1022 }
1023 else if (area == LEFT_MARGIN_AREA)
1024 {
1025 cols = (INTEGERP (w->left_margin_cols)
1026 ? XFASTINT (w->left_margin_cols) : 0);
1027 pixels = 0;
1028 }
1029 else if (area == RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA)
1030 {
1031 cols = (INTEGERP (w->right_margin_cols)
1032 ? XFASTINT (w->right_margin_cols) : 0);
1033 pixels = 0;
1034 }
1035 }
1036
1037 return cols * WINDOW_FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (w) + pixels;
1038 }
1039
1040
1041 /* Return the pixel height of the display area of window W, not
1042 including mode lines of W, if any. */
1043
1044 int
1045 window_box_height (struct window *w)
1046 {
1047 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
1048 int height = WINDOW_TOTAL_HEIGHT (w);
1049
1050 eassert (height >= 0);
1051
1052 /* Note: the code below that determines the mode-line/header-line
1053 height is essentially the same as that contained in the macro
1054 CURRENT_{MODE,HEADER}_LINE_HEIGHT, except that it checks whether
1055 the appropriate glyph row has its `mode_line_p' flag set,
1056 and if it doesn't, uses estimate_mode_line_height instead. */
1057
1058 if (WINDOW_WANTS_MODELINE_P (w))
1059 {
1060 struct glyph_row *ml_row
1061 = (w->current_matrix && w->current_matrix->rows
1062 ? MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)
1063 : 0);
1064 if (ml_row && ml_row->mode_line_p)
1065 height -= ml_row->height;
1066 else
1067 height -= estimate_mode_line_height (f, CURRENT_MODE_LINE_FACE_ID (w));
1068 }
1069
1070 if (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w))
1071 {
1072 struct glyph_row *hl_row
1073 = (w->current_matrix && w->current_matrix->rows
1074 ? MATRIX_HEADER_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)
1075 : 0);
1076 if (hl_row && hl_row->mode_line_p)
1077 height -= hl_row->height;
1078 else
1079 height -= estimate_mode_line_height (f, HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID);
1080 }
1081
1082 /* With a very small font and a mode-line that's taller than
1083 default, we might end up with a negative height. */
1084 return max (0, height);
1085 }
1086
1087 /* Return the window-relative coordinate of the left edge of display
1088 area AREA of window W. AREA < 0 means return the left edge of the
1089 whole window, to the right of the left fringe of W. */
1090
1091 int
1092 window_box_left_offset (struct window *w, int area)
1093 {
1094 int x;
1095
1096 if (w->pseudo_window_p)
1097 return 0;
1098
1099 x = WINDOW_LEFT_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (w);
1100
1101 if (area == TEXT_AREA)
1102 x += (WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
1103 + window_box_width (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA));
1104 else if (area == RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA)
1105 x += (WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
1106 + window_box_width (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA)
1107 + window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA)
1108 + (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
1109 ? 0
1110 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)));
1111 else if (area == LEFT_MARGIN_AREA
1112 && WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w))
1113 x += WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w);
1114
1115 return x;
1116 }
1117
1118
1119 /* Return the window-relative coordinate of the right edge of display
1120 area AREA of window W. AREA < 0 means return the right edge of the
1121 whole window, to the left of the right fringe of W. */
1122
1123 int
1124 window_box_right_offset (struct window *w, int area)
1125 {
1126 return window_box_left_offset (w, area) + window_box_width (w, area);
1127 }
1128
1129 /* Return the frame-relative coordinate of the left edge of display
1130 area AREA of window W. AREA < 0 means return the left edge of the
1131 whole window, to the right of the left fringe of W. */
1132
1133 int
1134 window_box_left (struct window *w, int area)
1135 {
1136 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
1137 int x;
1138
1139 if (w->pseudo_window_p)
1140 return FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
1141
1142 x = (WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (w)
1143 + window_box_left_offset (w, area));
1144
1145 return x;
1146 }
1147
1148
1149 /* Return the frame-relative coordinate of the right edge of display
1150 area AREA of window W. AREA < 0 means return the right edge of the
1151 whole window, to the left of the right fringe of W. */
1152
1153 int
1154 window_box_right (struct window *w, int area)
1155 {
1156 return window_box_left (w, area) + window_box_width (w, area);
1157 }
1158
1159 /* Get the bounding box of the display area AREA of window W, without
1160 mode lines, in frame-relative coordinates. AREA < 0 means the
1161 whole window, not including the left and right fringes of
1162 the window. Return in *BOX_X and *BOX_Y the frame-relative pixel
1163 coordinates of the upper-left corner of the box. Return in
1164 *BOX_WIDTH, and *BOX_HEIGHT the pixel width and height of the box. */
1165
1166 void
1167 window_box (struct window *w, int area, int *box_x, int *box_y,
1168 int *box_width, int *box_height)
1169 {
1170 if (box_width)
1171 *box_width = window_box_width (w, area);
1172 if (box_height)
1173 *box_height = window_box_height (w);
1174 if (box_x)
1175 *box_x = window_box_left (w, area);
1176 if (box_y)
1177 {
1178 *box_y = WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_Y (w);
1179 if (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w))
1180 *box_y += CURRENT_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
1181 }
1182 }
1183
1184
1185 /* Get the bounding box of the display area AREA of window W, without
1186 mode lines. AREA < 0 means the whole window, not including the
1187 left and right fringe of the window. Return in *TOP_LEFT_X
1188 and TOP_LEFT_Y the frame-relative pixel coordinates of the
1189 upper-left corner of the box. Return in *BOTTOM_RIGHT_X, and
1190 *BOTTOM_RIGHT_Y the coordinates of the bottom-right corner of the
1191 box. */
1192
1193 static inline void
1194 window_box_edges (struct window *w, int area, int *top_left_x, int *top_left_y,
1195 int *bottom_right_x, int *bottom_right_y)
1196 {
1197 window_box (w, area, top_left_x, top_left_y, bottom_right_x,
1198 bottom_right_y);
1199 *bottom_right_x += *top_left_x;
1200 *bottom_right_y += *top_left_y;
1201 }
1202
1203
1204 \f
1205 /***********************************************************************
1206 Utilities
1207 ***********************************************************************/
1208
1209 /* Return the bottom y-position of the line the iterator IT is in.
1210 This can modify IT's settings. */
1211
1212 int
1213 line_bottom_y (struct it *it)
1214 {
1215 int line_height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
1216 int line_top_y = it->current_y;
1217
1218 if (line_height == 0)
1219 {
1220 if (last_height)
1221 line_height = last_height;
1222 else if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < ZV)
1223 {
1224 move_it_by_lines (it, 1);
1225 line_height = (it->max_ascent || it->max_descent
1226 ? it->max_ascent + it->max_descent
1227 : last_height);
1228 }
1229 else
1230 {
1231 struct glyph_row *row = it->glyph_row;
1232
1233 /* Use the default character height. */
1234 it->glyph_row = NULL;
1235 it->what = IT_CHARACTER;
1236 it->c = ' ';
1237 it->len = 1;
1238 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
1239 line_height = it->ascent + it->descent;
1240 it->glyph_row = row;
1241 }
1242 }
1243
1244 return line_top_y + line_height;
1245 }
1246
1247 /* Subroutine of pos_visible_p below. Extracts a display string, if
1248 any, from the display spec given as its argument. */
1249 static Lisp_Object
1250 string_from_display_spec (Lisp_Object spec)
1251 {
1252 if (CONSP (spec))
1253 {
1254 while (CONSP (spec))
1255 {
1256 if (STRINGP (XCAR (spec)))
1257 return XCAR (spec);
1258 spec = XCDR (spec);
1259 }
1260 }
1261 else if (VECTORP (spec))
1262 {
1263 ptrdiff_t i;
1264
1265 for (i = 0; i < ASIZE (spec); i++)
1266 {
1267 if (STRINGP (AREF (spec, i)))
1268 return AREF (spec, i);
1269 }
1270 return Qnil;
1271 }
1272
1273 return spec;
1274 }
1275
1276
1277 /* Limit insanely large values of W->hscroll on frame F to the largest
1278 value that will still prevent first_visible_x and last_visible_x of
1279 'struct it' from overflowing an int. */
1280 static inline int
1281 window_hscroll_limited (struct window *w, struct frame *f)
1282 {
1283 ptrdiff_t window_hscroll = w->hscroll;
1284 int window_text_width = window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA);
1285 int colwidth = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
1286
1287 if (window_hscroll > (INT_MAX - window_text_width) / colwidth - 1)
1288 window_hscroll = (INT_MAX - window_text_width) / colwidth - 1;
1289
1290 return window_hscroll;
1291 }
1292
1293 /* Return 1 if position CHARPOS is visible in window W.
1294 CHARPOS < 0 means return info about WINDOW_END position.
1295 If visible, set *X and *Y to pixel coordinates of top left corner.
1296 Set *RTOP and *RBOT to pixel height of an invisible area of glyph at POS.
1297 Set *ROWH and *VPOS to row's visible height and VPOS (row number). */
1298
1299 int
1300 pos_visible_p (struct window *w, ptrdiff_t charpos, int *x, int *y,
1301 int *rtop, int *rbot, int *rowh, int *vpos)
1302 {
1303 struct it it;
1304 void *itdata = bidi_shelve_cache ();
1305 struct text_pos top;
1306 int visible_p = 0;
1307 struct buffer *old_buffer = NULL;
1308
1309 if (FRAME_INITIAL_P (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w))))
1310 return visible_p;
1311
1312 if (XBUFFER (w->buffer) != current_buffer)
1313 {
1314 old_buffer = current_buffer;
1315 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (w->buffer));
1316 }
1317
1318 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (top, w->start);
1319 /* Scrolling a minibuffer window via scroll bar when the echo area
1320 shows long text sometimes resets the minibuffer contents behind
1321 our backs. */
1322 if (CHARPOS (top) > ZV)
1323 SET_TEXT_POS (top, BEGV, BEGV_BYTE);
1324
1325 /* Compute exact mode line heights. */
1326 if (WINDOW_WANTS_MODELINE_P (w))
1327 current_mode_line_height
1328 = display_mode_line (w, CURRENT_MODE_LINE_FACE_ID (w),
1329 BVAR (current_buffer, mode_line_format));
1330
1331 if (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w))
1332 current_header_line_height
1333 = display_mode_line (w, HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID,
1334 BVAR (current_buffer, header_line_format));
1335
1336 start_display (&it, w, top);
1337 move_it_to (&it, charpos, -1, it.last_visible_y-1, -1,
1338 (charpos >= 0 ? MOVE_TO_POS : 0) | MOVE_TO_Y);
1339
1340 if (charpos >= 0
1341 && (((!it.bidi_p || it.bidi_it.scan_dir == 1)
1342 && IT_CHARPOS (it) >= charpos)
1343 /* When scanning backwards under bidi iteration, move_it_to
1344 stops at or _before_ CHARPOS, because it stops at or to
1345 the _right_ of the character at CHARPOS. */
1346 || (it.bidi_p && it.bidi_it.scan_dir == -1
1347 && IT_CHARPOS (it) <= charpos)))
1348 {
1349 /* We have reached CHARPOS, or passed it. How the call to
1350 move_it_to can overshoot: (i) If CHARPOS is on invisible text
1351 or covered by a display property, move_it_to stops at the end
1352 of the invisible text, to the right of CHARPOS. (ii) If
1353 CHARPOS is in a display vector, move_it_to stops on its last
1354 glyph. */
1355 int top_x = it.current_x;
1356 int top_y = it.current_y;
1357 /* Calling line_bottom_y may change it.method, it.position, etc. */
1358 enum it_method it_method = it.method;
1359 int bottom_y = (last_height = 0, line_bottom_y (&it));
1360 int window_top_y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
1361
1362 if (top_y < window_top_y)
1363 visible_p = bottom_y > window_top_y;
1364 else if (top_y < it.last_visible_y)
1365 visible_p = 1;
1366 if (bottom_y >= it.last_visible_y
1367 && it.bidi_p && it.bidi_it.scan_dir == -1
1368 && IT_CHARPOS (it) < charpos)
1369 {
1370 /* When the last line of the window is scanned backwards
1371 under bidi iteration, we could be duped into thinking
1372 that we have passed CHARPOS, when in fact move_it_to
1373 simply stopped short of CHARPOS because it reached
1374 last_visible_y. To see if that's what happened, we call
1375 move_it_to again with a slightly larger vertical limit,
1376 and see if it actually moved vertically; if it did, we
1377 didn't really reach CHARPOS, which is beyond window end. */
1378 struct it save_it = it;
1379 /* Why 10? because we don't know how many canonical lines
1380 will the height of the next line(s) be. So we guess. */
1381 int ten_more_lines =
1382 10 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w)));
1383
1384 move_it_to (&it, charpos, -1, bottom_y + ten_more_lines, -1,
1385 MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_Y);
1386 if (it.current_y > top_y)
1387 visible_p = 0;
1388
1389 it = save_it;
1390 }
1391 if (visible_p)
1392 {
1393 if (it_method == GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR)
1394 {
1395 /* We stopped on the last glyph of a display vector.
1396 Try and recompute. Hack alert! */
1397 if (charpos < 2 || top.charpos >= charpos)
1398 top_x = it.glyph_row->x;
1399 else
1400 {
1401 struct it it2;
1402 start_display (&it2, w, top);
1403 move_it_to (&it2, charpos - 1, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
1404 get_next_display_element (&it2);
1405 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (&it2);
1406 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (&it2)
1407 || it2.current_x > it2.last_visible_x)
1408 top_x = it.glyph_row->x;
1409 else
1410 {
1411 top_x = it2.current_x;
1412 top_y = it2.current_y;
1413 }
1414 }
1415 }
1416 else if (IT_CHARPOS (it) != charpos)
1417 {
1418 Lisp_Object cpos = make_number (charpos);
1419 Lisp_Object spec = Fget_char_property (cpos, Qdisplay, Qnil);
1420 Lisp_Object string = string_from_display_spec (spec);
1421 int newline_in_string = 0;
1422
1423 if (STRINGP (string))
1424 {
1425 const char *s = SSDATA (string);
1426 const char *e = s + SBYTES (string);
1427 while (s < e)
1428 {
1429 if (*s++ == '\n')
1430 {
1431 newline_in_string = 1;
1432 break;
1433 }
1434 }
1435 }
1436 /* The tricky code below is needed because there's a
1437 discrepancy between move_it_to and how we set cursor
1438 when the display line ends in a newline from a
1439 display string. move_it_to will stop _after_ such
1440 display strings, whereas set_cursor_from_row
1441 conspires with cursor_row_p to place the cursor on
1442 the first glyph produced from the display string. */
1443
1444 /* We have overshoot PT because it is covered by a
1445 display property whose value is a string. If the
1446 string includes embedded newlines, we are also in the
1447 wrong display line. Backtrack to the correct line,
1448 where the display string begins. */
1449 if (newline_in_string)
1450 {
1451 Lisp_Object startpos, endpos;
1452 EMACS_INT start, end;
1453 struct it it3;
1454 int it3_moved;
1455
1456 /* Find the first and the last buffer positions
1457 covered by the display string. */
1458 endpos =
1459 Fnext_single_char_property_change (cpos, Qdisplay,
1460 Qnil, Qnil);
1461 startpos =
1462 Fprevious_single_char_property_change (endpos, Qdisplay,
1463 Qnil, Qnil);
1464 start = XFASTINT (startpos);
1465 end = XFASTINT (endpos);
1466 /* Move to the last buffer position before the
1467 display property. */
1468 start_display (&it3, w, top);
1469 move_it_to (&it3, start - 1, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
1470 /* Move forward one more line if the position before
1471 the display string is a newline or if it is the
1472 rightmost character on a line that is
1473 continued or word-wrapped. */
1474 if (it3.method == GET_FROM_BUFFER
1475 && it3.c == '\n')
1476 move_it_by_lines (&it3, 1);
1477 else if (move_it_in_display_line_to (&it3, -1,
1478 it3.current_x
1479 + it3.pixel_width,
1480 MOVE_TO_X)
1481 == MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED)
1482 {
1483 move_it_by_lines (&it3, 1);
1484 /* When we are under word-wrap, the #$@%!
1485 move_it_by_lines moves 2 lines, so we need to
1486 fix that up. */
1487 if (it3.line_wrap == WORD_WRAP)
1488 move_it_by_lines (&it3, -1);
1489 }
1490
1491 /* Record the vertical coordinate of the display
1492 line where we wound up. */
1493 top_y = it3.current_y;
1494 if (it3.bidi_p)
1495 {
1496 /* When characters are reordered for display,
1497 the character displayed to the left of the
1498 display string could be _after_ the display
1499 property in the logical order. Use the
1500 smallest vertical position of these two. */
1501 start_display (&it3, w, top);
1502 move_it_to (&it3, end + 1, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
1503 if (it3.current_y < top_y)
1504 top_y = it3.current_y;
1505 }
1506 /* Move from the top of the window to the beginning
1507 of the display line where the display string
1508 begins. */
1509 start_display (&it3, w, top);
1510 move_it_to (&it3, -1, 0, top_y, -1, MOVE_TO_X | MOVE_TO_Y);
1511 /* If it3_moved stays zero after the 'while' loop
1512 below, that means we already were at a newline
1513 before the loop (e.g., the display string begins
1514 with a newline), so we don't need to (and cannot)
1515 inspect the glyphs of it3.glyph_row, because
1516 PRODUCE_GLYPHS will not produce anything for a
1517 newline, and thus it3.glyph_row stays at its
1518 stale content it got at top of the window. */
1519 it3_moved = 0;
1520 /* Finally, advance the iterator until we hit the
1521 first display element whose character position is
1522 CHARPOS, or until the first newline from the
1523 display string, which signals the end of the
1524 display line. */
1525 while (get_next_display_element (&it3))
1526 {
1527 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (&it3);
1528 if (IT_CHARPOS (it3) == charpos
1529 || ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (&it3))
1530 break;
1531 it3_moved = 1;
1532 set_iterator_to_next (&it3, 0);
1533 }
1534 top_x = it3.current_x - it3.pixel_width;
1535 /* Normally, we would exit the above loop because we
1536 found the display element whose character
1537 position is CHARPOS. For the contingency that we
1538 didn't, and stopped at the first newline from the
1539 display string, move back over the glyphs
1540 produced from the string, until we find the
1541 rightmost glyph not from the string. */
1542 if (it3_moved
1543 && IT_CHARPOS (it3) != charpos && EQ (it3.object, string))
1544 {
1545 struct glyph *g = it3.glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]
1546 + it3.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
1547
1548 while (EQ ((g - 1)->object, string))
1549 {
1550 --g;
1551 top_x -= g->pixel_width;
1552 }
1553 eassert (g < it3.glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]
1554 + it3.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA]);
1555 }
1556 }
1557 }
1558
1559 *x = top_x;
1560 *y = max (top_y + max (0, it.max_ascent - it.ascent), window_top_y);
1561 *rtop = max (0, window_top_y - top_y);
1562 *rbot = max (0, bottom_y - it.last_visible_y);
1563 *rowh = max (0, (min (bottom_y, it.last_visible_y)
1564 - max (top_y, window_top_y)));
1565 *vpos = it.vpos;
1566 }
1567 }
1568 else
1569 {
1570 /* We were asked to provide info about WINDOW_END. */
1571 struct it it2;
1572 void *it2data = NULL;
1573
1574 SAVE_IT (it2, it, it2data);
1575 if (IT_CHARPOS (it) < ZV && FETCH_BYTE (IT_BYTEPOS (it)) != '\n')
1576 move_it_by_lines (&it, 1);
1577 if (charpos < IT_CHARPOS (it)
1578 || (it.what == IT_EOB && charpos == IT_CHARPOS (it)))
1579 {
1580 visible_p = 1;
1581 RESTORE_IT (&it2, &it2, it2data);
1582 move_it_to (&it2, charpos, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
1583 *x = it2.current_x;
1584 *y = it2.current_y + it2.max_ascent - it2.ascent;
1585 *rtop = max (0, -it2.current_y);
1586 *rbot = max (0, ((it2.current_y + it2.max_ascent + it2.max_descent)
1587 - it.last_visible_y));
1588 *rowh = max (0, (min (it2.current_y + it2.max_ascent + it2.max_descent,
1589 it.last_visible_y)
1590 - max (it2.current_y,
1591 WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w))));
1592 *vpos = it2.vpos;
1593 }
1594 else
1595 bidi_unshelve_cache (it2data, 1);
1596 }
1597 bidi_unshelve_cache (itdata, 0);
1598
1599 if (old_buffer)
1600 set_buffer_internal_1 (old_buffer);
1601
1602 current_header_line_height = current_mode_line_height = -1;
1603
1604 if (visible_p && w->hscroll > 0)
1605 *x -=
1606 window_hscroll_limited (w, WINDOW_XFRAME (w))
1607 * WINDOW_FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (w);
1608
1609 #if 0
1610 /* Debugging code. */
1611 if (visible_p)
1612 fprintf (stderr, "+pv pt=%d vs=%d --> x=%d y=%d rt=%d rb=%d rh=%d vp=%d\n",
1613 charpos, w->vscroll, *x, *y, *rtop, *rbot, *rowh, *vpos);
1614 else
1615 fprintf (stderr, "-pv pt=%d vs=%d\n", charpos, w->vscroll);
1616 #endif
1617
1618 return visible_p;
1619 }
1620
1621
1622 /* Return the next character from STR. Return in *LEN the length of
1623 the character. This is like STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH but never
1624 returns an invalid character. If we find one, we return a `?', but
1625 with the length of the invalid character. */
1626
1627 static inline int
1628 string_char_and_length (const unsigned char *str, int *len)
1629 {
1630 int c;
1631
1632 c = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (str, *len);
1633 if (!CHAR_VALID_P (c))
1634 /* We may not change the length here because other places in Emacs
1635 don't use this function, i.e. they silently accept invalid
1636 characters. */
1637 c = '?';
1638
1639 return c;
1640 }
1641
1642
1643
1644 /* Given a position POS containing a valid character and byte position
1645 in STRING, return the position NCHARS ahead (NCHARS >= 0). */
1646
1647 static struct text_pos
1648 string_pos_nchars_ahead (struct text_pos pos, Lisp_Object string, ptrdiff_t nchars)
1649 {
1650 eassert (STRINGP (string) && nchars >= 0);
1651
1652 if (STRING_MULTIBYTE (string))
1653 {
1654 const unsigned char *p = SDATA (string) + BYTEPOS (pos);
1655 int len;
1656
1657 while (nchars--)
1658 {
1659 string_char_and_length (p, &len);
1660 p += len;
1661 CHARPOS (pos) += 1;
1662 BYTEPOS (pos) += len;
1663 }
1664 }
1665 else
1666 SET_TEXT_POS (pos, CHARPOS (pos) + nchars, BYTEPOS (pos) + nchars);
1667
1668 return pos;
1669 }
1670
1671
1672 /* Value is the text position, i.e. character and byte position,
1673 for character position CHARPOS in STRING. */
1674
1675 static inline struct text_pos
1676 string_pos (ptrdiff_t charpos, Lisp_Object string)
1677 {
1678 struct text_pos pos;
1679 eassert (STRINGP (string));
1680 eassert (charpos >= 0);
1681 SET_TEXT_POS (pos, charpos, string_char_to_byte (string, charpos));
1682 return pos;
1683 }
1684
1685
1686 /* Value is a text position, i.e. character and byte position, for
1687 character position CHARPOS in C string S. MULTIBYTE_P non-zero
1688 means recognize multibyte characters. */
1689
1690 static struct text_pos
1691 c_string_pos (ptrdiff_t charpos, const char *s, int multibyte_p)
1692 {
1693 struct text_pos pos;
1694
1695 eassert (s != NULL);
1696 eassert (charpos >= 0);
1697
1698 if (multibyte_p)
1699 {
1700 int len;
1701
1702 SET_TEXT_POS (pos, 0, 0);
1703 while (charpos--)
1704 {
1705 string_char_and_length ((const unsigned char *) s, &len);
1706 s += len;
1707 CHARPOS (pos) += 1;
1708 BYTEPOS (pos) += len;
1709 }
1710 }
1711 else
1712 SET_TEXT_POS (pos, charpos, charpos);
1713
1714 return pos;
1715 }
1716
1717
1718 /* Value is the number of characters in C string S. MULTIBYTE_P
1719 non-zero means recognize multibyte characters. */
1720
1721 static ptrdiff_t
1722 number_of_chars (const char *s, int multibyte_p)
1723 {
1724 ptrdiff_t nchars;
1725
1726 if (multibyte_p)
1727 {
1728 ptrdiff_t rest = strlen (s);
1729 int len;
1730 const unsigned char *p = (const unsigned char *) s;
1731
1732 for (nchars = 0; rest > 0; ++nchars)
1733 {
1734 string_char_and_length (p, &len);
1735 rest -= len, p += len;
1736 }
1737 }
1738 else
1739 nchars = strlen (s);
1740
1741 return nchars;
1742 }
1743
1744
1745 /* Compute byte position NEWPOS->bytepos corresponding to
1746 NEWPOS->charpos. POS is a known position in string STRING.
1747 NEWPOS->charpos must be >= POS.charpos. */
1748
1749 static void
1750 compute_string_pos (struct text_pos *newpos, struct text_pos pos, Lisp_Object string)
1751 {
1752 eassert (STRINGP (string));
1753 eassert (CHARPOS (*newpos) >= CHARPOS (pos));
1754
1755 if (STRING_MULTIBYTE (string))
1756 *newpos = string_pos_nchars_ahead (pos, string,
1757 CHARPOS (*newpos) - CHARPOS (pos));
1758 else
1759 BYTEPOS (*newpos) = CHARPOS (*newpos);
1760 }
1761
1762 /* EXPORT:
1763 Return an estimation of the pixel height of mode or header lines on
1764 frame F. FACE_ID specifies what line's height to estimate. */
1765
1766 int
1767 estimate_mode_line_height (struct frame *f, enum face_id face_id)
1768 {
1769 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
1770 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
1771 {
1772 int height = FONT_HEIGHT (FRAME_FONT (f));
1773
1774 /* This function is called so early when Emacs starts that the face
1775 cache and mode line face are not yet initialized. */
1776 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
1777 {
1778 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, face_id);
1779 if (face)
1780 {
1781 if (face->font)
1782 height = FONT_HEIGHT (face->font);
1783 if (face->box_line_width > 0)
1784 height += 2 * face->box_line_width;
1785 }
1786 }
1787
1788 return height;
1789 }
1790 #endif
1791
1792 return 1;
1793 }
1794
1795 /* Given a pixel position (PIX_X, PIX_Y) on frame F, return glyph
1796 co-ordinates in (*X, *Y). Set *BOUNDS to the rectangle that the
1797 glyph at X, Y occupies, if BOUNDS != 0. If NOCLIP is non-zero, do
1798 not force the value into range. */
1799
1800 void
1801 pixel_to_glyph_coords (FRAME_PTR f, register int pix_x, register int pix_y,
1802 int *x, int *y, NativeRectangle *bounds, int noclip)
1803 {
1804
1805 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
1806 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
1807 {
1808 /* Arrange for the division in FRAME_PIXEL_X_TO_COL etc. to round down
1809 even for negative values. */
1810 if (pix_x < 0)
1811 pix_x -= FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) - 1;
1812 if (pix_y < 0)
1813 pix_y -= FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) - 1;
1814
1815 pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_X_TO_COL (f, pix_x);
1816 pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_Y_TO_LINE (f, pix_y);
1817
1818 if (bounds)
1819 STORE_NATIVE_RECT (*bounds,
1820 FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, pix_x),
1821 FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, pix_y),
1822 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) - 1,
1823 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) - 1);
1824
1825 if (!noclip)
1826 {
1827 if (pix_x < 0)
1828 pix_x = 0;
1829 else if (pix_x > FRAME_TOTAL_COLS (f))
1830 pix_x = FRAME_TOTAL_COLS (f);
1831
1832 if (pix_y < 0)
1833 pix_y = 0;
1834 else if (pix_y > FRAME_LINES (f))
1835 pix_y = FRAME_LINES (f);
1836 }
1837 }
1838 #endif
1839
1840 *x = pix_x;
1841 *y = pix_y;
1842 }
1843
1844
1845 /* Find the glyph under window-relative coordinates X/Y in window W.
1846 Consider only glyphs from buffer text, i.e. no glyphs from overlay
1847 strings. Return in *HPOS and *VPOS the row and column number of
1848 the glyph found. Return in *AREA the glyph area containing X.
1849 Value is a pointer to the glyph found or null if X/Y is not on
1850 text, or we can't tell because W's current matrix is not up to
1851 date. */
1852
1853 static
1854 struct glyph *
1855 x_y_to_hpos_vpos (struct window *w, int x, int y, int *hpos, int *vpos,
1856 int *dx, int *dy, int *area)
1857 {
1858 struct glyph *glyph, *end;
1859 struct glyph_row *row = NULL;
1860 int x0, i;
1861
1862 /* Find row containing Y. Give up if some row is not enabled. */
1863 for (i = 0; i < w->current_matrix->nrows; ++i)
1864 {
1865 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, i);
1866 if (!row->enabled_p)
1867 return NULL;
1868 if (y >= row->y && y < MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row))
1869 break;
1870 }
1871
1872 *vpos = i;
1873 *hpos = 0;
1874
1875 /* Give up if Y is not in the window. */
1876 if (i == w->current_matrix->nrows)
1877 return NULL;
1878
1879 /* Get the glyph area containing X. */
1880 if (w->pseudo_window_p)
1881 {
1882 *area = TEXT_AREA;
1883 x0 = 0;
1884 }
1885 else
1886 {
1887 if (x < window_box_left_offset (w, TEXT_AREA))
1888 {
1889 *area = LEFT_MARGIN_AREA;
1890 x0 = window_box_left_offset (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA);
1891 }
1892 else if (x < window_box_right_offset (w, TEXT_AREA))
1893 {
1894 *area = TEXT_AREA;
1895 x0 = window_box_left_offset (w, TEXT_AREA) + min (row->x, 0);
1896 }
1897 else
1898 {
1899 *area = RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA;
1900 x0 = window_box_left_offset (w, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA);
1901 }
1902 }
1903
1904 /* Find glyph containing X. */
1905 glyph = row->glyphs[*area];
1906 end = glyph + row->used[*area];
1907 x -= x0;
1908 while (glyph < end && x >= glyph->pixel_width)
1909 {
1910 x -= glyph->pixel_width;
1911 ++glyph;
1912 }
1913
1914 if (glyph == end)
1915 return NULL;
1916
1917 if (dx)
1918 {
1919 *dx = x;
1920 *dy = y - (row->y + row->ascent - glyph->ascent);
1921 }
1922
1923 *hpos = glyph - row->glyphs[*area];
1924 return glyph;
1925 }
1926
1927 /* Convert frame-relative x/y to coordinates relative to window W.
1928 Takes pseudo-windows into account. */
1929
1930 static void
1931 frame_to_window_pixel_xy (struct window *w, int *x, int *y)
1932 {
1933 if (w->pseudo_window_p)
1934 {
1935 /* A pseudo-window is always full-width, and starts at the
1936 left edge of the frame, plus a frame border. */
1937 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
1938 *x -= FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
1939 *y = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_Y (w, *y);
1940 }
1941 else
1942 {
1943 *x -= WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (w);
1944 *y = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_Y (w, *y);
1945 }
1946 }
1947
1948 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
1949
1950 /* EXPORT:
1951 Return in RECTS[] at most N clipping rectangles for glyph string S.
1952 Return the number of stored rectangles. */
1953
1954 int
1955 get_glyph_string_clip_rects (struct glyph_string *s, NativeRectangle *rects, int n)
1956 {
1957 XRectangle r;
1958
1959 if (n <= 0)
1960 return 0;
1961
1962 if (s->row->full_width_p)
1963 {
1964 /* Draw full-width. X coordinates are relative to S->w->left_col. */
1965 r.x = WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (s->w);
1966 r.width = WINDOW_TOTAL_WIDTH (s->w);
1967
1968 /* Unless displaying a mode or menu bar line, which are always
1969 fully visible, clip to the visible part of the row. */
1970 if (s->w->pseudo_window_p)
1971 r.height = s->row->visible_height;
1972 else
1973 r.height = s->height;
1974 }
1975 else
1976 {
1977 /* This is a text line that may be partially visible. */
1978 r.x = window_box_left (s->w, s->area);
1979 r.width = window_box_width (s->w, s->area);
1980 r.height = s->row->visible_height;
1981 }
1982
1983 if (s->clip_head)
1984 if (r.x < s->clip_head->x)
1985 {
1986 if (r.width >= s->clip_head->x - r.x)
1987 r.width -= s->clip_head->x - r.x;
1988 else
1989 r.width = 0;
1990 r.x = s->clip_head->x;
1991 }
1992 if (s->clip_tail)
1993 if (r.x + r.width > s->clip_tail->x + s->clip_tail->background_width)
1994 {
1995 if (s->clip_tail->x + s->clip_tail->background_width >= r.x)
1996 r.width = s->clip_tail->x + s->clip_tail->background_width - r.x;
1997 else
1998 r.width = 0;
1999 }
2000
2001 /* If S draws overlapping rows, it's sufficient to use the top and
2002 bottom of the window for clipping because this glyph string
2003 intentionally draws over other lines. */
2004 if (s->for_overlaps)
2005 {
2006 r.y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (s->w);
2007 r.height = window_text_bottom_y (s->w) - r.y;
2008
2009 /* Alas, the above simple strategy does not work for the
2010 environments with anti-aliased text: if the same text is
2011 drawn onto the same place multiple times, it gets thicker.
2012 If the overlap we are processing is for the erased cursor, we
2013 take the intersection with the rectangle of the cursor. */
2014 if (s->for_overlaps & OVERLAPS_ERASED_CURSOR)
2015 {
2016 XRectangle rc, r_save = r;
2017
2018 rc.x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (s->w, s->w->phys_cursor.x);
2019 rc.y = s->w->phys_cursor.y;
2020 rc.width = s->w->phys_cursor_width;
2021 rc.height = s->w->phys_cursor_height;
2022
2023 x_intersect_rectangles (&r_save, &rc, &r);
2024 }
2025 }
2026 else
2027 {
2028 /* Don't use S->y for clipping because it doesn't take partially
2029 visible lines into account. For example, it can be negative for
2030 partially visible lines at the top of a window. */
2031 if (!s->row->full_width_p
2032 && MATRIX_ROW_PARTIALLY_VISIBLE_AT_TOP_P (s->w, s->row))
2033 r.y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (s->w);
2034 else
2035 r.y = max (0, s->row->y);
2036 }
2037
2038 r.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (s->w, r.y);
2039
2040 /* If drawing the cursor, don't let glyph draw outside its
2041 advertised boundaries. Cleartype does this under some circumstances. */
2042 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2043 {
2044 struct glyph *glyph = s->first_glyph;
2045 int height, max_y;
2046
2047 if (s->x > r.x)
2048 {
2049 r.width -= s->x - r.x;
2050 r.x = s->x;
2051 }
2052 r.width = min (r.width, glyph->pixel_width);
2053
2054 /* If r.y is below window bottom, ensure that we still see a cursor. */
2055 height = min (glyph->ascent + glyph->descent,
2056 min (FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (s->f), s->row->visible_height));
2057 max_y = window_text_bottom_y (s->w) - height;
2058 max_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (s->w, max_y);
2059 if (s->ybase - glyph->ascent > max_y)
2060 {
2061 r.y = max_y;
2062 r.height = height;
2063 }
2064 else
2065 {
2066 /* Don't draw cursor glyph taller than our actual glyph. */
2067 height = max (FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (s->f), glyph->ascent + glyph->descent);
2068 if (height < r.height)
2069 {
2070 max_y = r.y + r.height;
2071 r.y = min (max_y, max (r.y, s->ybase + glyph->descent - height));
2072 r.height = min (max_y - r.y, height);
2073 }
2074 }
2075 }
2076
2077 if (s->row->clip)
2078 {
2079 XRectangle r_save = r;
2080
2081 if (! x_intersect_rectangles (&r_save, s->row->clip, &r))
2082 r.width = 0;
2083 }
2084
2085 if ((s->for_overlaps & OVERLAPS_BOTH) == 0
2086 || ((s->for_overlaps & OVERLAPS_BOTH) == OVERLAPS_BOTH && n == 1))
2087 {
2088 #ifdef CONVERT_FROM_XRECT
2089 CONVERT_FROM_XRECT (r, *rects);
2090 #else
2091 *rects = r;
2092 #endif
2093 return 1;
2094 }
2095 else
2096 {
2097 /* If we are processing overlapping and allowed to return
2098 multiple clipping rectangles, we exclude the row of the glyph
2099 string from the clipping rectangle. This is to avoid drawing
2100 the same text on the environment with anti-aliasing. */
2101 #ifdef CONVERT_FROM_XRECT
2102 XRectangle rs[2];
2103 #else
2104 XRectangle *rs = rects;
2105 #endif
2106 int i = 0, row_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (s->w, s->row->y);
2107
2108 if (s->for_overlaps & OVERLAPS_PRED)
2109 {
2110 rs[i] = r;
2111 if (r.y + r.height > row_y)
2112 {
2113 if (r.y < row_y)
2114 rs[i].height = row_y - r.y;
2115 else
2116 rs[i].height = 0;
2117 }
2118 i++;
2119 }
2120 if (s->for_overlaps & OVERLAPS_SUCC)
2121 {
2122 rs[i] = r;
2123 if (r.y < row_y + s->row->visible_height)
2124 {
2125 if (r.y + r.height > row_y + s->row->visible_height)
2126 {
2127 rs[i].y = row_y + s->row->visible_height;
2128 rs[i].height = r.y + r.height - rs[i].y;
2129 }
2130 else
2131 rs[i].height = 0;
2132 }
2133 i++;
2134 }
2135
2136 n = i;
2137 #ifdef CONVERT_FROM_XRECT
2138 for (i = 0; i < n; i++)
2139 CONVERT_FROM_XRECT (rs[i], rects[i]);
2140 #endif
2141 return n;
2142 }
2143 }
2144
2145 /* EXPORT:
2146 Return in *NR the clipping rectangle for glyph string S. */
2147
2148 void
2149 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (struct glyph_string *s, NativeRectangle *nr)
2150 {
2151 get_glyph_string_clip_rects (s, nr, 1);
2152 }
2153
2154
2155 /* EXPORT:
2156 Return the position and height of the phys cursor in window W.
2157 Set w->phys_cursor_width to width of phys cursor.
2158 */
2159
2160 void
2161 get_phys_cursor_geometry (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row,
2162 struct glyph *glyph, int *xp, int *yp, int *heightp)
2163 {
2164 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
2165 int x, y, wd, h, h0, y0;
2166
2167 /* Compute the width of the rectangle to draw. If on a stretch
2168 glyph, and `x-stretch-block-cursor' is nil, don't draw a
2169 rectangle as wide as the glyph, but use a canonical character
2170 width instead. */
2171 wd = glyph->pixel_width - 1;
2172 #if defined (HAVE_NTGUI) || defined (HAVE_NS)
2173 wd++; /* Why? */
2174 #endif
2175
2176 x = w->phys_cursor.x;
2177 if (x < 0)
2178 {
2179 wd += x;
2180 x = 0;
2181 }
2182
2183 if (glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
2184 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2185 wd = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f), wd);
2186 w->phys_cursor_width = wd;
2187
2188 y = w->phys_cursor.y + row->ascent - glyph->ascent;
2189
2190 /* If y is below window bottom, ensure that we still see a cursor. */
2191 h0 = min (FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f), row->visible_height);
2192
2193 h = max (h0, glyph->ascent + glyph->descent);
2194 h0 = min (h0, glyph->ascent + glyph->descent);
2195
2196 y0 = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
2197 if (y < y0)
2198 {
2199 h = max (h - (y0 - y) + 1, h0);
2200 y = y0 - 1;
2201 }
2202 else
2203 {
2204 y0 = window_text_bottom_y (w) - h0;
2205 if (y > y0)
2206 {
2207 h += y - y0;
2208 y = y0;
2209 }
2210 }
2211
2212 *xp = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, x);
2213 *yp = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, y);
2214 *heightp = h;
2215 }
2216
2217 /*
2218 * Remember which glyph the mouse is over.
2219 */
2220
2221 void
2222 remember_mouse_glyph (struct frame *f, int gx, int gy, NativeRectangle *rect)
2223 {
2224 Lisp_Object window;
2225 struct window *w;
2226 struct glyph_row *r, *gr, *end_row;
2227 enum window_part part;
2228 enum glyph_row_area area;
2229 int x, y, width, height;
2230
2231 /* Try to determine frame pixel position and size of the glyph under
2232 frame pixel coordinates X/Y on frame F. */
2233
2234 if (!f->glyphs_initialized_p
2235 || (window = window_from_coordinates (f, gx, gy, &part, 0),
2236 NILP (window)))
2237 {
2238 width = FRAME_SMALLEST_CHAR_WIDTH (f);
2239 height = FRAME_SMALLEST_FONT_HEIGHT (f);
2240 goto virtual_glyph;
2241 }
2242
2243 w = XWINDOW (window);
2244 width = WINDOW_FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (w);
2245 height = WINDOW_FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
2246
2247 x = window_relative_x_coord (w, part, gx);
2248 y = gy - WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_Y (w);
2249
2250 r = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
2251 end_row = MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix, w);
2252
2253 if (w->pseudo_window_p)
2254 {
2255 area = TEXT_AREA;
2256 part = ON_MODE_LINE; /* Don't adjust margin. */
2257 goto text_glyph;
2258 }
2259
2260 switch (part)
2261 {
2262 case ON_LEFT_MARGIN:
2263 area = LEFT_MARGIN_AREA;
2264 goto text_glyph;
2265
2266 case ON_RIGHT_MARGIN:
2267 area = RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA;
2268 goto text_glyph;
2269
2270 case ON_HEADER_LINE:
2271 case ON_MODE_LINE:
2272 gr = (part == ON_HEADER_LINE
2273 ? MATRIX_HEADER_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)
2274 : MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix));
2275 gy = gr->y;
2276 area = TEXT_AREA;
2277 goto text_glyph_row_found;
2278
2279 case ON_TEXT:
2280 area = TEXT_AREA;
2281
2282 text_glyph:
2283 gr = 0; gy = 0;
2284 for (; r <= end_row && r->enabled_p; ++r)
2285 if (r->y + r->height > y)
2286 {
2287 gr = r; gy = r->y;
2288 break;
2289 }
2290
2291 text_glyph_row_found:
2292 if (gr && gy <= y)
2293 {
2294 struct glyph *g = gr->glyphs[area];
2295 struct glyph *end = g + gr->used[area];
2296
2297 height = gr->height;
2298 for (gx = gr->x; g < end; gx += g->pixel_width, ++g)
2299 if (gx + g->pixel_width > x)
2300 break;
2301
2302 if (g < end)
2303 {
2304 if (g->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
2305 {
2306 /* Don't remember when mouse is over image, as
2307 image may have hot-spots. */
2308 STORE_NATIVE_RECT (*rect, 0, 0, 0, 0);
2309 return;
2310 }
2311 width = g->pixel_width;
2312 }
2313 else
2314 {
2315 /* Use nominal char spacing at end of line. */
2316 x -= gx;
2317 gx += (x / width) * width;
2318 }
2319
2320 if (part != ON_MODE_LINE && part != ON_HEADER_LINE)
2321 gx += window_box_left_offset (w, area);
2322 }
2323 else
2324 {
2325 /* Use nominal line height at end of window. */
2326 gx = (x / width) * width;
2327 y -= gy;
2328 gy += (y / height) * height;
2329 }
2330 break;
2331
2332 case ON_LEFT_FRINGE:
2333 gx = (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
2334 ? WINDOW_LEFT_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (w)
2335 : window_box_right_offset (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA));
2336 width = WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w);
2337 goto row_glyph;
2338
2339 case ON_RIGHT_FRINGE:
2340 gx = (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
2341 ? window_box_right_offset (w, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA)
2342 : window_box_right_offset (w, TEXT_AREA));
2343 width = WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w);
2344 goto row_glyph;
2345
2346 case ON_SCROLL_BAR:
2347 gx = (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w)
2348 ? 0
2349 : (window_box_right_offset (w, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA)
2350 + (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
2351 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
2352 : 0)));
2353 width = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (w);
2354
2355 row_glyph:
2356 gr = 0, gy = 0;
2357 for (; r <= end_row && r->enabled_p; ++r)
2358 if (r->y + r->height > y)
2359 {
2360 gr = r; gy = r->y;
2361 break;
2362 }
2363
2364 if (gr && gy <= y)
2365 height = gr->height;
2366 else
2367 {
2368 /* Use nominal line height at end of window. */
2369 y -= gy;
2370 gy += (y / height) * height;
2371 }
2372 break;
2373
2374 default:
2375 ;
2376 virtual_glyph:
2377 /* If there is no glyph under the mouse, then we divide the screen
2378 into a grid of the smallest glyph in the frame, and use that
2379 as our "glyph". */
2380
2381 /* Arrange for the division in FRAME_PIXEL_X_TO_COL etc. to
2382 round down even for negative values. */
2383 if (gx < 0)
2384 gx -= width - 1;
2385 if (gy < 0)
2386 gy -= height - 1;
2387
2388 gx = (gx / width) * width;
2389 gy = (gy / height) * height;
2390
2391 goto store_rect;
2392 }
2393
2394 gx += WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (w);
2395 gy += WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_Y (w);
2396
2397 store_rect:
2398 STORE_NATIVE_RECT (*rect, gx, gy, width, height);
2399
2400 /* Visible feedback for debugging. */
2401 #if 0
2402 #if HAVE_X_WINDOWS
2403 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2404 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2405 gx, gy, width, height);
2406 #endif
2407 #endif
2408 }
2409
2410
2411 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
2412
2413 \f
2414 /***********************************************************************
2415 Lisp form evaluation
2416 ***********************************************************************/
2417
2418 /* Error handler for safe_eval and safe_call. */
2419
2420 static Lisp_Object
2421 safe_eval_handler (Lisp_Object arg, ptrdiff_t nargs, Lisp_Object *args)
2422 {
2423 add_to_log ("Error during redisplay: %S signalled %S",
2424 Flist (nargs, args), arg);
2425 return Qnil;
2426 }
2427
2428 /* Call function FUNC with the rest of NARGS - 1 arguments
2429 following. Return the result, or nil if something went
2430 wrong. Prevent redisplay during the evaluation. */
2431
2432 Lisp_Object
2433 safe_call (ptrdiff_t nargs, Lisp_Object func, ...)
2434 {
2435 Lisp_Object val;
2436
2437 if (inhibit_eval_during_redisplay)
2438 val = Qnil;
2439 else
2440 {
2441 va_list ap;
2442 ptrdiff_t i;
2443 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
2444 struct gcpro gcpro1;
2445 Lisp_Object *args = alloca (nargs * word_size);
2446
2447 args[0] = func;
2448 va_start (ap, func);
2449 for (i = 1; i < nargs; i++)
2450 args[i] = va_arg (ap, Lisp_Object);
2451 va_end (ap);
2452
2453 GCPRO1 (args[0]);
2454 gcpro1.nvars = nargs;
2455 specbind (Qinhibit_redisplay, Qt);
2456 /* Use Qt to ensure debugger does not run,
2457 so there is no possibility of wanting to redisplay. */
2458 val = internal_condition_case_n (Ffuncall, nargs, args, Qt,
2459 safe_eval_handler);
2460 UNGCPRO;
2461 val = unbind_to (count, val);
2462 }
2463
2464 return val;
2465 }
2466
2467
2468 /* Call function FN with one argument ARG.
2469 Return the result, or nil if something went wrong. */
2470
2471 Lisp_Object
2472 safe_call1 (Lisp_Object fn, Lisp_Object arg)
2473 {
2474 return safe_call (2, fn, arg);
2475 }
2476
2477 static Lisp_Object Qeval;
2478
2479 Lisp_Object
2480 safe_eval (Lisp_Object sexpr)
2481 {
2482 return safe_call1 (Qeval, sexpr);
2483 }
2484
2485 /* Call function FN with two arguments ARG1 and ARG2.
2486 Return the result, or nil if something went wrong. */
2487
2488 Lisp_Object
2489 safe_call2 (Lisp_Object fn, Lisp_Object arg1, Lisp_Object arg2)
2490 {
2491 return safe_call (3, fn, arg1, arg2);
2492 }
2493
2494
2495 \f
2496 /***********************************************************************
2497 Debugging
2498 ***********************************************************************/
2499
2500 #if 0
2501
2502 /* Define CHECK_IT to perform sanity checks on iterators.
2503 This is for debugging. It is too slow to do unconditionally. */
2504
2505 static void
2506 check_it (struct it *it)
2507 {
2508 if (it->method == GET_FROM_STRING)
2509 {
2510 eassert (STRINGP (it->string));
2511 eassert (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= 0);
2512 }
2513 else
2514 {
2515 eassert (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) < 0);
2516 if (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER)
2517 {
2518 /* Check that character and byte positions agree. */
2519 eassert (IT_CHARPOS (*it) == BYTE_TO_CHAR (IT_BYTEPOS (*it)));
2520 }
2521 }
2522
2523 if (it->dpvec)
2524 eassert (it->current.dpvec_index >= 0);
2525 else
2526 eassert (it->current.dpvec_index < 0);
2527 }
2528
2529 #define CHECK_IT(IT) check_it ((IT))
2530
2531 #else /* not 0 */
2532
2533 #define CHECK_IT(IT) (void) 0
2534
2535 #endif /* not 0 */
2536
2537
2538 #if defined GLYPH_DEBUG && defined ENABLE_CHECKING
2539
2540 /* Check that the window end of window W is what we expect it
2541 to be---the last row in the current matrix displaying text. */
2542
2543 static void
2544 check_window_end (struct window *w)
2545 {
2546 if (!MINI_WINDOW_P (w)
2547 && !NILP (w->window_end_valid))
2548 {
2549 struct glyph_row *row;
2550 eassert ((row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix,
2551 XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos)),
2552 !row->enabled_p
2553 || MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row)
2554 || MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (row, w->current_matrix) == 0));
2555 }
2556 }
2557
2558 #define CHECK_WINDOW_END(W) check_window_end ((W))
2559
2560 #else
2561
2562 #define CHECK_WINDOW_END(W) (void) 0
2563
2564 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG and ENABLE_CHECKING */
2565
2566
2567 \f
2568 /***********************************************************************
2569 Iterator initialization
2570 ***********************************************************************/
2571
2572 /* Initialize IT for displaying current_buffer in window W, starting
2573 at character position CHARPOS. CHARPOS < 0 means that no buffer
2574 position is specified which is useful when the iterator is assigned
2575 a position later. BYTEPOS is the byte position corresponding to
2576 CHARPOS. BYTEPOS < 0 means compute it from CHARPOS.
2577
2578 If ROW is not null, calls to produce_glyphs with IT as parameter
2579 will produce glyphs in that row.
2580
2581 BASE_FACE_ID is the id of a base face to use. It must be one of
2582 DEFAULT_FACE_ID for normal text, MODE_LINE_FACE_ID,
2583 MODE_LINE_INACTIVE_FACE_ID, or HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID for displaying
2584 mode lines, or TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID for displaying the tool-bar.
2585
2586 If ROW is null and BASE_FACE_ID is equal to MODE_LINE_FACE_ID,
2587 MODE_LINE_INACTIVE_FACE_ID, or HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID, the iterator
2588 will be initialized to use the corresponding mode line glyph row of
2589 the desired matrix of W. */
2590
2591 void
2592 init_iterator (struct it *it, struct window *w,
2593 ptrdiff_t charpos, ptrdiff_t bytepos,
2594 struct glyph_row *row, enum face_id base_face_id)
2595 {
2596 int highlight_region_p;
2597 enum face_id remapped_base_face_id = base_face_id;
2598
2599 /* Some precondition checks. */
2600 eassert (w != NULL && it != NULL);
2601 eassert (charpos < 0 || (charpos >= BUF_BEG (current_buffer)
2602 && charpos <= ZV));
2603
2604 /* If face attributes have been changed since the last redisplay,
2605 free realized faces now because they depend on face definitions
2606 that might have changed. Don't free faces while there might be
2607 desired matrices pending which reference these faces. */
2608 if (face_change_count && !inhibit_free_realized_faces)
2609 {
2610 face_change_count = 0;
2611 free_all_realized_faces (Qnil);
2612 }
2613
2614 /* Perhaps remap BASE_FACE_ID to a user-specified alternative. */
2615 if (! NILP (Vface_remapping_alist))
2616 remapped_base_face_id
2617 = lookup_basic_face (XFRAME (w->frame), base_face_id);
2618
2619 /* Use one of the mode line rows of W's desired matrix if
2620 appropriate. */
2621 if (row == NULL)
2622 {
2623 if (base_face_id == MODE_LINE_FACE_ID
2624 || base_face_id == MODE_LINE_INACTIVE_FACE_ID)
2625 row = MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->desired_matrix);
2626 else if (base_face_id == HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID)
2627 row = MATRIX_HEADER_LINE_ROW (w->desired_matrix);
2628 }
2629
2630 /* Clear IT. */
2631 memset (it, 0, sizeof *it);
2632 it->current.overlay_string_index = -1;
2633 it->current.dpvec_index = -1;
2634 it->base_face_id = remapped_base_face_id;
2635 it->string = Qnil;
2636 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = -1;
2637 it->paragraph_embedding = L2R;
2638 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = Qnil;
2639 it->bidi_it.string.s = NULL;
2640 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = 0;
2641
2642 /* The window in which we iterate over current_buffer: */
2643 XSETWINDOW (it->window, w);
2644 it->w = w;
2645 it->f = XFRAME (w->frame);
2646
2647 it->cmp_it.id = -1;
2648
2649 /* Extra space between lines (on window systems only). */
2650 if (base_face_id == DEFAULT_FACE_ID
2651 && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
2652 {
2653 if (NATNUMP (BVAR (current_buffer, extra_line_spacing)))
2654 it->extra_line_spacing = XFASTINT (BVAR (current_buffer, extra_line_spacing));
2655 else if (FLOATP (BVAR (current_buffer, extra_line_spacing)))
2656 it->extra_line_spacing = (XFLOAT_DATA (BVAR (current_buffer, extra_line_spacing))
2657 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (it->f));
2658 else if (it->f->extra_line_spacing > 0)
2659 it->extra_line_spacing = it->f->extra_line_spacing;
2660 it->max_extra_line_spacing = 0;
2661 }
2662
2663 /* If realized faces have been removed, e.g. because of face
2664 attribute changes of named faces, recompute them. When running
2665 in batch mode, the face cache of the initial frame is null. If
2666 we happen to get called, make a dummy face cache. */
2667 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (it->f) == NULL)
2668 init_frame_faces (it->f);
2669 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (it->f)->used == 0)
2670 recompute_basic_faces (it->f);
2671
2672 /* Current value of the `slice', `space-width', and 'height' properties. */
2673 it->slice.x = it->slice.y = it->slice.width = it->slice.height = Qnil;
2674 it->space_width = Qnil;
2675 it->font_height = Qnil;
2676 it->override_ascent = -1;
2677
2678 /* Are control characters displayed as `^C'? */
2679 it->ctl_arrow_p = !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, ctl_arrow));
2680
2681 /* -1 means everything between a CR and the following line end
2682 is invisible. >0 means lines indented more than this value are
2683 invisible. */
2684 it->selective = (INTEGERP (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display))
2685 ? (clip_to_bounds
2686 (-1, XINT (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display)),
2687 PTRDIFF_MAX))
2688 : (!NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display))
2689 ? -1 : 0));
2690 it->selective_display_ellipsis_p
2691 = !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display_ellipses));
2692
2693 /* Display table to use. */
2694 it->dp = window_display_table (w);
2695
2696 /* Are multibyte characters enabled in current_buffer? */
2697 it->multibyte_p = !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters));
2698
2699 /* Non-zero if we should highlight the region. */
2700 highlight_region_p
2701 = (!NILP (Vtransient_mark_mode)
2702 && !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, mark_active))
2703 && XMARKER (BVAR (current_buffer, mark))->buffer != 0);
2704
2705 /* Set IT->region_beg_charpos and IT->region_end_charpos to the
2706 start and end of a visible region in window IT->w. Set both to
2707 -1 to indicate no region. */
2708 if (highlight_region_p
2709 /* Maybe highlight only in selected window. */
2710 && (/* Either show region everywhere. */
2711 highlight_nonselected_windows
2712 /* Or show region in the selected window. */
2713 || w == XWINDOW (selected_window)
2714 /* Or show the region if we are in the mini-buffer and W is
2715 the window the mini-buffer refers to. */
2716 || (MINI_WINDOW_P (XWINDOW (selected_window))
2717 && WINDOWP (minibuf_selected_window)
2718 && w == XWINDOW (minibuf_selected_window))))
2719 {
2720 ptrdiff_t markpos = marker_position (BVAR (current_buffer, mark));
2721 it->region_beg_charpos = min (PT, markpos);
2722 it->region_end_charpos = max (PT, markpos);
2723 }
2724 else
2725 it->region_beg_charpos = it->region_end_charpos = -1;
2726
2727 /* Get the position at which the redisplay_end_trigger hook should
2728 be run, if it is to be run at all. */
2729 if (MARKERP (w->redisplay_end_trigger)
2730 && XMARKER (w->redisplay_end_trigger)->buffer != 0)
2731 it->redisplay_end_trigger_charpos
2732 = marker_position (w->redisplay_end_trigger);
2733 else if (INTEGERP (w->redisplay_end_trigger))
2734 it->redisplay_end_trigger_charpos =
2735 clip_to_bounds (PTRDIFF_MIN, XINT (w->redisplay_end_trigger), PTRDIFF_MAX);
2736
2737 it->tab_width = SANE_TAB_WIDTH (current_buffer);
2738
2739 /* Are lines in the display truncated? */
2740 if (base_face_id != DEFAULT_FACE_ID
2741 || it->w->hscroll
2742 || (! WINDOW_FULL_WIDTH_P (it->w)
2743 && ((!NILP (Vtruncate_partial_width_windows)
2744 && !INTEGERP (Vtruncate_partial_width_windows))
2745 || (INTEGERP (Vtruncate_partial_width_windows)
2746 && (WINDOW_TOTAL_COLS (it->w)
2747 < XINT (Vtruncate_partial_width_windows))))))
2748 it->line_wrap = TRUNCATE;
2749 else if (NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, truncate_lines)))
2750 it->line_wrap = NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, word_wrap))
2751 ? WINDOW_WRAP : WORD_WRAP;
2752 else
2753 it->line_wrap = TRUNCATE;
2754
2755 /* Get dimensions of truncation and continuation glyphs. These are
2756 displayed as fringe bitmaps under X, but we need them for such
2757 frames when the fringes are turned off. But leave the dimensions
2758 zero for tooltip frames, as these glyphs look ugly there and also
2759 sabotage calculations of tooltip dimensions in x-show-tip. */
2760 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
2761 if (!(FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
2762 && FRAMEP (tip_frame)
2763 && it->f == XFRAME (tip_frame)))
2764 #endif
2765 {
2766 if (it->line_wrap == TRUNCATE)
2767 {
2768 /* We will need the truncation glyph. */
2769 eassert (it->glyph_row == NULL);
2770 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_TRUNCATION);
2771 it->truncation_pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
2772 }
2773 else
2774 {
2775 /* We will need the continuation glyph. */
2776 eassert (it->glyph_row == NULL);
2777 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_CONTINUATION);
2778 it->continuation_pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
2779 }
2780 }
2781
2782 /* Reset these values to zero because the produce_special_glyphs
2783 above has changed them. */
2784 it->pixel_width = it->ascent = it->descent = 0;
2785 it->phys_ascent = it->phys_descent = 0;
2786
2787 /* Set this after getting the dimensions of truncation and
2788 continuation glyphs, so that we don't produce glyphs when calling
2789 produce_special_glyphs, above. */
2790 it->glyph_row = row;
2791 it->area = TEXT_AREA;
2792
2793 /* Forget any previous info about this row being reversed. */
2794 if (it->glyph_row)
2795 it->glyph_row->reversed_p = 0;
2796
2797 /* Get the dimensions of the display area. The display area
2798 consists of the visible window area plus a horizontally scrolled
2799 part to the left of the window. All x-values are relative to the
2800 start of this total display area. */
2801 if (base_face_id != DEFAULT_FACE_ID)
2802 {
2803 /* Mode lines, menu bar in terminal frames. */
2804 it->first_visible_x = 0;
2805 it->last_visible_x = WINDOW_TOTAL_WIDTH (w);
2806 }
2807 else
2808 {
2809 it->first_visible_x =
2810 window_hscroll_limited (it->w, it->f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it->f);
2811 it->last_visible_x = (it->first_visible_x
2812 + window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA));
2813
2814 /* If we truncate lines, leave room for the truncation glyph(s) at
2815 the right margin. Otherwise, leave room for the continuation
2816 glyph(s). Done only if the window has no fringes. Since we
2817 don't know at this point whether there will be any R2L lines in
2818 the window, we reserve space for truncation/continuation glyphs
2819 even if only one of the fringes is absent. */
2820 if (WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w) == 0
2821 || (it->bidi_p && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w) == 0))
2822 {
2823 if (it->line_wrap == TRUNCATE)
2824 it->last_visible_x -= it->truncation_pixel_width;
2825 else
2826 it->last_visible_x -= it->continuation_pixel_width;
2827 }
2828
2829 it->header_line_p = WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w);
2830 it->current_y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w) + w->vscroll;
2831 }
2832
2833 /* Leave room for a border glyph. */
2834 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
2835 && !WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (it->w))
2836 it->last_visible_x -= 1;
2837
2838 it->last_visible_y = window_text_bottom_y (w);
2839
2840 /* For mode lines and alike, arrange for the first glyph having a
2841 left box line if the face specifies a box. */
2842 if (base_face_id != DEFAULT_FACE_ID)
2843 {
2844 struct face *face;
2845
2846 it->face_id = remapped_base_face_id;
2847
2848 /* If we have a boxed mode line, make the first character appear
2849 with a left box line. */
2850 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, remapped_base_face_id);
2851 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2852 it->start_of_box_run_p = 1;
2853 }
2854
2855 /* If a buffer position was specified, set the iterator there,
2856 getting overlays and face properties from that position. */
2857 if (charpos >= BUF_BEG (current_buffer))
2858 {
2859 it->end_charpos = ZV;
2860 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = charpos;
2861
2862 /* We will rely on `reseat' to set this up properly, via
2863 handle_face_prop. */
2864 it->face_id = it->base_face_id;
2865
2866 /* Compute byte position if not specified. */
2867 if (bytepos < charpos)
2868 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = CHAR_TO_BYTE (charpos);
2869 else
2870 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = bytepos;
2871
2872 it->start = it->current;
2873 /* Do we need to reorder bidirectional text? Not if this is a
2874 unibyte buffer: by definition, none of the single-byte
2875 characters are strong R2L, so no reordering is needed. And
2876 bidi.c doesn't support unibyte buffers anyway. Also, don't
2877 reorder while we are loading loadup.el, since the tables of
2878 character properties needed for reordering are not yet
2879 available. */
2880 it->bidi_p =
2881 NILP (Vpurify_flag)
2882 && !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, bidi_display_reordering))
2883 && it->multibyte_p;
2884
2885 /* If we are to reorder bidirectional text, init the bidi
2886 iterator. */
2887 if (it->bidi_p)
2888 {
2889 /* Note the paragraph direction that this buffer wants to
2890 use. */
2891 if (EQ (BVAR (current_buffer, bidi_paragraph_direction),
2892 Qleft_to_right))
2893 it->paragraph_embedding = L2R;
2894 else if (EQ (BVAR (current_buffer, bidi_paragraph_direction),
2895 Qright_to_left))
2896 it->paragraph_embedding = R2L;
2897 else
2898 it->paragraph_embedding = NEUTRAL_DIR;
2899 bidi_unshelve_cache (NULL, 0);
2900 bidi_init_it (charpos, IT_BYTEPOS (*it), FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f),
2901 &it->bidi_it);
2902 }
2903
2904 /* Compute faces etc. */
2905 reseat (it, it->current.pos, 1);
2906 }
2907
2908 CHECK_IT (it);
2909 }
2910
2911
2912 /* Initialize IT for the display of window W with window start POS. */
2913
2914 void
2915 start_display (struct it *it, struct window *w, struct text_pos pos)
2916 {
2917 struct glyph_row *row;
2918 int first_vpos = WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w) ? 1 : 0;
2919
2920 row = w->desired_matrix->rows + first_vpos;
2921 init_iterator (it, w, CHARPOS (pos), BYTEPOS (pos), row, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
2922 it->first_vpos = first_vpos;
2923
2924 /* Don't reseat to previous visible line start if current start
2925 position is in a string or image. */
2926 if (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER && it->line_wrap != TRUNCATE)
2927 {
2928 int start_at_line_beg_p;
2929 int first_y = it->current_y;
2930
2931 /* If window start is not at a line start, skip forward to POS to
2932 get the correct continuation lines width. */
2933 start_at_line_beg_p = (CHARPOS (pos) == BEGV
2934 || FETCH_BYTE (BYTEPOS (pos) - 1) == '\n');
2935 if (!start_at_line_beg_p)
2936 {
2937 int new_x;
2938
2939 reseat_at_previous_visible_line_start (it);
2940 move_it_to (it, CHARPOS (pos), -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
2941
2942 new_x = it->current_x + it->pixel_width;
2943
2944 /* If lines are continued, this line may end in the middle
2945 of a multi-glyph character (e.g. a control character
2946 displayed as \003, or in the middle of an overlay
2947 string). In this case move_it_to above will not have
2948 taken us to the start of the continuation line but to the
2949 end of the continued line. */
2950 if (it->current_x > 0
2951 && it->line_wrap != TRUNCATE /* Lines are continued. */
2952 && (/* And glyph doesn't fit on the line. */
2953 new_x > it->last_visible_x
2954 /* Or it fits exactly and we're on a window
2955 system frame. */
2956 || (new_x == it->last_visible_x
2957 && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
2958 && ((it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L)
2959 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
2960 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)))))
2961 {
2962 if ((it->current.dpvec_index >= 0
2963 || it->current.overlay_string_index >= 0)
2964 /* If we are on a newline from a display vector or
2965 overlay string, then we are already at the end of
2966 a screen line; no need to go to the next line in
2967 that case, as this line is not really continued.
2968 (If we do go to the next line, C-e will not DTRT.) */
2969 && it->c != '\n')
2970 {
2971 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
2972 move_it_in_display_line_to (it, -1, -1, 0);
2973 }
2974
2975 it->continuation_lines_width += it->current_x;
2976 }
2977 /* If the character at POS is displayed via a display
2978 vector, move_it_to above stops at the final glyph of
2979 IT->dpvec. To make the caller redisplay that character
2980 again (a.k.a. start at POS), we need to reset the
2981 dpvec_index to the beginning of IT->dpvec. */
2982 else if (it->current.dpvec_index >= 0)
2983 it->current.dpvec_index = 0;
2984
2985 /* We're starting a new display line, not affected by the
2986 height of the continued line, so clear the appropriate
2987 fields in the iterator structure. */
2988 it->max_ascent = it->max_descent = 0;
2989 it->max_phys_ascent = it->max_phys_descent = 0;
2990
2991 it->current_y = first_y;
2992 it->vpos = 0;
2993 it->current_x = it->hpos = 0;
2994 }
2995 }
2996 }
2997
2998
2999 /* Return 1 if POS is a position in ellipses displayed for invisible
3000 text. W is the window we display, for text property lookup. */
3001
3002 static int
3003 in_ellipses_for_invisible_text_p (struct display_pos *pos, struct window *w)
3004 {
3005 Lisp_Object prop, window;
3006 int ellipses_p = 0;
3007 ptrdiff_t charpos = CHARPOS (pos->pos);
3008
3009 /* If POS specifies a position in a display vector, this might
3010 be for an ellipsis displayed for invisible text. We won't
3011 get the iterator set up for delivering that ellipsis unless
3012 we make sure that it gets aware of the invisible text. */
3013 if (pos->dpvec_index >= 0
3014 && pos->overlay_string_index < 0
3015 && CHARPOS (pos->string_pos) < 0
3016 && charpos > BEGV
3017 && (XSETWINDOW (window, w),
3018 prop = Fget_char_property (make_number (charpos),
3019 Qinvisible, window),
3020 !TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (prop)))
3021 {
3022 prop = Fget_char_property (make_number (charpos - 1), Qinvisible,
3023 window);
3024 ellipses_p = 2 == TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (prop);
3025 }
3026
3027 return ellipses_p;
3028 }
3029
3030
3031 /* Initialize IT for stepping through current_buffer in window W,
3032 starting at position POS that includes overlay string and display
3033 vector/ control character translation position information. Value
3034 is zero if there are overlay strings with newlines at POS. */
3035
3036 static int
3037 init_from_display_pos (struct it *it, struct window *w, struct display_pos *pos)
3038 {
3039 ptrdiff_t charpos = CHARPOS (pos->pos), bytepos = BYTEPOS (pos->pos);
3040 int i, overlay_strings_with_newlines = 0;
3041
3042 /* If POS specifies a position in a display vector, this might
3043 be for an ellipsis displayed for invisible text. We won't
3044 get the iterator set up for delivering that ellipsis unless
3045 we make sure that it gets aware of the invisible text. */
3046 if (in_ellipses_for_invisible_text_p (pos, w))
3047 {
3048 --charpos;
3049 bytepos = 0;
3050 }
3051
3052 /* Keep in mind: the call to reseat in init_iterator skips invisible
3053 text, so we might end up at a position different from POS. This
3054 is only a problem when POS is a row start after a newline and an
3055 overlay starts there with an after-string, and the overlay has an
3056 invisible property. Since we don't skip invisible text in
3057 display_line and elsewhere immediately after consuming the
3058 newline before the row start, such a POS will not be in a string,
3059 but the call to init_iterator below will move us to the
3060 after-string. */
3061 init_iterator (it, w, charpos, bytepos, NULL, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
3062
3063 /* This only scans the current chunk -- it should scan all chunks.
3064 However, OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE has been increased from 3 in 21.1
3065 to 16 in 22.1 to make this a lesser problem. */
3066 for (i = 0; i < it->n_overlay_strings && i < OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE; ++i)
3067 {
3068 const char *s = SSDATA (it->overlay_strings[i]);
3069 const char *e = s + SBYTES (it->overlay_strings[i]);
3070
3071 while (s < e && *s != '\n')
3072 ++s;
3073
3074 if (s < e)
3075 {
3076 overlay_strings_with_newlines = 1;
3077 break;
3078 }
3079 }
3080
3081 /* If position is within an overlay string, set up IT to the right
3082 overlay string. */
3083 if (pos->overlay_string_index >= 0)
3084 {
3085 int relative_index;
3086
3087 /* If the first overlay string happens to have a `display'
3088 property for an image, the iterator will be set up for that
3089 image, and we have to undo that setup first before we can
3090 correct the overlay string index. */
3091 if (it->method == GET_FROM_IMAGE)
3092 pop_it (it);
3093
3094 /* We already have the first chunk of overlay strings in
3095 IT->overlay_strings. Load more until the one for
3096 pos->overlay_string_index is in IT->overlay_strings. */
3097 if (pos->overlay_string_index >= OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE)
3098 {
3099 ptrdiff_t n = pos->overlay_string_index / OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE;
3100 it->current.overlay_string_index = 0;
3101 while (n--)
3102 {
3103 load_overlay_strings (it, 0);
3104 it->current.overlay_string_index += OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE;
3105 }
3106 }
3107
3108 it->current.overlay_string_index = pos->overlay_string_index;
3109 relative_index = (it->current.overlay_string_index
3110 % OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE);
3111 it->string = it->overlay_strings[relative_index];
3112 eassert (STRINGP (it->string));
3113 it->current.string_pos = pos->string_pos;
3114 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
3115 }
3116
3117 if (CHARPOS (pos->string_pos) >= 0)
3118 {
3119 /* Recorded position is not in an overlay string, but in another
3120 string. This can only be a string from a `display' property.
3121 IT should already be filled with that string. */
3122 it->current.string_pos = pos->string_pos;
3123 eassert (STRINGP (it->string));
3124 }
3125
3126 /* Restore position in display vector translations, control
3127 character translations or ellipses. */
3128 if (pos->dpvec_index >= 0)
3129 {
3130 if (it->dpvec == NULL)
3131 get_next_display_element (it);
3132 eassert (it->dpvec && it->current.dpvec_index == 0);
3133 it->current.dpvec_index = pos->dpvec_index;
3134 }
3135
3136 CHECK_IT (it);
3137 return !overlay_strings_with_newlines;
3138 }
3139
3140
3141 /* Initialize IT for stepping through current_buffer in window W
3142 starting at ROW->start. */
3143
3144 static void
3145 init_to_row_start (struct it *it, struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row)
3146 {
3147 init_from_display_pos (it, w, &row->start);
3148 it->start = row->start;
3149 it->continuation_lines_width = row->continuation_lines_width;
3150 CHECK_IT (it);
3151 }
3152
3153
3154 /* Initialize IT for stepping through current_buffer in window W
3155 starting in the line following ROW, i.e. starting at ROW->end.
3156 Value is zero if there are overlay strings with newlines at ROW's
3157 end position. */
3158
3159 static int
3160 init_to_row_end (struct it *it, struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row)
3161 {
3162 int success = 0;
3163
3164 if (init_from_display_pos (it, w, &row->end))
3165 {
3166 if (row->continued_p)
3167 it->continuation_lines_width
3168 = row->continuation_lines_width + row->pixel_width;
3169 CHECK_IT (it);
3170 success = 1;
3171 }
3172
3173 return success;
3174 }
3175
3176
3177
3178 \f
3179 /***********************************************************************
3180 Text properties
3181 ***********************************************************************/
3182
3183 /* Called when IT reaches IT->stop_charpos. Handle text property and
3184 overlay changes. Set IT->stop_charpos to the next position where
3185 to stop. */
3186
3187 static void
3188 handle_stop (struct it *it)
3189 {
3190 enum prop_handled handled;
3191 int handle_overlay_change_p;
3192 struct props *p;
3193
3194 it->dpvec = NULL;
3195 it->current.dpvec_index = -1;
3196 handle_overlay_change_p = !it->ignore_overlay_strings_at_pos_p;
3197 it->ignore_overlay_strings_at_pos_p = 0;
3198 it->ellipsis_p = 0;
3199
3200 /* Use face of preceding text for ellipsis (if invisible) */
3201 if (it->selective_display_ellipsis_p)
3202 it->saved_face_id = it->face_id;
3203
3204 do
3205 {
3206 handled = HANDLED_NORMALLY;
3207
3208 /* Call text property handlers. */
3209 for (p = it_props; p->handler; ++p)
3210 {
3211 handled = p->handler (it);
3212
3213 if (handled == HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS)
3214 break;
3215 else if (handled == HANDLED_RETURN)
3216 {
3217 /* We still want to show before and after strings from
3218 overlays even if the actual buffer text is replaced. */
3219 if (!handle_overlay_change_p
3220 || it->sp > 1
3221 /* Don't call get_overlay_strings_1 if we already
3222 have overlay strings loaded, because doing so
3223 will load them again and push the iterator state
3224 onto the stack one more time, which is not
3225 expected by the rest of the code that processes
3226 overlay strings. */
3227 || (it->current.overlay_string_index < 0
3228 ? !get_overlay_strings_1 (it, 0, 0)
3229 : 0))
3230 {
3231 if (it->ellipsis_p)
3232 setup_for_ellipsis (it, 0);
3233 /* When handling a display spec, we might load an
3234 empty string. In that case, discard it here. We
3235 used to discard it in handle_single_display_spec,
3236 but that causes get_overlay_strings_1, above, to
3237 ignore overlay strings that we must check. */
3238 if (STRINGP (it->string) && !SCHARS (it->string))
3239 pop_it (it);
3240 return;
3241 }
3242 else if (STRINGP (it->string) && !SCHARS (it->string))
3243 pop_it (it);
3244 else
3245 {
3246 it->ignore_overlay_strings_at_pos_p = 1;
3247 it->string_from_display_prop_p = 0;
3248 it->from_disp_prop_p = 0;
3249 handle_overlay_change_p = 0;
3250 }
3251 handled = HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS;
3252 break;
3253 }
3254 else if (handled == HANDLED_OVERLAY_STRING_CONSUMED)
3255 handle_overlay_change_p = 0;
3256 }
3257
3258 if (handled != HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS)
3259 {
3260 /* Don't check for overlay strings below when set to deliver
3261 characters from a display vector. */
3262 if (it->method == GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR)
3263 handle_overlay_change_p = 0;
3264
3265 /* Handle overlay changes.
3266 This sets HANDLED to HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS
3267 if it finds overlays. */
3268 if (handle_overlay_change_p)
3269 handled = handle_overlay_change (it);
3270 }
3271
3272 if (it->ellipsis_p)
3273 {
3274 setup_for_ellipsis (it, 0);
3275 break;
3276 }
3277 }
3278 while (handled == HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS);
3279
3280 /* Determine where to stop next. */
3281 if (handled == HANDLED_NORMALLY)
3282 compute_stop_pos (it);
3283 }
3284
3285
3286 /* Compute IT->stop_charpos from text property and overlay change
3287 information for IT's current position. */
3288
3289 static void
3290 compute_stop_pos (struct it *it)
3291 {
3292 register INTERVAL iv, next_iv;
3293 Lisp_Object object, limit, position;
3294 ptrdiff_t charpos, bytepos;
3295
3296 if (STRINGP (it->string))
3297 {
3298 /* Strings are usually short, so don't limit the search for
3299 properties. */
3300 it->stop_charpos = it->end_charpos;
3301 object = it->string;
3302 limit = Qnil;
3303 charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it);
3304 bytepos = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it);
3305 }
3306 else
3307 {
3308 ptrdiff_t pos;
3309
3310 /* If end_charpos is out of range for some reason, such as a
3311 misbehaving display function, rationalize it (Bug#5984). */
3312 if (it->end_charpos > ZV)
3313 it->end_charpos = ZV;
3314 it->stop_charpos = it->end_charpos;
3315
3316 /* If next overlay change is in front of the current stop pos
3317 (which is IT->end_charpos), stop there. Note: value of
3318 next_overlay_change is point-max if no overlay change
3319 follows. */
3320 charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
3321 bytepos = IT_BYTEPOS (*it);
3322 pos = next_overlay_change (charpos);
3323 if (pos < it->stop_charpos)
3324 it->stop_charpos = pos;
3325
3326 /* If showing the region, we have to stop at the region
3327 start or end because the face might change there. */
3328 if (it->region_beg_charpos > 0)
3329 {
3330 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < it->region_beg_charpos)
3331 it->stop_charpos = min (it->stop_charpos, it->region_beg_charpos);
3332 else if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < it->region_end_charpos)
3333 it->stop_charpos = min (it->stop_charpos, it->region_end_charpos);
3334 }
3335
3336 /* Set up variables for computing the stop position from text
3337 property changes. */
3338 XSETBUFFER (object, current_buffer);
3339 limit = make_number (IT_CHARPOS (*it) + TEXT_PROP_DISTANCE_LIMIT);
3340 }
3341
3342 /* Get the interval containing IT's position. Value is a null
3343 interval if there isn't such an interval. */
3344 position = make_number (charpos);
3345 iv = validate_interval_range (object, &position, &position, 0);
3346 if (iv)
3347 {
3348 Lisp_Object values_here[LAST_PROP_IDX];
3349 struct props *p;
3350
3351 /* Get properties here. */
3352 for (p = it_props; p->handler; ++p)
3353 values_here[p->idx] = textget (iv->plist, *p->name);
3354
3355 /* Look for an interval following iv that has different
3356 properties. */
3357 for (next_iv = next_interval (iv);
3358 (next_iv
3359 && (NILP (limit)
3360 || XFASTINT (limit) > next_iv->position));
3361 next_iv = next_interval (next_iv))
3362 {
3363 for (p = it_props; p->handler; ++p)
3364 {
3365 Lisp_Object new_value;
3366
3367 new_value = textget (next_iv->plist, *p->name);
3368 if (!EQ (values_here[p->idx], new_value))
3369 break;
3370 }
3371
3372 if (p->handler)
3373 break;
3374 }
3375
3376 if (next_iv)
3377 {
3378 if (INTEGERP (limit)
3379 && next_iv->position >= XFASTINT (limit))
3380 /* No text property change up to limit. */
3381 it->stop_charpos = min (XFASTINT (limit), it->stop_charpos);
3382 else
3383 /* Text properties change in next_iv. */
3384 it->stop_charpos = min (it->stop_charpos, next_iv->position);
3385 }
3386 }
3387
3388 if (it->cmp_it.id < 0)
3389 {
3390 ptrdiff_t stoppos = it->end_charpos;
3391
3392 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
3393 stoppos = -1;
3394 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it, charpos, bytepos,
3395 stoppos, it->string);
3396 }
3397
3398 eassert (STRINGP (it->string)
3399 || (it->stop_charpos >= BEGV
3400 && it->stop_charpos >= IT_CHARPOS (*it)));
3401 }
3402
3403
3404 /* Return the position of the next overlay change after POS in
3405 current_buffer. Value is point-max if no overlay change
3406 follows. This is like `next-overlay-change' but doesn't use
3407 xmalloc. */
3408
3409 static ptrdiff_t
3410 next_overlay_change (ptrdiff_t pos)
3411 {
3412 ptrdiff_t i, noverlays;
3413 ptrdiff_t endpos;
3414 Lisp_Object *overlays;
3415
3416 /* Get all overlays at the given position. */
3417 GET_OVERLAYS_AT (pos, overlays, noverlays, &endpos, 1);
3418
3419 /* If any of these overlays ends before endpos,
3420 use its ending point instead. */
3421 for (i = 0; i < noverlays; ++i)
3422 {
3423 Lisp_Object oend;
3424 ptrdiff_t oendpos;
3425
3426 oend = OVERLAY_END (overlays[i]);
3427 oendpos = OVERLAY_POSITION (oend);
3428 endpos = min (endpos, oendpos);
3429 }
3430
3431 return endpos;
3432 }
3433
3434 /* How many characters forward to search for a display property or
3435 display string. Searching too far forward makes the bidi display
3436 sluggish, especially in small windows. */
3437 #define MAX_DISP_SCAN 250
3438
3439 /* Return the character position of a display string at or after
3440 position specified by POSITION. If no display string exists at or
3441 after POSITION, return ZV. A display string is either an overlay
3442 with `display' property whose value is a string, or a `display'
3443 text property whose value is a string. STRING is data about the
3444 string to iterate; if STRING->lstring is nil, we are iterating a
3445 buffer. FRAME_WINDOW_P is non-zero when we are displaying a window
3446 on a GUI frame. DISP_PROP is set to zero if we searched
3447 MAX_DISP_SCAN characters forward without finding any display
3448 strings, non-zero otherwise. It is set to 2 if the display string
3449 uses any kind of `(space ...)' spec that will produce a stretch of
3450 white space in the text area. */
3451 ptrdiff_t
3452 compute_display_string_pos (struct text_pos *position,
3453 struct bidi_string_data *string,
3454 int frame_window_p, int *disp_prop)
3455 {
3456 /* OBJECT = nil means current buffer. */
3457 Lisp_Object object =
3458 (string && STRINGP (string->lstring)) ? string->lstring : Qnil;
3459 Lisp_Object pos, spec, limpos;
3460 int string_p = (string && (STRINGP (string->lstring) || string->s));
3461 ptrdiff_t eob = string_p ? string->schars : ZV;
3462 ptrdiff_t begb = string_p ? 0 : BEGV;
3463 ptrdiff_t bufpos, charpos = CHARPOS (*position);
3464 ptrdiff_t lim =
3465 (charpos < eob - MAX_DISP_SCAN) ? charpos + MAX_DISP_SCAN : eob;
3466 struct text_pos tpos;
3467 int rv = 0;
3468
3469 *disp_prop = 1;
3470
3471 if (charpos >= eob
3472 /* We don't support display properties whose values are strings
3473 that have display string properties. */
3474 || string->from_disp_str
3475 /* C strings cannot have display properties. */
3476 || (string->s && !STRINGP (object)))
3477 {
3478 *disp_prop = 0;
3479 return eob;
3480 }
3481
3482 /* If the character at CHARPOS is where the display string begins,
3483 return CHARPOS. */
3484 pos = make_number (charpos);
3485 if (STRINGP (object))
3486 bufpos = string->bufpos;
3487 else
3488 bufpos = charpos;
3489 tpos = *position;
3490 if (!NILP (spec = Fget_char_property (pos, Qdisplay, object))
3491 && (charpos <= begb
3492 || !EQ (Fget_char_property (make_number (charpos - 1), Qdisplay,
3493 object),
3494 spec))
3495 && (rv = handle_display_spec (NULL, spec, object, Qnil, &tpos, bufpos,
3496 frame_window_p)))
3497 {
3498 if (rv == 2)
3499 *disp_prop = 2;
3500 return charpos;
3501 }
3502
3503 /* Look forward for the first character with a `display' property
3504 that will replace the underlying text when displayed. */
3505 limpos = make_number (lim);
3506 do {
3507 pos = Fnext_single_char_property_change (pos, Qdisplay, object, limpos);
3508 CHARPOS (tpos) = XFASTINT (pos);
3509 if (CHARPOS (tpos) >= lim)
3510 {
3511 *disp_prop = 0;
3512 break;
3513 }
3514 if (STRINGP (object))
3515 BYTEPOS (tpos) = string_char_to_byte (object, CHARPOS (tpos));
3516 else
3517 BYTEPOS (tpos) = CHAR_TO_BYTE (CHARPOS (tpos));
3518 spec = Fget_char_property (pos, Qdisplay, object);
3519 if (!STRINGP (object))
3520 bufpos = CHARPOS (tpos);
3521 } while (NILP (spec)
3522 || !(rv = handle_display_spec (NULL, spec, object, Qnil, &tpos,
3523 bufpos, frame_window_p)));
3524 if (rv == 2)
3525 *disp_prop = 2;
3526
3527 return CHARPOS (tpos);
3528 }
3529
3530 /* Return the character position of the end of the display string that
3531 started at CHARPOS. If there's no display string at CHARPOS,
3532 return -1. A display string is either an overlay with `display'
3533 property whose value is a string or a `display' text property whose
3534 value is a string. */
3535 ptrdiff_t
3536 compute_display_string_end (ptrdiff_t charpos, struct bidi_string_data *string)
3537 {
3538 /* OBJECT = nil means current buffer. */
3539 Lisp_Object object =
3540 (string && STRINGP (string->lstring)) ? string->lstring : Qnil;
3541 Lisp_Object pos = make_number (charpos);
3542 ptrdiff_t eob =
3543 (STRINGP (object) || (string && string->s)) ? string->schars : ZV;
3544
3545 if (charpos >= eob || (string->s && !STRINGP (object)))
3546 return eob;
3547
3548 /* It could happen that the display property or overlay was removed
3549 since we found it in compute_display_string_pos above. One way
3550 this can happen is if JIT font-lock was called (through
3551 handle_fontified_prop), and jit-lock-functions remove text
3552 properties or overlays from the portion of buffer that includes
3553 CHARPOS. Muse mode is known to do that, for example. In this
3554 case, we return -1 to the caller, to signal that no display
3555 string is actually present at CHARPOS. See bidi_fetch_char for
3556 how this is handled.
3557
3558 An alternative would be to never look for display properties past
3559 it->stop_charpos. But neither compute_display_string_pos nor
3560 bidi_fetch_char that calls it know or care where the next
3561 stop_charpos is. */
3562 if (NILP (Fget_char_property (pos, Qdisplay, object)))
3563 return -1;
3564
3565 /* Look forward for the first character where the `display' property
3566 changes. */
3567 pos = Fnext_single_char_property_change (pos, Qdisplay, object, Qnil);
3568
3569 return XFASTINT (pos);
3570 }
3571
3572
3573 \f
3574 /***********************************************************************
3575 Fontification
3576 ***********************************************************************/
3577
3578 /* Handle changes in the `fontified' property of the current buffer by
3579 calling hook functions from Qfontification_functions to fontify
3580 regions of text. */
3581
3582 static enum prop_handled
3583 handle_fontified_prop (struct it *it)
3584 {
3585 Lisp_Object prop, pos;
3586 enum prop_handled handled = HANDLED_NORMALLY;
3587
3588 if (!NILP (Vmemory_full))
3589 return handled;
3590
3591 /* Get the value of the `fontified' property at IT's current buffer
3592 position. (The `fontified' property doesn't have a special
3593 meaning in strings.) If the value is nil, call functions from
3594 Qfontification_functions. */
3595 if (!STRINGP (it->string)
3596 && it->s == NULL
3597 && !NILP (Vfontification_functions)
3598 && !NILP (Vrun_hooks)
3599 && (pos = make_number (IT_CHARPOS (*it)),
3600 prop = Fget_char_property (pos, Qfontified, Qnil),
3601 /* Ignore the special cased nil value always present at EOB since
3602 no amount of fontifying will be able to change it. */
3603 NILP (prop) && IT_CHARPOS (*it) < Z))
3604 {
3605 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
3606 Lisp_Object val;
3607 struct buffer *obuf = current_buffer;
3608 int begv = BEGV, zv = ZV;
3609 int old_clip_changed = current_buffer->clip_changed;
3610
3611 val = Vfontification_functions;
3612 specbind (Qfontification_functions, Qnil);
3613
3614 eassert (it->end_charpos == ZV);
3615
3616 if (!CONSP (val) || EQ (XCAR (val), Qlambda))
3617 safe_call1 (val, pos);
3618 else
3619 {
3620 Lisp_Object fns, fn;
3621 struct gcpro gcpro1, gcpro2;
3622
3623 fns = Qnil;
3624 GCPRO2 (val, fns);
3625
3626 for (; CONSP (val); val = XCDR (val))
3627 {
3628 fn = XCAR (val);
3629
3630 if (EQ (fn, Qt))
3631 {
3632 /* A value of t indicates this hook has a local
3633 binding; it means to run the global binding too.
3634 In a global value, t should not occur. If it
3635 does, we must ignore it to avoid an endless
3636 loop. */
3637 for (fns = Fdefault_value (Qfontification_functions);
3638 CONSP (fns);
3639 fns = XCDR (fns))
3640 {
3641 fn = XCAR (fns);
3642 if (!EQ (fn, Qt))
3643 safe_call1 (fn, pos);
3644 }
3645 }
3646 else
3647 safe_call1 (fn, pos);
3648 }
3649
3650 UNGCPRO;
3651 }
3652
3653 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
3654
3655 /* Fontification functions routinely call `save-restriction'.
3656 Normally, this tags clip_changed, which can confuse redisplay
3657 (see discussion in Bug#6671). Since we don't perform any
3658 special handling of fontification changes in the case where
3659 `save-restriction' isn't called, there's no point doing so in
3660 this case either. So, if the buffer's restrictions are
3661 actually left unchanged, reset clip_changed. */
3662 if (obuf == current_buffer)
3663 {
3664 if (begv == BEGV && zv == ZV)
3665 current_buffer->clip_changed = old_clip_changed;
3666 }
3667 /* There isn't much we can reasonably do to protect against
3668 misbehaving fontification, but here's a fig leaf. */
3669 else if (!NILP (BVAR (obuf, name)))
3670 set_buffer_internal_1 (obuf);
3671
3672 /* The fontification code may have added/removed text.
3673 It could do even a lot worse, but let's at least protect against
3674 the most obvious case where only the text past `pos' gets changed',
3675 as is/was done in grep.el where some escapes sequences are turned
3676 into face properties (bug#7876). */
3677 it->end_charpos = ZV;
3678
3679 /* Return HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS only if function fontified
3680 something. This avoids an endless loop if they failed to
3681 fontify the text for which reason ever. */
3682 if (!NILP (Fget_char_property (pos, Qfontified, Qnil)))
3683 handled = HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS;
3684 }
3685
3686 return handled;
3687 }
3688
3689
3690 \f
3691 /***********************************************************************
3692 Faces
3693 ***********************************************************************/
3694
3695 /* Set up iterator IT from face properties at its current position.
3696 Called from handle_stop. */
3697
3698 static enum prop_handled
3699 handle_face_prop (struct it *it)
3700 {
3701 int new_face_id;
3702 ptrdiff_t next_stop;
3703
3704 if (!STRINGP (it->string))
3705 {
3706 new_face_id
3707 = face_at_buffer_position (it->w,
3708 IT_CHARPOS (*it),
3709 it->region_beg_charpos,
3710 it->region_end_charpos,
3711 &next_stop,
3712 (IT_CHARPOS (*it)
3713 + TEXT_PROP_DISTANCE_LIMIT),
3714 0, it->base_face_id);
3715
3716 /* Is this a start of a run of characters with box face?
3717 Caveat: this can be called for a freshly initialized
3718 iterator; face_id is -1 in this case. We know that the new
3719 face will not change until limit, i.e. if the new face has a
3720 box, all characters up to limit will have one. But, as
3721 usual, we don't know whether limit is really the end. */
3722 if (new_face_id != it->face_id)
3723 {
3724 struct face *new_face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, new_face_id);
3725
3726 /* If new face has a box but old face has not, this is
3727 the start of a run of characters with box, i.e. it has
3728 a shadow on the left side. The value of face_id of the
3729 iterator will be -1 if this is the initial call that gets
3730 the face. In this case, we have to look in front of IT's
3731 position and see whether there is a face != new_face_id. */
3732 it->start_of_box_run_p
3733 = (new_face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
3734 && (it->face_id >= 0
3735 || IT_CHARPOS (*it) == BEG
3736 || new_face_id != face_before_it_pos (it)));
3737 it->face_box_p = new_face->box != FACE_NO_BOX;
3738 }
3739 }
3740 else
3741 {
3742 int base_face_id;
3743 ptrdiff_t bufpos;
3744 int i;
3745 Lisp_Object from_overlay
3746 = (it->current.overlay_string_index >= 0
3747 ? it->string_overlays[it->current.overlay_string_index
3748 % OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE]
3749 : Qnil);
3750
3751 /* See if we got to this string directly or indirectly from
3752 an overlay property. That includes the before-string or
3753 after-string of an overlay, strings in display properties
3754 provided by an overlay, their text properties, etc.
3755
3756 FROM_OVERLAY is the overlay that brought us here, or nil if none. */
3757 if (! NILP (from_overlay))
3758 for (i = it->sp - 1; i >= 0; i--)
3759 {
3760 if (it->stack[i].current.overlay_string_index >= 0)
3761 from_overlay
3762 = it->string_overlays[it->stack[i].current.overlay_string_index
3763 % OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE];
3764 else if (! NILP (it->stack[i].from_overlay))
3765 from_overlay = it->stack[i].from_overlay;
3766
3767 if (!NILP (from_overlay))
3768 break;
3769 }
3770
3771 if (! NILP (from_overlay))
3772 {
3773 bufpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
3774 /* For a string from an overlay, the base face depends
3775 only on text properties and ignores overlays. */
3776 base_face_id
3777 = face_for_overlay_string (it->w,
3778 IT_CHARPOS (*it),
3779 it->region_beg_charpos,
3780 it->region_end_charpos,
3781 &next_stop,
3782 (IT_CHARPOS (*it)
3783 + TEXT_PROP_DISTANCE_LIMIT),
3784 0,
3785 from_overlay);
3786 }
3787 else
3788 {
3789 bufpos = 0;
3790
3791 /* For strings from a `display' property, use the face at
3792 IT's current buffer position as the base face to merge
3793 with, so that overlay strings appear in the same face as
3794 surrounding text, unless they specify their own
3795 faces. */
3796 base_face_id = it->string_from_prefix_prop_p
3797 ? DEFAULT_FACE_ID
3798 : underlying_face_id (it);
3799 }
3800
3801 new_face_id = face_at_string_position (it->w,
3802 it->string,
3803 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
3804 bufpos,
3805 it->region_beg_charpos,
3806 it->region_end_charpos,
3807 &next_stop,
3808 base_face_id, 0);
3809
3810 /* Is this a start of a run of characters with box? Caveat:
3811 this can be called for a freshly allocated iterator; face_id
3812 is -1 is this case. We know that the new face will not
3813 change until the next check pos, i.e. if the new face has a
3814 box, all characters up to that position will have a
3815 box. But, as usual, we don't know whether that position
3816 is really the end. */
3817 if (new_face_id != it->face_id)
3818 {
3819 struct face *new_face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, new_face_id);
3820 struct face *old_face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
3821
3822 /* If new face has a box but old face hasn't, this is the
3823 start of a run of characters with box, i.e. it has a
3824 shadow on the left side. */
3825 it->start_of_box_run_p
3826 = new_face->box && (old_face == NULL || !old_face->box);
3827 it->face_box_p = new_face->box != FACE_NO_BOX;
3828 }
3829 }
3830
3831 it->face_id = new_face_id;
3832 return HANDLED_NORMALLY;
3833 }
3834
3835
3836 /* Return the ID of the face ``underlying'' IT's current position,
3837 which is in a string. If the iterator is associated with a
3838 buffer, return the face at IT's current buffer position.
3839 Otherwise, use the iterator's base_face_id. */
3840
3841 static int
3842 underlying_face_id (struct it *it)
3843 {
3844 int face_id = it->base_face_id, i;
3845
3846 eassert (STRINGP (it->string));
3847
3848 for (i = it->sp - 1; i >= 0; --i)
3849 if (NILP (it->stack[i].string))
3850 face_id = it->stack[i].face_id;
3851
3852 return face_id;
3853 }
3854
3855
3856 /* Compute the face one character before or after the current position
3857 of IT, in the visual order. BEFORE_P non-zero means get the face
3858 in front (to the left in L2R paragraphs, to the right in R2L
3859 paragraphs) of IT's screen position. Value is the ID of the face. */
3860
3861 static int
3862 face_before_or_after_it_pos (struct it *it, int before_p)
3863 {
3864 int face_id, limit;
3865 ptrdiff_t next_check_charpos;
3866 struct it it_copy;
3867 void *it_copy_data = NULL;
3868
3869 eassert (it->s == NULL);
3870
3871 if (STRINGP (it->string))
3872 {
3873 ptrdiff_t bufpos, charpos;
3874 int base_face_id;
3875
3876 /* No face change past the end of the string (for the case
3877 we are padding with spaces). No face change before the
3878 string start. */
3879 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= SCHARS (it->string)
3880 || (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) == 0 && before_p))
3881 return it->face_id;
3882
3883 if (!it->bidi_p)
3884 {
3885 /* Set charpos to the position before or after IT's current
3886 position, in the logical order, which in the non-bidi
3887 case is the same as the visual order. */
3888 if (before_p)
3889 charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) - 1;
3890 else if (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION)
3891 /* For composition, we must check the character after the
3892 composition. */
3893 charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) + it->cmp_it.nchars;
3894 else
3895 charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) + 1;
3896 }
3897 else
3898 {
3899 if (before_p)
3900 {
3901 /* With bidi iteration, the character before the current
3902 in the visual order cannot be found by simple
3903 iteration, because "reverse" reordering is not
3904 supported. Instead, we need to use the move_it_*
3905 family of functions. */
3906 /* Ignore face changes before the first visible
3907 character on this display line. */
3908 if (it->current_x <= it->first_visible_x)
3909 return it->face_id;
3910 SAVE_IT (it_copy, *it, it_copy_data);
3911 /* Implementation note: Since move_it_in_display_line
3912 works in the iterator geometry, and thinks the first
3913 character is always the leftmost, even in R2L lines,
3914 we don't need to distinguish between the R2L and L2R
3915 cases here. */
3916 move_it_in_display_line (&it_copy, SCHARS (it_copy.string),
3917 it_copy.current_x - 1, MOVE_TO_X);
3918 charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (it_copy);
3919 RESTORE_IT (it, it, it_copy_data);
3920 }
3921 else
3922 {
3923 /* Set charpos to the string position of the character
3924 that comes after IT's current position in the visual
3925 order. */
3926 int n = (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION ? it->cmp_it.nchars : 1);
3927
3928 it_copy = *it;
3929 while (n--)
3930 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it_copy.bidi_it);
3931
3932 charpos = it_copy.bidi_it.charpos;
3933 }
3934 }
3935 eassert (0 <= charpos && charpos <= SCHARS (it->string));
3936
3937 if (it->current.overlay_string_index >= 0)
3938 bufpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
3939 else
3940 bufpos = 0;
3941
3942 base_face_id = underlying_face_id (it);
3943
3944 /* Get the face for ASCII, or unibyte. */
3945 face_id = face_at_string_position (it->w,
3946 it->string,
3947 charpos,
3948 bufpos,
3949 it->region_beg_charpos,
3950 it->region_end_charpos,
3951 &next_check_charpos,
3952 base_face_id, 0);
3953
3954 /* Correct the face for charsets different from ASCII. Do it
3955 for the multibyte case only. The face returned above is
3956 suitable for unibyte text if IT->string is unibyte. */
3957 if (STRING_MULTIBYTE (it->string))
3958 {
3959 struct text_pos pos1 = string_pos (charpos, it->string);
3960 const unsigned char *p = SDATA (it->string) + BYTEPOS (pos1);
3961 int c, len;
3962 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, face_id);
3963
3964 c = string_char_and_length (p, &len);
3965 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (it->f, face, c, charpos, it->string);
3966 }
3967 }
3968 else
3969 {
3970 struct text_pos pos;
3971
3972 if ((IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= ZV && !before_p)
3973 || (IT_CHARPOS (*it) <= BEGV && before_p))
3974 return it->face_id;
3975
3976 limit = IT_CHARPOS (*it) + TEXT_PROP_DISTANCE_LIMIT;
3977 pos = it->current.pos;
3978
3979 if (!it->bidi_p)
3980 {
3981 if (before_p)
3982 DEC_TEXT_POS (pos, it->multibyte_p);
3983 else
3984 {
3985 if (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION)
3986 {
3987 /* For composition, we must check the position after
3988 the composition. */
3989 pos.charpos += it->cmp_it.nchars;
3990 pos.bytepos += it->len;
3991 }
3992 else
3993 INC_TEXT_POS (pos, it->multibyte_p);
3994 }
3995 }
3996 else
3997 {
3998 if (before_p)
3999 {
4000 /* With bidi iteration, the character before the current
4001 in the visual order cannot be found by simple
4002 iteration, because "reverse" reordering is not
4003 supported. Instead, we need to use the move_it_*
4004 family of functions. */
4005 /* Ignore face changes before the first visible
4006 character on this display line. */
4007 if (it->current_x <= it->first_visible_x)
4008 return it->face_id;
4009 SAVE_IT (it_copy, *it, it_copy_data);
4010 /* Implementation note: Since move_it_in_display_line
4011 works in the iterator geometry, and thinks the first
4012 character is always the leftmost, even in R2L lines,
4013 we don't need to distinguish between the R2L and L2R
4014 cases here. */
4015 move_it_in_display_line (&it_copy, ZV,
4016 it_copy.current_x - 1, MOVE_TO_X);
4017 pos = it_copy.current.pos;
4018 RESTORE_IT (it, it, it_copy_data);
4019 }
4020 else
4021 {
4022 /* Set charpos to the buffer position of the character
4023 that comes after IT's current position in the visual
4024 order. */
4025 int n = (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION ? it->cmp_it.nchars : 1);
4026
4027 it_copy = *it;
4028 while (n--)
4029 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it_copy.bidi_it);
4030
4031 SET_TEXT_POS (pos,
4032 it_copy.bidi_it.charpos, it_copy.bidi_it.bytepos);
4033 }
4034 }
4035 eassert (BEGV <= CHARPOS (pos) && CHARPOS (pos) <= ZV);
4036
4037 /* Determine face for CHARSET_ASCII, or unibyte. */
4038 face_id = face_at_buffer_position (it->w,
4039 CHARPOS (pos),
4040 it->region_beg_charpos,
4041 it->region_end_charpos,
4042 &next_check_charpos,
4043 limit, 0, -1);
4044
4045 /* Correct the face for charsets different from ASCII. Do it
4046 for the multibyte case only. The face returned above is
4047 suitable for unibyte text if current_buffer is unibyte. */
4048 if (it->multibyte_p)
4049 {
4050 int c = FETCH_MULTIBYTE_CHAR (BYTEPOS (pos));
4051 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, face_id);
4052 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (it->f, face, c, CHARPOS (pos), Qnil);
4053 }
4054 }
4055
4056 return face_id;
4057 }
4058
4059
4060 \f
4061 /***********************************************************************
4062 Invisible text
4063 ***********************************************************************/
4064
4065 /* Set up iterator IT from invisible properties at its current
4066 position. Called from handle_stop. */
4067
4068 static enum prop_handled
4069 handle_invisible_prop (struct it *it)
4070 {
4071 enum prop_handled handled = HANDLED_NORMALLY;
4072 int invis_p;
4073 Lisp_Object prop;
4074
4075 if (STRINGP (it->string))
4076 {
4077 Lisp_Object end_charpos, limit, charpos;
4078
4079 /* Get the value of the invisible text property at the
4080 current position. Value will be nil if there is no such
4081 property. */
4082 charpos = make_number (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it));
4083 prop = Fget_text_property (charpos, Qinvisible, it->string);
4084 invis_p = TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (prop);
4085
4086 if (invis_p && IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) < it->end_charpos)
4087 {
4088 /* Record whether we have to display an ellipsis for the
4089 invisible text. */
4090 int display_ellipsis_p = (invis_p == 2);
4091 ptrdiff_t len, endpos;
4092
4093 handled = HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS;
4094
4095 /* Get the position at which the next visible text can be
4096 found in IT->string, if any. */
4097 endpos = len = SCHARS (it->string);
4098 XSETINT (limit, len);
4099 do
4100 {
4101 end_charpos = Fnext_single_property_change (charpos, Qinvisible,
4102 it->string, limit);
4103 if (INTEGERP (end_charpos))
4104 {
4105 endpos = XFASTINT (end_charpos);
4106 prop = Fget_text_property (end_charpos, Qinvisible, it->string);
4107 invis_p = TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (prop);
4108 if (invis_p == 2)
4109 display_ellipsis_p = 1;
4110 }
4111 }
4112 while (invis_p && endpos < len);
4113
4114 if (display_ellipsis_p)
4115 it->ellipsis_p = 1;
4116
4117 if (endpos < len)
4118 {
4119 /* Text at END_CHARPOS is visible. Move IT there. */
4120 struct text_pos old;
4121 ptrdiff_t oldpos;
4122
4123 old = it->current.string_pos;
4124 oldpos = CHARPOS (old);
4125 if (it->bidi_p)
4126 {
4127 if (it->bidi_it.first_elt
4128 && it->bidi_it.charpos < SCHARS (it->string))
4129 bidi_paragraph_init (it->paragraph_embedding,
4130 &it->bidi_it, 1);
4131 /* Bidi-iterate out of the invisible text. */
4132 do
4133 {
4134 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
4135 }
4136 while (oldpos <= it->bidi_it.charpos
4137 && it->bidi_it.charpos < endpos);
4138
4139 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
4140 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
4141 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= endpos)
4142 it->prev_stop = endpos;
4143 }
4144 else
4145 {
4146 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = XFASTINT (end_charpos);
4147 compute_string_pos (&it->current.string_pos, old, it->string);
4148 }
4149 }
4150 else
4151 {
4152 /* The rest of the string is invisible. If this is an
4153 overlay string, proceed with the next overlay string
4154 or whatever comes and return a character from there. */
4155 if (it->current.overlay_string_index >= 0
4156 && !display_ellipsis_p)
4157 {
4158 next_overlay_string (it);
4159 /* Don't check for overlay strings when we just
4160 finished processing them. */
4161 handled = HANDLED_OVERLAY_STRING_CONSUMED;
4162 }
4163 else
4164 {
4165 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = SCHARS (it->string);
4166 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = SBYTES (it->string);
4167 }
4168 }
4169 }
4170 }
4171 else
4172 {
4173 ptrdiff_t newpos, next_stop, start_charpos, tem;
4174 Lisp_Object pos, overlay;
4175
4176 /* First of all, is there invisible text at this position? */
4177 tem = start_charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
4178 pos = make_number (tem);
4179 prop = get_char_property_and_overlay (pos, Qinvisible, it->window,
4180 &overlay);
4181 invis_p = TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (prop);
4182
4183 /* If we are on invisible text, skip over it. */
4184 if (invis_p && start_charpos < it->end_charpos)
4185 {
4186 /* Record whether we have to display an ellipsis for the
4187 invisible text. */
4188 int display_ellipsis_p = invis_p == 2;
4189
4190 handled = HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS;
4191
4192 /* Loop skipping over invisible text. The loop is left at
4193 ZV or with IT on the first char being visible again. */
4194 do
4195 {
4196 /* Try to skip some invisible text. Return value is the
4197 position reached which can be equal to where we start
4198 if there is nothing invisible there. This skips both
4199 over invisible text properties and overlays with
4200 invisible property. */
4201 newpos = skip_invisible (tem, &next_stop, ZV, it->window);
4202
4203 /* If we skipped nothing at all we weren't at invisible
4204 text in the first place. If everything to the end of
4205 the buffer was skipped, end the loop. */
4206 if (newpos == tem || newpos >= ZV)
4207 invis_p = 0;
4208 else
4209 {
4210 /* We skipped some characters but not necessarily
4211 all there are. Check if we ended up on visible
4212 text. Fget_char_property returns the property of
4213 the char before the given position, i.e. if we
4214 get invis_p = 0, this means that the char at
4215 newpos is visible. */
4216 pos = make_number (newpos);
4217 prop = Fget_char_property (pos, Qinvisible, it->window);
4218 invis_p = TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (prop);
4219 }
4220
4221 /* If we ended up on invisible text, proceed to
4222 skip starting with next_stop. */
4223 if (invis_p)
4224 tem = next_stop;
4225
4226 /* If there are adjacent invisible texts, don't lose the
4227 second one's ellipsis. */
4228 if (invis_p == 2)
4229 display_ellipsis_p = 1;
4230 }
4231 while (invis_p);
4232
4233 /* The position newpos is now either ZV or on visible text. */
4234 if (it->bidi_p)
4235 {
4236 ptrdiff_t bpos = CHAR_TO_BYTE (newpos);
4237 int on_newline =
4238 bpos == ZV_BYTE || FETCH_BYTE (bpos) == '\n';
4239 int after_newline =
4240 newpos <= BEGV || FETCH_BYTE (bpos - 1) == '\n';
4241
4242 /* If the invisible text ends on a newline or on a
4243 character after a newline, we can avoid the costly,
4244 character by character, bidi iteration to NEWPOS, and
4245 instead simply reseat the iterator there. That's
4246 because all bidi reordering information is tossed at
4247 the newline. This is a big win for modes that hide
4248 complete lines, like Outline, Org, etc. */
4249 if (on_newline || after_newline)
4250 {
4251 struct text_pos tpos;
4252 bidi_dir_t pdir = it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir;
4253
4254 SET_TEXT_POS (tpos, newpos, bpos);
4255 reseat_1 (it, tpos, 0);
4256 /* If we reseat on a newline/ZV, we need to prep the
4257 bidi iterator for advancing to the next character
4258 after the newline/EOB, keeping the current paragraph
4259 direction (so that PRODUCE_GLYPHS does TRT wrt
4260 prepending/appending glyphs to a glyph row). */
4261 if (on_newline)
4262 {
4263 it->bidi_it.first_elt = 0;
4264 it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir = pdir;
4265 it->bidi_it.ch = (bpos == ZV_BYTE) ? -1 : '\n';
4266 it->bidi_it.nchars = 1;
4267 it->bidi_it.ch_len = 1;
4268 }
4269 }
4270 else /* Must use the slow method. */
4271 {
4272 /* With bidi iteration, the region of invisible text
4273 could start and/or end in the middle of a
4274 non-base embedding level. Therefore, we need to
4275 skip invisible text using the bidi iterator,
4276 starting at IT's current position, until we find
4277 ourselves outside of the invisible text.
4278 Skipping invisible text _after_ bidi iteration
4279 avoids affecting the visual order of the
4280 displayed text when invisible properties are
4281 added or removed. */
4282 if (it->bidi_it.first_elt && it->bidi_it.charpos < ZV)
4283 {
4284 /* If we were `reseat'ed to a new paragraph,
4285 determine the paragraph base direction. We
4286 need to do it now because
4287 next_element_from_buffer may not have a
4288 chance to do it, if we are going to skip any
4289 text at the beginning, which resets the
4290 FIRST_ELT flag. */
4291 bidi_paragraph_init (it->paragraph_embedding,
4292 &it->bidi_it, 1);
4293 }
4294 do
4295 {
4296 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
4297 }
4298 while (it->stop_charpos <= it->bidi_it.charpos
4299 && it->bidi_it.charpos < newpos);
4300 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
4301 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
4302 /* If we overstepped NEWPOS, record its position in
4303 the iterator, so that we skip invisible text if
4304 later the bidi iteration lands us in the
4305 invisible region again. */
4306 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= newpos)
4307 it->prev_stop = newpos;
4308 }
4309 }
4310 else
4311 {
4312 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = newpos;
4313 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = CHAR_TO_BYTE (newpos);
4314 }
4315
4316 /* If there are before-strings at the start of invisible
4317 text, and the text is invisible because of a text
4318 property, arrange to show before-strings because 20.x did
4319 it that way. (If the text is invisible because of an
4320 overlay property instead of a text property, this is
4321 already handled in the overlay code.) */
4322 if (NILP (overlay)
4323 && get_overlay_strings (it, it->stop_charpos))
4324 {
4325 handled = HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS;
4326 it->stack[it->sp - 1].display_ellipsis_p = display_ellipsis_p;
4327 }
4328 else if (display_ellipsis_p)
4329 {
4330 /* Make sure that the glyphs of the ellipsis will get
4331 correct `charpos' values. If we would not update
4332 it->position here, the glyphs would belong to the
4333 last visible character _before_ the invisible
4334 text, which confuses `set_cursor_from_row'.
4335
4336 We use the last invisible position instead of the
4337 first because this way the cursor is always drawn on
4338 the first "." of the ellipsis, whenever PT is inside
4339 the invisible text. Otherwise the cursor would be
4340 placed _after_ the ellipsis when the point is after the
4341 first invisible character. */
4342 if (!STRINGP (it->object))
4343 {
4344 it->position.charpos = newpos - 1;
4345 it->position.bytepos = CHAR_TO_BYTE (it->position.charpos);
4346 }
4347 it->ellipsis_p = 1;
4348 /* Let the ellipsis display before
4349 considering any properties of the following char.
4350 Fixes jasonr@gnu.org 01 Oct 07 bug. */
4351 handled = HANDLED_RETURN;
4352 }
4353 }
4354 }
4355
4356 return handled;
4357 }
4358
4359
4360 /* Make iterator IT return `...' next.
4361 Replaces LEN characters from buffer. */
4362
4363 static void
4364 setup_for_ellipsis (struct it *it, int len)
4365 {
4366 /* Use the display table definition for `...'. Invalid glyphs
4367 will be handled by the method returning elements from dpvec. */
4368 if (it->dp && VECTORP (DISP_INVIS_VECTOR (it->dp)))
4369 {
4370 struct Lisp_Vector *v = XVECTOR (DISP_INVIS_VECTOR (it->dp));
4371 it->dpvec = v->contents;
4372 it->dpend = v->contents + v->header.size;
4373 }
4374 else
4375 {
4376 /* Default `...'. */
4377 it->dpvec = default_invis_vector;
4378 it->dpend = default_invis_vector + 3;
4379 }
4380
4381 it->dpvec_char_len = len;
4382 it->current.dpvec_index = 0;
4383 it->dpvec_face_id = -1;
4384
4385 /* Remember the current face id in case glyphs specify faces.
4386 IT's face is restored in set_iterator_to_next.
4387 saved_face_id was set to preceding char's face in handle_stop. */
4388 if (it->saved_face_id < 0 || it->saved_face_id != it->face_id)
4389 it->saved_face_id = it->face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
4390
4391 it->method = GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR;
4392 it->ellipsis_p = 1;
4393 }
4394
4395
4396 \f
4397 /***********************************************************************
4398 'display' property
4399 ***********************************************************************/
4400
4401 /* Set up iterator IT from `display' property at its current position.
4402 Called from handle_stop.
4403 We return HANDLED_RETURN if some part of the display property
4404 overrides the display of the buffer text itself.
4405 Otherwise we return HANDLED_NORMALLY. */
4406
4407 static enum prop_handled
4408 handle_display_prop (struct it *it)
4409 {
4410 Lisp_Object propval, object, overlay;
4411 struct text_pos *position;
4412 ptrdiff_t bufpos;
4413 /* Nonzero if some property replaces the display of the text itself. */
4414 int display_replaced_p = 0;
4415
4416 if (STRINGP (it->string))
4417 {
4418 object = it->string;
4419 position = &it->current.string_pos;
4420 bufpos = CHARPOS (it->current.pos);
4421 }
4422 else
4423 {
4424 XSETWINDOW (object, it->w);
4425 position = &it->current.pos;
4426 bufpos = CHARPOS (*position);
4427 }
4428
4429 /* Reset those iterator values set from display property values. */
4430 it->slice.x = it->slice.y = it->slice.width = it->slice.height = Qnil;
4431 it->space_width = Qnil;
4432 it->font_height = Qnil;
4433 it->voffset = 0;
4434
4435 /* We don't support recursive `display' properties, i.e. string
4436 values that have a string `display' property, that have a string
4437 `display' property etc. */
4438 if (!it->string_from_display_prop_p)
4439 it->area = TEXT_AREA;
4440
4441 propval = get_char_property_and_overlay (make_number (position->charpos),
4442 Qdisplay, object, &overlay);
4443 if (NILP (propval))
4444 return HANDLED_NORMALLY;
4445 /* Now OVERLAY is the overlay that gave us this property, or nil
4446 if it was a text property. */
4447
4448 if (!STRINGP (it->string))
4449 object = it->w->buffer;
4450
4451 display_replaced_p = handle_display_spec (it, propval, object, overlay,
4452 position, bufpos,
4453 FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f));
4454
4455 return display_replaced_p ? HANDLED_RETURN : HANDLED_NORMALLY;
4456 }
4457
4458 /* Subroutine of handle_display_prop. Returns non-zero if the display
4459 specification in SPEC is a replacing specification, i.e. it would
4460 replace the text covered by `display' property with something else,
4461 such as an image or a display string. If SPEC includes any kind or
4462 `(space ...) specification, the value is 2; this is used by
4463 compute_display_string_pos, which see.
4464
4465 See handle_single_display_spec for documentation of arguments.
4466 frame_window_p is non-zero if the window being redisplayed is on a
4467 GUI frame; this argument is used only if IT is NULL, see below.
4468
4469 IT can be NULL, if this is called by the bidi reordering code
4470 through compute_display_string_pos, which see. In that case, this
4471 function only examines SPEC, but does not otherwise "handle" it, in
4472 the sense that it doesn't set up members of IT from the display
4473 spec. */
4474 static int
4475 handle_display_spec (struct it *it, Lisp_Object spec, Lisp_Object object,
4476 Lisp_Object overlay, struct text_pos *position,
4477 ptrdiff_t bufpos, int frame_window_p)
4478 {
4479 int replacing_p = 0;
4480 int rv;
4481
4482 if (CONSP (spec)
4483 /* Simple specifications. */
4484 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qimage)
4485 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qspace)
4486 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qwhen)
4487 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qslice)
4488 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qspace_width)
4489 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qheight)
4490 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qraise)
4491 /* Marginal area specifications. */
4492 && !(CONSP (XCAR (spec)) && EQ (XCAR (XCAR (spec)), Qmargin))
4493 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qleft_fringe)
4494 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qright_fringe)
4495 && !NILP (XCAR (spec)))
4496 {
4497 for (; CONSP (spec); spec = XCDR (spec))
4498 {
4499 if ((rv = handle_single_display_spec (it, XCAR (spec), object,
4500 overlay, position, bufpos,
4501 replacing_p, frame_window_p)))
4502 {
4503 replacing_p = rv;
4504 /* If some text in a string is replaced, `position' no
4505 longer points to the position of `object'. */
4506 if (!it || STRINGP (object))
4507 break;
4508 }
4509 }
4510 }
4511 else if (VECTORP (spec))
4512 {
4513 ptrdiff_t i;
4514 for (i = 0; i < ASIZE (spec); ++i)
4515 if ((rv = handle_single_display_spec (it, AREF (spec, i), object,
4516 overlay, position, bufpos,
4517 replacing_p, frame_window_p)))
4518 {
4519 replacing_p = rv;
4520 /* If some text in a string is replaced, `position' no
4521 longer points to the position of `object'. */
4522 if (!it || STRINGP (object))
4523 break;
4524 }
4525 }
4526 else
4527 {
4528 if ((rv = handle_single_display_spec (it, spec, object, overlay,
4529 position, bufpos, 0,
4530 frame_window_p)))
4531 replacing_p = rv;
4532 }
4533
4534 return replacing_p;
4535 }
4536
4537 /* Value is the position of the end of the `display' property starting
4538 at START_POS in OBJECT. */
4539
4540 static struct text_pos
4541 display_prop_end (struct it *it, Lisp_Object object, struct text_pos start_pos)
4542 {
4543 Lisp_Object end;
4544 struct text_pos end_pos;
4545
4546 end = Fnext_single_char_property_change (make_number (CHARPOS (start_pos)),
4547 Qdisplay, object, Qnil);
4548 CHARPOS (end_pos) = XFASTINT (end);
4549 if (STRINGP (object))
4550 compute_string_pos (&end_pos, start_pos, it->string);
4551 else
4552 BYTEPOS (end_pos) = CHAR_TO_BYTE (XFASTINT (end));
4553
4554 return end_pos;
4555 }
4556
4557
4558 /* Set up IT from a single `display' property specification SPEC. OBJECT
4559 is the object in which the `display' property was found. *POSITION
4560 is the position in OBJECT at which the `display' property was found.
4561 BUFPOS is the buffer position of OBJECT (different from POSITION if
4562 OBJECT is not a buffer). DISPLAY_REPLACED_P non-zero means that we
4563 previously saw a display specification which already replaced text
4564 display with something else, for example an image; we ignore such
4565 properties after the first one has been processed.
4566
4567 OVERLAY is the overlay this `display' property came from,
4568 or nil if it was a text property.
4569
4570 If SPEC is a `space' or `image' specification, and in some other
4571 cases too, set *POSITION to the position where the `display'
4572 property ends.
4573
4574 If IT is NULL, only examine the property specification in SPEC, but
4575 don't set up IT. In that case, FRAME_WINDOW_P non-zero means SPEC
4576 is intended to be displayed in a window on a GUI frame.
4577
4578 Value is non-zero if something was found which replaces the display
4579 of buffer or string text. */
4580
4581 static int
4582 handle_single_display_spec (struct it *it, Lisp_Object spec, Lisp_Object object,
4583 Lisp_Object overlay, struct text_pos *position,
4584 ptrdiff_t bufpos, int display_replaced_p,
4585 int frame_window_p)
4586 {
4587 Lisp_Object form;
4588 Lisp_Object location, value;
4589 struct text_pos start_pos = *position;
4590 int valid_p;
4591
4592 /* If SPEC is a list of the form `(when FORM . VALUE)', evaluate FORM.
4593 If the result is non-nil, use VALUE instead of SPEC. */
4594 form = Qt;
4595 if (CONSP (spec) && EQ (XCAR (spec), Qwhen))
4596 {
4597 spec = XCDR (spec);
4598 if (!CONSP (spec))
4599 return 0;
4600 form = XCAR (spec);
4601 spec = XCDR (spec);
4602 }
4603
4604 if (!NILP (form) && !EQ (form, Qt))
4605 {
4606 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
4607 struct gcpro gcpro1;
4608
4609 /* Bind `object' to the object having the `display' property, a
4610 buffer or string. Bind `position' to the position in the
4611 object where the property was found, and `buffer-position'
4612 to the current position in the buffer. */
4613
4614 if (NILP (object))
4615 XSETBUFFER (object, current_buffer);
4616 specbind (Qobject, object);
4617 specbind (Qposition, make_number (CHARPOS (*position)));
4618 specbind (Qbuffer_position, make_number (bufpos));
4619 GCPRO1 (form);
4620 form = safe_eval (form);
4621 UNGCPRO;
4622 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
4623 }
4624
4625 if (NILP (form))
4626 return 0;
4627
4628 /* Handle `(height HEIGHT)' specifications. */
4629 if (CONSP (spec)
4630 && EQ (XCAR (spec), Qheight)
4631 && CONSP (XCDR (spec)))
4632 {
4633 if (it)
4634 {
4635 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
4636 return 0;
4637
4638 it->font_height = XCAR (XCDR (spec));
4639 if (!NILP (it->font_height))
4640 {
4641 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
4642 int new_height = -1;
4643
4644 if (CONSP (it->font_height)
4645 && (EQ (XCAR (it->font_height), Qplus)
4646 || EQ (XCAR (it->font_height), Qminus))
4647 && CONSP (XCDR (it->font_height))
4648 && RANGED_INTEGERP (0, XCAR (XCDR (it->font_height)), INT_MAX))
4649 {
4650 /* `(+ N)' or `(- N)' where N is an integer. */
4651 int steps = XINT (XCAR (XCDR (it->font_height)));
4652 if (EQ (XCAR (it->font_height), Qplus))
4653 steps = - steps;
4654 it->face_id = smaller_face (it->f, it->face_id, steps);
4655 }
4656 else if (FUNCTIONP (it->font_height))
4657 {
4658 /* Call function with current height as argument.
4659 Value is the new height. */
4660 Lisp_Object height;
4661 height = safe_call1 (it->font_height,
4662 face->lface[LFACE_HEIGHT_INDEX]);
4663 if (NUMBERP (height))
4664 new_height = XFLOATINT (height);
4665 }
4666 else if (NUMBERP (it->font_height))
4667 {
4668 /* Value is a multiple of the canonical char height. */
4669 struct face *f;
4670
4671 f = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f,
4672 lookup_basic_face (it->f, DEFAULT_FACE_ID));
4673 new_height = (XFLOATINT (it->font_height)
4674 * XINT (f->lface[LFACE_HEIGHT_INDEX]));
4675 }
4676 else
4677 {
4678 /* Evaluate IT->font_height with `height' bound to the
4679 current specified height to get the new height. */
4680 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
4681
4682 specbind (Qheight, face->lface[LFACE_HEIGHT_INDEX]);
4683 value = safe_eval (it->font_height);
4684 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
4685
4686 if (NUMBERP (value))
4687 new_height = XFLOATINT (value);
4688 }
4689
4690 if (new_height > 0)
4691 it->face_id = face_with_height (it->f, it->face_id, new_height);
4692 }
4693 }
4694
4695 return 0;
4696 }
4697
4698 /* Handle `(space-width WIDTH)'. */
4699 if (CONSP (spec)
4700 && EQ (XCAR (spec), Qspace_width)
4701 && CONSP (XCDR (spec)))
4702 {
4703 if (it)
4704 {
4705 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
4706 return 0;
4707
4708 value = XCAR (XCDR (spec));
4709 if (NUMBERP (value) && XFLOATINT (value) > 0)
4710 it->space_width = value;
4711 }
4712
4713 return 0;
4714 }
4715
4716 /* Handle `(slice X Y WIDTH HEIGHT)'. */
4717 if (CONSP (spec)
4718 && EQ (XCAR (spec), Qslice))
4719 {
4720 Lisp_Object tem;
4721
4722 if (it)
4723 {
4724 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
4725 return 0;
4726
4727 if (tem = XCDR (spec), CONSP (tem))
4728 {
4729 it->slice.x = XCAR (tem);
4730 if (tem = XCDR (tem), CONSP (tem))
4731 {
4732 it->slice.y = XCAR (tem);
4733 if (tem = XCDR (tem), CONSP (tem))
4734 {
4735 it->slice.width = XCAR (tem);
4736 if (tem = XCDR (tem), CONSP (tem))
4737 it->slice.height = XCAR (tem);
4738 }
4739 }
4740 }
4741 }
4742
4743 return 0;
4744 }
4745
4746 /* Handle `(raise FACTOR)'. */
4747 if (CONSP (spec)
4748 && EQ (XCAR (spec), Qraise)
4749 && CONSP (XCDR (spec)))
4750 {
4751 if (it)
4752 {
4753 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
4754 return 0;
4755
4756 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
4757 value = XCAR (XCDR (spec));
4758 if (NUMBERP (value))
4759 {
4760 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
4761 it->voffset = - (XFLOATINT (value)
4762 * (FONT_HEIGHT (face->font)));
4763 }
4764 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
4765 }
4766
4767 return 0;
4768 }
4769
4770 /* Don't handle the other kinds of display specifications
4771 inside a string that we got from a `display' property. */
4772 if (it && it->string_from_display_prop_p)
4773 return 0;
4774
4775 /* Characters having this form of property are not displayed, so
4776 we have to find the end of the property. */
4777 if (it)
4778 {
4779 start_pos = *position;
4780 *position = display_prop_end (it, object, start_pos);
4781 }
4782 value = Qnil;
4783
4784 /* Stop the scan at that end position--we assume that all
4785 text properties change there. */
4786 if (it)
4787 it->stop_charpos = position->charpos;
4788
4789 /* Handle `(left-fringe BITMAP [FACE])'
4790 and `(right-fringe BITMAP [FACE])'. */
4791 if (CONSP (spec)
4792 && (EQ (XCAR (spec), Qleft_fringe)
4793 || EQ (XCAR (spec), Qright_fringe))
4794 && CONSP (XCDR (spec)))
4795 {
4796 int fringe_bitmap;
4797
4798 if (it)
4799 {
4800 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
4801 /* If we return here, POSITION has been advanced
4802 across the text with this property. */
4803 {
4804 /* Synchronize the bidi iterator with POSITION. This is
4805 needed because we are not going to push the iterator
4806 on behalf of this display property, so there will be
4807 no pop_it call to do this synchronization for us. */
4808 if (it->bidi_p)
4809 {
4810 it->position = *position;
4811 iterate_out_of_display_property (it);
4812 *position = it->position;
4813 }
4814 return 1;
4815 }
4816 }
4817 else if (!frame_window_p)
4818 return 1;
4819
4820 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
4821 value = XCAR (XCDR (spec));
4822 if (!SYMBOLP (value)
4823 || !(fringe_bitmap = lookup_fringe_bitmap (value)))
4824 /* If we return here, POSITION has been advanced
4825 across the text with this property. */
4826 {
4827 if (it && it->bidi_p)
4828 {
4829 it->position = *position;
4830 iterate_out_of_display_property (it);
4831 *position = it->position;
4832 }
4833 return 1;
4834 }
4835
4836 if (it)
4837 {
4838 int face_id = lookup_basic_face (it->f, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);;
4839
4840 if (CONSP (XCDR (XCDR (spec))))
4841 {
4842 Lisp_Object face_name = XCAR (XCDR (XCDR (spec)));
4843 int face_id2 = lookup_derived_face (it->f, face_name,
4844 FRINGE_FACE_ID, 0);
4845 if (face_id2 >= 0)
4846 face_id = face_id2;
4847 }
4848
4849 /* Save current settings of IT so that we can restore them
4850 when we are finished with the glyph property value. */
4851 push_it (it, position);
4852
4853 it->area = TEXT_AREA;
4854 it->what = IT_IMAGE;
4855 it->image_id = -1; /* no image */
4856 it->position = start_pos;
4857 it->object = NILP (object) ? it->w->buffer : object;
4858 it->method = GET_FROM_IMAGE;
4859 it->from_overlay = Qnil;
4860 it->face_id = face_id;
4861 it->from_disp_prop_p = 1;
4862
4863 /* Say that we haven't consumed the characters with
4864 `display' property yet. The call to pop_it in
4865 set_iterator_to_next will clean this up. */
4866 *position = start_pos;
4867
4868 if (EQ (XCAR (spec), Qleft_fringe))
4869 {
4870 it->left_user_fringe_bitmap = fringe_bitmap;
4871 it->left_user_fringe_face_id = face_id;
4872 }
4873 else
4874 {
4875 it->right_user_fringe_bitmap = fringe_bitmap;
4876 it->right_user_fringe_face_id = face_id;
4877 }
4878 }
4879 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
4880 return 1;
4881 }
4882
4883 /* Prepare to handle `((margin left-margin) ...)',
4884 `((margin right-margin) ...)' and `((margin nil) ...)'
4885 prefixes for display specifications. */
4886 location = Qunbound;
4887 if (CONSP (spec) && CONSP (XCAR (spec)))
4888 {
4889 Lisp_Object tem;
4890
4891 value = XCDR (spec);
4892 if (CONSP (value))
4893 value = XCAR (value);
4894
4895 tem = XCAR (spec);
4896 if (EQ (XCAR (tem), Qmargin)
4897 && (tem = XCDR (tem),
4898 tem = CONSP (tem) ? XCAR (tem) : Qnil,
4899 (NILP (tem)
4900 || EQ (tem, Qleft_margin)
4901 || EQ (tem, Qright_margin))))
4902 location = tem;
4903 }
4904
4905 if (EQ (location, Qunbound))
4906 {
4907 location = Qnil;
4908 value = spec;
4909 }
4910
4911 /* After this point, VALUE is the property after any
4912 margin prefix has been stripped. It must be a string,
4913 an image specification, or `(space ...)'.
4914
4915 LOCATION specifies where to display: `left-margin',
4916 `right-margin' or nil. */
4917
4918 valid_p = (STRINGP (value)
4919 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
4920 || ((it ? FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f) : frame_window_p)
4921 && valid_image_p (value))
4922 #endif /* not HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
4923 || (CONSP (value) && EQ (XCAR (value), Qspace)));
4924
4925 if (valid_p && !display_replaced_p)
4926 {
4927 int retval = 1;
4928
4929 if (!it)
4930 {
4931 /* Callers need to know whether the display spec is any kind
4932 of `(space ...)' spec that is about to affect text-area
4933 display. */
4934 if (CONSP (value) && EQ (XCAR (value), Qspace) && NILP (location))
4935 retval = 2;
4936 return retval;
4937 }
4938
4939 /* Save current settings of IT so that we can restore them
4940 when we are finished with the glyph property value. */
4941 push_it (it, position);
4942 it->from_overlay = overlay;
4943 it->from_disp_prop_p = 1;
4944
4945 if (NILP (location))
4946 it->area = TEXT_AREA;
4947 else if (EQ (location, Qleft_margin))
4948 it->area = LEFT_MARGIN_AREA;
4949 else
4950 it->area = RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA;
4951
4952 if (STRINGP (value))
4953 {
4954 it->string = value;
4955 it->multibyte_p = STRING_MULTIBYTE (it->string);
4956 it->current.overlay_string_index = -1;
4957 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = 0;
4958 it->end_charpos = it->string_nchars = SCHARS (it->string);
4959 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
4960 it->stop_charpos = 0;
4961 it->prev_stop = 0;
4962 it->base_level_stop = 0;
4963 it->string_from_display_prop_p = 1;
4964 /* Say that we haven't consumed the characters with
4965 `display' property yet. The call to pop_it in
4966 set_iterator_to_next will clean this up. */
4967 if (BUFFERP (object))
4968 *position = start_pos;
4969
4970 /* Force paragraph direction to be that of the parent
4971 object. If the parent object's paragraph direction is
4972 not yet determined, default to L2R. */
4973 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L)
4974 it->paragraph_embedding = it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir;
4975 else
4976 it->paragraph_embedding = L2R;
4977
4978 /* Set up the bidi iterator for this display string. */
4979 if (it->bidi_p)
4980 {
4981 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = it->string;
4982 it->bidi_it.string.s = NULL;
4983 it->bidi_it.string.schars = it->end_charpos;
4984 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = bufpos;
4985 it->bidi_it.string.from_disp_str = 1;
4986 it->bidi_it.string.unibyte = !it->multibyte_p;
4987 bidi_init_it (0, 0, FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f), &it->bidi_it);
4988 }
4989 }
4990 else if (CONSP (value) && EQ (XCAR (value), Qspace))
4991 {
4992 it->method = GET_FROM_STRETCH;
4993 it->object = value;
4994 *position = it->position = start_pos;
4995 retval = 1 + (it->area == TEXT_AREA);
4996 }
4997 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
4998 else
4999 {
5000 it->what = IT_IMAGE;
5001 it->image_id = lookup_image (it->f, value);
5002 it->position = start_pos;
5003 it->object = NILP (object) ? it->w->buffer : object;
5004 it->method = GET_FROM_IMAGE;
5005
5006 /* Say that we haven't consumed the characters with
5007 `display' property yet. The call to pop_it in
5008 set_iterator_to_next will clean this up. */
5009 *position = start_pos;
5010 }
5011 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
5012
5013 return retval;
5014 }
5015
5016 /* Invalid property or property not supported. Restore
5017 POSITION to what it was before. */
5018 *position = start_pos;
5019 return 0;
5020 }
5021
5022 /* Check if PROP is a display property value whose text should be
5023 treated as intangible. OVERLAY is the overlay from which PROP
5024 came, or nil if it came from a text property. CHARPOS and BYTEPOS
5025 specify the buffer position covered by PROP. */
5026
5027 int
5028 display_prop_intangible_p (Lisp_Object prop, Lisp_Object overlay,
5029 ptrdiff_t charpos, ptrdiff_t bytepos)
5030 {
5031 int frame_window_p = FRAME_WINDOW_P (XFRAME (selected_frame));
5032 struct text_pos position;
5033
5034 SET_TEXT_POS (position, charpos, bytepos);
5035 return handle_display_spec (NULL, prop, Qnil, overlay,
5036 &position, charpos, frame_window_p);
5037 }
5038
5039
5040 /* Return 1 if PROP is a display sub-property value containing STRING.
5041
5042 Implementation note: this and the following function are really
5043 special cases of handle_display_spec and
5044 handle_single_display_spec, and should ideally use the same code.
5045 Until they do, these two pairs must be consistent and must be
5046 modified in sync. */
5047
5048 static int
5049 single_display_spec_string_p (Lisp_Object prop, Lisp_Object string)
5050 {
5051 if (EQ (string, prop))
5052 return 1;
5053
5054 /* Skip over `when FORM'. */
5055 if (CONSP (prop) && EQ (XCAR (prop), Qwhen))
5056 {
5057 prop = XCDR (prop);
5058 if (!CONSP (prop))
5059 return 0;
5060 /* Actually, the condition following `when' should be eval'ed,
5061 like handle_single_display_spec does, and we should return
5062 zero if it evaluates to nil. However, this function is
5063 called only when the buffer was already displayed and some
5064 glyph in the glyph matrix was found to come from a display
5065 string. Therefore, the condition was already evaluated, and
5066 the result was non-nil, otherwise the display string wouldn't
5067 have been displayed and we would have never been called for
5068 this property. Thus, we can skip the evaluation and assume
5069 its result is non-nil. */
5070 prop = XCDR (prop);
5071 }
5072
5073 if (CONSP (prop))
5074 /* Skip over `margin LOCATION'. */
5075 if (EQ (XCAR (prop), Qmargin))
5076 {
5077 prop = XCDR (prop);
5078 if (!CONSP (prop))
5079 return 0;
5080
5081 prop = XCDR (prop);
5082 if (!CONSP (prop))
5083 return 0;
5084 }
5085
5086 return EQ (prop, string) || (CONSP (prop) && EQ (XCAR (prop), string));
5087 }
5088
5089
5090 /* Return 1 if STRING appears in the `display' property PROP. */
5091
5092 static int
5093 display_prop_string_p (Lisp_Object prop, Lisp_Object string)
5094 {
5095 if (CONSP (prop)
5096 && !EQ (XCAR (prop), Qwhen)
5097 && !(CONSP (XCAR (prop)) && EQ (Qmargin, XCAR (XCAR (prop)))))
5098 {
5099 /* A list of sub-properties. */
5100 while (CONSP (prop))
5101 {
5102 if (single_display_spec_string_p (XCAR (prop), string))
5103 return 1;
5104 prop = XCDR (prop);
5105 }
5106 }
5107 else if (VECTORP (prop))
5108 {
5109 /* A vector of sub-properties. */
5110 ptrdiff_t i;
5111 for (i = 0; i < ASIZE (prop); ++i)
5112 if (single_display_spec_string_p (AREF (prop, i), string))
5113 return 1;
5114 }
5115 else
5116 return single_display_spec_string_p (prop, string);
5117
5118 return 0;
5119 }
5120
5121 /* Look for STRING in overlays and text properties in the current
5122 buffer, between character positions FROM and TO (excluding TO).
5123 BACK_P non-zero means look back (in this case, TO is supposed to be
5124 less than FROM).
5125 Value is the first character position where STRING was found, or
5126 zero if it wasn't found before hitting TO.
5127
5128 This function may only use code that doesn't eval because it is
5129 called asynchronously from note_mouse_highlight. */
5130
5131 static ptrdiff_t
5132 string_buffer_position_lim (Lisp_Object string,
5133 ptrdiff_t from, ptrdiff_t to, int back_p)
5134 {
5135 Lisp_Object limit, prop, pos;
5136 int found = 0;
5137
5138 pos = make_number (max (from, BEGV));
5139
5140 if (!back_p) /* looking forward */
5141 {
5142 limit = make_number (min (to, ZV));
5143 while (!found && !EQ (pos, limit))
5144 {
5145 prop = Fget_char_property (pos, Qdisplay, Qnil);
5146 if (!NILP (prop) && display_prop_string_p (prop, string))
5147 found = 1;
5148 else
5149 pos = Fnext_single_char_property_change (pos, Qdisplay, Qnil,
5150 limit);
5151 }
5152 }
5153 else /* looking back */
5154 {
5155 limit = make_number (max (to, BEGV));
5156 while (!found && !EQ (pos, limit))
5157 {
5158 prop = Fget_char_property (pos, Qdisplay, Qnil);
5159 if (!NILP (prop) && display_prop_string_p (prop, string))
5160 found = 1;
5161 else
5162 pos = Fprevious_single_char_property_change (pos, Qdisplay, Qnil,
5163 limit);
5164 }
5165 }
5166
5167 return found ? XINT (pos) : 0;
5168 }
5169
5170 /* Determine which buffer position in current buffer STRING comes from.
5171 AROUND_CHARPOS is an approximate position where it could come from.
5172 Value is the buffer position or 0 if it couldn't be determined.
5173
5174 This function is necessary because we don't record buffer positions
5175 in glyphs generated from strings (to keep struct glyph small).
5176 This function may only use code that doesn't eval because it is
5177 called asynchronously from note_mouse_highlight. */
5178
5179 static ptrdiff_t
5180 string_buffer_position (Lisp_Object string, ptrdiff_t around_charpos)
5181 {
5182 const int MAX_DISTANCE = 1000;
5183 ptrdiff_t found = string_buffer_position_lim (string, around_charpos,
5184 around_charpos + MAX_DISTANCE,
5185 0);
5186
5187 if (!found)
5188 found = string_buffer_position_lim (string, around_charpos,
5189 around_charpos - MAX_DISTANCE, 1);
5190 return found;
5191 }
5192
5193
5194 \f
5195 /***********************************************************************
5196 `composition' property
5197 ***********************************************************************/
5198
5199 /* Set up iterator IT from `composition' property at its current
5200 position. Called from handle_stop. */
5201
5202 static enum prop_handled
5203 handle_composition_prop (struct it *it)
5204 {
5205 Lisp_Object prop, string;
5206 ptrdiff_t pos, pos_byte, start, end;
5207
5208 if (STRINGP (it->string))
5209 {
5210 unsigned char *s;
5211
5212 pos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it);
5213 pos_byte = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it);
5214 string = it->string;
5215 s = SDATA (string) + pos_byte;
5216 it->c = STRING_CHAR (s);
5217 }
5218 else
5219 {
5220 pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
5221 pos_byte = IT_BYTEPOS (*it);
5222 string = Qnil;
5223 it->c = FETCH_CHAR (pos_byte);
5224 }
5225
5226 /* If there's a valid composition and point is not inside of the
5227 composition (in the case that the composition is from the current
5228 buffer), draw a glyph composed from the composition components. */
5229 if (find_composition (pos, -1, &start, &end, &prop, string)
5230 && COMPOSITION_VALID_P (start, end, prop)
5231 && (STRINGP (it->string) || (PT <= start || PT >= end)))
5232 {
5233 if (start < pos)
5234 /* As we can't handle this situation (perhaps font-lock added
5235 a new composition), we just return here hoping that next
5236 redisplay will detect this composition much earlier. */
5237 return HANDLED_NORMALLY;
5238 if (start != pos)
5239 {
5240 if (STRINGP (it->string))
5241 pos_byte = string_char_to_byte (it->string, start);
5242 else
5243 pos_byte = CHAR_TO_BYTE (start);
5244 }
5245 it->cmp_it.id = get_composition_id (start, pos_byte, end - start,
5246 prop, string);
5247
5248 if (it->cmp_it.id >= 0)
5249 {
5250 it->cmp_it.ch = -1;
5251 it->cmp_it.nchars = COMPOSITION_LENGTH (prop);
5252 it->cmp_it.nglyphs = -1;
5253 }
5254 }
5255
5256 return HANDLED_NORMALLY;
5257 }
5258
5259
5260 \f
5261 /***********************************************************************
5262 Overlay strings
5263 ***********************************************************************/
5264
5265 /* The following structure is used to record overlay strings for
5266 later sorting in load_overlay_strings. */
5267
5268 struct overlay_entry
5269 {
5270 Lisp_Object overlay;
5271 Lisp_Object string;
5272 EMACS_INT priority;
5273 int after_string_p;
5274 };
5275
5276
5277 /* Set up iterator IT from overlay strings at its current position.
5278 Called from handle_stop. */
5279
5280 static enum prop_handled
5281 handle_overlay_change (struct it *it)
5282 {
5283 if (!STRINGP (it->string) && get_overlay_strings (it, 0))
5284 return HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS;
5285 else
5286 return HANDLED_NORMALLY;
5287 }
5288
5289
5290 /* Set up the next overlay string for delivery by IT, if there is an
5291 overlay string to deliver. Called by set_iterator_to_next when the
5292 end of the current overlay string is reached. If there are more
5293 overlay strings to display, IT->string and
5294 IT->current.overlay_string_index are set appropriately here.
5295 Otherwise IT->string is set to nil. */
5296
5297 static void
5298 next_overlay_string (struct it *it)
5299 {
5300 ++it->current.overlay_string_index;
5301 if (it->current.overlay_string_index == it->n_overlay_strings)
5302 {
5303 /* No more overlay strings. Restore IT's settings to what
5304 they were before overlay strings were processed, and
5305 continue to deliver from current_buffer. */
5306
5307 it->ellipsis_p = (it->stack[it->sp - 1].display_ellipsis_p != 0);
5308 pop_it (it);
5309 eassert (it->sp > 0
5310 || (NILP (it->string)
5311 && it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER
5312 && it->stop_charpos >= BEGV
5313 && it->stop_charpos <= it->end_charpos));
5314 it->current.overlay_string_index = -1;
5315 it->n_overlay_strings = 0;
5316 it->overlay_strings_charpos = -1;
5317 /* If there's an empty display string on the stack, pop the
5318 stack, to resync the bidi iterator with IT's position. Such
5319 empty strings are pushed onto the stack in
5320 get_overlay_strings_1. */
5321 if (it->sp > 0 && STRINGP (it->string) && !SCHARS (it->string))
5322 pop_it (it);
5323
5324 /* If we're at the end of the buffer, record that we have
5325 processed the overlay strings there already, so that
5326 next_element_from_buffer doesn't try it again. */
5327 if (NILP (it->string) && IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->end_charpos)
5328 it->overlay_strings_at_end_processed_p = 1;
5329 }
5330 else
5331 {
5332 /* There are more overlay strings to process. If
5333 IT->current.overlay_string_index has advanced to a position
5334 where we must load IT->overlay_strings with more strings, do
5335 it. We must load at the IT->overlay_strings_charpos where
5336 IT->n_overlay_strings was originally computed; when invisible
5337 text is present, this might not be IT_CHARPOS (Bug#7016). */
5338 int i = it->current.overlay_string_index % OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE;
5339
5340 if (it->current.overlay_string_index && i == 0)
5341 load_overlay_strings (it, it->overlay_strings_charpos);
5342
5343 /* Initialize IT to deliver display elements from the overlay
5344 string. */
5345 it->string = it->overlay_strings[i];
5346 it->multibyte_p = STRING_MULTIBYTE (it->string);
5347 SET_TEXT_POS (it->current.string_pos, 0, 0);
5348 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
5349 it->stop_charpos = 0;
5350 if (it->cmp_it.stop_pos >= 0)
5351 it->cmp_it.stop_pos = 0;
5352 it->prev_stop = 0;
5353 it->base_level_stop = 0;
5354
5355 /* Set up the bidi iterator for this overlay string. */
5356 if (it->bidi_p)
5357 {
5358 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = it->string;
5359 it->bidi_it.string.s = NULL;
5360 it->bidi_it.string.schars = SCHARS (it->string);
5361 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = it->overlay_strings_charpos;
5362 it->bidi_it.string.from_disp_str = it->string_from_display_prop_p;
5363 it->bidi_it.string.unibyte = !it->multibyte_p;
5364 bidi_init_it (0, 0, FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f), &it->bidi_it);
5365 }
5366 }
5367
5368 CHECK_IT (it);
5369 }
5370
5371
5372 /* Compare two overlay_entry structures E1 and E2. Used as a
5373 comparison function for qsort in load_overlay_strings. Overlay
5374 strings for the same position are sorted so that
5375
5376 1. All after-strings come in front of before-strings, except
5377 when they come from the same overlay.
5378
5379 2. Within after-strings, strings are sorted so that overlay strings
5380 from overlays with higher priorities come first.
5381
5382 2. Within before-strings, strings are sorted so that overlay
5383 strings from overlays with higher priorities come last.
5384
5385 Value is analogous to strcmp. */
5386
5387
5388 static int
5389 compare_overlay_entries (const void *e1, const void *e2)
5390 {
5391 struct overlay_entry *entry1 = (struct overlay_entry *) e1;
5392 struct overlay_entry *entry2 = (struct overlay_entry *) e2;
5393 int result;
5394
5395 if (entry1->after_string_p != entry2->after_string_p)
5396 {
5397 /* Let after-strings appear in front of before-strings if
5398 they come from different overlays. */
5399 if (EQ (entry1->overlay, entry2->overlay))
5400 result = entry1->after_string_p ? 1 : -1;
5401 else
5402 result = entry1->after_string_p ? -1 : 1;
5403 }
5404 else if (entry1->priority != entry2->priority)
5405 {
5406 if (entry1->after_string_p)
5407 /* After-strings sorted in order of decreasing priority. */
5408 result = entry2->priority < entry1->priority ? -1 : 1;
5409 else
5410 /* Before-strings sorted in order of increasing priority. */
5411 result = entry1->priority < entry2->priority ? -1 : 1;
5412 }
5413 else
5414 result = 0;
5415
5416 return result;
5417 }
5418
5419
5420 /* Load the vector IT->overlay_strings with overlay strings from IT's
5421 current buffer position, or from CHARPOS if that is > 0. Set
5422 IT->n_overlays to the total number of overlay strings found.
5423
5424 Overlay strings are processed OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE strings at
5425 a time. On entry into load_overlay_strings,
5426 IT->current.overlay_string_index gives the number of overlay
5427 strings that have already been loaded by previous calls to this
5428 function.
5429
5430 IT->add_overlay_start contains an additional overlay start
5431 position to consider for taking overlay strings from, if non-zero.
5432 This position comes into play when the overlay has an `invisible'
5433 property, and both before and after-strings. When we've skipped to
5434 the end of the overlay, because of its `invisible' property, we
5435 nevertheless want its before-string to appear.
5436 IT->add_overlay_start will contain the overlay start position
5437 in this case.
5438
5439 Overlay strings are sorted so that after-string strings come in
5440 front of before-string strings. Within before and after-strings,
5441 strings are sorted by overlay priority. See also function
5442 compare_overlay_entries. */
5443
5444 static void
5445 load_overlay_strings (struct it *it, ptrdiff_t charpos)
5446 {
5447 Lisp_Object overlay, window, str, invisible;
5448 struct Lisp_Overlay *ov;
5449 ptrdiff_t start, end;
5450 ptrdiff_t size = 20;
5451 ptrdiff_t n = 0, i, j;
5452 int invis_p;
5453 struct overlay_entry *entries = alloca (size * sizeof *entries);
5454 USE_SAFE_ALLOCA;
5455
5456 if (charpos <= 0)
5457 charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
5458
5459 /* Append the overlay string STRING of overlay OVERLAY to vector
5460 `entries' which has size `size' and currently contains `n'
5461 elements. AFTER_P non-zero means STRING is an after-string of
5462 OVERLAY. */
5463 #define RECORD_OVERLAY_STRING(OVERLAY, STRING, AFTER_P) \
5464 do \
5465 { \
5466 Lisp_Object priority; \
5467 \
5468 if (n == size) \
5469 { \
5470 struct overlay_entry *old = entries; \
5471 SAFE_NALLOCA (entries, 2, size); \
5472 memcpy (entries, old, size * sizeof *entries); \
5473 size *= 2; \
5474 } \
5475 \
5476 entries[n].string = (STRING); \
5477 entries[n].overlay = (OVERLAY); \
5478 priority = Foverlay_get ((OVERLAY), Qpriority); \
5479 entries[n].priority = INTEGERP (priority) ? XINT (priority) : 0; \
5480 entries[n].after_string_p = (AFTER_P); \
5481 ++n; \
5482 } \
5483 while (0)
5484
5485 /* Process overlay before the overlay center. */
5486 for (ov = current_buffer->overlays_before; ov; ov = ov->next)
5487 {
5488 XSETMISC (overlay, ov);
5489 eassert (OVERLAYP (overlay));
5490 start = OVERLAY_POSITION (OVERLAY_START (overlay));
5491 end = OVERLAY_POSITION (OVERLAY_END (overlay));
5492
5493 if (end < charpos)
5494 break;
5495
5496 /* Skip this overlay if it doesn't start or end at IT's current
5497 position. */
5498 if (end != charpos && start != charpos)
5499 continue;
5500
5501 /* Skip this overlay if it doesn't apply to IT->w. */
5502 window = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qwindow);
5503 if (WINDOWP (window) && XWINDOW (window) != it->w)
5504 continue;
5505
5506 /* If the text ``under'' the overlay is invisible, both before-
5507 and after-strings from this overlay are visible; start and
5508 end position are indistinguishable. */
5509 invisible = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qinvisible);
5510 invis_p = TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (invisible);
5511
5512 /* If overlay has a non-empty before-string, record it. */
5513 if ((start == charpos || (end == charpos && invis_p))
5514 && (str = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qbefore_string), STRINGP (str))
5515 && SCHARS (str))
5516 RECORD_OVERLAY_STRING (overlay, str, 0);
5517
5518 /* If overlay has a non-empty after-string, record it. */
5519 if ((end == charpos || (start == charpos && invis_p))
5520 && (str = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qafter_string), STRINGP (str))
5521 && SCHARS (str))
5522 RECORD_OVERLAY_STRING (overlay, str, 1);
5523 }
5524
5525 /* Process overlays after the overlay center. */
5526 for (ov = current_buffer->overlays_after; ov; ov = ov->next)
5527 {
5528 XSETMISC (overlay, ov);
5529 eassert (OVERLAYP (overlay));
5530 start = OVERLAY_POSITION (OVERLAY_START (overlay));
5531 end = OVERLAY_POSITION (OVERLAY_END (overlay));
5532
5533 if (start > charpos)
5534 break;
5535
5536 /* Skip this overlay if it doesn't start or end at IT's current
5537 position. */
5538 if (end != charpos && start != charpos)
5539 continue;
5540
5541 /* Skip this overlay if it doesn't apply to IT->w. */
5542 window = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qwindow);
5543 if (WINDOWP (window) && XWINDOW (window) != it->w)
5544 continue;
5545
5546 /* If the text ``under'' the overlay is invisible, it has a zero
5547 dimension, and both before- and after-strings apply. */
5548 invisible = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qinvisible);
5549 invis_p = TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (invisible);
5550
5551 /* If overlay has a non-empty before-string, record it. */
5552 if ((start == charpos || (end == charpos && invis_p))
5553 && (str = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qbefore_string), STRINGP (str))
5554 && SCHARS (str))
5555 RECORD_OVERLAY_STRING (overlay, str, 0);
5556
5557 /* If overlay has a non-empty after-string, record it. */
5558 if ((end == charpos || (start == charpos && invis_p))
5559 && (str = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qafter_string), STRINGP (str))
5560 && SCHARS (str))
5561 RECORD_OVERLAY_STRING (overlay, str, 1);
5562 }
5563
5564 #undef RECORD_OVERLAY_STRING
5565
5566 /* Sort entries. */
5567 if (n > 1)
5568 qsort (entries, n, sizeof *entries, compare_overlay_entries);
5569
5570 /* Record number of overlay strings, and where we computed it. */
5571 it->n_overlay_strings = n;
5572 it->overlay_strings_charpos = charpos;
5573
5574 /* IT->current.overlay_string_index is the number of overlay strings
5575 that have already been consumed by IT. Copy some of the
5576 remaining overlay strings to IT->overlay_strings. */
5577 i = 0;
5578 j = it->current.overlay_string_index;
5579 while (i < OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE && j < n)
5580 {
5581 it->overlay_strings[i] = entries[j].string;
5582 it->string_overlays[i++] = entries[j++].overlay;
5583 }
5584
5585 CHECK_IT (it);
5586 SAFE_FREE ();
5587 }
5588
5589
5590 /* Get the first chunk of overlay strings at IT's current buffer
5591 position, or at CHARPOS if that is > 0. Value is non-zero if at
5592 least one overlay string was found. */
5593
5594 static int
5595 get_overlay_strings_1 (struct it *it, ptrdiff_t charpos, int compute_stop_p)
5596 {
5597 /* Get the first OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE overlay strings to
5598 process. This fills IT->overlay_strings with strings, and sets
5599 IT->n_overlay_strings to the total number of strings to process.
5600 IT->pos.overlay_string_index has to be set temporarily to zero
5601 because load_overlay_strings needs this; it must be set to -1
5602 when no overlay strings are found because a zero value would
5603 indicate a position in the first overlay string. */
5604 it->current.overlay_string_index = 0;
5605 load_overlay_strings (it, charpos);
5606
5607 /* If we found overlay strings, set up IT to deliver display
5608 elements from the first one. Otherwise set up IT to deliver
5609 from current_buffer. */
5610 if (it->n_overlay_strings)
5611 {
5612 /* Make sure we know settings in current_buffer, so that we can
5613 restore meaningful values when we're done with the overlay
5614 strings. */
5615 if (compute_stop_p)
5616 compute_stop_pos (it);
5617 eassert (it->face_id >= 0);
5618
5619 /* Save IT's settings. They are restored after all overlay
5620 strings have been processed. */
5621 eassert (!compute_stop_p || it->sp == 0);
5622
5623 /* When called from handle_stop, there might be an empty display
5624 string loaded. In that case, don't bother saving it. But
5625 don't use this optimization with the bidi iterator, since we
5626 need the corresponding pop_it call to resync the bidi
5627 iterator's position with IT's position, after we are done
5628 with the overlay strings. (The corresponding call to pop_it
5629 in case of an empty display string is in
5630 next_overlay_string.) */
5631 if (!(!it->bidi_p
5632 && STRINGP (it->string) && !SCHARS (it->string)))
5633 push_it (it, NULL);
5634
5635 /* Set up IT to deliver display elements from the first overlay
5636 string. */
5637 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = 0;
5638 it->string = it->overlay_strings[0];
5639 it->from_overlay = Qnil;
5640 it->stop_charpos = 0;
5641 eassert (STRINGP (it->string));
5642 it->end_charpos = SCHARS (it->string);
5643 it->prev_stop = 0;
5644 it->base_level_stop = 0;
5645 it->multibyte_p = STRING_MULTIBYTE (it->string);
5646 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
5647 it->from_disp_prop_p = 0;
5648
5649 /* Force paragraph direction to be that of the parent
5650 buffer. */
5651 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L)
5652 it->paragraph_embedding = it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir;
5653 else
5654 it->paragraph_embedding = L2R;
5655
5656 /* Set up the bidi iterator for this overlay string. */
5657 if (it->bidi_p)
5658 {
5659 ptrdiff_t pos = (charpos > 0 ? charpos : IT_CHARPOS (*it));
5660
5661 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = it->string;
5662 it->bidi_it.string.s = NULL;
5663 it->bidi_it.string.schars = SCHARS (it->string);
5664 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = pos;
5665 it->bidi_it.string.from_disp_str = it->string_from_display_prop_p;
5666 it->bidi_it.string.unibyte = !it->multibyte_p;
5667 bidi_init_it (0, 0, FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f), &it->bidi_it);
5668 }
5669 return 1;
5670 }
5671
5672 it->current.overlay_string_index = -1;
5673 return 0;
5674 }
5675
5676 static int
5677 get_overlay_strings (struct it *it, ptrdiff_t charpos)
5678 {
5679 it->string = Qnil;
5680 it->method = GET_FROM_BUFFER;
5681
5682 (void) get_overlay_strings_1 (it, charpos, 1);
5683
5684 CHECK_IT (it);
5685
5686 /* Value is non-zero if we found at least one overlay string. */
5687 return STRINGP (it->string);
5688 }
5689
5690
5691 \f
5692 /***********************************************************************
5693 Saving and restoring state
5694 ***********************************************************************/
5695
5696 /* Save current settings of IT on IT->stack. Called, for example,
5697 before setting up IT for an overlay string, to be able to restore
5698 IT's settings to what they were after the overlay string has been
5699 processed. If POSITION is non-NULL, it is the position to save on
5700 the stack instead of IT->position. */
5701
5702 static void
5703 push_it (struct it *it, struct text_pos *position)
5704 {
5705 struct iterator_stack_entry *p;
5706
5707 eassert (it->sp < IT_STACK_SIZE);
5708 p = it->stack + it->sp;
5709
5710 p->stop_charpos = it->stop_charpos;
5711 p->prev_stop = it->prev_stop;
5712 p->base_level_stop = it->base_level_stop;
5713 p->cmp_it = it->cmp_it;
5714 eassert (it->face_id >= 0);
5715 p->face_id = it->face_id;
5716 p->string = it->string;
5717 p->method = it->method;
5718 p->from_overlay = it->from_overlay;
5719 switch (p->method)
5720 {
5721 case GET_FROM_IMAGE:
5722 p->u.image.object = it->object;
5723 p->u.image.image_id = it->image_id;
5724 p->u.image.slice = it->slice;
5725 break;
5726 case GET_FROM_STRETCH:
5727 p->u.stretch.object = it->object;
5728 break;
5729 }
5730 p->position = position ? *position : it->position;
5731 p->current = it->current;
5732 p->end_charpos = it->end_charpos;
5733 p->string_nchars = it->string_nchars;
5734 p->area = it->area;
5735 p->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
5736 p->avoid_cursor_p = it->avoid_cursor_p;
5737 p->space_width = it->space_width;
5738 p->font_height = it->font_height;
5739 p->voffset = it->voffset;
5740 p->string_from_display_prop_p = it->string_from_display_prop_p;
5741 p->string_from_prefix_prop_p = it->string_from_prefix_prop_p;
5742 p->display_ellipsis_p = 0;
5743 p->line_wrap = it->line_wrap;
5744 p->bidi_p = it->bidi_p;
5745 p->paragraph_embedding = it->paragraph_embedding;
5746 p->from_disp_prop_p = it->from_disp_prop_p;
5747 ++it->sp;
5748
5749 /* Save the state of the bidi iterator as well. */
5750 if (it->bidi_p)
5751 bidi_push_it (&it->bidi_it);
5752 }
5753
5754 static void
5755 iterate_out_of_display_property (struct it *it)
5756 {
5757 int buffer_p = !STRINGP (it->string);
5758 ptrdiff_t eob = (buffer_p ? ZV : it->end_charpos);
5759 ptrdiff_t bob = (buffer_p ? BEGV : 0);
5760
5761 eassert (eob >= CHARPOS (it->position) && CHARPOS (it->position) >= bob);
5762
5763 /* Maybe initialize paragraph direction. If we are at the beginning
5764 of a new paragraph, next_element_from_buffer may not have a
5765 chance to do that. */
5766 if (it->bidi_it.first_elt && it->bidi_it.charpos < eob)
5767 bidi_paragraph_init (it->paragraph_embedding, &it->bidi_it, 1);
5768 /* prev_stop can be zero, so check against BEGV as well. */
5769 while (it->bidi_it.charpos >= bob
5770 && it->prev_stop <= it->bidi_it.charpos
5771 && it->bidi_it.charpos < CHARPOS (it->position)
5772 && it->bidi_it.charpos < eob)
5773 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
5774 /* Record the stop_pos we just crossed, for when we cross it
5775 back, maybe. */
5776 if (it->bidi_it.charpos > CHARPOS (it->position))
5777 it->prev_stop = CHARPOS (it->position);
5778 /* If we ended up not where pop_it put us, resync IT's
5779 positional members with the bidi iterator. */
5780 if (it->bidi_it.charpos != CHARPOS (it->position))
5781 SET_TEXT_POS (it->position, it->bidi_it.charpos, it->bidi_it.bytepos);
5782 if (buffer_p)
5783 it->current.pos = it->position;
5784 else
5785 it->current.string_pos = it->position;
5786 }
5787
5788 /* Restore IT's settings from IT->stack. Called, for example, when no
5789 more overlay strings must be processed, and we return to delivering
5790 display elements from a buffer, or when the end of a string from a
5791 `display' property is reached and we return to delivering display
5792 elements from an overlay string, or from a buffer. */
5793
5794 static void
5795 pop_it (struct it *it)
5796 {
5797 struct iterator_stack_entry *p;
5798 int from_display_prop = it->from_disp_prop_p;
5799
5800 eassert (it->sp > 0);
5801 --it->sp;
5802 p = it->stack + it->sp;
5803 it->stop_charpos = p->stop_charpos;
5804 it->prev_stop = p->prev_stop;
5805 it->base_level_stop = p->base_level_stop;
5806 it->cmp_it = p->cmp_it;
5807 it->face_id = p->face_id;
5808 it->current = p->current;
5809 it->position = p->position;
5810 it->string = p->string;
5811 it->from_overlay = p->from_overlay;
5812 if (NILP (it->string))
5813 SET_TEXT_POS (it->current.string_pos, -1, -1);
5814 it->method = p->method;
5815 switch (it->method)
5816 {
5817 case GET_FROM_IMAGE:
5818 it->image_id = p->u.image.image_id;
5819 it->object = p->u.image.object;
5820 it->slice = p->u.image.slice;
5821 break;
5822 case GET_FROM_STRETCH:
5823 it->object = p->u.stretch.object;
5824 break;
5825 case GET_FROM_BUFFER:
5826 it->object = it->w->buffer;
5827 break;
5828 case GET_FROM_STRING:
5829 it->object = it->string;
5830 break;
5831 case GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR:
5832 if (it->s)
5833 it->method = GET_FROM_C_STRING;
5834 else if (STRINGP (it->string))
5835 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
5836 else
5837 {
5838 it->method = GET_FROM_BUFFER;
5839 it->object = it->w->buffer;
5840 }
5841 }
5842 it->end_charpos = p->end_charpos;
5843 it->string_nchars = p->string_nchars;
5844 it->area = p->area;
5845 it->multibyte_p = p->multibyte_p;
5846 it->avoid_cursor_p = p->avoid_cursor_p;
5847 it->space_width = p->space_width;
5848 it->font_height = p->font_height;
5849 it->voffset = p->voffset;
5850 it->string_from_display_prop_p = p->string_from_display_prop_p;
5851 it->string_from_prefix_prop_p = p->string_from_prefix_prop_p;
5852 it->line_wrap = p->line_wrap;
5853 it->bidi_p = p->bidi_p;
5854 it->paragraph_embedding = p->paragraph_embedding;
5855 it->from_disp_prop_p = p->from_disp_prop_p;
5856 if (it->bidi_p)
5857 {
5858 bidi_pop_it (&it->bidi_it);
5859 /* Bidi-iterate until we get out of the portion of text, if any,
5860 covered by a `display' text property or by an overlay with
5861 `display' property. (We cannot just jump there, because the
5862 internal coherency of the bidi iterator state can not be
5863 preserved across such jumps.) We also must determine the
5864 paragraph base direction if the overlay we just processed is
5865 at the beginning of a new paragraph. */
5866 if (from_display_prop
5867 && (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER || it->method == GET_FROM_STRING))
5868 iterate_out_of_display_property (it);
5869
5870 eassert ((BUFFERP (it->object)
5871 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) == it->bidi_it.charpos
5872 && IT_BYTEPOS (*it) == it->bidi_it.bytepos)
5873 || (STRINGP (it->object)
5874 && IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) == it->bidi_it.charpos
5875 && IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) == it->bidi_it.bytepos)
5876 || (CONSP (it->object) && it->method == GET_FROM_STRETCH));
5877 }
5878 }
5879
5880
5881 \f
5882 /***********************************************************************
5883 Moving over lines
5884 ***********************************************************************/
5885
5886 /* Set IT's current position to the previous line start. */
5887
5888 static void
5889 back_to_previous_line_start (struct it *it)
5890 {
5891 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = find_next_newline_no_quit (IT_CHARPOS (*it) - 1, -1);
5892 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = CHAR_TO_BYTE (IT_CHARPOS (*it));
5893 }
5894
5895
5896 /* Move IT to the next line start.
5897
5898 Value is non-zero if a newline was found. Set *SKIPPED_P to 1 if
5899 we skipped over part of the text (as opposed to moving the iterator
5900 continuously over the text). Otherwise, don't change the value
5901 of *SKIPPED_P.
5902
5903 If BIDI_IT_PREV is non-NULL, store into it the state of the bidi
5904 iterator on the newline, if it was found.
5905
5906 Newlines may come from buffer text, overlay strings, or strings
5907 displayed via the `display' property. That's the reason we can't
5908 simply use find_next_newline_no_quit.
5909
5910 Note that this function may not skip over invisible text that is so
5911 because of text properties and immediately follows a newline. If
5912 it would, function reseat_at_next_visible_line_start, when called
5913 from set_iterator_to_next, would effectively make invisible
5914 characters following a newline part of the wrong glyph row, which
5915 leads to wrong cursor motion. */
5916
5917 static int
5918 forward_to_next_line_start (struct it *it, int *skipped_p,
5919 struct bidi_it *bidi_it_prev)
5920 {
5921 ptrdiff_t old_selective;
5922 int newline_found_p, n;
5923 const int MAX_NEWLINE_DISTANCE = 500;
5924
5925 /* If already on a newline, just consume it to avoid unintended
5926 skipping over invisible text below. */
5927 if (it->what == IT_CHARACTER
5928 && it->c == '\n'
5929 && CHARPOS (it->position) == IT_CHARPOS (*it))
5930 {
5931 if (it->bidi_p && bidi_it_prev)
5932 *bidi_it_prev = it->bidi_it;
5933 set_iterator_to_next (it, 0);
5934 it->c = 0;
5935 return 1;
5936 }
5937
5938 /* Don't handle selective display in the following. It's (a)
5939 unnecessary because it's done by the caller, and (b) leads to an
5940 infinite recursion because next_element_from_ellipsis indirectly
5941 calls this function. */
5942 old_selective = it->selective;
5943 it->selective = 0;
5944
5945 /* Scan for a newline within MAX_NEWLINE_DISTANCE display elements
5946 from buffer text. */
5947 for (n = newline_found_p = 0;
5948 !newline_found_p && n < MAX_NEWLINE_DISTANCE;
5949 n += STRINGP (it->string) ? 0 : 1)
5950 {
5951 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
5952 return 0;
5953 newline_found_p = it->what == IT_CHARACTER && it->c == '\n';
5954 if (newline_found_p && it->bidi_p && bidi_it_prev)
5955 *bidi_it_prev = it->bidi_it;
5956 set_iterator_to_next (it, 0);
5957 }
5958
5959 /* If we didn't find a newline near enough, see if we can use a
5960 short-cut. */
5961 if (!newline_found_p)
5962 {
5963 ptrdiff_t start = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
5964 ptrdiff_t limit = find_next_newline_no_quit (start, 1);
5965 Lisp_Object pos;
5966
5967 eassert (!STRINGP (it->string));
5968
5969 /* If there isn't any `display' property in sight, and no
5970 overlays, we can just use the position of the newline in
5971 buffer text. */
5972 if (it->stop_charpos >= limit
5973 || ((pos = Fnext_single_property_change (make_number (start),
5974 Qdisplay, Qnil,
5975 make_number (limit)),
5976 NILP (pos))
5977 && next_overlay_change (start) == ZV))
5978 {
5979 if (!it->bidi_p)
5980 {
5981 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = limit;
5982 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = CHAR_TO_BYTE (limit);
5983 }
5984 else
5985 {
5986 struct bidi_it bprev;
5987
5988 /* Help bidi.c avoid expensive searches for display
5989 properties and overlays, by telling it that there are
5990 none up to `limit'. */
5991 if (it->bidi_it.disp_pos < limit)
5992 {
5993 it->bidi_it.disp_pos = limit;
5994 it->bidi_it.disp_prop = 0;
5995 }
5996 do {
5997 bprev = it->bidi_it;
5998 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
5999 } while (it->bidi_it.charpos != limit);
6000 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = limit;
6001 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
6002 if (bidi_it_prev)
6003 *bidi_it_prev = bprev;
6004 }
6005 *skipped_p = newline_found_p = 1;
6006 }
6007 else
6008 {
6009 while (get_next_display_element (it)
6010 && !newline_found_p)
6011 {
6012 newline_found_p = ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it);
6013 if (newline_found_p && it->bidi_p && bidi_it_prev)
6014 *bidi_it_prev = it->bidi_it;
6015 set_iterator_to_next (it, 0);
6016 }
6017 }
6018 }
6019
6020 it->selective = old_selective;
6021 return newline_found_p;
6022 }
6023
6024
6025 /* Set IT's current position to the previous visible line start. Skip
6026 invisible text that is so either due to text properties or due to
6027 selective display. Caution: this does not change IT->current_x and
6028 IT->hpos. */
6029
6030 static void
6031 back_to_previous_visible_line_start (struct it *it)
6032 {
6033 while (IT_CHARPOS (*it) > BEGV)
6034 {
6035 back_to_previous_line_start (it);
6036
6037 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) <= BEGV)
6038 break;
6039
6040 /* If selective > 0, then lines indented more than its value are
6041 invisible. */
6042 if (it->selective > 0
6043 && indented_beyond_p (IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it),
6044 it->selective))
6045 continue;
6046
6047 /* Check the newline before point for invisibility. */
6048 {
6049 Lisp_Object prop;
6050 prop = Fget_char_property (make_number (IT_CHARPOS (*it) - 1),
6051 Qinvisible, it->window);
6052 if (TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (prop))
6053 continue;
6054 }
6055
6056 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) <= BEGV)
6057 break;
6058
6059 {
6060 struct it it2;
6061 void *it2data = NULL;
6062 ptrdiff_t pos;
6063 ptrdiff_t beg, end;
6064 Lisp_Object val, overlay;
6065
6066 SAVE_IT (it2, *it, it2data);
6067
6068 /* If newline is part of a composition, continue from start of composition */
6069 if (find_composition (IT_CHARPOS (*it), -1, &beg, &end, &val, Qnil)
6070 && beg < IT_CHARPOS (*it))
6071 goto replaced;
6072
6073 /* If newline is replaced by a display property, find start of overlay
6074 or interval and continue search from that point. */
6075 pos = --IT_CHARPOS (it2);
6076 --IT_BYTEPOS (it2);
6077 it2.sp = 0;
6078 bidi_unshelve_cache (NULL, 0);
6079 it2.string_from_display_prop_p = 0;
6080 it2.from_disp_prop_p = 0;
6081 if (handle_display_prop (&it2) == HANDLED_RETURN
6082 && !NILP (val = get_char_property_and_overlay
6083 (make_number (pos), Qdisplay, Qnil, &overlay))
6084 && (OVERLAYP (overlay)
6085 ? (beg = OVERLAY_POSITION (OVERLAY_START (overlay)))
6086 : get_property_and_range (pos, Qdisplay, &val, &beg, &end, Qnil)))
6087 {
6088 RESTORE_IT (it, it, it2data);
6089 goto replaced;
6090 }
6091
6092 /* Newline is not replaced by anything -- so we are done. */
6093 RESTORE_IT (it, it, it2data);
6094 break;
6095
6096 replaced:
6097 if (beg < BEGV)
6098 beg = BEGV;
6099 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = beg;
6100 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = buf_charpos_to_bytepos (current_buffer, beg);
6101 }
6102 }
6103
6104 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
6105
6106 eassert (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= BEGV);
6107 eassert (IT_CHARPOS (*it) == BEGV
6108 || FETCH_BYTE (IT_BYTEPOS (*it) - 1) == '\n');
6109 CHECK_IT (it);
6110 }
6111
6112
6113 /* Reseat iterator IT at the previous visible line start. Skip
6114 invisible text that is so either due to text properties or due to
6115 selective display. At the end, update IT's overlay information,
6116 face information etc. */
6117
6118 void
6119 reseat_at_previous_visible_line_start (struct it *it)
6120 {
6121 back_to_previous_visible_line_start (it);
6122 reseat (it, it->current.pos, 1);
6123 CHECK_IT (it);
6124 }
6125
6126
6127 /* Reseat iterator IT on the next visible line start in the current
6128 buffer. ON_NEWLINE_P non-zero means position IT on the newline
6129 preceding the line start. Skip over invisible text that is so
6130 because of selective display. Compute faces, overlays etc at the
6131 new position. Note that this function does not skip over text that
6132 is invisible because of text properties. */
6133
6134 static void
6135 reseat_at_next_visible_line_start (struct it *it, int on_newline_p)
6136 {
6137 int newline_found_p, skipped_p = 0;
6138 struct bidi_it bidi_it_prev;
6139
6140 newline_found_p = forward_to_next_line_start (it, &skipped_p, &bidi_it_prev);
6141
6142 /* Skip over lines that are invisible because they are indented
6143 more than the value of IT->selective. */
6144 if (it->selective > 0)
6145 while (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < ZV
6146 && indented_beyond_p (IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it),
6147 it->selective))
6148 {
6149 eassert (IT_BYTEPOS (*it) == BEGV
6150 || FETCH_BYTE (IT_BYTEPOS (*it) - 1) == '\n');
6151 newline_found_p =
6152 forward_to_next_line_start (it, &skipped_p, &bidi_it_prev);
6153 }
6154
6155 /* Position on the newline if that's what's requested. */
6156 if (on_newline_p && newline_found_p)
6157 {
6158 if (STRINGP (it->string))
6159 {
6160 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) > 0)
6161 {
6162 if (!it->bidi_p)
6163 {
6164 --IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it);
6165 --IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it);
6166 }
6167 else
6168 {
6169 /* We need to restore the bidi iterator to the state
6170 it had on the newline, and resync the IT's
6171 position with that. */
6172 it->bidi_it = bidi_it_prev;
6173 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
6174 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
6175 }
6176 }
6177 }
6178 else if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) > BEGV)
6179 {
6180 if (!it->bidi_p)
6181 {
6182 --IT_CHARPOS (*it);
6183 --IT_BYTEPOS (*it);
6184 }
6185 else
6186 {
6187 /* We need to restore the bidi iterator to the state it
6188 had on the newline and resync IT with that. */
6189 it->bidi_it = bidi_it_prev;
6190 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
6191 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
6192 }
6193 reseat (it, it->current.pos, 0);
6194 }
6195 }
6196 else if (skipped_p)
6197 reseat (it, it->current.pos, 0);
6198
6199 CHECK_IT (it);
6200 }
6201
6202
6203 \f
6204 /***********************************************************************
6205 Changing an iterator's position
6206 ***********************************************************************/
6207
6208 /* Change IT's current position to POS in current_buffer. If FORCE_P
6209 is non-zero, always check for text properties at the new position.
6210 Otherwise, text properties are only looked up if POS >=
6211 IT->check_charpos of a property. */
6212
6213 static void
6214 reseat (struct it *it, struct text_pos pos, int force_p)
6215 {
6216 ptrdiff_t original_pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
6217
6218 reseat_1 (it, pos, 0);
6219
6220 /* Determine where to check text properties. Avoid doing it
6221 where possible because text property lookup is very expensive. */
6222 if (force_p
6223 || CHARPOS (pos) > it->stop_charpos
6224 || CHARPOS (pos) < original_pos)
6225 {
6226 if (it->bidi_p)
6227 {
6228 /* For bidi iteration, we need to prime prev_stop and
6229 base_level_stop with our best estimations. */
6230 /* Implementation note: Of course, POS is not necessarily a
6231 stop position, so assigning prev_pos to it is a lie; we
6232 should have called compute_stop_backwards. However, if
6233 the current buffer does not include any R2L characters,
6234 that call would be a waste of cycles, because the
6235 iterator will never move back, and thus never cross this
6236 "fake" stop position. So we delay that backward search
6237 until the time we really need it, in next_element_from_buffer. */
6238 if (CHARPOS (pos) != it->prev_stop)
6239 it->prev_stop = CHARPOS (pos);
6240 if (CHARPOS (pos) < it->base_level_stop)
6241 it->base_level_stop = 0; /* meaning it's unknown */
6242 handle_stop (it);
6243 }
6244 else
6245 {
6246 handle_stop (it);
6247 it->prev_stop = it->base_level_stop = 0;
6248 }
6249
6250 }
6251
6252 CHECK_IT (it);
6253 }
6254
6255
6256 /* Change IT's buffer position to POS. SET_STOP_P non-zero means set
6257 IT->stop_pos to POS, also. */
6258
6259 static void
6260 reseat_1 (struct it *it, struct text_pos pos, int set_stop_p)
6261 {
6262 /* Don't call this function when scanning a C string. */
6263 eassert (it->s == NULL);
6264
6265 /* POS must be a reasonable value. */
6266 eassert (CHARPOS (pos) >= BEGV && CHARPOS (pos) <= ZV);
6267
6268 it->current.pos = it->position = pos;
6269 it->end_charpos = ZV;
6270 it->dpvec = NULL;
6271 it->current.dpvec_index = -1;
6272 it->current.overlay_string_index = -1;
6273 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = -1;
6274 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = -1;
6275 it->string = Qnil;
6276 it->method = GET_FROM_BUFFER;
6277 it->object = it->w->buffer;
6278 it->area = TEXT_AREA;
6279 it->multibyte_p = !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters));
6280 it->sp = 0;
6281 it->string_from_display_prop_p = 0;
6282 it->string_from_prefix_prop_p = 0;
6283
6284 it->from_disp_prop_p = 0;
6285 it->face_before_selective_p = 0;
6286 if (it->bidi_p)
6287 {
6288 bidi_init_it (IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it), FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f),
6289 &it->bidi_it);
6290 bidi_unshelve_cache (NULL, 0);
6291 it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir = NEUTRAL_DIR;
6292 it->bidi_it.string.s = NULL;
6293 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = Qnil;
6294 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = 0;
6295 it->bidi_it.string.unibyte = 0;
6296 }
6297
6298 if (set_stop_p)
6299 {
6300 it->stop_charpos = CHARPOS (pos);
6301 it->base_level_stop = CHARPOS (pos);
6302 }
6303 }
6304
6305
6306 /* Set up IT for displaying a string, starting at CHARPOS in window W.
6307 If S is non-null, it is a C string to iterate over. Otherwise,
6308 STRING gives a Lisp string to iterate over.
6309
6310 If PRECISION > 0, don't return more then PRECISION number of
6311 characters from the string.
6312
6313 If FIELD_WIDTH > 0, return padding spaces until FIELD_WIDTH
6314 characters have been returned. FIELD_WIDTH < 0 means an infinite
6315 field width.
6316
6317 MULTIBYTE = 0 means disable processing of multibyte characters,
6318 MULTIBYTE > 0 means enable it,
6319 MULTIBYTE < 0 means use IT->multibyte_p.
6320
6321 IT must be initialized via a prior call to init_iterator before
6322 calling this function. */
6323
6324 static void
6325 reseat_to_string (struct it *it, const char *s, Lisp_Object string,
6326 ptrdiff_t charpos, ptrdiff_t precision, int field_width,
6327 int multibyte)
6328 {
6329 /* No region in strings. */
6330 it->region_beg_charpos = it->region_end_charpos = -1;
6331
6332 /* No text property checks performed by default, but see below. */
6333 it->stop_charpos = -1;
6334
6335 /* Set iterator position and end position. */
6336 memset (&it->current, 0, sizeof it->current);
6337 it->current.overlay_string_index = -1;
6338 it->current.dpvec_index = -1;
6339 eassert (charpos >= 0);
6340
6341 /* If STRING is specified, use its multibyteness, otherwise use the
6342 setting of MULTIBYTE, if specified. */
6343 if (multibyte >= 0)
6344 it->multibyte_p = multibyte > 0;
6345
6346 /* Bidirectional reordering of strings is controlled by the default
6347 value of bidi-display-reordering. Don't try to reorder while
6348 loading loadup.el, as the necessary character property tables are
6349 not yet available. */
6350 it->bidi_p =
6351 NILP (Vpurify_flag)
6352 && !NILP (BVAR (&buffer_defaults, bidi_display_reordering));
6353
6354 if (s == NULL)
6355 {
6356 eassert (STRINGP (string));
6357 it->string = string;
6358 it->s = NULL;
6359 it->end_charpos = it->string_nchars = SCHARS (string);
6360 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
6361 it->current.string_pos = string_pos (charpos, string);
6362
6363 if (it->bidi_p)
6364 {
6365 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = string;
6366 it->bidi_it.string.s = NULL;
6367 it->bidi_it.string.schars = it->end_charpos;
6368 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = 0;
6369 it->bidi_it.string.from_disp_str = 0;
6370 it->bidi_it.string.unibyte = !it->multibyte_p;
6371 bidi_init_it (charpos, IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it),
6372 FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f), &it->bidi_it);
6373 }
6374 }
6375 else
6376 {
6377 it->s = (const unsigned char *) s;
6378 it->string = Qnil;
6379
6380 /* Note that we use IT->current.pos, not it->current.string_pos,
6381 for displaying C strings. */
6382 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = -1;
6383 if (it->multibyte_p)
6384 {
6385 it->current.pos = c_string_pos (charpos, s, 1);
6386 it->end_charpos = it->string_nchars = number_of_chars (s, 1);
6387 }
6388 else
6389 {
6390 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = charpos;
6391 it->end_charpos = it->string_nchars = strlen (s);
6392 }
6393
6394 if (it->bidi_p)
6395 {
6396 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = Qnil;
6397 it->bidi_it.string.s = (const unsigned char *) s;
6398 it->bidi_it.string.schars = it->end_charpos;
6399 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = 0;
6400 it->bidi_it.string.from_disp_str = 0;
6401 it->bidi_it.string.unibyte = !it->multibyte_p;
6402 bidi_init_it (charpos, IT_BYTEPOS (*it), FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f),
6403 &it->bidi_it);
6404 }
6405 it->method = GET_FROM_C_STRING;
6406 }
6407
6408 /* PRECISION > 0 means don't return more than PRECISION characters
6409 from the string. */
6410 if (precision > 0 && it->end_charpos - charpos > precision)
6411 {
6412 it->end_charpos = it->string_nchars = charpos + precision;
6413 if (it->bidi_p)
6414 it->bidi_it.string.schars = it->end_charpos;
6415 }
6416
6417 /* FIELD_WIDTH > 0 means pad with spaces until FIELD_WIDTH
6418 characters have been returned. FIELD_WIDTH == 0 means don't pad,
6419 FIELD_WIDTH < 0 means infinite field width. This is useful for
6420 padding with `-' at the end of a mode line. */
6421 if (field_width < 0)
6422 field_width = INFINITY;
6423 /* Implementation note: We deliberately don't enlarge
6424 it->bidi_it.string.schars here to fit it->end_charpos, because
6425 the bidi iterator cannot produce characters out of thin air. */
6426 if (field_width > it->end_charpos - charpos)
6427 it->end_charpos = charpos + field_width;
6428
6429 /* Use the standard display table for displaying strings. */
6430 if (DISP_TABLE_P (Vstandard_display_table))
6431 it->dp = XCHAR_TABLE (Vstandard_display_table);
6432
6433 it->stop_charpos = charpos;
6434 it->prev_stop = charpos;
6435 it->base_level_stop = 0;
6436 if (it->bidi_p)
6437 {
6438 it->bidi_it.first_elt = 1;
6439 it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir = NEUTRAL_DIR;
6440 it->bidi_it.disp_pos = -1;
6441 }
6442 if (s == NULL && it->multibyte_p)
6443 {
6444 ptrdiff_t endpos = SCHARS (it->string);
6445 if (endpos > it->end_charpos)
6446 endpos = it->end_charpos;
6447 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it, charpos, -1, endpos,
6448 it->string);
6449 }
6450 CHECK_IT (it);
6451 }
6452
6453
6454 \f
6455 /***********************************************************************
6456 Iteration
6457 ***********************************************************************/
6458
6459 /* Map enum it_method value to corresponding next_element_from_* function. */
6460
6461 static int (* get_next_element[NUM_IT_METHODS]) (struct it *it) =
6462 {
6463 next_element_from_buffer,
6464 next_element_from_display_vector,
6465 next_element_from_string,
6466 next_element_from_c_string,
6467 next_element_from_image,
6468 next_element_from_stretch
6469 };
6470
6471 #define GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT(it) (*get_next_element[(it)->method]) (it)
6472
6473
6474 /* Return 1 iff a character at CHARPOS (and BYTEPOS) is composed
6475 (possibly with the following characters). */
6476
6477 #define CHAR_COMPOSED_P(IT,CHARPOS,BYTEPOS,END_CHARPOS) \
6478 ((IT)->cmp_it.id >= 0 \
6479 || ((IT)->cmp_it.stop_pos == (CHARPOS) \
6480 && composition_reseat_it (&(IT)->cmp_it, CHARPOS, BYTEPOS, \
6481 END_CHARPOS, (IT)->w, \
6482 FACE_FROM_ID ((IT)->f, (IT)->face_id), \
6483 (IT)->string)))
6484
6485
6486 /* Lookup the char-table Vglyphless_char_display for character C (-1
6487 if we want information for no-font case), and return the display
6488 method symbol. By side-effect, update it->what and
6489 it->glyphless_method. This function is called from
6490 get_next_display_element for each character element, and from
6491 x_produce_glyphs when no suitable font was found. */
6492
6493 Lisp_Object
6494 lookup_glyphless_char_display (int c, struct it *it)
6495 {
6496 Lisp_Object glyphless_method = Qnil;
6497
6498 if (CHAR_TABLE_P (Vglyphless_char_display)
6499 && CHAR_TABLE_EXTRA_SLOTS (XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display)) >= 1)
6500 {
6501 if (c >= 0)
6502 {
6503 glyphless_method = CHAR_TABLE_REF (Vglyphless_char_display, c);
6504 if (CONSP (glyphless_method))
6505 glyphless_method = FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
6506 ? XCAR (glyphless_method)
6507 : XCDR (glyphless_method);
6508 }
6509 else
6510 glyphless_method = XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display)->extras[0];
6511 }
6512
6513 retry:
6514 if (NILP (glyphless_method))
6515 {
6516 if (c >= 0)
6517 /* The default is to display the character by a proper font. */
6518 return Qnil;
6519 /* The default for the no-font case is to display an empty box. */
6520 glyphless_method = Qempty_box;
6521 }
6522 if (EQ (glyphless_method, Qzero_width))
6523 {
6524 if (c >= 0)
6525 return glyphless_method;
6526 /* This method can't be used for the no-font case. */
6527 glyphless_method = Qempty_box;
6528 }
6529 if (EQ (glyphless_method, Qthin_space))
6530 it->glyphless_method = GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_THIN_SPACE;
6531 else if (EQ (glyphless_method, Qempty_box))
6532 it->glyphless_method = GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_EMPTY_BOX;
6533 else if (EQ (glyphless_method, Qhex_code))
6534 it->glyphless_method = GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE;
6535 else if (STRINGP (glyphless_method))
6536 it->glyphless_method = GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM;
6537 else
6538 {
6539 /* Invalid value. We use the default method. */
6540 glyphless_method = Qnil;
6541 goto retry;
6542 }
6543 it->what = IT_GLYPHLESS;
6544 return glyphless_method;
6545 }
6546
6547 /* Load IT's display element fields with information about the next
6548 display element from the current position of IT. Value is zero if
6549 end of buffer (or C string) is reached. */
6550
6551 static struct frame *last_escape_glyph_frame = NULL;
6552 static int last_escape_glyph_face_id = (1 << FACE_ID_BITS);
6553 static int last_escape_glyph_merged_face_id = 0;
6554
6555 struct frame *last_glyphless_glyph_frame = NULL;
6556 int last_glyphless_glyph_face_id = (1 << FACE_ID_BITS);
6557 int last_glyphless_glyph_merged_face_id = 0;
6558
6559 static int
6560 get_next_display_element (struct it *it)
6561 {
6562 /* Non-zero means that we found a display element. Zero means that
6563 we hit the end of what we iterate over. Performance note: the
6564 function pointer `method' used here turns out to be faster than
6565 using a sequence of if-statements. */
6566 int success_p;
6567
6568 get_next:
6569 success_p = GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
6570
6571 if (it->what == IT_CHARACTER)
6572 {
6573 /* UAX#9, L4: "A character is depicted by a mirrored glyph if
6574 and only if (a) the resolved directionality of that character
6575 is R..." */
6576 /* FIXME: Do we need an exception for characters from display
6577 tables? */
6578 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.type == STRONG_R)
6579 it->c = bidi_mirror_char (it->c);
6580 /* Map via display table or translate control characters.
6581 IT->c, IT->len etc. have been set to the next character by
6582 the function call above. If we have a display table, and it
6583 contains an entry for IT->c, translate it. Don't do this if
6584 IT->c itself comes from a display table, otherwise we could
6585 end up in an infinite recursion. (An alternative could be to
6586 count the recursion depth of this function and signal an
6587 error when a certain maximum depth is reached.) Is it worth
6588 it? */
6589 if (success_p && it->dpvec == NULL)
6590 {
6591 Lisp_Object dv;
6592 struct charset *unibyte = CHARSET_FROM_ID (charset_unibyte);
6593 int nonascii_space_p = 0;
6594 int nonascii_hyphen_p = 0;
6595 int c = it->c; /* This is the character to display. */
6596
6597 if (! it->multibyte_p && ! ASCII_CHAR_P (c))
6598 {
6599 eassert (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (c));
6600 if (unibyte_display_via_language_environment)
6601 {
6602 c = DECODE_CHAR (unibyte, c);
6603 if (c < 0)
6604 c = BYTE8_TO_CHAR (it->c);
6605 }
6606 else
6607 c = BYTE8_TO_CHAR (it->c);
6608 }
6609
6610 if (it->dp
6611 && (dv = DISP_CHAR_VECTOR (it->dp, c),
6612 VECTORP (dv)))
6613 {
6614 struct Lisp_Vector *v = XVECTOR (dv);
6615
6616 /* Return the first character from the display table
6617 entry, if not empty. If empty, don't display the
6618 current character. */
6619 if (v->header.size)
6620 {
6621 it->dpvec_char_len = it->len;
6622 it->dpvec = v->contents;
6623 it->dpend = v->contents + v->header.size;
6624 it->current.dpvec_index = 0;
6625 it->dpvec_face_id = -1;
6626 it->saved_face_id = it->face_id;
6627 it->method = GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR;
6628 it->ellipsis_p = 0;
6629 }
6630 else
6631 {
6632 set_iterator_to_next (it, 0);
6633 }
6634 goto get_next;
6635 }
6636
6637 if (! NILP (lookup_glyphless_char_display (c, it)))
6638 {
6639 if (it->what == IT_GLYPHLESS)
6640 goto done;
6641 /* Don't display this character. */
6642 set_iterator_to_next (it, 0);
6643 goto get_next;
6644 }
6645
6646 /* If `nobreak-char-display' is non-nil, we display
6647 non-ASCII spaces and hyphens specially. */
6648 if (! ASCII_CHAR_P (c) && ! NILP (Vnobreak_char_display))
6649 {
6650 if (c == 0xA0)
6651 nonascii_space_p = 1;
6652 else if (c == 0xAD || c == 0x2010 || c == 0x2011)
6653 nonascii_hyphen_p = 1;
6654 }
6655
6656 /* Translate control characters into `\003' or `^C' form.
6657 Control characters coming from a display table entry are
6658 currently not translated because we use IT->dpvec to hold
6659 the translation. This could easily be changed but I
6660 don't believe that it is worth doing.
6661
6662 The characters handled by `nobreak-char-display' must be
6663 translated too.
6664
6665 Non-printable characters and raw-byte characters are also
6666 translated to octal form. */
6667 if (((c < ' ' || c == 127) /* ASCII control chars */
6668 ? (it->area != TEXT_AREA
6669 /* In mode line, treat \n, \t like other crl chars. */
6670 || (c != '\t'
6671 && it->glyph_row
6672 && (it->glyph_row->mode_line_p || it->avoid_cursor_p))
6673 || (c != '\n' && c != '\t'))
6674 : (nonascii_space_p
6675 || nonascii_hyphen_p
6676 || CHAR_BYTE8_P (c)
6677 || ! CHAR_PRINTABLE_P (c))))
6678 {
6679 /* C is a control character, non-ASCII space/hyphen,
6680 raw-byte, or a non-printable character which must be
6681 displayed either as '\003' or as `^C' where the '\\'
6682 and '^' can be defined in the display table. Fill
6683 IT->ctl_chars with glyphs for what we have to
6684 display. Then, set IT->dpvec to these glyphs. */
6685 Lisp_Object gc;
6686 int ctl_len;
6687 int face_id;
6688 int lface_id = 0;
6689 int escape_glyph;
6690
6691 /* Handle control characters with ^. */
6692
6693 if (ASCII_CHAR_P (c) && it->ctl_arrow_p)
6694 {
6695 int g;
6696
6697 g = '^'; /* default glyph for Control */
6698 /* Set IT->ctl_chars[0] to the glyph for `^'. */
6699 if (it->dp
6700 && (gc = DISP_CTRL_GLYPH (it->dp), GLYPH_CODE_P (gc)))
6701 {
6702 g = GLYPH_CODE_CHAR (gc);
6703 lface_id = GLYPH_CODE_FACE (gc);
6704 }
6705 if (lface_id)
6706 {
6707 face_id = merge_faces (it->f, Qt, lface_id, it->face_id);
6708 }
6709 else if (it->f == last_escape_glyph_frame
6710 && it->face_id == last_escape_glyph_face_id)
6711 {
6712 face_id = last_escape_glyph_merged_face_id;
6713 }
6714 else
6715 {
6716 /* Merge the escape-glyph face into the current face. */
6717 face_id = merge_faces (it->f, Qescape_glyph, 0,
6718 it->face_id);
6719 last_escape_glyph_frame = it->f;
6720 last_escape_glyph_face_id = it->face_id;
6721 last_escape_glyph_merged_face_id = face_id;
6722 }
6723
6724 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[0], g);
6725 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[1], c ^ 0100);
6726 ctl_len = 2;
6727 goto display_control;
6728 }
6729
6730 /* Handle non-ascii space in the mode where it only gets
6731 highlighting. */
6732
6733 if (nonascii_space_p && EQ (Vnobreak_char_display, Qt))
6734 {
6735 /* Merge `nobreak-space' into the current face. */
6736 face_id = merge_faces (it->f, Qnobreak_space, 0,
6737 it->face_id);
6738 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[0], ' ');
6739 ctl_len = 1;
6740 goto display_control;
6741 }
6742
6743 /* Handle sequences that start with the "escape glyph". */
6744
6745 /* the default escape glyph is \. */
6746 escape_glyph = '\\';
6747
6748 if (it->dp
6749 && (gc = DISP_ESCAPE_GLYPH (it->dp), GLYPH_CODE_P (gc)))
6750 {
6751 escape_glyph = GLYPH_CODE_CHAR (gc);
6752 lface_id = GLYPH_CODE_FACE (gc);
6753 }
6754 if (lface_id)
6755 {
6756 /* The display table specified a face.
6757 Merge it into face_id and also into escape_glyph. */
6758 face_id = merge_faces (it->f, Qt, lface_id,
6759 it->face_id);
6760 }
6761 else if (it->f == last_escape_glyph_frame
6762 && it->face_id == last_escape_glyph_face_id)
6763 {
6764 face_id = last_escape_glyph_merged_face_id;
6765 }
6766 else
6767 {
6768 /* Merge the escape-glyph face into the current face. */
6769 face_id = merge_faces (it->f, Qescape_glyph, 0,
6770 it->face_id);
6771 last_escape_glyph_frame = it->f;
6772 last_escape_glyph_face_id = it->face_id;
6773 last_escape_glyph_merged_face_id = face_id;
6774 }
6775
6776 /* Draw non-ASCII hyphen with just highlighting: */
6777
6778 if (nonascii_hyphen_p && EQ (Vnobreak_char_display, Qt))
6779 {
6780 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[0], '-');
6781 ctl_len = 1;
6782 goto display_control;
6783 }
6784
6785 /* Draw non-ASCII space/hyphen with escape glyph: */
6786
6787 if (nonascii_space_p || nonascii_hyphen_p)
6788 {
6789 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[0], escape_glyph);
6790 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[1], nonascii_space_p ? ' ' : '-');
6791 ctl_len = 2;
6792 goto display_control;
6793 }
6794
6795 {
6796 char str[10];
6797 int len, i;
6798
6799 if (CHAR_BYTE8_P (c))
6800 /* Display \200 instead of \17777600. */
6801 c = CHAR_TO_BYTE8 (c);
6802 len = sprintf (str, "%03o", c);
6803
6804 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[0], escape_glyph);
6805 for (i = 0; i < len; i++)
6806 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[i + 1], str[i]);
6807 ctl_len = len + 1;
6808 }
6809
6810 display_control:
6811 /* Set up IT->dpvec and return first character from it. */
6812 it->dpvec_char_len = it->len;
6813 it->dpvec = it->ctl_chars;
6814 it->dpend = it->dpvec + ctl_len;
6815 it->current.dpvec_index = 0;
6816 it->dpvec_face_id = face_id;
6817 it->saved_face_id = it->face_id;
6818 it->method = GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR;
6819 it->ellipsis_p = 0;
6820 goto get_next;
6821 }
6822 it->char_to_display = c;
6823 }
6824 else if (success_p)
6825 {
6826 it->char_to_display = it->c;
6827 }
6828 }
6829
6830 /* Adjust face id for a multibyte character. There are no multibyte
6831 character in unibyte text. */
6832 if ((it->what == IT_CHARACTER || it->what == IT_COMPOSITION)
6833 && it->multibyte_p
6834 && success_p
6835 && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
6836 {
6837 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
6838
6839 if (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION && it->cmp_it.ch >= 0)
6840 {
6841 /* Automatic composition with glyph-string. */
6842 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (it->cmp_it.id);
6843
6844 it->face_id = face_for_font (it->f, LGSTRING_FONT (gstring), face);
6845 }
6846 else
6847 {
6848 ptrdiff_t pos = (it->s ? -1
6849 : STRINGP (it->string) ? IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it)
6850 : IT_CHARPOS (*it));
6851 int c;
6852
6853 if (it->what == IT_CHARACTER)
6854 c = it->char_to_display;
6855 else
6856 {
6857 struct composition *cmp = composition_table[it->cmp_it.id];
6858 int i;
6859
6860 c = ' ';
6861 for (i = 0; i < cmp->glyph_len; i++)
6862 /* TAB in a composition means display glyphs with
6863 padding space on the left or right. */
6864 if ((c = COMPOSITION_GLYPH (cmp, i)) != '\t')
6865 break;
6866 }
6867 it->face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (it->f, face, c, pos, it->string);
6868 }
6869 }
6870
6871 done:
6872 /* Is this character the last one of a run of characters with
6873 box? If yes, set IT->end_of_box_run_p to 1. */
6874 if (it->face_box_p
6875 && it->s == NULL)
6876 {
6877 if (it->method == GET_FROM_STRING && it->sp)
6878 {
6879 int face_id = underlying_face_id (it);
6880 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, face_id);
6881
6882 if (face)
6883 {
6884 if (face->box == FACE_NO_BOX)
6885 {
6886 /* If the box comes from face properties in a
6887 display string, check faces in that string. */
6888 int string_face_id = face_after_it_pos (it);
6889 it->end_of_box_run_p
6890 = (FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, string_face_id)->box
6891 == FACE_NO_BOX);
6892 }
6893 /* Otherwise, the box comes from the underlying face.
6894 If this is the last string character displayed, check
6895 the next buffer location. */
6896 else if ((IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= SCHARS (it->string) - 1)
6897 && (it->current.overlay_string_index
6898 == it->n_overlay_strings - 1))
6899 {
6900 ptrdiff_t ignore;
6901 int next_face_id;
6902 struct text_pos pos = it->current.pos;
6903 INC_TEXT_POS (pos, it->multibyte_p);
6904
6905 next_face_id = face_at_buffer_position
6906 (it->w, CHARPOS (pos), it->region_beg_charpos,
6907 it->region_end_charpos, &ignore,
6908 (IT_CHARPOS (*it) + TEXT_PROP_DISTANCE_LIMIT), 0,
6909 -1);
6910 it->end_of_box_run_p
6911 = (FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, next_face_id)->box
6912 == FACE_NO_BOX);
6913 }
6914 }
6915 }
6916 else
6917 {
6918 int face_id = face_after_it_pos (it);
6919 it->end_of_box_run_p
6920 = (face_id != it->face_id
6921 && FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, face_id)->box == FACE_NO_BOX);
6922 }
6923 }
6924 /* If we reached the end of the object we've been iterating (e.g., a
6925 display string or an overlay string), and there's something on
6926 IT->stack, proceed with what's on the stack. It doesn't make
6927 sense to return zero if there's unprocessed stuff on the stack,
6928 because otherwise that stuff will never be displayed. */
6929 if (!success_p && it->sp > 0)
6930 {
6931 set_iterator_to_next (it, 0);
6932 success_p = get_next_display_element (it);
6933 }
6934
6935 /* Value is 0 if end of buffer or string reached. */
6936 return success_p;
6937 }
6938
6939
6940 /* Move IT to the next display element.
6941
6942 RESEAT_P non-zero means if called on a newline in buffer text,
6943 skip to the next visible line start.
6944
6945 Functions get_next_display_element and set_iterator_to_next are
6946 separate because I find this arrangement easier to handle than a
6947 get_next_display_element function that also increments IT's
6948 position. The way it is we can first look at an iterator's current
6949 display element, decide whether it fits on a line, and if it does,
6950 increment the iterator position. The other way around we probably
6951 would either need a flag indicating whether the iterator has to be
6952 incremented the next time, or we would have to implement a
6953 decrement position function which would not be easy to write. */
6954
6955 void
6956 set_iterator_to_next (struct it *it, int reseat_p)
6957 {
6958 /* Reset flags indicating start and end of a sequence of characters
6959 with box. Reset them at the start of this function because
6960 moving the iterator to a new position might set them. */
6961 it->start_of_box_run_p = it->end_of_box_run_p = 0;
6962
6963 switch (it->method)
6964 {
6965 case GET_FROM_BUFFER:
6966 /* The current display element of IT is a character from
6967 current_buffer. Advance in the buffer, and maybe skip over
6968 invisible lines that are so because of selective display. */
6969 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it) && reseat_p)
6970 reseat_at_next_visible_line_start (it, 0);
6971 else if (it->cmp_it.id >= 0)
6972 {
6973 /* We are currently getting glyphs from a composition. */
6974 int i;
6975
6976 if (! it->bidi_p)
6977 {
6978 IT_CHARPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nchars;
6979 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nbytes;
6980 if (it->cmp_it.to < it->cmp_it.nglyphs)
6981 {
6982 it->cmp_it.from = it->cmp_it.to;
6983 }
6984 else
6985 {
6986 it->cmp_it.id = -1;
6987 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it, IT_CHARPOS (*it),
6988 IT_BYTEPOS (*it),
6989 it->end_charpos, Qnil);
6990 }
6991 }
6992 else if (! it->cmp_it.reversed_p)
6993 {
6994 /* Composition created while scanning forward. */
6995 /* Update IT's char/byte positions to point to the first
6996 character of the next grapheme cluster, or to the
6997 character visually after the current composition. */
6998 for (i = 0; i < it->cmp_it.nchars; i++)
6999 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7000 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7001 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7002
7003 if (it->cmp_it.to < it->cmp_it.nglyphs)
7004 {
7005 /* Proceed to the next grapheme cluster. */
7006 it->cmp_it.from = it->cmp_it.to;
7007 }
7008 else
7009 {
7010 /* No more grapheme clusters in this composition.
7011 Find the next stop position. */
7012 ptrdiff_t stop = it->end_charpos;
7013 if (it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
7014 /* Now we are scanning backward and don't know
7015 where to stop. */
7016 stop = -1;
7017 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it, IT_CHARPOS (*it),
7018 IT_BYTEPOS (*it), stop, Qnil);
7019 }
7020 }
7021 else
7022 {
7023 /* Composition created while scanning backward. */
7024 /* Update IT's char/byte positions to point to the last
7025 character of the previous grapheme cluster, or the
7026 character visually after the current composition. */
7027 for (i = 0; i < it->cmp_it.nchars; i++)
7028 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7029 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7030 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7031 if (it->cmp_it.from > 0)
7032 {
7033 /* Proceed to the previous grapheme cluster. */
7034 it->cmp_it.to = it->cmp_it.from;
7035 }
7036 else
7037 {
7038 /* No more grapheme clusters in this composition.
7039 Find the next stop position. */
7040 ptrdiff_t stop = it->end_charpos;
7041 if (it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
7042 /* Now we are scanning backward and don't know
7043 where to stop. */
7044 stop = -1;
7045 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it, IT_CHARPOS (*it),
7046 IT_BYTEPOS (*it), stop, Qnil);
7047 }
7048 }
7049 }
7050 else
7051 {
7052 eassert (it->len != 0);
7053
7054 if (!it->bidi_p)
7055 {
7056 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) += it->len;
7057 IT_CHARPOS (*it) += 1;
7058 }
7059 else
7060 {
7061 int prev_scan_dir = it->bidi_it.scan_dir;
7062 /* If this is a new paragraph, determine its base
7063 direction (a.k.a. its base embedding level). */
7064 if (it->bidi_it.new_paragraph)
7065 bidi_paragraph_init (it->paragraph_embedding, &it->bidi_it, 0);
7066 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7067 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7068 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7069 if (prev_scan_dir != it->bidi_it.scan_dir)
7070 {
7071 /* As the scan direction was changed, we must
7072 re-compute the stop position for composition. */
7073 ptrdiff_t stop = it->end_charpos;
7074 if (it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
7075 stop = -1;
7076 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it, IT_CHARPOS (*it),
7077 IT_BYTEPOS (*it), stop, Qnil);
7078 }
7079 }
7080 eassert (IT_BYTEPOS (*it) == CHAR_TO_BYTE (IT_CHARPOS (*it)));
7081 }
7082 break;
7083
7084 case GET_FROM_C_STRING:
7085 /* Current display element of IT is from a C string. */
7086 if (!it->bidi_p
7087 /* If the string position is beyond string's end, it means
7088 next_element_from_c_string is padding the string with
7089 blanks, in which case we bypass the bidi iterator,
7090 because it cannot deal with such virtual characters. */
7091 || IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->bidi_it.string.schars)
7092 {
7093 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) += it->len;
7094 IT_CHARPOS (*it) += 1;
7095 }
7096 else
7097 {
7098 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7099 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7100 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7101 }
7102 break;
7103
7104 case GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR:
7105 /* Current display element of IT is from a display table entry.
7106 Advance in the display table definition. Reset it to null if
7107 end reached, and continue with characters from buffers/
7108 strings. */
7109 ++it->current.dpvec_index;
7110
7111 /* Restore face of the iterator to what they were before the
7112 display vector entry (these entries may contain faces). */
7113 it->face_id = it->saved_face_id;
7114
7115 if (it->dpvec + it->current.dpvec_index >= it->dpend)
7116 {
7117 int recheck_faces = it->ellipsis_p;
7118
7119 if (it->s)
7120 it->method = GET_FROM_C_STRING;
7121 else if (STRINGP (it->string))
7122 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
7123 else
7124 {
7125 it->method = GET_FROM_BUFFER;
7126 it->object = it->w->buffer;
7127 }
7128
7129 it->dpvec = NULL;
7130 it->current.dpvec_index = -1;
7131
7132 /* Skip over characters which were displayed via IT->dpvec. */
7133 if (it->dpvec_char_len < 0)
7134 reseat_at_next_visible_line_start (it, 1);
7135 else if (it->dpvec_char_len > 0)
7136 {
7137 if (it->method == GET_FROM_STRING
7138 && it->n_overlay_strings > 0)
7139 it->ignore_overlay_strings_at_pos_p = 1;
7140 it->len = it->dpvec_char_len;
7141 set_iterator_to_next (it, reseat_p);
7142 }
7143
7144 /* Maybe recheck faces after display vector */
7145 if (recheck_faces)
7146 it->stop_charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
7147 }
7148 break;
7149
7150 case GET_FROM_STRING:
7151 /* Current display element is a character from a Lisp string. */
7152 eassert (it->s == NULL && STRINGP (it->string));
7153 /* Don't advance past string end. These conditions are true
7154 when set_iterator_to_next is called at the end of
7155 get_next_display_element, in which case the Lisp string is
7156 already exhausted, and all we want is pop the iterator
7157 stack. */
7158 if (it->current.overlay_string_index >= 0)
7159 {
7160 /* This is an overlay string, so there's no padding with
7161 spaces, and the number of characters in the string is
7162 where the string ends. */
7163 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= SCHARS (it->string))
7164 goto consider_string_end;
7165 }
7166 else
7167 {
7168 /* Not an overlay string. There could be padding, so test
7169 against it->end_charpos . */
7170 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->end_charpos)
7171 goto consider_string_end;
7172 }
7173 if (it->cmp_it.id >= 0)
7174 {
7175 int i;
7176
7177 if (! it->bidi_p)
7178 {
7179 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nchars;
7180 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nbytes;
7181 if (it->cmp_it.to < it->cmp_it.nglyphs)
7182 it->cmp_it.from = it->cmp_it.to;
7183 else
7184 {
7185 it->cmp_it.id = -1;
7186 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it,
7187 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
7188 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it),
7189 it->end_charpos, it->string);
7190 }
7191 }
7192 else if (! it->cmp_it.reversed_p)
7193 {
7194 for (i = 0; i < it->cmp_it.nchars; i++)
7195 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7196 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7197 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7198
7199 if (it->cmp_it.to < it->cmp_it.nglyphs)
7200 it->cmp_it.from = it->cmp_it.to;
7201 else
7202 {
7203 ptrdiff_t stop = it->end_charpos;
7204 if (it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
7205 stop = -1;
7206 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it,
7207 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
7208 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it), stop,
7209 it->string);
7210 }
7211 }
7212 else
7213 {
7214 for (i = 0; i < it->cmp_it.nchars; i++)
7215 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7216 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7217 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7218 if (it->cmp_it.from > 0)
7219 it->cmp_it.to = it->cmp_it.from;
7220 else
7221 {
7222 ptrdiff_t stop = it->end_charpos;
7223 if (it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
7224 stop = -1;
7225 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it,
7226 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
7227 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it), stop,
7228 it->string);
7229 }
7230 }
7231 }
7232 else
7233 {
7234 if (!it->bidi_p
7235 /* If the string position is beyond string's end, it
7236 means next_element_from_string is padding the string
7237 with blanks, in which case we bypass the bidi
7238 iterator, because it cannot deal with such virtual
7239 characters. */
7240 || IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->bidi_it.string.schars)
7241 {
7242 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) += it->len;
7243 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) += 1;
7244 }
7245 else
7246 {
7247 int prev_scan_dir = it->bidi_it.scan_dir;
7248
7249 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7250 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7251 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7252 if (prev_scan_dir != it->bidi_it.scan_dir)
7253 {
7254 ptrdiff_t stop = it->end_charpos;
7255
7256 if (it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
7257 stop = -1;
7258 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it,
7259 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
7260 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it), stop,
7261 it->string);
7262 }
7263 }
7264 }
7265
7266 consider_string_end:
7267
7268 if (it->current.overlay_string_index >= 0)
7269 {
7270 /* IT->string is an overlay string. Advance to the
7271 next, if there is one. */
7272 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= SCHARS (it->string))
7273 {
7274 it->ellipsis_p = 0;
7275 next_overlay_string (it);
7276 if (it->ellipsis_p)
7277 setup_for_ellipsis (it, 0);
7278 }
7279 }
7280 else
7281 {
7282 /* IT->string is not an overlay string. If we reached
7283 its end, and there is something on IT->stack, proceed
7284 with what is on the stack. This can be either another
7285 string, this time an overlay string, or a buffer. */
7286 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) == SCHARS (it->string)
7287 && it->sp > 0)
7288 {
7289 pop_it (it);
7290 if (it->method == GET_FROM_STRING)
7291 goto consider_string_end;
7292 }
7293 }
7294 break;
7295
7296 case GET_FROM_IMAGE:
7297 case GET_FROM_STRETCH:
7298 /* The position etc with which we have to proceed are on
7299 the stack. The position may be at the end of a string,
7300 if the `display' property takes up the whole string. */
7301 eassert (it->sp > 0);
7302 pop_it (it);
7303 if (it->method == GET_FROM_STRING)
7304 goto consider_string_end;
7305 break;
7306
7307 default:
7308 /* There are no other methods defined, so this should be a bug. */
7309 abort ();
7310 }
7311
7312 eassert (it->method != GET_FROM_STRING
7313 || (STRINGP (it->string)
7314 && IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= 0));
7315 }
7316
7317 /* Load IT's display element fields with information about the next
7318 display element which comes from a display table entry or from the
7319 result of translating a control character to one of the forms `^C'
7320 or `\003'.
7321
7322 IT->dpvec holds the glyphs to return as characters.
7323 IT->saved_face_id holds the face id before the display vector--it
7324 is restored into IT->face_id in set_iterator_to_next. */
7325
7326 static int
7327 next_element_from_display_vector (struct it *it)
7328 {
7329 Lisp_Object gc;
7330
7331 /* Precondition. */
7332 eassert (it->dpvec && it->current.dpvec_index >= 0);
7333
7334 it->face_id = it->saved_face_id;
7335
7336 /* KFS: This code used to check ip->dpvec[0] instead of the current element.
7337 That seemed totally bogus - so I changed it... */
7338 gc = it->dpvec[it->current.dpvec_index];
7339
7340 if (GLYPH_CODE_P (gc))
7341 {
7342 it->c = GLYPH_CODE_CHAR (gc);
7343 it->len = CHAR_BYTES (it->c);
7344
7345 /* The entry may contain a face id to use. Such a face id is
7346 the id of a Lisp face, not a realized face. A face id of
7347 zero means no face is specified. */
7348 if (it->dpvec_face_id >= 0)
7349 it->face_id = it->dpvec_face_id;
7350 else
7351 {
7352 int lface_id = GLYPH_CODE_FACE (gc);
7353 if (lface_id > 0)
7354 it->face_id = merge_faces (it->f, Qt, lface_id,
7355 it->saved_face_id);
7356 }
7357 }
7358 else
7359 /* Display table entry is invalid. Return a space. */
7360 it->c = ' ', it->len = 1;
7361
7362 /* Don't change position and object of the iterator here. They are
7363 still the values of the character that had this display table
7364 entry or was translated, and that's what we want. */
7365 it->what = IT_CHARACTER;
7366 return 1;
7367 }
7368
7369 /* Get the first element of string/buffer in the visual order, after
7370 being reseated to a new position in a string or a buffer. */
7371 static void
7372 get_visually_first_element (struct it *it)
7373 {
7374 int string_p = STRINGP (it->string) || it->s;
7375 ptrdiff_t eob = (string_p ? it->bidi_it.string.schars : ZV);
7376 ptrdiff_t bob = (string_p ? 0 : BEGV);
7377
7378 if (STRINGP (it->string))
7379 {
7380 it->bidi_it.charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it);
7381 it->bidi_it.bytepos = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it);
7382 }
7383 else
7384 {
7385 it->bidi_it.charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
7386 it->bidi_it.bytepos = IT_BYTEPOS (*it);
7387 }
7388
7389 if (it->bidi_it.charpos == eob)
7390 {
7391 /* Nothing to do, but reset the FIRST_ELT flag, like
7392 bidi_paragraph_init does, because we are not going to
7393 call it. */
7394 it->bidi_it.first_elt = 0;
7395 }
7396 else if (it->bidi_it.charpos == bob
7397 || (!string_p
7398 && (FETCH_CHAR (it->bidi_it.bytepos - 1) == '\n'
7399 || FETCH_CHAR (it->bidi_it.bytepos) == '\n')))
7400 {
7401 /* If we are at the beginning of a line/string, we can produce
7402 the next element right away. */
7403 bidi_paragraph_init (it->paragraph_embedding, &it->bidi_it, 1);
7404 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7405 }
7406 else
7407 {
7408 ptrdiff_t orig_bytepos = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7409
7410 /* We need to prime the bidi iterator starting at the line's or
7411 string's beginning, before we will be able to produce the
7412 next element. */
7413 if (string_p)
7414 it->bidi_it.charpos = it->bidi_it.bytepos = 0;
7415 else
7416 {
7417 it->bidi_it.charpos = find_next_newline_no_quit (IT_CHARPOS (*it),
7418 -1);
7419 it->bidi_it.bytepos = CHAR_TO_BYTE (it->bidi_it.charpos);
7420 }
7421 bidi_paragraph_init (it->paragraph_embedding, &it->bidi_it, 1);
7422 do
7423 {
7424 /* Now return to buffer/string position where we were asked
7425 to get the next display element, and produce that. */
7426 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7427 }
7428 while (it->bidi_it.bytepos != orig_bytepos
7429 && it->bidi_it.charpos < eob);
7430 }
7431
7432 /* Adjust IT's position information to where we ended up. */
7433 if (STRINGP (it->string))
7434 {
7435 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7436 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7437 }
7438 else
7439 {
7440 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7441 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7442 }
7443
7444 if (STRINGP (it->string) || !it->s)
7445 {
7446 ptrdiff_t stop, charpos, bytepos;
7447
7448 if (STRINGP (it->string))
7449 {
7450 eassert (!it->s);
7451 stop = SCHARS (it->string);
7452 if (stop > it->end_charpos)
7453 stop = it->end_charpos;
7454 charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it);
7455 bytepos = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it);
7456 }
7457 else
7458 {
7459 stop = it->end_charpos;
7460 charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
7461 bytepos = IT_BYTEPOS (*it);
7462 }
7463 if (it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
7464 stop = -1;
7465 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it, charpos, bytepos, stop,
7466 it->string);
7467 }
7468 }
7469
7470 /* Load IT with the next display element from Lisp string IT->string.
7471 IT->current.string_pos is the current position within the string.
7472 If IT->current.overlay_string_index >= 0, the Lisp string is an
7473 overlay string. */
7474
7475 static int
7476 next_element_from_string (struct it *it)
7477 {
7478 struct text_pos position;
7479
7480 eassert (STRINGP (it->string));
7481 eassert (!it->bidi_p || EQ (it->string, it->bidi_it.string.lstring));
7482 eassert (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= 0);
7483 position = it->current.string_pos;
7484
7485 /* With bidi reordering, the character to display might not be the
7486 character at IT_STRING_CHARPOS. BIDI_IT.FIRST_ELT non-zero means
7487 that we were reseat()ed to a new string, whose paragraph
7488 direction is not known. */
7489 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.first_elt)
7490 {
7491 get_visually_first_element (it);
7492 SET_TEXT_POS (position, IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it), IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it));
7493 }
7494
7495 /* Time to check for invisible text? */
7496 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) < it->end_charpos)
7497 {
7498 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->stop_charpos)
7499 {
7500 if (!(!it->bidi_p
7501 || BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it)
7502 || IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) == it->stop_charpos))
7503 {
7504 /* With bidi non-linear iteration, we could find
7505 ourselves far beyond the last computed stop_charpos,
7506 with several other stop positions in between that we
7507 missed. Scan them all now, in buffer's logical
7508 order, until we find and handle the last stop_charpos
7509 that precedes our current position. */
7510 handle_stop_backwards (it, it->stop_charpos);
7511 return GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
7512 }
7513 else
7514 {
7515 if (it->bidi_p)
7516 {
7517 /* Take note of the stop position we just moved
7518 across, for when we will move back across it. */
7519 it->prev_stop = it->stop_charpos;
7520 /* If we are at base paragraph embedding level, take
7521 note of the last stop position seen at this
7522 level. */
7523 if (BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it))
7524 it->base_level_stop = it->stop_charpos;
7525 }
7526 handle_stop (it);
7527
7528 /* Since a handler may have changed IT->method, we must
7529 recurse here. */
7530 return GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
7531 }
7532 }
7533 else if (it->bidi_p
7534 /* If we are before prev_stop, we may have overstepped
7535 on our way backwards a stop_pos, and if so, we need
7536 to handle that stop_pos. */
7537 && IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) < it->prev_stop
7538 /* We can sometimes back up for reasons that have nothing
7539 to do with bidi reordering. E.g., compositions. The
7540 code below is only needed when we are above the base
7541 embedding level, so test for that explicitly. */
7542 && !BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it))
7543 {
7544 /* If we lost track of base_level_stop, we have no better
7545 place for handle_stop_backwards to start from than string
7546 beginning. This happens, e.g., when we were reseated to
7547 the previous screenful of text by vertical-motion. */
7548 if (it->base_level_stop <= 0
7549 || IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) < it->base_level_stop)
7550 it->base_level_stop = 0;
7551 handle_stop_backwards (it, it->base_level_stop);
7552 return GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
7553 }
7554 }
7555
7556 if (it->current.overlay_string_index >= 0)
7557 {
7558 /* Get the next character from an overlay string. In overlay
7559 strings, there is no field width or padding with spaces to
7560 do. */
7561 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= SCHARS (it->string))
7562 {
7563 it->what = IT_EOB;
7564 return 0;
7565 }
7566 else if (CHAR_COMPOSED_P (it, IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
7567 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it),
7568 it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0
7569 ? -1
7570 : SCHARS (it->string))
7571 && next_element_from_composition (it))
7572 {
7573 return 1;
7574 }
7575 else if (STRING_MULTIBYTE (it->string))
7576 {
7577 const unsigned char *s = (SDATA (it->string)
7578 + IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it));
7579 it->c = string_char_and_length (s, &it->len);
7580 }
7581 else
7582 {
7583 it->c = SREF (it->string, IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it));
7584 it->len = 1;
7585 }
7586 }
7587 else
7588 {
7589 /* Get the next character from a Lisp string that is not an
7590 overlay string. Such strings come from the mode line, for
7591 example. We may have to pad with spaces, or truncate the
7592 string. See also next_element_from_c_string. */
7593 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->end_charpos)
7594 {
7595 it->what = IT_EOB;
7596 return 0;
7597 }
7598 else if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->string_nchars)
7599 {
7600 /* Pad with spaces. */
7601 it->c = ' ', it->len = 1;
7602 CHARPOS (position) = BYTEPOS (position) = -1;
7603 }
7604 else if (CHAR_COMPOSED_P (it, IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
7605 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it),
7606 it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0
7607 ? -1
7608 : it->string_nchars)
7609 && next_element_from_composition (it))
7610 {
7611 return 1;
7612 }
7613 else if (STRING_MULTIBYTE (it->string))
7614 {
7615 const unsigned char *s = (SDATA (it->string)
7616 + IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it));
7617 it->c = string_char_and_length (s, &it->len);
7618 }
7619 else
7620 {
7621 it->c = SREF (it->string, IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it));
7622 it->len = 1;
7623 }
7624 }
7625
7626 /* Record what we have and where it came from. */
7627 it->what = IT_CHARACTER;
7628 it->object = it->string;
7629 it->position = position;
7630 return 1;
7631 }
7632
7633
7634 /* Load IT with next display element from C string IT->s.
7635 IT->string_nchars is the maximum number of characters to return
7636 from the string. IT->end_charpos may be greater than
7637 IT->string_nchars when this function is called, in which case we
7638 may have to return padding spaces. Value is zero if end of string
7639 reached, including padding spaces. */
7640
7641 static int
7642 next_element_from_c_string (struct it *it)
7643 {
7644 int success_p = 1;
7645
7646 eassert (it->s);
7647 eassert (!it->bidi_p || it->s == it->bidi_it.string.s);
7648 it->what = IT_CHARACTER;
7649 BYTEPOS (it->position) = CHARPOS (it->position) = 0;
7650 it->object = Qnil;
7651
7652 /* With bidi reordering, the character to display might not be the
7653 character at IT_CHARPOS. BIDI_IT.FIRST_ELT non-zero means that
7654 we were reseated to a new string, whose paragraph direction is
7655 not known. */
7656 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.first_elt)
7657 get_visually_first_element (it);
7658
7659 /* IT's position can be greater than IT->string_nchars in case a
7660 field width or precision has been specified when the iterator was
7661 initialized. */
7662 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->end_charpos)
7663 {
7664 /* End of the game. */
7665 it->what = IT_EOB;
7666 success_p = 0;
7667 }
7668 else if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->string_nchars)
7669 {
7670 /* Pad with spaces. */
7671 it->c = ' ', it->len = 1;
7672 BYTEPOS (it->position) = CHARPOS (it->position) = -1;
7673 }
7674 else if (it->multibyte_p)
7675 it->c = string_char_and_length (it->s + IT_BYTEPOS (*it), &it->len);
7676 else
7677 it->c = it->s[IT_BYTEPOS (*it)], it->len = 1;
7678
7679 return success_p;
7680 }
7681
7682
7683 /* Set up IT to return characters from an ellipsis, if appropriate.
7684 The definition of the ellipsis glyphs may come from a display table
7685 entry. This function fills IT with the first glyph from the
7686 ellipsis if an ellipsis is to be displayed. */
7687
7688 static int
7689 next_element_from_ellipsis (struct it *it)
7690 {
7691 if (it->selective_display_ellipsis_p)
7692 setup_for_ellipsis (it, it->len);
7693 else
7694 {
7695 /* The face at the current position may be different from the
7696 face we find after the invisible text. Remember what it
7697 was in IT->saved_face_id, and signal that it's there by
7698 setting face_before_selective_p. */
7699 it->saved_face_id = it->face_id;
7700 it->method = GET_FROM_BUFFER;
7701 it->object = it->w->buffer;
7702 reseat_at_next_visible_line_start (it, 1);
7703 it->face_before_selective_p = 1;
7704 }
7705
7706 return GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
7707 }
7708
7709
7710 /* Deliver an image display element. The iterator IT is already
7711 filled with image information (done in handle_display_prop). Value
7712 is always 1. */
7713
7714
7715 static int
7716 next_element_from_image (struct it *it)
7717 {
7718 it->what = IT_IMAGE;
7719 it->ignore_overlay_strings_at_pos_p = 0;
7720 return 1;
7721 }
7722
7723
7724 /* Fill iterator IT with next display element from a stretch glyph
7725 property. IT->object is the value of the text property. Value is
7726 always 1. */
7727
7728 static int
7729 next_element_from_stretch (struct it *it)
7730 {
7731 it->what = IT_STRETCH;
7732 return 1;
7733 }
7734
7735 /* Scan backwards from IT's current position until we find a stop
7736 position, or until BEGV. This is called when we find ourself
7737 before both the last known prev_stop and base_level_stop while
7738 reordering bidirectional text. */
7739
7740 static void
7741 compute_stop_pos_backwards (struct it *it)
7742 {
7743 const int SCAN_BACK_LIMIT = 1000;
7744 struct text_pos pos;
7745 struct display_pos save_current = it->current;
7746 struct text_pos save_position = it->position;
7747 ptrdiff_t charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
7748 ptrdiff_t where_we_are = charpos;
7749 ptrdiff_t save_stop_pos = it->stop_charpos;
7750 ptrdiff_t save_end_pos = it->end_charpos;
7751
7752 eassert (NILP (it->string) && !it->s);
7753 eassert (it->bidi_p);
7754 it->bidi_p = 0;
7755 do
7756 {
7757 it->end_charpos = min (charpos + 1, ZV);
7758 charpos = max (charpos - SCAN_BACK_LIMIT, BEGV);
7759 SET_TEXT_POS (pos, charpos, BYTE_TO_CHAR (charpos));
7760 reseat_1 (it, pos, 0);
7761 compute_stop_pos (it);
7762 /* We must advance forward, right? */
7763 if (it->stop_charpos <= charpos)
7764 abort ();
7765 }
7766 while (charpos > BEGV && it->stop_charpos >= it->end_charpos);
7767
7768 if (it->stop_charpos <= where_we_are)
7769 it->prev_stop = it->stop_charpos;
7770 else
7771 it->prev_stop = BEGV;
7772 it->bidi_p = 1;
7773 it->current = save_current;
7774 it->position = save_position;
7775 it->stop_charpos = save_stop_pos;
7776 it->end_charpos = save_end_pos;
7777 }
7778
7779 /* Scan forward from CHARPOS in the current buffer/string, until we
7780 find a stop position > current IT's position. Then handle the stop
7781 position before that. This is called when we bump into a stop
7782 position while reordering bidirectional text. CHARPOS should be
7783 the last previously processed stop_pos (or BEGV/0, if none were
7784 processed yet) whose position is less that IT's current
7785 position. */
7786
7787 static void
7788 handle_stop_backwards (struct it *it, ptrdiff_t charpos)
7789 {
7790 int bufp = !STRINGP (it->string);
7791 ptrdiff_t where_we_are = (bufp ? IT_CHARPOS (*it) : IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it));
7792 struct display_pos save_current = it->current;
7793 struct text_pos save_position = it->position;
7794 struct text_pos pos1;
7795 ptrdiff_t next_stop;
7796
7797 /* Scan in strict logical order. */
7798 eassert (it->bidi_p);
7799 it->bidi_p = 0;
7800 do
7801 {
7802 it->prev_stop = charpos;
7803 if (bufp)
7804 {
7805 SET_TEXT_POS (pos1, charpos, CHAR_TO_BYTE (charpos));
7806 reseat_1 (it, pos1, 0);
7807 }
7808 else
7809 it->current.string_pos = string_pos (charpos, it->string);
7810 compute_stop_pos (it);
7811 /* We must advance forward, right? */
7812 if (it->stop_charpos <= it->prev_stop)
7813 abort ();
7814 charpos = it->stop_charpos;
7815 }
7816 while (charpos <= where_we_are);
7817
7818 it->bidi_p = 1;
7819 it->current = save_current;
7820 it->position = save_position;
7821 next_stop = it->stop_charpos;
7822 it->stop_charpos = it->prev_stop;
7823 handle_stop (it);
7824 it->stop_charpos = next_stop;
7825 }
7826
7827 /* Load IT with the next display element from current_buffer. Value
7828 is zero if end of buffer reached. IT->stop_charpos is the next
7829 position at which to stop and check for text properties or buffer
7830 end. */
7831
7832 static int
7833 next_element_from_buffer (struct it *it)
7834 {
7835 int success_p = 1;
7836
7837 eassert (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= BEGV);
7838 eassert (NILP (it->string) && !it->s);
7839 eassert (!it->bidi_p
7840 || (EQ (it->bidi_it.string.lstring, Qnil)
7841 && it->bidi_it.string.s == NULL));
7842
7843 /* With bidi reordering, the character to display might not be the
7844 character at IT_CHARPOS. BIDI_IT.FIRST_ELT non-zero means that
7845 we were reseat()ed to a new buffer position, which is potentially
7846 a different paragraph. */
7847 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.first_elt)
7848 {
7849 get_visually_first_element (it);
7850 SET_TEXT_POS (it->position, IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
7851 }
7852
7853 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->stop_charpos)
7854 {
7855 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->end_charpos)
7856 {
7857 int overlay_strings_follow_p;
7858
7859 /* End of the game, except when overlay strings follow that
7860 haven't been returned yet. */
7861 if (it->overlay_strings_at_end_processed_p)
7862 overlay_strings_follow_p = 0;
7863 else
7864 {
7865 it->overlay_strings_at_end_processed_p = 1;
7866 overlay_strings_follow_p = get_overlay_strings (it, 0);
7867 }
7868
7869 if (overlay_strings_follow_p)
7870 success_p = GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
7871 else
7872 {
7873 it->what = IT_EOB;
7874 it->position = it->current.pos;
7875 success_p = 0;
7876 }
7877 }
7878 else if (!(!it->bidi_p
7879 || BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it)
7880 || IT_CHARPOS (*it) == it->stop_charpos))
7881 {
7882 /* With bidi non-linear iteration, we could find ourselves
7883 far beyond the last computed stop_charpos, with several
7884 other stop positions in between that we missed. Scan
7885 them all now, in buffer's logical order, until we find
7886 and handle the last stop_charpos that precedes our
7887 current position. */
7888 handle_stop_backwards (it, it->stop_charpos);
7889 return GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
7890 }
7891 else
7892 {
7893 if (it->bidi_p)
7894 {
7895 /* Take note of the stop position we just moved across,
7896 for when we will move back across it. */
7897 it->prev_stop = it->stop_charpos;
7898 /* If we are at base paragraph embedding level, take
7899 note of the last stop position seen at this
7900 level. */
7901 if (BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it))
7902 it->base_level_stop = it->stop_charpos;
7903 }
7904 handle_stop (it);
7905 return GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
7906 }
7907 }
7908 else if (it->bidi_p
7909 /* If we are before prev_stop, we may have overstepped on
7910 our way backwards a stop_pos, and if so, we need to
7911 handle that stop_pos. */
7912 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) < it->prev_stop
7913 /* We can sometimes back up for reasons that have nothing
7914 to do with bidi reordering. E.g., compositions. The
7915 code below is only needed when we are above the base
7916 embedding level, so test for that explicitly. */
7917 && !BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it))
7918 {
7919 if (it->base_level_stop <= 0
7920 || IT_CHARPOS (*it) < it->base_level_stop)
7921 {
7922 /* If we lost track of base_level_stop, we need to find
7923 prev_stop by looking backwards. This happens, e.g., when
7924 we were reseated to the previous screenful of text by
7925 vertical-motion. */
7926 it->base_level_stop = BEGV;
7927 compute_stop_pos_backwards (it);
7928 handle_stop_backwards (it, it->prev_stop);
7929 }
7930 else
7931 handle_stop_backwards (it, it->base_level_stop);
7932 return GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
7933 }
7934 else
7935 {
7936 /* No face changes, overlays etc. in sight, so just return a
7937 character from current_buffer. */
7938 unsigned char *p;
7939 ptrdiff_t stop;
7940
7941 /* Maybe run the redisplay end trigger hook. Performance note:
7942 This doesn't seem to cost measurable time. */
7943 if (it->redisplay_end_trigger_charpos
7944 && it->glyph_row
7945 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->redisplay_end_trigger_charpos)
7946 run_redisplay_end_trigger_hook (it);
7947
7948 stop = it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0 ? -1 : it->end_charpos;
7949 if (CHAR_COMPOSED_P (it, IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it),
7950 stop)
7951 && next_element_from_composition (it))
7952 {
7953 return 1;
7954 }
7955
7956 /* Get the next character, maybe multibyte. */
7957 p = BYTE_POS_ADDR (IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
7958 if (it->multibyte_p && !ASCII_BYTE_P (*p))
7959 it->c = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (p, it->len);
7960 else
7961 it->c = *p, it->len = 1;
7962
7963 /* Record what we have and where it came from. */
7964 it->what = IT_CHARACTER;
7965 it->object = it->w->buffer;
7966 it->position = it->current.pos;
7967
7968 /* Normally we return the character found above, except when we
7969 really want to return an ellipsis for selective display. */
7970 if (it->selective)
7971 {
7972 if (it->c == '\n')
7973 {
7974 /* A value of selective > 0 means hide lines indented more
7975 than that number of columns. */
7976 if (it->selective > 0
7977 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) + 1 < ZV
7978 && indented_beyond_p (IT_CHARPOS (*it) + 1,
7979 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) + 1,
7980 it->selective))
7981 {
7982 success_p = next_element_from_ellipsis (it);
7983 it->dpvec_char_len = -1;
7984 }
7985 }
7986 else if (it->c == '\r' && it->selective == -1)
7987 {
7988 /* A value of selective == -1 means that everything from the
7989 CR to the end of the line is invisible, with maybe an
7990 ellipsis displayed for it. */
7991 success_p = next_element_from_ellipsis (it);
7992 it->dpvec_char_len = -1;
7993 }
7994 }
7995 }
7996
7997 /* Value is zero if end of buffer reached. */
7998 eassert (!success_p || it->what != IT_CHARACTER || it->len > 0);
7999 return success_p;
8000 }
8001
8002
8003 /* Run the redisplay end trigger hook for IT. */
8004
8005 static void
8006 run_redisplay_end_trigger_hook (struct it *it)
8007 {
8008 Lisp_Object args[3];
8009
8010 /* IT->glyph_row should be non-null, i.e. we should be actually
8011 displaying something, or otherwise we should not run the hook. */
8012 eassert (it->glyph_row);
8013
8014 /* Set up hook arguments. */
8015 args[0] = Qredisplay_end_trigger_functions;
8016 args[1] = it->window;
8017 XSETINT (args[2], it->redisplay_end_trigger_charpos);
8018 it->redisplay_end_trigger_charpos = 0;
8019
8020 /* Since we are *trying* to run these functions, don't try to run
8021 them again, even if they get an error. */
8022 wset_redisplay_end_trigger (it->w, Qnil);
8023 Frun_hook_with_args (3, args);
8024
8025 /* Notice if it changed the face of the character we are on. */
8026 handle_face_prop (it);
8027 }
8028
8029
8030 /* Deliver a composition display element. Unlike the other
8031 next_element_from_XXX, this function is not registered in the array
8032 get_next_element[]. It is called from next_element_from_buffer and
8033 next_element_from_string when necessary. */
8034
8035 static int
8036 next_element_from_composition (struct it *it)
8037 {
8038 it->what = IT_COMPOSITION;
8039 it->len = it->cmp_it.nbytes;
8040 if (STRINGP (it->string))
8041 {
8042 if (it->c < 0)
8043 {
8044 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nchars;
8045 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nbytes;
8046 return 0;
8047 }
8048 it->position = it->current.string_pos;
8049 it->object = it->string;
8050 it->c = composition_update_it (&it->cmp_it, IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
8051 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it), it->string);
8052 }
8053 else
8054 {
8055 if (it->c < 0)
8056 {
8057 IT_CHARPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nchars;
8058 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nbytes;
8059 if (it->bidi_p)
8060 {
8061 if (it->bidi_it.new_paragraph)
8062 bidi_paragraph_init (it->paragraph_embedding, &it->bidi_it, 0);
8063 /* Resync the bidi iterator with IT's new position.
8064 FIXME: this doesn't support bidirectional text. */
8065 while (it->bidi_it.charpos < IT_CHARPOS (*it))
8066 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
8067 }
8068 return 0;
8069 }
8070 it->position = it->current.pos;
8071 it->object = it->w->buffer;
8072 it->c = composition_update_it (&it->cmp_it, IT_CHARPOS (*it),
8073 IT_BYTEPOS (*it), Qnil);
8074 }
8075 return 1;
8076 }
8077
8078
8079 \f
8080 /***********************************************************************
8081 Moving an iterator without producing glyphs
8082 ***********************************************************************/
8083
8084 /* Check if iterator is at a position corresponding to a valid buffer
8085 position after some move_it_ call. */
8086
8087 #define IT_POS_VALID_AFTER_MOVE_P(it) \
8088 ((it)->method == GET_FROM_STRING \
8089 ? IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) == 0 \
8090 : 1)
8091
8092
8093 /* Move iterator IT to a specified buffer or X position within one
8094 line on the display without producing glyphs.
8095
8096 OP should be a bit mask including some or all of these bits:
8097 MOVE_TO_X: Stop upon reaching x-position TO_X.
8098 MOVE_TO_POS: Stop upon reaching buffer or string position TO_CHARPOS.
8099 Regardless of OP's value, stop upon reaching the end of the display line.
8100
8101 TO_X is normally a value 0 <= TO_X <= IT->last_visible_x.
8102 This means, in particular, that TO_X includes window's horizontal
8103 scroll amount.
8104
8105 The return value has several possible values that
8106 say what condition caused the scan to stop:
8107
8108 MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV
8109 - when TO_POS or ZV was reached.
8110
8111 MOVE_X_REACHED
8112 -when TO_X was reached before TO_POS or ZV were reached.
8113
8114 MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED
8115 - when we reached the end of the display area and the line must
8116 be continued.
8117
8118 MOVE_LINE_TRUNCATED
8119 - when we reached the end of the display area and the line is
8120 truncated.
8121
8122 MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR
8123 - when we stopped at a line end, i.e. a newline or a CR and selective
8124 display is on. */
8125
8126 static enum move_it_result
8127 move_it_in_display_line_to (struct it *it,
8128 ptrdiff_t to_charpos, int to_x,
8129 enum move_operation_enum op)
8130 {
8131 enum move_it_result result = MOVE_UNDEFINED;
8132 struct glyph_row *saved_glyph_row;
8133 struct it wrap_it, atpos_it, atx_it, ppos_it;
8134 void *wrap_data = NULL, *atpos_data = NULL, *atx_data = NULL;
8135 void *ppos_data = NULL;
8136 int may_wrap = 0;
8137 enum it_method prev_method = it->method;
8138 ptrdiff_t prev_pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
8139 int saw_smaller_pos = prev_pos < to_charpos;
8140
8141 /* Don't produce glyphs in produce_glyphs. */
8142 saved_glyph_row = it->glyph_row;
8143 it->glyph_row = NULL;
8144
8145 /* Use wrap_it to save a copy of IT wherever a word wrap could
8146 occur. Use atpos_it to save a copy of IT at the desired buffer
8147 position, if found, so that we can scan ahead and check if the
8148 word later overshoots the window edge. Use atx_it similarly, for
8149 pixel positions. */
8150 wrap_it.sp = -1;
8151 atpos_it.sp = -1;
8152 atx_it.sp = -1;
8153
8154 /* Use ppos_it under bidi reordering to save a copy of IT for the
8155 position > CHARPOS that is the closest to CHARPOS. We restore
8156 that position in IT when we have scanned the entire display line
8157 without finding a match for CHARPOS and all the character
8158 positions are greater than CHARPOS. */
8159 if (it->bidi_p)
8160 {
8161 SAVE_IT (ppos_it, *it, ppos_data);
8162 SET_TEXT_POS (ppos_it.current.pos, ZV, ZV_BYTE);
8163 if ((op & MOVE_TO_POS) && IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= to_charpos)
8164 SAVE_IT (ppos_it, *it, ppos_data);
8165 }
8166
8167 #define BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P() \
8168 ((op & MOVE_TO_POS) != 0 \
8169 && BUFFERP (it->object) \
8170 && (IT_CHARPOS (*it) == to_charpos \
8171 || ((!it->bidi_p \
8172 || BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it)) \
8173 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos) \
8174 || (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION \
8175 && ((IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos \
8176 && to_charpos >= it->cmp_it.charpos) \
8177 || (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < to_charpos \
8178 && to_charpos <= it->cmp_it.charpos)))) \
8179 && (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER \
8180 || (it->method == GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR \
8181 && it->dpvec + it->current.dpvec_index + 1 >= it->dpend)))
8182
8183 /* If there's a line-/wrap-prefix, handle it. */
8184 if (it->hpos == 0 && it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER
8185 && it->current_y < it->last_visible_y)
8186 handle_line_prefix (it);
8187
8188 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < CHARPOS (this_line_min_pos))
8189 SET_TEXT_POS (this_line_min_pos, IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
8190
8191 while (1)
8192 {
8193 int x, i, ascent = 0, descent = 0;
8194
8195 /* Utility macro to reset an iterator with x, ascent, and descent. */
8196 #define IT_RESET_X_ASCENT_DESCENT(IT) \
8197 ((IT)->current_x = x, (IT)->max_ascent = ascent, \
8198 (IT)->max_descent = descent)
8199
8200 /* Stop if we move beyond TO_CHARPOS (after an image or a
8201 display string or stretch glyph). */
8202 if ((op & MOVE_TO_POS) != 0
8203 && BUFFERP (it->object)
8204 && it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER
8205 && (((!it->bidi_p
8206 /* When the iterator is at base embedding level, we
8207 are guaranteed that characters are delivered for
8208 display in strictly increasing order of their
8209 buffer positions. */
8210 || BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it))
8211 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos)
8212 || (it->bidi_p
8213 && (prev_method == GET_FROM_IMAGE
8214 || prev_method == GET_FROM_STRETCH
8215 || prev_method == GET_FROM_STRING)
8216 /* Passed TO_CHARPOS from left to right. */
8217 && ((prev_pos < to_charpos
8218 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos)
8219 /* Passed TO_CHARPOS from right to left. */
8220 || (prev_pos > to_charpos
8221 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) < to_charpos)))))
8222 {
8223 if (it->line_wrap != WORD_WRAP || wrap_it.sp < 0)
8224 {
8225 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8226 break;
8227 }
8228 else if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP && atpos_it.sp < 0)
8229 /* If wrap_it is valid, the current position might be in a
8230 word that is wrapped. So, save the iterator in
8231 atpos_it and continue to see if wrapping happens. */
8232 SAVE_IT (atpos_it, *it, atpos_data);
8233 }
8234
8235 /* Stop when ZV reached.
8236 We used to stop here when TO_CHARPOS reached as well, but that is
8237 too soon if this glyph does not fit on this line. So we handle it
8238 explicitly below. */
8239 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
8240 {
8241 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8242 break;
8243 }
8244
8245 if (it->line_wrap == TRUNCATE)
8246 {
8247 if (BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P ())
8248 {
8249 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8250 break;
8251 }
8252 }
8253 else
8254 {
8255 if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP)
8256 {
8257 if (IT_DISPLAYING_WHITESPACE (it))
8258 may_wrap = 1;
8259 else if (may_wrap)
8260 {
8261 /* We have reached a glyph that follows one or more
8262 whitespace characters. If the position is
8263 already found, we are done. */
8264 if (atpos_it.sp >= 0)
8265 {
8266 RESTORE_IT (it, &atpos_it, atpos_data);
8267 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8268 goto done;
8269 }
8270 if (atx_it.sp >= 0)
8271 {
8272 RESTORE_IT (it, &atx_it, atx_data);
8273 result = MOVE_X_REACHED;
8274 goto done;
8275 }
8276 /* Otherwise, we can wrap here. */
8277 SAVE_IT (wrap_it, *it, wrap_data);
8278 may_wrap = 0;
8279 }
8280 }
8281 }
8282
8283 /* Remember the line height for the current line, in case
8284 the next element doesn't fit on the line. */
8285 ascent = it->max_ascent;
8286 descent = it->max_descent;
8287
8288 /* The call to produce_glyphs will get the metrics of the
8289 display element IT is loaded with. Record the x-position
8290 before this display element, in case it doesn't fit on the
8291 line. */
8292 x = it->current_x;
8293
8294 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
8295
8296 if (it->area != TEXT_AREA)
8297 {
8298 prev_method = it->method;
8299 if (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER)
8300 prev_pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
8301 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
8302 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < CHARPOS (this_line_min_pos))
8303 SET_TEXT_POS (this_line_min_pos,
8304 IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
8305 if (it->bidi_p
8306 && (op & MOVE_TO_POS)
8307 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos
8308 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) < IT_CHARPOS (ppos_it))
8309 SAVE_IT (ppos_it, *it, ppos_data);
8310 continue;
8311 }
8312
8313 /* The number of glyphs we get back in IT->nglyphs will normally
8314 be 1 except when IT->c is (i) a TAB, or (ii) a multi-glyph
8315 character on a terminal frame, or (iii) a line end. For the
8316 second case, IT->nglyphs - 1 padding glyphs will be present.
8317 (On X frames, there is only one glyph produced for a
8318 composite character.)
8319
8320 The behavior implemented below means, for continuation lines,
8321 that as many spaces of a TAB as fit on the current line are
8322 displayed there. For terminal frames, as many glyphs of a
8323 multi-glyph character are displayed in the current line, too.
8324 This is what the old redisplay code did, and we keep it that
8325 way. Under X, the whole shape of a complex character must
8326 fit on the line or it will be completely displayed in the
8327 next line.
8328
8329 Note that both for tabs and padding glyphs, all glyphs have
8330 the same width. */
8331 if (it->nglyphs)
8332 {
8333 /* More than one glyph or glyph doesn't fit on line. All
8334 glyphs have the same width. */
8335 int single_glyph_width = it->pixel_width / it->nglyphs;
8336 int new_x;
8337 int x_before_this_char = x;
8338 int hpos_before_this_char = it->hpos;
8339
8340 for (i = 0; i < it->nglyphs; ++i, x = new_x)
8341 {
8342 new_x = x + single_glyph_width;
8343
8344 /* We want to leave anything reaching TO_X to the caller. */
8345 if ((op & MOVE_TO_X) && new_x > to_x)
8346 {
8347 if (BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P ())
8348 {
8349 if (it->line_wrap != WORD_WRAP || wrap_it.sp < 0)
8350 goto buffer_pos_reached;
8351 if (atpos_it.sp < 0)
8352 {
8353 SAVE_IT (atpos_it, *it, atpos_data);
8354 IT_RESET_X_ASCENT_DESCENT (&atpos_it);
8355 }
8356 }
8357 else
8358 {
8359 if (it->line_wrap != WORD_WRAP || wrap_it.sp < 0)
8360 {
8361 it->current_x = x;
8362 result = MOVE_X_REACHED;
8363 break;
8364 }
8365 if (atx_it.sp < 0)
8366 {
8367 SAVE_IT (atx_it, *it, atx_data);
8368 IT_RESET_X_ASCENT_DESCENT (&atx_it);
8369 }
8370 }
8371 }
8372
8373 if (/* Lines are continued. */
8374 it->line_wrap != TRUNCATE
8375 && (/* And glyph doesn't fit on the line. */
8376 new_x > it->last_visible_x
8377 /* Or it fits exactly and we're on a window
8378 system frame. */
8379 || (new_x == it->last_visible_x
8380 && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
8381 && ((it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L)
8382 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
8383 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)))))
8384 {
8385 if (/* IT->hpos == 0 means the very first glyph
8386 doesn't fit on the line, e.g. a wide image. */
8387 it->hpos == 0
8388 || (new_x == it->last_visible_x
8389 && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)))
8390 {
8391 ++it->hpos;
8392 it->current_x = new_x;
8393
8394 /* The character's last glyph just barely fits
8395 in this row. */
8396 if (i == it->nglyphs - 1)
8397 {
8398 /* If this is the destination position,
8399 return a position *before* it in this row,
8400 now that we know it fits in this row. */
8401 if (BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P ())
8402 {
8403 if (it->line_wrap != WORD_WRAP
8404 || wrap_it.sp < 0)
8405 {
8406 it->hpos = hpos_before_this_char;
8407 it->current_x = x_before_this_char;
8408 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8409 break;
8410 }
8411 if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP
8412 && atpos_it.sp < 0)
8413 {
8414 SAVE_IT (atpos_it, *it, atpos_data);
8415 atpos_it.current_x = x_before_this_char;
8416 atpos_it.hpos = hpos_before_this_char;
8417 }
8418 }
8419
8420 prev_method = it->method;
8421 if (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER)
8422 prev_pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
8423 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
8424 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < CHARPOS (this_line_min_pos))
8425 SET_TEXT_POS (this_line_min_pos,
8426 IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
8427 /* On graphical terminals, newlines may
8428 "overflow" into the fringe if
8429 overflow-newline-into-fringe is non-nil.
8430 On text terminals, and on graphical
8431 terminals with no right margin, newlines
8432 may overflow into the last glyph on the
8433 display line.*/
8434 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
8435 || ((it->bidi_p
8436 && it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L)
8437 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
8438 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)) == 0
8439 || IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE (it))
8440 {
8441 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
8442 {
8443 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8444 break;
8445 }
8446 if (BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P ())
8447 {
8448 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
8449 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8450 else
8451 result = MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED;
8452 break;
8453 }
8454 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
8455 {
8456 result = MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR;
8457 break;
8458 }
8459 }
8460 }
8461 }
8462 else
8463 IT_RESET_X_ASCENT_DESCENT (it);
8464
8465 if (wrap_it.sp >= 0)
8466 {
8467 RESTORE_IT (it, &wrap_it, wrap_data);
8468 atpos_it.sp = -1;
8469 atx_it.sp = -1;
8470 }
8471
8472 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it_in: continued at %d\n",
8473 IT_CHARPOS (*it)));
8474 result = MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED;
8475 break;
8476 }
8477
8478 if (BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P ())
8479 {
8480 if (it->line_wrap != WORD_WRAP || wrap_it.sp < 0)
8481 goto buffer_pos_reached;
8482 if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP && atpos_it.sp < 0)
8483 {
8484 SAVE_IT (atpos_it, *it, atpos_data);
8485 IT_RESET_X_ASCENT_DESCENT (&atpos_it);
8486 }
8487 }
8488
8489 if (new_x > it->first_visible_x)
8490 {
8491 /* Glyph is visible. Increment number of glyphs that
8492 would be displayed. */
8493 ++it->hpos;
8494 }
8495 }
8496
8497 if (result != MOVE_UNDEFINED)
8498 break;
8499 }
8500 else if (BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P ())
8501 {
8502 buffer_pos_reached:
8503 IT_RESET_X_ASCENT_DESCENT (it);
8504 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8505 break;
8506 }
8507 else if ((op & MOVE_TO_X) && it->current_x >= to_x)
8508 {
8509 /* Stop when TO_X specified and reached. This check is
8510 necessary here because of lines consisting of a line end,
8511 only. The line end will not produce any glyphs and we
8512 would never get MOVE_X_REACHED. */
8513 eassert (it->nglyphs == 0);
8514 result = MOVE_X_REACHED;
8515 break;
8516 }
8517
8518 /* Is this a line end? If yes, we're done. */
8519 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
8520 {
8521 /* If we are past TO_CHARPOS, but never saw any character
8522 positions smaller than TO_CHARPOS, return
8523 MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV, like the unidirectional display
8524 did. */
8525 if (it->bidi_p && (op & MOVE_TO_POS) != 0)
8526 {
8527 if (!saw_smaller_pos && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos)
8528 {
8529 if (IT_CHARPOS (ppos_it) < ZV)
8530 {
8531 RESTORE_IT (it, &ppos_it, ppos_data);
8532 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8533 }
8534 else
8535 goto buffer_pos_reached;
8536 }
8537 else if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP && atpos_it.sp >= 0
8538 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos)
8539 goto buffer_pos_reached;
8540 else
8541 result = MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR;
8542 }
8543 else
8544 result = MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR;
8545 break;
8546 }
8547
8548 prev_method = it->method;
8549 if (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER)
8550 prev_pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
8551 /* The current display element has been consumed. Advance
8552 to the next. */
8553 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
8554 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < CHARPOS (this_line_min_pos))
8555 SET_TEXT_POS (this_line_min_pos, IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
8556 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < to_charpos)
8557 saw_smaller_pos = 1;
8558 if (it->bidi_p
8559 && (op & MOVE_TO_POS)
8560 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= to_charpos
8561 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) < IT_CHARPOS (ppos_it))
8562 SAVE_IT (ppos_it, *it, ppos_data);
8563
8564 /* Stop if lines are truncated and IT's current x-position is
8565 past the right edge of the window now. */
8566 if (it->line_wrap == TRUNCATE
8567 && it->current_x >= it->last_visible_x)
8568 {
8569 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
8570 || ((it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L)
8571 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
8572 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)) == 0
8573 || IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE (it))
8574 {
8575 int at_eob_p = 0;
8576
8577 if ((at_eob_p = !get_next_display_element (it))
8578 || BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P ()
8579 /* If we are past TO_CHARPOS, but never saw any
8580 character positions smaller than TO_CHARPOS,
8581 return MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV, like the
8582 unidirectional display did. */
8583 || (it->bidi_p && (op & MOVE_TO_POS) != 0
8584 && !saw_smaller_pos
8585 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos))
8586 {
8587 if (it->bidi_p
8588 && !at_eob_p && IT_CHARPOS (ppos_it) < ZV)
8589 RESTORE_IT (it, &ppos_it, ppos_data);
8590 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8591 break;
8592 }
8593 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
8594 {
8595 result = MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR;
8596 break;
8597 }
8598 }
8599 else if (it->bidi_p && (op & MOVE_TO_POS) != 0
8600 && !saw_smaller_pos
8601 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos)
8602 {
8603 if (IT_CHARPOS (ppos_it) < ZV)
8604 RESTORE_IT (it, &ppos_it, ppos_data);
8605 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8606 break;
8607 }
8608 result = MOVE_LINE_TRUNCATED;
8609 break;
8610 }
8611 #undef IT_RESET_X_ASCENT_DESCENT
8612 }
8613
8614 #undef BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P
8615
8616 /* If we scanned beyond to_pos and didn't find a point to wrap at,
8617 restore the saved iterator. */
8618 if (atpos_it.sp >= 0)
8619 RESTORE_IT (it, &atpos_it, atpos_data);
8620 else if (atx_it.sp >= 0)
8621 RESTORE_IT (it, &atx_it, atx_data);
8622
8623 done:
8624
8625 if (atpos_data)
8626 bidi_unshelve_cache (atpos_data, 1);
8627 if (atx_data)
8628 bidi_unshelve_cache (atx_data, 1);
8629 if (wrap_data)
8630 bidi_unshelve_cache (wrap_data, 1);
8631 if (ppos_data)
8632 bidi_unshelve_cache (ppos_data, 1);
8633
8634 /* Restore the iterator settings altered at the beginning of this
8635 function. */
8636 it->glyph_row = saved_glyph_row;
8637 return result;
8638 }
8639
8640 /* For external use. */
8641 void
8642 move_it_in_display_line (struct it *it,
8643 ptrdiff_t to_charpos, int to_x,
8644 enum move_operation_enum op)
8645 {
8646 if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP
8647 && (op & MOVE_TO_X))
8648 {
8649 struct it save_it;
8650 void *save_data = NULL;
8651 int skip;
8652
8653 SAVE_IT (save_it, *it, save_data);
8654 skip = move_it_in_display_line_to (it, to_charpos, to_x, op);
8655 /* When word-wrap is on, TO_X may lie past the end
8656 of a wrapped line. Then it->current is the
8657 character on the next line, so backtrack to the
8658 space before the wrap point. */
8659 if (skip == MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED)
8660 {
8661 int prev_x = max (it->current_x - 1, 0);
8662 RESTORE_IT (it, &save_it, save_data);
8663 move_it_in_display_line_to
8664 (it, -1, prev_x, MOVE_TO_X);
8665 }
8666 else
8667 bidi_unshelve_cache (save_data, 1);
8668 }
8669 else
8670 move_it_in_display_line_to (it, to_charpos, to_x, op);
8671 }
8672
8673
8674 /* Move IT forward until it satisfies one or more of the criteria in
8675 TO_CHARPOS, TO_X, TO_Y, and TO_VPOS.
8676
8677 OP is a bit-mask that specifies where to stop, and in particular,
8678 which of those four position arguments makes a difference. See the
8679 description of enum move_operation_enum.
8680
8681 If TO_CHARPOS is in invisible text, e.g. a truncated part of a
8682 screen line, this function will set IT to the next position that is
8683 displayed to the right of TO_CHARPOS on the screen. */
8684
8685 void
8686 move_it_to (struct it *it, ptrdiff_t to_charpos, int to_x, int to_y, int to_vpos, int op)
8687 {
8688 enum move_it_result skip, skip2 = MOVE_X_REACHED;
8689 int line_height, line_start_x = 0, reached = 0;
8690 void *backup_data = NULL;
8691
8692 for (;;)
8693 {
8694 if (op & MOVE_TO_VPOS)
8695 {
8696 /* If no TO_CHARPOS and no TO_X specified, stop at the
8697 start of the line TO_VPOS. */
8698 if ((op & (MOVE_TO_X | MOVE_TO_POS)) == 0)
8699 {
8700 if (it->vpos == to_vpos)
8701 {
8702 reached = 1;
8703 break;
8704 }
8705 else
8706 skip = move_it_in_display_line_to (it, -1, -1, 0);
8707 }
8708 else
8709 {
8710 /* TO_VPOS >= 0 means stop at TO_X in the line at
8711 TO_VPOS, or at TO_POS, whichever comes first. */
8712 if (it->vpos == to_vpos)
8713 {
8714 reached = 2;
8715 break;
8716 }
8717
8718 skip = move_it_in_display_line_to (it, to_charpos, to_x, op);
8719
8720 if (skip == MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV || it->vpos == to_vpos)
8721 {
8722 reached = 3;
8723 break;
8724 }
8725 else if (skip == MOVE_X_REACHED && it->vpos != to_vpos)
8726 {
8727 /* We have reached TO_X but not in the line we want. */
8728 skip = move_it_in_display_line_to (it, to_charpos,
8729 -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
8730 if (skip == MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV)
8731 {
8732 reached = 4;
8733 break;
8734 }
8735 }
8736 }
8737 }
8738 else if (op & MOVE_TO_Y)
8739 {
8740 struct it it_backup;
8741
8742 if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP)
8743 SAVE_IT (it_backup, *it, backup_data);
8744
8745 /* TO_Y specified means stop at TO_X in the line containing
8746 TO_Y---or at TO_CHARPOS if this is reached first. The
8747 problem is that we can't really tell whether the line
8748 contains TO_Y before we have completely scanned it, and
8749 this may skip past TO_X. What we do is to first scan to
8750 TO_X.
8751
8752 If TO_X is not specified, use a TO_X of zero. The reason
8753 is to make the outcome of this function more predictable.
8754 If we didn't use TO_X == 0, we would stop at the end of
8755 the line which is probably not what a caller would expect
8756 to happen. */
8757 skip = move_it_in_display_line_to
8758 (it, to_charpos, ((op & MOVE_TO_X) ? to_x : 0),
8759 (MOVE_TO_X | (op & MOVE_TO_POS)));
8760
8761 /* If TO_CHARPOS is reached or ZV, we don't have to do more. */
8762 if (skip == MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV)
8763 reached = 5;
8764 else if (skip == MOVE_X_REACHED)
8765 {
8766 /* If TO_X was reached, we want to know whether TO_Y is
8767 in the line. We know this is the case if the already
8768 scanned glyphs make the line tall enough. Otherwise,
8769 we must check by scanning the rest of the line. */
8770 line_height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
8771 if (to_y >= it->current_y
8772 && to_y < it->current_y + line_height)
8773 {
8774 reached = 6;
8775 break;
8776 }
8777 SAVE_IT (it_backup, *it, backup_data);
8778 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it: from %d\n", IT_CHARPOS (*it)));
8779 skip2 = move_it_in_display_line_to (it, to_charpos, -1,
8780 op & MOVE_TO_POS);
8781 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it: to %d\n", IT_CHARPOS (*it)));
8782 line_height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
8783 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it: line_height = %d\n", line_height));
8784
8785 if (to_y >= it->current_y
8786 && to_y < it->current_y + line_height)
8787 {
8788 /* If TO_Y is in this line and TO_X was reached
8789 above, we scanned too far. We have to restore
8790 IT's settings to the ones before skipping. But
8791 keep the more accurate values of max_ascent and
8792 max_descent we've found while skipping the rest
8793 of the line, for the sake of callers, such as
8794 pos_visible_p, that need to know the line
8795 height. */
8796 int max_ascent = it->max_ascent;
8797 int max_descent = it->max_descent;
8798
8799 RESTORE_IT (it, &it_backup, backup_data);
8800 it->max_ascent = max_ascent;
8801 it->max_descent = max_descent;
8802 reached = 6;
8803 }
8804 else
8805 {
8806 skip = skip2;
8807 if (skip == MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV)
8808 reached = 7;
8809 }
8810 }
8811 else
8812 {
8813 /* Check whether TO_Y is in this line. */
8814 line_height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
8815 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it: line_height = %d\n", line_height));
8816
8817 if (to_y >= it->current_y
8818 && to_y < it->current_y + line_height)
8819 {
8820 /* When word-wrap is on, TO_X may lie past the end
8821 of a wrapped line. Then it->current is the
8822 character on the next line, so backtrack to the
8823 space before the wrap point. */
8824 if (skip == MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED
8825 && it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP)
8826 {
8827 int prev_x = max (it->current_x - 1, 0);
8828 RESTORE_IT (it, &it_backup, backup_data);
8829 skip = move_it_in_display_line_to
8830 (it, -1, prev_x, MOVE_TO_X);
8831 }
8832 reached = 6;
8833 }
8834 }
8835
8836 if (reached)
8837 break;
8838 }
8839 else if (BUFFERP (it->object)
8840 && (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER
8841 || it->method == GET_FROM_STRETCH)
8842 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= to_charpos
8843 /* Under bidi iteration, a call to set_iterator_to_next
8844 can scan far beyond to_charpos if the initial
8845 portion of the next line needs to be reordered. In
8846 that case, give move_it_in_display_line_to another
8847 chance below. */
8848 && !(it->bidi_p
8849 && it->bidi_it.scan_dir == -1))
8850 skip = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8851 else
8852 skip = move_it_in_display_line_to (it, to_charpos, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
8853
8854 switch (skip)
8855 {
8856 case MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV:
8857 reached = 8;
8858 goto out;
8859
8860 case MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR:
8861 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
8862 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
8863 break;
8864
8865 case MOVE_LINE_TRUNCATED:
8866 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
8867 reseat_at_next_visible_line_start (it, 0);
8868 if ((op & MOVE_TO_POS) != 0
8869 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos)
8870 {
8871 reached = 9;
8872 goto out;
8873 }
8874 break;
8875
8876 case MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED:
8877 /* For continued lines ending in a tab, some of the glyphs
8878 associated with the tab are displayed on the current
8879 line. Since it->current_x does not include these glyphs,
8880 we use it->last_visible_x instead. */
8881 if (it->c == '\t')
8882 {
8883 it->continuation_lines_width += it->last_visible_x;
8884 /* When moving by vpos, ensure that the iterator really
8885 advances to the next line (bug#847, bug#969). Fixme:
8886 do we need to do this in other circumstances? */
8887 if (it->current_x != it->last_visible_x
8888 && (op & MOVE_TO_VPOS)
8889 && !(op & (MOVE_TO_X | MOVE_TO_POS)))
8890 {
8891 line_start_x = it->current_x + it->pixel_width
8892 - it->last_visible_x;
8893 set_iterator_to_next (it, 0);
8894 }
8895 }
8896 else
8897 it->continuation_lines_width += it->current_x;
8898 break;
8899
8900 default:
8901 abort ();
8902 }
8903
8904 /* Reset/increment for the next run. */
8905 recenter_overlay_lists (current_buffer, IT_CHARPOS (*it));
8906 it->current_x = line_start_x;
8907 line_start_x = 0;
8908 it->hpos = 0;
8909 it->current_y += it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
8910 ++it->vpos;
8911 last_height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
8912 last_max_ascent = it->max_ascent;
8913 it->max_ascent = it->max_descent = 0;
8914 }
8915
8916 out:
8917
8918 /* On text terminals, we may stop at the end of a line in the middle
8919 of a multi-character glyph. If the glyph itself is continued,
8920 i.e. it is actually displayed on the next line, don't treat this
8921 stopping point as valid; move to the next line instead (unless
8922 that brings us offscreen). */
8923 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
8924 && op & MOVE_TO_POS
8925 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) == to_charpos
8926 && it->what == IT_CHARACTER
8927 && it->nglyphs > 1
8928 && it->line_wrap == WINDOW_WRAP
8929 && it->current_x == it->last_visible_x - 1
8930 && it->c != '\n'
8931 && it->c != '\t'
8932 && it->vpos < XFASTINT (it->w->window_end_vpos))
8933 {
8934 it->continuation_lines_width += it->current_x;
8935 it->current_x = it->hpos = it->max_ascent = it->max_descent = 0;
8936 it->current_y += it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
8937 ++it->vpos;
8938 last_height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
8939 last_max_ascent = it->max_ascent;
8940 }
8941
8942 if (backup_data)
8943 bidi_unshelve_cache (backup_data, 1);
8944
8945 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it_to: reached %d\n", reached));
8946 }
8947
8948
8949 /* Move iterator IT backward by a specified y-distance DY, DY >= 0.
8950
8951 If DY > 0, move IT backward at least that many pixels. DY = 0
8952 means move IT backward to the preceding line start or BEGV. This
8953 function may move over more than DY pixels if IT->current_y - DY
8954 ends up in the middle of a line; in this case IT->current_y will be
8955 set to the top of the line moved to. */
8956
8957 void
8958 move_it_vertically_backward (struct it *it, int dy)
8959 {
8960 int nlines, h;
8961 struct it it2, it3;
8962 void *it2data = NULL, *it3data = NULL;
8963 ptrdiff_t start_pos;
8964
8965 move_further_back:
8966 eassert (dy >= 0);
8967
8968 start_pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
8969
8970 /* Estimate how many newlines we must move back. */
8971 nlines = max (1, dy / FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (it->f));
8972
8973 /* Set the iterator's position that many lines back. */
8974 while (nlines-- && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > BEGV)
8975 back_to_previous_visible_line_start (it);
8976
8977 /* Reseat the iterator here. When moving backward, we don't want
8978 reseat to skip forward over invisible text, set up the iterator
8979 to deliver from overlay strings at the new position etc. So,
8980 use reseat_1 here. */
8981 reseat_1 (it, it->current.pos, 1);
8982
8983 /* We are now surely at a line start. */
8984 it->current_x = it->hpos = 0; /* FIXME: this is incorrect when bidi
8985 reordering is in effect. */
8986 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
8987
8988 /* Move forward and see what y-distance we moved. First move to the
8989 start of the next line so that we get its height. We need this
8990 height to be able to tell whether we reached the specified
8991 y-distance. */
8992 SAVE_IT (it2, *it, it2data);
8993 it2.max_ascent = it2.max_descent = 0;
8994 do
8995 {
8996 move_it_to (&it2, start_pos, -1, -1, it2.vpos + 1,
8997 MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_VPOS);
8998 }
8999 while (!(IT_POS_VALID_AFTER_MOVE_P (&it2)
9000 /* If we are in a display string which starts at START_POS,
9001 and that display string includes a newline, and we are
9002 right after that newline (i.e. at the beginning of a
9003 display line), exit the loop, because otherwise we will
9004 infloop, since move_it_to will see that it is already at
9005 START_POS and will not move. */
9006 || (it2.method == GET_FROM_STRING
9007 && IT_CHARPOS (it2) == start_pos
9008 && SREF (it2.string, IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (it2) - 1) == '\n')));
9009 eassert (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= BEGV);
9010 SAVE_IT (it3, it2, it3data);
9011
9012 move_it_to (&it2, start_pos, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
9013 eassert (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= BEGV);
9014 /* H is the actual vertical distance from the position in *IT
9015 and the starting position. */
9016 h = it2.current_y - it->current_y;
9017 /* NLINES is the distance in number of lines. */
9018 nlines = it2.vpos - it->vpos;
9019
9020 /* Correct IT's y and vpos position
9021 so that they are relative to the starting point. */
9022 it->vpos -= nlines;
9023 it->current_y -= h;
9024
9025 if (dy == 0)
9026 {
9027 /* DY == 0 means move to the start of the screen line. The
9028 value of nlines is > 0 if continuation lines were involved,
9029 or if the original IT position was at start of a line. */
9030 RESTORE_IT (it, it, it2data);
9031 if (nlines > 0)
9032 move_it_by_lines (it, nlines);
9033 /* The above code moves us to some position NLINES down,
9034 usually to its first glyph (leftmost in an L2R line), but
9035 that's not necessarily the start of the line, under bidi
9036 reordering. We want to get to the character position
9037 that is immediately after the newline of the previous
9038 line. */
9039 if (it->bidi_p
9040 && !it->continuation_lines_width
9041 && !STRINGP (it->string)
9042 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > BEGV
9043 && FETCH_BYTE (IT_BYTEPOS (*it) - 1) != '\n')
9044 {
9045 ptrdiff_t nl_pos =
9046 find_next_newline_no_quit (IT_CHARPOS (*it) - 1, -1);
9047
9048 move_it_to (it, nl_pos, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
9049 }
9050 bidi_unshelve_cache (it3data, 1);
9051 }
9052 else
9053 {
9054 /* The y-position we try to reach, relative to *IT.
9055 Note that H has been subtracted in front of the if-statement. */
9056 int target_y = it->current_y + h - dy;
9057 int y0 = it3.current_y;
9058 int y1;
9059 int line_height;
9060
9061 RESTORE_IT (&it3, &it3, it3data);
9062 y1 = line_bottom_y (&it3);
9063 line_height = y1 - y0;
9064 RESTORE_IT (it, it, it2data);
9065 /* If we did not reach target_y, try to move further backward if
9066 we can. If we moved too far backward, try to move forward. */
9067 if (target_y < it->current_y
9068 /* This is heuristic. In a window that's 3 lines high, with
9069 a line height of 13 pixels each, recentering with point
9070 on the bottom line will try to move -39/2 = 19 pixels
9071 backward. Try to avoid moving into the first line. */
9072 && (it->current_y - target_y
9073 > min (window_box_height (it->w), line_height * 2 / 3))
9074 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > BEGV)
9075 {
9076 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, " not far enough -> move_vert %d\n",
9077 target_y - it->current_y));
9078 dy = it->current_y - target_y;
9079 goto move_further_back;
9080 }
9081 else if (target_y >= it->current_y + line_height
9082 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) < ZV)
9083 {
9084 /* Should move forward by at least one line, maybe more.
9085
9086 Note: Calling move_it_by_lines can be expensive on
9087 terminal frames, where compute_motion is used (via
9088 vmotion) to do the job, when there are very long lines
9089 and truncate-lines is nil. That's the reason for
9090 treating terminal frames specially here. */
9091
9092 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
9093 move_it_vertically (it, target_y - (it->current_y + line_height));
9094 else
9095 {
9096 do
9097 {
9098 move_it_by_lines (it, 1);
9099 }
9100 while (target_y >= line_bottom_y (it) && IT_CHARPOS (*it) < ZV);
9101 }
9102 }
9103 }
9104 }
9105
9106
9107 /* Move IT by a specified amount of pixel lines DY. DY negative means
9108 move backwards. DY = 0 means move to start of screen line. At the
9109 end, IT will be on the start of a screen line. */
9110
9111 void
9112 move_it_vertically (struct it *it, int dy)
9113 {
9114 if (dy <= 0)
9115 move_it_vertically_backward (it, -dy);
9116 else
9117 {
9118 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it_v: from %d, %d\n", IT_CHARPOS (*it), dy));
9119 move_it_to (it, ZV, -1, it->current_y + dy, -1,
9120 MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_Y);
9121 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it_v: to %d\n", IT_CHARPOS (*it)));
9122
9123 /* If buffer ends in ZV without a newline, move to the start of
9124 the line to satisfy the post-condition. */
9125 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) == ZV
9126 && ZV > BEGV
9127 && FETCH_BYTE (IT_BYTEPOS (*it) - 1) != '\n')
9128 move_it_by_lines (it, 0);
9129 }
9130 }
9131
9132
9133 /* Move iterator IT past the end of the text line it is in. */
9134
9135 void
9136 move_it_past_eol (struct it *it)
9137 {
9138 enum move_it_result rc;
9139
9140 rc = move_it_in_display_line_to (it, Z, 0, MOVE_TO_POS);
9141 if (rc == MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR)
9142 set_iterator_to_next (it, 0);
9143 }
9144
9145
9146 /* Move IT by a specified number DVPOS of screen lines down. DVPOS
9147 negative means move up. DVPOS == 0 means move to the start of the
9148 screen line.
9149
9150 Optimization idea: If we would know that IT->f doesn't use
9151 a face with proportional font, we could be faster for
9152 truncate-lines nil. */
9153
9154 void
9155 move_it_by_lines (struct it *it, ptrdiff_t dvpos)
9156 {
9157
9158 /* The commented-out optimization uses vmotion on terminals. This
9159 gives bad results, because elements like it->what, on which
9160 callers such as pos_visible_p rely, aren't updated. */
9161 /* struct position pos;
9162 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
9163 {
9164 struct text_pos textpos;
9165
9166 pos = *vmotion (IT_CHARPOS (*it), dvpos, it->w);
9167 SET_TEXT_POS (textpos, pos.bufpos, pos.bytepos);
9168 reseat (it, textpos, 1);
9169 it->vpos += pos.vpos;
9170 it->current_y += pos.vpos;
9171 }
9172 else */
9173
9174 if (dvpos == 0)
9175 {
9176 /* DVPOS == 0 means move to the start of the screen line. */
9177 move_it_vertically_backward (it, 0);
9178 /* Let next call to line_bottom_y calculate real line height */
9179 last_height = 0;
9180 }
9181 else if (dvpos > 0)
9182 {
9183 move_it_to (it, -1, -1, -1, it->vpos + dvpos, MOVE_TO_VPOS);
9184 if (!IT_POS_VALID_AFTER_MOVE_P (it))
9185 {
9186 /* Only move to the next buffer position if we ended up in a
9187 string from display property, not in an overlay string
9188 (before-string or after-string). That is because the
9189 latter don't conceal the underlying buffer position, so
9190 we can ask to move the iterator to the exact position we
9191 are interested in. Note that, even if we are already at
9192 IT_CHARPOS (*it), the call below is not a no-op, as it
9193 will detect that we are at the end of the string, pop the
9194 iterator, and compute it->current_x and it->hpos
9195 correctly. */
9196 move_it_to (it, IT_CHARPOS (*it) + it->string_from_display_prop_p,
9197 -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
9198 }
9199 }
9200 else
9201 {
9202 struct it it2;
9203 void *it2data = NULL;
9204 ptrdiff_t start_charpos, i;
9205
9206 /* Start at the beginning of the screen line containing IT's
9207 position. This may actually move vertically backwards,
9208 in case of overlays, so adjust dvpos accordingly. */
9209 dvpos += it->vpos;
9210 move_it_vertically_backward (it, 0);
9211 dvpos -= it->vpos;
9212
9213 /* Go back -DVPOS visible lines and reseat the iterator there. */
9214 start_charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
9215 for (i = -dvpos; i > 0 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > BEGV; --i)
9216 back_to_previous_visible_line_start (it);
9217 reseat (it, it->current.pos, 1);
9218
9219 /* Move further back if we end up in a string or an image. */
9220 while (!IT_POS_VALID_AFTER_MOVE_P (it))
9221 {
9222 /* First try to move to start of display line. */
9223 dvpos += it->vpos;
9224 move_it_vertically_backward (it, 0);
9225 dvpos -= it->vpos;
9226 if (IT_POS_VALID_AFTER_MOVE_P (it))
9227 break;
9228 /* If start of line is still in string or image,
9229 move further back. */
9230 back_to_previous_visible_line_start (it);
9231 reseat (it, it->current.pos, 1);
9232 dvpos--;
9233 }
9234
9235 it->current_x = it->hpos = 0;
9236
9237 /* Above call may have moved too far if continuation lines
9238 are involved. Scan forward and see if it did. */
9239 SAVE_IT (it2, *it, it2data);
9240 it2.vpos = it2.current_y = 0;
9241 move_it_to (&it2, start_charpos, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
9242 it->vpos -= it2.vpos;
9243 it->current_y -= it2.current_y;
9244 it->current_x = it->hpos = 0;
9245
9246 /* If we moved too far back, move IT some lines forward. */
9247 if (it2.vpos > -dvpos)
9248 {
9249 int delta = it2.vpos + dvpos;
9250
9251 RESTORE_IT (&it2, &it2, it2data);
9252 SAVE_IT (it2, *it, it2data);
9253 move_it_to (it, -1, -1, -1, it->vpos + delta, MOVE_TO_VPOS);
9254 /* Move back again if we got too far ahead. */
9255 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= start_charpos)
9256 RESTORE_IT (it, &it2, it2data);
9257 else
9258 bidi_unshelve_cache (it2data, 1);
9259 }
9260 else
9261 RESTORE_IT (it, it, it2data);
9262 }
9263 }
9264
9265 /* Return 1 if IT points into the middle of a display vector. */
9266
9267 int
9268 in_display_vector_p (struct it *it)
9269 {
9270 return (it->method == GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR
9271 && it->current.dpvec_index > 0
9272 && it->dpvec + it->current.dpvec_index != it->dpend);
9273 }
9274
9275 \f
9276 /***********************************************************************
9277 Messages
9278 ***********************************************************************/
9279
9280
9281 /* Add a message with format string FORMAT and arguments ARG1 and ARG2
9282 to *Messages*. */
9283
9284 void
9285 add_to_log (const char *format, Lisp_Object arg1, Lisp_Object arg2)
9286 {
9287 Lisp_Object args[3];
9288 Lisp_Object msg, fmt;
9289 char *buffer;
9290 ptrdiff_t len;
9291 struct gcpro gcpro1, gcpro2, gcpro3, gcpro4;
9292 USE_SAFE_ALLOCA;
9293
9294 /* Do nothing if called asynchronously. Inserting text into
9295 a buffer may call after-change-functions and alike and
9296 that would means running Lisp asynchronously. */
9297 if (handling_signal)
9298 return;
9299
9300 fmt = msg = Qnil;
9301 GCPRO4 (fmt, msg, arg1, arg2);
9302
9303 args[0] = fmt = build_string (format);
9304 args[1] = arg1;
9305 args[2] = arg2;
9306 msg = Fformat (3, args);
9307
9308 len = SBYTES (msg) + 1;
9309 buffer = SAFE_ALLOCA (len);
9310 memcpy (buffer, SDATA (msg), len);
9311
9312 message_dolog (buffer, len - 1, 1, 0);
9313 SAFE_FREE ();
9314
9315 UNGCPRO;
9316 }
9317
9318
9319 /* Output a newline in the *Messages* buffer if "needs" one. */
9320
9321 void
9322 message_log_maybe_newline (void)
9323 {
9324 if (message_log_need_newline)
9325 message_dolog ("", 0, 1, 0);
9326 }
9327
9328
9329 /* Add a string M of length NBYTES to the message log, optionally
9330 terminated with a newline when NLFLAG is non-zero. MULTIBYTE, if
9331 nonzero, means interpret the contents of M as multibyte. This
9332 function calls low-level routines in order to bypass text property
9333 hooks, etc. which might not be safe to run.
9334
9335 This may GC (insert may run before/after change hooks),
9336 so the buffer M must NOT point to a Lisp string. */
9337
9338 void
9339 message_dolog (const char *m, ptrdiff_t nbytes, int nlflag, int multibyte)
9340 {
9341 const unsigned char *msg = (const unsigned char *) m;
9342
9343 if (!NILP (Vmemory_full))
9344 return;
9345
9346 if (!NILP (Vmessage_log_max))
9347 {
9348 struct buffer *oldbuf;
9349 Lisp_Object oldpoint, oldbegv, oldzv;
9350 int old_windows_or_buffers_changed = windows_or_buffers_changed;
9351 ptrdiff_t point_at_end = 0;
9352 ptrdiff_t zv_at_end = 0;
9353 Lisp_Object old_deactivate_mark, tem;
9354 struct gcpro gcpro1;
9355
9356 old_deactivate_mark = Vdeactivate_mark;
9357 oldbuf = current_buffer;
9358 Fset_buffer (Fget_buffer_create (Vmessages_buffer_name));
9359 bset_undo_list (current_buffer, Qt);
9360
9361 oldpoint = message_dolog_marker1;
9362 set_marker_restricted (oldpoint, make_number (PT), Qnil);
9363 oldbegv = message_dolog_marker2;
9364 set_marker_restricted (oldbegv, make_number (BEGV), Qnil);
9365 oldzv = message_dolog_marker3;
9366 set_marker_restricted (oldzv, make_number (ZV), Qnil);
9367 GCPRO1 (old_deactivate_mark);
9368
9369 if (PT == Z)
9370 point_at_end = 1;
9371 if (ZV == Z)
9372 zv_at_end = 1;
9373
9374 BEGV = BEG;
9375 BEGV_BYTE = BEG_BYTE;
9376 ZV = Z;
9377 ZV_BYTE = Z_BYTE;
9378 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (Z, Z_BYTE);
9379
9380 /* Insert the string--maybe converting multibyte to single byte
9381 or vice versa, so that all the text fits the buffer. */
9382 if (multibyte
9383 && NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters)))
9384 {
9385 ptrdiff_t i;
9386 int c, char_bytes;
9387 char work[1];
9388
9389 /* Convert a multibyte string to single-byte
9390 for the *Message* buffer. */
9391 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += char_bytes)
9392 {
9393 c = string_char_and_length (msg + i, &char_bytes);
9394 work[0] = (ASCII_CHAR_P (c)
9395 ? c
9396 : multibyte_char_to_unibyte (c));
9397 insert_1_both (work, 1, 1, 1, 0, 0);
9398 }
9399 }
9400 else if (! multibyte
9401 && ! NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters)))
9402 {
9403 ptrdiff_t i;
9404 int c, char_bytes;
9405 unsigned char str[MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH];
9406 /* Convert a single-byte string to multibyte
9407 for the *Message* buffer. */
9408 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
9409 {
9410 c = msg[i];
9411 MAKE_CHAR_MULTIBYTE (c);
9412 char_bytes = CHAR_STRING (c, str);
9413 insert_1_both ((char *) str, 1, char_bytes, 1, 0, 0);
9414 }
9415 }
9416 else if (nbytes)
9417 insert_1 (m, nbytes, 1, 0, 0);
9418
9419 if (nlflag)
9420 {
9421 ptrdiff_t this_bol, this_bol_byte, prev_bol, prev_bol_byte;
9422 printmax_t dups;
9423 insert_1 ("\n", 1, 1, 0, 0);
9424
9425 scan_newline (Z, Z_BYTE, BEG, BEG_BYTE, -2, 0);
9426 this_bol = PT;
9427 this_bol_byte = PT_BYTE;
9428
9429 /* See if this line duplicates the previous one.
9430 If so, combine duplicates. */
9431 if (this_bol > BEG)
9432 {
9433 scan_newline (PT, PT_BYTE, BEG, BEG_BYTE, -2, 0);
9434 prev_bol = PT;
9435 prev_bol_byte = PT_BYTE;
9436
9437 dups = message_log_check_duplicate (prev_bol_byte,
9438 this_bol_byte);
9439 if (dups)
9440 {
9441 del_range_both (prev_bol, prev_bol_byte,
9442 this_bol, this_bol_byte, 0);
9443 if (dups > 1)
9444 {
9445 char dupstr[sizeof " [ times]"
9446 + INT_STRLEN_BOUND (printmax_t)];
9447
9448 /* If you change this format, don't forget to also
9449 change message_log_check_duplicate. */
9450 int duplen = sprintf (dupstr, " [%"pMd" times]", dups);
9451 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (Z - 1, Z_BYTE - 1);
9452 insert_1 (dupstr, duplen, 1, 0, 1);
9453 }
9454 }
9455 }
9456
9457 /* If we have more than the desired maximum number of lines
9458 in the *Messages* buffer now, delete the oldest ones.
9459 This is safe because we don't have undo in this buffer. */
9460
9461 if (NATNUMP (Vmessage_log_max))
9462 {
9463 scan_newline (Z, Z_BYTE, BEG, BEG_BYTE,
9464 -XFASTINT (Vmessage_log_max) - 1, 0);
9465 del_range_both (BEG, BEG_BYTE, PT, PT_BYTE, 0);
9466 }
9467 }
9468 BEGV = XMARKER (oldbegv)->charpos;
9469 BEGV_BYTE = marker_byte_position (oldbegv);
9470
9471 if (zv_at_end)
9472 {
9473 ZV = Z;
9474 ZV_BYTE = Z_BYTE;
9475 }
9476 else
9477 {
9478 ZV = XMARKER (oldzv)->charpos;
9479 ZV_BYTE = marker_byte_position (oldzv);
9480 }
9481
9482 if (point_at_end)
9483 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (Z, Z_BYTE);
9484 else
9485 /* We can't do Fgoto_char (oldpoint) because it will run some
9486 Lisp code. */
9487 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (XMARKER (oldpoint)->charpos,
9488 XMARKER (oldpoint)->bytepos);
9489
9490 UNGCPRO;
9491 unchain_marker (XMARKER (oldpoint));
9492 unchain_marker (XMARKER (oldbegv));
9493 unchain_marker (XMARKER (oldzv));
9494
9495 tem = Fget_buffer_window (Fcurrent_buffer (), Qt);
9496 set_buffer_internal (oldbuf);
9497 if (NILP (tem))
9498 windows_or_buffers_changed = old_windows_or_buffers_changed;
9499 message_log_need_newline = !nlflag;
9500 Vdeactivate_mark = old_deactivate_mark;
9501 }
9502 }
9503
9504
9505 /* We are at the end of the buffer after just having inserted a newline.
9506 (Note: We depend on the fact we won't be crossing the gap.)
9507 Check to see if the most recent message looks a lot like the previous one.
9508 Return 0 if different, 1 if the new one should just replace it, or a
9509 value N > 1 if we should also append " [N times]". */
9510
9511 static intmax_t
9512 message_log_check_duplicate (ptrdiff_t prev_bol_byte, ptrdiff_t this_bol_byte)
9513 {
9514 ptrdiff_t i;
9515 ptrdiff_t len = Z_BYTE - 1 - this_bol_byte;
9516 int seen_dots = 0;
9517 unsigned char *p1 = BUF_BYTE_ADDRESS (current_buffer, prev_bol_byte);
9518 unsigned char *p2 = BUF_BYTE_ADDRESS (current_buffer, this_bol_byte);
9519
9520 for (i = 0; i < len; i++)
9521 {
9522 if (i >= 3 && p1[i-3] == '.' && p1[i-2] == '.' && p1[i-1] == '.')
9523 seen_dots = 1;
9524 if (p1[i] != p2[i])
9525 return seen_dots;
9526 }
9527 p1 += len;
9528 if (*p1 == '\n')
9529 return 2;
9530 if (*p1++ == ' ' && *p1++ == '[')
9531 {
9532 char *pend;
9533 intmax_t n = strtoimax ((char *) p1, &pend, 10);
9534 if (0 < n && n < INTMAX_MAX && strncmp (pend, " times]\n", 8) == 0)
9535 return n+1;
9536 }
9537 return 0;
9538 }
9539 \f
9540
9541 /* Display an echo area message M with a specified length of NBYTES
9542 bytes. The string may include null characters. If M is 0, clear
9543 out any existing message, and let the mini-buffer text show
9544 through.
9545
9546 This may GC, so the buffer M must NOT point to a Lisp string. */
9547
9548 void
9549 message2 (const char *m, ptrdiff_t nbytes, int multibyte)
9550 {
9551 /* First flush out any partial line written with print. */
9552 message_log_maybe_newline ();
9553 if (m)
9554 message_dolog (m, nbytes, 1, multibyte);
9555 message2_nolog (m, nbytes, multibyte);
9556 }
9557
9558
9559 /* The non-logging counterpart of message2. */
9560
9561 void
9562 message2_nolog (const char *m, ptrdiff_t nbytes, int multibyte)
9563 {
9564 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
9565 message_enable_multibyte = multibyte;
9566
9567 if (FRAME_INITIAL_P (sf))
9568 {
9569 if (noninteractive_need_newline)
9570 putc ('\n', stderr);
9571 noninteractive_need_newline = 0;
9572 if (m)
9573 fwrite (m, nbytes, 1, stderr);
9574 if (cursor_in_echo_area == 0)
9575 fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9576 fflush (stderr);
9577 }
9578 /* A null message buffer means that the frame hasn't really been
9579 initialized yet. Error messages get reported properly by
9580 cmd_error, so this must be just an informative message; toss it. */
9581 else if (INTERACTIVE
9582 && sf->glyphs_initialized_p
9583 && FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF (sf))
9584 {
9585 Lisp_Object mini_window;
9586 struct frame *f;
9587
9588 /* Get the frame containing the mini-buffer
9589 that the selected frame is using. */
9590 mini_window = FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (sf);
9591 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (mini_window)));
9592
9593 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9594 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (sf)
9595 && ! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9596 Fmake_frame_visible (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (mini_window)));
9597
9598 if (m)
9599 {
9600 set_message (m, Qnil, nbytes, multibyte);
9601 if (minibuffer_auto_raise)
9602 Fraise_frame (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (mini_window)));
9603 }
9604 else
9605 clear_message (1, 1);
9606
9607 do_pending_window_change (0);
9608 echo_area_display (1);
9609 do_pending_window_change (0);
9610 if (FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->frame_up_to_date_hook != 0 && ! gc_in_progress)
9611 (*FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->frame_up_to_date_hook) (f);
9612 }
9613 }
9614
9615
9616 /* Display an echo area message M with a specified length of NBYTES
9617 bytes. The string may include null characters. If M is not a
9618 string, clear out any existing message, and let the mini-buffer
9619 text show through.
9620
9621 This function cancels echoing. */
9622
9623 void
9624 message3 (Lisp_Object m, ptrdiff_t nbytes, int multibyte)
9625 {
9626 struct gcpro gcpro1;
9627
9628 GCPRO1 (m);
9629 clear_message (1,1);
9630 cancel_echoing ();
9631
9632 /* First flush out any partial line written with print. */
9633 message_log_maybe_newline ();
9634 if (STRINGP (m))
9635 {
9636 USE_SAFE_ALLOCA;
9637 char *buffer = SAFE_ALLOCA (nbytes);
9638 memcpy (buffer, SDATA (m), nbytes);
9639 message_dolog (buffer, nbytes, 1, multibyte);
9640 SAFE_FREE ();
9641 }
9642 message3_nolog (m, nbytes, multibyte);
9643
9644 UNGCPRO;
9645 }
9646
9647
9648 /* The non-logging version of message3.
9649 This does not cancel echoing, because it is used for echoing.
9650 Perhaps we need to make a separate function for echoing
9651 and make this cancel echoing. */
9652
9653 void
9654 message3_nolog (Lisp_Object m, ptrdiff_t nbytes, int multibyte)
9655 {
9656 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
9657 message_enable_multibyte = multibyte;
9658
9659 if (FRAME_INITIAL_P (sf))
9660 {
9661 if (noninteractive_need_newline)
9662 putc ('\n', stderr);
9663 noninteractive_need_newline = 0;
9664 if (STRINGP (m))
9665 fwrite (SDATA (m), nbytes, 1, stderr);
9666 if (cursor_in_echo_area == 0)
9667 fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9668 fflush (stderr);
9669 }
9670 /* A null message buffer means that the frame hasn't really been
9671 initialized yet. Error messages get reported properly by
9672 cmd_error, so this must be just an informative message; toss it. */
9673 else if (INTERACTIVE
9674 && sf->glyphs_initialized_p
9675 && FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF (sf))
9676 {
9677 Lisp_Object mini_window;
9678 Lisp_Object frame;
9679 struct frame *f;
9680
9681 /* Get the frame containing the mini-buffer
9682 that the selected frame is using. */
9683 mini_window = FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (sf);
9684 frame = XWINDOW (mini_window)->frame;
9685 f = XFRAME (frame);
9686
9687 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9688 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (sf)
9689 && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9690 Fmake_frame_visible (frame);
9691
9692 if (STRINGP (m) && SCHARS (m) > 0)
9693 {
9694 set_message (NULL, m, nbytes, multibyte);
9695 if (minibuffer_auto_raise)
9696 Fraise_frame (frame);
9697 /* Assume we are not echoing.
9698 (If we are, echo_now will override this.) */
9699 echo_message_buffer = Qnil;
9700 }
9701 else
9702 clear_message (1, 1);
9703
9704 do_pending_window_change (0);
9705 echo_area_display (1);
9706 do_pending_window_change (0);
9707 if (FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->frame_up_to_date_hook != 0 && ! gc_in_progress)
9708 (*FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->frame_up_to_date_hook) (f);
9709 }
9710 }
9711
9712
9713 /* Display a null-terminated echo area message M. If M is 0, clear
9714 out any existing message, and let the mini-buffer text show through.
9715
9716 The buffer M must continue to exist until after the echo area gets
9717 cleared or some other message gets displayed there. Do not pass
9718 text that is stored in a Lisp string. Do not pass text in a buffer
9719 that was alloca'd. */
9720
9721 void
9722 message1 (const char *m)
9723 {
9724 message2 (m, (m ? strlen (m) : 0), 0);
9725 }
9726
9727
9728 /* The non-logging counterpart of message1. */
9729
9730 void
9731 message1_nolog (const char *m)
9732 {
9733 message2_nolog (m, (m ? strlen (m) : 0), 0);
9734 }
9735
9736 /* Display a message M which contains a single %s
9737 which gets replaced with STRING. */
9738
9739 void
9740 message_with_string (const char *m, Lisp_Object string, int log)
9741 {
9742 CHECK_STRING (string);
9743
9744 if (noninteractive)
9745 {
9746 if (m)
9747 {
9748 if (noninteractive_need_newline)
9749 putc ('\n', stderr);
9750 noninteractive_need_newline = 0;
9751 fprintf (stderr, m, SDATA (string));
9752 if (!cursor_in_echo_area)
9753 fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9754 fflush (stderr);
9755 }
9756 }
9757 else if (INTERACTIVE)
9758 {
9759 /* The frame whose minibuffer we're going to display the message on.
9760 It may be larger than the selected frame, so we need
9761 to use its buffer, not the selected frame's buffer. */
9762 Lisp_Object mini_window;
9763 struct frame *f, *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
9764
9765 /* Get the frame containing the minibuffer
9766 that the selected frame is using. */
9767 mini_window = FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (sf);
9768 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (mini_window)));
9769
9770 /* A null message buffer means that the frame hasn't really been
9771 initialized yet. Error messages get reported properly by
9772 cmd_error, so this must be just an informative message; toss it. */
9773 if (FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF (f))
9774 {
9775 Lisp_Object args[2], msg;
9776 struct gcpro gcpro1, gcpro2;
9777
9778 args[0] = build_string (m);
9779 args[1] = msg = string;
9780 GCPRO2 (args[0], msg);
9781 gcpro1.nvars = 2;
9782
9783 msg = Fformat (2, args);
9784
9785 if (log)
9786 message3 (msg, SBYTES (msg), STRING_MULTIBYTE (msg));
9787 else
9788 message3_nolog (msg, SBYTES (msg), STRING_MULTIBYTE (msg));
9789
9790 UNGCPRO;
9791
9792 /* Print should start at the beginning of the message
9793 buffer next time. */
9794 message_buf_print = 0;
9795 }
9796 }
9797 }
9798
9799
9800 /* Dump an informative message to the minibuf. If M is 0, clear out
9801 any existing message, and let the mini-buffer text show through. */
9802
9803 static void
9804 vmessage (const char *m, va_list ap)
9805 {
9806 if (noninteractive)
9807 {
9808 if (m)
9809 {
9810 if (noninteractive_need_newline)
9811 putc ('\n', stderr);
9812 noninteractive_need_newline = 0;
9813 vfprintf (stderr, m, ap);
9814 if (cursor_in_echo_area == 0)
9815 fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9816 fflush (stderr);
9817 }
9818 }
9819 else if (INTERACTIVE)
9820 {
9821 /* The frame whose mini-buffer we're going to display the message
9822 on. It may be larger than the selected frame, so we need to
9823 use its buffer, not the selected frame's buffer. */
9824 Lisp_Object mini_window;
9825 struct frame *f, *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
9826
9827 /* Get the frame containing the mini-buffer
9828 that the selected frame is using. */
9829 mini_window = FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (sf);
9830 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (mini_window)));
9831
9832 /* A null message buffer means that the frame hasn't really been
9833 initialized yet. Error messages get reported properly by
9834 cmd_error, so this must be just an informative message; toss
9835 it. */
9836 if (FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF (f))
9837 {
9838 if (m)
9839 {
9840 ptrdiff_t len;
9841
9842 len = doprnt (FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF (f),
9843 FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF_SIZE (f), m, (char *)0, ap);
9844
9845 message2 (FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF (f), len, 1);
9846 }
9847 else
9848 message1 (0);
9849
9850 /* Print should start at the beginning of the message
9851 buffer next time. */
9852 message_buf_print = 0;
9853 }
9854 }
9855 }
9856
9857 void
9858 message (const char *m, ...)
9859 {
9860 va_list ap;
9861 va_start (ap, m);
9862 vmessage (m, ap);
9863 va_end (ap);
9864 }
9865
9866
9867 #if 0
9868 /* The non-logging version of message. */
9869
9870 void
9871 message_nolog (const char *m, ...)
9872 {
9873 Lisp_Object old_log_max;
9874 va_list ap;
9875 va_start (ap, m);
9876 old_log_max = Vmessage_log_max;
9877 Vmessage_log_max = Qnil;
9878 vmessage (m, ap);
9879 Vmessage_log_max = old_log_max;
9880 va_end (ap);
9881 }
9882 #endif
9883
9884
9885 /* Display the current message in the current mini-buffer. This is
9886 only called from error handlers in process.c, and is not time
9887 critical. */
9888
9889 void
9890 update_echo_area (void)
9891 {
9892 if (!NILP (echo_area_buffer[0]))
9893 {
9894 Lisp_Object string;
9895 string = Fcurrent_message ();
9896 message3 (string, SBYTES (string),
9897 !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters)));
9898 }
9899 }
9900
9901
9902 /* Make sure echo area buffers in `echo_buffers' are live.
9903 If they aren't, make new ones. */
9904
9905 static void
9906 ensure_echo_area_buffers (void)
9907 {
9908 int i;
9909
9910 for (i = 0; i < 2; ++i)
9911 if (!BUFFERP (echo_buffer[i])
9912 || NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (echo_buffer[i]), name)))
9913 {
9914 char name[30];
9915 Lisp_Object old_buffer;
9916 int j;
9917
9918 old_buffer = echo_buffer[i];
9919 echo_buffer[i] = Fget_buffer_create
9920 (make_formatted_string (name, " *Echo Area %d*", i));
9921 bset_truncate_lines (XBUFFER (echo_buffer[i]), Qnil);
9922 /* to force word wrap in echo area -
9923 it was decided to postpone this*/
9924 /* XBUFFER (echo_buffer[i])->word_wrap = Qt; */
9925
9926 for (j = 0; j < 2; ++j)
9927 if (EQ (old_buffer, echo_area_buffer[j]))
9928 echo_area_buffer[j] = echo_buffer[i];
9929 }
9930 }
9931
9932
9933 /* Call FN with args A1..A4 with either the current or last displayed
9934 echo_area_buffer as current buffer.
9935
9936 WHICH zero means use the current message buffer
9937 echo_area_buffer[0]. If that is nil, choose a suitable buffer
9938 from echo_buffer[] and clear it.
9939
9940 WHICH > 0 means use echo_area_buffer[1]. If that is nil, choose a
9941 suitable buffer from echo_buffer[] and clear it.
9942
9943 If WHICH < 0, set echo_area_buffer[1] to echo_area_buffer[0], so
9944 that the current message becomes the last displayed one, make
9945 choose a suitable buffer for echo_area_buffer[0], and clear it.
9946
9947 Value is what FN returns. */
9948
9949 static int
9950 with_echo_area_buffer (struct window *w, int which,
9951 int (*fn) (ptrdiff_t, Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t),
9952 ptrdiff_t a1, Lisp_Object a2, ptrdiff_t a3, ptrdiff_t a4)
9953 {
9954 Lisp_Object buffer;
9955 int this_one, the_other, clear_buffer_p, rc;
9956 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
9957
9958 /* If buffers aren't live, make new ones. */
9959 ensure_echo_area_buffers ();
9960
9961 clear_buffer_p = 0;
9962
9963 if (which == 0)
9964 this_one = 0, the_other = 1;
9965 else if (which > 0)
9966 this_one = 1, the_other = 0;
9967 else
9968 {
9969 this_one = 0, the_other = 1;
9970 clear_buffer_p = 1;
9971
9972 /* We need a fresh one in case the current echo buffer equals
9973 the one containing the last displayed echo area message. */
9974 if (!NILP (echo_area_buffer[this_one])
9975 && EQ (echo_area_buffer[this_one], echo_area_buffer[the_other]))
9976 echo_area_buffer[this_one] = Qnil;
9977 }
9978
9979 /* Choose a suitable buffer from echo_buffer[] is we don't
9980 have one. */
9981 if (NILP (echo_area_buffer[this_one]))
9982 {
9983 echo_area_buffer[this_one]
9984 = (EQ (echo_area_buffer[the_other], echo_buffer[this_one])
9985 ? echo_buffer[the_other]
9986 : echo_buffer[this_one]);
9987 clear_buffer_p = 1;
9988 }
9989
9990 buffer = echo_area_buffer[this_one];
9991
9992 /* Don't get confused by reusing the buffer used for echoing
9993 for a different purpose. */
9994 if (echo_kboard == NULL && EQ (buffer, echo_message_buffer))
9995 cancel_echoing ();
9996
9997 record_unwind_protect (unwind_with_echo_area_buffer,
9998 with_echo_area_buffer_unwind_data (w));
9999
10000 /* Make the echo area buffer current. Note that for display
10001 purposes, it is not necessary that the displayed window's buffer
10002 == current_buffer, except for text property lookup. So, let's
10003 only set that buffer temporarily here without doing a full
10004 Fset_window_buffer. We must also change w->pointm, though,
10005 because otherwise an assertions in unshow_buffer fails, and Emacs
10006 aborts. */
10007 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (buffer));
10008 if (w)
10009 {
10010 wset_buffer (w, buffer);
10011 set_marker_both (w->pointm, buffer, BEG, BEG_BYTE);
10012 }
10013
10014 bset_undo_list (current_buffer, Qt);
10015 bset_read_only (current_buffer, Qnil);
10016 specbind (Qinhibit_read_only, Qt);
10017 specbind (Qinhibit_modification_hooks, Qt);
10018
10019 if (clear_buffer_p && Z > BEG)
10020 del_range (BEG, Z);
10021
10022 eassert (BEGV >= BEG);
10023 eassert (ZV <= Z && ZV >= BEGV);
10024
10025 rc = fn (a1, a2, a3, a4);
10026
10027 eassert (BEGV >= BEG);
10028 eassert (ZV <= Z && ZV >= BEGV);
10029
10030 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
10031 return rc;
10032 }
10033
10034
10035 /* Save state that should be preserved around the call to the function
10036 FN called in with_echo_area_buffer. */
10037
10038 static Lisp_Object
10039 with_echo_area_buffer_unwind_data (struct window *w)
10040 {
10041 int i = 0;
10042 Lisp_Object vector, tmp;
10043
10044 /* Reduce consing by keeping one vector in
10045 Vwith_echo_area_save_vector. */
10046 vector = Vwith_echo_area_save_vector;
10047 Vwith_echo_area_save_vector = Qnil;
10048
10049 if (NILP (vector))
10050 vector = Fmake_vector (make_number (7), Qnil);
10051
10052 XSETBUFFER (tmp, current_buffer); ASET (vector, i, tmp); ++i;
10053 ASET (vector, i, Vdeactivate_mark); ++i;
10054 ASET (vector, i, make_number (windows_or_buffers_changed)); ++i;
10055
10056 if (w)
10057 {
10058 XSETWINDOW (tmp, w); ASET (vector, i, tmp); ++i;
10059 ASET (vector, i, w->buffer); ++i;
10060 ASET (vector, i, make_number (XMARKER (w->pointm)->charpos)); ++i;
10061 ASET (vector, i, make_number (XMARKER (w->pointm)->bytepos)); ++i;
10062 }
10063 else
10064 {
10065 int end = i + 4;
10066 for (; i < end; ++i)
10067 ASET (vector, i, Qnil);
10068 }
10069
10070 eassert (i == ASIZE (vector));
10071 return vector;
10072 }
10073
10074
10075 /* Restore global state from VECTOR which was created by
10076 with_echo_area_buffer_unwind_data. */
10077
10078 static Lisp_Object
10079 unwind_with_echo_area_buffer (Lisp_Object vector)
10080 {
10081 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (AREF (vector, 0)));
10082 Vdeactivate_mark = AREF (vector, 1);
10083 windows_or_buffers_changed = XFASTINT (AREF (vector, 2));
10084
10085 if (WINDOWP (AREF (vector, 3)))
10086 {
10087 struct window *w;
10088 Lisp_Object buffer, charpos, bytepos;
10089
10090 w = XWINDOW (AREF (vector, 3));
10091 buffer = AREF (vector, 4);
10092 charpos = AREF (vector, 5);
10093 bytepos = AREF (vector, 6);
10094
10095 wset_buffer (w, buffer);
10096 set_marker_both (w->pointm, buffer,
10097 XFASTINT (charpos), XFASTINT (bytepos));
10098 }
10099
10100 Vwith_echo_area_save_vector = vector;
10101 return Qnil;
10102 }
10103
10104
10105 /* Set up the echo area for use by print functions. MULTIBYTE_P
10106 non-zero means we will print multibyte. */
10107
10108 void
10109 setup_echo_area_for_printing (int multibyte_p)
10110 {
10111 /* If we can't find an echo area any more, exit. */
10112 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (selected_frame)))
10113 Fkill_emacs (Qnil);
10114
10115 ensure_echo_area_buffers ();
10116
10117 if (!message_buf_print)
10118 {
10119 /* A message has been output since the last time we printed.
10120 Choose a fresh echo area buffer. */
10121 if (EQ (echo_area_buffer[1], echo_buffer[0]))
10122 echo_area_buffer[0] = echo_buffer[1];
10123 else
10124 echo_area_buffer[0] = echo_buffer[0];
10125
10126 /* Switch to that buffer and clear it. */
10127 set_buffer_internal (XBUFFER (echo_area_buffer[0]));
10128 bset_truncate_lines (current_buffer, Qnil);
10129
10130 if (Z > BEG)
10131 {
10132 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
10133 specbind (Qinhibit_read_only, Qt);
10134 /* Note that undo recording is always disabled. */
10135 del_range (BEG, Z);
10136 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
10137 }
10138 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (BEG, BEG_BYTE);
10139
10140 /* Set up the buffer for the multibyteness we need. */
10141 if (multibyte_p
10142 != !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters)))
10143 Fset_buffer_multibyte (multibyte_p ? Qt : Qnil);
10144
10145 /* Raise the frame containing the echo area. */
10146 if (minibuffer_auto_raise)
10147 {
10148 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
10149 Lisp_Object mini_window;
10150 mini_window = FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (sf);
10151 Fraise_frame (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (mini_window)));
10152 }
10153
10154 message_log_maybe_newline ();
10155 message_buf_print = 1;
10156 }
10157 else
10158 {
10159 if (NILP (echo_area_buffer[0]))
10160 {
10161 if (EQ (echo_area_buffer[1], echo_buffer[0]))
10162 echo_area_buffer[0] = echo_buffer[1];
10163 else
10164 echo_area_buffer[0] = echo_buffer[0];
10165 }
10166
10167 if (current_buffer != XBUFFER (echo_area_buffer[0]))
10168 {
10169 /* Someone switched buffers between print requests. */
10170 set_buffer_internal (XBUFFER (echo_area_buffer[0]));
10171 bset_truncate_lines (current_buffer, Qnil);
10172 }
10173 }
10174 }
10175
10176
10177 /* Display an echo area message in window W. Value is non-zero if W's
10178 height is changed. If display_last_displayed_message_p is
10179 non-zero, display the message that was last displayed, otherwise
10180 display the current message. */
10181
10182 static int
10183 display_echo_area (struct window *w)
10184 {
10185 int i, no_message_p, window_height_changed_p;
10186
10187 /* Temporarily disable garbage collections while displaying the echo
10188 area. This is done because a GC can print a message itself.
10189 That message would modify the echo area buffer's contents while a
10190 redisplay of the buffer is going on, and seriously confuse
10191 redisplay. */
10192 ptrdiff_t count = inhibit_garbage_collection ();
10193
10194 /* If there is no message, we must call display_echo_area_1
10195 nevertheless because it resizes the window. But we will have to
10196 reset the echo_area_buffer in question to nil at the end because
10197 with_echo_area_buffer will sets it to an empty buffer. */
10198 i = display_last_displayed_message_p ? 1 : 0;
10199 no_message_p = NILP (echo_area_buffer[i]);
10200
10201 window_height_changed_p
10202 = with_echo_area_buffer (w, display_last_displayed_message_p,
10203 display_echo_area_1,
10204 (intptr_t) w, Qnil, 0, 0);
10205
10206 if (no_message_p)
10207 echo_area_buffer[i] = Qnil;
10208
10209 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
10210 return window_height_changed_p;
10211 }
10212
10213
10214 /* Helper for display_echo_area. Display the current buffer which
10215 contains the current echo area message in window W, a mini-window,
10216 a pointer to which is passed in A1. A2..A4 are currently not used.
10217 Change the height of W so that all of the message is displayed.
10218 Value is non-zero if height of W was changed. */
10219
10220 static int
10221 display_echo_area_1 (ptrdiff_t a1, Lisp_Object a2, ptrdiff_t a3, ptrdiff_t a4)
10222 {
10223 intptr_t i1 = a1;
10224 struct window *w = (struct window *) i1;
10225 Lisp_Object window;
10226 struct text_pos start;
10227 int window_height_changed_p = 0;
10228
10229 /* Do this before displaying, so that we have a large enough glyph
10230 matrix for the display. If we can't get enough space for the
10231 whole text, display the last N lines. That works by setting w->start. */
10232 window_height_changed_p = resize_mini_window (w, 0);
10233
10234 /* Use the starting position chosen by resize_mini_window. */
10235 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (start, w->start);
10236
10237 /* Display. */
10238 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
10239 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
10240 try_window (window, start, 0);
10241
10242 return window_height_changed_p;
10243 }
10244
10245
10246 /* Resize the echo area window to exactly the size needed for the
10247 currently displayed message, if there is one. If a mini-buffer
10248 is active, don't shrink it. */
10249
10250 void
10251 resize_echo_area_exactly (void)
10252 {
10253 if (BUFFERP (echo_area_buffer[0])
10254 && WINDOWP (echo_area_window))
10255 {
10256 struct window *w = XWINDOW (echo_area_window);
10257 int resized_p;
10258 Lisp_Object resize_exactly;
10259
10260 if (minibuf_level == 0)
10261 resize_exactly = Qt;
10262 else
10263 resize_exactly = Qnil;
10264
10265 resized_p = with_echo_area_buffer (w, 0, resize_mini_window_1,
10266 (intptr_t) w, resize_exactly,
10267 0, 0);
10268 if (resized_p)
10269 {
10270 ++windows_or_buffers_changed;
10271 ++update_mode_lines;
10272 redisplay_internal ();
10273 }
10274 }
10275 }
10276
10277
10278 /* Callback function for with_echo_area_buffer, when used from
10279 resize_echo_area_exactly. A1 contains a pointer to the window to
10280 resize, EXACTLY non-nil means resize the mini-window exactly to the
10281 size of the text displayed. A3 and A4 are not used. Value is what
10282 resize_mini_window returns. */
10283
10284 static int
10285 resize_mini_window_1 (ptrdiff_t a1, Lisp_Object exactly, ptrdiff_t a3, ptrdiff_t a4)
10286 {
10287 intptr_t i1 = a1;
10288 return resize_mini_window ((struct window *) i1, !NILP (exactly));
10289 }
10290
10291
10292 /* Resize mini-window W to fit the size of its contents. EXACT_P
10293 means size the window exactly to the size needed. Otherwise, it's
10294 only enlarged until W's buffer is empty.
10295
10296 Set W->start to the right place to begin display. If the whole
10297 contents fit, start at the beginning. Otherwise, start so as
10298 to make the end of the contents appear. This is particularly
10299 important for y-or-n-p, but seems desirable generally.
10300
10301 Value is non-zero if the window height has been changed. */
10302
10303 int
10304 resize_mini_window (struct window *w, int exact_p)
10305 {
10306 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
10307 int window_height_changed_p = 0;
10308
10309 eassert (MINI_WINDOW_P (w));
10310
10311 /* By default, start display at the beginning. */
10312 set_marker_both (w->start, w->buffer,
10313 BUF_BEGV (XBUFFER (w->buffer)),
10314 BUF_BEGV_BYTE (XBUFFER (w->buffer)));
10315
10316 /* Don't resize windows while redisplaying a window; it would
10317 confuse redisplay functions when the size of the window they are
10318 displaying changes from under them. Such a resizing can happen,
10319 for instance, when which-func prints a long message while
10320 we are running fontification-functions. We're running these
10321 functions with safe_call which binds inhibit-redisplay to t. */
10322 if (!NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay))
10323 return 0;
10324
10325 /* Nil means don't try to resize. */
10326 if (NILP (Vresize_mini_windows)
10327 || (FRAME_X_P (f) && FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f) == NULL))
10328 return 0;
10329
10330 if (!FRAME_MINIBUF_ONLY_P (f))
10331 {
10332 struct it it;
10333 struct window *root = XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f));
10334 int total_height = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (root) + WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w);
10335 int height;
10336 EMACS_INT max_height;
10337 int unit = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
10338 struct text_pos start;
10339 struct buffer *old_current_buffer = NULL;
10340
10341 if (current_buffer != XBUFFER (w->buffer))
10342 {
10343 old_current_buffer = current_buffer;
10344 set_buffer_internal (XBUFFER (w->buffer));
10345 }
10346
10347 init_iterator (&it, w, BEGV, BEGV_BYTE, NULL, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
10348
10349 /* Compute the max. number of lines specified by the user. */
10350 if (FLOATP (Vmax_mini_window_height))
10351 max_height = XFLOATINT (Vmax_mini_window_height) * FRAME_LINES (f);
10352 else if (INTEGERP (Vmax_mini_window_height))
10353 max_height = XINT (Vmax_mini_window_height);
10354 else
10355 max_height = total_height / 4;
10356
10357 /* Correct that max. height if it's bogus. */
10358 max_height = max (1, max_height);
10359 max_height = min (total_height, max_height);
10360
10361 /* Find out the height of the text in the window. */
10362 if (it.line_wrap == TRUNCATE)
10363 height = 1;
10364 else
10365 {
10366 last_height = 0;
10367 move_it_to (&it, ZV, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
10368 if (it.max_ascent == 0 && it.max_descent == 0)
10369 height = it.current_y + last_height;
10370 else
10371 height = it.current_y + it.max_ascent + it.max_descent;
10372 height -= min (it.extra_line_spacing, it.max_extra_line_spacing);
10373 height = (height + unit - 1) / unit;
10374 }
10375
10376 /* Compute a suitable window start. */
10377 if (height > max_height)
10378 {
10379 height = max_height;
10380 init_iterator (&it, w, ZV, ZV_BYTE, NULL, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
10381 move_it_vertically_backward (&it, (height - 1) * unit);
10382 start = it.current.pos;
10383 }
10384 else
10385 SET_TEXT_POS (start, BEGV, BEGV_BYTE);
10386 SET_MARKER_FROM_TEXT_POS (w->start, start);
10387
10388 if (EQ (Vresize_mini_windows, Qgrow_only))
10389 {
10390 /* Let it grow only, until we display an empty message, in which
10391 case the window shrinks again. */
10392 if (height > WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w))
10393 {
10394 int old_height = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w);
10395 freeze_window_starts (f, 1);
10396 grow_mini_window (w, height - WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w));
10397 window_height_changed_p = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) != old_height;
10398 }
10399 else if (height < WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w)
10400 && (exact_p || BEGV == ZV))
10401 {
10402 int old_height = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w);
10403 freeze_window_starts (f, 0);
10404 shrink_mini_window (w);
10405 window_height_changed_p = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) != old_height;
10406 }
10407 }
10408 else
10409 {
10410 /* Always resize to exact size needed. */
10411 if (height > WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w))
10412 {
10413 int old_height = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w);
10414 freeze_window_starts (f, 1);
10415 grow_mini_window (w, height - WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w));
10416 window_height_changed_p = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) != old_height;
10417 }
10418 else if (height < WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w))
10419 {
10420 int old_height = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w);
10421 freeze_window_starts (f, 0);
10422 shrink_mini_window (w);
10423
10424 if (height)
10425 {
10426 freeze_window_starts (f, 1);
10427 grow_mini_window (w, height - WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w));
10428 }
10429
10430 window_height_changed_p = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) != old_height;
10431 }
10432 }
10433
10434 if (old_current_buffer)
10435 set_buffer_internal (old_current_buffer);
10436 }
10437
10438 return window_height_changed_p;
10439 }
10440
10441
10442 /* Value is the current message, a string, or nil if there is no
10443 current message. */
10444
10445 Lisp_Object
10446 current_message (void)
10447 {
10448 Lisp_Object msg;
10449
10450 if (!BUFFERP (echo_area_buffer[0]))
10451 msg = Qnil;
10452 else
10453 {
10454 with_echo_area_buffer (0, 0, current_message_1,
10455 (intptr_t) &msg, Qnil, 0, 0);
10456 if (NILP (msg))
10457 echo_area_buffer[0] = Qnil;
10458 }
10459
10460 return msg;
10461 }
10462
10463
10464 static int
10465 current_message_1 (ptrdiff_t a1, Lisp_Object a2, ptrdiff_t a3, ptrdiff_t a4)
10466 {
10467 intptr_t i1 = a1;
10468 Lisp_Object *msg = (Lisp_Object *) i1;
10469
10470 if (Z > BEG)
10471 *msg = make_buffer_string (BEG, Z, 1);
10472 else
10473 *msg = Qnil;
10474 return 0;
10475 }
10476
10477
10478 /* Push the current message on Vmessage_stack for later restoration
10479 by restore_message. Value is non-zero if the current message isn't
10480 empty. This is a relatively infrequent operation, so it's not
10481 worth optimizing. */
10482
10483 bool
10484 push_message (void)
10485 {
10486 Lisp_Object msg = current_message ();
10487 Vmessage_stack = Fcons (msg, Vmessage_stack);
10488 return STRINGP (msg);
10489 }
10490
10491
10492 /* Restore message display from the top of Vmessage_stack. */
10493
10494 void
10495 restore_message (void)
10496 {
10497 Lisp_Object msg;
10498
10499 eassert (CONSP (Vmessage_stack));
10500 msg = XCAR (Vmessage_stack);
10501 if (STRINGP (msg))
10502 message3_nolog (msg, SBYTES (msg), STRING_MULTIBYTE (msg));
10503 else
10504 message3_nolog (msg, 0, 0);
10505 }
10506
10507
10508 /* Handler for record_unwind_protect calling pop_message. */
10509
10510 Lisp_Object
10511 pop_message_unwind (Lisp_Object dummy)
10512 {
10513 pop_message ();
10514 return Qnil;
10515 }
10516
10517 /* Pop the top-most entry off Vmessage_stack. */
10518
10519 static void
10520 pop_message (void)
10521 {
10522 eassert (CONSP (Vmessage_stack));
10523 Vmessage_stack = XCDR (Vmessage_stack);
10524 }
10525
10526
10527 /* Check that Vmessage_stack is nil. Called from emacs.c when Emacs
10528 exits. If the stack is not empty, we have a missing pop_message
10529 somewhere. */
10530
10531 void
10532 check_message_stack (void)
10533 {
10534 if (!NILP (Vmessage_stack))
10535 abort ();
10536 }
10537
10538
10539 /* Truncate to NCHARS what will be displayed in the echo area the next
10540 time we display it---but don't redisplay it now. */
10541
10542 void
10543 truncate_echo_area (ptrdiff_t nchars)
10544 {
10545 if (nchars == 0)
10546 echo_area_buffer[0] = Qnil;
10547 /* A null message buffer means that the frame hasn't really been
10548 initialized yet. Error messages get reported properly by
10549 cmd_error, so this must be just an informative message; toss it. */
10550 else if (!noninteractive
10551 && INTERACTIVE
10552 && !NILP (echo_area_buffer[0]))
10553 {
10554 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
10555 if (FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF (sf))
10556 with_echo_area_buffer (0, 0, truncate_message_1, nchars, Qnil, 0, 0);
10557 }
10558 }
10559
10560
10561 /* Helper function for truncate_echo_area. Truncate the current
10562 message to at most NCHARS characters. */
10563
10564 static int
10565 truncate_message_1 (ptrdiff_t nchars, Lisp_Object a2, ptrdiff_t a3, ptrdiff_t a4)
10566 {
10567 if (BEG + nchars < Z)
10568 del_range (BEG + nchars, Z);
10569 if (Z == BEG)
10570 echo_area_buffer[0] = Qnil;
10571 return 0;
10572 }
10573
10574
10575 /* Set the current message to a substring of S or STRING.
10576
10577 If STRING is a Lisp string, set the message to the first NBYTES
10578 bytes from STRING. NBYTES zero means use the whole string. If
10579 STRING is multibyte, the message will be displayed multibyte.
10580
10581 If S is not null, set the message to the first LEN bytes of S. LEN
10582 zero means use the whole string. MULTIBYTE_P non-zero means S is
10583 multibyte. Display the message multibyte in that case.
10584
10585 Doesn't GC, as with_echo_area_buffer binds Qinhibit_modification_hooks
10586 to t before calling set_message_1 (which calls insert).
10587 */
10588
10589 static void
10590 set_message (const char *s, Lisp_Object string,
10591 ptrdiff_t nbytes, int multibyte_p)
10592 {
10593 message_enable_multibyte
10594 = ((s && multibyte_p)
10595 || (STRINGP (string) && STRING_MULTIBYTE (string)));
10596
10597 with_echo_area_buffer (0, -1, set_message_1,
10598 (intptr_t) s, string, nbytes, multibyte_p);
10599 message_buf_print = 0;
10600 help_echo_showing_p = 0;
10601 }
10602
10603
10604 /* Helper function for set_message. Arguments have the same meaning
10605 as there, with A1 corresponding to S and A2 corresponding to STRING
10606 This function is called with the echo area buffer being
10607 current. */
10608
10609 static int
10610 set_message_1 (ptrdiff_t a1, Lisp_Object a2, ptrdiff_t nbytes, ptrdiff_t multibyte_p)
10611 {
10612 intptr_t i1 = a1;
10613 const char *s = (const char *) i1;
10614 const unsigned char *msg = (const unsigned char *) s;
10615 Lisp_Object string = a2;
10616
10617 /* Change multibyteness of the echo buffer appropriately. */
10618 if (message_enable_multibyte
10619 != !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters)))
10620 Fset_buffer_multibyte (message_enable_multibyte ? Qt : Qnil);
10621
10622 bset_truncate_lines (current_buffer, message_truncate_lines ? Qt : Qnil);
10623 if (!NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, bidi_display_reordering)))
10624 bset_bidi_paragraph_direction (current_buffer, Qleft_to_right);
10625
10626 /* Insert new message at BEG. */
10627 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (BEG, BEG_BYTE);
10628
10629 if (STRINGP (string))
10630 {
10631 ptrdiff_t nchars;
10632
10633 if (nbytes == 0)
10634 nbytes = SBYTES (string);
10635 nchars = string_byte_to_char (string, nbytes);
10636
10637 /* This function takes care of single/multibyte conversion. We
10638 just have to ensure that the echo area buffer has the right
10639 setting of enable_multibyte_characters. */
10640 insert_from_string (string, 0, 0, nchars, nbytes, 1);
10641 }
10642 else if (s)
10643 {
10644 if (nbytes == 0)
10645 nbytes = strlen (s);
10646
10647 if (multibyte_p && NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters)))
10648 {
10649 /* Convert from multi-byte to single-byte. */
10650 ptrdiff_t i;
10651 int c, n;
10652 char work[1];
10653
10654 /* Convert a multibyte string to single-byte. */
10655 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += n)
10656 {
10657 c = string_char_and_length (msg + i, &n);
10658 work[0] = (ASCII_CHAR_P (c)
10659 ? c
10660 : multibyte_char_to_unibyte (c));
10661 insert_1_both (work, 1, 1, 1, 0, 0);
10662 }
10663 }
10664 else if (!multibyte_p
10665 && !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters)))
10666 {
10667 /* Convert from single-byte to multi-byte. */
10668 ptrdiff_t i;
10669 int c, n;
10670 unsigned char str[MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH];
10671
10672 /* Convert a single-byte string to multibyte. */
10673 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
10674 {
10675 c = msg[i];
10676 MAKE_CHAR_MULTIBYTE (c);
10677 n = CHAR_STRING (c, str);
10678 insert_1_both ((char *) str, 1, n, 1, 0, 0);
10679 }
10680 }
10681 else
10682 insert_1 (s, nbytes, 1, 0, 0);
10683 }
10684
10685 return 0;
10686 }
10687
10688
10689 /* Clear messages. CURRENT_P non-zero means clear the current
10690 message. LAST_DISPLAYED_P non-zero means clear the message
10691 last displayed. */
10692
10693 void
10694 clear_message (int current_p, int last_displayed_p)
10695 {
10696 if (current_p)
10697 {
10698 echo_area_buffer[0] = Qnil;
10699 message_cleared_p = 1;
10700 }
10701
10702 if (last_displayed_p)
10703 echo_area_buffer[1] = Qnil;
10704
10705 message_buf_print = 0;
10706 }
10707
10708 /* Clear garbaged frames.
10709
10710 This function is used where the old redisplay called
10711 redraw_garbaged_frames which in turn called redraw_frame which in
10712 turn called clear_frame. The call to clear_frame was a source of
10713 flickering. I believe a clear_frame is not necessary. It should
10714 suffice in the new redisplay to invalidate all current matrices,
10715 and ensure a complete redisplay of all windows. */
10716
10717 static void
10718 clear_garbaged_frames (void)
10719 {
10720 if (frame_garbaged)
10721 {
10722 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
10723 int changed_count = 0;
10724
10725 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
10726 {
10727 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
10728
10729 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
10730 {
10731 if (f->resized_p)
10732 {
10733 Fredraw_frame (frame);
10734 f->force_flush_display_p = 1;
10735 }
10736 clear_current_matrices (f);
10737 changed_count++;
10738 f->garbaged = 0;
10739 f->resized_p = 0;
10740 }
10741 }
10742
10743 frame_garbaged = 0;
10744 if (changed_count)
10745 ++windows_or_buffers_changed;
10746 }
10747 }
10748
10749
10750 /* Redisplay the echo area of the selected frame. If UPDATE_FRAME_P
10751 is non-zero update selected_frame. Value is non-zero if the
10752 mini-windows height has been changed. */
10753
10754 static int
10755 echo_area_display (int update_frame_p)
10756 {
10757 Lisp_Object mini_window;
10758 struct window *w;
10759 struct frame *f;
10760 int window_height_changed_p = 0;
10761 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
10762
10763 mini_window = FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (sf);
10764 w = XWINDOW (mini_window);
10765 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
10766
10767 /* Don't display if frame is invisible or not yet initialized. */
10768 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || !f->glyphs_initialized_p)
10769 return 0;
10770
10771 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
10772 /* When Emacs starts, selected_frame may be the initial terminal
10773 frame. If we let this through, a message would be displayed on
10774 the terminal. */
10775 if (FRAME_INITIAL_P (XFRAME (selected_frame)))
10776 return 0;
10777 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
10778
10779 /* Redraw garbaged frames. */
10780 if (frame_garbaged)
10781 clear_garbaged_frames ();
10782
10783 if (!NILP (echo_area_buffer[0]) || minibuf_level == 0)
10784 {
10785 echo_area_window = mini_window;
10786 window_height_changed_p = display_echo_area (w);
10787 w->must_be_updated_p = 1;
10788
10789 /* Update the display, unless called from redisplay_internal.
10790 Also don't update the screen during redisplay itself. The
10791 update will happen at the end of redisplay, and an update
10792 here could cause confusion. */
10793 if (update_frame_p && !redisplaying_p)
10794 {
10795 int n = 0;
10796
10797 /* If the display update has been interrupted by pending
10798 input, update mode lines in the frame. Due to the
10799 pending input, it might have been that redisplay hasn't
10800 been called, so that mode lines above the echo area are
10801 garbaged. This looks odd, so we prevent it here. */
10802 if (!display_completed)
10803 n = redisplay_mode_lines (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f), 0);
10804
10805 if (window_height_changed_p
10806 /* Don't do this if Emacs is shutting down. Redisplay
10807 needs to run hooks. */
10808 && !NILP (Vrun_hooks))
10809 {
10810 /* Must update other windows. Likewise as in other
10811 cases, don't let this update be interrupted by
10812 pending input. */
10813 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
10814 specbind (Qredisplay_dont_pause, Qt);
10815 windows_or_buffers_changed = 1;
10816 redisplay_internal ();
10817 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
10818 }
10819 else if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f) && n == 0)
10820 {
10821 /* Window configuration is the same as before.
10822 Can do with a display update of the echo area,
10823 unless we displayed some mode lines. */
10824 update_single_window (w, 1);
10825 FRAME_RIF (f)->flush_display (f);
10826 }
10827 else
10828 update_frame (f, 1, 1);
10829
10830 /* If cursor is in the echo area, make sure that the next
10831 redisplay displays the minibuffer, so that the cursor will
10832 be replaced with what the minibuffer wants. */
10833 if (cursor_in_echo_area)
10834 ++windows_or_buffers_changed;
10835 }
10836 }
10837 else if (!EQ (mini_window, selected_window))
10838 windows_or_buffers_changed++;
10839
10840 /* Last displayed message is now the current message. */
10841 echo_area_buffer[1] = echo_area_buffer[0];
10842 /* Inform read_char that we're not echoing. */
10843 echo_message_buffer = Qnil;
10844
10845 /* Prevent redisplay optimization in redisplay_internal by resetting
10846 this_line_start_pos. This is done because the mini-buffer now
10847 displays the message instead of its buffer text. */
10848 if (EQ (mini_window, selected_window))
10849 CHARPOS (this_line_start_pos) = 0;
10850
10851 return window_height_changed_p;
10852 }
10853
10854
10855 \f
10856 /***********************************************************************
10857 Mode Lines and Frame Titles
10858 ***********************************************************************/
10859
10860 /* A buffer for constructing non-propertized mode-line strings and
10861 frame titles in it; allocated from the heap in init_xdisp and
10862 resized as needed in store_mode_line_noprop_char. */
10863
10864 static char *mode_line_noprop_buf;
10865
10866 /* The buffer's end, and a current output position in it. */
10867
10868 static char *mode_line_noprop_buf_end;
10869 static char *mode_line_noprop_ptr;
10870
10871 #define MODE_LINE_NOPROP_LEN(start) \
10872 ((mode_line_noprop_ptr - mode_line_noprop_buf) - start)
10873
10874 static enum {
10875 MODE_LINE_DISPLAY = 0,
10876 MODE_LINE_TITLE,
10877 MODE_LINE_NOPROP,
10878 MODE_LINE_STRING
10879 } mode_line_target;
10880
10881 /* Alist that caches the results of :propertize.
10882 Each element is (PROPERTIZED-STRING . PROPERTY-LIST). */
10883 static Lisp_Object mode_line_proptrans_alist;
10884
10885 /* List of strings making up the mode-line. */
10886 static Lisp_Object mode_line_string_list;
10887
10888 /* Base face property when building propertized mode line string. */
10889 static Lisp_Object mode_line_string_face;
10890 static Lisp_Object mode_line_string_face_prop;
10891
10892
10893 /* Unwind data for mode line strings */
10894
10895 static Lisp_Object Vmode_line_unwind_vector;
10896
10897 static Lisp_Object
10898 format_mode_line_unwind_data (struct frame *target_frame,
10899 struct buffer *obuf,
10900 Lisp_Object owin,
10901 int save_proptrans)
10902 {
10903 Lisp_Object vector, tmp;
10904
10905 /* Reduce consing by keeping one vector in
10906 Vwith_echo_area_save_vector. */
10907 vector = Vmode_line_unwind_vector;
10908 Vmode_line_unwind_vector = Qnil;
10909
10910 if (NILP (vector))
10911 vector = Fmake_vector (make_number (10), Qnil);
10912
10913 ASET (vector, 0, make_number (mode_line_target));
10914 ASET (vector, 1, make_number (MODE_LINE_NOPROP_LEN (0)));
10915 ASET (vector, 2, mode_line_string_list);
10916 ASET (vector, 3, save_proptrans ? mode_line_proptrans_alist : Qt);
10917 ASET (vector, 4, mode_line_string_face);
10918 ASET (vector, 5, mode_line_string_face_prop);
10919
10920 if (obuf)
10921 XSETBUFFER (tmp, obuf);
10922 else
10923 tmp = Qnil;
10924 ASET (vector, 6, tmp);
10925 ASET (vector, 7, owin);
10926 if (target_frame)
10927 {
10928 /* Similarly to `with-selected-window', if the operation selects
10929 a window on another frame, we must restore that frame's
10930 selected window, and (for a tty) the top-frame. */
10931 ASET (vector, 8, target_frame->selected_window);
10932 if (FRAME_TERMCAP_P (target_frame))
10933 ASET (vector, 9, FRAME_TTY (target_frame)->top_frame);
10934 }
10935
10936 return vector;
10937 }
10938
10939 static Lisp_Object
10940 unwind_format_mode_line (Lisp_Object vector)
10941 {
10942 Lisp_Object old_window = AREF (vector, 7);
10943 Lisp_Object target_frame_window = AREF (vector, 8);
10944 Lisp_Object old_top_frame = AREF (vector, 9);
10945
10946 mode_line_target = XINT (AREF (vector, 0));
10947 mode_line_noprop_ptr = mode_line_noprop_buf + XINT (AREF (vector, 1));
10948 mode_line_string_list = AREF (vector, 2);
10949 if (! EQ (AREF (vector, 3), Qt))
10950 mode_line_proptrans_alist = AREF (vector, 3);
10951 mode_line_string_face = AREF (vector, 4);
10952 mode_line_string_face_prop = AREF (vector, 5);
10953
10954 /* Select window before buffer, since it may change the buffer. */
10955 if (!NILP (old_window))
10956 {
10957 /* If the operation that we are unwinding had selected a window
10958 on a different frame, reset its frame-selected-window. For a
10959 text terminal, reset its top-frame if necessary. */
10960 if (!NILP (target_frame_window))
10961 {
10962 Lisp_Object frame
10963 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (target_frame_window));
10964
10965 if (!EQ (frame, WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (old_window))))
10966 Fselect_window (target_frame_window, Qt);
10967
10968 if (!NILP (old_top_frame) && !EQ (old_top_frame, frame))
10969 Fselect_frame (old_top_frame, Qt);
10970 }
10971
10972 Fselect_window (old_window, Qt);
10973 }
10974
10975 if (!NILP (AREF (vector, 6)))
10976 {
10977 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (AREF (vector, 6)));
10978 ASET (vector, 6, Qnil);
10979 }
10980
10981 Vmode_line_unwind_vector = vector;
10982 return Qnil;
10983 }
10984
10985
10986 /* Store a single character C for the frame title in mode_line_noprop_buf.
10987 Re-allocate mode_line_noprop_buf if necessary. */
10988
10989 static void
10990 store_mode_line_noprop_char (char c)
10991 {
10992 /* If output position has reached the end of the allocated buffer,
10993 increase the buffer's size. */
10994 if (mode_line_noprop_ptr == mode_line_noprop_buf_end)
10995 {
10996 ptrdiff_t len = MODE_LINE_NOPROP_LEN (0);
10997 ptrdiff_t size = len;
10998 mode_line_noprop_buf =
10999 xpalloc (mode_line_noprop_buf, &size, 1, STRING_BYTES_BOUND, 1);
11000 mode_line_noprop_buf_end = mode_line_noprop_buf + size;
11001 mode_line_noprop_ptr = mode_line_noprop_buf + len;
11002 }
11003
11004 *mode_line_noprop_ptr++ = c;
11005 }
11006
11007
11008 /* Store part of a frame title in mode_line_noprop_buf, beginning at
11009 mode_line_noprop_ptr. STRING is the string to store. Do not copy
11010 characters that yield more columns than PRECISION; PRECISION <= 0
11011 means copy the whole string. Pad with spaces until FIELD_WIDTH
11012 number of characters have been copied; FIELD_WIDTH <= 0 means don't
11013 pad. Called from display_mode_element when it is used to build a
11014 frame title. */
11015
11016 static int
11017 store_mode_line_noprop (const char *string, int field_width, int precision)
11018 {
11019 const unsigned char *str = (const unsigned char *) string;
11020 int n = 0;
11021 ptrdiff_t dummy, nbytes;
11022
11023 /* Copy at most PRECISION chars from STR. */
11024 nbytes = strlen (string);
11025 n += c_string_width (str, nbytes, precision, &dummy, &nbytes);
11026 while (nbytes--)
11027 store_mode_line_noprop_char (*str++);
11028
11029 /* Fill up with spaces until FIELD_WIDTH reached. */
11030 while (field_width > 0
11031 && n < field_width)
11032 {
11033 store_mode_line_noprop_char (' ');
11034 ++n;
11035 }
11036
11037 return n;
11038 }
11039
11040 /***********************************************************************
11041 Frame Titles
11042 ***********************************************************************/
11043
11044 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
11045
11046 /* Set the title of FRAME, if it has changed. The title format is
11047 Vicon_title_format if FRAME is iconified, otherwise it is
11048 frame_title_format. */
11049
11050 static void
11051 x_consider_frame_title (Lisp_Object frame)
11052 {
11053 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
11054
11055 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
11056 || FRAME_MINIBUF_ONLY_P (f)
11057 || f->explicit_name)
11058 {
11059 /* Do we have more than one visible frame on this X display? */
11060 Lisp_Object tail;
11061 Lisp_Object fmt;
11062 ptrdiff_t title_start;
11063 char *title;
11064 ptrdiff_t len;
11065 struct it it;
11066 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
11067
11068 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
11069 {
11070 Lisp_Object other_frame = XCAR (tail);
11071 struct frame *tf = XFRAME (other_frame);
11072
11073 if (tf != f
11074 && FRAME_KBOARD (tf) == FRAME_KBOARD (f)
11075 && !FRAME_MINIBUF_ONLY_P (tf)
11076 && !EQ (other_frame, tip_frame)
11077 && (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (tf) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (tf)))
11078 break;
11079 }
11080
11081 /* Set global variable indicating that multiple frames exist. */
11082 multiple_frames = CONSP (tail);
11083
11084 /* Switch to the buffer of selected window of the frame. Set up
11085 mode_line_target so that display_mode_element will output into
11086 mode_line_noprop_buf; then display the title. */
11087 record_unwind_protect (unwind_format_mode_line,
11088 format_mode_line_unwind_data
11089 (f, current_buffer, selected_window, 0));
11090
11091 Fselect_window (f->selected_window, Qt);
11092 set_buffer_internal_1
11093 (XBUFFER (XWINDOW (f->selected_window)->buffer));
11094 fmt = FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) ? Vicon_title_format : Vframe_title_format;
11095
11096 mode_line_target = MODE_LINE_TITLE;
11097 title_start = MODE_LINE_NOPROP_LEN (0);
11098 init_iterator (&it, XWINDOW (f->selected_window), -1, -1,
11099 NULL, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
11100 display_mode_element (&it, 0, -1, -1, fmt, Qnil, 0);
11101 len = MODE_LINE_NOPROP_LEN (title_start);
11102 title = mode_line_noprop_buf + title_start;
11103 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
11104
11105 /* Set the title only if it's changed. This avoids consing in
11106 the common case where it hasn't. (If it turns out that we've
11107 already wasted too much time by walking through the list with
11108 display_mode_element, then we might need to optimize at a
11109 higher level than this.) */
11110 if (! STRINGP (f->name)
11111 || SBYTES (f->name) != len
11112 || memcmp (title, SDATA (f->name), len) != 0)
11113 x_implicitly_set_name (f, make_string (title, len), Qnil);
11114 }
11115 }
11116
11117 #endif /* not HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
11118
11119 \f
11120 /***********************************************************************
11121 Menu Bars
11122 ***********************************************************************/
11123
11124
11125 /* Prepare for redisplay by updating menu-bar item lists when
11126 appropriate. This can call eval. */
11127
11128 void
11129 prepare_menu_bars (void)
11130 {
11131 int all_windows;
11132 struct gcpro gcpro1, gcpro2;
11133 struct frame *f;
11134 Lisp_Object tooltip_frame;
11135
11136 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
11137 tooltip_frame = tip_frame;
11138 #else
11139 tooltip_frame = Qnil;
11140 #endif
11141
11142 /* Update all frame titles based on their buffer names, etc. We do
11143 this before the menu bars so that the buffer-menu will show the
11144 up-to-date frame titles. */
11145 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
11146 if (windows_or_buffers_changed || update_mode_lines)
11147 {
11148 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
11149
11150 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
11151 {
11152 f = XFRAME (frame);
11153 if (!EQ (frame, tooltip_frame)
11154 && (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)))
11155 x_consider_frame_title (frame);
11156 }
11157 }
11158 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
11159
11160 /* Update the menu bar item lists, if appropriate. This has to be
11161 done before any actual redisplay or generation of display lines. */
11162 all_windows = (update_mode_lines
11163 || buffer_shared > 1
11164 || windows_or_buffers_changed);
11165 if (all_windows)
11166 {
11167 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
11168 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
11169 /* 1 means that update_menu_bar has run its hooks
11170 so any further calls to update_menu_bar shouldn't do so again. */
11171 int menu_bar_hooks_run = 0;
11172
11173 record_unwind_save_match_data ();
11174
11175 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
11176 {
11177 f = XFRAME (frame);
11178
11179 /* Ignore tooltip frame. */
11180 if (EQ (frame, tooltip_frame))
11181 continue;
11182
11183 /* If a window on this frame changed size, report that to
11184 the user and clear the size-change flag. */
11185 if (FRAME_WINDOW_SIZES_CHANGED (f))
11186 {
11187 Lisp_Object functions;
11188
11189 /* Clear flag first in case we get an error below. */
11190 FRAME_WINDOW_SIZES_CHANGED (f) = 0;
11191 functions = Vwindow_size_change_functions;
11192 GCPRO2 (tail, functions);
11193
11194 while (CONSP (functions))
11195 {
11196 if (!EQ (XCAR (functions), Qt))
11197 call1 (XCAR (functions), frame);
11198 functions = XCDR (functions);
11199 }
11200 UNGCPRO;
11201 }
11202
11203 GCPRO1 (tail);
11204 menu_bar_hooks_run = update_menu_bar (f, 0, menu_bar_hooks_run);
11205 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
11206 update_tool_bar (f, 0);
11207 #endif
11208 #ifdef HAVE_NS
11209 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
11210 && FRAME_NS_P (f))
11211 ns_set_doc_edited
11212 (f, Fbuffer_modified_p (XWINDOW (f->selected_window)->buffer));
11213 #endif
11214 UNGCPRO;
11215 }
11216
11217 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
11218 }
11219 else
11220 {
11221 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
11222 update_menu_bar (sf, 1, 0);
11223 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
11224 update_tool_bar (sf, 1);
11225 #endif
11226 }
11227 }
11228
11229
11230 /* Update the menu bar item list for frame F. This has to be done
11231 before we start to fill in any display lines, because it can call
11232 eval.
11233
11234 If SAVE_MATCH_DATA is non-zero, we must save and restore it here.
11235
11236 If HOOKS_RUN is 1, that means a previous call to update_menu_bar
11237 already ran the menu bar hooks for this redisplay, so there
11238 is no need to run them again. The return value is the
11239 updated value of this flag, to pass to the next call. */
11240
11241 static int
11242 update_menu_bar (struct frame *f, int save_match_data, int hooks_run)
11243 {
11244 Lisp_Object window;
11245 register struct window *w;
11246
11247 /* If called recursively during a menu update, do nothing. This can
11248 happen when, for instance, an activate-menubar-hook causes a
11249 redisplay. */
11250 if (inhibit_menubar_update)
11251 return hooks_run;
11252
11253 window = FRAME_SELECTED_WINDOW (f);
11254 w = XWINDOW (window);
11255
11256 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
11257 ?
11258 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (HAVE_NTGUI) \
11259 || defined (HAVE_NS) || defined (USE_GTK)
11260 FRAME_EXTERNAL_MENU_BAR (f)
11261 #else
11262 FRAME_MENU_BAR_LINES (f) > 0
11263 #endif
11264 : FRAME_MENU_BAR_LINES (f) > 0)
11265 {
11266 /* If the user has switched buffers or windows, we need to
11267 recompute to reflect the new bindings. But we'll
11268 recompute when update_mode_lines is set too; that means
11269 that people can use force-mode-line-update to request
11270 that the menu bar be recomputed. The adverse effect on
11271 the rest of the redisplay algorithm is about the same as
11272 windows_or_buffers_changed anyway. */
11273 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
11274 /* This used to test w->update_mode_line, but we believe
11275 there is no need to recompute the menu in that case. */
11276 || update_mode_lines
11277 || ((BUF_SAVE_MODIFF (XBUFFER (w->buffer))
11278 < BUF_MODIFF (XBUFFER (w->buffer)))
11279 != w->last_had_star)
11280 || ((!NILP (Vtransient_mark_mode)
11281 && !NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), mark_active)))
11282 != !NILP (w->region_showing)))
11283 {
11284 struct buffer *prev = current_buffer;
11285 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
11286
11287 specbind (Qinhibit_menubar_update, Qt);
11288
11289 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (w->buffer));
11290 if (save_match_data)
11291 record_unwind_save_match_data ();
11292 if (NILP (Voverriding_local_map_menu_flag))
11293 {
11294 specbind (Qoverriding_terminal_local_map, Qnil);
11295 specbind (Qoverriding_local_map, Qnil);
11296 }
11297
11298 if (!hooks_run)
11299 {
11300 /* Run the Lucid hook. */
11301 safe_run_hooks (Qactivate_menubar_hook);
11302
11303 /* If it has changed current-menubar from previous value,
11304 really recompute the menu-bar from the value. */
11305 if (! NILP (Vlucid_menu_bar_dirty_flag))
11306 call0 (Qrecompute_lucid_menubar);
11307
11308 safe_run_hooks (Qmenu_bar_update_hook);
11309
11310 hooks_run = 1;
11311 }
11312
11313 XSETFRAME (Vmenu_updating_frame, f);
11314 fset_menu_bar_items (f, menu_bar_items (FRAME_MENU_BAR_ITEMS (f)));
11315
11316 /* Redisplay the menu bar in case we changed it. */
11317 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (HAVE_NTGUI) \
11318 || defined (HAVE_NS) || defined (USE_GTK)
11319 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
11320 {
11321 #if defined (HAVE_NS)
11322 /* All frames on Mac OS share the same menubar. So only
11323 the selected frame should be allowed to set it. */
11324 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
11325 #endif
11326 set_frame_menubar (f, 0, 0);
11327 }
11328 else
11329 /* On a terminal screen, the menu bar is an ordinary screen
11330 line, and this makes it get updated. */
11331 w->update_mode_line = 1;
11332 #else /* ! (USE_X_TOOLKIT || HAVE_NTGUI || HAVE_NS || USE_GTK) */
11333 /* In the non-toolkit version, the menu bar is an ordinary screen
11334 line, and this makes it get updated. */
11335 w->update_mode_line = 1;
11336 #endif /* ! (USE_X_TOOLKIT || HAVE_NTGUI || HAVE_NS || USE_GTK) */
11337
11338 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
11339 set_buffer_internal_1 (prev);
11340 }
11341 }
11342
11343 return hooks_run;
11344 }
11345
11346
11347 \f
11348 /***********************************************************************
11349 Output Cursor
11350 ***********************************************************************/
11351
11352 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
11353
11354 /* EXPORT:
11355 Nominal cursor position -- where to draw output.
11356 HPOS and VPOS are window relative glyph matrix coordinates.
11357 X and Y are window relative pixel coordinates. */
11358
11359 struct cursor_pos output_cursor;
11360
11361
11362 /* EXPORT:
11363 Set the global variable output_cursor to CURSOR. All cursor
11364 positions are relative to updated_window. */
11365
11366 void
11367 set_output_cursor (struct cursor_pos *cursor)
11368 {
11369 output_cursor.hpos = cursor->hpos;
11370 output_cursor.vpos = cursor->vpos;
11371 output_cursor.x = cursor->x;
11372 output_cursor.y = cursor->y;
11373 }
11374
11375
11376 /* EXPORT for RIF:
11377 Set a nominal cursor position.
11378
11379 HPOS and VPOS are column/row positions in a window glyph matrix. X
11380 and Y are window text area relative pixel positions.
11381
11382 If this is done during an update, updated_window will contain the
11383 window that is being updated and the position is the future output
11384 cursor position for that window. If updated_window is null, use
11385 selected_window and display the cursor at the given position. */
11386
11387 void
11388 x_cursor_to (int vpos, int hpos, int y, int x)
11389 {
11390 struct window *w;
11391
11392 /* If updated_window is not set, work on selected_window. */
11393 if (updated_window)
11394 w = updated_window;
11395 else
11396 w = XWINDOW (selected_window);
11397
11398 /* Set the output cursor. */
11399 output_cursor.hpos = hpos;
11400 output_cursor.vpos = vpos;
11401 output_cursor.x = x;
11402 output_cursor.y = y;
11403
11404 /* If not called as part of an update, really display the cursor.
11405 This will also set the cursor position of W. */
11406 if (updated_window == NULL)
11407 {
11408 BLOCK_INPUT;
11409 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, hpos, vpos, x, y);
11410 if (FRAME_RIF (SELECTED_FRAME ())->flush_display_optional)
11411 FRAME_RIF (SELECTED_FRAME ())->flush_display_optional (SELECTED_FRAME ());
11412 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
11413 }
11414 }
11415
11416 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
11417
11418 \f
11419 /***********************************************************************
11420 Tool-bars
11421 ***********************************************************************/
11422
11423 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
11424
11425 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
11426
11427 FRAME_PTR last_mouse_frame;
11428
11429 /* Tool-bar item index of the item on which a mouse button was pressed
11430 or -1. */
11431
11432 int last_tool_bar_item;
11433
11434
11435 static Lisp_Object
11436 update_tool_bar_unwind (Lisp_Object frame)
11437 {
11438 selected_frame = frame;
11439 return Qnil;
11440 }
11441
11442 /* Update the tool-bar item list for frame F. This has to be done
11443 before we start to fill in any display lines. Called from
11444 prepare_menu_bars. If SAVE_MATCH_DATA is non-zero, we must save
11445 and restore it here. */
11446
11447 static void
11448 update_tool_bar (struct frame *f, int save_match_data)
11449 {
11450 #if defined (USE_GTK) || defined (HAVE_NS)
11451 int do_update = FRAME_EXTERNAL_TOOL_BAR (f);
11452 #else
11453 int do_update = WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
11454 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)) > 0;
11455 #endif
11456
11457 if (do_update)
11458 {
11459 Lisp_Object window;
11460 struct window *w;
11461
11462 window = FRAME_SELECTED_WINDOW (f);
11463 w = XWINDOW (window);
11464
11465 /* If the user has switched buffers or windows, we need to
11466 recompute to reflect the new bindings. But we'll
11467 recompute when update_mode_lines is set too; that means
11468 that people can use force-mode-line-update to request
11469 that the menu bar be recomputed. The adverse effect on
11470 the rest of the redisplay algorithm is about the same as
11471 windows_or_buffers_changed anyway. */
11472 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
11473 || w->update_mode_line
11474 || update_mode_lines
11475 || ((BUF_SAVE_MODIFF (XBUFFER (w->buffer))
11476 < BUF_MODIFF (XBUFFER (w->buffer)))
11477 != w->last_had_star)
11478 || ((!NILP (Vtransient_mark_mode)
11479 && !NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), mark_active)))
11480 != !NILP (w->region_showing)))
11481 {
11482 struct buffer *prev = current_buffer;
11483 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
11484 Lisp_Object frame, new_tool_bar;
11485 int new_n_tool_bar;
11486 struct gcpro gcpro1;
11487
11488 /* Set current_buffer to the buffer of the selected
11489 window of the frame, so that we get the right local
11490 keymaps. */
11491 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (w->buffer));
11492
11493 /* Save match data, if we must. */
11494 if (save_match_data)
11495 record_unwind_save_match_data ();
11496
11497 /* Make sure that we don't accidentally use bogus keymaps. */
11498 if (NILP (Voverriding_local_map_menu_flag))
11499 {
11500 specbind (Qoverriding_terminal_local_map, Qnil);
11501 specbind (Qoverriding_local_map, Qnil);
11502 }
11503
11504 GCPRO1 (new_tool_bar);
11505
11506 /* We must temporarily set the selected frame to this frame
11507 before calling tool_bar_items, because the calculation of
11508 the tool-bar keymap uses the selected frame (see
11509 `tool-bar-make-keymap' in tool-bar.el). */
11510 record_unwind_protect (update_tool_bar_unwind, selected_frame);
11511 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
11512 selected_frame = frame;
11513
11514 /* Build desired tool-bar items from keymaps. */
11515 new_tool_bar
11516 = tool_bar_items (Fcopy_sequence (f->tool_bar_items),
11517 &new_n_tool_bar);
11518
11519 /* Redisplay the tool-bar if we changed it. */
11520 if (new_n_tool_bar != f->n_tool_bar_items
11521 || NILP (Fequal (new_tool_bar, f->tool_bar_items)))
11522 {
11523 /* Redisplay that happens asynchronously due to an expose event
11524 may access f->tool_bar_items. Make sure we update both
11525 variables within BLOCK_INPUT so no such event interrupts. */
11526 BLOCK_INPUT;
11527 fset_tool_bar_items (f, new_tool_bar);
11528 f->n_tool_bar_items = new_n_tool_bar;
11529 w->update_mode_line = 1;
11530 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
11531 }
11532
11533 UNGCPRO;
11534
11535 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
11536 set_buffer_internal_1 (prev);
11537 }
11538 }
11539 }
11540
11541
11542 /* Set F->desired_tool_bar_string to a Lisp string representing frame
11543 F's desired tool-bar contents. F->tool_bar_items must have
11544 been set up previously by calling prepare_menu_bars. */
11545
11546 static void
11547 build_desired_tool_bar_string (struct frame *f)
11548 {
11549 int i, size, size_needed;
11550 struct gcpro gcpro1, gcpro2, gcpro3;
11551 Lisp_Object image, plist, props;
11552
11553 image = plist = props = Qnil;
11554 GCPRO3 (image, plist, props);
11555
11556 /* Prepare F->desired_tool_bar_string. If we can reuse it, do so.
11557 Otherwise, make a new string. */
11558
11559 /* The size of the string we might be able to reuse. */
11560 size = (STRINGP (f->desired_tool_bar_string)
11561 ? SCHARS (f->desired_tool_bar_string)
11562 : 0);
11563
11564 /* We need one space in the string for each image. */
11565 size_needed = f->n_tool_bar_items;
11566
11567 /* Reuse f->desired_tool_bar_string, if possible. */
11568 if (size < size_needed || NILP (f->desired_tool_bar_string))
11569 fset_desired_tool_bar_string
11570 (f, Fmake_string (make_number (size_needed), make_number (' ')));
11571 else
11572 {
11573 props = list4 (Qdisplay, Qnil, Qmenu_item, Qnil);
11574 Fremove_text_properties (make_number (0), make_number (size),
11575 props, f->desired_tool_bar_string);
11576 }
11577
11578 /* Put a `display' property on the string for the images to display,
11579 put a `menu_item' property on tool-bar items with a value that
11580 is the index of the item in F's tool-bar item vector. */
11581 for (i = 0; i < f->n_tool_bar_items; ++i)
11582 {
11583 #define PROP(IDX) \
11584 AREF (f->tool_bar_items, i * TOOL_BAR_ITEM_NSLOTS + (IDX))
11585
11586 int enabled_p = !NILP (PROP (TOOL_BAR_ITEM_ENABLED_P));
11587 int selected_p = !NILP (PROP (TOOL_BAR_ITEM_SELECTED_P));
11588 int hmargin, vmargin, relief, idx, end;
11589
11590 /* If image is a vector, choose the image according to the
11591 button state. */
11592 image = PROP (TOOL_BAR_ITEM_IMAGES);
11593 if (VECTORP (image))
11594 {
11595 if (enabled_p)
11596 idx = (selected_p
11597 ? TOOL_BAR_IMAGE_ENABLED_SELECTED
11598 : TOOL_BAR_IMAGE_ENABLED_DESELECTED);
11599 else
11600 idx = (selected_p
11601 ? TOOL_BAR_IMAGE_DISABLED_SELECTED
11602 : TOOL_BAR_IMAGE_DISABLED_DESELECTED);
11603
11604 eassert (ASIZE (image) >= idx);
11605 image = AREF (image, idx);
11606 }
11607 else
11608 idx = -1;
11609
11610 /* Ignore invalid image specifications. */
11611 if (!valid_image_p (image))
11612 continue;
11613
11614 /* Display the tool-bar button pressed, or depressed. */
11615 plist = Fcopy_sequence (XCDR (image));
11616
11617 /* Compute margin and relief to draw. */
11618 relief = (tool_bar_button_relief >= 0
11619 ? tool_bar_button_relief
11620 : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF);
11621 hmargin = vmargin = relief;
11622
11623 if (RANGED_INTEGERP (1, Vtool_bar_button_margin,
11624 INT_MAX - max (hmargin, vmargin)))
11625 {
11626 hmargin += XFASTINT (Vtool_bar_button_margin);
11627 vmargin += XFASTINT (Vtool_bar_button_margin);
11628 }
11629 else if (CONSP (Vtool_bar_button_margin))
11630 {
11631 if (RANGED_INTEGERP (1, XCAR (Vtool_bar_button_margin),
11632 INT_MAX - hmargin))
11633 hmargin += XFASTINT (XCAR (Vtool_bar_button_margin));
11634
11635 if (RANGED_INTEGERP (1, XCDR (Vtool_bar_button_margin),
11636 INT_MAX - vmargin))
11637 vmargin += XFASTINT (XCDR (Vtool_bar_button_margin));
11638 }
11639
11640 if (auto_raise_tool_bar_buttons_p)
11641 {
11642 /* Add a `:relief' property to the image spec if the item is
11643 selected. */
11644 if (selected_p)
11645 {
11646 plist = Fplist_put (plist, QCrelief, make_number (-relief));
11647 hmargin -= relief;
11648 vmargin -= relief;
11649 }
11650 }
11651 else
11652 {
11653 /* If image is selected, display it pressed, i.e. with a
11654 negative relief. If it's not selected, display it with a
11655 raised relief. */
11656 plist = Fplist_put (plist, QCrelief,
11657 (selected_p
11658 ? make_number (-relief)
11659 : make_number (relief)));
11660 hmargin -= relief;
11661 vmargin -= relief;
11662 }
11663
11664 /* Put a margin around the image. */
11665 if (hmargin || vmargin)
11666 {
11667 if (hmargin == vmargin)
11668 plist = Fplist_put (plist, QCmargin, make_number (hmargin));
11669 else
11670 plist = Fplist_put (plist, QCmargin,
11671 Fcons (make_number (hmargin),
11672 make_number (vmargin)));
11673 }
11674
11675 /* If button is not enabled, and we don't have special images
11676 for the disabled state, make the image appear disabled by
11677 applying an appropriate algorithm to it. */
11678 if (!enabled_p && idx < 0)
11679 plist = Fplist_put (plist, QCconversion, Qdisabled);
11680
11681 /* Put a `display' text property on the string for the image to
11682 display. Put a `menu-item' property on the string that gives
11683 the start of this item's properties in the tool-bar items
11684 vector. */
11685 image = Fcons (Qimage, plist);
11686 props = list4 (Qdisplay, image,
11687 Qmenu_item, make_number (i * TOOL_BAR_ITEM_NSLOTS));
11688
11689 /* Let the last image hide all remaining spaces in the tool bar
11690 string. The string can be longer than needed when we reuse a
11691 previous string. */
11692 if (i + 1 == f->n_tool_bar_items)
11693 end = SCHARS (f->desired_tool_bar_string);
11694 else
11695 end = i + 1;
11696 Fadd_text_properties (make_number (i), make_number (end),
11697 props, f->desired_tool_bar_string);
11698 #undef PROP
11699 }
11700
11701 UNGCPRO;
11702 }
11703
11704
11705 /* Display one line of the tool-bar of frame IT->f.
11706
11707 HEIGHT specifies the desired height of the tool-bar line.
11708 If the actual height of the glyph row is less than HEIGHT, the
11709 row's height is increased to HEIGHT, and the icons are centered
11710 vertically in the new height.
11711
11712 If HEIGHT is -1, we are counting needed tool-bar lines, so don't
11713 count a final empty row in case the tool-bar width exactly matches
11714 the window width.
11715 */
11716
11717 static void
11718 display_tool_bar_line (struct it *it, int height)
11719 {
11720 struct glyph_row *row = it->glyph_row;
11721 int max_x = it->last_visible_x;
11722 struct glyph *last;
11723
11724 prepare_desired_row (row);
11725 row->y = it->current_y;
11726
11727 /* Note that this isn't made use of if the face hasn't a box,
11728 so there's no need to check the face here. */
11729 it->start_of_box_run_p = 1;
11730
11731 while (it->current_x < max_x)
11732 {
11733 int x, n_glyphs_before, i, nglyphs;
11734 struct it it_before;
11735
11736 /* Get the next display element. */
11737 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
11738 {
11739 /* Don't count empty row if we are counting needed tool-bar lines. */
11740 if (height < 0 && !it->hpos)
11741 return;
11742 break;
11743 }
11744
11745 /* Produce glyphs. */
11746 n_glyphs_before = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
11747 it_before = *it;
11748
11749 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
11750
11751 nglyphs = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - n_glyphs_before;
11752 i = 0;
11753 x = it_before.current_x;
11754 while (i < nglyphs)
11755 {
11756 struct glyph *glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + n_glyphs_before + i;
11757
11758 if (x + glyph->pixel_width > max_x)
11759 {
11760 /* Glyph doesn't fit on line. Backtrack. */
11761 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = n_glyphs_before;
11762 *it = it_before;
11763 /* If this is the only glyph on this line, it will never fit on the
11764 tool-bar, so skip it. But ensure there is at least one glyph,
11765 so we don't accidentally disable the tool-bar. */
11766 if (n_glyphs_before == 0
11767 && (it->vpos > 0 || IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) < it->end_charpos-1))
11768 break;
11769 goto out;
11770 }
11771
11772 ++it->hpos;
11773 x += glyph->pixel_width;
11774 ++i;
11775 }
11776
11777 /* Stop at line end. */
11778 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
11779 break;
11780
11781 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
11782 }
11783
11784 out:;
11785
11786 row->displays_text_p = row->used[TEXT_AREA] != 0;
11787
11788 /* Use default face for the border below the tool bar.
11789
11790 FIXME: When auto-resize-tool-bars is grow-only, there is
11791 no additional border below the possibly empty tool-bar lines.
11792 So to make the extra empty lines look "normal", we have to
11793 use the tool-bar face for the border too. */
11794 if (!row->displays_text_p && !EQ (Vauto_resize_tool_bars, Qgrow_only))
11795 it->face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
11796
11797 extend_face_to_end_of_line (it);
11798 last = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
11799 last->right_box_line_p = 1;
11800 if (last == row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA])
11801 last->left_box_line_p = 1;
11802
11803 /* Make line the desired height and center it vertically. */
11804 if ((height -= it->max_ascent + it->max_descent) > 0)
11805 {
11806 /* Don't add more than one line height. */
11807 height %= FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (it->f);
11808 it->max_ascent += height / 2;
11809 it->max_descent += (height + 1) / 2;
11810 }
11811
11812 compute_line_metrics (it);
11813
11814 /* If line is empty, make it occupy the rest of the tool-bar. */
11815 if (!row->displays_text_p)
11816 {
11817 row->height = row->phys_height = it->last_visible_y - row->y;
11818 row->visible_height = row->height;
11819 row->ascent = row->phys_ascent = 0;
11820 row->extra_line_spacing = 0;
11821 }
11822
11823 row->full_width_p = 1;
11824 row->continued_p = 0;
11825 row->truncated_on_left_p = 0;
11826 row->truncated_on_right_p = 0;
11827
11828 it->current_x = it->hpos = 0;
11829 it->current_y += row->height;
11830 ++it->vpos;
11831 ++it->glyph_row;
11832 }
11833
11834
11835 /* Max tool-bar height. */
11836
11837 #define MAX_FRAME_TOOL_BAR_HEIGHT(f) \
11838 ((FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) * FRAME_LINES (f)))
11839
11840 /* Value is the number of screen lines needed to make all tool-bar
11841 items of frame F visible. The number of actual rows needed is
11842 returned in *N_ROWS if non-NULL. */
11843
11844 static int
11845 tool_bar_lines_needed (struct frame *f, int *n_rows)
11846 {
11847 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window);
11848 struct it it;
11849 /* tool_bar_lines_needed is called from redisplay_tool_bar after building
11850 the desired matrix, so use (unused) mode-line row as temporary row to
11851 avoid destroying the first tool-bar row. */
11852 struct glyph_row *temp_row = MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->desired_matrix);
11853
11854 /* Initialize an iterator for iteration over
11855 F->desired_tool_bar_string in the tool-bar window of frame F. */
11856 init_iterator (&it, w, -1, -1, temp_row, TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID);
11857 it.first_visible_x = 0;
11858 it.last_visible_x = FRAME_TOTAL_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
11859 reseat_to_string (&it, NULL, f->desired_tool_bar_string, 0, 0, 0, -1);
11860 it.paragraph_embedding = L2R;
11861
11862 while (!ITERATOR_AT_END_P (&it))
11863 {
11864 clear_glyph_row (temp_row);
11865 it.glyph_row = temp_row;
11866 display_tool_bar_line (&it, -1);
11867 }
11868 clear_glyph_row (temp_row);
11869
11870 /* f->n_tool_bar_rows == 0 means "unknown"; -1 means no tool-bar. */
11871 if (n_rows)
11872 *n_rows = it.vpos > 0 ? it.vpos : -1;
11873
11874 return (it.current_y + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) - 1) / FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
11875 }
11876
11877
11878 DEFUN ("tool-bar-lines-needed", Ftool_bar_lines_needed, Stool_bar_lines_needed,
11879 0, 1, 0,
11880 doc: /* Return the number of lines occupied by the tool bar of FRAME. */)
11881 (Lisp_Object frame)
11882 {
11883 struct frame *f;
11884 struct window *w;
11885 int nlines = 0;
11886
11887 if (NILP (frame))
11888 frame = selected_frame;
11889 else
11890 CHECK_FRAME (frame);
11891 f = XFRAME (frame);
11892
11893 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
11894 && (w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window),
11895 WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) > 0))
11896 {
11897 update_tool_bar (f, 1);
11898 if (f->n_tool_bar_items)
11899 {
11900 build_desired_tool_bar_string (f);
11901 nlines = tool_bar_lines_needed (f, NULL);
11902 }
11903 }
11904
11905 return make_number (nlines);
11906 }
11907
11908
11909 /* Display the tool-bar of frame F. Value is non-zero if tool-bar's
11910 height should be changed. */
11911
11912 static int
11913 redisplay_tool_bar (struct frame *f)
11914 {
11915 struct window *w;
11916 struct it it;
11917 struct glyph_row *row;
11918
11919 #if defined (USE_GTK) || defined (HAVE_NS)
11920 if (FRAME_EXTERNAL_TOOL_BAR (f))
11921 update_frame_tool_bar (f);
11922 return 0;
11923 #endif
11924
11925 /* If frame hasn't a tool-bar window or if it is zero-height, don't
11926 do anything. This means you must start with tool-bar-lines
11927 non-zero to get the auto-sizing effect. Or in other words, you
11928 can turn off tool-bars by specifying tool-bar-lines zero. */
11929 if (!WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
11930 || (w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window),
11931 WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) == 0))
11932 return 0;
11933
11934 /* Set up an iterator for the tool-bar window. */
11935 init_iterator (&it, w, -1, -1, w->desired_matrix->rows, TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID);
11936 it.first_visible_x = 0;
11937 it.last_visible_x = FRAME_TOTAL_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
11938 row = it.glyph_row;
11939
11940 /* Build a string that represents the contents of the tool-bar. */
11941 build_desired_tool_bar_string (f);
11942 reseat_to_string (&it, NULL, f->desired_tool_bar_string, 0, 0, 0, -1);
11943 /* FIXME: This should be controlled by a user option. But it
11944 doesn't make sense to have an R2L tool bar if the menu bar cannot
11945 be drawn also R2L, and making the menu bar R2L is tricky due
11946 toolkit-specific code that implements it. If an R2L tool bar is
11947 ever supported, display_tool_bar_line should also be augmented to
11948 call unproduce_glyphs like display_line and display_string
11949 do. */
11950 it.paragraph_embedding = L2R;
11951
11952 if (f->n_tool_bar_rows == 0)
11953 {
11954 int nlines;
11955
11956 if ((nlines = tool_bar_lines_needed (f, &f->n_tool_bar_rows),
11957 nlines != WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w)))
11958 {
11959 Lisp_Object frame;
11960 int old_height = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w);
11961
11962 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
11963 Fmodify_frame_parameters (frame,
11964 Fcons (Fcons (Qtool_bar_lines,
11965 make_number (nlines)),
11966 Qnil));
11967 if (WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) != old_height)
11968 {
11969 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
11970 fonts_changed_p = 1;
11971 return 1;
11972 }
11973 }
11974 }
11975
11976 /* Display as many lines as needed to display all tool-bar items. */
11977
11978 if (f->n_tool_bar_rows > 0)
11979 {
11980 int border, rows, height, extra;
11981
11982 if (TYPE_RANGED_INTEGERP (int, Vtool_bar_border))
11983 border = XINT (Vtool_bar_border);
11984 else if (EQ (Vtool_bar_border, Qinternal_border_width))
11985 border = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
11986 else if (EQ (Vtool_bar_border, Qborder_width))
11987 border = f->border_width;
11988 else
11989 border = 0;
11990 if (border < 0)
11991 border = 0;
11992
11993 rows = f->n_tool_bar_rows;
11994 height = max (1, (it.last_visible_y - border) / rows);
11995 extra = it.last_visible_y - border - height * rows;
11996
11997 while (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y)
11998 {
11999 int h = 0;
12000 if (extra > 0 && rows-- > 0)
12001 {
12002 h = (extra + rows - 1) / rows;
12003 extra -= h;
12004 }
12005 display_tool_bar_line (&it, height + h);
12006 }
12007 }
12008 else
12009 {
12010 while (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y)
12011 display_tool_bar_line (&it, 0);
12012 }
12013
12014 /* It doesn't make much sense to try scrolling in the tool-bar
12015 window, so don't do it. */
12016 w->desired_matrix->no_scrolling_p = 1;
12017 w->must_be_updated_p = 1;
12018
12019 if (!NILP (Vauto_resize_tool_bars))
12020 {
12021 int max_tool_bar_height = MAX_FRAME_TOOL_BAR_HEIGHT (f);
12022 int change_height_p = 0;
12023
12024 /* If we couldn't display everything, change the tool-bar's
12025 height if there is room for more. */
12026 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (it) < it.end_charpos
12027 && it.current_y < max_tool_bar_height)
12028 change_height_p = 1;
12029
12030 row = it.glyph_row - 1;
12031
12032 /* If there are blank lines at the end, except for a partially
12033 visible blank line at the end that is smaller than
12034 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT, change the tool-bar's height. */
12035 if (!row->displays_text_p
12036 && row->height >= FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
12037 change_height_p = 1;
12038
12039 /* If row displays tool-bar items, but is partially visible,
12040 change the tool-bar's height. */
12041 if (row->displays_text_p
12042 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) > it.last_visible_y
12043 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < max_tool_bar_height)
12044 change_height_p = 1;
12045
12046 /* Resize windows as needed by changing the `tool-bar-lines'
12047 frame parameter. */
12048 if (change_height_p)
12049 {
12050 Lisp_Object frame;
12051 int old_height = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w);
12052 int nrows;
12053 int nlines = tool_bar_lines_needed (f, &nrows);
12054
12055 change_height_p = ((EQ (Vauto_resize_tool_bars, Qgrow_only)
12056 && !f->minimize_tool_bar_window_p)
12057 ? (nlines > old_height)
12058 : (nlines != old_height));
12059 f->minimize_tool_bar_window_p = 0;
12060
12061 if (change_height_p)
12062 {
12063 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
12064 Fmodify_frame_parameters (frame,
12065 Fcons (Fcons (Qtool_bar_lines,
12066 make_number (nlines)),
12067 Qnil));
12068 if (WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) != old_height)
12069 {
12070 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
12071 f->n_tool_bar_rows = nrows;
12072 fonts_changed_p = 1;
12073 return 1;
12074 }
12075 }
12076 }
12077 }
12078
12079 f->minimize_tool_bar_window_p = 0;
12080 return 0;
12081 }
12082
12083
12084 /* Get information about the tool-bar item which is displayed in GLYPH
12085 on frame F. Return in *PROP_IDX the index where tool-bar item
12086 properties start in F->tool_bar_items. Value is zero if
12087 GLYPH doesn't display a tool-bar item. */
12088
12089 static int
12090 tool_bar_item_info (struct frame *f, struct glyph *glyph, int *prop_idx)
12091 {
12092 Lisp_Object prop;
12093 int success_p;
12094 int charpos;
12095
12096 /* This function can be called asynchronously, which means we must
12097 exclude any possibility that Fget_text_property signals an
12098 error. */
12099 charpos = min (SCHARS (f->current_tool_bar_string), glyph->charpos);
12100 charpos = max (0, charpos);
12101
12102 /* Get the text property `menu-item' at pos. The value of that
12103 property is the start index of this item's properties in
12104 F->tool_bar_items. */
12105 prop = Fget_text_property (make_number (charpos),
12106 Qmenu_item, f->current_tool_bar_string);
12107 if (INTEGERP (prop))
12108 {
12109 *prop_idx = XINT (prop);
12110 success_p = 1;
12111 }
12112 else
12113 success_p = 0;
12114
12115 return success_p;
12116 }
12117
12118 \f
12119 /* Get information about the tool-bar item at position X/Y on frame F.
12120 Return in *GLYPH a pointer to the glyph of the tool-bar item in
12121 the current matrix of the tool-bar window of F, or NULL if not
12122 on a tool-bar item. Return in *PROP_IDX the index of the tool-bar
12123 item in F->tool_bar_items. Value is
12124
12125 -1 if X/Y is not on a tool-bar item
12126 0 if X/Y is on the same item that was highlighted before.
12127 1 otherwise. */
12128
12129 static int
12130 get_tool_bar_item (struct frame *f, int x, int y, struct glyph **glyph,
12131 int *hpos, int *vpos, int *prop_idx)
12132 {
12133 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
12134 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window);
12135 int area;
12136
12137 /* Find the glyph under X/Y. */
12138 *glyph = x_y_to_hpos_vpos (w, x, y, hpos, vpos, 0, 0, &area);
12139 if (*glyph == NULL)
12140 return -1;
12141
12142 /* Get the start of this tool-bar item's properties in
12143 f->tool_bar_items. */
12144 if (!tool_bar_item_info (f, *glyph, prop_idx))
12145 return -1;
12146
12147 /* Is mouse on the highlighted item? */
12148 if (EQ (f->tool_bar_window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window)
12149 && *vpos >= hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
12150 && *vpos <= hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
12151 && (*vpos > hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
12152 || *hpos >= hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col)
12153 && (*vpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
12154 || *hpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col
12155 || hlinfo->mouse_face_past_end))
12156 return 0;
12157
12158 return 1;
12159 }
12160
12161
12162 /* EXPORT:
12163 Handle mouse button event on the tool-bar of frame F, at
12164 frame-relative coordinates X/Y. DOWN_P is 1 for a button press,
12165 0 for button release. MODIFIERS is event modifiers for button
12166 release. */
12167
12168 void
12169 handle_tool_bar_click (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int down_p,
12170 int modifiers)
12171 {
12172 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
12173 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window);
12174 int hpos, vpos, prop_idx;
12175 struct glyph *glyph;
12176 Lisp_Object enabled_p;
12177
12178 /* If not on the highlighted tool-bar item, return. */
12179 frame_to_window_pixel_xy (w, &x, &y);
12180 if (get_tool_bar_item (f, x, y, &glyph, &hpos, &vpos, &prop_idx) != 0)
12181 return;
12182
12183 /* If item is disabled, do nothing. */
12184 enabled_p = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_ENABLED_P);
12185 if (NILP (enabled_p))
12186 return;
12187
12188 if (down_p)
12189 {
12190 /* Show item in pressed state. */
12191 show_mouse_face (hlinfo, DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN);
12192 hlinfo->mouse_face_image_state = DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN;
12193 last_tool_bar_item = prop_idx;
12194 }
12195 else
12196 {
12197 Lisp_Object key, frame;
12198 struct input_event event;
12199 EVENT_INIT (event);
12200
12201 /* Show item in released state. */
12202 show_mouse_face (hlinfo, DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED);
12203 hlinfo->mouse_face_image_state = DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
12204
12205 key = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_KEY);
12206
12207 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
12208 event.kind = TOOL_BAR_EVENT;
12209 event.frame_or_window = frame;
12210 event.arg = frame;
12211 kbd_buffer_store_event (&event);
12212
12213 event.kind = TOOL_BAR_EVENT;
12214 event.frame_or_window = frame;
12215 event.arg = key;
12216 event.modifiers = modifiers;
12217 kbd_buffer_store_event (&event);
12218 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
12219 }
12220 }
12221
12222
12223 /* Possibly highlight a tool-bar item on frame F when mouse moves to
12224 tool-bar window-relative coordinates X/Y. Called from
12225 note_mouse_highlight. */
12226
12227 static void
12228 note_tool_bar_highlight (struct frame *f, int x, int y)
12229 {
12230 Lisp_Object window = f->tool_bar_window;
12231 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
12232 Display_Info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
12233 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
12234 int hpos, vpos;
12235 struct glyph *glyph;
12236 struct glyph_row *row;
12237 int i;
12238 Lisp_Object enabled_p;
12239 int prop_idx;
12240 enum draw_glyphs_face draw = DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
12241 int mouse_down_p, rc;
12242
12243 /* Function note_mouse_highlight is called with negative X/Y
12244 values when mouse moves outside of the frame. */
12245 if (x <= 0 || y <= 0)
12246 {
12247 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
12248 return;
12249 }
12250
12251 rc = get_tool_bar_item (f, x, y, &glyph, &hpos, &vpos, &prop_idx);
12252 if (rc < 0)
12253 {
12254 /* Not on tool-bar item. */
12255 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
12256 return;
12257 }
12258 else if (rc == 0)
12259 /* On same tool-bar item as before. */
12260 goto set_help_echo;
12261
12262 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
12263
12264 /* Mouse is down, but on different tool-bar item? */
12265 mouse_down_p = (dpyinfo->grabbed
12266 && f == last_mouse_frame
12267 && FRAME_LIVE_P (f));
12268 if (mouse_down_p
12269 && last_tool_bar_item != prop_idx)
12270 return;
12271
12272 hlinfo->mouse_face_image_state = DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT;
12273 draw = mouse_down_p ? DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN : DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
12274
12275 /* If tool-bar item is not enabled, don't highlight it. */
12276 enabled_p = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_ENABLED_P);
12277 if (!NILP (enabled_p))
12278 {
12279 /* Compute the x-position of the glyph. In front and past the
12280 image is a space. We include this in the highlighted area. */
12281 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
12282 for (i = x = 0; i < hpos; ++i)
12283 x += row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][i].pixel_width;
12284
12285 /* Record this as the current active region. */
12286 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = hpos;
12287 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = vpos;
12288 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x = x;
12289 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_y = row->y;
12290 hlinfo->mouse_face_past_end = 0;
12291
12292 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = hpos + 1;
12293 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = vpos;
12294 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x = x + glyph->pixel_width;
12295 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_y = row->y;
12296 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = window;
12297 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id = TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID;
12298
12299 /* Display it as active. */
12300 show_mouse_face (hlinfo, draw);
12301 hlinfo->mouse_face_image_state = draw;
12302 }
12303
12304 set_help_echo:
12305
12306 /* Set help_echo_string to a help string to display for this tool-bar item.
12307 XTread_socket does the rest. */
12308 help_echo_object = help_echo_window = Qnil;
12309 help_echo_pos = -1;
12310 help_echo_string = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_HELP);
12311 if (NILP (help_echo_string))
12312 help_echo_string = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_CAPTION);
12313 }
12314
12315 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
12316
12317
12318 \f
12319 /************************************************************************
12320 Horizontal scrolling
12321 ************************************************************************/
12322
12323 static int hscroll_window_tree (Lisp_Object);
12324 static int hscroll_windows (Lisp_Object);
12325
12326 /* For all leaf windows in the window tree rooted at WINDOW, set their
12327 hscroll value so that PT is (i) visible in the window, and (ii) so
12328 that it is not within a certain margin at the window's left and
12329 right border. Value is non-zero if any window's hscroll has been
12330 changed. */
12331
12332 static int
12333 hscroll_window_tree (Lisp_Object window)
12334 {
12335 int hscrolled_p = 0;
12336 int hscroll_relative_p = FLOATP (Vhscroll_step);
12337 int hscroll_step_abs = 0;
12338 double hscroll_step_rel = 0;
12339
12340 if (hscroll_relative_p)
12341 {
12342 hscroll_step_rel = XFLOAT_DATA (Vhscroll_step);
12343 if (hscroll_step_rel < 0)
12344 {
12345 hscroll_relative_p = 0;
12346 hscroll_step_abs = 0;
12347 }
12348 }
12349 else if (TYPE_RANGED_INTEGERP (int, Vhscroll_step))
12350 {
12351 hscroll_step_abs = XINT (Vhscroll_step);
12352 if (hscroll_step_abs < 0)
12353 hscroll_step_abs = 0;
12354 }
12355 else
12356 hscroll_step_abs = 0;
12357
12358 while (WINDOWP (window))
12359 {
12360 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
12361
12362 if (WINDOWP (w->hchild))
12363 hscrolled_p |= hscroll_window_tree (w->hchild);
12364 else if (WINDOWP (w->vchild))
12365 hscrolled_p |= hscroll_window_tree (w->vchild);
12366 else if (w->cursor.vpos >= 0)
12367 {
12368 int h_margin;
12369 int text_area_width;
12370 struct glyph_row *current_cursor_row
12371 = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->cursor.vpos);
12372 struct glyph_row *desired_cursor_row
12373 = MATRIX_ROW (w->desired_matrix, w->cursor.vpos);
12374 struct glyph_row *cursor_row
12375 = (desired_cursor_row->enabled_p
12376 ? desired_cursor_row
12377 : current_cursor_row);
12378 int row_r2l_p = cursor_row->reversed_p;
12379
12380 text_area_width = window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA);
12381
12382 /* Scroll when cursor is inside this scroll margin. */
12383 h_margin = hscroll_margin * WINDOW_FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (w);
12384
12385 if (!NILP (Fbuffer_local_value (Qauto_hscroll_mode, w->buffer))
12386 /* For left-to-right rows, hscroll when cursor is either
12387 (i) inside the right hscroll margin, or (ii) if it is
12388 inside the left margin and the window is already
12389 hscrolled. */
12390 && ((!row_r2l_p
12391 && ((w->hscroll
12392 && w->cursor.x <= h_margin)
12393 || (cursor_row->enabled_p
12394 && cursor_row->truncated_on_right_p
12395 && (w->cursor.x >= text_area_width - h_margin))))
12396 /* For right-to-left rows, the logic is similar,
12397 except that rules for scrolling to left and right
12398 are reversed. E.g., if cursor.x <= h_margin, we
12399 need to hscroll "to the right" unconditionally,
12400 and that will scroll the screen to the left so as
12401 to reveal the next portion of the row. */
12402 || (row_r2l_p
12403 && ((cursor_row->enabled_p
12404 /* FIXME: It is confusing to set the
12405 truncated_on_right_p flag when R2L rows
12406 are actually truncated on the left. */
12407 && cursor_row->truncated_on_right_p
12408 && w->cursor.x <= h_margin)
12409 || (w->hscroll
12410 && (w->cursor.x >= text_area_width - h_margin))))))
12411 {
12412 struct it it;
12413 ptrdiff_t hscroll;
12414 struct buffer *saved_current_buffer;
12415 ptrdiff_t pt;
12416 int wanted_x;
12417
12418 /* Find point in a display of infinite width. */
12419 saved_current_buffer = current_buffer;
12420 current_buffer = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
12421
12422 if (w == XWINDOW (selected_window))
12423 pt = PT;
12424 else
12425 {
12426 pt = marker_position (w->pointm);
12427 pt = max (BEGV, pt);
12428 pt = min (ZV, pt);
12429 }
12430
12431 /* Move iterator to pt starting at cursor_row->start in
12432 a line with infinite width. */
12433 init_to_row_start (&it, w, cursor_row);
12434 it.last_visible_x = INFINITY;
12435 move_it_in_display_line_to (&it, pt, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
12436 current_buffer = saved_current_buffer;
12437
12438 /* Position cursor in window. */
12439 if (!hscroll_relative_p && hscroll_step_abs == 0)
12440 hscroll = max (0, (it.current_x
12441 - (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (&it)
12442 ? (text_area_width - 4 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it.f))
12443 : (text_area_width / 2))))
12444 / FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it.f);
12445 else if ((!row_r2l_p
12446 && w->cursor.x >= text_area_width - h_margin)
12447 || (row_r2l_p && w->cursor.x <= h_margin))
12448 {
12449 if (hscroll_relative_p)
12450 wanted_x = text_area_width * (1 - hscroll_step_rel)
12451 - h_margin;
12452 else
12453 wanted_x = text_area_width
12454 - hscroll_step_abs * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it.f)
12455 - h_margin;
12456 hscroll
12457 = max (0, it.current_x - wanted_x) / FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it.f);
12458 }
12459 else
12460 {
12461 if (hscroll_relative_p)
12462 wanted_x = text_area_width * hscroll_step_rel
12463 + h_margin;
12464 else
12465 wanted_x = hscroll_step_abs * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it.f)
12466 + h_margin;
12467 hscroll
12468 = max (0, it.current_x - wanted_x) / FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it.f);
12469 }
12470 hscroll = max (hscroll, w->min_hscroll);
12471
12472 /* Don't prevent redisplay optimizations if hscroll
12473 hasn't changed, as it will unnecessarily slow down
12474 redisplay. */
12475 if (w->hscroll != hscroll)
12476 {
12477 XBUFFER (w->buffer)->prevent_redisplay_optimizations_p = 1;
12478 w->hscroll = hscroll;
12479 hscrolled_p = 1;
12480 }
12481 }
12482 }
12483
12484 window = w->next;
12485 }
12486
12487 /* Value is non-zero if hscroll of any leaf window has been changed. */
12488 return hscrolled_p;
12489 }
12490
12491
12492 /* Set hscroll so that cursor is visible and not inside horizontal
12493 scroll margins for all windows in the tree rooted at WINDOW. See
12494 also hscroll_window_tree above. Value is non-zero if any window's
12495 hscroll has been changed. If it has, desired matrices on the frame
12496 of WINDOW are cleared. */
12497
12498 static int
12499 hscroll_windows (Lisp_Object window)
12500 {
12501 int hscrolled_p = hscroll_window_tree (window);
12502 if (hscrolled_p)
12503 clear_desired_matrices (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (window))));
12504 return hscrolled_p;
12505 }
12506
12507
12508 \f
12509 /************************************************************************
12510 Redisplay
12511 ************************************************************************/
12512
12513 /* Variables holding some state of redisplay if GLYPH_DEBUG is defined
12514 to a non-zero value. This is sometimes handy to have in a debugger
12515 session. */
12516
12517 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
12518
12519 /* First and last unchanged row for try_window_id. */
12520
12521 static int debug_first_unchanged_at_end_vpos;
12522 static int debug_last_unchanged_at_beg_vpos;
12523
12524 /* Delta vpos and y. */
12525
12526 static int debug_dvpos, debug_dy;
12527
12528 /* Delta in characters and bytes for try_window_id. */
12529
12530 static ptrdiff_t debug_delta, debug_delta_bytes;
12531
12532 /* Values of window_end_pos and window_end_vpos at the end of
12533 try_window_id. */
12534
12535 static ptrdiff_t debug_end_vpos;
12536
12537 /* Append a string to W->desired_matrix->method. FMT is a printf
12538 format string. If trace_redisplay_p is non-zero also printf the
12539 resulting string to stderr. */
12540
12541 static void debug_method_add (struct window *, char const *, ...)
12542 ATTRIBUTE_FORMAT_PRINTF (2, 3);
12543
12544 static void
12545 debug_method_add (struct window *w, char const *fmt, ...)
12546 {
12547 char *method = w->desired_matrix->method;
12548 int len = strlen (method);
12549 int size = sizeof w->desired_matrix->method;
12550 int remaining = size - len - 1;
12551 va_list ap;
12552
12553 if (len && remaining)
12554 {
12555 method[len] = '|';
12556 --remaining, ++len;
12557 }
12558
12559 va_start (ap, fmt);
12560 vsnprintf (method + len, remaining + 1, fmt, ap);
12561 va_end (ap);
12562
12563 if (trace_redisplay_p)
12564 fprintf (stderr, "%p (%s): %s\n",
12565 w,
12566 ((BUFFERP (w->buffer)
12567 && STRINGP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), name)))
12568 ? SSDATA (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), name))
12569 : "no buffer"),
12570 method + len);
12571 }
12572
12573 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
12574
12575
12576 /* Value is non-zero if all changes in window W, which displays
12577 current_buffer, are in the text between START and END. START is a
12578 buffer position, END is given as a distance from Z. Used in
12579 redisplay_internal for display optimization. */
12580
12581 static inline int
12582 text_outside_line_unchanged_p (struct window *w,
12583 ptrdiff_t start, ptrdiff_t end)
12584 {
12585 int unchanged_p = 1;
12586
12587 /* If text or overlays have changed, see where. */
12588 if (w->last_modified < MODIFF
12589 || w->last_overlay_modified < OVERLAY_MODIFF)
12590 {
12591 /* Gap in the line? */
12592 if (GPT < start || Z - GPT < end)
12593 unchanged_p = 0;
12594
12595 /* Changes start in front of the line, or end after it? */
12596 if (unchanged_p
12597 && (BEG_UNCHANGED < start - 1
12598 || END_UNCHANGED < end))
12599 unchanged_p = 0;
12600
12601 /* If selective display, can't optimize if changes start at the
12602 beginning of the line. */
12603 if (unchanged_p
12604 && INTEGERP (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display))
12605 && XINT (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display)) > 0
12606 && (BEG_UNCHANGED < start || GPT <= start))
12607 unchanged_p = 0;
12608
12609 /* If there are overlays at the start or end of the line, these
12610 may have overlay strings with newlines in them. A change at
12611 START, for instance, may actually concern the display of such
12612 overlay strings as well, and they are displayed on different
12613 lines. So, quickly rule out this case. (For the future, it
12614 might be desirable to implement something more telling than
12615 just BEG/END_UNCHANGED.) */
12616 if (unchanged_p)
12617 {
12618 if (BEG + BEG_UNCHANGED == start
12619 && overlay_touches_p (start))
12620 unchanged_p = 0;
12621 if (END_UNCHANGED == end
12622 && overlay_touches_p (Z - end))
12623 unchanged_p = 0;
12624 }
12625
12626 /* Under bidi reordering, adding or deleting a character in the
12627 beginning of a paragraph, before the first strong directional
12628 character, can change the base direction of the paragraph (unless
12629 the buffer specifies a fixed paragraph direction), which will
12630 require to redisplay the whole paragraph. It might be worthwhile
12631 to find the paragraph limits and widen the range of redisplayed
12632 lines to that, but for now just give up this optimization. */
12633 if (!NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), bidi_display_reordering))
12634 && NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), bidi_paragraph_direction)))
12635 unchanged_p = 0;
12636 }
12637
12638 return unchanged_p;
12639 }
12640
12641
12642 /* Do a frame update, taking possible shortcuts into account. This is
12643 the main external entry point for redisplay.
12644
12645 If the last redisplay displayed an echo area message and that message
12646 is no longer requested, we clear the echo area or bring back the
12647 mini-buffer if that is in use. */
12648
12649 void
12650 redisplay (void)
12651 {
12652 redisplay_internal ();
12653 }
12654
12655
12656 static Lisp_Object
12657 overlay_arrow_string_or_property (Lisp_Object var)
12658 {
12659 Lisp_Object val;
12660
12661 if (val = Fget (var, Qoverlay_arrow_string), STRINGP (val))
12662 return val;
12663
12664 return Voverlay_arrow_string;
12665 }
12666
12667 /* Return 1 if there are any overlay-arrows in current_buffer. */
12668 static int
12669 overlay_arrow_in_current_buffer_p (void)
12670 {
12671 Lisp_Object vlist;
12672
12673 for (vlist = Voverlay_arrow_variable_list;
12674 CONSP (vlist);
12675 vlist = XCDR (vlist))
12676 {
12677 Lisp_Object var = XCAR (vlist);
12678 Lisp_Object val;
12679
12680 if (!SYMBOLP (var))
12681 continue;
12682 val = find_symbol_value (var);
12683 if (MARKERP (val)
12684 && current_buffer == XMARKER (val)->buffer)
12685 return 1;
12686 }
12687 return 0;
12688 }
12689
12690
12691 /* Return 1 if any overlay_arrows have moved or overlay-arrow-string
12692 has changed. */
12693
12694 static int
12695 overlay_arrows_changed_p (void)
12696 {
12697 Lisp_Object vlist;
12698
12699 for (vlist = Voverlay_arrow_variable_list;
12700 CONSP (vlist);
12701 vlist = XCDR (vlist))
12702 {
12703 Lisp_Object var = XCAR (vlist);
12704 Lisp_Object val, pstr;
12705
12706 if (!SYMBOLP (var))
12707 continue;
12708 val = find_symbol_value (var);
12709 if (!MARKERP (val))
12710 continue;
12711 if (! EQ (COERCE_MARKER (val),
12712 Fget (var, Qlast_arrow_position))
12713 || ! (pstr = overlay_arrow_string_or_property (var),
12714 EQ (pstr, Fget (var, Qlast_arrow_string))))
12715 return 1;
12716 }
12717 return 0;
12718 }
12719
12720 /* Mark overlay arrows to be updated on next redisplay. */
12721
12722 static void
12723 update_overlay_arrows (int up_to_date)
12724 {
12725 Lisp_Object vlist;
12726
12727 for (vlist = Voverlay_arrow_variable_list;
12728 CONSP (vlist);
12729 vlist = XCDR (vlist))
12730 {
12731 Lisp_Object var = XCAR (vlist);
12732
12733 if (!SYMBOLP (var))
12734 continue;
12735
12736 if (up_to_date > 0)
12737 {
12738 Lisp_Object val = find_symbol_value (var);
12739 Fput (var, Qlast_arrow_position,
12740 COERCE_MARKER (val));
12741 Fput (var, Qlast_arrow_string,
12742 overlay_arrow_string_or_property (var));
12743 }
12744 else if (up_to_date < 0
12745 || !NILP (Fget (var, Qlast_arrow_position)))
12746 {
12747 Fput (var, Qlast_arrow_position, Qt);
12748 Fput (var, Qlast_arrow_string, Qt);
12749 }
12750 }
12751 }
12752
12753
12754 /* Return overlay arrow string to display at row.
12755 Return integer (bitmap number) for arrow bitmap in left fringe.
12756 Return nil if no overlay arrow. */
12757
12758 static Lisp_Object
12759 overlay_arrow_at_row (struct it *it, struct glyph_row *row)
12760 {
12761 Lisp_Object vlist;
12762
12763 for (vlist = Voverlay_arrow_variable_list;
12764 CONSP (vlist);
12765 vlist = XCDR (vlist))
12766 {
12767 Lisp_Object var = XCAR (vlist);
12768 Lisp_Object val;
12769
12770 if (!SYMBOLP (var))
12771 continue;
12772
12773 val = find_symbol_value (var);
12774
12775 if (MARKERP (val)
12776 && current_buffer == XMARKER (val)->buffer
12777 && (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) == marker_position (val)))
12778 {
12779 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
12780 /* FIXME: if ROW->reversed_p is set, this should test
12781 the right fringe, not the left one. */
12782 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w) > 0)
12783 {
12784 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
12785 if (val = Fget (var, Qoverlay_arrow_bitmap), SYMBOLP (val))
12786 {
12787 int fringe_bitmap;
12788 if ((fringe_bitmap = lookup_fringe_bitmap (val)) != 0)
12789 return make_number (fringe_bitmap);
12790 }
12791 #endif
12792 return make_number (-1); /* Use default arrow bitmap */
12793 }
12794 return overlay_arrow_string_or_property (var);
12795 }
12796 }
12797
12798 return Qnil;
12799 }
12800
12801 /* Return 1 if point moved out of or into a composition. Otherwise
12802 return 0. PREV_BUF and PREV_PT are the last point buffer and
12803 position. BUF and PT are the current point buffer and position. */
12804
12805 static int
12806 check_point_in_composition (struct buffer *prev_buf, ptrdiff_t prev_pt,
12807 struct buffer *buf, ptrdiff_t pt)
12808 {
12809 ptrdiff_t start, end;
12810 Lisp_Object prop;
12811 Lisp_Object buffer;
12812
12813 XSETBUFFER (buffer, buf);
12814 /* Check a composition at the last point if point moved within the
12815 same buffer. */
12816 if (prev_buf == buf)
12817 {
12818 if (prev_pt == pt)
12819 /* Point didn't move. */
12820 return 0;
12821
12822 if (prev_pt > BUF_BEGV (buf) && prev_pt < BUF_ZV (buf)
12823 && find_composition (prev_pt, -1, &start, &end, &prop, buffer)
12824 && COMPOSITION_VALID_P (start, end, prop)
12825 && start < prev_pt && end > prev_pt)
12826 /* The last point was within the composition. Return 1 iff
12827 point moved out of the composition. */
12828 return (pt <= start || pt >= end);
12829 }
12830
12831 /* Check a composition at the current point. */
12832 return (pt > BUF_BEGV (buf) && pt < BUF_ZV (buf)
12833 && find_composition (pt, -1, &start, &end, &prop, buffer)
12834 && COMPOSITION_VALID_P (start, end, prop)
12835 && start < pt && end > pt);
12836 }
12837
12838
12839 /* Reconsider the setting of B->clip_changed which is displayed
12840 in window W. */
12841
12842 static inline void
12843 reconsider_clip_changes (struct window *w, struct buffer *b)
12844 {
12845 if (b->clip_changed
12846 && !NILP (w->window_end_valid)
12847 && w->current_matrix->buffer == b
12848 && w->current_matrix->zv == BUF_ZV (b)
12849 && w->current_matrix->begv == BUF_BEGV (b))
12850 b->clip_changed = 0;
12851
12852 /* If display wasn't paused, and W is not a tool bar window, see if
12853 point has been moved into or out of a composition. In that case,
12854 we set b->clip_changed to 1 to force updating the screen. If
12855 b->clip_changed has already been set to 1, we can skip this
12856 check. */
12857 if (!b->clip_changed
12858 && BUFFERP (w->buffer) && !NILP (w->window_end_valid))
12859 {
12860 ptrdiff_t pt;
12861
12862 if (w == XWINDOW (selected_window))
12863 pt = PT;
12864 else
12865 pt = marker_position (w->pointm);
12866
12867 if ((w->current_matrix->buffer != XBUFFER (w->buffer)
12868 || pt != w->last_point)
12869 && check_point_in_composition (w->current_matrix->buffer,
12870 w->last_point,
12871 XBUFFER (w->buffer), pt))
12872 b->clip_changed = 1;
12873 }
12874 }
12875 \f
12876
12877 /* Select FRAME to forward the values of frame-local variables into C
12878 variables so that the redisplay routines can access those values
12879 directly. */
12880
12881 static void
12882 select_frame_for_redisplay (Lisp_Object frame)
12883 {
12884 Lisp_Object tail, tem;
12885 Lisp_Object old = selected_frame;
12886 struct Lisp_Symbol *sym;
12887
12888 eassert (FRAMEP (frame) && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (frame)));
12889
12890 selected_frame = frame;
12891
12892 do {
12893 for (tail = XFRAME (frame)->param_alist;
12894 CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
12895 if (CONSP (XCAR (tail))
12896 && (tem = XCAR (XCAR (tail)),
12897 SYMBOLP (tem))
12898 && (sym = indirect_variable (XSYMBOL (tem)),
12899 sym->redirect == SYMBOL_LOCALIZED)
12900 && sym->val.blv->frame_local)
12901 /* Use find_symbol_value rather than Fsymbol_value
12902 to avoid an error if it is void. */
12903 find_symbol_value (tem);
12904 } while (!EQ (frame, old) && (frame = old, 1));
12905 }
12906
12907
12908 #define STOP_POLLING \
12909 do { if (! polling_stopped_here) stop_polling (); \
12910 polling_stopped_here = 1; } while (0)
12911
12912 #define RESUME_POLLING \
12913 do { if (polling_stopped_here) start_polling (); \
12914 polling_stopped_here = 0; } while (0)
12915
12916
12917 /* Perhaps in the future avoid recentering windows if it
12918 is not necessary; currently that causes some problems. */
12919
12920 static void
12921 redisplay_internal (void)
12922 {
12923 struct window *w = XWINDOW (selected_window);
12924 struct window *sw;
12925 struct frame *fr;
12926 int pending;
12927 int must_finish = 0;
12928 struct text_pos tlbufpos, tlendpos;
12929 int number_of_visible_frames;
12930 ptrdiff_t count, count1;
12931 struct frame *sf;
12932 int polling_stopped_here = 0;
12933 Lisp_Object old_frame = selected_frame;
12934
12935 /* Non-zero means redisplay has to consider all windows on all
12936 frames. Zero means, only selected_window is considered. */
12937 int consider_all_windows_p;
12938
12939 /* Non-zero means redisplay has to redisplay the miniwindow */
12940 int update_miniwindow_p = 0;
12941
12942 TRACE ((stderr, "redisplay_internal %d\n", redisplaying_p));
12943
12944 /* No redisplay if running in batch mode or frame is not yet fully
12945 initialized, or redisplay is explicitly turned off by setting
12946 Vinhibit_redisplay. */
12947 if (FRAME_INITIAL_P (SELECTED_FRAME ())
12948 || !NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay))
12949 return;
12950
12951 /* Don't examine these until after testing Vinhibit_redisplay.
12952 When Emacs is shutting down, perhaps because its connection to
12953 X has dropped, we should not look at them at all. */
12954 fr = XFRAME (w->frame);
12955 sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
12956
12957 if (!fr->glyphs_initialized_p)
12958 return;
12959
12960 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK) || defined (HAVE_NS)
12961 if (popup_activated ())
12962 return;
12963 #endif
12964
12965 /* I don't think this happens but let's be paranoid. */
12966 if (redisplaying_p)
12967 return;
12968
12969 /* Record a function that resets redisplaying_p to its old value
12970 when we leave this function. */
12971 count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
12972 record_unwind_protect (unwind_redisplay,
12973 Fcons (make_number (redisplaying_p), selected_frame));
12974 ++redisplaying_p;
12975 specbind (Qinhibit_free_realized_faces, Qnil);
12976
12977 {
12978 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
12979
12980 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
12981 {
12982 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
12983 f->already_hscrolled_p = 0;
12984 }
12985 }
12986
12987 retry:
12988 /* Remember the currently selected window. */
12989 sw = w;
12990
12991 if (!EQ (old_frame, selected_frame)
12992 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (old_frame)))
12993 /* When running redisplay, we play a bit fast-and-loose and allow e.g.
12994 selected_frame and selected_window to be temporarily out-of-sync so
12995 when we come back here via `goto retry', we need to resync because we
12996 may need to run Elisp code (via prepare_menu_bars). */
12997 select_frame_for_redisplay (old_frame);
12998
12999 pending = 0;
13000 reconsider_clip_changes (w, current_buffer);
13001 last_escape_glyph_frame = NULL;
13002 last_escape_glyph_face_id = (1 << FACE_ID_BITS);
13003 last_glyphless_glyph_frame = NULL;
13004 last_glyphless_glyph_face_id = (1 << FACE_ID_BITS);
13005
13006 /* If new fonts have been loaded that make a glyph matrix adjustment
13007 necessary, do it. */
13008 if (fonts_changed_p)
13009 {
13010 adjust_glyphs (NULL);
13011 ++windows_or_buffers_changed;
13012 fonts_changed_p = 0;
13013 }
13014
13015 /* If face_change_count is non-zero, init_iterator will free all
13016 realized faces, which includes the faces referenced from current
13017 matrices. So, we can't reuse current matrices in this case. */
13018 if (face_change_count)
13019 ++windows_or_buffers_changed;
13020
13021 if ((FRAME_TERMCAP_P (sf) || FRAME_MSDOS_P (sf))
13022 && FRAME_TTY (sf)->previous_frame != sf)
13023 {
13024 /* Since frames on a single ASCII terminal share the same
13025 display area, displaying a different frame means redisplay
13026 the whole thing. */
13027 windows_or_buffers_changed++;
13028 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (sf);
13029 #ifndef DOS_NT
13030 set_tty_color_mode (FRAME_TTY (sf), sf);
13031 #endif
13032 FRAME_TTY (sf)->previous_frame = sf;
13033 }
13034
13035 /* Set the visible flags for all frames. Do this before checking
13036 for resized or garbaged frames; they want to know if their frames
13037 are visible. See the comment in frame.h for
13038 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY. */
13039 {
13040 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
13041
13042 number_of_visible_frames = 0;
13043
13044 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
13045 {
13046 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
13047
13048 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
13049 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
13050 ++number_of_visible_frames;
13051 clear_desired_matrices (f);
13052 }
13053 }
13054
13055 /* Notice any pending interrupt request to change frame size. */
13056 do_pending_window_change (1);
13057
13058 /* do_pending_window_change could change the selected_window due to
13059 frame resizing which makes the selected window too small. */
13060 if (WINDOWP (selected_window) && (w = XWINDOW (selected_window)) != sw)
13061 {
13062 sw = w;
13063 reconsider_clip_changes (w, current_buffer);
13064 }
13065
13066 /* Clear frames marked as garbaged. */
13067 if (frame_garbaged)
13068 clear_garbaged_frames ();
13069
13070 /* Build menubar and tool-bar items. */
13071 if (NILP (Vmemory_full))
13072 prepare_menu_bars ();
13073
13074 if (windows_or_buffers_changed)
13075 update_mode_lines++;
13076
13077 /* Detect case that we need to write or remove a star in the mode line. */
13078 if ((SAVE_MODIFF < MODIFF) != w->last_had_star)
13079 {
13080 w->update_mode_line = 1;
13081 if (buffer_shared > 1)
13082 update_mode_lines++;
13083 }
13084
13085 /* Avoid invocation of point motion hooks by `current_column' below. */
13086 count1 = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
13087 specbind (Qinhibit_point_motion_hooks, Qt);
13088
13089 /* If %c is in the mode line, update it if needed. */
13090 if (!NILP (w->column_number_displayed)
13091 /* This alternative quickly identifies a common case
13092 where no change is needed. */
13093 && !(PT == w->last_point
13094 && w->last_modified >= MODIFF
13095 && w->last_overlay_modified >= OVERLAY_MODIFF)
13096 && (XFASTINT (w->column_number_displayed) != current_column ()))
13097 w->update_mode_line = 1;
13098
13099 unbind_to (count1, Qnil);
13100
13101 FRAME_SCROLL_BOTTOM_VPOS (XFRAME (w->frame)) = -1;
13102
13103 /* The variable buffer_shared is set in redisplay_window and
13104 indicates that we redisplay a buffer in different windows. See
13105 there. */
13106 consider_all_windows_p = (update_mode_lines || buffer_shared > 1
13107 || cursor_type_changed);
13108
13109 /* If specs for an arrow have changed, do thorough redisplay
13110 to ensure we remove any arrow that should no longer exist. */
13111 if (overlay_arrows_changed_p ())
13112 consider_all_windows_p = windows_or_buffers_changed = 1;
13113
13114 /* Normally the message* functions will have already displayed and
13115 updated the echo area, but the frame may have been trashed, or
13116 the update may have been preempted, so display the echo area
13117 again here. Checking message_cleared_p captures the case that
13118 the echo area should be cleared. */
13119 if ((!NILP (echo_area_buffer[0]) && !display_last_displayed_message_p)
13120 || (!NILP (echo_area_buffer[1]) && display_last_displayed_message_p)
13121 || (message_cleared_p
13122 && minibuf_level == 0
13123 /* If the mini-window is currently selected, this means the
13124 echo-area doesn't show through. */
13125 && !MINI_WINDOW_P (XWINDOW (selected_window))))
13126 {
13127 int window_height_changed_p = echo_area_display (0);
13128
13129 if (message_cleared_p)
13130 update_miniwindow_p = 1;
13131
13132 must_finish = 1;
13133
13134 /* If we don't display the current message, don't clear the
13135 message_cleared_p flag, because, if we did, we wouldn't clear
13136 the echo area in the next redisplay which doesn't preserve
13137 the echo area. */
13138 if (!display_last_displayed_message_p)
13139 message_cleared_p = 0;
13140
13141 if (fonts_changed_p)
13142 goto retry;
13143 else if (window_height_changed_p)
13144 {
13145 consider_all_windows_p = 1;
13146 ++update_mode_lines;
13147 ++windows_or_buffers_changed;
13148
13149 /* If window configuration was changed, frames may have been
13150 marked garbaged. Clear them or we will experience
13151 surprises wrt scrolling. */
13152 if (frame_garbaged)
13153 clear_garbaged_frames ();
13154 }
13155 }
13156 else if (EQ (selected_window, minibuf_window)
13157 && (current_buffer->clip_changed
13158 || w->last_modified < MODIFF
13159 || w->last_overlay_modified < OVERLAY_MODIFF)
13160 && resize_mini_window (w, 0))
13161 {
13162 /* Resized active mini-window to fit the size of what it is
13163 showing if its contents might have changed. */
13164 must_finish = 1;
13165 /* FIXME: this causes all frames to be updated, which seems unnecessary
13166 since only the current frame needs to be considered. This function needs
13167 to be rewritten with two variables, consider_all_windows and
13168 consider_all_frames. */
13169 consider_all_windows_p = 1;
13170 ++windows_or_buffers_changed;
13171 ++update_mode_lines;
13172
13173 /* If window configuration was changed, frames may have been
13174 marked garbaged. Clear them or we will experience
13175 surprises wrt scrolling. */
13176 if (frame_garbaged)
13177 clear_garbaged_frames ();
13178 }
13179
13180
13181 /* If showing the region, and mark has changed, we must redisplay
13182 the whole window. The assignment to this_line_start_pos prevents
13183 the optimization directly below this if-statement. */
13184 if (((!NILP (Vtransient_mark_mode)
13185 && !NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), mark_active)))
13186 != !NILP (w->region_showing))
13187 || (!NILP (w->region_showing)
13188 && !EQ (w->region_showing,
13189 Fmarker_position (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), mark)))))
13190 CHARPOS (this_line_start_pos) = 0;
13191
13192 /* Optimize the case that only the line containing the cursor in the
13193 selected window has changed. Variables starting with this_ are
13194 set in display_line and record information about the line
13195 containing the cursor. */
13196 tlbufpos = this_line_start_pos;
13197 tlendpos = this_line_end_pos;
13198 if (!consider_all_windows_p
13199 && CHARPOS (tlbufpos) > 0
13200 && !w->update_mode_line
13201 && !current_buffer->clip_changed
13202 && !current_buffer->prevent_redisplay_optimizations_p
13203 && FRAME_VISIBLE_P (XFRAME (w->frame))
13204 && !FRAME_OBSCURED_P (XFRAME (w->frame))
13205 /* Make sure recorded data applies to current buffer, etc. */
13206 && this_line_buffer == current_buffer
13207 && current_buffer == XBUFFER (w->buffer)
13208 && !w->force_start
13209 && !w->optional_new_start
13210 /* Point must be on the line that we have info recorded about. */
13211 && PT >= CHARPOS (tlbufpos)
13212 && PT <= Z - CHARPOS (tlendpos)
13213 /* All text outside that line, including its final newline,
13214 must be unchanged. */
13215 && text_outside_line_unchanged_p (w, CHARPOS (tlbufpos),
13216 CHARPOS (tlendpos)))
13217 {
13218 if (CHARPOS (tlbufpos) > BEGV
13219 && FETCH_BYTE (BYTEPOS (tlbufpos) - 1) != '\n'
13220 && (CHARPOS (tlbufpos) == ZV
13221 || FETCH_BYTE (BYTEPOS (tlbufpos)) == '\n'))
13222 /* Former continuation line has disappeared by becoming empty. */
13223 goto cancel;
13224 else if (w->last_modified < MODIFF
13225 || w->last_overlay_modified < OVERLAY_MODIFF
13226 || MINI_WINDOW_P (w))
13227 {
13228 /* We have to handle the case of continuation around a
13229 wide-column character (see the comment in indent.c around
13230 line 1340).
13231
13232 For instance, in the following case:
13233
13234 -------- Insert --------
13235 K_A_N_\\ `a' K_A_N_a\ `X_' are wide-column chars.
13236 J_I_ ==> J_I_ `^^' are cursors.
13237 ^^ ^^
13238 -------- --------
13239
13240 As we have to redraw the line above, we cannot use this
13241 optimization. */
13242
13243 struct it it;
13244 int line_height_before = this_line_pixel_height;
13245
13246 /* Note that start_display will handle the case that the
13247 line starting at tlbufpos is a continuation line. */
13248 start_display (&it, w, tlbufpos);
13249
13250 /* Implementation note: It this still necessary? */
13251 if (it.current_x != this_line_start_x)
13252 goto cancel;
13253
13254 TRACE ((stderr, "trying display optimization 1\n"));
13255 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
13256 overlay_arrow_seen = 0;
13257 it.vpos = this_line_vpos;
13258 it.current_y = this_line_y;
13259 it.glyph_row = MATRIX_ROW (w->desired_matrix, this_line_vpos);
13260 display_line (&it);
13261
13262 /* If line contains point, is not continued,
13263 and ends at same distance from eob as before, we win. */
13264 if (w->cursor.vpos >= 0
13265 /* Line is not continued, otherwise this_line_start_pos
13266 would have been set to 0 in display_line. */
13267 && CHARPOS (this_line_start_pos)
13268 /* Line ends as before. */
13269 && CHARPOS (this_line_end_pos) == CHARPOS (tlendpos)
13270 /* Line has same height as before. Otherwise other lines
13271 would have to be shifted up or down. */
13272 && this_line_pixel_height == line_height_before)
13273 {
13274 /* If this is not the window's last line, we must adjust
13275 the charstarts of the lines below. */
13276 if (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y)
13277 {
13278 struct glyph_row *row
13279 = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, this_line_vpos + 1);
13280 ptrdiff_t delta, delta_bytes;
13281
13282 /* We used to distinguish between two cases here,
13283 conditioned by Z - CHARPOS (tlendpos) == ZV, for
13284 when the line ends in a newline or the end of the
13285 buffer's accessible portion. But both cases did
13286 the same, so they were collapsed. */
13287 delta = (Z
13288 - CHARPOS (tlendpos)
13289 - MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row));
13290 delta_bytes = (Z_BYTE
13291 - BYTEPOS (tlendpos)
13292 - MATRIX_ROW_START_BYTEPOS (row));
13293
13294 increment_matrix_positions (w->current_matrix,
13295 this_line_vpos + 1,
13296 w->current_matrix->nrows,
13297 delta, delta_bytes);
13298 }
13299
13300 /* If this row displays text now but previously didn't,
13301 or vice versa, w->window_end_vpos may have to be
13302 adjusted. */
13303 if ((it.glyph_row - 1)->displays_text_p)
13304 {
13305 if (XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos) < this_line_vpos)
13306 wset_window_end_vpos (w, make_number (this_line_vpos));
13307 }
13308 else if (XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos) == this_line_vpos
13309 && this_line_vpos > 0)
13310 wset_window_end_vpos (w, make_number (this_line_vpos - 1));
13311 wset_window_end_valid (w, Qnil);
13312
13313 /* Update hint: No need to try to scroll in update_window. */
13314 w->desired_matrix->no_scrolling_p = 1;
13315
13316 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
13317 *w->desired_matrix->method = 0;
13318 debug_method_add (w, "optimization 1");
13319 #endif
13320 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
13321 update_window_fringes (w, 0);
13322 #endif
13323 goto update;
13324 }
13325 else
13326 goto cancel;
13327 }
13328 else if (/* Cursor position hasn't changed. */
13329 PT == w->last_point
13330 /* Make sure the cursor was last displayed
13331 in this window. Otherwise we have to reposition it. */
13332 && 0 <= w->cursor.vpos
13333 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) > w->cursor.vpos)
13334 {
13335 if (!must_finish)
13336 {
13337 do_pending_window_change (1);
13338 /* If selected_window changed, redisplay again. */
13339 if (WINDOWP (selected_window)
13340 && (w = XWINDOW (selected_window)) != sw)
13341 goto retry;
13342
13343 /* We used to always goto end_of_redisplay here, but this
13344 isn't enough if we have a blinking cursor. */
13345 if (w->cursor_off_p == w->last_cursor_off_p)
13346 goto end_of_redisplay;
13347 }
13348 goto update;
13349 }
13350 /* If highlighting the region, or if the cursor is in the echo area,
13351 then we can't just move the cursor. */
13352 else if (! (!NILP (Vtransient_mark_mode)
13353 && !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, mark_active)))
13354 && (EQ (selected_window,
13355 BVAR (current_buffer, last_selected_window))
13356 || highlight_nonselected_windows)
13357 && NILP (w->region_showing)
13358 && NILP (Vshow_trailing_whitespace)
13359 && !cursor_in_echo_area)
13360 {
13361 struct it it;
13362 struct glyph_row *row;
13363
13364 /* Skip from tlbufpos to PT and see where it is. Note that
13365 PT may be in invisible text. If so, we will end at the
13366 next visible position. */
13367 init_iterator (&it, w, CHARPOS (tlbufpos), BYTEPOS (tlbufpos),
13368 NULL, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
13369 it.current_x = this_line_start_x;
13370 it.current_y = this_line_y;
13371 it.vpos = this_line_vpos;
13372
13373 /* The call to move_it_to stops in front of PT, but
13374 moves over before-strings. */
13375 move_it_to (&it, PT, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
13376
13377 if (it.vpos == this_line_vpos
13378 && (row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, this_line_vpos),
13379 row->enabled_p))
13380 {
13381 eassert (this_line_vpos == it.vpos);
13382 eassert (this_line_y == it.current_y);
13383 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
13384 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
13385 *w->desired_matrix->method = 0;
13386 debug_method_add (w, "optimization 3");
13387 #endif
13388 goto update;
13389 }
13390 else
13391 goto cancel;
13392 }
13393
13394 cancel:
13395 /* Text changed drastically or point moved off of line. */
13396 SET_MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (w->desired_matrix, this_line_vpos, 0);
13397 }
13398
13399 CHARPOS (this_line_start_pos) = 0;
13400 consider_all_windows_p |= buffer_shared > 1;
13401 ++clear_face_cache_count;
13402 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
13403 ++clear_image_cache_count;
13404 #endif
13405
13406 /* Build desired matrices, and update the display. If
13407 consider_all_windows_p is non-zero, do it for all windows on all
13408 frames. Otherwise do it for selected_window, only. */
13409
13410 if (consider_all_windows_p)
13411 {
13412 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
13413
13414 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
13415 XFRAME (frame)->updated_p = 0;
13416
13417 /* Recompute # windows showing selected buffer. This will be
13418 incremented each time such a window is displayed. */
13419 buffer_shared = 0;
13420
13421 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
13422 {
13423 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
13424
13425 /* We don't have to do anything for unselected terminal
13426 frames. */
13427 if ((FRAME_TERMCAP_P (f) || FRAME_MSDOS_P (f))
13428 && !EQ (FRAME_TTY (f)->top_frame, frame))
13429 continue;
13430
13431 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f) || FRAME_TERMCAP_P (f) || f == sf)
13432 {
13433 if (! EQ (frame, selected_frame))
13434 /* Select the frame, for the sake of frame-local
13435 variables. */
13436 select_frame_for_redisplay (frame);
13437
13438 /* Mark all the scroll bars to be removed; we'll redeem
13439 the ones we want when we redisplay their windows. */
13440 if (FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->condemn_scroll_bars_hook)
13441 FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->condemn_scroll_bars_hook (f);
13442
13443 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && !FRAME_OBSCURED_P (f))
13444 redisplay_windows (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f));
13445
13446 /* The X error handler may have deleted that frame. */
13447 if (!FRAME_LIVE_P (f))
13448 continue;
13449
13450 /* Any scroll bars which redisplay_windows should have
13451 nuked should now go away. */
13452 if (FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->judge_scroll_bars_hook)
13453 FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->judge_scroll_bars_hook (f);
13454
13455 /* If fonts changed, display again. */
13456 /* ??? rms: I suspect it is a mistake to jump all the way
13457 back to retry here. It should just retry this frame. */
13458 if (fonts_changed_p)
13459 goto retry;
13460
13461 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && !FRAME_OBSCURED_P (f))
13462 {
13463 /* See if we have to hscroll. */
13464 if (!f->already_hscrolled_p)
13465 {
13466 f->already_hscrolled_p = 1;
13467 if (hscroll_windows (f->root_window))
13468 goto retry;
13469 }
13470
13471 /* Prevent various kinds of signals during display
13472 update. stdio is not robust about handling
13473 signals, which can cause an apparent I/O
13474 error. */
13475 if (interrupt_input)
13476 unrequest_sigio ();
13477 STOP_POLLING;
13478
13479 /* Update the display. */
13480 set_window_update_flags (XWINDOW (f->root_window), 1);
13481 pending |= update_frame (f, 0, 0);
13482 f->updated_p = 1;
13483 }
13484 }
13485 }
13486
13487 if (!EQ (old_frame, selected_frame)
13488 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (old_frame)))
13489 /* We played a bit fast-and-loose above and allowed selected_frame
13490 and selected_window to be temporarily out-of-sync but let's make
13491 sure this stays contained. */
13492 select_frame_for_redisplay (old_frame);
13493 eassert (EQ (XFRAME (selected_frame)->selected_window,
13494 selected_window));
13495
13496 if (!pending)
13497 {
13498 /* Do the mark_window_display_accurate after all windows have
13499 been redisplayed because this call resets flags in buffers
13500 which are needed for proper redisplay. */
13501 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
13502 {
13503 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
13504 if (f->updated_p)
13505 {
13506 mark_window_display_accurate (f->root_window, 1);
13507 if (FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->frame_up_to_date_hook)
13508 FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->frame_up_to_date_hook (f);
13509 }
13510 }
13511 }
13512 }
13513 else if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (sf) && !FRAME_OBSCURED_P (sf))
13514 {
13515 Lisp_Object mini_window = FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (sf);
13516 struct frame *mini_frame;
13517
13518 displayed_buffer = XBUFFER (XWINDOW (selected_window)->buffer);
13519 /* Use list_of_error, not Qerror, so that
13520 we catch only errors and don't run the debugger. */
13521 internal_condition_case_1 (redisplay_window_1, selected_window,
13522 list_of_error,
13523 redisplay_window_error);
13524 if (update_miniwindow_p)
13525 internal_condition_case_1 (redisplay_window_1, mini_window,
13526 list_of_error,
13527 redisplay_window_error);
13528
13529 /* Compare desired and current matrices, perform output. */
13530
13531 update:
13532 /* If fonts changed, display again. */
13533 if (fonts_changed_p)
13534 goto retry;
13535
13536 /* Prevent various kinds of signals during display update.
13537 stdio is not robust about handling signals,
13538 which can cause an apparent I/O error. */
13539 if (interrupt_input)
13540 unrequest_sigio ();
13541 STOP_POLLING;
13542
13543 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (sf) && !FRAME_OBSCURED_P (sf))
13544 {
13545 if (hscroll_windows (selected_window))
13546 goto retry;
13547
13548 XWINDOW (selected_window)->must_be_updated_p = 1;
13549 pending = update_frame (sf, 0, 0);
13550 }
13551
13552 /* We may have called echo_area_display at the top of this
13553 function. If the echo area is on another frame, that may
13554 have put text on a frame other than the selected one, so the
13555 above call to update_frame would not have caught it. Catch
13556 it here. */
13557 mini_window = FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (sf);
13558 mini_frame = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (mini_window)));
13559
13560 if (mini_frame != sf && FRAME_WINDOW_P (mini_frame))
13561 {
13562 XWINDOW (mini_window)->must_be_updated_p = 1;
13563 pending |= update_frame (mini_frame, 0, 0);
13564 if (!pending && hscroll_windows (mini_window))
13565 goto retry;
13566 }
13567 }
13568
13569 /* If display was paused because of pending input, make sure we do a
13570 thorough update the next time. */
13571 if (pending)
13572 {
13573 /* Prevent the optimization at the beginning of
13574 redisplay_internal that tries a single-line update of the
13575 line containing the cursor in the selected window. */
13576 CHARPOS (this_line_start_pos) = 0;
13577
13578 /* Let the overlay arrow be updated the next time. */
13579 update_overlay_arrows (0);
13580
13581 /* If we pause after scrolling, some rows in the current
13582 matrices of some windows are not valid. */
13583 if (!WINDOW_FULL_WIDTH_P (w)
13584 && !FRAME_WINDOW_P (XFRAME (w->frame)))
13585 update_mode_lines = 1;
13586 }
13587 else
13588 {
13589 if (!consider_all_windows_p)
13590 {
13591 /* This has already been done above if
13592 consider_all_windows_p is set. */
13593 mark_window_display_accurate_1 (w, 1);
13594
13595 /* Say overlay arrows are up to date. */
13596 update_overlay_arrows (1);
13597
13598 if (FRAME_TERMINAL (sf)->frame_up_to_date_hook != 0)
13599 FRAME_TERMINAL (sf)->frame_up_to_date_hook (sf);
13600 }
13601
13602 update_mode_lines = 0;
13603 windows_or_buffers_changed = 0;
13604 cursor_type_changed = 0;
13605 }
13606
13607 /* Start SIGIO interrupts coming again. Having them off during the
13608 code above makes it less likely one will discard output, but not
13609 impossible, since there might be stuff in the system buffer here.
13610 But it is much hairier to try to do anything about that. */
13611 if (interrupt_input)
13612 request_sigio ();
13613 RESUME_POLLING;
13614
13615 /* If a frame has become visible which was not before, redisplay
13616 again, so that we display it. Expose events for such a frame
13617 (which it gets when becoming visible) don't call the parts of
13618 redisplay constructing glyphs, so simply exposing a frame won't
13619 display anything in this case. So, we have to display these
13620 frames here explicitly. */
13621 if (!pending)
13622 {
13623 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
13624 int new_count = 0;
13625
13626 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
13627 {
13628 int this_is_visible = 0;
13629
13630 if (XFRAME (frame)->visible)
13631 this_is_visible = 1;
13632 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (XFRAME (frame));
13633 if (XFRAME (frame)->visible)
13634 this_is_visible = 1;
13635
13636 if (this_is_visible)
13637 new_count++;
13638 }
13639
13640 if (new_count != number_of_visible_frames)
13641 windows_or_buffers_changed++;
13642 }
13643
13644 /* Change frame size now if a change is pending. */
13645 do_pending_window_change (1);
13646
13647 /* If we just did a pending size change, or have additional
13648 visible frames, or selected_window changed, redisplay again. */
13649 if ((windows_or_buffers_changed && !pending)
13650 || (WINDOWP (selected_window) && (w = XWINDOW (selected_window)) != sw))
13651 goto retry;
13652
13653 /* Clear the face and image caches.
13654
13655 We used to do this only if consider_all_windows_p. But the cache
13656 needs to be cleared if a timer creates images in the current
13657 buffer (e.g. the test case in Bug#6230). */
13658
13659 if (clear_face_cache_count > CLEAR_FACE_CACHE_COUNT)
13660 {
13661 clear_face_cache (0);
13662 clear_face_cache_count = 0;
13663 }
13664
13665 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
13666 if (clear_image_cache_count > CLEAR_IMAGE_CACHE_COUNT)
13667 {
13668 clear_image_caches (Qnil);
13669 clear_image_cache_count = 0;
13670 }
13671 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
13672
13673 end_of_redisplay:
13674 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
13675 RESUME_POLLING;
13676 }
13677
13678
13679 /* Redisplay, but leave alone any recent echo area message unless
13680 another message has been requested in its place.
13681
13682 This is useful in situations where you need to redisplay but no
13683 user action has occurred, making it inappropriate for the message
13684 area to be cleared. See tracking_off and
13685 wait_reading_process_output for examples of these situations.
13686
13687 FROM_WHERE is an integer saying from where this function was
13688 called. This is useful for debugging. */
13689
13690 void
13691 redisplay_preserve_echo_area (int from_where)
13692 {
13693 TRACE ((stderr, "redisplay_preserve_echo_area (%d)\n", from_where));
13694
13695 if (!NILP (echo_area_buffer[1]))
13696 {
13697 /* We have a previously displayed message, but no current
13698 message. Redisplay the previous message. */
13699 display_last_displayed_message_p = 1;
13700 redisplay_internal ();
13701 display_last_displayed_message_p = 0;
13702 }
13703 else
13704 redisplay_internal ();
13705
13706 if (FRAME_RIF (SELECTED_FRAME ()) != NULL
13707 && FRAME_RIF (SELECTED_FRAME ())->flush_display_optional)
13708 FRAME_RIF (SELECTED_FRAME ())->flush_display_optional (NULL);
13709 }
13710
13711
13712 /* Function registered with record_unwind_protect in
13713 redisplay_internal. Reset redisplaying_p to the value it had
13714 before redisplay_internal was called, and clear
13715 prevent_freeing_realized_faces_p. It also selects the previously
13716 selected frame, unless it has been deleted (by an X connection
13717 failure during redisplay, for example). */
13718
13719 static Lisp_Object
13720 unwind_redisplay (Lisp_Object val)
13721 {
13722 Lisp_Object old_redisplaying_p, old_frame;
13723
13724 old_redisplaying_p = XCAR (val);
13725 redisplaying_p = XFASTINT (old_redisplaying_p);
13726 old_frame = XCDR (val);
13727 if (! EQ (old_frame, selected_frame)
13728 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (old_frame)))
13729 select_frame_for_redisplay (old_frame);
13730 return Qnil;
13731 }
13732
13733
13734 /* Mark the display of window W as accurate or inaccurate. If
13735 ACCURATE_P is non-zero mark display of W as accurate. If
13736 ACCURATE_P is zero, arrange for W to be redisplayed the next time
13737 redisplay_internal is called. */
13738
13739 static void
13740 mark_window_display_accurate_1 (struct window *w, int accurate_p)
13741 {
13742 if (BUFFERP (w->buffer))
13743 {
13744 struct buffer *b = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
13745
13746 w->last_modified = accurate_p ? BUF_MODIFF(b) : 0;
13747 w->last_overlay_modified = accurate_p ? BUF_OVERLAY_MODIFF(b) : 0;
13748 w->last_had_star
13749 = BUF_MODIFF (b) > BUF_SAVE_MODIFF (b);
13750
13751 if (accurate_p)
13752 {
13753 b->clip_changed = 0;
13754 b->prevent_redisplay_optimizations_p = 0;
13755
13756 BUF_UNCHANGED_MODIFIED (b) = BUF_MODIFF (b);
13757 BUF_OVERLAY_UNCHANGED_MODIFIED (b) = BUF_OVERLAY_MODIFF (b);
13758 BUF_BEG_UNCHANGED (b) = BUF_GPT (b) - BUF_BEG (b);
13759 BUF_END_UNCHANGED (b) = BUF_Z (b) - BUF_GPT (b);
13760
13761 w->current_matrix->buffer = b;
13762 w->current_matrix->begv = BUF_BEGV (b);
13763 w->current_matrix->zv = BUF_ZV (b);
13764
13765 w->last_cursor = w->cursor;
13766 w->last_cursor_off_p = w->cursor_off_p;
13767
13768 if (w == XWINDOW (selected_window))
13769 w->last_point = BUF_PT (b);
13770 else
13771 w->last_point = XMARKER (w->pointm)->charpos;
13772 }
13773 }
13774
13775 if (accurate_p)
13776 {
13777 wset_window_end_valid (w, w->buffer);
13778 w->update_mode_line = 0;
13779 }
13780 }
13781
13782
13783 /* Mark the display of windows in the window tree rooted at WINDOW as
13784 accurate or inaccurate. If ACCURATE_P is non-zero mark display of
13785 windows as accurate. If ACCURATE_P is zero, arrange for windows to
13786 be redisplayed the next time redisplay_internal is called. */
13787
13788 void
13789 mark_window_display_accurate (Lisp_Object window, int accurate_p)
13790 {
13791 struct window *w;
13792
13793 for (; !NILP (window); window = w->next)
13794 {
13795 w = XWINDOW (window);
13796 mark_window_display_accurate_1 (w, accurate_p);
13797
13798 if (!NILP (w->vchild))
13799 mark_window_display_accurate (w->vchild, accurate_p);
13800 if (!NILP (w->hchild))
13801 mark_window_display_accurate (w->hchild, accurate_p);
13802 }
13803
13804 if (accurate_p)
13805 {
13806 update_overlay_arrows (1);
13807 }
13808 else
13809 {
13810 /* Force a thorough redisplay the next time by setting
13811 last_arrow_position and last_arrow_string to t, which is
13812 unequal to any useful value of Voverlay_arrow_... */
13813 update_overlay_arrows (-1);
13814 }
13815 }
13816
13817
13818 /* Return value in display table DP (Lisp_Char_Table *) for character
13819 C. Since a display table doesn't have any parent, we don't have to
13820 follow parent. Do not call this function directly but use the
13821 macro DISP_CHAR_VECTOR. */
13822
13823 Lisp_Object
13824 disp_char_vector (struct Lisp_Char_Table *dp, int c)
13825 {
13826 Lisp_Object val;
13827
13828 if (ASCII_CHAR_P (c))
13829 {
13830 val = dp->ascii;
13831 if (SUB_CHAR_TABLE_P (val))
13832 val = XSUB_CHAR_TABLE (val)->contents[c];
13833 }
13834 else
13835 {
13836 Lisp_Object table;
13837
13838 XSETCHAR_TABLE (table, dp);
13839 val = char_table_ref (table, c);
13840 }
13841 if (NILP (val))
13842 val = dp->defalt;
13843 return val;
13844 }
13845
13846
13847 \f
13848 /***********************************************************************
13849 Window Redisplay
13850 ***********************************************************************/
13851
13852 /* Redisplay all leaf windows in the window tree rooted at WINDOW. */
13853
13854 static void
13855 redisplay_windows (Lisp_Object window)
13856 {
13857 while (!NILP (window))
13858 {
13859 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
13860
13861 if (!NILP (w->hchild))
13862 redisplay_windows (w->hchild);
13863 else if (!NILP (w->vchild))
13864 redisplay_windows (w->vchild);
13865 else if (!NILP (w->buffer))
13866 {
13867 displayed_buffer = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
13868 /* Use list_of_error, not Qerror, so that
13869 we catch only errors and don't run the debugger. */
13870 internal_condition_case_1 (redisplay_window_0, window,
13871 list_of_error,
13872 redisplay_window_error);
13873 }
13874
13875 window = w->next;
13876 }
13877 }
13878
13879 static Lisp_Object
13880 redisplay_window_error (Lisp_Object ignore)
13881 {
13882 displayed_buffer->display_error_modiff = BUF_MODIFF (displayed_buffer);
13883 return Qnil;
13884 }
13885
13886 static Lisp_Object
13887 redisplay_window_0 (Lisp_Object window)
13888 {
13889 if (displayed_buffer->display_error_modiff < BUF_MODIFF (displayed_buffer))
13890 redisplay_window (window, 0);
13891 return Qnil;
13892 }
13893
13894 static Lisp_Object
13895 redisplay_window_1 (Lisp_Object window)
13896 {
13897 if (displayed_buffer->display_error_modiff < BUF_MODIFF (displayed_buffer))
13898 redisplay_window (window, 1);
13899 return Qnil;
13900 }
13901 \f
13902
13903 /* Set cursor position of W. PT is assumed to be displayed in ROW.
13904 DELTA and DELTA_BYTES are the numbers of characters and bytes by
13905 which positions recorded in ROW differ from current buffer
13906 positions.
13907
13908 Return 0 if cursor is not on this row, 1 otherwise. */
13909
13910 static int
13911 set_cursor_from_row (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row,
13912 struct glyph_matrix *matrix,
13913 ptrdiff_t delta, ptrdiff_t delta_bytes,
13914 int dy, int dvpos)
13915 {
13916 struct glyph *glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
13917 struct glyph *end = glyph + row->used[TEXT_AREA];
13918 struct glyph *cursor = NULL;
13919 /* The last known character position in row. */
13920 ptrdiff_t last_pos = MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) + delta;
13921 int x = row->x;
13922 ptrdiff_t pt_old = PT - delta;
13923 ptrdiff_t pos_before = MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) + delta;
13924 ptrdiff_t pos_after = MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) + delta;
13925 struct glyph *glyph_before = glyph - 1, *glyph_after = end;
13926 /* A glyph beyond the edge of TEXT_AREA which we should never
13927 touch. */
13928 struct glyph *glyphs_end = end;
13929 /* Non-zero means we've found a match for cursor position, but that
13930 glyph has the avoid_cursor_p flag set. */
13931 int match_with_avoid_cursor = 0;
13932 /* Non-zero means we've seen at least one glyph that came from a
13933 display string. */
13934 int string_seen = 0;
13935 /* Largest and smallest buffer positions seen so far during scan of
13936 glyph row. */
13937 ptrdiff_t bpos_max = pos_before;
13938 ptrdiff_t bpos_min = pos_after;
13939 /* Last buffer position covered by an overlay string with an integer
13940 `cursor' property. */
13941 ptrdiff_t bpos_covered = 0;
13942 /* Non-zero means the display string on which to display the cursor
13943 comes from a text property, not from an overlay. */
13944 int string_from_text_prop = 0;
13945
13946 /* Don't even try doing anything if called for a mode-line or
13947 header-line row, since the rest of the code isn't prepared to
13948 deal with such calamities. */
13949 eassert (!row->mode_line_p);
13950 if (row->mode_line_p)
13951 return 0;
13952
13953 /* Skip over glyphs not having an object at the start and the end of
13954 the row. These are special glyphs like truncation marks on
13955 terminal frames. */
13956 if (row->displays_text_p)
13957 {
13958 if (!row->reversed_p)
13959 {
13960 while (glyph < end
13961 && INTEGERP (glyph->object)
13962 && glyph->charpos < 0)
13963 {
13964 x += glyph->pixel_width;
13965 ++glyph;
13966 }
13967 while (end > glyph
13968 && INTEGERP ((end - 1)->object)
13969 /* CHARPOS is zero for blanks and stretch glyphs
13970 inserted by extend_face_to_end_of_line. */
13971 && (end - 1)->charpos <= 0)
13972 --end;
13973 glyph_before = glyph - 1;
13974 glyph_after = end;
13975 }
13976 else
13977 {
13978 struct glyph *g;
13979
13980 /* If the glyph row is reversed, we need to process it from back
13981 to front, so swap the edge pointers. */
13982 glyphs_end = end = glyph - 1;
13983 glyph += row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
13984
13985 while (glyph > end + 1
13986 && INTEGERP (glyph->object)
13987 && glyph->charpos < 0)
13988 {
13989 --glyph;
13990 x -= glyph->pixel_width;
13991 }
13992 if (INTEGERP (glyph->object) && glyph->charpos < 0)
13993 --glyph;
13994 /* By default, in reversed rows we put the cursor on the
13995 rightmost (first in the reading order) glyph. */
13996 for (g = end + 1; g < glyph; g++)
13997 x += g->pixel_width;
13998 while (end < glyph
13999 && INTEGERP ((end + 1)->object)
14000 && (end + 1)->charpos <= 0)
14001 ++end;
14002 glyph_before = glyph + 1;
14003 glyph_after = end;
14004 }
14005 }
14006 else if (row->reversed_p)
14007 {
14008 /* In R2L rows that don't display text, put the cursor on the
14009 rightmost glyph. Case in point: an empty last line that is
14010 part of an R2L paragraph. */
14011 cursor = end - 1;
14012 /* Avoid placing the cursor on the last glyph of the row, where
14013 on terminal frames we hold the vertical border between
14014 adjacent windows. */
14015 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (WINDOW_XFRAME (w))
14016 && !WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
14017 && cursor == row->glyphs[LAST_AREA] - 1)
14018 cursor--;
14019 x = -1; /* will be computed below, at label compute_x */
14020 }
14021
14022 /* Step 1: Try to find the glyph whose character position
14023 corresponds to point. If that's not possible, find 2 glyphs
14024 whose character positions are the closest to point, one before
14025 point, the other after it. */
14026 if (!row->reversed_p)
14027 while (/* not marched to end of glyph row */
14028 glyph < end
14029 /* glyph was not inserted by redisplay for internal purposes */
14030 && !INTEGERP (glyph->object))
14031 {
14032 if (BUFFERP (glyph->object))
14033 {
14034 ptrdiff_t dpos = glyph->charpos - pt_old;
14035
14036 if (glyph->charpos > bpos_max)
14037 bpos_max = glyph->charpos;
14038 if (glyph->charpos < bpos_min)
14039 bpos_min = glyph->charpos;
14040 if (!glyph->avoid_cursor_p)
14041 {
14042 /* If we hit point, we've found the glyph on which to
14043 display the cursor. */
14044 if (dpos == 0)
14045 {
14046 match_with_avoid_cursor = 0;
14047 break;
14048 }
14049 /* See if we've found a better approximation to
14050 POS_BEFORE or to POS_AFTER. */
14051 if (0 > dpos && dpos > pos_before - pt_old)
14052 {
14053 pos_before = glyph->charpos;
14054 glyph_before = glyph;
14055 }
14056 else if (0 < dpos && dpos < pos_after - pt_old)
14057 {
14058 pos_after = glyph->charpos;
14059 glyph_after = glyph;
14060 }
14061 }
14062 else if (dpos == 0)
14063 match_with_avoid_cursor = 1;
14064 }
14065 else if (STRINGP (glyph->object))
14066 {
14067 Lisp_Object chprop;
14068 ptrdiff_t glyph_pos = glyph->charpos;
14069
14070 chprop = Fget_char_property (make_number (glyph_pos), Qcursor,
14071 glyph->object);
14072 if (!NILP (chprop))
14073 {
14074 /* If the string came from a `display' text property,
14075 look up the buffer position of that property and
14076 use that position to update bpos_max, as if we
14077 actually saw such a position in one of the row's
14078 glyphs. This helps with supporting integer values
14079 of `cursor' property on the display string in
14080 situations where most or all of the row's buffer
14081 text is completely covered by display properties,
14082 so that no glyph with valid buffer positions is
14083 ever seen in the row. */
14084 ptrdiff_t prop_pos =
14085 string_buffer_position_lim (glyph->object, pos_before,
14086 pos_after, 0);
14087
14088 if (prop_pos >= pos_before)
14089 bpos_max = prop_pos - 1;
14090 }
14091 if (INTEGERP (chprop))
14092 {
14093 bpos_covered = bpos_max + XINT (chprop);
14094 /* If the `cursor' property covers buffer positions up
14095 to and including point, we should display cursor on
14096 this glyph. Note that, if a `cursor' property on one
14097 of the string's characters has an integer value, we
14098 will break out of the loop below _before_ we get to
14099 the position match above. IOW, integer values of
14100 the `cursor' property override the "exact match for
14101 point" strategy of positioning the cursor. */
14102 /* Implementation note: bpos_max == pt_old when, e.g.,
14103 we are in an empty line, where bpos_max is set to
14104 MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS, see above. */
14105 if (bpos_max <= pt_old && bpos_covered >= pt_old)
14106 {
14107 cursor = glyph;
14108 break;
14109 }
14110 }
14111
14112 string_seen = 1;
14113 }
14114 x += glyph->pixel_width;
14115 ++glyph;
14116 }
14117 else if (glyph > end) /* row is reversed */
14118 while (!INTEGERP (glyph->object))
14119 {
14120 if (BUFFERP (glyph->object))
14121 {
14122 ptrdiff_t dpos = glyph->charpos - pt_old;
14123
14124 if (glyph->charpos > bpos_max)
14125 bpos_max = glyph->charpos;
14126 if (glyph->charpos < bpos_min)
14127 bpos_min = glyph->charpos;
14128 if (!glyph->avoid_cursor_p)
14129 {
14130 if (dpos == 0)
14131 {
14132 match_with_avoid_cursor = 0;
14133 break;
14134 }
14135 if (0 > dpos && dpos > pos_before - pt_old)
14136 {
14137 pos_before = glyph->charpos;
14138 glyph_before = glyph;
14139 }
14140 else if (0 < dpos && dpos < pos_after - pt_old)
14141 {
14142 pos_after = glyph->charpos;
14143 glyph_after = glyph;
14144 }
14145 }
14146 else if (dpos == 0)
14147 match_with_avoid_cursor = 1;
14148 }
14149 else if (STRINGP (glyph->object))
14150 {
14151 Lisp_Object chprop;
14152 ptrdiff_t glyph_pos = glyph->charpos;
14153
14154 chprop = Fget_char_property (make_number (glyph_pos), Qcursor,
14155 glyph->object);
14156 if (!NILP (chprop))
14157 {
14158 ptrdiff_t prop_pos =
14159 string_buffer_position_lim (glyph->object, pos_before,
14160 pos_after, 0);
14161
14162 if (prop_pos >= pos_before)
14163 bpos_max = prop_pos - 1;
14164 }
14165 if (INTEGERP (chprop))
14166 {
14167 bpos_covered = bpos_max + XINT (chprop);
14168 /* If the `cursor' property covers buffer positions up
14169 to and including point, we should display cursor on
14170 this glyph. */
14171 if (bpos_max <= pt_old && bpos_covered >= pt_old)
14172 {
14173 cursor = glyph;
14174 break;
14175 }
14176 }
14177 string_seen = 1;
14178 }
14179 --glyph;
14180 if (glyph == glyphs_end) /* don't dereference outside TEXT_AREA */
14181 {
14182 x--; /* can't use any pixel_width */
14183 break;
14184 }
14185 x -= glyph->pixel_width;
14186 }
14187
14188 /* Step 2: If we didn't find an exact match for point, we need to
14189 look for a proper place to put the cursor among glyphs between
14190 GLYPH_BEFORE and GLYPH_AFTER. */
14191 if (!((row->reversed_p ? glyph > glyphs_end : glyph < glyphs_end)
14192 && BUFFERP (glyph->object) && glyph->charpos == pt_old)
14193 && bpos_covered < pt_old)
14194 {
14195 /* An empty line has a single glyph whose OBJECT is zero and
14196 whose CHARPOS is the position of a newline on that line.
14197 Note that on a TTY, there are more glyphs after that, which
14198 were produced by extend_face_to_end_of_line, but their
14199 CHARPOS is zero or negative. */
14200 int empty_line_p =
14201 (row->reversed_p ? glyph > glyphs_end : glyph < glyphs_end)
14202 && INTEGERP (glyph->object) && glyph->charpos > 0;
14203
14204 if (row->ends_in_ellipsis_p && pos_after == last_pos)
14205 {
14206 ptrdiff_t ellipsis_pos;
14207
14208 /* Scan back over the ellipsis glyphs. */
14209 if (!row->reversed_p)
14210 {
14211 ellipsis_pos = (glyph - 1)->charpos;
14212 while (glyph > row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]
14213 && (glyph - 1)->charpos == ellipsis_pos)
14214 glyph--, x -= glyph->pixel_width;
14215 /* That loop always goes one position too far, including
14216 the glyph before the ellipsis. So scan forward over
14217 that one. */
14218 x += glyph->pixel_width;
14219 glyph++;
14220 }
14221 else /* row is reversed */
14222 {
14223 ellipsis_pos = (glyph + 1)->charpos;
14224 while (glyph < row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1
14225 && (glyph + 1)->charpos == ellipsis_pos)
14226 glyph++, x += glyph->pixel_width;
14227 x -= glyph->pixel_width;
14228 glyph--;
14229 }
14230 }
14231 else if (match_with_avoid_cursor)
14232 {
14233 cursor = glyph_after;
14234 x = -1;
14235 }
14236 else if (string_seen)
14237 {
14238 int incr = row->reversed_p ? -1 : +1;
14239
14240 /* Need to find the glyph that came out of a string which is
14241 present at point. That glyph is somewhere between
14242 GLYPH_BEFORE and GLYPH_AFTER, and it came from a string
14243 positioned between POS_BEFORE and POS_AFTER in the
14244 buffer. */
14245 struct glyph *start, *stop;
14246 ptrdiff_t pos = pos_before;
14247
14248 x = -1;
14249
14250 /* If the row ends in a newline from a display string,
14251 reordering could have moved the glyphs belonging to the
14252 string out of the [GLYPH_BEFORE..GLYPH_AFTER] range. So
14253 in this case we extend the search to the last glyph in
14254 the row that was not inserted by redisplay. */
14255 if (row->ends_in_newline_from_string_p)
14256 {
14257 glyph_after = end;
14258 pos_after = MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) + delta;
14259 }
14260
14261 /* GLYPH_BEFORE and GLYPH_AFTER are the glyphs that
14262 correspond to POS_BEFORE and POS_AFTER, respectively. We
14263 need START and STOP in the order that corresponds to the
14264 row's direction as given by its reversed_p flag. If the
14265 directionality of characters between POS_BEFORE and
14266 POS_AFTER is the opposite of the row's base direction,
14267 these characters will have been reordered for display,
14268 and we need to reverse START and STOP. */
14269 if (!row->reversed_p)
14270 {
14271 start = min (glyph_before, glyph_after);
14272 stop = max (glyph_before, glyph_after);
14273 }
14274 else
14275 {
14276 start = max (glyph_before, glyph_after);
14277 stop = min (glyph_before, glyph_after);
14278 }
14279 for (glyph = start + incr;
14280 row->reversed_p ? glyph > stop : glyph < stop; )
14281 {
14282
14283 /* Any glyphs that come from the buffer are here because
14284 of bidi reordering. Skip them, and only pay
14285 attention to glyphs that came from some string. */
14286 if (STRINGP (glyph->object))
14287 {
14288 Lisp_Object str;
14289 ptrdiff_t tem;
14290 /* If the display property covers the newline, we
14291 need to search for it one position farther. */
14292 ptrdiff_t lim = pos_after
14293 + (pos_after == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) + delta);
14294
14295 string_from_text_prop = 0;
14296 str = glyph->object;
14297 tem = string_buffer_position_lim (str, pos, lim, 0);
14298 if (tem == 0 /* from overlay */
14299 || pos <= tem)
14300 {
14301 /* If the string from which this glyph came is
14302 found in the buffer at point, or at position
14303 that is closer to point than pos_after, then
14304 we've found the glyph we've been looking for.
14305 If it comes from an overlay (tem == 0), and
14306 it has the `cursor' property on one of its
14307 glyphs, record that glyph as a candidate for
14308 displaying the cursor. (As in the
14309 unidirectional version, we will display the
14310 cursor on the last candidate we find.) */
14311 if (tem == 0
14312 || tem == pt_old
14313 || (tem - pt_old > 0 && tem < pos_after))
14314 {
14315 /* The glyphs from this string could have
14316 been reordered. Find the one with the
14317 smallest string position. Or there could
14318 be a character in the string with the
14319 `cursor' property, which means display
14320 cursor on that character's glyph. */
14321 ptrdiff_t strpos = glyph->charpos;
14322
14323 if (tem)
14324 {
14325 cursor = glyph;
14326 string_from_text_prop = 1;
14327 }
14328 for ( ;
14329 (row->reversed_p ? glyph > stop : glyph < stop)
14330 && EQ (glyph->object, str);
14331 glyph += incr)
14332 {
14333 Lisp_Object cprop;
14334 ptrdiff_t gpos = glyph->charpos;
14335
14336 cprop = Fget_char_property (make_number (gpos),
14337 Qcursor,
14338 glyph->object);
14339 if (!NILP (cprop))
14340 {
14341 cursor = glyph;
14342 break;
14343 }
14344 if (tem && glyph->charpos < strpos)
14345 {
14346 strpos = glyph->charpos;
14347 cursor = glyph;
14348 }
14349 }
14350
14351 if (tem == pt_old
14352 || (tem - pt_old > 0 && tem < pos_after))
14353 goto compute_x;
14354 }
14355 if (tem)
14356 pos = tem + 1; /* don't find previous instances */
14357 }
14358 /* This string is not what we want; skip all of the
14359 glyphs that came from it. */
14360 while ((row->reversed_p ? glyph > stop : glyph < stop)
14361 && EQ (glyph->object, str))
14362 glyph += incr;
14363 }
14364 else
14365 glyph += incr;
14366 }
14367
14368 /* If we reached the end of the line, and END was from a string,
14369 the cursor is not on this line. */
14370 if (cursor == NULL
14371 && (row->reversed_p ? glyph <= end : glyph >= end)
14372 && (row->reversed_p ? end > glyphs_end : end < glyphs_end)
14373 && STRINGP (end->object)
14374 && row->continued_p)
14375 return 0;
14376 }
14377 /* A truncated row may not include PT among its character positions.
14378 Setting the cursor inside the scroll margin will trigger
14379 recalculation of hscroll in hscroll_window_tree. But if a
14380 display string covers point, defer to the string-handling
14381 code below to figure this out. */
14382 else if (row->truncated_on_left_p && pt_old < bpos_min)
14383 {
14384 cursor = glyph_before;
14385 x = -1;
14386 }
14387 else if ((row->truncated_on_right_p && pt_old > bpos_max)
14388 /* Zero-width characters produce no glyphs. */
14389 || (!empty_line_p
14390 && (row->reversed_p
14391 ? glyph_after > glyphs_end
14392 : glyph_after < glyphs_end)))
14393 {
14394 cursor = glyph_after;
14395 x = -1;
14396 }
14397 }
14398
14399 compute_x:
14400 if (cursor != NULL)
14401 glyph = cursor;
14402 else if (glyph == glyphs_end
14403 && pos_before == pos_after
14404 && STRINGP ((row->reversed_p
14405 ? row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1
14406 : row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA])->object))
14407 {
14408 /* If all the glyphs of this row came from strings, put the
14409 cursor on the first glyph of the row. This avoids having the
14410 cursor outside of the text area in this very rare and hard
14411 use case. */
14412 glyph =
14413 row->reversed_p
14414 ? row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1
14415 : row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
14416 }
14417 if (x < 0)
14418 {
14419 struct glyph *g;
14420
14421 /* Need to compute x that corresponds to GLYPH. */
14422 for (g = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA], x = row->x; g < glyph; g++)
14423 {
14424 if (g >= row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA])
14425 abort ();
14426 x += g->pixel_width;
14427 }
14428 }
14429
14430 /* ROW could be part of a continued line, which, under bidi
14431 reordering, might have other rows whose start and end charpos
14432 occlude point. Only set w->cursor if we found a better
14433 approximation to the cursor position than we have from previously
14434 examined candidate rows belonging to the same continued line. */
14435 if (/* we already have a candidate row */
14436 w->cursor.vpos >= 0
14437 /* that candidate is not the row we are processing */
14438 && MATRIX_ROW (matrix, w->cursor.vpos) != row
14439 /* Make sure cursor.vpos specifies a row whose start and end
14440 charpos occlude point, and it is valid candidate for being a
14441 cursor-row. This is because some callers of this function
14442 leave cursor.vpos at the row where the cursor was displayed
14443 during the last redisplay cycle. */
14444 && MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (MATRIX_ROW (matrix, w->cursor.vpos)) <= pt_old
14445 && pt_old <= MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (MATRIX_ROW (matrix, w->cursor.vpos))
14446 && cursor_row_p (MATRIX_ROW (matrix, w->cursor.vpos)))
14447 {
14448 struct glyph *g1 =
14449 MATRIX_ROW_GLYPH_START (matrix, w->cursor.vpos) + w->cursor.hpos;
14450
14451 /* Don't consider glyphs that are outside TEXT_AREA. */
14452 if (!(row->reversed_p ? glyph > glyphs_end : glyph < glyphs_end))
14453 return 0;
14454 /* Keep the candidate whose buffer position is the closest to
14455 point or has the `cursor' property. */
14456 if (/* previous candidate is a glyph in TEXT_AREA of that row */
14457 w->cursor.hpos >= 0
14458 && w->cursor.hpos < MATRIX_ROW_USED (matrix, w->cursor.vpos)
14459 && ((BUFFERP (g1->object)
14460 && (g1->charpos == pt_old /* an exact match always wins */
14461 || (BUFFERP (glyph->object)
14462 && eabs (g1->charpos - pt_old)
14463 < eabs (glyph->charpos - pt_old))))
14464 /* previous candidate is a glyph from a string that has
14465 a non-nil `cursor' property */
14466 || (STRINGP (g1->object)
14467 && (!NILP (Fget_char_property (make_number (g1->charpos),
14468 Qcursor, g1->object))
14469 /* previous candidate is from the same display
14470 string as this one, and the display string
14471 came from a text property */
14472 || (EQ (g1->object, glyph->object)
14473 && string_from_text_prop)
14474 /* this candidate is from newline and its
14475 position is not an exact match */
14476 || (INTEGERP (glyph->object)
14477 && glyph->charpos != pt_old)))))
14478 return 0;
14479 /* If this candidate gives an exact match, use that. */
14480 if (!((BUFFERP (glyph->object) && glyph->charpos == pt_old)
14481 /* If this candidate is a glyph created for the
14482 terminating newline of a line, and point is on that
14483 newline, it wins because it's an exact match. */
14484 || (!row->continued_p
14485 && INTEGERP (glyph->object)
14486 && glyph->charpos == 0
14487 && pt_old == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) - 1))
14488 /* Otherwise, keep the candidate that comes from a row
14489 spanning less buffer positions. This may win when one or
14490 both candidate positions are on glyphs that came from
14491 display strings, for which we cannot compare buffer
14492 positions. */
14493 && MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (MATRIX_ROW (matrix, w->cursor.vpos))
14494 - MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (MATRIX_ROW (matrix, w->cursor.vpos))
14495 < MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) - MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row))
14496 return 0;
14497 }
14498 w->cursor.hpos = glyph - row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
14499 w->cursor.x = x;
14500 w->cursor.vpos = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (row, matrix) + dvpos;
14501 w->cursor.y = row->y + dy;
14502
14503 if (w == XWINDOW (selected_window))
14504 {
14505 if (!row->continued_p
14506 && !MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (row)
14507 && row->x == 0)
14508 {
14509 this_line_buffer = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
14510
14511 CHARPOS (this_line_start_pos)
14512 = MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) + delta;
14513 BYTEPOS (this_line_start_pos)
14514 = MATRIX_ROW_START_BYTEPOS (row) + delta_bytes;
14515
14516 CHARPOS (this_line_end_pos)
14517 = Z - (MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) + delta);
14518 BYTEPOS (this_line_end_pos)
14519 = Z_BYTE - (MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (row) + delta_bytes);
14520
14521 this_line_y = w->cursor.y;
14522 this_line_pixel_height = row->height;
14523 this_line_vpos = w->cursor.vpos;
14524 this_line_start_x = row->x;
14525 }
14526 else
14527 CHARPOS (this_line_start_pos) = 0;
14528 }
14529
14530 return 1;
14531 }
14532
14533
14534 /* Run window scroll functions, if any, for WINDOW with new window
14535 start STARTP. Sets the window start of WINDOW to that position.
14536
14537 We assume that the window's buffer is really current. */
14538
14539 static inline struct text_pos
14540 run_window_scroll_functions (Lisp_Object window, struct text_pos startp)
14541 {
14542 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
14543 SET_MARKER_FROM_TEXT_POS (w->start, startp);
14544
14545 if (current_buffer != XBUFFER (w->buffer))
14546 abort ();
14547
14548 if (!NILP (Vwindow_scroll_functions))
14549 {
14550 run_hook_with_args_2 (Qwindow_scroll_functions, window,
14551 make_number (CHARPOS (startp)));
14552 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (startp, w->start);
14553 /* In case the hook functions switch buffers. */
14554 if (current_buffer != XBUFFER (w->buffer))
14555 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (w->buffer));
14556 }
14557
14558 return startp;
14559 }
14560
14561
14562 /* Make sure the line containing the cursor is fully visible.
14563 A value of 1 means there is nothing to be done.
14564 (Either the line is fully visible, or it cannot be made so,
14565 or we cannot tell.)
14566
14567 If FORCE_P is non-zero, return 0 even if partial visible cursor row
14568 is higher than window.
14569
14570 A value of 0 means the caller should do scrolling
14571 as if point had gone off the screen. */
14572
14573 static int
14574 cursor_row_fully_visible_p (struct window *w, int force_p, int current_matrix_p)
14575 {
14576 struct glyph_matrix *matrix;
14577 struct glyph_row *row;
14578 int window_height;
14579
14580 if (!make_cursor_line_fully_visible_p)
14581 return 1;
14582
14583 /* It's not always possible to find the cursor, e.g, when a window
14584 is full of overlay strings. Don't do anything in that case. */
14585 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
14586 return 1;
14587
14588 matrix = current_matrix_p ? w->current_matrix : w->desired_matrix;
14589 row = MATRIX_ROW (matrix, w->cursor.vpos);
14590
14591 /* If the cursor row is not partially visible, there's nothing to do. */
14592 if (!MATRIX_ROW_PARTIALLY_VISIBLE_P (w, row))
14593 return 1;
14594
14595 /* If the row the cursor is in is taller than the window's height,
14596 it's not clear what to do, so do nothing. */
14597 window_height = window_box_height (w);
14598 if (row->height >= window_height)
14599 {
14600 if (!force_p || MINI_WINDOW_P (w)
14601 || w->vscroll || w->cursor.vpos == 0)
14602 return 1;
14603 }
14604 return 0;
14605 }
14606
14607
14608 /* Try scrolling PT into view in window WINDOW. JUST_THIS_ONE_P
14609 non-zero means only WINDOW is redisplayed in redisplay_internal.
14610 TEMP_SCROLL_STEP has the same meaning as emacs_scroll_step, and is used
14611 in redisplay_window to bring a partially visible line into view in
14612 the case that only the cursor has moved.
14613
14614 LAST_LINE_MISFIT should be nonzero if we're scrolling because the
14615 last screen line's vertical height extends past the end of the screen.
14616
14617 Value is
14618
14619 1 if scrolling succeeded
14620
14621 0 if scrolling didn't find point.
14622
14623 -1 if new fonts have been loaded so that we must interrupt
14624 redisplay, adjust glyph matrices, and try again. */
14625
14626 enum
14627 {
14628 SCROLLING_SUCCESS,
14629 SCROLLING_FAILED,
14630 SCROLLING_NEED_LARGER_MATRICES
14631 };
14632
14633 /* If scroll-conservatively is more than this, never recenter.
14634
14635 If you change this, don't forget to update the doc string of
14636 `scroll-conservatively' and the Emacs manual. */
14637 #define SCROLL_LIMIT 100
14638
14639 static int
14640 try_scrolling (Lisp_Object window, int just_this_one_p,
14641 ptrdiff_t arg_scroll_conservatively, ptrdiff_t scroll_step,
14642 int temp_scroll_step, int last_line_misfit)
14643 {
14644 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
14645 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
14646 struct text_pos pos, startp;
14647 struct it it;
14648 int this_scroll_margin, scroll_max, rc, height;
14649 int dy = 0, amount_to_scroll = 0, scroll_down_p = 0;
14650 int extra_scroll_margin_lines = last_line_misfit ? 1 : 0;
14651 Lisp_Object aggressive;
14652 /* We will never try scrolling more than this number of lines. */
14653 int scroll_limit = SCROLL_LIMIT;
14654
14655 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
14656 debug_method_add (w, "try_scrolling");
14657 #endif
14658
14659 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (startp, w->start);
14660
14661 /* Compute scroll margin height in pixels. We scroll when point is
14662 within this distance from the top or bottom of the window. */
14663 if (scroll_margin > 0)
14664 this_scroll_margin = min (scroll_margin, WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) / 4)
14665 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
14666 else
14667 this_scroll_margin = 0;
14668
14669 /* Force arg_scroll_conservatively to have a reasonable value, to
14670 avoid scrolling too far away with slow move_it_* functions. Note
14671 that the user can supply scroll-conservatively equal to
14672 `most-positive-fixnum', which can be larger than INT_MAX. */
14673 if (arg_scroll_conservatively > scroll_limit)
14674 {
14675 arg_scroll_conservatively = scroll_limit + 1;
14676 scroll_max = scroll_limit * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
14677 }
14678 else if (scroll_step || arg_scroll_conservatively || temp_scroll_step)
14679 /* Compute how much we should try to scroll maximally to bring
14680 point into view. */
14681 scroll_max = (max (scroll_step,
14682 max (arg_scroll_conservatively, temp_scroll_step))
14683 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f));
14684 else if (NUMBERP (BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_down_aggressively))
14685 || NUMBERP (BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_up_aggressively)))
14686 /* We're trying to scroll because of aggressive scrolling but no
14687 scroll_step is set. Choose an arbitrary one. */
14688 scroll_max = 10 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
14689 else
14690 scroll_max = 0;
14691
14692 too_near_end:
14693
14694 /* Decide whether to scroll down. */
14695 if (PT > CHARPOS (startp))
14696 {
14697 int scroll_margin_y;
14698
14699 /* Compute the pixel ypos of the scroll margin, then move IT to
14700 either that ypos or PT, whichever comes first. */
14701 start_display (&it, w, startp);
14702 scroll_margin_y = it.last_visible_y - this_scroll_margin
14703 - FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) * extra_scroll_margin_lines;
14704 move_it_to (&it, PT, -1, scroll_margin_y - 1, -1,
14705 (MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_Y));
14706
14707 if (PT > CHARPOS (it.current.pos))
14708 {
14709 int y0 = line_bottom_y (&it);
14710 /* Compute how many pixels below window bottom to stop searching
14711 for PT. This avoids costly search for PT that is far away if
14712 the user limited scrolling by a small number of lines, but
14713 always finds PT if scroll_conservatively is set to a large
14714 number, such as most-positive-fixnum. */
14715 int slack = max (scroll_max, 10 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f));
14716 int y_to_move = it.last_visible_y + slack;
14717
14718 /* Compute the distance from the scroll margin to PT or to
14719 the scroll limit, whichever comes first. This should
14720 include the height of the cursor line, to make that line
14721 fully visible. */
14722 move_it_to (&it, PT, -1, y_to_move,
14723 -1, MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_Y);
14724 dy = line_bottom_y (&it) - y0;
14725
14726 if (dy > scroll_max)
14727 return SCROLLING_FAILED;
14728
14729 if (dy > 0)
14730 scroll_down_p = 1;
14731 }
14732 }
14733
14734 if (scroll_down_p)
14735 {
14736 /* Point is in or below the bottom scroll margin, so move the
14737 window start down. If scrolling conservatively, move it just
14738 enough down to make point visible. If scroll_step is set,
14739 move it down by scroll_step. */
14740 if (arg_scroll_conservatively)
14741 amount_to_scroll
14742 = min (max (dy, FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)),
14743 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) * arg_scroll_conservatively);
14744 else if (scroll_step || temp_scroll_step)
14745 amount_to_scroll = scroll_max;
14746 else
14747 {
14748 aggressive = BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_up_aggressively);
14749 height = WINDOW_BOX_TEXT_HEIGHT (w);
14750 if (NUMBERP (aggressive))
14751 {
14752 double float_amount = XFLOATINT (aggressive) * height;
14753 amount_to_scroll = float_amount;
14754 if (amount_to_scroll == 0 && float_amount > 0)
14755 amount_to_scroll = 1;
14756 /* Don't let point enter the scroll margin near top of
14757 the window. */
14758 if (amount_to_scroll > height - 2*this_scroll_margin + dy)
14759 amount_to_scroll = height - 2*this_scroll_margin + dy;
14760 }
14761 }
14762
14763 if (amount_to_scroll <= 0)
14764 return SCROLLING_FAILED;
14765
14766 start_display (&it, w, startp);
14767 if (arg_scroll_conservatively <= scroll_limit)
14768 move_it_vertically (&it, amount_to_scroll);
14769 else
14770 {
14771 /* Extra precision for users who set scroll-conservatively
14772 to a large number: make sure the amount we scroll
14773 the window start is never less than amount_to_scroll,
14774 which was computed as distance from window bottom to
14775 point. This matters when lines at window top and lines
14776 below window bottom have different height. */
14777 struct it it1;
14778 void *it1data = NULL;
14779 /* We use a temporary it1 because line_bottom_y can modify
14780 its argument, if it moves one line down; see there. */
14781 int start_y;
14782
14783 SAVE_IT (it1, it, it1data);
14784 start_y = line_bottom_y (&it1);
14785 do {
14786 RESTORE_IT (&it, &it, it1data);
14787 move_it_by_lines (&it, 1);
14788 SAVE_IT (it1, it, it1data);
14789 } while (line_bottom_y (&it1) - start_y < amount_to_scroll);
14790 }
14791
14792 /* If STARTP is unchanged, move it down another screen line. */
14793 if (CHARPOS (it.current.pos) == CHARPOS (startp))
14794 move_it_by_lines (&it, 1);
14795 startp = it.current.pos;
14796 }
14797 else
14798 {
14799 struct text_pos scroll_margin_pos = startp;
14800
14801 /* See if point is inside the scroll margin at the top of the
14802 window. */
14803 if (this_scroll_margin)
14804 {
14805 start_display (&it, w, startp);
14806 move_it_vertically (&it, this_scroll_margin);
14807 scroll_margin_pos = it.current.pos;
14808 }
14809
14810 if (PT < CHARPOS (scroll_margin_pos))
14811 {
14812 /* Point is in the scroll margin at the top of the window or
14813 above what is displayed in the window. */
14814 int y0, y_to_move;
14815
14816 /* Compute the vertical distance from PT to the scroll
14817 margin position. Move as far as scroll_max allows, or
14818 one screenful, or 10 screen lines, whichever is largest.
14819 Give up if distance is greater than scroll_max. */
14820 SET_TEXT_POS (pos, PT, PT_BYTE);
14821 start_display (&it, w, pos);
14822 y0 = it.current_y;
14823 y_to_move = max (it.last_visible_y,
14824 max (scroll_max, 10 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)));
14825 move_it_to (&it, CHARPOS (scroll_margin_pos), 0,
14826 y_to_move, -1,
14827 MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_X | MOVE_TO_Y);
14828 dy = it.current_y - y0;
14829 if (dy > scroll_max)
14830 return SCROLLING_FAILED;
14831
14832 /* Compute new window start. */
14833 start_display (&it, w, startp);
14834
14835 if (arg_scroll_conservatively)
14836 amount_to_scroll = max (dy, FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) *
14837 max (scroll_step, temp_scroll_step));
14838 else if (scroll_step || temp_scroll_step)
14839 amount_to_scroll = scroll_max;
14840 else
14841 {
14842 aggressive = BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_down_aggressively);
14843 height = WINDOW_BOX_TEXT_HEIGHT (w);
14844 if (NUMBERP (aggressive))
14845 {
14846 double float_amount = XFLOATINT (aggressive) * height;
14847 amount_to_scroll = float_amount;
14848 if (amount_to_scroll == 0 && float_amount > 0)
14849 amount_to_scroll = 1;
14850 amount_to_scroll -=
14851 this_scroll_margin - dy - FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
14852 /* Don't let point enter the scroll margin near
14853 bottom of the window. */
14854 if (amount_to_scroll > height - 2*this_scroll_margin + dy)
14855 amount_to_scroll = height - 2*this_scroll_margin + dy;
14856 }
14857 }
14858
14859 if (amount_to_scroll <= 0)
14860 return SCROLLING_FAILED;
14861
14862 move_it_vertically_backward (&it, amount_to_scroll);
14863 startp = it.current.pos;
14864 }
14865 }
14866
14867 /* Run window scroll functions. */
14868 startp = run_window_scroll_functions (window, startp);
14869
14870 /* Display the window. Give up if new fonts are loaded, or if point
14871 doesn't appear. */
14872 if (!try_window (window, startp, 0))
14873 rc = SCROLLING_NEED_LARGER_MATRICES;
14874 else if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
14875 {
14876 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
14877 rc = SCROLLING_FAILED;
14878 }
14879 else
14880 {
14881 /* Maybe forget recorded base line for line number display. */
14882 if (!just_this_one_p
14883 || current_buffer->clip_changed
14884 || BEG_UNCHANGED < CHARPOS (startp))
14885 wset_base_line_number (w, Qnil);
14886
14887 /* If cursor ends up on a partially visible line,
14888 treat that as being off the bottom of the screen. */
14889 if (! cursor_row_fully_visible_p (w, extra_scroll_margin_lines <= 1, 0)
14890 /* It's possible that the cursor is on the first line of the
14891 buffer, which is partially obscured due to a vscroll
14892 (Bug#7537). In that case, avoid looping forever . */
14893 && extra_scroll_margin_lines < w->desired_matrix->nrows - 1)
14894 {
14895 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
14896 ++extra_scroll_margin_lines;
14897 goto too_near_end;
14898 }
14899 rc = SCROLLING_SUCCESS;
14900 }
14901
14902 return rc;
14903 }
14904
14905
14906 /* Compute a suitable window start for window W if display of W starts
14907 on a continuation line. Value is non-zero if a new window start
14908 was computed.
14909
14910 The new window start will be computed, based on W's width, starting
14911 from the start of the continued line. It is the start of the
14912 screen line with the minimum distance from the old start W->start. */
14913
14914 static int
14915 compute_window_start_on_continuation_line (struct window *w)
14916 {
14917 struct text_pos pos, start_pos;
14918 int window_start_changed_p = 0;
14919
14920 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (start_pos, w->start);
14921
14922 /* If window start is on a continuation line... Window start may be
14923 < BEGV in case there's invisible text at the start of the
14924 buffer (M-x rmail, for example). */
14925 if (CHARPOS (start_pos) > BEGV
14926 && FETCH_BYTE (BYTEPOS (start_pos) - 1) != '\n')
14927 {
14928 struct it it;
14929 struct glyph_row *row;
14930
14931 /* Handle the case that the window start is out of range. */
14932 if (CHARPOS (start_pos) < BEGV)
14933 SET_TEXT_POS (start_pos, BEGV, BEGV_BYTE);
14934 else if (CHARPOS (start_pos) > ZV)
14935 SET_TEXT_POS (start_pos, ZV, ZV_BYTE);
14936
14937 /* Find the start of the continued line. This should be fast
14938 because scan_buffer is fast (newline cache). */
14939 row = w->desired_matrix->rows + (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w) ? 1 : 0);
14940 init_iterator (&it, w, CHARPOS (start_pos), BYTEPOS (start_pos),
14941 row, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
14942 reseat_at_previous_visible_line_start (&it);
14943
14944 /* If the line start is "too far" away from the window start,
14945 say it takes too much time to compute a new window start. */
14946 if (CHARPOS (start_pos) - IT_CHARPOS (it)
14947 < WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) * WINDOW_TOTAL_COLS (w))
14948 {
14949 int min_distance, distance;
14950
14951 /* Move forward by display lines to find the new window
14952 start. If window width was enlarged, the new start can
14953 be expected to be > the old start. If window width was
14954 decreased, the new window start will be < the old start.
14955 So, we're looking for the display line start with the
14956 minimum distance from the old window start. */
14957 pos = it.current.pos;
14958 min_distance = INFINITY;
14959 while ((distance = eabs (CHARPOS (start_pos) - IT_CHARPOS (it))),
14960 distance < min_distance)
14961 {
14962 min_distance = distance;
14963 pos = it.current.pos;
14964 move_it_by_lines (&it, 1);
14965 }
14966
14967 /* Set the window start there. */
14968 SET_MARKER_FROM_TEXT_POS (w->start, pos);
14969 window_start_changed_p = 1;
14970 }
14971 }
14972
14973 return window_start_changed_p;
14974 }
14975
14976
14977 /* Try cursor movement in case text has not changed in window WINDOW,
14978 with window start STARTP. Value is
14979
14980 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS if successful
14981
14982 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_CANNOT_BE_USED if this method cannot be used
14983
14984 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL if we know we have to scroll the
14985 display. *SCROLL_STEP is set to 1, under certain circumstances, if
14986 we want to scroll as if scroll-step were set to 1. See the code.
14987
14988 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_NEED_LARGER_MATRICES if we need larger matrices, in
14989 which case we have to abort this redisplay, and adjust matrices
14990 first. */
14991
14992 enum
14993 {
14994 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS,
14995 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_CANNOT_BE_USED,
14996 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL,
14997 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_NEED_LARGER_MATRICES
14998 };
14999
15000 static int
15001 try_cursor_movement (Lisp_Object window, struct text_pos startp, int *scroll_step)
15002 {
15003 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
15004 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
15005 int rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_CANNOT_BE_USED;
15006
15007 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
15008 if (inhibit_try_cursor_movement)
15009 return rc;
15010 #endif
15011
15012 /* Previously, there was a check for Lisp integer in the
15013 if-statement below. Now, this field is converted to
15014 ptrdiff_t, thus zero means invalid position in a buffer. */
15015 eassert (w->last_point > 0);
15016
15017 /* Handle case where text has not changed, only point, and it has
15018 not moved off the frame. */
15019 if (/* Point may be in this window. */
15020 PT >= CHARPOS (startp)
15021 /* Selective display hasn't changed. */
15022 && !current_buffer->clip_changed
15023 /* Function force-mode-line-update is used to force a thorough
15024 redisplay. It sets either windows_or_buffers_changed or
15025 update_mode_lines. So don't take a shortcut here for these
15026 cases. */
15027 && !update_mode_lines
15028 && !windows_or_buffers_changed
15029 && !cursor_type_changed
15030 /* Can't use this case if highlighting a region. When a
15031 region exists, cursor movement has to do more than just
15032 set the cursor. */
15033 && !(!NILP (Vtransient_mark_mode)
15034 && !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, mark_active)))
15035 && NILP (w->region_showing)
15036 && NILP (Vshow_trailing_whitespace)
15037 /* This code is not used for mini-buffer for the sake of the case
15038 of redisplaying to replace an echo area message; since in
15039 that case the mini-buffer contents per se are usually
15040 unchanged. This code is of no real use in the mini-buffer
15041 since the handling of this_line_start_pos, etc., in redisplay
15042 handles the same cases. */
15043 && !EQ (window, minibuf_window)
15044 /* When splitting windows or for new windows, it happens that
15045 redisplay is called with a nil window_end_vpos or one being
15046 larger than the window. This should really be fixed in
15047 window.c. I don't have this on my list, now, so we do
15048 approximately the same as the old redisplay code. --gerd. */
15049 && INTEGERP (w->window_end_vpos)
15050 && XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos) < w->current_matrix->nrows
15051 && (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
15052 || !overlay_arrow_in_current_buffer_p ()))
15053 {
15054 int this_scroll_margin, top_scroll_margin;
15055 struct glyph_row *row = NULL;
15056
15057 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
15058 debug_method_add (w, "cursor movement");
15059 #endif
15060
15061 /* Scroll if point within this distance from the top or bottom
15062 of the window. This is a pixel value. */
15063 if (scroll_margin > 0)
15064 {
15065 this_scroll_margin = min (scroll_margin, WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) / 4);
15066 this_scroll_margin *= FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
15067 }
15068 else
15069 this_scroll_margin = 0;
15070
15071 top_scroll_margin = this_scroll_margin;
15072 if (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w))
15073 top_scroll_margin += CURRENT_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
15074
15075 /* Start with the row the cursor was displayed during the last
15076 not paused redisplay. Give up if that row is not valid. */
15077 if (w->last_cursor.vpos < 0
15078 || w->last_cursor.vpos >= w->current_matrix->nrows)
15079 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
15080 else
15081 {
15082 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->last_cursor.vpos);
15083 if (row->mode_line_p)
15084 ++row;
15085 if (!row->enabled_p)
15086 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
15087 }
15088
15089 if (rc == CURSOR_MOVEMENT_CANNOT_BE_USED)
15090 {
15091 int scroll_p = 0, must_scroll = 0;
15092 int last_y = window_text_bottom_y (w) - this_scroll_margin;
15093
15094 if (PT > w->last_point)
15095 {
15096 /* Point has moved forward. */
15097 while (MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) < PT
15098 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < last_y)
15099 {
15100 eassert (row->enabled_p);
15101 ++row;
15102 }
15103
15104 /* If the end position of a row equals the start
15105 position of the next row, and PT is at that position,
15106 we would rather display cursor in the next line. */
15107 while (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < last_y
15108 && MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) == PT
15109 && row < w->current_matrix->rows
15110 + w->current_matrix->nrows - 1
15111 && MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row+1) == PT
15112 && !cursor_row_p (row))
15113 ++row;
15114
15115 /* If within the scroll margin, scroll. Note that
15116 MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y gives the pixel position at which
15117 the next line would be drawn, and that
15118 this_scroll_margin can be zero. */
15119 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) > last_y
15120 || PT > MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
15121 /* Line is completely visible last line in window
15122 and PT is to be set in the next line. */
15123 || (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) == last_y
15124 && PT == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
15125 && !row->ends_at_zv_p
15126 && !MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (row)))
15127 scroll_p = 1;
15128 }
15129 else if (PT < w->last_point)
15130 {
15131 /* Cursor has to be moved backward. Note that PT >=
15132 CHARPOS (startp) because of the outer if-statement. */
15133 while (!row->mode_line_p
15134 && (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) > PT
15135 || (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) == PT
15136 && (MATRIX_ROW_STARTS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (row)
15137 || (/* STARTS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_STRING_P (row) */
15138 row > w->current_matrix->rows
15139 && (row-1)->ends_in_newline_from_string_p))))
15140 && (row->y > top_scroll_margin
15141 || CHARPOS (startp) == BEGV))
15142 {
15143 eassert (row->enabled_p);
15144 --row;
15145 }
15146
15147 /* Consider the following case: Window starts at BEGV,
15148 there is invisible, intangible text at BEGV, so that
15149 display starts at some point START > BEGV. It can
15150 happen that we are called with PT somewhere between
15151 BEGV and START. Try to handle that case. */
15152 if (row < w->current_matrix->rows
15153 || row->mode_line_p)
15154 {
15155 row = w->current_matrix->rows;
15156 if (row->mode_line_p)
15157 ++row;
15158 }
15159
15160 /* Due to newlines in overlay strings, we may have to
15161 skip forward over overlay strings. */
15162 while (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < last_y
15163 && MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) == PT
15164 && !cursor_row_p (row))
15165 ++row;
15166
15167 /* If within the scroll margin, scroll. */
15168 if (row->y < top_scroll_margin
15169 && CHARPOS (startp) != BEGV)
15170 scroll_p = 1;
15171 }
15172 else
15173 {
15174 /* Cursor did not move. So don't scroll even if cursor line
15175 is partially visible, as it was so before. */
15176 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS;
15177 }
15178
15179 if (PT < MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row)
15180 || PT > MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row))
15181 {
15182 /* if PT is not in the glyph row, give up. */
15183 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
15184 must_scroll = 1;
15185 }
15186 else if (rc != CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS
15187 && !NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), bidi_display_reordering)))
15188 {
15189 struct glyph_row *row1;
15190
15191 /* If rows are bidi-reordered and point moved, back up
15192 until we find a row that does not belong to a
15193 continuation line. This is because we must consider
15194 all rows of a continued line as candidates for the
15195 new cursor positioning, since row start and end
15196 positions change non-linearly with vertical position
15197 in such rows. */
15198 /* FIXME: Revisit this when glyph ``spilling'' in
15199 continuation lines' rows is implemented for
15200 bidi-reordered rows. */
15201 for (row1 = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
15202 MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (row);
15203 --row)
15204 {
15205 /* If we hit the beginning of the displayed portion
15206 without finding the first row of a continued
15207 line, give up. */
15208 if (row <= row1)
15209 {
15210 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
15211 break;
15212 }
15213 eassert (row->enabled_p);
15214 }
15215 }
15216 if (must_scroll)
15217 ;
15218 else if (rc != CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS
15219 && MATRIX_ROW_PARTIALLY_VISIBLE_P (w, row)
15220 /* Make sure this isn't a header line by any chance, since
15221 then MATRIX_ROW_PARTIALLY_VISIBLE_P might yield non-zero. */
15222 && !row->mode_line_p
15223 && make_cursor_line_fully_visible_p)
15224 {
15225 if (PT == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
15226 && !row->ends_at_zv_p
15227 && !MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (row))
15228 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
15229 else if (row->height > window_box_height (w))
15230 {
15231 /* If we end up in a partially visible line, let's
15232 make it fully visible, except when it's taller
15233 than the window, in which case we can't do much
15234 about it. */
15235 *scroll_step = 1;
15236 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
15237 }
15238 else
15239 {
15240 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
15241 if (!cursor_row_fully_visible_p (w, 0, 1))
15242 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
15243 else
15244 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS;
15245 }
15246 }
15247 else if (scroll_p)
15248 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
15249 else if (rc != CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS
15250 && !NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), bidi_display_reordering)))
15251 {
15252 /* With bidi-reordered rows, there could be more than
15253 one candidate row whose start and end positions
15254 occlude point. We need to let set_cursor_from_row
15255 find the best candidate. */
15256 /* FIXME: Revisit this when glyph ``spilling'' in
15257 continuation lines' rows is implemented for
15258 bidi-reordered rows. */
15259 int rv = 0;
15260
15261 do
15262 {
15263 int at_zv_p = 0, exact_match_p = 0;
15264
15265 if (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) <= PT
15266 && PT <= MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
15267 && cursor_row_p (row))
15268 rv |= set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix,
15269 0, 0, 0, 0);
15270 /* As soon as we've found the exact match for point,
15271 or the first suitable row whose ends_at_zv_p flag
15272 is set, we are done. */
15273 at_zv_p =
15274 MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->cursor.vpos)->ends_at_zv_p;
15275 if (rv && !at_zv_p
15276 && w->cursor.hpos >= 0
15277 && w->cursor.hpos < MATRIX_ROW_USED (w->current_matrix,
15278 w->cursor.vpos))
15279 {
15280 struct glyph_row *candidate =
15281 MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->cursor.vpos);
15282 struct glyph *g =
15283 candidate->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + w->cursor.hpos;
15284 ptrdiff_t endpos = MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (candidate);
15285
15286 exact_match_p =
15287 (BUFFERP (g->object) && g->charpos == PT)
15288 || (INTEGERP (g->object)
15289 && (g->charpos == PT
15290 || (g->charpos == 0 && endpos - 1 == PT)));
15291 }
15292 if (rv && (at_zv_p || exact_match_p))
15293 {
15294 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS;
15295 break;
15296 }
15297 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) == last_y)
15298 break;
15299 ++row;
15300 }
15301 while (((MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (row)
15302 || row->continued_p)
15303 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) <= last_y)
15304 || (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) == PT
15305 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < last_y));
15306 /* If we didn't find any candidate rows, or exited the
15307 loop before all the candidates were examined, signal
15308 to the caller that this method failed. */
15309 if (rc != CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS
15310 && !(rv
15311 && !MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (row)
15312 && !row->continued_p))
15313 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
15314 else if (rv)
15315 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS;
15316 }
15317 else
15318 {
15319 do
15320 {
15321 if (set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0))
15322 {
15323 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS;
15324 break;
15325 }
15326 ++row;
15327 }
15328 while (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < last_y
15329 && MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) == PT
15330 && cursor_row_p (row));
15331 }
15332 }
15333 }
15334
15335 return rc;
15336 }
15337
15338 #if !defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS || defined USE_GTK
15339 static
15340 #endif
15341 void
15342 set_vertical_scroll_bar (struct window *w)
15343 {
15344 ptrdiff_t start, end, whole;
15345
15346 /* Calculate the start and end positions for the current window.
15347 At some point, it would be nice to choose between scrollbars
15348 which reflect the whole buffer size, with special markers
15349 indicating narrowing, and scrollbars which reflect only the
15350 visible region.
15351
15352 Note that mini-buffers sometimes aren't displaying any text. */
15353 if (!MINI_WINDOW_P (w)
15354 || (w == XWINDOW (minibuf_window)
15355 && NILP (echo_area_buffer[0])))
15356 {
15357 struct buffer *buf = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
15358 whole = BUF_ZV (buf) - BUF_BEGV (buf);
15359 start = marker_position (w->start) - BUF_BEGV (buf);
15360 /* I don't think this is guaranteed to be right. For the
15361 moment, we'll pretend it is. */
15362 end = BUF_Z (buf) - XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos) - BUF_BEGV (buf);
15363
15364 if (end < start)
15365 end = start;
15366 if (whole < (end - start))
15367 whole = end - start;
15368 }
15369 else
15370 start = end = whole = 0;
15371
15372 /* Indicate what this scroll bar ought to be displaying now. */
15373 if (FRAME_TERMINAL (XFRAME (w->frame))->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook)
15374 (*FRAME_TERMINAL (XFRAME (w->frame))->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook)
15375 (w, end - start, whole, start);
15376 }
15377
15378
15379 /* Redisplay leaf window WINDOW. JUST_THIS_ONE_P non-zero means only
15380 selected_window is redisplayed.
15381
15382 We can return without actually redisplaying the window if
15383 fonts_changed_p is nonzero. In that case, redisplay_internal will
15384 retry. */
15385
15386 static void
15387 redisplay_window (Lisp_Object window, int just_this_one_p)
15388 {
15389 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
15390 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
15391 struct buffer *buffer = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
15392 struct buffer *old = current_buffer;
15393 struct text_pos lpoint, opoint, startp;
15394 int update_mode_line;
15395 int tem;
15396 struct it it;
15397 /* Record it now because it's overwritten. */
15398 int current_matrix_up_to_date_p = 0;
15399 int used_current_matrix_p = 0;
15400 /* This is less strict than current_matrix_up_to_date_p.
15401 It indicates that the buffer contents and narrowing are unchanged. */
15402 int buffer_unchanged_p = 0;
15403 int temp_scroll_step = 0;
15404 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
15405 int rc;
15406 int centering_position = -1;
15407 int last_line_misfit = 0;
15408 ptrdiff_t beg_unchanged, end_unchanged;
15409
15410 SET_TEXT_POS (lpoint, PT, PT_BYTE);
15411 opoint = lpoint;
15412
15413 /* W must be a leaf window here. */
15414 eassert (!NILP (w->buffer));
15415 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
15416 *w->desired_matrix->method = 0;
15417 #endif
15418
15419 restart:
15420 reconsider_clip_changes (w, buffer);
15421
15422 /* Has the mode line to be updated? */
15423 update_mode_line = (w->update_mode_line
15424 || update_mode_lines
15425 || buffer->clip_changed
15426 || buffer->prevent_redisplay_optimizations_p);
15427
15428 if (MINI_WINDOW_P (w))
15429 {
15430 if (w == XWINDOW (echo_area_window)
15431 && !NILP (echo_area_buffer[0]))
15432 {
15433 if (update_mode_line)
15434 /* We may have to update a tty frame's menu bar or a
15435 tool-bar. Example `M-x C-h C-h C-g'. */
15436 goto finish_menu_bars;
15437 else
15438 /* We've already displayed the echo area glyphs in this window. */
15439 goto finish_scroll_bars;
15440 }
15441 else if ((w != XWINDOW (minibuf_window)
15442 || minibuf_level == 0)
15443 /* When buffer is nonempty, redisplay window normally. */
15444 && BUF_Z (XBUFFER (w->buffer)) == BUF_BEG (XBUFFER (w->buffer))
15445 /* Quail displays non-mini buffers in minibuffer window.
15446 In that case, redisplay the window normally. */
15447 && !NILP (Fmemq (w->buffer, Vminibuffer_list)))
15448 {
15449 /* W is a mini-buffer window, but it's not active, so clear
15450 it. */
15451 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w);
15452 struct glyph_row *row;
15453 int y;
15454
15455 for (y = 0, row = w->desired_matrix->rows;
15456 y < yb;
15457 y += row->height, ++row)
15458 blank_row (w, row, y);
15459 goto finish_scroll_bars;
15460 }
15461
15462 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
15463 }
15464
15465 /* Otherwise set up data on this window; select its buffer and point
15466 value. */
15467 /* Really select the buffer, for the sake of buffer-local
15468 variables. */
15469 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (w->buffer));
15470
15471 current_matrix_up_to_date_p
15472 = (!NILP (w->window_end_valid)
15473 && !current_buffer->clip_changed
15474 && !current_buffer->prevent_redisplay_optimizations_p
15475 && w->last_modified >= MODIFF
15476 && w->last_overlay_modified >= OVERLAY_MODIFF);
15477
15478 /* Run the window-bottom-change-functions
15479 if it is possible that the text on the screen has changed
15480 (either due to modification of the text, or any other reason). */
15481 if (!current_matrix_up_to_date_p
15482 && !NILP (Vwindow_text_change_functions))
15483 {
15484 safe_run_hooks (Qwindow_text_change_functions);
15485 goto restart;
15486 }
15487
15488 beg_unchanged = BEG_UNCHANGED;
15489 end_unchanged = END_UNCHANGED;
15490
15491 SET_TEXT_POS (opoint, PT, PT_BYTE);
15492
15493 specbind (Qinhibit_point_motion_hooks, Qt);
15494
15495 buffer_unchanged_p
15496 = (!NILP (w->window_end_valid)
15497 && !current_buffer->clip_changed
15498 && w->last_modified >= MODIFF
15499 && w->last_overlay_modified >= OVERLAY_MODIFF);
15500
15501 /* When windows_or_buffers_changed is non-zero, we can't rely on
15502 the window end being valid, so set it to nil there. */
15503 if (windows_or_buffers_changed)
15504 {
15505 /* If window starts on a continuation line, maybe adjust the
15506 window start in case the window's width changed. */
15507 if (XMARKER (w->start)->buffer == current_buffer)
15508 compute_window_start_on_continuation_line (w);
15509
15510 wset_window_end_valid (w, Qnil);
15511 }
15512
15513 /* Some sanity checks. */
15514 CHECK_WINDOW_END (w);
15515 if (Z == Z_BYTE && CHARPOS (opoint) != BYTEPOS (opoint))
15516 abort ();
15517 if (BYTEPOS (opoint) < CHARPOS (opoint))
15518 abort ();
15519
15520 /* If %c is in mode line, update it if needed. */
15521 if (!NILP (w->column_number_displayed)
15522 /* This alternative quickly identifies a common case
15523 where no change is needed. */
15524 && !(PT == w->last_point
15525 && w->last_modified >= MODIFF
15526 && w->last_overlay_modified >= OVERLAY_MODIFF)
15527 && (XFASTINT (w->column_number_displayed) != current_column ()))
15528 update_mode_line = 1;
15529
15530 /* Count number of windows showing the selected buffer. An indirect
15531 buffer counts as its base buffer. */
15532 if (!just_this_one_p)
15533 {
15534 struct buffer *current_base, *window_base;
15535 current_base = current_buffer;
15536 window_base = XBUFFER (XWINDOW (selected_window)->buffer);
15537 if (current_base->base_buffer)
15538 current_base = current_base->base_buffer;
15539 if (window_base->base_buffer)
15540 window_base = window_base->base_buffer;
15541 if (current_base == window_base)
15542 buffer_shared++;
15543 }
15544
15545 /* Point refers normally to the selected window. For any other
15546 window, set up appropriate value. */
15547 if (!EQ (window, selected_window))
15548 {
15549 ptrdiff_t new_pt = XMARKER (w->pointm)->charpos;
15550 ptrdiff_t new_pt_byte = marker_byte_position (w->pointm);
15551 if (new_pt < BEGV)
15552 {
15553 new_pt = BEGV;
15554 new_pt_byte = BEGV_BYTE;
15555 set_marker_both (w->pointm, Qnil, BEGV, BEGV_BYTE);
15556 }
15557 else if (new_pt > (ZV - 1))
15558 {
15559 new_pt = ZV;
15560 new_pt_byte = ZV_BYTE;
15561 set_marker_both (w->pointm, Qnil, ZV, ZV_BYTE);
15562 }
15563
15564 /* We don't use SET_PT so that the point-motion hooks don't run. */
15565 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (new_pt, new_pt_byte);
15566 }
15567
15568 /* If any of the character widths specified in the display table
15569 have changed, invalidate the width run cache. It's true that
15570 this may be a bit late to catch such changes, but the rest of
15571 redisplay goes (non-fatally) haywire when the display table is
15572 changed, so why should we worry about doing any better? */
15573 if (current_buffer->width_run_cache)
15574 {
15575 struct Lisp_Char_Table *disptab = buffer_display_table ();
15576
15577 if (! disptab_matches_widthtab
15578 (disptab, XVECTOR (BVAR (current_buffer, width_table))))
15579 {
15580 invalidate_region_cache (current_buffer,
15581 current_buffer->width_run_cache,
15582 BEG, Z);
15583 recompute_width_table (current_buffer, disptab);
15584 }
15585 }
15586
15587 /* If window-start is screwed up, choose a new one. */
15588 if (XMARKER (w->start)->buffer != current_buffer)
15589 goto recenter;
15590
15591 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (startp, w->start);
15592
15593 /* If someone specified a new starting point but did not insist,
15594 check whether it can be used. */
15595 if (w->optional_new_start
15596 && CHARPOS (startp) >= BEGV
15597 && CHARPOS (startp) <= ZV)
15598 {
15599 w->optional_new_start = 0;
15600 start_display (&it, w, startp);
15601 move_it_to (&it, PT, 0, it.last_visible_y, -1,
15602 MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_X | MOVE_TO_Y);
15603 if (IT_CHARPOS (it) == PT)
15604 w->force_start = 1;
15605 /* IT may overshoot PT if text at PT is invisible. */
15606 else if (IT_CHARPOS (it) > PT && CHARPOS (startp) <= PT)
15607 w->force_start = 1;
15608 }
15609
15610 force_start:
15611
15612 /* Handle case where place to start displaying has been specified,
15613 unless the specified location is outside the accessible range. */
15614 if (w->force_start || w->frozen_window_start_p)
15615 {
15616 /* We set this later on if we have to adjust point. */
15617 int new_vpos = -1;
15618
15619 w->force_start = 0;
15620 w->vscroll = 0;
15621 wset_window_end_valid (w, Qnil);
15622
15623 /* Forget any recorded base line for line number display. */
15624 if (!buffer_unchanged_p)
15625 wset_base_line_number (w, Qnil);
15626
15627 /* Redisplay the mode line. Select the buffer properly for that.
15628 Also, run the hook window-scroll-functions
15629 because we have scrolled. */
15630 /* Note, we do this after clearing force_start because
15631 if there's an error, it is better to forget about force_start
15632 than to get into an infinite loop calling the hook functions
15633 and having them get more errors. */
15634 if (!update_mode_line
15635 || ! NILP (Vwindow_scroll_functions))
15636 {
15637 update_mode_line = 1;
15638 w->update_mode_line = 1;
15639 startp = run_window_scroll_functions (window, startp);
15640 }
15641
15642 w->last_modified = 0;
15643 w->last_overlay_modified = 0;
15644 if (CHARPOS (startp) < BEGV)
15645 SET_TEXT_POS (startp, BEGV, BEGV_BYTE);
15646 else if (CHARPOS (startp) > ZV)
15647 SET_TEXT_POS (startp, ZV, ZV_BYTE);
15648
15649 /* Redisplay, then check if cursor has been set during the
15650 redisplay. Give up if new fonts were loaded. */
15651 /* We used to issue a CHECK_MARGINS argument to try_window here,
15652 but this causes scrolling to fail when point begins inside
15653 the scroll margin (bug#148) -- cyd */
15654 if (!try_window (window, startp, 0))
15655 {
15656 w->force_start = 1;
15657 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
15658 goto need_larger_matrices;
15659 }
15660
15661 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0 && !w->frozen_window_start_p)
15662 {
15663 /* If point does not appear, try to move point so it does
15664 appear. The desired matrix has been built above, so we
15665 can use it here. */
15666 new_vpos = window_box_height (w) / 2;
15667 }
15668
15669 if (!cursor_row_fully_visible_p (w, 0, 0))
15670 {
15671 /* Point does appear, but on a line partly visible at end of window.
15672 Move it back to a fully-visible line. */
15673 new_vpos = window_box_height (w);
15674 }
15675
15676 /* If we need to move point for either of the above reasons,
15677 now actually do it. */
15678 if (new_vpos >= 0)
15679 {
15680 struct glyph_row *row;
15681
15682 row = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->desired_matrix);
15683 while (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < new_vpos)
15684 ++row;
15685
15686 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row),
15687 MATRIX_ROW_START_BYTEPOS (row));
15688
15689 if (w != XWINDOW (selected_window))
15690 set_marker_both (w->pointm, Qnil, PT, PT_BYTE);
15691 else if (current_buffer == old)
15692 SET_TEXT_POS (lpoint, PT, PT_BYTE);
15693
15694 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->desired_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
15695
15696 /* If we are highlighting the region, then we just changed
15697 the region, so redisplay to show it. */
15698 if (!NILP (Vtransient_mark_mode)
15699 && !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, mark_active)))
15700 {
15701 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
15702 if (!try_window (window, startp, 0))
15703 goto need_larger_matrices;
15704 }
15705 }
15706
15707 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
15708 debug_method_add (w, "forced window start");
15709 #endif
15710 goto done;
15711 }
15712
15713 /* Handle case where text has not changed, only point, and it has
15714 not moved off the frame, and we are not retrying after hscroll.
15715 (current_matrix_up_to_date_p is nonzero when retrying.) */
15716 if (current_matrix_up_to_date_p
15717 && (rc = try_cursor_movement (window, startp, &temp_scroll_step),
15718 rc != CURSOR_MOVEMENT_CANNOT_BE_USED))
15719 {
15720 switch (rc)
15721 {
15722 case CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS:
15723 used_current_matrix_p = 1;
15724 goto done;
15725
15726 case CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL:
15727 goto try_to_scroll;
15728
15729 default:
15730 abort ();
15731 }
15732 }
15733 /* If current starting point was originally the beginning of a line
15734 but no longer is, find a new starting point. */
15735 else if (w->start_at_line_beg
15736 && !(CHARPOS (startp) <= BEGV
15737 || FETCH_BYTE (BYTEPOS (startp) - 1) == '\n'))
15738 {
15739 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
15740 debug_method_add (w, "recenter 1");
15741 #endif
15742 goto recenter;
15743 }
15744
15745 /* Try scrolling with try_window_id. Value is > 0 if update has
15746 been done, it is -1 if we know that the same window start will
15747 not work. It is 0 if unsuccessful for some other reason. */
15748 else if ((tem = try_window_id (w)) != 0)
15749 {
15750 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
15751 debug_method_add (w, "try_window_id %d", tem);
15752 #endif
15753
15754 if (fonts_changed_p)
15755 goto need_larger_matrices;
15756 if (tem > 0)
15757 goto done;
15758
15759 /* Otherwise try_window_id has returned -1 which means that we
15760 don't want the alternative below this comment to execute. */
15761 }
15762 else if (CHARPOS (startp) >= BEGV
15763 && CHARPOS (startp) <= ZV
15764 && PT >= CHARPOS (startp)
15765 && (CHARPOS (startp) < ZV
15766 /* Avoid starting at end of buffer. */
15767 || CHARPOS (startp) == BEGV
15768 || (w->last_modified >= MODIFF
15769 && w->last_overlay_modified >= OVERLAY_MODIFF)))
15770 {
15771 int d1, d2, d3, d4, d5, d6;
15772
15773 /* If first window line is a continuation line, and window start
15774 is inside the modified region, but the first change is before
15775 current window start, we must select a new window start.
15776
15777 However, if this is the result of a down-mouse event (e.g. by
15778 extending the mouse-drag-overlay), we don't want to select a
15779 new window start, since that would change the position under
15780 the mouse, resulting in an unwanted mouse-movement rather
15781 than a simple mouse-click. */
15782 if (!w->start_at_line_beg
15783 && NILP (do_mouse_tracking)
15784 && CHARPOS (startp) > BEGV
15785 && CHARPOS (startp) > BEG + beg_unchanged
15786 && CHARPOS (startp) <= Z - end_unchanged
15787 /* Even if w->start_at_line_beg is nil, a new window may
15788 start at a line_beg, since that's how set_buffer_window
15789 sets it. So, we need to check the return value of
15790 compute_window_start_on_continuation_line. (See also
15791 bug#197). */
15792 && XMARKER (w->start)->buffer == current_buffer
15793 && compute_window_start_on_continuation_line (w)
15794 /* It doesn't make sense to force the window start like we
15795 do at label force_start if it is already known that point
15796 will not be visible in the resulting window, because
15797 doing so will move point from its correct position
15798 instead of scrolling the window to bring point into view.
15799 See bug#9324. */
15800 && pos_visible_p (w, PT, &d1, &d2, &d3, &d4, &d5, &d6))
15801 {
15802 w->force_start = 1;
15803 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (startp, w->start);
15804 goto force_start;
15805 }
15806
15807 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
15808 debug_method_add (w, "same window start");
15809 #endif
15810
15811 /* Try to redisplay starting at same place as before.
15812 If point has not moved off frame, accept the results. */
15813 if (!current_matrix_up_to_date_p
15814 /* Don't use try_window_reusing_current_matrix in this case
15815 because a window scroll function can have changed the
15816 buffer. */
15817 || !NILP (Vwindow_scroll_functions)
15818 || MINI_WINDOW_P (w)
15819 || !(used_current_matrix_p
15820 = try_window_reusing_current_matrix (w)))
15821 {
15822 IF_DEBUG (debug_method_add (w, "1"));
15823 if (try_window (window, startp, TRY_WINDOW_CHECK_MARGINS) < 0)
15824 /* -1 means we need to scroll.
15825 0 means we need new matrices, but fonts_changed_p
15826 is set in that case, so we will detect it below. */
15827 goto try_to_scroll;
15828 }
15829
15830 if (fonts_changed_p)
15831 goto need_larger_matrices;
15832
15833 if (w->cursor.vpos >= 0)
15834 {
15835 if (!just_this_one_p
15836 || current_buffer->clip_changed
15837 || BEG_UNCHANGED < CHARPOS (startp))
15838 /* Forget any recorded base line for line number display. */
15839 wset_base_line_number (w, Qnil);
15840
15841 if (!cursor_row_fully_visible_p (w, 1, 0))
15842 {
15843 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
15844 last_line_misfit = 1;
15845 }
15846 /* Drop through and scroll. */
15847 else
15848 goto done;
15849 }
15850 else
15851 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
15852 }
15853
15854 try_to_scroll:
15855
15856 w->last_modified = 0;
15857 w->last_overlay_modified = 0;
15858
15859 /* Redisplay the mode line. Select the buffer properly for that. */
15860 if (!update_mode_line)
15861 {
15862 update_mode_line = 1;
15863 w->update_mode_line = 1;
15864 }
15865
15866 /* Try to scroll by specified few lines. */
15867 if ((scroll_conservatively
15868 || emacs_scroll_step
15869 || temp_scroll_step
15870 || NUMBERP (BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_up_aggressively))
15871 || NUMBERP (BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_down_aggressively)))
15872 && CHARPOS (startp) >= BEGV
15873 && CHARPOS (startp) <= ZV)
15874 {
15875 /* The function returns -1 if new fonts were loaded, 1 if
15876 successful, 0 if not successful. */
15877 int ss = try_scrolling (window, just_this_one_p,
15878 scroll_conservatively,
15879 emacs_scroll_step,
15880 temp_scroll_step, last_line_misfit);
15881 switch (ss)
15882 {
15883 case SCROLLING_SUCCESS:
15884 goto done;
15885
15886 case SCROLLING_NEED_LARGER_MATRICES:
15887 goto need_larger_matrices;
15888
15889 case SCROLLING_FAILED:
15890 break;
15891
15892 default:
15893 abort ();
15894 }
15895 }
15896
15897 /* Finally, just choose a place to start which positions point
15898 according to user preferences. */
15899
15900 recenter:
15901
15902 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
15903 debug_method_add (w, "recenter");
15904 #endif
15905
15906 /* w->vscroll = 0; */
15907
15908 /* Forget any previously recorded base line for line number display. */
15909 if (!buffer_unchanged_p)
15910 wset_base_line_number (w, Qnil);
15911
15912 /* Determine the window start relative to point. */
15913 init_iterator (&it, w, PT, PT_BYTE, NULL, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
15914 it.current_y = it.last_visible_y;
15915 if (centering_position < 0)
15916 {
15917 int margin =
15918 scroll_margin > 0
15919 ? min (scroll_margin, WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) / 4)
15920 : 0;
15921 ptrdiff_t margin_pos = CHARPOS (startp);
15922 Lisp_Object aggressive;
15923 int scrolling_up;
15924
15925 /* If there is a scroll margin at the top of the window, find
15926 its character position. */
15927 if (margin
15928 /* Cannot call start_display if startp is not in the
15929 accessible region of the buffer. This can happen when we
15930 have just switched to a different buffer and/or changed
15931 its restriction. In that case, startp is initialized to
15932 the character position 1 (BEGV) because we did not yet
15933 have chance to display the buffer even once. */
15934 && BEGV <= CHARPOS (startp) && CHARPOS (startp) <= ZV)
15935 {
15936 struct it it1;
15937 void *it1data = NULL;
15938
15939 SAVE_IT (it1, it, it1data);
15940 start_display (&it1, w, startp);
15941 move_it_vertically (&it1, margin * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f));
15942 margin_pos = IT_CHARPOS (it1);
15943 RESTORE_IT (&it, &it, it1data);
15944 }
15945 scrolling_up = PT > margin_pos;
15946 aggressive =
15947 scrolling_up
15948 ? BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_up_aggressively)
15949 : BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_down_aggressively);
15950
15951 if (!MINI_WINDOW_P (w)
15952 && (scroll_conservatively > SCROLL_LIMIT || NUMBERP (aggressive)))
15953 {
15954 int pt_offset = 0;
15955
15956 /* Setting scroll-conservatively overrides
15957 scroll-*-aggressively. */
15958 if (!scroll_conservatively && NUMBERP (aggressive))
15959 {
15960 double float_amount = XFLOATINT (aggressive);
15961
15962 pt_offset = float_amount * WINDOW_BOX_TEXT_HEIGHT (w);
15963 if (pt_offset == 0 && float_amount > 0)
15964 pt_offset = 1;
15965 if (pt_offset && margin > 0)
15966 margin -= 1;
15967 }
15968 /* Compute how much to move the window start backward from
15969 point so that point will be displayed where the user
15970 wants it. */
15971 if (scrolling_up)
15972 {
15973 centering_position = it.last_visible_y;
15974 if (pt_offset)
15975 centering_position -= pt_offset;
15976 centering_position -=
15977 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) * (1 + margin + (last_line_misfit != 0))
15978 + WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
15979 /* Don't let point enter the scroll margin near top of
15980 the window. */
15981 if (centering_position < margin * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
15982 centering_position = margin * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
15983 }
15984 else
15985 centering_position = margin * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) + pt_offset;
15986 }
15987 else
15988 /* Set the window start half the height of the window backward
15989 from point. */
15990 centering_position = window_box_height (w) / 2;
15991 }
15992 move_it_vertically_backward (&it, centering_position);
15993
15994 eassert (IT_CHARPOS (it) >= BEGV);
15995
15996 /* The function move_it_vertically_backward may move over more
15997 than the specified y-distance. If it->w is small, e.g. a
15998 mini-buffer window, we may end up in front of the window's
15999 display area. Start displaying at the start of the line
16000 containing PT in this case. */
16001 if (it.current_y <= 0)
16002 {
16003 init_iterator (&it, w, PT, PT_BYTE, NULL, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
16004 move_it_vertically_backward (&it, 0);
16005 it.current_y = 0;
16006 }
16007
16008 it.current_x = it.hpos = 0;
16009
16010 /* Set the window start position here explicitly, to avoid an
16011 infinite loop in case the functions in window-scroll-functions
16012 get errors. */
16013 set_marker_both (w->start, Qnil, IT_CHARPOS (it), IT_BYTEPOS (it));
16014
16015 /* Run scroll hooks. */
16016 startp = run_window_scroll_functions (window, it.current.pos);
16017
16018 /* Redisplay the window. */
16019 if (!current_matrix_up_to_date_p
16020 || windows_or_buffers_changed
16021 || cursor_type_changed
16022 /* Don't use try_window_reusing_current_matrix in this case
16023 because it can have changed the buffer. */
16024 || !NILP (Vwindow_scroll_functions)
16025 || !just_this_one_p
16026 || MINI_WINDOW_P (w)
16027 || !(used_current_matrix_p
16028 = try_window_reusing_current_matrix (w)))
16029 try_window (window, startp, 0);
16030
16031 /* If new fonts have been loaded (due to fontsets), give up. We
16032 have to start a new redisplay since we need to re-adjust glyph
16033 matrices. */
16034 if (fonts_changed_p)
16035 goto need_larger_matrices;
16036
16037 /* If cursor did not appear assume that the middle of the window is
16038 in the first line of the window. Do it again with the next line.
16039 (Imagine a window of height 100, displaying two lines of height
16040 60. Moving back 50 from it->last_visible_y will end in the first
16041 line.) */
16042 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
16043 {
16044 if (!NILP (w->window_end_valid)
16045 && PT >= Z - XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos))
16046 {
16047 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16048 move_it_by_lines (&it, 1);
16049 try_window (window, it.current.pos, 0);
16050 }
16051 else if (PT < IT_CHARPOS (it))
16052 {
16053 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16054 move_it_by_lines (&it, -1);
16055 try_window (window, it.current.pos, 0);
16056 }
16057 else
16058 {
16059 /* Not much we can do about it. */
16060 }
16061 }
16062
16063 /* Consider the following case: Window starts at BEGV, there is
16064 invisible, intangible text at BEGV, so that display starts at
16065 some point START > BEGV. It can happen that we are called with
16066 PT somewhere between BEGV and START. Try to handle that case. */
16067 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
16068 {
16069 struct glyph_row *row = w->current_matrix->rows;
16070 if (row->mode_line_p)
16071 ++row;
16072 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
16073 }
16074
16075 if (!cursor_row_fully_visible_p (w, 0, 0))
16076 {
16077 /* If vscroll is enabled, disable it and try again. */
16078 if (w->vscroll)
16079 {
16080 w->vscroll = 0;
16081 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16082 goto recenter;
16083 }
16084
16085 /* Users who set scroll-conservatively to a large number want
16086 point just above/below the scroll margin. If we ended up
16087 with point's row partially visible, move the window start to
16088 make that row fully visible and out of the margin. */
16089 if (scroll_conservatively > SCROLL_LIMIT)
16090 {
16091 int margin =
16092 scroll_margin > 0
16093 ? min (scroll_margin, WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) / 4)
16094 : 0;
16095 int move_down = w->cursor.vpos >= WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) / 2;
16096
16097 move_it_by_lines (&it, move_down ? margin + 1 : -(margin + 1));
16098 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16099 if (1 == try_window (window, it.current.pos,
16100 TRY_WINDOW_CHECK_MARGINS))
16101 goto done;
16102 }
16103
16104 /* If centering point failed to make the whole line visible,
16105 put point at the top instead. That has to make the whole line
16106 visible, if it can be done. */
16107 if (centering_position == 0)
16108 goto done;
16109
16110 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16111 centering_position = 0;
16112 goto recenter;
16113 }
16114
16115 done:
16116
16117 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (startp, w->start);
16118 w->start_at_line_beg = (CHARPOS (startp) == BEGV
16119 || FETCH_BYTE (BYTEPOS (startp) - 1) == '\n');
16120
16121 /* Display the mode line, if we must. */
16122 if ((update_mode_line
16123 /* If window not full width, must redo its mode line
16124 if (a) the window to its side is being redone and
16125 (b) we do a frame-based redisplay. This is a consequence
16126 of how inverted lines are drawn in frame-based redisplay. */
16127 || (!just_this_one_p
16128 && !FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
16129 && !WINDOW_FULL_WIDTH_P (w))
16130 /* Line number to display. */
16131 || INTEGERP (w->base_line_pos)
16132 /* Column number is displayed and different from the one displayed. */
16133 || (!NILP (w->column_number_displayed)
16134 && (XFASTINT (w->column_number_displayed) != current_column ())))
16135 /* This means that the window has a mode line. */
16136 && (WINDOW_WANTS_MODELINE_P (w)
16137 || WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w)))
16138 {
16139 display_mode_lines (w);
16140
16141 /* If mode line height has changed, arrange for a thorough
16142 immediate redisplay using the correct mode line height. */
16143 if (WINDOW_WANTS_MODELINE_P (w)
16144 && CURRENT_MODE_LINE_HEIGHT (w) != DESIRED_MODE_LINE_HEIGHT (w))
16145 {
16146 fonts_changed_p = 1;
16147 MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)->height
16148 = DESIRED_MODE_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
16149 }
16150
16151 /* If header line height has changed, arrange for a thorough
16152 immediate redisplay using the correct header line height. */
16153 if (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w)
16154 && CURRENT_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w) != DESIRED_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w))
16155 {
16156 fonts_changed_p = 1;
16157 MATRIX_HEADER_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)->height
16158 = DESIRED_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
16159 }
16160
16161 if (fonts_changed_p)
16162 goto need_larger_matrices;
16163 }
16164
16165 if (!line_number_displayed
16166 && !BUFFERP (w->base_line_pos))
16167 {
16168 wset_base_line_pos (w, Qnil);
16169 wset_base_line_number (w, Qnil);
16170 }
16171
16172 finish_menu_bars:
16173
16174 /* When we reach a frame's selected window, redo the frame's menu bar. */
16175 if (update_mode_line
16176 && EQ (FRAME_SELECTED_WINDOW (f), window))
16177 {
16178 int redisplay_menu_p = 0;
16179
16180 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
16181 {
16182 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (HAVE_NTGUI) \
16183 || defined (HAVE_NS) || defined (USE_GTK)
16184 redisplay_menu_p = FRAME_EXTERNAL_MENU_BAR (f);
16185 #else
16186 redisplay_menu_p = FRAME_MENU_BAR_LINES (f) > 0;
16187 #endif
16188 }
16189 else
16190 redisplay_menu_p = FRAME_MENU_BAR_LINES (f) > 0;
16191
16192 if (redisplay_menu_p)
16193 display_menu_bar (w);
16194
16195 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
16196 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
16197 {
16198 #if defined (USE_GTK) || defined (HAVE_NS)
16199 if (FRAME_EXTERNAL_TOOL_BAR (f))
16200 redisplay_tool_bar (f);
16201 #else
16202 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
16203 && (FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) > 0
16204 || !NILP (Vauto_resize_tool_bars))
16205 && redisplay_tool_bar (f))
16206 ignore_mouse_drag_p = 1;
16207 #endif
16208 }
16209 #endif
16210 }
16211
16212 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
16213 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
16214 && update_window_fringes (w, (just_this_one_p
16215 || (!used_current_matrix_p && !overlay_arrow_seen)
16216 || w->pseudo_window_p)))
16217 {
16218 update_begin (f);
16219 BLOCK_INPUT;
16220 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
16221 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
16222 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
16223 update_end (f);
16224 }
16225 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
16226
16227 /* We go to this label, with fonts_changed_p nonzero,
16228 if it is necessary to try again using larger glyph matrices.
16229 We have to redeem the scroll bar even in this case,
16230 because the loop in redisplay_internal expects that. */
16231 need_larger_matrices:
16232 ;
16233 finish_scroll_bars:
16234
16235 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR (w))
16236 {
16237 /* Set the thumb's position and size. */
16238 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
16239
16240 /* Note that we actually used the scroll bar attached to this
16241 window, so it shouldn't be deleted at the end of redisplay. */
16242 if (FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->redeem_scroll_bar_hook)
16243 (*FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->redeem_scroll_bar_hook) (w);
16244 }
16245
16246 /* Restore current_buffer and value of point in it. The window
16247 update may have changed the buffer, so first make sure `opoint'
16248 is still valid (Bug#6177). */
16249 if (CHARPOS (opoint) < BEGV)
16250 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (BEGV, BEGV_BYTE);
16251 else if (CHARPOS (opoint) > ZV)
16252 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (Z, Z_BYTE);
16253 else
16254 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (CHARPOS (opoint), BYTEPOS (opoint));
16255
16256 set_buffer_internal_1 (old);
16257 /* Avoid an abort in TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH if the buffer has become
16258 shorter. This can be caused by log truncation in *Messages*. */
16259 if (CHARPOS (lpoint) <= ZV)
16260 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (CHARPOS (lpoint), BYTEPOS (lpoint));
16261
16262 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
16263 }
16264
16265
16266 /* Build the complete desired matrix of WINDOW with a window start
16267 buffer position POS.
16268
16269 Value is 1 if successful. It is zero if fonts were loaded during
16270 redisplay which makes re-adjusting glyph matrices necessary, and -1
16271 if point would appear in the scroll margins.
16272 (We check the former only if TRY_WINDOW_IGNORE_FONTS_CHANGE is
16273 unset in FLAGS, and the latter only if TRY_WINDOW_CHECK_MARGINS is
16274 set in FLAGS.) */
16275
16276 int
16277 try_window (Lisp_Object window, struct text_pos pos, int flags)
16278 {
16279 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
16280 struct it it;
16281 struct glyph_row *last_text_row = NULL;
16282 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
16283
16284 /* Make POS the new window start. */
16285 set_marker_both (w->start, Qnil, CHARPOS (pos), BYTEPOS (pos));
16286
16287 /* Mark cursor position as unknown. No overlay arrow seen. */
16288 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
16289 overlay_arrow_seen = 0;
16290
16291 /* Initialize iterator and info to start at POS. */
16292 start_display (&it, w, pos);
16293
16294 /* Display all lines of W. */
16295 while (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y)
16296 {
16297 if (display_line (&it))
16298 last_text_row = it.glyph_row - 1;
16299 if (fonts_changed_p && !(flags & TRY_WINDOW_IGNORE_FONTS_CHANGE))
16300 return 0;
16301 }
16302
16303 /* Don't let the cursor end in the scroll margins. */
16304 if ((flags & TRY_WINDOW_CHECK_MARGINS)
16305 && !MINI_WINDOW_P (w))
16306 {
16307 int this_scroll_margin;
16308
16309 if (scroll_margin > 0)
16310 {
16311 this_scroll_margin = min (scroll_margin, WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) / 4);
16312 this_scroll_margin *= FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
16313 }
16314 else
16315 this_scroll_margin = 0;
16316
16317 if ((w->cursor.y >= 0 /* not vscrolled */
16318 && w->cursor.y < this_scroll_margin
16319 && CHARPOS (pos) > BEGV
16320 && IT_CHARPOS (it) < ZV)
16321 /* rms: considering make_cursor_line_fully_visible_p here
16322 seems to give wrong results. We don't want to recenter
16323 when the last line is partly visible, we want to allow
16324 that case to be handled in the usual way. */
16325 || w->cursor.y > it.last_visible_y - this_scroll_margin - 1)
16326 {
16327 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
16328 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16329 return -1;
16330 }
16331 }
16332
16333 /* If bottom moved off end of frame, change mode line percentage. */
16334 if (XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos) <= 0
16335 && Z != IT_CHARPOS (it))
16336 w->update_mode_line = 1;
16337
16338 /* Set window_end_pos to the offset of the last character displayed
16339 on the window from the end of current_buffer. Set
16340 window_end_vpos to its row number. */
16341 if (last_text_row)
16342 {
16343 eassert (MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (last_text_row));
16344 w->window_end_bytepos
16345 = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (last_text_row);
16346 wset_window_end_pos
16347 (w, make_number (Z - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (last_text_row)));
16348 wset_window_end_vpos
16349 (w, make_number (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (last_text_row, w->desired_matrix)));
16350 eassert
16351 (MATRIX_ROW (w->desired_matrix,
16352 XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos))->displays_text_p);
16353 }
16354 else
16355 {
16356 w->window_end_bytepos = Z_BYTE - ZV_BYTE;
16357 wset_window_end_pos (w, make_number (Z - ZV));
16358 wset_window_end_vpos (w, make_number (0));
16359 }
16360
16361 /* But that is not valid info until redisplay finishes. */
16362 wset_window_end_valid (w, Qnil);
16363 return 1;
16364 }
16365
16366
16367 \f
16368 /************************************************************************
16369 Window redisplay reusing current matrix when buffer has not changed
16370 ************************************************************************/
16371
16372 /* Try redisplay of window W showing an unchanged buffer with a
16373 different window start than the last time it was displayed by
16374 reusing its current matrix. Value is non-zero if successful.
16375 W->start is the new window start. */
16376
16377 static int
16378 try_window_reusing_current_matrix (struct window *w)
16379 {
16380 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
16381 struct glyph_row *bottom_row;
16382 struct it it;
16383 struct run run;
16384 struct text_pos start, new_start;
16385 int nrows_scrolled, i;
16386 struct glyph_row *last_text_row;
16387 struct glyph_row *last_reused_text_row;
16388 struct glyph_row *start_row;
16389 int start_vpos, min_y, max_y;
16390
16391 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
16392 if (inhibit_try_window_reusing)
16393 return 0;
16394 #endif
16395
16396 if (/* This function doesn't handle terminal frames. */
16397 !FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
16398 /* Don't try to reuse the display if windows have been split
16399 or such. */
16400 || windows_or_buffers_changed
16401 || cursor_type_changed)
16402 return 0;
16403
16404 /* Can't do this if region may have changed. */
16405 if ((!NILP (Vtransient_mark_mode)
16406 && !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, mark_active)))
16407 || !NILP (w->region_showing)
16408 || !NILP (Vshow_trailing_whitespace))
16409 return 0;
16410
16411 /* If top-line visibility has changed, give up. */
16412 if (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w)
16413 != MATRIX_HEADER_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)->mode_line_p)
16414 return 0;
16415
16416 /* Give up if old or new display is scrolled vertically. We could
16417 make this function handle this, but right now it doesn't. */
16418 start_row = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
16419 if (w->vscroll || MATRIX_ROW_PARTIALLY_VISIBLE_P (w, start_row))
16420 return 0;
16421
16422 /* The variable new_start now holds the new window start. The old
16423 start `start' can be determined from the current matrix. */
16424 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (new_start, w->start);
16425 start = start_row->minpos;
16426 start_vpos = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (start_row, w->current_matrix);
16427
16428 /* Clear the desired matrix for the display below. */
16429 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16430
16431 if (CHARPOS (new_start) <= CHARPOS (start))
16432 {
16433 /* Don't use this method if the display starts with an ellipsis
16434 displayed for invisible text. It's not easy to handle that case
16435 below, and it's certainly not worth the effort since this is
16436 not a frequent case. */
16437 if (in_ellipses_for_invisible_text_p (&start_row->start, w))
16438 return 0;
16439
16440 IF_DEBUG (debug_method_add (w, "twu1"));
16441
16442 /* Display up to a row that can be reused. The variable
16443 last_text_row is set to the last row displayed that displays
16444 text. Note that it.vpos == 0 if or if not there is a
16445 header-line; it's not the same as the MATRIX_ROW_VPOS! */
16446 start_display (&it, w, new_start);
16447 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
16448 last_text_row = last_reused_text_row = NULL;
16449
16450 while (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y
16451 && !fonts_changed_p)
16452 {
16453 /* If we have reached into the characters in the START row,
16454 that means the line boundaries have changed. So we
16455 can't start copying with the row START. Maybe it will
16456 work to start copying with the following row. */
16457 while (IT_CHARPOS (it) > CHARPOS (start))
16458 {
16459 /* Advance to the next row as the "start". */
16460 start_row++;
16461 start = start_row->minpos;
16462 /* If there are no more rows to try, or just one, give up. */
16463 if (start_row == MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix) - 1
16464 || w->vscroll || MATRIX_ROW_PARTIALLY_VISIBLE_P (w, start_row)
16465 || CHARPOS (start) == ZV)
16466 {
16467 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16468 return 0;
16469 }
16470
16471 start_vpos = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (start_row, w->current_matrix);
16472 }
16473 /* If we have reached alignment, we can copy the rest of the
16474 rows. */
16475 if (IT_CHARPOS (it) == CHARPOS (start)
16476 /* Don't accept "alignment" inside a display vector,
16477 since start_row could have started in the middle of
16478 that same display vector (thus their character
16479 positions match), and we have no way of telling if
16480 that is the case. */
16481 && it.current.dpvec_index < 0)
16482 break;
16483
16484 if (display_line (&it))
16485 last_text_row = it.glyph_row - 1;
16486
16487 }
16488
16489 /* A value of current_y < last_visible_y means that we stopped
16490 at the previous window start, which in turn means that we
16491 have at least one reusable row. */
16492 if (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y)
16493 {
16494 struct glyph_row *row;
16495
16496 /* IT.vpos always starts from 0; it counts text lines. */
16497 nrows_scrolled = it.vpos - (start_row - MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix));
16498
16499 /* Find PT if not already found in the lines displayed. */
16500 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
16501 {
16502 int dy = it.current_y - start_row->y;
16503
16504 row = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
16505 row = row_containing_pos (w, PT, row, NULL, dy);
16506 if (row)
16507 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix, 0, 0,
16508 dy, nrows_scrolled);
16509 else
16510 {
16511 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16512 return 0;
16513 }
16514 }
16515
16516 /* Scroll the display. Do it before the current matrix is
16517 changed. The problem here is that update has not yet
16518 run, i.e. part of the current matrix is not up to date.
16519 scroll_run_hook will clear the cursor, and use the
16520 current matrix to get the height of the row the cursor is
16521 in. */
16522 run.current_y = start_row->y;
16523 run.desired_y = it.current_y;
16524 run.height = it.last_visible_y - it.current_y;
16525
16526 if (run.height > 0 && run.current_y != run.desired_y)
16527 {
16528 update_begin (f);
16529 FRAME_RIF (f)->update_window_begin_hook (w);
16530 FRAME_RIF (f)->clear_window_mouse_face (w);
16531 FRAME_RIF (f)->scroll_run_hook (w, &run);
16532 FRAME_RIF (f)->update_window_end_hook (w, 0, 0);
16533 update_end (f);
16534 }
16535
16536 /* Shift current matrix down by nrows_scrolled lines. */
16537 bottom_row = MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix, w);
16538 rotate_matrix (w->current_matrix,
16539 start_vpos,
16540 MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (bottom_row, w->current_matrix),
16541 nrows_scrolled);
16542
16543 /* Disable lines that must be updated. */
16544 for (i = 0; i < nrows_scrolled; ++i)
16545 (start_row + i)->enabled_p = 0;
16546
16547 /* Re-compute Y positions. */
16548 min_y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
16549 max_y = it.last_visible_y;
16550 for (row = start_row + nrows_scrolled;
16551 row < bottom_row;
16552 ++row)
16553 {
16554 row->y = it.current_y;
16555 row->visible_height = row->height;
16556
16557 if (row->y < min_y)
16558 row->visible_height -= min_y - row->y;
16559 if (row->y + row->height > max_y)
16560 row->visible_height -= row->y + row->height - max_y;
16561 if (row->fringe_bitmap_periodic_p)
16562 row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
16563
16564 it.current_y += row->height;
16565
16566 if (MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row))
16567 last_reused_text_row = row;
16568 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) >= it.last_visible_y)
16569 break;
16570 }
16571
16572 /* Disable lines in the current matrix which are now
16573 below the window. */
16574 for (++row; row < bottom_row; ++row)
16575 row->enabled_p = row->mode_line_p = 0;
16576 }
16577
16578 /* Update window_end_pos etc.; last_reused_text_row is the last
16579 reused row from the current matrix containing text, if any.
16580 The value of last_text_row is the last displayed line
16581 containing text. */
16582 if (last_reused_text_row)
16583 {
16584 w->window_end_bytepos
16585 = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (last_reused_text_row);
16586 wset_window_end_pos
16587 (w, make_number (Z
16588 - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (last_reused_text_row)));
16589 wset_window_end_vpos
16590 (w, make_number (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (last_reused_text_row,
16591 w->current_matrix)));
16592 }
16593 else if (last_text_row)
16594 {
16595 w->window_end_bytepos
16596 = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (last_text_row);
16597 wset_window_end_pos
16598 (w, make_number (Z - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (last_text_row)));
16599 wset_window_end_vpos
16600 (w, make_number (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (last_text_row,
16601 w->desired_matrix)));
16602 }
16603 else
16604 {
16605 /* This window must be completely empty. */
16606 w->window_end_bytepos = Z_BYTE - ZV_BYTE;
16607 wset_window_end_pos (w, make_number (Z - ZV));
16608 wset_window_end_vpos (w, make_number (0));
16609 }
16610 wset_window_end_valid (w, Qnil);
16611
16612 /* Update hint: don't try scrolling again in update_window. */
16613 w->desired_matrix->no_scrolling_p = 1;
16614
16615 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
16616 debug_method_add (w, "try_window_reusing_current_matrix 1");
16617 #endif
16618 return 1;
16619 }
16620 else if (CHARPOS (new_start) > CHARPOS (start))
16621 {
16622 struct glyph_row *pt_row, *row;
16623 struct glyph_row *first_reusable_row;
16624 struct glyph_row *first_row_to_display;
16625 int dy;
16626 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w);
16627
16628 /* Find the row starting at new_start, if there is one. Don't
16629 reuse a partially visible line at the end. */
16630 first_reusable_row = start_row;
16631 while (first_reusable_row->enabled_p
16632 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (first_reusable_row) < yb
16633 && (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (first_reusable_row)
16634 < CHARPOS (new_start)))
16635 ++first_reusable_row;
16636
16637 /* Give up if there is no row to reuse. */
16638 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (first_reusable_row) >= yb
16639 || !first_reusable_row->enabled_p
16640 || (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (first_reusable_row)
16641 != CHARPOS (new_start)))
16642 return 0;
16643
16644 /* We can reuse fully visible rows beginning with
16645 first_reusable_row to the end of the window. Set
16646 first_row_to_display to the first row that cannot be reused.
16647 Set pt_row to the row containing point, if there is any. */
16648 pt_row = NULL;
16649 for (first_row_to_display = first_reusable_row;
16650 MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (first_row_to_display) < yb;
16651 ++first_row_to_display)
16652 {
16653 if (PT >= MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (first_row_to_display)
16654 && (PT < MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (first_row_to_display)
16655 || (PT == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (first_row_to_display)
16656 && first_row_to_display->ends_at_zv_p
16657 && pt_row == NULL)))
16658 pt_row = first_row_to_display;
16659 }
16660
16661 /* Start displaying at the start of first_row_to_display. */
16662 eassert (first_row_to_display->y < yb);
16663 init_to_row_start (&it, w, first_row_to_display);
16664
16665 nrows_scrolled = (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (first_reusable_row, w->current_matrix)
16666 - start_vpos);
16667 it.vpos = (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (first_row_to_display, w->current_matrix)
16668 - nrows_scrolled);
16669 it.current_y = (first_row_to_display->y - first_reusable_row->y
16670 + WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w));
16671
16672 /* Display lines beginning with first_row_to_display in the
16673 desired matrix. Set last_text_row to the last row displayed
16674 that displays text. */
16675 it.glyph_row = MATRIX_ROW (w->desired_matrix, it.vpos);
16676 if (pt_row == NULL)
16677 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
16678 last_text_row = NULL;
16679 while (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y && !fonts_changed_p)
16680 if (display_line (&it))
16681 last_text_row = it.glyph_row - 1;
16682
16683 /* If point is in a reused row, adjust y and vpos of the cursor
16684 position. */
16685 if (pt_row)
16686 {
16687 w->cursor.vpos -= nrows_scrolled;
16688 w->cursor.y -= first_reusable_row->y - start_row->y;
16689 }
16690
16691 /* Give up if point isn't in a row displayed or reused. (This
16692 also handles the case where w->cursor.vpos < nrows_scrolled
16693 after the calls to display_line, which can happen with scroll
16694 margins. See bug#1295.) */
16695 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
16696 {
16697 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16698 return 0;
16699 }
16700
16701 /* Scroll the display. */
16702 run.current_y = first_reusable_row->y;
16703 run.desired_y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
16704 run.height = it.last_visible_y - run.current_y;
16705 dy = run.current_y - run.desired_y;
16706
16707 if (run.height)
16708 {
16709 update_begin (f);
16710 FRAME_RIF (f)->update_window_begin_hook (w);
16711 FRAME_RIF (f)->clear_window_mouse_face (w);
16712 FRAME_RIF (f)->scroll_run_hook (w, &run);
16713 FRAME_RIF (f)->update_window_end_hook (w, 0, 0);
16714 update_end (f);
16715 }
16716
16717 /* Adjust Y positions of reused rows. */
16718 bottom_row = MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix, w);
16719 min_y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
16720 max_y = it.last_visible_y;
16721 for (row = first_reusable_row; row < first_row_to_display; ++row)
16722 {
16723 row->y -= dy;
16724 row->visible_height = row->height;
16725 if (row->y < min_y)
16726 row->visible_height -= min_y - row->y;
16727 if (row->y + row->height > max_y)
16728 row->visible_height -= row->y + row->height - max_y;
16729 if (row->fringe_bitmap_periodic_p)
16730 row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
16731 }
16732
16733 /* Scroll the current matrix. */
16734 eassert (nrows_scrolled > 0);
16735 rotate_matrix (w->current_matrix,
16736 start_vpos,
16737 MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (bottom_row, w->current_matrix),
16738 -nrows_scrolled);
16739
16740 /* Disable rows not reused. */
16741 for (row -= nrows_scrolled; row < bottom_row; ++row)
16742 row->enabled_p = 0;
16743
16744 /* Point may have moved to a different line, so we cannot assume that
16745 the previous cursor position is valid; locate the correct row. */
16746 if (pt_row)
16747 {
16748 for (row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->cursor.vpos);
16749 row < bottom_row
16750 && PT >= MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
16751 && !row->ends_at_zv_p;
16752 row++)
16753 {
16754 w->cursor.vpos++;
16755 w->cursor.y = row->y;
16756 }
16757 if (row < bottom_row)
16758 {
16759 struct glyph *glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + w->cursor.hpos;
16760 struct glyph *end = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA];
16761
16762 /* Can't use this optimization with bidi-reordered glyph
16763 rows, unless cursor is already at point. */
16764 if (!NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), bidi_display_reordering)))
16765 {
16766 if (!(w->cursor.hpos >= 0
16767 && w->cursor.hpos < row->used[TEXT_AREA]
16768 && BUFFERP (glyph->object)
16769 && glyph->charpos == PT))
16770 return 0;
16771 }
16772 else
16773 for (; glyph < end
16774 && (!BUFFERP (glyph->object)
16775 || glyph->charpos < PT);
16776 glyph++)
16777 {
16778 w->cursor.hpos++;
16779 w->cursor.x += glyph->pixel_width;
16780 }
16781 }
16782 }
16783
16784 /* Adjust window end. A null value of last_text_row means that
16785 the window end is in reused rows which in turn means that
16786 only its vpos can have changed. */
16787 if (last_text_row)
16788 {
16789 w->window_end_bytepos
16790 = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (last_text_row);
16791 wset_window_end_pos
16792 (w, make_number (Z - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (last_text_row)));
16793 wset_window_end_vpos
16794 (w, make_number (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (last_text_row,
16795 w->desired_matrix)));
16796 }
16797 else
16798 {
16799 wset_window_end_vpos
16800 (w, make_number (XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos) - nrows_scrolled));
16801 }
16802
16803 wset_window_end_valid (w, Qnil);
16804 w->desired_matrix->no_scrolling_p = 1;
16805
16806 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
16807 debug_method_add (w, "try_window_reusing_current_matrix 2");
16808 #endif
16809 return 1;
16810 }
16811
16812 return 0;
16813 }
16814
16815
16816 \f
16817 /************************************************************************
16818 Window redisplay reusing current matrix when buffer has changed
16819 ************************************************************************/
16820
16821 static struct glyph_row *find_last_unchanged_at_beg_row (struct window *);
16822 static struct glyph_row *find_first_unchanged_at_end_row (struct window *,
16823 ptrdiff_t *, ptrdiff_t *);
16824 static struct glyph_row *
16825 find_last_row_displaying_text (struct glyph_matrix *, struct it *,
16826 struct glyph_row *);
16827
16828
16829 /* Return the last row in MATRIX displaying text. If row START is
16830 non-null, start searching with that row. IT gives the dimensions
16831 of the display. Value is null if matrix is empty; otherwise it is
16832 a pointer to the row found. */
16833
16834 static struct glyph_row *
16835 find_last_row_displaying_text (struct glyph_matrix *matrix, struct it *it,
16836 struct glyph_row *start)
16837 {
16838 struct glyph_row *row, *row_found;
16839
16840 /* Set row_found to the last row in IT->w's current matrix
16841 displaying text. The loop looks funny but think of partially
16842 visible lines. */
16843 row_found = NULL;
16844 row = start ? start : MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (matrix);
16845 while (MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row))
16846 {
16847 eassert (row->enabled_p);
16848 row_found = row;
16849 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) >= it->last_visible_y)
16850 break;
16851 ++row;
16852 }
16853
16854 return row_found;
16855 }
16856
16857
16858 /* Return the last row in the current matrix of W that is not affected
16859 by changes at the start of current_buffer that occurred since W's
16860 current matrix was built. Value is null if no such row exists.
16861
16862 BEG_UNCHANGED us the number of characters unchanged at the start of
16863 current_buffer. BEG + BEG_UNCHANGED is the buffer position of the
16864 first changed character in current_buffer. Characters at positions <
16865 BEG + BEG_UNCHANGED are at the same buffer positions as they were
16866 when the current matrix was built. */
16867
16868 static struct glyph_row *
16869 find_last_unchanged_at_beg_row (struct window *w)
16870 {
16871 ptrdiff_t first_changed_pos = BEG + BEG_UNCHANGED;
16872 struct glyph_row *row;
16873 struct glyph_row *row_found = NULL;
16874 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w);
16875
16876 /* Find the last row displaying unchanged text. */
16877 for (row = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
16878 MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row)
16879 && MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) < first_changed_pos;
16880 ++row)
16881 {
16882 if (/* If row ends before first_changed_pos, it is unchanged,
16883 except in some case. */
16884 MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) <= first_changed_pos
16885 /* When row ends in ZV and we write at ZV it is not
16886 unchanged. */
16887 && !row->ends_at_zv_p
16888 /* When first_changed_pos is the end of a continued line,
16889 row is not unchanged because it may be no longer
16890 continued. */
16891 && !(MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) == first_changed_pos
16892 && (row->continued_p
16893 || row->exact_window_width_line_p))
16894 /* If ROW->end is beyond ZV, then ROW->end is outdated and
16895 needs to be recomputed, so don't consider this row as
16896 unchanged. This happens when the last line was
16897 bidi-reordered and was killed immediately before this
16898 redisplay cycle. In that case, ROW->end stores the
16899 buffer position of the first visual-order character of
16900 the killed text, which is now beyond ZV. */
16901 && CHARPOS (row->end.pos) <= ZV)
16902 row_found = row;
16903
16904 /* Stop if last visible row. */
16905 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) >= yb)
16906 break;
16907 }
16908
16909 return row_found;
16910 }
16911
16912
16913 /* Find the first glyph row in the current matrix of W that is not
16914 affected by changes at the end of current_buffer since the
16915 time W's current matrix was built.
16916
16917 Return in *DELTA the number of chars by which buffer positions in
16918 unchanged text at the end of current_buffer must be adjusted.
16919
16920 Return in *DELTA_BYTES the corresponding number of bytes.
16921
16922 Value is null if no such row exists, i.e. all rows are affected by
16923 changes. */
16924
16925 static struct glyph_row *
16926 find_first_unchanged_at_end_row (struct window *w,
16927 ptrdiff_t *delta, ptrdiff_t *delta_bytes)
16928 {
16929 struct glyph_row *row;
16930 struct glyph_row *row_found = NULL;
16931
16932 *delta = *delta_bytes = 0;
16933
16934 /* Display must not have been paused, otherwise the current matrix
16935 is not up to date. */
16936 eassert (!NILP (w->window_end_valid));
16937
16938 /* A value of window_end_pos >= END_UNCHANGED means that the window
16939 end is in the range of changed text. If so, there is no
16940 unchanged row at the end of W's current matrix. */
16941 if (XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos) >= END_UNCHANGED)
16942 return NULL;
16943
16944 /* Set row to the last row in W's current matrix displaying text. */
16945 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos));
16946
16947 /* If matrix is entirely empty, no unchanged row exists. */
16948 if (MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row))
16949 {
16950 /* The value of row is the last glyph row in the matrix having a
16951 meaningful buffer position in it. The end position of row
16952 corresponds to window_end_pos. This allows us to translate
16953 buffer positions in the current matrix to current buffer
16954 positions for characters not in changed text. */
16955 ptrdiff_t Z_old =
16956 MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) + XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos);
16957 ptrdiff_t Z_BYTE_old =
16958 MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (row) + w->window_end_bytepos;
16959 ptrdiff_t last_unchanged_pos, last_unchanged_pos_old;
16960 struct glyph_row *first_text_row
16961 = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
16962
16963 *delta = Z - Z_old;
16964 *delta_bytes = Z_BYTE - Z_BYTE_old;
16965
16966 /* Set last_unchanged_pos to the buffer position of the last
16967 character in the buffer that has not been changed. Z is the
16968 index + 1 of the last character in current_buffer, i.e. by
16969 subtracting END_UNCHANGED we get the index of the last
16970 unchanged character, and we have to add BEG to get its buffer
16971 position. */
16972 last_unchanged_pos = Z - END_UNCHANGED + BEG;
16973 last_unchanged_pos_old = last_unchanged_pos - *delta;
16974
16975 /* Search backward from ROW for a row displaying a line that
16976 starts at a minimum position >= last_unchanged_pos_old. */
16977 for (; row > first_text_row; --row)
16978 {
16979 /* This used to abort, but it can happen.
16980 It is ok to just stop the search instead here. KFS. */
16981 if (!row->enabled_p || !MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row))
16982 break;
16983
16984 if (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) >= last_unchanged_pos_old)
16985 row_found = row;
16986 }
16987 }
16988
16989 eassert (!row_found || MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row_found));
16990
16991 return row_found;
16992 }
16993
16994
16995 /* Make sure that glyph rows in the current matrix of window W
16996 reference the same glyph memory as corresponding rows in the
16997 frame's frame matrix. This function is called after scrolling W's
16998 current matrix on a terminal frame in try_window_id and
16999 try_window_reusing_current_matrix. */
17000
17001 static void
17002 sync_frame_with_window_matrix_rows (struct window *w)
17003 {
17004 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
17005 struct glyph_row *window_row, *window_row_end, *frame_row;
17006
17007 /* Preconditions: W must be a leaf window and full-width. Its frame
17008 must have a frame matrix. */
17009 eassert (NILP (w->hchild) && NILP (w->vchild));
17010 eassert (WINDOW_FULL_WIDTH_P (w));
17011 eassert (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (f));
17012
17013 /* If W is a full-width window, glyph pointers in W's current matrix
17014 have, by definition, to be the same as glyph pointers in the
17015 corresponding frame matrix. Note that frame matrices have no
17016 marginal areas (see build_frame_matrix). */
17017 window_row = w->current_matrix->rows;
17018 window_row_end = window_row + w->current_matrix->nrows;
17019 frame_row = f->current_matrix->rows + WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_LINE (w);
17020 while (window_row < window_row_end)
17021 {
17022 struct glyph *start = window_row->glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA];
17023 struct glyph *end = window_row->glyphs[LAST_AREA];
17024
17025 frame_row->glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA] = start;
17026 frame_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] = start;
17027 frame_row->glyphs[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA] = end;
17028 frame_row->glyphs[LAST_AREA] = end;
17029
17030 /* Disable frame rows whose corresponding window rows have
17031 been disabled in try_window_id. */
17032 if (!window_row->enabled_p)
17033 frame_row->enabled_p = 0;
17034
17035 ++window_row, ++frame_row;
17036 }
17037 }
17038
17039
17040 /* Find the glyph row in window W containing CHARPOS. Consider all
17041 rows between START and END (not inclusive). END null means search
17042 all rows to the end of the display area of W. Value is the row
17043 containing CHARPOS or null. */
17044
17045 struct glyph_row *
17046 row_containing_pos (struct window *w, ptrdiff_t charpos,
17047 struct glyph_row *start, struct glyph_row *end, int dy)
17048 {
17049 struct glyph_row *row = start;
17050 struct glyph_row *best_row = NULL;
17051 ptrdiff_t mindif = BUF_ZV (XBUFFER (w->buffer)) + 1;
17052 int last_y;
17053
17054 /* If we happen to start on a header-line, skip that. */
17055 if (row->mode_line_p)
17056 ++row;
17057
17058 if ((end && row >= end) || !row->enabled_p)
17059 return NULL;
17060
17061 last_y = window_text_bottom_y (w) - dy;
17062
17063 while (1)
17064 {
17065 /* Give up if we have gone too far. */
17066 if (end && row >= end)
17067 return NULL;
17068 /* This formerly returned if they were equal.
17069 I think that both quantities are of a "last plus one" type;
17070 if so, when they are equal, the row is within the screen. -- rms. */
17071 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) > last_y)
17072 return NULL;
17073
17074 /* If it is in this row, return this row. */
17075 if (! (MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) < charpos
17076 || (MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) == charpos
17077 /* The end position of a row equals the start
17078 position of the next row. If CHARPOS is there, we
17079 would rather display it in the next line, except
17080 when this line ends in ZV. */
17081 && !row->ends_at_zv_p
17082 && !MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (row)))
17083 && charpos >= MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row))
17084 {
17085 struct glyph *g;
17086
17087 if (NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), bidi_display_reordering))
17088 || (!best_row && !row->continued_p))
17089 return row;
17090 /* In bidi-reordered rows, there could be several rows
17091 occluding point, all of them belonging to the same
17092 continued line. We need to find the row which fits
17093 CHARPOS the best. */
17094 for (g = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
17095 g < row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA];
17096 g++)
17097 {
17098 if (!STRINGP (g->object))
17099 {
17100 if (g->charpos > 0 && eabs (g->charpos - charpos) < mindif)
17101 {
17102 mindif = eabs (g->charpos - charpos);
17103 best_row = row;
17104 /* Exact match always wins. */
17105 if (mindif == 0)
17106 return best_row;
17107 }
17108 }
17109 }
17110 }
17111 else if (best_row && !row->continued_p)
17112 return best_row;
17113 ++row;
17114 }
17115 }
17116
17117
17118 /* Try to redisplay window W by reusing its existing display. W's
17119 current matrix must be up to date when this function is called,
17120 i.e. window_end_valid must not be nil.
17121
17122 Value is
17123
17124 1 if display has been updated
17125 0 if otherwise unsuccessful
17126 -1 if redisplay with same window start is known not to succeed
17127
17128 The following steps are performed:
17129
17130 1. Find the last row in the current matrix of W that is not
17131 affected by changes at the start of current_buffer. If no such row
17132 is found, give up.
17133
17134 2. Find the first row in W's current matrix that is not affected by
17135 changes at the end of current_buffer. Maybe there is no such row.
17136
17137 3. Display lines beginning with the row + 1 found in step 1 to the
17138 row found in step 2 or, if step 2 didn't find a row, to the end of
17139 the window.
17140
17141 4. If cursor is not known to appear on the window, give up.
17142
17143 5. If display stopped at the row found in step 2, scroll the
17144 display and current matrix as needed.
17145
17146 6. Maybe display some lines at the end of W, if we must. This can
17147 happen under various circumstances, like a partially visible line
17148 becoming fully visible, or because newly displayed lines are displayed
17149 in smaller font sizes.
17150
17151 7. Update W's window end information. */
17152
17153 static int
17154 try_window_id (struct window *w)
17155 {
17156 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
17157 struct glyph_matrix *current_matrix = w->current_matrix;
17158 struct glyph_matrix *desired_matrix = w->desired_matrix;
17159 struct glyph_row *last_unchanged_at_beg_row;
17160 struct glyph_row *first_unchanged_at_end_row;
17161 struct glyph_row *row;
17162 struct glyph_row *bottom_row;
17163 int bottom_vpos;
17164 struct it it;
17165 ptrdiff_t delta = 0, delta_bytes = 0, stop_pos;
17166 int dvpos, dy;
17167 struct text_pos start_pos;
17168 struct run run;
17169 int first_unchanged_at_end_vpos = 0;
17170 struct glyph_row *last_text_row, *last_text_row_at_end;
17171 struct text_pos start;
17172 ptrdiff_t first_changed_charpos, last_changed_charpos;
17173
17174 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
17175 if (inhibit_try_window_id)
17176 return 0;
17177 #endif
17178
17179 /* This is handy for debugging. */
17180 #if 0
17181 #define GIVE_UP(X) \
17182 do { \
17183 fprintf (stderr, "try_window_id give up %d\n", (X)); \
17184 return 0; \
17185 } while (0)
17186 #else
17187 #define GIVE_UP(X) return 0
17188 #endif
17189
17190 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (start, w->start);
17191
17192 /* Don't use this for mini-windows because these can show
17193 messages and mini-buffers, and we don't handle that here. */
17194 if (MINI_WINDOW_P (w))
17195 GIVE_UP (1);
17196
17197 /* This flag is used to prevent redisplay optimizations. */
17198 if (windows_or_buffers_changed || cursor_type_changed)
17199 GIVE_UP (2);
17200
17201 /* Verify that narrowing has not changed.
17202 Also verify that we were not told to prevent redisplay optimizations.
17203 It would be nice to further
17204 reduce the number of cases where this prevents try_window_id. */
17205 if (current_buffer->clip_changed
17206 || current_buffer->prevent_redisplay_optimizations_p)
17207 GIVE_UP (3);
17208
17209 /* Window must either use window-based redisplay or be full width. */
17210 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
17211 && (!FRAME_LINE_INS_DEL_OK (f)
17212 || !WINDOW_FULL_WIDTH_P (w)))
17213 GIVE_UP (4);
17214
17215 /* Give up if point is known NOT to appear in W. */
17216 if (PT < CHARPOS (start))
17217 GIVE_UP (5);
17218
17219 /* Another way to prevent redisplay optimizations. */
17220 if (w->last_modified == 0)
17221 GIVE_UP (6);
17222
17223 /* Verify that window is not hscrolled. */
17224 if (w->hscroll != 0)
17225 GIVE_UP (7);
17226
17227 /* Verify that display wasn't paused. */
17228 if (NILP (w->window_end_valid))
17229 GIVE_UP (8);
17230
17231 /* Can't use this if highlighting a region because a cursor movement
17232 will do more than just set the cursor. */
17233 if (!NILP (Vtransient_mark_mode)
17234 && !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, mark_active)))
17235 GIVE_UP (9);
17236
17237 /* Likewise if highlighting trailing whitespace. */
17238 if (!NILP (Vshow_trailing_whitespace))
17239 GIVE_UP (11);
17240
17241 /* Likewise if showing a region. */
17242 if (!NILP (w->region_showing))
17243 GIVE_UP (10);
17244
17245 /* Can't use this if overlay arrow position and/or string have
17246 changed. */
17247 if (overlay_arrows_changed_p ())
17248 GIVE_UP (12);
17249
17250 /* When word-wrap is on, adding a space to the first word of a
17251 wrapped line can change the wrap position, altering the line
17252 above it. It might be worthwhile to handle this more
17253 intelligently, but for now just redisplay from scratch. */
17254 if (!NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), word_wrap)))
17255 GIVE_UP (21);
17256
17257 /* Under bidi reordering, adding or deleting a character in the
17258 beginning of a paragraph, before the first strong directional
17259 character, can change the base direction of the paragraph (unless
17260 the buffer specifies a fixed paragraph direction), which will
17261 require to redisplay the whole paragraph. It might be worthwhile
17262 to find the paragraph limits and widen the range of redisplayed
17263 lines to that, but for now just give up this optimization and
17264 redisplay from scratch. */
17265 if (!NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), bidi_display_reordering))
17266 && NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), bidi_paragraph_direction)))
17267 GIVE_UP (22);
17268
17269 /* Make sure beg_unchanged and end_unchanged are up to date. Do it
17270 only if buffer has really changed. The reason is that the gap is
17271 initially at Z for freshly visited files. The code below would
17272 set end_unchanged to 0 in that case. */
17273 if (MODIFF > SAVE_MODIFF
17274 /* This seems to happen sometimes after saving a buffer. */
17275 || BEG_UNCHANGED + END_UNCHANGED > Z_BYTE)
17276 {
17277 if (GPT - BEG < BEG_UNCHANGED)
17278 BEG_UNCHANGED = GPT - BEG;
17279 if (Z - GPT < END_UNCHANGED)
17280 END_UNCHANGED = Z - GPT;
17281 }
17282
17283 /* The position of the first and last character that has been changed. */
17284 first_changed_charpos = BEG + BEG_UNCHANGED;
17285 last_changed_charpos = Z - END_UNCHANGED;
17286
17287 /* If window starts after a line end, and the last change is in
17288 front of that newline, then changes don't affect the display.
17289 This case happens with stealth-fontification. Note that although
17290 the display is unchanged, glyph positions in the matrix have to
17291 be adjusted, of course. */
17292 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos));
17293 if (MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row)
17294 && ((last_changed_charpos < CHARPOS (start)
17295 && CHARPOS (start) == BEGV)
17296 || (last_changed_charpos < CHARPOS (start) - 1
17297 && FETCH_BYTE (BYTEPOS (start) - 1) == '\n')))
17298 {
17299 ptrdiff_t Z_old, Z_delta, Z_BYTE_old, Z_delta_bytes;
17300 struct glyph_row *r0;
17301
17302 /* Compute how many chars/bytes have been added to or removed
17303 from the buffer. */
17304 Z_old = MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) + XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos);
17305 Z_BYTE_old = MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (row) + w->window_end_bytepos;
17306 Z_delta = Z - Z_old;
17307 Z_delta_bytes = Z_BYTE - Z_BYTE_old;
17308
17309 /* Give up if PT is not in the window. Note that it already has
17310 been checked at the start of try_window_id that PT is not in
17311 front of the window start. */
17312 if (PT >= MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) + Z_delta)
17313 GIVE_UP (13);
17314
17315 /* If window start is unchanged, we can reuse the whole matrix
17316 as is, after adjusting glyph positions. No need to compute
17317 the window end again, since its offset from Z hasn't changed. */
17318 r0 = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (current_matrix);
17319 if (CHARPOS (start) == MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (r0) + Z_delta
17320 && BYTEPOS (start) == MATRIX_ROW_START_BYTEPOS (r0) + Z_delta_bytes
17321 /* PT must not be in a partially visible line. */
17322 && !(PT >= MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) + Z_delta
17323 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) > window_text_bottom_y (w)))
17324 {
17325 /* Adjust positions in the glyph matrix. */
17326 if (Z_delta || Z_delta_bytes)
17327 {
17328 struct glyph_row *r1
17329 = MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (current_matrix, w);
17330 increment_matrix_positions (w->current_matrix,
17331 MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (r0, current_matrix),
17332 MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (r1, current_matrix),
17333 Z_delta, Z_delta_bytes);
17334 }
17335
17336 /* Set the cursor. */
17337 row = row_containing_pos (w, PT, r0, NULL, 0);
17338 if (row)
17339 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, current_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
17340 else
17341 abort ();
17342 return 1;
17343 }
17344 }
17345
17346 /* Handle the case that changes are all below what is displayed in
17347 the window, and that PT is in the window. This shortcut cannot
17348 be taken if ZV is visible in the window, and text has been added
17349 there that is visible in the window. */
17350 if (first_changed_charpos >= MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
17351 /* ZV is not visible in the window, or there are no
17352 changes at ZV, actually. */
17353 && (current_matrix->zv > MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
17354 || first_changed_charpos == last_changed_charpos))
17355 {
17356 struct glyph_row *r0;
17357
17358 /* Give up if PT is not in the window. Note that it already has
17359 been checked at the start of try_window_id that PT is not in
17360 front of the window start. */
17361 if (PT >= MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row))
17362 GIVE_UP (14);
17363
17364 /* If window start is unchanged, we can reuse the whole matrix
17365 as is, without changing glyph positions since no text has
17366 been added/removed in front of the window end. */
17367 r0 = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (current_matrix);
17368 if (TEXT_POS_EQUAL_P (start, r0->minpos)
17369 /* PT must not be in a partially visible line. */
17370 && !(PT >= MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row)
17371 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) > window_text_bottom_y (w)))
17372 {
17373 /* We have to compute the window end anew since text
17374 could have been added/removed after it. */
17375 wset_window_end_pos
17376 (w, make_number (Z - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)));
17377 w->window_end_bytepos
17378 = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (row);
17379
17380 /* Set the cursor. */
17381 row = row_containing_pos (w, PT, r0, NULL, 0);
17382 if (row)
17383 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, current_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
17384 else
17385 abort ();
17386 return 2;
17387 }
17388 }
17389
17390 /* Give up if window start is in the changed area.
17391
17392 The condition used to read
17393
17394 (BEG_UNCHANGED + END_UNCHANGED != Z - BEG && ...)
17395
17396 but why that was tested escapes me at the moment. */
17397 if (CHARPOS (start) >= first_changed_charpos
17398 && CHARPOS (start) <= last_changed_charpos)
17399 GIVE_UP (15);
17400
17401 /* Check that window start agrees with the start of the first glyph
17402 row in its current matrix. Check this after we know the window
17403 start is not in changed text, otherwise positions would not be
17404 comparable. */
17405 row = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (current_matrix);
17406 if (!TEXT_POS_EQUAL_P (start, row->minpos))
17407 GIVE_UP (16);
17408
17409 /* Give up if the window ends in strings. Overlay strings
17410 at the end are difficult to handle, so don't try. */
17411 row = MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos));
17412 if (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row))
17413 GIVE_UP (20);
17414
17415 /* Compute the position at which we have to start displaying new
17416 lines. Some of the lines at the top of the window might be
17417 reusable because they are not displaying changed text. Find the
17418 last row in W's current matrix not affected by changes at the
17419 start of current_buffer. Value is null if changes start in the
17420 first line of window. */
17421 last_unchanged_at_beg_row = find_last_unchanged_at_beg_row (w);
17422 if (last_unchanged_at_beg_row)
17423 {
17424 /* Avoid starting to display in the middle of a character, a TAB
17425 for instance. This is easier than to set up the iterator
17426 exactly, and it's not a frequent case, so the additional
17427 effort wouldn't really pay off. */
17428 while ((MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (last_unchanged_at_beg_row)
17429 || last_unchanged_at_beg_row->ends_in_newline_from_string_p)
17430 && last_unchanged_at_beg_row > w->current_matrix->rows)
17431 --last_unchanged_at_beg_row;
17432
17433 if (MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (last_unchanged_at_beg_row))
17434 GIVE_UP (17);
17435
17436 if (init_to_row_end (&it, w, last_unchanged_at_beg_row) == 0)
17437 GIVE_UP (18);
17438 start_pos = it.current.pos;
17439
17440 /* Start displaying new lines in the desired matrix at the same
17441 vpos we would use in the current matrix, i.e. below
17442 last_unchanged_at_beg_row. */
17443 it.vpos = 1 + MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (last_unchanged_at_beg_row,
17444 current_matrix);
17445 it.glyph_row = MATRIX_ROW (desired_matrix, it.vpos);
17446 it.current_y = MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (last_unchanged_at_beg_row);
17447
17448 eassert (it.hpos == 0 && it.current_x == 0);
17449 }
17450 else
17451 {
17452 /* There are no reusable lines at the start of the window.
17453 Start displaying in the first text line. */
17454 start_display (&it, w, start);
17455 it.vpos = it.first_vpos;
17456 start_pos = it.current.pos;
17457 }
17458
17459 /* Find the first row that is not affected by changes at the end of
17460 the buffer. Value will be null if there is no unchanged row, in
17461 which case we must redisplay to the end of the window. delta
17462 will be set to the value by which buffer positions beginning with
17463 first_unchanged_at_end_row have to be adjusted due to text
17464 changes. */
17465 first_unchanged_at_end_row
17466 = find_first_unchanged_at_end_row (w, &delta, &delta_bytes);
17467 IF_DEBUG (debug_delta = delta);
17468 IF_DEBUG (debug_delta_bytes = delta_bytes);
17469
17470 /* Set stop_pos to the buffer position up to which we will have to
17471 display new lines. If first_unchanged_at_end_row != NULL, this
17472 is the buffer position of the start of the line displayed in that
17473 row. For first_unchanged_at_end_row == NULL, use 0 to indicate
17474 that we don't stop at a buffer position. */
17475 stop_pos = 0;
17476 if (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17477 {
17478 eassert (last_unchanged_at_beg_row == NULL
17479 || first_unchanged_at_end_row >= last_unchanged_at_beg_row);
17480
17481 /* If this is a continuation line, move forward to the next one
17482 that isn't. Changes in lines above affect this line.
17483 Caution: this may move first_unchanged_at_end_row to a row
17484 not displaying text. */
17485 while (MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17486 && MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17487 && (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17488 < it.last_visible_y))
17489 ++first_unchanged_at_end_row;
17490
17491 if (!MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17492 || (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17493 >= it.last_visible_y))
17494 first_unchanged_at_end_row = NULL;
17495 else
17496 {
17497 stop_pos = (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17498 + delta);
17499 first_unchanged_at_end_vpos
17500 = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (first_unchanged_at_end_row, current_matrix);
17501 eassert (stop_pos >= Z - END_UNCHANGED);
17502 }
17503 }
17504 else if (last_unchanged_at_beg_row == NULL)
17505 GIVE_UP (19);
17506
17507
17508 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
17509
17510 /* Either there is no unchanged row at the end, or the one we have
17511 now displays text. This is a necessary condition for the window
17512 end pos calculation at the end of this function. */
17513 eassert (first_unchanged_at_end_row == NULL
17514 || MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (first_unchanged_at_end_row));
17515
17516 debug_last_unchanged_at_beg_vpos
17517 = (last_unchanged_at_beg_row
17518 ? MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (last_unchanged_at_beg_row, current_matrix)
17519 : -1);
17520 debug_first_unchanged_at_end_vpos = first_unchanged_at_end_vpos;
17521
17522 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
17523
17524
17525 /* Display new lines. Set last_text_row to the last new line
17526 displayed which has text on it, i.e. might end up as being the
17527 line where the window_end_vpos is. */
17528 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
17529 last_text_row = NULL;
17530 overlay_arrow_seen = 0;
17531 while (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y
17532 && !fonts_changed_p
17533 && (first_unchanged_at_end_row == NULL
17534 || IT_CHARPOS (it) < stop_pos))
17535 {
17536 if (display_line (&it))
17537 last_text_row = it.glyph_row - 1;
17538 }
17539
17540 if (fonts_changed_p)
17541 return -1;
17542
17543
17544 /* Compute differences in buffer positions, y-positions etc. for
17545 lines reused at the bottom of the window. Compute what we can
17546 scroll. */
17547 if (first_unchanged_at_end_row
17548 /* No lines reused because we displayed everything up to the
17549 bottom of the window. */
17550 && it.current_y < it.last_visible_y)
17551 {
17552 dvpos = (it.vpos
17553 - MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (first_unchanged_at_end_row,
17554 current_matrix));
17555 dy = it.current_y - first_unchanged_at_end_row->y;
17556 run.current_y = first_unchanged_at_end_row->y;
17557 run.desired_y = run.current_y + dy;
17558 run.height = it.last_visible_y - max (run.current_y, run.desired_y);
17559 }
17560 else
17561 {
17562 delta = delta_bytes = dvpos = dy
17563 = run.current_y = run.desired_y = run.height = 0;
17564 first_unchanged_at_end_row = NULL;
17565 }
17566 IF_DEBUG (debug_dvpos = dvpos; debug_dy = dy);
17567
17568
17569 /* Find the cursor if not already found. We have to decide whether
17570 PT will appear on this window (it sometimes doesn't, but this is
17571 not a very frequent case.) This decision has to be made before
17572 the current matrix is altered. A value of cursor.vpos < 0 means
17573 that PT is either in one of the lines beginning at
17574 first_unchanged_at_end_row or below the window. Don't care for
17575 lines that might be displayed later at the window end; as
17576 mentioned, this is not a frequent case. */
17577 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
17578 {
17579 /* Cursor in unchanged rows at the top? */
17580 if (PT < CHARPOS (start_pos)
17581 && last_unchanged_at_beg_row)
17582 {
17583 row = row_containing_pos (w, PT,
17584 MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix),
17585 last_unchanged_at_beg_row + 1, 0);
17586 if (row)
17587 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
17588 }
17589
17590 /* Start from first_unchanged_at_end_row looking for PT. */
17591 else if (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17592 {
17593 row = row_containing_pos (w, PT - delta,
17594 first_unchanged_at_end_row, NULL, 0);
17595 if (row)
17596 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix, delta,
17597 delta_bytes, dy, dvpos);
17598 }
17599
17600 /* Give up if cursor was not found. */
17601 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
17602 {
17603 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
17604 return -1;
17605 }
17606 }
17607
17608 /* Don't let the cursor end in the scroll margins. */
17609 {
17610 int this_scroll_margin, cursor_height;
17611
17612 this_scroll_margin =
17613 max (0, min (scroll_margin, WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) / 4));
17614 this_scroll_margin *= FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (it.f);
17615 cursor_height = MATRIX_ROW (w->desired_matrix, w->cursor.vpos)->height;
17616
17617 if ((w->cursor.y < this_scroll_margin
17618 && CHARPOS (start) > BEGV)
17619 /* Old redisplay didn't take scroll margin into account at the bottom,
17620 but then global-hl-line-mode doesn't scroll. KFS 2004-06-14 */
17621 || (w->cursor.y + (make_cursor_line_fully_visible_p
17622 ? cursor_height + this_scroll_margin
17623 : 1)) > it.last_visible_y)
17624 {
17625 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
17626 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
17627 return -1;
17628 }
17629 }
17630
17631 /* Scroll the display. Do it before changing the current matrix so
17632 that xterm.c doesn't get confused about where the cursor glyph is
17633 found. */
17634 if (dy && run.height)
17635 {
17636 update_begin (f);
17637
17638 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
17639 {
17640 FRAME_RIF (f)->update_window_begin_hook (w);
17641 FRAME_RIF (f)->clear_window_mouse_face (w);
17642 FRAME_RIF (f)->scroll_run_hook (w, &run);
17643 FRAME_RIF (f)->update_window_end_hook (w, 0, 0);
17644 }
17645 else
17646 {
17647 /* Terminal frame. In this case, dvpos gives the number of
17648 lines to scroll by; dvpos < 0 means scroll up. */
17649 int from_vpos
17650 = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (first_unchanged_at_end_row, w->current_matrix);
17651 int from = WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_LINE (w) + from_vpos;
17652 int end = (WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_LINE (w)
17653 + (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w) ? 1 : 0)
17654 + window_internal_height (w));
17655
17656 #if defined (HAVE_GPM) || defined (MSDOS)
17657 x_clear_window_mouse_face (w);
17658 #endif
17659 /* Perform the operation on the screen. */
17660 if (dvpos > 0)
17661 {
17662 /* Scroll last_unchanged_at_beg_row to the end of the
17663 window down dvpos lines. */
17664 set_terminal_window (f, end);
17665
17666 /* On dumb terminals delete dvpos lines at the end
17667 before inserting dvpos empty lines. */
17668 if (!FRAME_SCROLL_REGION_OK (f))
17669 ins_del_lines (f, end - dvpos, -dvpos);
17670
17671 /* Insert dvpos empty lines in front of
17672 last_unchanged_at_beg_row. */
17673 ins_del_lines (f, from, dvpos);
17674 }
17675 else if (dvpos < 0)
17676 {
17677 /* Scroll up last_unchanged_at_beg_vpos to the end of
17678 the window to last_unchanged_at_beg_vpos - |dvpos|. */
17679 set_terminal_window (f, end);
17680
17681 /* Delete dvpos lines in front of
17682 last_unchanged_at_beg_vpos. ins_del_lines will set
17683 the cursor to the given vpos and emit |dvpos| delete
17684 line sequences. */
17685 ins_del_lines (f, from + dvpos, dvpos);
17686
17687 /* On a dumb terminal insert dvpos empty lines at the
17688 end. */
17689 if (!FRAME_SCROLL_REGION_OK (f))
17690 ins_del_lines (f, end + dvpos, -dvpos);
17691 }
17692
17693 set_terminal_window (f, 0);
17694 }
17695
17696 update_end (f);
17697 }
17698
17699 /* Shift reused rows of the current matrix to the right position.
17700 BOTTOM_ROW is the last + 1 row in the current matrix reserved for
17701 text. */
17702 bottom_row = MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (current_matrix, w);
17703 bottom_vpos = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (bottom_row, current_matrix);
17704 if (dvpos < 0)
17705 {
17706 rotate_matrix (current_matrix, first_unchanged_at_end_vpos + dvpos,
17707 bottom_vpos, dvpos);
17708 enable_glyph_matrix_rows (current_matrix, bottom_vpos + dvpos,
17709 bottom_vpos, 0);
17710 }
17711 else if (dvpos > 0)
17712 {
17713 rotate_matrix (current_matrix, first_unchanged_at_end_vpos,
17714 bottom_vpos, dvpos);
17715 enable_glyph_matrix_rows (current_matrix, first_unchanged_at_end_vpos,
17716 first_unchanged_at_end_vpos + dvpos, 0);
17717 }
17718
17719 /* For frame-based redisplay, make sure that current frame and window
17720 matrix are in sync with respect to glyph memory. */
17721 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
17722 sync_frame_with_window_matrix_rows (w);
17723
17724 /* Adjust buffer positions in reused rows. */
17725 if (delta || delta_bytes)
17726 increment_matrix_positions (current_matrix,
17727 first_unchanged_at_end_vpos + dvpos,
17728 bottom_vpos, delta, delta_bytes);
17729
17730 /* Adjust Y positions. */
17731 if (dy)
17732 shift_glyph_matrix (w, current_matrix,
17733 first_unchanged_at_end_vpos + dvpos,
17734 bottom_vpos, dy);
17735
17736 if (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17737 {
17738 first_unchanged_at_end_row += dvpos;
17739 if (first_unchanged_at_end_row->y >= it.last_visible_y
17740 || !MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (first_unchanged_at_end_row))
17741 first_unchanged_at_end_row = NULL;
17742 }
17743
17744 /* If scrolling up, there may be some lines to display at the end of
17745 the window. */
17746 last_text_row_at_end = NULL;
17747 if (dy < 0)
17748 {
17749 /* Scrolling up can leave for example a partially visible line
17750 at the end of the window to be redisplayed. */
17751 /* Set last_row to the glyph row in the current matrix where the
17752 window end line is found. It has been moved up or down in
17753 the matrix by dvpos. */
17754 int last_vpos = XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos) + dvpos;
17755 struct glyph_row *last_row = MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, last_vpos);
17756
17757 /* If last_row is the window end line, it should display text. */
17758 eassert (last_row->displays_text_p);
17759
17760 /* If window end line was partially visible before, begin
17761 displaying at that line. Otherwise begin displaying with the
17762 line following it. */
17763 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (last_row) - dy >= it.last_visible_y)
17764 {
17765 init_to_row_start (&it, w, last_row);
17766 it.vpos = last_vpos;
17767 it.current_y = last_row->y;
17768 }
17769 else
17770 {
17771 init_to_row_end (&it, w, last_row);
17772 it.vpos = 1 + last_vpos;
17773 it.current_y = MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (last_row);
17774 ++last_row;
17775 }
17776
17777 /* We may start in a continuation line. If so, we have to
17778 get the right continuation_lines_width and current_x. */
17779 it.continuation_lines_width = last_row->continuation_lines_width;
17780 it.hpos = it.current_x = 0;
17781
17782 /* Display the rest of the lines at the window end. */
17783 it.glyph_row = MATRIX_ROW (desired_matrix, it.vpos);
17784 while (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y
17785 && !fonts_changed_p)
17786 {
17787 /* Is it always sure that the display agrees with lines in
17788 the current matrix? I don't think so, so we mark rows
17789 displayed invalid in the current matrix by setting their
17790 enabled_p flag to zero. */
17791 MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, it.vpos)->enabled_p = 0;
17792 if (display_line (&it))
17793 last_text_row_at_end = it.glyph_row - 1;
17794 }
17795 }
17796
17797 /* Update window_end_pos and window_end_vpos. */
17798 if (first_unchanged_at_end_row
17799 && !last_text_row_at_end)
17800 {
17801 /* Window end line if one of the preserved rows from the current
17802 matrix. Set row to the last row displaying text in current
17803 matrix starting at first_unchanged_at_end_row, after
17804 scrolling. */
17805 eassert (first_unchanged_at_end_row->displays_text_p);
17806 row = find_last_row_displaying_text (w->current_matrix, &it,
17807 first_unchanged_at_end_row);
17808 eassert (row && MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row));
17809
17810 wset_window_end_pos (w, make_number (Z - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)));
17811 w->window_end_bytepos = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (row);
17812 wset_window_end_vpos
17813 (w, make_number (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (row, w->current_matrix)));
17814 eassert (w->window_end_bytepos >= 0);
17815 IF_DEBUG (debug_method_add (w, "A"));
17816 }
17817 else if (last_text_row_at_end)
17818 {
17819 wset_window_end_pos
17820 (w, make_number (Z - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (last_text_row_at_end)));
17821 w->window_end_bytepos
17822 = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (last_text_row_at_end);
17823 wset_window_end_vpos
17824 (w, make_number (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (last_text_row_at_end,
17825 desired_matrix)));
17826 eassert (w->window_end_bytepos >= 0);
17827 IF_DEBUG (debug_method_add (w, "B"));
17828 }
17829 else if (last_text_row)
17830 {
17831 /* We have displayed either to the end of the window or at the
17832 end of the window, i.e. the last row with text is to be found
17833 in the desired matrix. */
17834 wset_window_end_pos
17835 (w, make_number (Z - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (last_text_row)));
17836 w->window_end_bytepos
17837 = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (last_text_row);
17838 wset_window_end_vpos
17839 (w, make_number (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (last_text_row, desired_matrix)));
17840 eassert (w->window_end_bytepos >= 0);
17841 }
17842 else if (first_unchanged_at_end_row == NULL
17843 && last_text_row == NULL
17844 && last_text_row_at_end == NULL)
17845 {
17846 /* Displayed to end of window, but no line containing text was
17847 displayed. Lines were deleted at the end of the window. */
17848 int first_vpos = WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w) ? 1 : 0;
17849 int vpos = XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos);
17850 struct glyph_row *current_row = current_matrix->rows + vpos;
17851 struct glyph_row *desired_row = desired_matrix->rows + vpos;
17852
17853 for (row = NULL;
17854 row == NULL && vpos >= first_vpos;
17855 --vpos, --current_row, --desired_row)
17856 {
17857 if (desired_row->enabled_p)
17858 {
17859 if (desired_row->displays_text_p)
17860 row = desired_row;
17861 }
17862 else if (current_row->displays_text_p)
17863 row = current_row;
17864 }
17865
17866 eassert (row != NULL);
17867 wset_window_end_vpos (w, make_number (vpos + 1));
17868 wset_window_end_pos (w, make_number (Z - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)));
17869 w->window_end_bytepos = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (row);
17870 eassert (w->window_end_bytepos >= 0);
17871 IF_DEBUG (debug_method_add (w, "C"));
17872 }
17873 else
17874 abort ();
17875
17876 IF_DEBUG (debug_end_pos = XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos);
17877 debug_end_vpos = XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos));
17878
17879 /* Record that display has not been completed. */
17880 wset_window_end_valid (w, Qnil);
17881 w->desired_matrix->no_scrolling_p = 1;
17882 return 3;
17883
17884 #undef GIVE_UP
17885 }
17886
17887
17888 \f
17889 /***********************************************************************
17890 More debugging support
17891 ***********************************************************************/
17892
17893 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
17894
17895 void dump_glyph_row (struct glyph_row *, int, int) EXTERNALLY_VISIBLE;
17896 void dump_glyph_matrix (struct glyph_matrix *, int) EXTERNALLY_VISIBLE;
17897 void dump_glyph (struct glyph_row *, struct glyph *, int) EXTERNALLY_VISIBLE;
17898
17899
17900 /* Dump the contents of glyph matrix MATRIX on stderr.
17901
17902 GLYPHS 0 means don't show glyph contents.
17903 GLYPHS 1 means show glyphs in short form
17904 GLYPHS > 1 means show glyphs in long form. */
17905
17906 void
17907 dump_glyph_matrix (struct glyph_matrix *matrix, int glyphs)
17908 {
17909 int i;
17910 for (i = 0; i < matrix->nrows; ++i)
17911 dump_glyph_row (MATRIX_ROW (matrix, i), i, glyphs);
17912 }
17913
17914
17915 /* Dump contents of glyph GLYPH to stderr. ROW and AREA are
17916 the glyph row and area where the glyph comes from. */
17917
17918 void
17919 dump_glyph (struct glyph_row *row, struct glyph *glyph, int area)
17920 {
17921 if (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
17922 {
17923 fprintf (stderr,
17924 " %5td %4c %6"pI"d %c %3d 0x%05x %c %4d %1.1d%1.1d\n",
17925 glyph - row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA],
17926 'C',
17927 glyph->charpos,
17928 (BUFFERP (glyph->object)
17929 ? 'B'
17930 : (STRINGP (glyph->object)
17931 ? 'S'
17932 : '-')),
17933 glyph->pixel_width,
17934 glyph->u.ch,
17935 (glyph->u.ch < 0x80 && glyph->u.ch >= ' '
17936 ? glyph->u.ch
17937 : '.'),
17938 glyph->face_id,
17939 glyph->left_box_line_p,
17940 glyph->right_box_line_p);
17941 }
17942 else if (glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH)
17943 {
17944 fprintf (stderr,
17945 " %5td %4c %6"pI"d %c %3d 0x%05x %c %4d %1.1d%1.1d\n",
17946 glyph - row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA],
17947 'S',
17948 glyph->charpos,
17949 (BUFFERP (glyph->object)
17950 ? 'B'
17951 : (STRINGP (glyph->object)
17952 ? 'S'
17953 : '-')),
17954 glyph->pixel_width,
17955 0,
17956 '.',
17957 glyph->face_id,
17958 glyph->left_box_line_p,
17959 glyph->right_box_line_p);
17960 }
17961 else if (glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
17962 {
17963 fprintf (stderr,
17964 " %5td %4c %6"pI"d %c %3d 0x%05x %c %4d %1.1d%1.1d\n",
17965 glyph - row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA],
17966 'I',
17967 glyph->charpos,
17968 (BUFFERP (glyph->object)
17969 ? 'B'
17970 : (STRINGP (glyph->object)
17971 ? 'S'
17972 : '-')),
17973 glyph->pixel_width,
17974 glyph->u.img_id,
17975 '.',
17976 glyph->face_id,
17977 glyph->left_box_line_p,
17978 glyph->right_box_line_p);
17979 }
17980 else if (glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH)
17981 {
17982 fprintf (stderr,
17983 " %5td %4c %6"pI"d %c %3d 0x%05x",
17984 glyph - row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA],
17985 '+',
17986 glyph->charpos,
17987 (BUFFERP (glyph->object)
17988 ? 'B'
17989 : (STRINGP (glyph->object)
17990 ? 'S'
17991 : '-')),
17992 glyph->pixel_width,
17993 glyph->u.cmp.id);
17994 if (glyph->u.cmp.automatic)
17995 fprintf (stderr,
17996 "[%d-%d]",
17997 glyph->slice.cmp.from, glyph->slice.cmp.to);
17998 fprintf (stderr, " . %4d %1.1d%1.1d\n",
17999 glyph->face_id,
18000 glyph->left_box_line_p,
18001 glyph->right_box_line_p);
18002 }
18003 }
18004
18005
18006 /* Dump the contents of glyph row at VPOS in MATRIX to stderr.
18007 GLYPHS 0 means don't show glyph contents.
18008 GLYPHS 1 means show glyphs in short form
18009 GLYPHS > 1 means show glyphs in long form. */
18010
18011 void
18012 dump_glyph_row (struct glyph_row *row, int vpos, int glyphs)
18013 {
18014 if (glyphs != 1)
18015 {
18016 fprintf (stderr, "Row Start End Used oE><\\CTZFesm X Y W H V A P\n");
18017 fprintf (stderr, "======================================================================\n");
18018
18019 fprintf (stderr, "%3d %5"pI"d %5"pI"d %4d %1.1d%1.1d%1.1d%1.1d\
18020 %1.1d%1.1d%1.1d%1.1d%1.1d%1.1d%1.1d%1.1d %4d %4d %4d %4d %4d %4d %4d\n",
18021 vpos,
18022 MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row),
18023 MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row),
18024 row->used[TEXT_AREA],
18025 row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p,
18026 row->enabled_p,
18027 row->truncated_on_left_p,
18028 row->truncated_on_right_p,
18029 row->continued_p,
18030 MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (row),
18031 row->displays_text_p,
18032 row->ends_at_zv_p,
18033 row->fill_line_p,
18034 row->ends_in_middle_of_char_p,
18035 row->starts_in_middle_of_char_p,
18036 row->mouse_face_p,
18037 row->x,
18038 row->y,
18039 row->pixel_width,
18040 row->height,
18041 row->visible_height,
18042 row->ascent,
18043 row->phys_ascent);
18044 fprintf (stderr, "%9"pD"d %5"pD"d\t%5d\n", row->start.overlay_string_index,
18045 row->end.overlay_string_index,
18046 row->continuation_lines_width);
18047 fprintf (stderr, "%9"pI"d %5"pI"d\n",
18048 CHARPOS (row->start.string_pos),
18049 CHARPOS (row->end.string_pos));
18050 fprintf (stderr, "%9d %5d\n", row->start.dpvec_index,
18051 row->end.dpvec_index);
18052 }
18053
18054 if (glyphs > 1)
18055 {
18056 int area;
18057
18058 for (area = LEFT_MARGIN_AREA; area < LAST_AREA; ++area)
18059 {
18060 struct glyph *glyph = row->glyphs[area];
18061 struct glyph *glyph_end = glyph + row->used[area];
18062
18063 /* Glyph for a line end in text. */
18064 if (area == TEXT_AREA && glyph == glyph_end && glyph->charpos > 0)
18065 ++glyph_end;
18066
18067 if (glyph < glyph_end)
18068 fprintf (stderr, " Glyph Type Pos O W Code C Face LR\n");
18069
18070 for (; glyph < glyph_end; ++glyph)
18071 dump_glyph (row, glyph, area);
18072 }
18073 }
18074 else if (glyphs == 1)
18075 {
18076 int area;
18077
18078 for (area = LEFT_MARGIN_AREA; area < LAST_AREA; ++area)
18079 {
18080 char *s = alloca (row->used[area] + 1);
18081 int i;
18082
18083 for (i = 0; i < row->used[area]; ++i)
18084 {
18085 struct glyph *glyph = row->glyphs[area] + i;
18086 if (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
18087 && glyph->u.ch < 0x80
18088 && glyph->u.ch >= ' ')
18089 s[i] = glyph->u.ch;
18090 else
18091 s[i] = '.';
18092 }
18093
18094 s[i] = '\0';
18095 fprintf (stderr, "%3d: (%d) '%s'\n", vpos, row->enabled_p, s);
18096 }
18097 }
18098 }
18099
18100
18101 DEFUN ("dump-glyph-matrix", Fdump_glyph_matrix,
18102 Sdump_glyph_matrix, 0, 1, "p",
18103 doc: /* Dump the current matrix of the selected window to stderr.
18104 Shows contents of glyph row structures. With non-nil
18105 parameter GLYPHS, dump glyphs as well. If GLYPHS is 1 show
18106 glyphs in short form, otherwise show glyphs in long form. */)
18107 (Lisp_Object glyphs)
18108 {
18109 struct window *w = XWINDOW (selected_window);
18110 struct buffer *buffer = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
18111
18112 fprintf (stderr, "PT = %"pI"d, BEGV = %"pI"d. ZV = %"pI"d\n",
18113 BUF_PT (buffer), BUF_BEGV (buffer), BUF_ZV (buffer));
18114 fprintf (stderr, "Cursor x = %d, y = %d, hpos = %d, vpos = %d\n",
18115 w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y, w->cursor.hpos, w->cursor.vpos);
18116 fprintf (stderr, "=============================================\n");
18117 dump_glyph_matrix (w->current_matrix,
18118 TYPE_RANGED_INTEGERP (int, glyphs) ? XINT (glyphs) : 0);
18119 return Qnil;
18120 }
18121
18122
18123 DEFUN ("dump-frame-glyph-matrix", Fdump_frame_glyph_matrix,
18124 Sdump_frame_glyph_matrix, 0, 0, "", doc: /* */)
18125 (void)
18126 {
18127 struct frame *f = XFRAME (selected_frame);
18128 dump_glyph_matrix (f->current_matrix, 1);
18129 return Qnil;
18130 }
18131
18132
18133 DEFUN ("dump-glyph-row", Fdump_glyph_row, Sdump_glyph_row, 1, 2, "",
18134 doc: /* Dump glyph row ROW to stderr.
18135 GLYPH 0 means don't dump glyphs.
18136 GLYPH 1 means dump glyphs in short form.
18137 GLYPH > 1 or omitted means dump glyphs in long form. */)
18138 (Lisp_Object row, Lisp_Object glyphs)
18139 {
18140 struct glyph_matrix *matrix;
18141 EMACS_INT vpos;
18142
18143 CHECK_NUMBER (row);
18144 matrix = XWINDOW (selected_window)->current_matrix;
18145 vpos = XINT (row);
18146 if (vpos >= 0 && vpos < matrix->nrows)
18147 dump_glyph_row (MATRIX_ROW (matrix, vpos),
18148 vpos,
18149 TYPE_RANGED_INTEGERP (int, glyphs) ? XINT (glyphs) : 2);
18150 return Qnil;
18151 }
18152
18153
18154 DEFUN ("dump-tool-bar-row", Fdump_tool_bar_row, Sdump_tool_bar_row, 1, 2, "",
18155 doc: /* Dump glyph row ROW of the tool-bar of the current frame to stderr.
18156 GLYPH 0 means don't dump glyphs.
18157 GLYPH 1 means dump glyphs in short form.
18158 GLYPH > 1 or omitted means dump glyphs in long form. */)
18159 (Lisp_Object row, Lisp_Object glyphs)
18160 {
18161 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
18162 struct glyph_matrix *m = XWINDOW (sf->tool_bar_window)->current_matrix;
18163 EMACS_INT vpos;
18164
18165 CHECK_NUMBER (row);
18166 vpos = XINT (row);
18167 if (vpos >= 0 && vpos < m->nrows)
18168 dump_glyph_row (MATRIX_ROW (m, vpos), vpos,
18169 TYPE_RANGED_INTEGERP (int, glyphs) ? XINT (glyphs) : 2);
18170 return Qnil;
18171 }
18172
18173
18174 DEFUN ("trace-redisplay", Ftrace_redisplay, Strace_redisplay, 0, 1, "P",
18175 doc: /* Toggle tracing of redisplay.
18176 With ARG, turn tracing on if and only if ARG is positive. */)
18177 (Lisp_Object arg)
18178 {
18179 if (NILP (arg))
18180 trace_redisplay_p = !trace_redisplay_p;
18181 else
18182 {
18183 arg = Fprefix_numeric_value (arg);
18184 trace_redisplay_p = XINT (arg) > 0;
18185 }
18186
18187 return Qnil;
18188 }
18189
18190
18191 DEFUN ("trace-to-stderr", Ftrace_to_stderr, Strace_to_stderr, 1, MANY, "",
18192 doc: /* Like `format', but print result to stderr.
18193 usage: (trace-to-stderr STRING &rest OBJECTS) */)
18194 (ptrdiff_t nargs, Lisp_Object *args)
18195 {
18196 Lisp_Object s = Fformat (nargs, args);
18197 fprintf (stderr, "%s", SDATA (s));
18198 return Qnil;
18199 }
18200
18201 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
18202
18203
18204 \f
18205 /***********************************************************************
18206 Building Desired Matrix Rows
18207 ***********************************************************************/
18208
18209 /* Return a temporary glyph row holding the glyphs of an overlay arrow.
18210 Used for non-window-redisplay windows, and for windows w/o left fringe. */
18211
18212 static struct glyph_row *
18213 get_overlay_arrow_glyph_row (struct window *w, Lisp_Object overlay_arrow_string)
18214 {
18215 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
18216 struct buffer *buffer = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
18217 struct buffer *old = current_buffer;
18218 const unsigned char *arrow_string = SDATA (overlay_arrow_string);
18219 int arrow_len = SCHARS (overlay_arrow_string);
18220 const unsigned char *arrow_end = arrow_string + arrow_len;
18221 const unsigned char *p;
18222 struct it it;
18223 int multibyte_p;
18224 int n_glyphs_before;
18225
18226 set_buffer_temp (buffer);
18227 init_iterator (&it, w, -1, -1, &scratch_glyph_row, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
18228 it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] = 0;
18229 SET_TEXT_POS (it.position, 0, 0);
18230
18231 multibyte_p = !NILP (BVAR (buffer, enable_multibyte_characters));
18232 p = arrow_string;
18233 while (p < arrow_end)
18234 {
18235 Lisp_Object face, ilisp;
18236
18237 /* Get the next character. */
18238 if (multibyte_p)
18239 it.c = it.char_to_display = string_char_and_length (p, &it.len);
18240 else
18241 {
18242 it.c = it.char_to_display = *p, it.len = 1;
18243 if (! ASCII_CHAR_P (it.c))
18244 it.char_to_display = BYTE8_TO_CHAR (it.c);
18245 }
18246 p += it.len;
18247
18248 /* Get its face. */
18249 ilisp = make_number (p - arrow_string);
18250 face = Fget_text_property (ilisp, Qface, overlay_arrow_string);
18251 it.face_id = compute_char_face (f, it.char_to_display, face);
18252
18253 /* Compute its width, get its glyphs. */
18254 n_glyphs_before = it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18255 SET_TEXT_POS (it.position, -1, -1);
18256 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (&it);
18257
18258 /* If this character doesn't fit any more in the line, we have
18259 to remove some glyphs. */
18260 if (it.current_x > it.last_visible_x)
18261 {
18262 it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] = n_glyphs_before;
18263 break;
18264 }
18265 }
18266
18267 set_buffer_temp (old);
18268 return it.glyph_row;
18269 }
18270
18271
18272 /* Insert truncation glyphs at the start of IT->glyph_row. Which
18273 glyphs to insert is determined by produce_special_glyphs. */
18274
18275 static void
18276 insert_left_trunc_glyphs (struct it *it)
18277 {
18278 struct it truncate_it;
18279 struct glyph *from, *end, *to, *toend;
18280
18281 eassert (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
18282 || (!it->glyph_row->reversed_p
18283 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w) == 0)
18284 || (it->glyph_row->reversed_p
18285 && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w) == 0));
18286
18287 /* Get the truncation glyphs. */
18288 truncate_it = *it;
18289 truncate_it.current_x = 0;
18290 truncate_it.face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
18291 truncate_it.glyph_row = &scratch_glyph_row;
18292 truncate_it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] = 0;
18293 CHARPOS (truncate_it.position) = BYTEPOS (truncate_it.position) = -1;
18294 truncate_it.object = make_number (0);
18295 produce_special_glyphs (&truncate_it, IT_TRUNCATION);
18296
18297 /* Overwrite glyphs from IT with truncation glyphs. */
18298 if (!it->glyph_row->reversed_p)
18299 {
18300 short tused = truncate_it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18301
18302 from = truncate_it.glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18303 end = from + tused;
18304 to = it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18305 toend = to + it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18306 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
18307 {
18308 /* On GUI frames, when variable-size fonts are displayed,
18309 the truncation glyphs may need more pixels than the row's
18310 glyphs they overwrite. We overwrite more glyphs to free
18311 enough screen real estate, and enlarge the stretch glyph
18312 on the right (see display_line), if there is one, to
18313 preserve the screen position of the truncation glyphs on
18314 the right. */
18315 int w = 0;
18316 struct glyph *g = to;
18317 short used;
18318
18319 /* The first glyph could be partially visible, in which case
18320 it->glyph_row->x will be negative. But we want the left
18321 truncation glyphs to be aligned at the left margin of the
18322 window, so we override the x coordinate at which the row
18323 will begin. */
18324 it->glyph_row->x = 0;
18325 while (g < toend && w < it->truncation_pixel_width)
18326 {
18327 w += g->pixel_width;
18328 ++g;
18329 }
18330 if (g - to - tused > 0)
18331 {
18332 memmove (to + tused, g, (toend - g) * sizeof(*g));
18333 it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] -= g - to - tused;
18334 }
18335 used = it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18336 if (it->glyph_row->truncated_on_right_p
18337 && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w) == 0
18338 && it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][used - 2].type
18339 == STRETCH_GLYPH)
18340 {
18341 int extra = w - it->truncation_pixel_width;
18342
18343 it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][used - 2].pixel_width += extra;
18344 }
18345 }
18346
18347 while (from < end)
18348 *to++ = *from++;
18349
18350 /* There may be padding glyphs left over. Overwrite them too. */
18351 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
18352 {
18353 while (to < toend && CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (*to))
18354 {
18355 from = truncate_it.glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18356 while (from < end)
18357 *to++ = *from++;
18358 }
18359 }
18360
18361 if (to > toend)
18362 it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] = to - it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18363 }
18364 else
18365 {
18366 short tused = truncate_it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18367
18368 /* In R2L rows, overwrite the last (rightmost) glyphs, and do
18369 that back to front. */
18370 end = truncate_it.glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18371 from = end + truncate_it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
18372 toend = it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18373 to = toend + it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
18374 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
18375 {
18376 int w = 0;
18377 struct glyph *g = to;
18378
18379 while (g >= toend && w < it->truncation_pixel_width)
18380 {
18381 w += g->pixel_width;
18382 --g;
18383 }
18384 if (to - g - tused > 0)
18385 to = g + tused;
18386 if (it->glyph_row->truncated_on_right_p
18387 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w) == 0
18388 && it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][1].type == STRETCH_GLYPH)
18389 {
18390 int extra = w - it->truncation_pixel_width;
18391
18392 it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][1].pixel_width += extra;
18393 }
18394 }
18395
18396 while (from >= end && to >= toend)
18397 *to-- = *from--;
18398 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
18399 {
18400 while (to >= toend && CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (*to))
18401 {
18402 from =
18403 truncate_it.glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]
18404 + truncate_it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
18405 while (from >= end && to >= toend)
18406 *to-- = *from--;
18407 }
18408 }
18409 if (from >= end)
18410 {
18411 /* Need to free some room before prepending additional
18412 glyphs. */
18413 int move_by = from - end + 1;
18414 struct glyph *g0 = it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18415 struct glyph *g = g0 + it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
18416
18417 for ( ; g >= g0; g--)
18418 g[move_by] = *g;
18419 while (from >= end)
18420 *to-- = *from--;
18421 it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] += move_by;
18422 }
18423 }
18424 }
18425
18426 /* Compute the hash code for ROW. */
18427 unsigned
18428 row_hash (struct glyph_row *row)
18429 {
18430 int area, k;
18431 unsigned hashval = 0;
18432
18433 for (area = LEFT_MARGIN_AREA; area < LAST_AREA; ++area)
18434 for (k = 0; k < row->used[area]; ++k)
18435 hashval = ((((hashval << 4) + (hashval >> 24)) & 0x0fffffff)
18436 + row->glyphs[area][k].u.val
18437 + row->glyphs[area][k].face_id
18438 + row->glyphs[area][k].padding_p
18439 + (row->glyphs[area][k].type << 2));
18440
18441 return hashval;
18442 }
18443
18444 /* Compute the pixel height and width of IT->glyph_row.
18445
18446 Most of the time, ascent and height of a display line will be equal
18447 to the max_ascent and max_height values of the display iterator
18448 structure. This is not the case if
18449
18450 1. We hit ZV without displaying anything. In this case, max_ascent
18451 and max_height will be zero.
18452
18453 2. We have some glyphs that don't contribute to the line height.
18454 (The glyph row flag contributes_to_line_height_p is for future
18455 pixmap extensions).
18456
18457 The first case is easily covered by using default values because in
18458 these cases, the line height does not really matter, except that it
18459 must not be zero. */
18460
18461 static void
18462 compute_line_metrics (struct it *it)
18463 {
18464 struct glyph_row *row = it->glyph_row;
18465
18466 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
18467 {
18468 int i, min_y, max_y;
18469
18470 /* The line may consist of one space only, that was added to
18471 place the cursor on it. If so, the row's height hasn't been
18472 computed yet. */
18473 if (row->height == 0)
18474 {
18475 if (it->max_ascent + it->max_descent == 0)
18476 it->max_descent = it->max_phys_descent = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (it->f);
18477 row->ascent = it->max_ascent;
18478 row->height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
18479 row->phys_ascent = it->max_phys_ascent;
18480 row->phys_height = it->max_phys_ascent + it->max_phys_descent;
18481 row->extra_line_spacing = it->max_extra_line_spacing;
18482 }
18483
18484 /* Compute the width of this line. */
18485 row->pixel_width = row->x;
18486 for (i = 0; i < row->used[TEXT_AREA]; ++i)
18487 row->pixel_width += row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][i].pixel_width;
18488
18489 eassert (row->pixel_width >= 0);
18490 eassert (row->ascent >= 0 && row->height > 0);
18491
18492 row->overlapping_p = (MATRIX_ROW_OVERLAPS_SUCC_P (row)
18493 || MATRIX_ROW_OVERLAPS_PRED_P (row));
18494
18495 /* If first line's physical ascent is larger than its logical
18496 ascent, use the physical ascent, and make the row taller.
18497 This makes accented characters fully visible. */
18498 if (row == MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (it->w->desired_matrix)
18499 && row->phys_ascent > row->ascent)
18500 {
18501 row->height += row->phys_ascent - row->ascent;
18502 row->ascent = row->phys_ascent;
18503 }
18504
18505 /* Compute how much of the line is visible. */
18506 row->visible_height = row->height;
18507
18508 min_y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (it->w);
18509 max_y = WINDOW_BOX_HEIGHT_NO_MODE_LINE (it->w);
18510
18511 if (row->y < min_y)
18512 row->visible_height -= min_y - row->y;
18513 if (row->y + row->height > max_y)
18514 row->visible_height -= row->y + row->height - max_y;
18515 }
18516 else
18517 {
18518 row->pixel_width = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18519 if (row->continued_p)
18520 row->pixel_width -= it->continuation_pixel_width;
18521 else if (row->truncated_on_right_p)
18522 row->pixel_width -= it->truncation_pixel_width;
18523 row->ascent = row->phys_ascent = 0;
18524 row->height = row->phys_height = row->visible_height = 1;
18525 row->extra_line_spacing = 0;
18526 }
18527
18528 /* Compute a hash code for this row. */
18529 row->hash = row_hash (row);
18530
18531 it->max_ascent = it->max_descent = 0;
18532 it->max_phys_ascent = it->max_phys_descent = 0;
18533 }
18534
18535
18536 /* Append one space to the glyph row of iterator IT if doing a
18537 window-based redisplay. The space has the same face as
18538 IT->face_id. Value is non-zero if a space was added.
18539
18540 This function is called to make sure that there is always one glyph
18541 at the end of a glyph row that the cursor can be set on under
18542 window-systems. (If there weren't such a glyph we would not know
18543 how wide and tall a box cursor should be displayed).
18544
18545 At the same time this space let's a nicely handle clearing to the
18546 end of the line if the row ends in italic text. */
18547
18548 static int
18549 append_space_for_newline (struct it *it, int default_face_p)
18550 {
18551 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
18552 {
18553 int n = it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18554
18555 if (it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + n
18556 < it->glyph_row->glyphs[1 + TEXT_AREA])
18557 {
18558 /* Save some values that must not be changed.
18559 Must save IT->c and IT->len because otherwise
18560 ITERATOR_AT_END_P wouldn't work anymore after
18561 append_space_for_newline has been called. */
18562 enum display_element_type saved_what = it->what;
18563 int saved_c = it->c, saved_len = it->len;
18564 int saved_char_to_display = it->char_to_display;
18565 int saved_x = it->current_x;
18566 int saved_face_id = it->face_id;
18567 struct text_pos saved_pos;
18568 Lisp_Object saved_object;
18569 struct face *face;
18570
18571 saved_object = it->object;
18572 saved_pos = it->position;
18573
18574 it->what = IT_CHARACTER;
18575 memset (&it->position, 0, sizeof it->position);
18576 it->object = make_number (0);
18577 it->c = it->char_to_display = ' ';
18578 it->len = 1;
18579
18580 /* If the default face was remapped, be sure to use the
18581 remapped face for the appended newline. */
18582 if (default_face_p)
18583 it->face_id = lookup_basic_face (it->f, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
18584 else if (it->face_before_selective_p)
18585 it->face_id = it->saved_face_id;
18586 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
18587 it->face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (it->f, face, 0, -1, Qnil);
18588
18589 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
18590
18591 it->override_ascent = -1;
18592 it->constrain_row_ascent_descent_p = 0;
18593 it->current_x = saved_x;
18594 it->object = saved_object;
18595 it->position = saved_pos;
18596 it->what = saved_what;
18597 it->face_id = saved_face_id;
18598 it->len = saved_len;
18599 it->c = saved_c;
18600 it->char_to_display = saved_char_to_display;
18601 return 1;
18602 }
18603 }
18604
18605 return 0;
18606 }
18607
18608
18609 /* Extend the face of the last glyph in the text area of IT->glyph_row
18610 to the end of the display line. Called from display_line. If the
18611 glyph row is empty, add a space glyph to it so that we know the
18612 face to draw. Set the glyph row flag fill_line_p. If the glyph
18613 row is R2L, prepend a stretch glyph to cover the empty space to the
18614 left of the leftmost glyph. */
18615
18616 static void
18617 extend_face_to_end_of_line (struct it *it)
18618 {
18619 struct face *face, *default_face;
18620 struct frame *f = it->f;
18621
18622 /* If line is already filled, do nothing. Non window-system frames
18623 get a grace of one more ``pixel'' because their characters are
18624 1-``pixel'' wide, so they hit the equality too early. This grace
18625 is needed only for R2L rows that are not continued, to produce
18626 one extra blank where we could display the cursor. */
18627 if (it->current_x >= it->last_visible_x
18628 + (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
18629 && it->glyph_row->reversed_p
18630 && !it->glyph_row->continued_p))
18631 return;
18632
18633 /* The default face, possibly remapped. */
18634 default_face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, lookup_basic_face (f, DEFAULT_FACE_ID));
18635
18636 /* Face extension extends the background and box of IT->face_id
18637 to the end of the line. If the background equals the background
18638 of the frame, we don't have to do anything. */
18639 if (it->face_before_selective_p)
18640 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, it->saved_face_id);
18641 else
18642 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, it->face_id);
18643
18644 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
18645 && it->glyph_row->displays_text_p
18646 && face->box == FACE_NO_BOX
18647 && face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f)
18648 && !face->stipple
18649 && !it->glyph_row->reversed_p)
18650 return;
18651
18652 /* Set the glyph row flag indicating that the face of the last glyph
18653 in the text area has to be drawn to the end of the text area. */
18654 it->glyph_row->fill_line_p = 1;
18655
18656 /* If current character of IT is not ASCII, make sure we have the
18657 ASCII face. This will be automatically undone the next time
18658 get_next_display_element returns a multibyte character. Note
18659 that the character will always be single byte in unibyte
18660 text. */
18661 if (!ASCII_CHAR_P (it->c))
18662 {
18663 it->face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (f, face, 0, -1, Qnil);
18664 }
18665
18666 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
18667 {
18668 /* If the row is empty, add a space with the current face of IT,
18669 so that we know which face to draw. */
18670 if (it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] == 0)
18671 {
18672 it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][0] = space_glyph;
18673 it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][0].face_id = face->id;
18674 it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] = 1;
18675 }
18676 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
18677 if (it->glyph_row->reversed_p)
18678 {
18679 /* Prepend a stretch glyph to the row, such that the
18680 rightmost glyph will be drawn flushed all the way to the
18681 right margin of the window. The stretch glyph that will
18682 occupy the empty space, if any, to the left of the
18683 glyphs. */
18684 struct font *font = face->font ? face->font : FRAME_FONT (f);
18685 struct glyph *row_start = it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18686 struct glyph *row_end = row_start + it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18687 struct glyph *g;
18688 int row_width, stretch_ascent, stretch_width;
18689 struct text_pos saved_pos;
18690 int saved_face_id, saved_avoid_cursor;
18691
18692 for (row_width = 0, g = row_start; g < row_end; g++)
18693 row_width += g->pixel_width;
18694 stretch_width = window_box_width (it->w, TEXT_AREA) - row_width;
18695 if (stretch_width > 0)
18696 {
18697 stretch_ascent =
18698 (((it->ascent + it->descent)
18699 * FONT_BASE (font)) / FONT_HEIGHT (font));
18700 saved_pos = it->position;
18701 memset (&it->position, 0, sizeof it->position);
18702 saved_avoid_cursor = it->avoid_cursor_p;
18703 it->avoid_cursor_p = 1;
18704 saved_face_id = it->face_id;
18705 /* The last row's stretch glyph should get the default
18706 face, to avoid painting the rest of the window with
18707 the region face, if the region ends at ZV. */
18708 if (it->glyph_row->ends_at_zv_p)
18709 it->face_id = default_face->id;
18710 else
18711 it->face_id = face->id;
18712 append_stretch_glyph (it, make_number (0), stretch_width,
18713 it->ascent + it->descent, stretch_ascent);
18714 it->position = saved_pos;
18715 it->avoid_cursor_p = saved_avoid_cursor;
18716 it->face_id = saved_face_id;
18717 }
18718 }
18719 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
18720 }
18721 else
18722 {
18723 /* Save some values that must not be changed. */
18724 int saved_x = it->current_x;
18725 struct text_pos saved_pos;
18726 Lisp_Object saved_object;
18727 enum display_element_type saved_what = it->what;
18728 int saved_face_id = it->face_id;
18729
18730 saved_object = it->object;
18731 saved_pos = it->position;
18732
18733 it->what = IT_CHARACTER;
18734 memset (&it->position, 0, sizeof it->position);
18735 it->object = make_number (0);
18736 it->c = it->char_to_display = ' ';
18737 it->len = 1;
18738 /* The last row's blank glyphs should get the default face, to
18739 avoid painting the rest of the window with the region face,
18740 if the region ends at ZV. */
18741 if (it->glyph_row->ends_at_zv_p)
18742 it->face_id = default_face->id;
18743 else
18744 it->face_id = face->id;
18745
18746 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
18747
18748 while (it->current_x <= it->last_visible_x)
18749 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
18750
18751 /* Don't count these blanks really. It would let us insert a left
18752 truncation glyph below and make us set the cursor on them, maybe. */
18753 it->current_x = saved_x;
18754 it->object = saved_object;
18755 it->position = saved_pos;
18756 it->what = saved_what;
18757 it->face_id = saved_face_id;
18758 }
18759 }
18760
18761
18762 /* Value is non-zero if text starting at CHARPOS in current_buffer is
18763 trailing whitespace. */
18764
18765 static int
18766 trailing_whitespace_p (ptrdiff_t charpos)
18767 {
18768 ptrdiff_t bytepos = CHAR_TO_BYTE (charpos);
18769 int c = 0;
18770
18771 while (bytepos < ZV_BYTE
18772 && (c = FETCH_CHAR (bytepos),
18773 c == ' ' || c == '\t'))
18774 ++bytepos;
18775
18776 if (bytepos >= ZV_BYTE || c == '\n' || c == '\r')
18777 {
18778 if (bytepos != PT_BYTE)
18779 return 1;
18780 }
18781 return 0;
18782 }
18783
18784
18785 /* Highlight trailing whitespace, if any, in ROW. */
18786
18787 static void
18788 highlight_trailing_whitespace (struct frame *f, struct glyph_row *row)
18789 {
18790 int used = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18791
18792 if (used)
18793 {
18794 struct glyph *start = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18795 struct glyph *glyph = start + used - 1;
18796
18797 if (row->reversed_p)
18798 {
18799 /* Right-to-left rows need to be processed in the opposite
18800 direction, so swap the edge pointers. */
18801 glyph = start;
18802 start = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + used - 1;
18803 }
18804
18805 /* Skip over glyphs inserted to display the cursor at the
18806 end of a line, for extending the face of the last glyph
18807 to the end of the line on terminals, and for truncation
18808 and continuation glyphs. */
18809 if (!row->reversed_p)
18810 {
18811 while (glyph >= start
18812 && glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
18813 && INTEGERP (glyph->object))
18814 --glyph;
18815 }
18816 else
18817 {
18818 while (glyph <= start
18819 && glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
18820 && INTEGERP (glyph->object))
18821 ++glyph;
18822 }
18823
18824 /* If last glyph is a space or stretch, and it's trailing
18825 whitespace, set the face of all trailing whitespace glyphs in
18826 IT->glyph_row to `trailing-whitespace'. */
18827 if ((row->reversed_p ? glyph <= start : glyph >= start)
18828 && BUFFERP (glyph->object)
18829 && (glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
18830 || (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
18831 && glyph->u.ch == ' '))
18832 && trailing_whitespace_p (glyph->charpos))
18833 {
18834 int face_id = lookup_named_face (f, Qtrailing_whitespace, 0);
18835 if (face_id < 0)
18836 return;
18837
18838 if (!row->reversed_p)
18839 {
18840 while (glyph >= start
18841 && BUFFERP (glyph->object)
18842 && (glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
18843 || (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
18844 && glyph->u.ch == ' ')))
18845 (glyph--)->face_id = face_id;
18846 }
18847 else
18848 {
18849 while (glyph <= start
18850 && BUFFERP (glyph->object)
18851 && (glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
18852 || (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
18853 && glyph->u.ch == ' ')))
18854 (glyph++)->face_id = face_id;
18855 }
18856 }
18857 }
18858 }
18859
18860
18861 /* Value is non-zero if glyph row ROW should be
18862 used to hold the cursor. */
18863
18864 static int
18865 cursor_row_p (struct glyph_row *row)
18866 {
18867 int result = 1;
18868
18869 if (PT == CHARPOS (row->end.pos)
18870 || PT == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row))
18871 {
18872 /* Suppose the row ends on a string.
18873 Unless the row is continued, that means it ends on a newline
18874 in the string. If it's anything other than a display string
18875 (e.g., a before-string from an overlay), we don't want the
18876 cursor there. (This heuristic seems to give the optimal
18877 behavior for the various types of multi-line strings.)
18878 One exception: if the string has `cursor' property on one of
18879 its characters, we _do_ want the cursor there. */
18880 if (CHARPOS (row->end.string_pos) >= 0)
18881 {
18882 if (row->continued_p)
18883 result = 1;
18884 else
18885 {
18886 /* Check for `display' property. */
18887 struct glyph *beg = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18888 struct glyph *end = beg + row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
18889 struct glyph *glyph;
18890
18891 result = 0;
18892 for (glyph = end; glyph >= beg; --glyph)
18893 if (STRINGP (glyph->object))
18894 {
18895 Lisp_Object prop
18896 = Fget_char_property (make_number (PT),
18897 Qdisplay, Qnil);
18898 result =
18899 (!NILP (prop)
18900 && display_prop_string_p (prop, glyph->object));
18901 /* If there's a `cursor' property on one of the
18902 string's characters, this row is a cursor row,
18903 even though this is not a display string. */
18904 if (!result)
18905 {
18906 Lisp_Object s = glyph->object;
18907
18908 for ( ; glyph >= beg && EQ (glyph->object, s); --glyph)
18909 {
18910 ptrdiff_t gpos = glyph->charpos;
18911
18912 if (!NILP (Fget_char_property (make_number (gpos),
18913 Qcursor, s)))
18914 {
18915 result = 1;
18916 break;
18917 }
18918 }
18919 }
18920 break;
18921 }
18922 }
18923 }
18924 else if (MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (row))
18925 {
18926 /* If the row ends in middle of a real character,
18927 and the line is continued, we want the cursor here.
18928 That's because CHARPOS (ROW->end.pos) would equal
18929 PT if PT is before the character. */
18930 if (!row->ends_in_ellipsis_p)
18931 result = row->continued_p;
18932 else
18933 /* If the row ends in an ellipsis, then
18934 CHARPOS (ROW->end.pos) will equal point after the
18935 invisible text. We want that position to be displayed
18936 after the ellipsis. */
18937 result = 0;
18938 }
18939 /* If the row ends at ZV, display the cursor at the end of that
18940 row instead of at the start of the row below. */
18941 else if (row->ends_at_zv_p)
18942 result = 1;
18943 else
18944 result = 0;
18945 }
18946
18947 return result;
18948 }
18949
18950 \f
18951
18952 /* Push the property PROP so that it will be rendered at the current
18953 position in IT. Return 1 if PROP was successfully pushed, 0
18954 otherwise. Called from handle_line_prefix to handle the
18955 `line-prefix' and `wrap-prefix' properties. */
18956
18957 static int
18958 push_prefix_prop (struct it *it, Lisp_Object prop)
18959 {
18960 struct text_pos pos =
18961 STRINGP (it->string) ? it->current.string_pos : it->current.pos;
18962
18963 eassert (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER
18964 || it->method == GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR
18965 || it->method == GET_FROM_STRING);
18966
18967 /* We need to save the current buffer/string position, so it will be
18968 restored by pop_it, because iterate_out_of_display_property
18969 depends on that being set correctly, but some situations leave
18970 it->position not yet set when this function is called. */
18971 push_it (it, &pos);
18972
18973 if (STRINGP (prop))
18974 {
18975 if (SCHARS (prop) == 0)
18976 {
18977 pop_it (it);
18978 return 0;
18979 }
18980
18981 it->string = prop;
18982 it->string_from_prefix_prop_p = 1;
18983 it->multibyte_p = STRING_MULTIBYTE (it->string);
18984 it->current.overlay_string_index = -1;
18985 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = 0;
18986 it->end_charpos = it->string_nchars = SCHARS (it->string);
18987 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
18988 it->stop_charpos = 0;
18989 it->prev_stop = 0;
18990 it->base_level_stop = 0;
18991
18992 /* Force paragraph direction to be that of the parent
18993 buffer/string. */
18994 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L)
18995 it->paragraph_embedding = it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir;
18996 else
18997 it->paragraph_embedding = L2R;
18998
18999 /* Set up the bidi iterator for this display string. */
19000 if (it->bidi_p)
19001 {
19002 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = it->string;
19003 it->bidi_it.string.s = NULL;
19004 it->bidi_it.string.schars = it->end_charpos;
19005 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
19006 it->bidi_it.string.from_disp_str = it->string_from_display_prop_p;
19007 it->bidi_it.string.unibyte = !it->multibyte_p;
19008 bidi_init_it (0, 0, FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f), &it->bidi_it);
19009 }
19010 }
19011 else if (CONSP (prop) && EQ (XCAR (prop), Qspace))
19012 {
19013 it->method = GET_FROM_STRETCH;
19014 it->object = prop;
19015 }
19016 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
19017 else if (IMAGEP (prop))
19018 {
19019 it->what = IT_IMAGE;
19020 it->image_id = lookup_image (it->f, prop);
19021 it->method = GET_FROM_IMAGE;
19022 }
19023 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
19024 else
19025 {
19026 pop_it (it); /* bogus display property, give up */
19027 return 0;
19028 }
19029
19030 return 1;
19031 }
19032
19033 /* Return the character-property PROP at the current position in IT. */
19034
19035 static Lisp_Object
19036 get_it_property (struct it *it, Lisp_Object prop)
19037 {
19038 Lisp_Object position;
19039
19040 if (STRINGP (it->object))
19041 position = make_number (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it));
19042 else if (BUFFERP (it->object))
19043 position = make_number (IT_CHARPOS (*it));
19044 else
19045 return Qnil;
19046
19047 return Fget_char_property (position, prop, it->object);
19048 }
19049
19050 /* See if there's a line- or wrap-prefix, and if so, push it on IT. */
19051
19052 static void
19053 handle_line_prefix (struct it *it)
19054 {
19055 Lisp_Object prefix;
19056
19057 if (it->continuation_lines_width > 0)
19058 {
19059 prefix = get_it_property (it, Qwrap_prefix);
19060 if (NILP (prefix))
19061 prefix = Vwrap_prefix;
19062 }
19063 else
19064 {
19065 prefix = get_it_property (it, Qline_prefix);
19066 if (NILP (prefix))
19067 prefix = Vline_prefix;
19068 }
19069 if (! NILP (prefix) && push_prefix_prop (it, prefix))
19070 {
19071 /* If the prefix is wider than the window, and we try to wrap
19072 it, it would acquire its own wrap prefix, and so on till the
19073 iterator stack overflows. So, don't wrap the prefix. */
19074 it->line_wrap = TRUNCATE;
19075 it->avoid_cursor_p = 1;
19076 }
19077 }
19078
19079 \f
19080
19081 /* Remove N glyphs at the start of a reversed IT->glyph_row. Called
19082 only for R2L lines from display_line and display_string, when they
19083 decide that too many glyphs were produced by PRODUCE_GLYPHS, and
19084 the line/string needs to be continued on the next glyph row. */
19085 static void
19086 unproduce_glyphs (struct it *it, int n)
19087 {
19088 struct glyph *glyph, *end;
19089
19090 eassert (it->glyph_row);
19091 eassert (it->glyph_row->reversed_p);
19092 eassert (it->area == TEXT_AREA);
19093 eassert (n <= it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA]);
19094
19095 if (n > it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])
19096 n = it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
19097 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + n;
19098 end = it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
19099 for ( ; glyph < end; glyph++)
19100 glyph[-n] = *glyph;
19101 }
19102
19103 /* Find the positions in a bidi-reordered ROW to serve as ROW->minpos
19104 and ROW->maxpos. */
19105 static void
19106 find_row_edges (struct it *it, struct glyph_row *row,
19107 ptrdiff_t min_pos, ptrdiff_t min_bpos,
19108 ptrdiff_t max_pos, ptrdiff_t max_bpos)
19109 {
19110 /* FIXME: Revisit this when glyph ``spilling'' in continuation
19111 lines' rows is implemented for bidi-reordered rows. */
19112
19113 /* ROW->minpos is the value of min_pos, the minimal buffer position
19114 we have in ROW, or ROW->start.pos if that is smaller. */
19115 if (min_pos <= ZV && min_pos < row->start.pos.charpos)
19116 SET_TEXT_POS (row->minpos, min_pos, min_bpos);
19117 else
19118 /* We didn't find buffer positions smaller than ROW->start, or
19119 didn't find _any_ valid buffer positions in any of the glyphs,
19120 so we must trust the iterator's computed positions. */
19121 row->minpos = row->start.pos;
19122 if (max_pos <= 0)
19123 {
19124 max_pos = CHARPOS (it->current.pos);
19125 max_bpos = BYTEPOS (it->current.pos);
19126 }
19127
19128 /* Here are the various use-cases for ending the row, and the
19129 corresponding values for ROW->maxpos:
19130
19131 Line ends in a newline from buffer eol_pos + 1
19132 Line is continued from buffer max_pos + 1
19133 Line is truncated on right it->current.pos
19134 Line ends in a newline from string max_pos + 1(*)
19135 (*) + 1 only when line ends in a forward scan
19136 Line is continued from string max_pos
19137 Line is continued from display vector max_pos
19138 Line is entirely from a string min_pos == max_pos
19139 Line is entirely from a display vector min_pos == max_pos
19140 Line that ends at ZV ZV
19141
19142 If you discover other use-cases, please add them here as
19143 appropriate. */
19144 if (row->ends_at_zv_p)
19145 row->maxpos = it->current.pos;
19146 else if (row->used[TEXT_AREA])
19147 {
19148 int seen_this_string = 0;
19149 struct glyph_row *r1 = row - 1;
19150
19151 /* Did we see the same display string on the previous row? */
19152 if (STRINGP (it->object)
19153 /* this is not the first row */
19154 && row > it->w->desired_matrix->rows
19155 /* previous row is not the header line */
19156 && !r1->mode_line_p
19157 /* previous row also ends in a newline from a string */
19158 && r1->ends_in_newline_from_string_p)
19159 {
19160 struct glyph *start, *end;
19161
19162 /* Search for the last glyph of the previous row that came
19163 from buffer or string. Depending on whether the row is
19164 L2R or R2L, we need to process it front to back or the
19165 other way round. */
19166 if (!r1->reversed_p)
19167 {
19168 start = r1->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
19169 end = start + r1->used[TEXT_AREA];
19170 /* Glyphs inserted by redisplay have an integer (zero)
19171 as their object. */
19172 while (end > start
19173 && INTEGERP ((end - 1)->object)
19174 && (end - 1)->charpos <= 0)
19175 --end;
19176 if (end > start)
19177 {
19178 if (EQ ((end - 1)->object, it->object))
19179 seen_this_string = 1;
19180 }
19181 else
19182 /* If all the glyphs of the previous row were inserted
19183 by redisplay, it means the previous row was
19184 produced from a single newline, which is only
19185 possible if that newline came from the same string
19186 as the one which produced this ROW. */
19187 seen_this_string = 1;
19188 }
19189 else
19190 {
19191 end = r1->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
19192 start = end + r1->used[TEXT_AREA];
19193 while (end < start
19194 && INTEGERP ((end + 1)->object)
19195 && (end + 1)->charpos <= 0)
19196 ++end;
19197 if (end < start)
19198 {
19199 if (EQ ((end + 1)->object, it->object))
19200 seen_this_string = 1;
19201 }
19202 else
19203 seen_this_string = 1;
19204 }
19205 }
19206 /* Take note of each display string that covers a newline only
19207 once, the first time we see it. This is for when a display
19208 string includes more than one newline in it. */
19209 if (row->ends_in_newline_from_string_p && !seen_this_string)
19210 {
19211 /* If we were scanning the buffer forward when we displayed
19212 the string, we want to account for at least one buffer
19213 position that belongs to this row (position covered by
19214 the display string), so that cursor positioning will
19215 consider this row as a candidate when point is at the end
19216 of the visual line represented by this row. This is not
19217 required when scanning back, because max_pos will already
19218 have a much larger value. */
19219 if (CHARPOS (row->end.pos) > max_pos)
19220 INC_BOTH (max_pos, max_bpos);
19221 SET_TEXT_POS (row->maxpos, max_pos, max_bpos);
19222 }
19223 else if (CHARPOS (it->eol_pos) > 0)
19224 SET_TEXT_POS (row->maxpos,
19225 CHARPOS (it->eol_pos) + 1, BYTEPOS (it->eol_pos) + 1);
19226 else if (row->continued_p)
19227 {
19228 /* If max_pos is different from IT's current position, it
19229 means IT->method does not belong to the display element
19230 at max_pos. However, it also means that the display
19231 element at max_pos was displayed in its entirety on this
19232 line, which is equivalent to saying that the next line
19233 starts at the next buffer position. */
19234 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) == max_pos && it->method != GET_FROM_BUFFER)
19235 SET_TEXT_POS (row->maxpos, max_pos, max_bpos);
19236 else
19237 {
19238 INC_BOTH (max_pos, max_bpos);
19239 SET_TEXT_POS (row->maxpos, max_pos, max_bpos);
19240 }
19241 }
19242 else if (row->truncated_on_right_p)
19243 /* display_line already called reseat_at_next_visible_line_start,
19244 which puts the iterator at the beginning of the next line, in
19245 the logical order. */
19246 row->maxpos = it->current.pos;
19247 else if (max_pos == min_pos && it->method != GET_FROM_BUFFER)
19248 /* A line that is entirely from a string/image/stretch... */
19249 row->maxpos = row->minpos;
19250 else
19251 abort ();
19252 }
19253 else
19254 row->maxpos = it->current.pos;
19255 }
19256
19257 /* Construct the glyph row IT->glyph_row in the desired matrix of
19258 IT->w from text at the current position of IT. See dispextern.h
19259 for an overview of struct it. Value is non-zero if
19260 IT->glyph_row displays text, as opposed to a line displaying ZV
19261 only. */
19262
19263 static int
19264 display_line (struct it *it)
19265 {
19266 struct glyph_row *row = it->glyph_row;
19267 Lisp_Object overlay_arrow_string;
19268 struct it wrap_it;
19269 void *wrap_data = NULL;
19270 int may_wrap = 0, wrap_x IF_LINT (= 0);
19271 int wrap_row_used = -1;
19272 int wrap_row_ascent IF_LINT (= 0), wrap_row_height IF_LINT (= 0);
19273 int wrap_row_phys_ascent IF_LINT (= 0), wrap_row_phys_height IF_LINT (= 0);
19274 int wrap_row_extra_line_spacing IF_LINT (= 0);
19275 ptrdiff_t wrap_row_min_pos IF_LINT (= 0), wrap_row_min_bpos IF_LINT (= 0);
19276 ptrdiff_t wrap_row_max_pos IF_LINT (= 0), wrap_row_max_bpos IF_LINT (= 0);
19277 int cvpos;
19278 ptrdiff_t min_pos = ZV + 1, max_pos = 0;
19279 ptrdiff_t min_bpos IF_LINT (= 0), max_bpos IF_LINT (= 0);
19280
19281 /* We always start displaying at hpos zero even if hscrolled. */
19282 eassert (it->hpos == 0 && it->current_x == 0);
19283
19284 if (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (row, it->w->desired_matrix)
19285 >= it->w->desired_matrix->nrows)
19286 {
19287 it->w->nrows_scale_factor++;
19288 fonts_changed_p = 1;
19289 return 0;
19290 }
19291
19292 /* Is IT->w showing the region? */
19293 wset_region_showing (it->w, it->region_beg_charpos > 0 ? Qt : Qnil);
19294
19295 /* Clear the result glyph row and enable it. */
19296 prepare_desired_row (row);
19297
19298 row->y = it->current_y;
19299 row->start = it->start;
19300 row->continuation_lines_width = it->continuation_lines_width;
19301 row->displays_text_p = 1;
19302 row->starts_in_middle_of_char_p = it->starts_in_middle_of_char_p;
19303 it->starts_in_middle_of_char_p = 0;
19304
19305 /* Arrange the overlays nicely for our purposes. Usually, we call
19306 display_line on only one line at a time, in which case this
19307 can't really hurt too much, or we call it on lines which appear
19308 one after another in the buffer, in which case all calls to
19309 recenter_overlay_lists but the first will be pretty cheap. */
19310 recenter_overlay_lists (current_buffer, IT_CHARPOS (*it));
19311
19312 /* Move over display elements that are not visible because we are
19313 hscrolled. This may stop at an x-position < IT->first_visible_x
19314 if the first glyph is partially visible or if we hit a line end. */
19315 if (it->current_x < it->first_visible_x)
19316 {
19317 enum move_it_result move_result;
19318
19319 this_line_min_pos = row->start.pos;
19320 move_result = move_it_in_display_line_to (it, ZV, it->first_visible_x,
19321 MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_X);
19322 /* If we are under a large hscroll, move_it_in_display_line_to
19323 could hit the end of the line without reaching
19324 it->first_visible_x. Pretend that we did reach it. This is
19325 especially important on a TTY, where we will call
19326 extend_face_to_end_of_line, which needs to know how many
19327 blank glyphs to produce. */
19328 if (it->current_x < it->first_visible_x
19329 && (move_result == MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR
19330 || move_result == MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV))
19331 it->current_x = it->first_visible_x;
19332
19333 /* Record the smallest positions seen while we moved over
19334 display elements that are not visible. This is needed by
19335 redisplay_internal for optimizing the case where the cursor
19336 stays inside the same line. The rest of this function only
19337 considers positions that are actually displayed, so
19338 RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS will not otherwise record positions that
19339 are hscrolled to the left of the left edge of the window. */
19340 min_pos = CHARPOS (this_line_min_pos);
19341 min_bpos = BYTEPOS (this_line_min_pos);
19342 }
19343 else
19344 {
19345 /* We only do this when not calling `move_it_in_display_line_to'
19346 above, because move_it_in_display_line_to calls
19347 handle_line_prefix itself. */
19348 handle_line_prefix (it);
19349 }
19350
19351 /* Get the initial row height. This is either the height of the
19352 text hscrolled, if there is any, or zero. */
19353 row->ascent = it->max_ascent;
19354 row->height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
19355 row->phys_ascent = it->max_phys_ascent;
19356 row->phys_height = it->max_phys_ascent + it->max_phys_descent;
19357 row->extra_line_spacing = it->max_extra_line_spacing;
19358
19359 /* Utility macro to record max and min buffer positions seen until now. */
19360 #define RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS(IT) \
19361 do \
19362 { \
19363 int composition_p = !STRINGP ((IT)->string) \
19364 && ((IT)->what == IT_COMPOSITION); \
19365 ptrdiff_t current_pos = \
19366 composition_p ? (IT)->cmp_it.charpos \
19367 : IT_CHARPOS (*(IT)); \
19368 ptrdiff_t current_bpos = \
19369 composition_p ? CHAR_TO_BYTE (current_pos) \
19370 : IT_BYTEPOS (*(IT)); \
19371 if (current_pos < min_pos) \
19372 { \
19373 min_pos = current_pos; \
19374 min_bpos = current_bpos; \
19375 } \
19376 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) > max_pos) \
19377 { \
19378 max_pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it); \
19379 max_bpos = IT_BYTEPOS (*it); \
19380 } \
19381 } \
19382 while (0)
19383
19384 /* Loop generating characters. The loop is left with IT on the next
19385 character to display. */
19386 while (1)
19387 {
19388 int n_glyphs_before, hpos_before, x_before;
19389 int x, nglyphs;
19390 int ascent = 0, descent = 0, phys_ascent = 0, phys_descent = 0;
19391
19392 /* Retrieve the next thing to display. Value is zero if end of
19393 buffer reached. */
19394 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
19395 {
19396 /* Maybe add a space at the end of this line that is used to
19397 display the cursor there under X. Set the charpos of the
19398 first glyph of blank lines not corresponding to any text
19399 to -1. */
19400 if (IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE (it))
19401 row->exact_window_width_line_p = 1;
19402 else if ((append_space_for_newline (it, 1) && row->used[TEXT_AREA] == 1)
19403 || row->used[TEXT_AREA] == 0)
19404 {
19405 row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]->charpos = -1;
19406 row->displays_text_p = 0;
19407
19408 if (!NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (it->w->buffer), indicate_empty_lines))
19409 && (!MINI_WINDOW_P (it->w)
19410 || (minibuf_level && EQ (it->window, minibuf_window))))
19411 row->indicate_empty_line_p = 1;
19412 }
19413
19414 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
19415 row->ends_at_zv_p = 1;
19416 /* A row that displays right-to-left text must always have
19417 its last face extended all the way to the end of line,
19418 even if this row ends in ZV, because we still write to
19419 the screen left to right. We also need to extend the
19420 last face if the default face is remapped to some
19421 different face, otherwise the functions that clear
19422 portions of the screen will clear with the default face's
19423 background color. */
19424 if (row->reversed_p
19425 || lookup_basic_face (it->f, DEFAULT_FACE_ID) != DEFAULT_FACE_ID)
19426 extend_face_to_end_of_line (it);
19427 break;
19428 }
19429
19430 /* Now, get the metrics of what we want to display. This also
19431 generates glyphs in `row' (which is IT->glyph_row). */
19432 n_glyphs_before = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
19433 x = it->current_x;
19434
19435 /* Remember the line height so far in case the next element doesn't
19436 fit on the line. */
19437 if (it->line_wrap != TRUNCATE)
19438 {
19439 ascent = it->max_ascent;
19440 descent = it->max_descent;
19441 phys_ascent = it->max_phys_ascent;
19442 phys_descent = it->max_phys_descent;
19443
19444 if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP && it->area == TEXT_AREA)
19445 {
19446 if (IT_DISPLAYING_WHITESPACE (it))
19447 may_wrap = 1;
19448 else if (may_wrap)
19449 {
19450 SAVE_IT (wrap_it, *it, wrap_data);
19451 wrap_x = x;
19452 wrap_row_used = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
19453 wrap_row_ascent = row->ascent;
19454 wrap_row_height = row->height;
19455 wrap_row_phys_ascent = row->phys_ascent;
19456 wrap_row_phys_height = row->phys_height;
19457 wrap_row_extra_line_spacing = row->extra_line_spacing;
19458 wrap_row_min_pos = min_pos;
19459 wrap_row_min_bpos = min_bpos;
19460 wrap_row_max_pos = max_pos;
19461 wrap_row_max_bpos = max_bpos;
19462 may_wrap = 0;
19463 }
19464 }
19465 }
19466
19467 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
19468
19469 /* If this display element was in marginal areas, continue with
19470 the next one. */
19471 if (it->area != TEXT_AREA)
19472 {
19473 row->ascent = max (row->ascent, it->max_ascent);
19474 row->height = max (row->height, it->max_ascent + it->max_descent);
19475 row->phys_ascent = max (row->phys_ascent, it->max_phys_ascent);
19476 row->phys_height = max (row->phys_height,
19477 it->max_phys_ascent + it->max_phys_descent);
19478 row->extra_line_spacing = max (row->extra_line_spacing,
19479 it->max_extra_line_spacing);
19480 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
19481 continue;
19482 }
19483
19484 /* Does the display element fit on the line? If we truncate
19485 lines, we should draw past the right edge of the window. If
19486 we don't truncate, we want to stop so that we can display the
19487 continuation glyph before the right margin. If lines are
19488 continued, there are two possible strategies for characters
19489 resulting in more than 1 glyph (e.g. tabs): Display as many
19490 glyphs as possible in this line and leave the rest for the
19491 continuation line, or display the whole element in the next
19492 line. Original redisplay did the former, so we do it also. */
19493 nglyphs = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - n_glyphs_before;
19494 hpos_before = it->hpos;
19495 x_before = x;
19496
19497 if (/* Not a newline. */
19498 nglyphs > 0
19499 /* Glyphs produced fit entirely in the line. */
19500 && it->current_x < it->last_visible_x)
19501 {
19502 it->hpos += nglyphs;
19503 row->ascent = max (row->ascent, it->max_ascent);
19504 row->height = max (row->height, it->max_ascent + it->max_descent);
19505 row->phys_ascent = max (row->phys_ascent, it->max_phys_ascent);
19506 row->phys_height = max (row->phys_height,
19507 it->max_phys_ascent + it->max_phys_descent);
19508 row->extra_line_spacing = max (row->extra_line_spacing,
19509 it->max_extra_line_spacing);
19510 if (it->current_x - it->pixel_width < it->first_visible_x)
19511 row->x = x - it->first_visible_x;
19512 /* Record the maximum and minimum buffer positions seen so
19513 far in glyphs that will be displayed by this row. */
19514 if (it->bidi_p)
19515 RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS (it);
19516 }
19517 else
19518 {
19519 int i, new_x;
19520 struct glyph *glyph;
19521
19522 for (i = 0; i < nglyphs; ++i, x = new_x)
19523 {
19524 glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + n_glyphs_before + i;
19525 new_x = x + glyph->pixel_width;
19526
19527 if (/* Lines are continued. */
19528 it->line_wrap != TRUNCATE
19529 && (/* Glyph doesn't fit on the line. */
19530 new_x > it->last_visible_x
19531 /* Or it fits exactly on a window system frame. */
19532 || (new_x == it->last_visible_x
19533 && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
19534 && (row->reversed_p
19535 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
19536 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)))))
19537 {
19538 /* End of a continued line. */
19539
19540 if (it->hpos == 0
19541 || (new_x == it->last_visible_x
19542 && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
19543 && (row->reversed_p
19544 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
19545 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w))))
19546 {
19547 /* Current glyph is the only one on the line or
19548 fits exactly on the line. We must continue
19549 the line because we can't draw the cursor
19550 after the glyph. */
19551 row->continued_p = 1;
19552 it->current_x = new_x;
19553 it->continuation_lines_width += new_x;
19554 ++it->hpos;
19555 if (i == nglyphs - 1)
19556 {
19557 /* If line-wrap is on, check if a previous
19558 wrap point was found. */
19559 if (wrap_row_used > 0
19560 /* Even if there is a previous wrap
19561 point, continue the line here as
19562 usual, if (i) the previous character
19563 was a space or tab AND (ii) the
19564 current character is not. */
19565 && (!may_wrap
19566 || IT_DISPLAYING_WHITESPACE (it)))
19567 goto back_to_wrap;
19568
19569 /* Record the maximum and minimum buffer
19570 positions seen so far in glyphs that will be
19571 displayed by this row. */
19572 if (it->bidi_p)
19573 RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS (it);
19574 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
19575 if (IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE (it))
19576 {
19577 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
19578 {
19579 row->exact_window_width_line_p = 1;
19580 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
19581 row->continued_p = 0;
19582 row->ends_at_zv_p = 1;
19583 }
19584 else if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
19585 {
19586 row->continued_p = 0;
19587 row->exact_window_width_line_p = 1;
19588 }
19589 }
19590 }
19591 else if (it->bidi_p)
19592 RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS (it);
19593 }
19594 else if (CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (*glyph)
19595 && !FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
19596 {
19597 /* A padding glyph that doesn't fit on this line.
19598 This means the whole character doesn't fit
19599 on the line. */
19600 if (row->reversed_p)
19601 unproduce_glyphs (it, row->used[TEXT_AREA]
19602 - n_glyphs_before);
19603 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = n_glyphs_before;
19604
19605 /* Fill the rest of the row with continuation
19606 glyphs like in 20.x. */
19607 while (row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA]
19608 < row->glyphs[1 + TEXT_AREA])
19609 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_CONTINUATION);
19610
19611 row->continued_p = 1;
19612 it->current_x = x_before;
19613 it->continuation_lines_width += x_before;
19614
19615 /* Restore the height to what it was before the
19616 element not fitting on the line. */
19617 it->max_ascent = ascent;
19618 it->max_descent = descent;
19619 it->max_phys_ascent = phys_ascent;
19620 it->max_phys_descent = phys_descent;
19621 }
19622 else if (wrap_row_used > 0)
19623 {
19624 back_to_wrap:
19625 if (row->reversed_p)
19626 unproduce_glyphs (it,
19627 row->used[TEXT_AREA] - wrap_row_used);
19628 RESTORE_IT (it, &wrap_it, wrap_data);
19629 it->continuation_lines_width += wrap_x;
19630 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = wrap_row_used;
19631 row->ascent = wrap_row_ascent;
19632 row->height = wrap_row_height;
19633 row->phys_ascent = wrap_row_phys_ascent;
19634 row->phys_height = wrap_row_phys_height;
19635 row->extra_line_spacing = wrap_row_extra_line_spacing;
19636 min_pos = wrap_row_min_pos;
19637 min_bpos = wrap_row_min_bpos;
19638 max_pos = wrap_row_max_pos;
19639 max_bpos = wrap_row_max_bpos;
19640 row->continued_p = 1;
19641 row->ends_at_zv_p = 0;
19642 row->exact_window_width_line_p = 0;
19643 it->continuation_lines_width += x;
19644
19645 /* Make sure that a non-default face is extended
19646 up to the right margin of the window. */
19647 extend_face_to_end_of_line (it);
19648 }
19649 else if (it->c == '\t' && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
19650 {
19651 /* A TAB that extends past the right edge of the
19652 window. This produces a single glyph on
19653 window system frames. We leave the glyph in
19654 this row and let it fill the row, but don't
19655 consume the TAB. */
19656 if ((row->reversed_p
19657 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
19658 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)) == 0)
19659 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_CONTINUATION);
19660 it->continuation_lines_width += it->last_visible_x;
19661 row->ends_in_middle_of_char_p = 1;
19662 row->continued_p = 1;
19663 glyph->pixel_width = it->last_visible_x - x;
19664 it->starts_in_middle_of_char_p = 1;
19665 }
19666 else
19667 {
19668 /* Something other than a TAB that draws past
19669 the right edge of the window. Restore
19670 positions to values before the element. */
19671 if (row->reversed_p)
19672 unproduce_glyphs (it, row->used[TEXT_AREA]
19673 - (n_glyphs_before + i));
19674 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = n_glyphs_before + i;
19675
19676 /* Display continuation glyphs. */
19677 it->current_x = x_before;
19678 it->continuation_lines_width += x;
19679 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
19680 || (row->reversed_p
19681 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
19682 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)) == 0)
19683 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_CONTINUATION);
19684 row->continued_p = 1;
19685
19686 extend_face_to_end_of_line (it);
19687
19688 if (nglyphs > 1 && i > 0)
19689 {
19690 row->ends_in_middle_of_char_p = 1;
19691 it->starts_in_middle_of_char_p = 1;
19692 }
19693
19694 /* Restore the height to what it was before the
19695 element not fitting on the line. */
19696 it->max_ascent = ascent;
19697 it->max_descent = descent;
19698 it->max_phys_ascent = phys_ascent;
19699 it->max_phys_descent = phys_descent;
19700 }
19701
19702 break;
19703 }
19704 else if (new_x > it->first_visible_x)
19705 {
19706 /* Increment number of glyphs actually displayed. */
19707 ++it->hpos;
19708
19709 /* Record the maximum and minimum buffer positions
19710 seen so far in glyphs that will be displayed by
19711 this row. */
19712 if (it->bidi_p)
19713 RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS (it);
19714
19715 if (x < it->first_visible_x)
19716 /* Glyph is partially visible, i.e. row starts at
19717 negative X position. */
19718 row->x = x - it->first_visible_x;
19719 }
19720 else
19721 {
19722 /* Glyph is completely off the left margin of the
19723 window. This should not happen because of the
19724 move_it_in_display_line at the start of this
19725 function, unless the text display area of the
19726 window is empty. */
19727 eassert (it->first_visible_x <= it->last_visible_x);
19728 }
19729 }
19730 /* Even if this display element produced no glyphs at all,
19731 we want to record its position. */
19732 if (it->bidi_p && nglyphs == 0)
19733 RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS (it);
19734
19735 row->ascent = max (row->ascent, it->max_ascent);
19736 row->height = max (row->height, it->max_ascent + it->max_descent);
19737 row->phys_ascent = max (row->phys_ascent, it->max_phys_ascent);
19738 row->phys_height = max (row->phys_height,
19739 it->max_phys_ascent + it->max_phys_descent);
19740 row->extra_line_spacing = max (row->extra_line_spacing,
19741 it->max_extra_line_spacing);
19742
19743 /* End of this display line if row is continued. */
19744 if (row->continued_p || row->ends_at_zv_p)
19745 break;
19746 }
19747
19748 at_end_of_line:
19749 /* Is this a line end? If yes, we're also done, after making
19750 sure that a non-default face is extended up to the right
19751 margin of the window. */
19752 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
19753 {
19754 int used_before = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
19755
19756 row->ends_in_newline_from_string_p = STRINGP (it->object);
19757
19758 /* Add a space at the end of the line that is used to
19759 display the cursor there. */
19760 if (!IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE (it))
19761 append_space_for_newline (it, 0);
19762
19763 /* Extend the face to the end of the line. */
19764 extend_face_to_end_of_line (it);
19765
19766 /* Make sure we have the position. */
19767 if (used_before == 0)
19768 row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]->charpos = CHARPOS (it->position);
19769
19770 /* Record the position of the newline, for use in
19771 find_row_edges. */
19772 it->eol_pos = it->current.pos;
19773
19774 /* Consume the line end. This skips over invisible lines. */
19775 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
19776 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
19777 break;
19778 }
19779
19780 /* Proceed with next display element. Note that this skips
19781 over lines invisible because of selective display. */
19782 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
19783
19784 /* If we truncate lines, we are done when the last displayed
19785 glyphs reach past the right margin of the window. */
19786 if (it->line_wrap == TRUNCATE
19787 && (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f) && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
19788 ? (it->current_x >= it->last_visible_x)
19789 : (it->current_x > it->last_visible_x)))
19790 {
19791 /* Maybe add truncation glyphs. */
19792 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
19793 || (row->reversed_p
19794 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
19795 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)) == 0)
19796 {
19797 int i, n;
19798
19799 if (!row->reversed_p)
19800 {
19801 for (i = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1; i > 0; --i)
19802 if (!CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][i]))
19803 break;
19804 }
19805 else
19806 {
19807 for (i = 0; i < row->used[TEXT_AREA]; i++)
19808 if (!CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][i]))
19809 break;
19810 /* Remove any padding glyphs at the front of ROW, to
19811 make room for the truncation glyphs we will be
19812 adding below. The loop below always inserts at
19813 least one truncation glyph, so also remove the
19814 last glyph added to ROW. */
19815 unproduce_glyphs (it, i + 1);
19816 /* Adjust i for the loop below. */
19817 i = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - (i + 1);
19818 }
19819
19820 it->current_x = x_before;
19821 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
19822 {
19823 for (n = row->used[TEXT_AREA]; i < n; ++i)
19824 {
19825 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = i;
19826 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_TRUNCATION);
19827 }
19828 }
19829 else
19830 {
19831 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = i;
19832 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_TRUNCATION);
19833 }
19834 }
19835 else if (IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE (it))
19836 {
19837 /* Don't truncate if we can overflow newline into fringe. */
19838 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
19839 {
19840 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
19841 row->ends_at_zv_p = 1;
19842 row->exact_window_width_line_p = 1;
19843 break;
19844 }
19845 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
19846 {
19847 row->exact_window_width_line_p = 1;
19848 goto at_end_of_line;
19849 }
19850 it->current_x = x_before;
19851 }
19852
19853 row->truncated_on_right_p = 1;
19854 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
19855 reseat_at_next_visible_line_start (it, 0);
19856 row->ends_at_zv_p = FETCH_BYTE (IT_BYTEPOS (*it) - 1) != '\n';
19857 it->hpos = hpos_before;
19858 break;
19859 }
19860 }
19861
19862 if (wrap_data)
19863 bidi_unshelve_cache (wrap_data, 1);
19864
19865 /* If line is not empty and hscrolled, maybe insert truncation glyphs
19866 at the left window margin. */
19867 if (it->first_visible_x
19868 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) != CHARPOS (row->start.pos))
19869 {
19870 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
19871 || (row->reversed_p
19872 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
19873 : WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)) == 0)
19874 insert_left_trunc_glyphs (it);
19875 row->truncated_on_left_p = 1;
19876 }
19877
19878 /* Remember the position at which this line ends.
19879
19880 BIDI Note: any code that needs MATRIX_ROW_START/END_CHARPOS
19881 cannot be before the call to find_row_edges below, since that is
19882 where these positions are determined. */
19883 row->end = it->current;
19884 if (!it->bidi_p)
19885 {
19886 row->minpos = row->start.pos;
19887 row->maxpos = row->end.pos;
19888 }
19889 else
19890 {
19891 /* ROW->minpos and ROW->maxpos must be the smallest and
19892 `1 + the largest' buffer positions in ROW. But if ROW was
19893 bidi-reordered, these two positions can be anywhere in the
19894 row, so we must determine them now. */
19895 find_row_edges (it, row, min_pos, min_bpos, max_pos, max_bpos);
19896 }
19897
19898 /* If the start of this line is the overlay arrow-position, then
19899 mark this glyph row as the one containing the overlay arrow.
19900 This is clearly a mess with variable size fonts. It would be
19901 better to let it be displayed like cursors under X. */
19902 if ((row->displays_text_p || !overlay_arrow_seen)
19903 && (overlay_arrow_string = overlay_arrow_at_row (it, row),
19904 !NILP (overlay_arrow_string)))
19905 {
19906 /* Overlay arrow in window redisplay is a fringe bitmap. */
19907 if (STRINGP (overlay_arrow_string))
19908 {
19909 struct glyph_row *arrow_row
19910 = get_overlay_arrow_glyph_row (it->w, overlay_arrow_string);
19911 struct glyph *glyph = arrow_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
19912 struct glyph *arrow_end = glyph + arrow_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
19913 struct glyph *p = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
19914 struct glyph *p2, *end;
19915
19916 /* Copy the arrow glyphs. */
19917 while (glyph < arrow_end)
19918 *p++ = *glyph++;
19919
19920 /* Throw away padding glyphs. */
19921 p2 = p;
19922 end = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA];
19923 while (p2 < end && CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (*p2))
19924 ++p2;
19925 if (p2 > p)
19926 {
19927 while (p2 < end)
19928 *p++ = *p2++;
19929 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = p2 - row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
19930 }
19931 }
19932 else
19933 {
19934 eassert (INTEGERP (overlay_arrow_string));
19935 row->overlay_arrow_bitmap = XINT (overlay_arrow_string);
19936 }
19937 overlay_arrow_seen = 1;
19938 }
19939
19940 /* Highlight trailing whitespace. */
19941 if (!NILP (Vshow_trailing_whitespace))
19942 highlight_trailing_whitespace (it->f, it->glyph_row);
19943
19944 /* Compute pixel dimensions of this line. */
19945 compute_line_metrics (it);
19946
19947 /* Implementation note: No changes in the glyphs of ROW or in their
19948 faces can be done past this point, because compute_line_metrics
19949 computes ROW's hash value and stores it within the glyph_row
19950 structure. */
19951
19952 /* Record whether this row ends inside an ellipsis. */
19953 row->ends_in_ellipsis_p
19954 = (it->method == GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR
19955 && it->ellipsis_p);
19956
19957 /* Save fringe bitmaps in this row. */
19958 row->left_user_fringe_bitmap = it->left_user_fringe_bitmap;
19959 row->left_user_fringe_face_id = it->left_user_fringe_face_id;
19960 row->right_user_fringe_bitmap = it->right_user_fringe_bitmap;
19961 row->right_user_fringe_face_id = it->right_user_fringe_face_id;
19962
19963 it->left_user_fringe_bitmap = 0;
19964 it->left_user_fringe_face_id = 0;
19965 it->right_user_fringe_bitmap = 0;
19966 it->right_user_fringe_face_id = 0;
19967
19968 /* Maybe set the cursor. */
19969 cvpos = it->w->cursor.vpos;
19970 if ((cvpos < 0
19971 /* In bidi-reordered rows, keep checking for proper cursor
19972 position even if one has been found already, because buffer
19973 positions in such rows change non-linearly with ROW->VPOS,
19974 when a line is continued. One exception: when we are at ZV,
19975 display cursor on the first suitable glyph row, since all
19976 the empty rows after that also have their position set to ZV. */
19977 /* FIXME: Revisit this when glyph ``spilling'' in continuation
19978 lines' rows is implemented for bidi-reordered rows. */
19979 || (it->bidi_p
19980 && !MATRIX_ROW (it->w->desired_matrix, cvpos)->ends_at_zv_p))
19981 && PT >= MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row)
19982 && PT <= MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
19983 && cursor_row_p (row))
19984 set_cursor_from_row (it->w, row, it->w->desired_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
19985
19986 /* Prepare for the next line. This line starts horizontally at (X
19987 HPOS) = (0 0). Vertical positions are incremented. As a
19988 convenience for the caller, IT->glyph_row is set to the next
19989 row to be used. */
19990 it->current_x = it->hpos = 0;
19991 it->current_y += row->height;
19992 SET_TEXT_POS (it->eol_pos, 0, 0);
19993 ++it->vpos;
19994 ++it->glyph_row;
19995 /* The next row should by default use the same value of the
19996 reversed_p flag as this one. set_iterator_to_next decides when
19997 it's a new paragraph, and PRODUCE_GLYPHS recomputes the value of
19998 the flag accordingly. */
19999 if (it->glyph_row < MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (it->w->desired_matrix, it->w))
20000 it->glyph_row->reversed_p = row->reversed_p;
20001 it->start = row->end;
20002 return row->displays_text_p;
20003
20004 #undef RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS
20005 }
20006
20007 DEFUN ("current-bidi-paragraph-direction", Fcurrent_bidi_paragraph_direction,
20008 Scurrent_bidi_paragraph_direction, 0, 1, 0,
20009 doc: /* Return paragraph direction at point in BUFFER.
20010 Value is either `left-to-right' or `right-to-left'.
20011 If BUFFER is omitted or nil, it defaults to the current buffer.
20012
20013 Paragraph direction determines how the text in the paragraph is displayed.
20014 In left-to-right paragraphs, text begins at the left margin of the window
20015 and the reading direction is generally left to right. In right-to-left
20016 paragraphs, text begins at the right margin and is read from right to left.
20017
20018 See also `bidi-paragraph-direction'. */)
20019 (Lisp_Object buffer)
20020 {
20021 struct buffer *buf = current_buffer;
20022 struct buffer *old = buf;
20023
20024 if (! NILP (buffer))
20025 {
20026 CHECK_BUFFER (buffer);
20027 buf = XBUFFER (buffer);
20028 }
20029
20030 if (NILP (BVAR (buf, bidi_display_reordering))
20031 || NILP (BVAR (buf, enable_multibyte_characters))
20032 /* When we are loading loadup.el, the character property tables
20033 needed for bidi iteration are not yet available. */
20034 || !NILP (Vpurify_flag))
20035 return Qleft_to_right;
20036 else if (!NILP (BVAR (buf, bidi_paragraph_direction)))
20037 return BVAR (buf, bidi_paragraph_direction);
20038 else
20039 {
20040 /* Determine the direction from buffer text. We could try to
20041 use current_matrix if it is up to date, but this seems fast
20042 enough as it is. */
20043 struct bidi_it itb;
20044 ptrdiff_t pos = BUF_PT (buf);
20045 ptrdiff_t bytepos = BUF_PT_BYTE (buf);
20046 int c;
20047 void *itb_data = bidi_shelve_cache ();
20048
20049 set_buffer_temp (buf);
20050 /* bidi_paragraph_init finds the base direction of the paragraph
20051 by searching forward from paragraph start. We need the base
20052 direction of the current or _previous_ paragraph, so we need
20053 to make sure we are within that paragraph. To that end, find
20054 the previous non-empty line. */
20055 if (pos >= ZV && pos > BEGV)
20056 {
20057 pos--;
20058 bytepos = CHAR_TO_BYTE (pos);
20059 }
20060 if (fast_looking_at (build_string ("[\f\t ]*\n"),
20061 pos, bytepos, ZV, ZV_BYTE, Qnil) > 0)
20062 {
20063 while ((c = FETCH_BYTE (bytepos)) == '\n'
20064 || c == ' ' || c == '\t' || c == '\f')
20065 {
20066 if (bytepos <= BEGV_BYTE)
20067 break;
20068 bytepos--;
20069 pos--;
20070 }
20071 while (!CHAR_HEAD_P (FETCH_BYTE (bytepos)))
20072 bytepos--;
20073 }
20074 bidi_init_it (pos, bytepos, FRAME_WINDOW_P (SELECTED_FRAME ()), &itb);
20075 itb.paragraph_dir = NEUTRAL_DIR;
20076 itb.string.s = NULL;
20077 itb.string.lstring = Qnil;
20078 itb.string.bufpos = 0;
20079 itb.string.unibyte = 0;
20080 bidi_paragraph_init (NEUTRAL_DIR, &itb, 1);
20081 bidi_unshelve_cache (itb_data, 0);
20082 set_buffer_temp (old);
20083 switch (itb.paragraph_dir)
20084 {
20085 case L2R:
20086 return Qleft_to_right;
20087 break;
20088 case R2L:
20089 return Qright_to_left;
20090 break;
20091 default:
20092 abort ();
20093 }
20094 }
20095 }
20096
20097
20098 \f
20099 /***********************************************************************
20100 Menu Bar
20101 ***********************************************************************/
20102
20103 /* Redisplay the menu bar in the frame for window W.
20104
20105 The menu bar of X frames that don't have X toolkit support is
20106 displayed in a special window W->frame->menu_bar_window.
20107
20108 The menu bar of terminal frames is treated specially as far as
20109 glyph matrices are concerned. Menu bar lines are not part of
20110 windows, so the update is done directly on the frame matrix rows
20111 for the menu bar. */
20112
20113 static void
20114 display_menu_bar (struct window *w)
20115 {
20116 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
20117 struct it it;
20118 Lisp_Object items;
20119 int i;
20120
20121 /* Don't do all this for graphical frames. */
20122 #ifdef HAVE_NTGUI
20123 if (FRAME_W32_P (f))
20124 return;
20125 #endif
20126 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
20127 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
20128 return;
20129 #endif
20130
20131 #ifdef HAVE_NS
20132 if (FRAME_NS_P (f))
20133 return;
20134 #endif /* HAVE_NS */
20135
20136 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
20137 eassert (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (f));
20138 init_iterator (&it, w, -1, -1, f->desired_matrix->rows, MENU_FACE_ID);
20139 it.first_visible_x = 0;
20140 it.last_visible_x = FRAME_TOTAL_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
20141 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
20142 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
20143 {
20144 /* Menu bar lines are displayed in the desired matrix of the
20145 dummy window menu_bar_window. */
20146 struct window *menu_w;
20147 eassert (WINDOWP (f->menu_bar_window));
20148 menu_w = XWINDOW (f->menu_bar_window);
20149 init_iterator (&it, menu_w, -1, -1, menu_w->desired_matrix->rows,
20150 MENU_FACE_ID);
20151 it.first_visible_x = 0;
20152 it.last_visible_x = FRAME_TOTAL_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
20153 }
20154 else
20155 {
20156 /* This is a TTY frame, i.e. character hpos/vpos are used as
20157 pixel x/y. */
20158 init_iterator (&it, w, -1, -1, f->desired_matrix->rows,
20159 MENU_FACE_ID);
20160 it.first_visible_x = 0;
20161 it.last_visible_x = FRAME_COLS (f);
20162 }
20163 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
20164
20165 /* FIXME: This should be controlled by a user option. See the
20166 comments in redisplay_tool_bar and display_mode_line about
20167 this. */
20168 it.paragraph_embedding = L2R;
20169
20170 if (! mode_line_inverse_video)
20171 /* Force the menu-bar to be displayed in the default face. */
20172 it.base_face_id = it.face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
20173
20174 /* Clear all rows of the menu bar. */
20175 for (i = 0; i < FRAME_MENU_BAR_LINES (f); ++i)
20176 {
20177 struct glyph_row *row = it.glyph_row + i;
20178 clear_glyph_row (row);
20179 row->enabled_p = 1;
20180 row->full_width_p = 1;
20181 }
20182
20183 /* Display all items of the menu bar. */
20184 items = FRAME_MENU_BAR_ITEMS (it.f);
20185 for (i = 0; i < ASIZE (items); i += 4)
20186 {
20187 Lisp_Object string;
20188
20189 /* Stop at nil string. */
20190 string = AREF (items, i + 1);
20191 if (NILP (string))
20192 break;
20193
20194 /* Remember where item was displayed. */
20195 ASET (items, i + 3, make_number (it.hpos));
20196
20197 /* Display the item, pad with one space. */
20198 if (it.current_x < it.last_visible_x)
20199 display_string (NULL, string, Qnil, 0, 0, &it,
20200 SCHARS (string) + 1, 0, 0, -1);
20201 }
20202
20203 /* Fill out the line with spaces. */
20204 if (it.current_x < it.last_visible_x)
20205 display_string ("", Qnil, Qnil, 0, 0, &it, -1, 0, 0, -1);
20206
20207 /* Compute the total height of the lines. */
20208 compute_line_metrics (&it);
20209 }
20210
20211
20212 \f
20213 /***********************************************************************
20214 Mode Line
20215 ***********************************************************************/
20216
20217 /* Redisplay mode lines in the window tree whose root is WINDOW. If
20218 FORCE is non-zero, redisplay mode lines unconditionally.
20219 Otherwise, redisplay only mode lines that are garbaged. Value is
20220 the number of windows whose mode lines were redisplayed. */
20221
20222 static int
20223 redisplay_mode_lines (Lisp_Object window, int force)
20224 {
20225 int nwindows = 0;
20226
20227 while (!NILP (window))
20228 {
20229 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
20230
20231 if (WINDOWP (w->hchild))
20232 nwindows += redisplay_mode_lines (w->hchild, force);
20233 else if (WINDOWP (w->vchild))
20234 nwindows += redisplay_mode_lines (w->vchild, force);
20235 else if (force
20236 || FRAME_GARBAGED_P (XFRAME (w->frame))
20237 || !MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)->enabled_p)
20238 {
20239 struct text_pos lpoint;
20240 struct buffer *old = current_buffer;
20241
20242 /* Set the window's buffer for the mode line display. */
20243 SET_TEXT_POS (lpoint, PT, PT_BYTE);
20244 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (w->buffer));
20245
20246 /* Point refers normally to the selected window. For any
20247 other window, set up appropriate value. */
20248 if (!EQ (window, selected_window))
20249 {
20250 struct text_pos pt;
20251
20252 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (pt, w->pointm);
20253 if (CHARPOS (pt) < BEGV)
20254 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (BEGV, BEGV_BYTE);
20255 else if (CHARPOS (pt) > (ZV - 1))
20256 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (ZV, ZV_BYTE);
20257 else
20258 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (CHARPOS (pt), BYTEPOS (pt));
20259 }
20260
20261 /* Display mode lines. */
20262 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
20263 if (display_mode_lines (w))
20264 {
20265 ++nwindows;
20266 w->must_be_updated_p = 1;
20267 }
20268
20269 /* Restore old settings. */
20270 set_buffer_internal_1 (old);
20271 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (CHARPOS (lpoint), BYTEPOS (lpoint));
20272 }
20273
20274 window = w->next;
20275 }
20276
20277 return nwindows;
20278 }
20279
20280
20281 /* Display the mode and/or header line of window W. Value is the
20282 sum number of mode lines and header lines displayed. */
20283
20284 static int
20285 display_mode_lines (struct window *w)
20286 {
20287 Lisp_Object old_selected_window, old_selected_frame;
20288 int n = 0;
20289
20290 old_selected_frame = selected_frame;
20291 selected_frame = w->frame;
20292 old_selected_window = selected_window;
20293 XSETWINDOW (selected_window, w);
20294
20295 /* These will be set while the mode line specs are processed. */
20296 line_number_displayed = 0;
20297 wset_column_number_displayed (w, Qnil);
20298
20299 if (WINDOW_WANTS_MODELINE_P (w))
20300 {
20301 struct window *sel_w = XWINDOW (old_selected_window);
20302
20303 /* Select mode line face based on the real selected window. */
20304 display_mode_line (w, CURRENT_MODE_LINE_FACE_ID_3 (sel_w, sel_w, w),
20305 BVAR (current_buffer, mode_line_format));
20306 ++n;
20307 }
20308
20309 if (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w))
20310 {
20311 display_mode_line (w, HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID,
20312 BVAR (current_buffer, header_line_format));
20313 ++n;
20314 }
20315
20316 selected_frame = old_selected_frame;
20317 selected_window = old_selected_window;
20318 return n;
20319 }
20320
20321
20322 /* Display mode or header line of window W. FACE_ID specifies which
20323 line to display; it is either MODE_LINE_FACE_ID or
20324 HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID. FORMAT is the mode/header line format to
20325 display. Value is the pixel height of the mode/header line
20326 displayed. */
20327
20328 static int
20329 display_mode_line (struct window *w, enum face_id face_id, Lisp_Object format)
20330 {
20331 struct it it;
20332 struct face *face;
20333 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
20334
20335 init_iterator (&it, w, -1, -1, NULL, face_id);
20336 /* Don't extend on a previously drawn mode-line.
20337 This may happen if called from pos_visible_p. */
20338 it.glyph_row->enabled_p = 0;
20339 prepare_desired_row (it.glyph_row);
20340
20341 it.glyph_row->mode_line_p = 1;
20342
20343 if (! mode_line_inverse_video)
20344 /* Force the mode-line to be displayed in the default face. */
20345 it.base_face_id = it.face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
20346
20347 /* FIXME: This should be controlled by a user option. But
20348 supporting such an option is not trivial, since the mode line is
20349 made up of many separate strings. */
20350 it.paragraph_embedding = L2R;
20351
20352 record_unwind_protect (unwind_format_mode_line,
20353 format_mode_line_unwind_data (NULL, NULL, Qnil, 0));
20354
20355 mode_line_target = MODE_LINE_DISPLAY;
20356
20357 /* Temporarily make frame's keyboard the current kboard so that
20358 kboard-local variables in the mode_line_format will get the right
20359 values. */
20360 push_kboard (FRAME_KBOARD (it.f));
20361 record_unwind_save_match_data ();
20362 display_mode_element (&it, 0, 0, 0, format, Qnil, 0);
20363 pop_kboard ();
20364
20365 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
20366
20367 /* Fill up with spaces. */
20368 display_string (" ", Qnil, Qnil, 0, 0, &it, 10000, -1, -1, 0);
20369
20370 compute_line_metrics (&it);
20371 it.glyph_row->full_width_p = 1;
20372 it.glyph_row->continued_p = 0;
20373 it.glyph_row->truncated_on_left_p = 0;
20374 it.glyph_row->truncated_on_right_p = 0;
20375
20376 /* Make a 3D mode-line have a shadow at its right end. */
20377 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it.f, face_id);
20378 extend_face_to_end_of_line (&it);
20379 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
20380 {
20381 struct glyph *last = (it.glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]
20382 + it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1);
20383 last->right_box_line_p = 1;
20384 }
20385
20386 return it.glyph_row->height;
20387 }
20388
20389 /* Move element ELT in LIST to the front of LIST.
20390 Return the updated list. */
20391
20392 static Lisp_Object
20393 move_elt_to_front (Lisp_Object elt, Lisp_Object list)
20394 {
20395 register Lisp_Object tail, prev;
20396 register Lisp_Object tem;
20397
20398 tail = list;
20399 prev = Qnil;
20400 while (CONSP (tail))
20401 {
20402 tem = XCAR (tail);
20403
20404 if (EQ (elt, tem))
20405 {
20406 /* Splice out the link TAIL. */
20407 if (NILP (prev))
20408 list = XCDR (tail);
20409 else
20410 Fsetcdr (prev, XCDR (tail));
20411
20412 /* Now make it the first. */
20413 Fsetcdr (tail, list);
20414 return tail;
20415 }
20416 else
20417 prev = tail;
20418 tail = XCDR (tail);
20419 QUIT;
20420 }
20421
20422 /* Not found--return unchanged LIST. */
20423 return list;
20424 }
20425
20426 /* Contribute ELT to the mode line for window IT->w. How it
20427 translates into text depends on its data type.
20428
20429 IT describes the display environment in which we display, as usual.
20430
20431 DEPTH is the depth in recursion. It is used to prevent
20432 infinite recursion here.
20433
20434 FIELD_WIDTH is the number of characters the display of ELT should
20435 occupy in the mode line, and PRECISION is the maximum number of
20436 characters to display from ELT's representation. See
20437 display_string for details.
20438
20439 Returns the hpos of the end of the text generated by ELT.
20440
20441 PROPS is a property list to add to any string we encounter.
20442
20443 If RISKY is nonzero, remove (disregard) any properties in any string
20444 we encounter, and ignore :eval and :propertize.
20445
20446 The global variable `mode_line_target' determines whether the
20447 output is passed to `store_mode_line_noprop',
20448 `store_mode_line_string', or `display_string'. */
20449
20450 static int
20451 display_mode_element (struct it *it, int depth, int field_width, int precision,
20452 Lisp_Object elt, Lisp_Object props, int risky)
20453 {
20454 int n = 0, field, prec;
20455 int literal = 0;
20456
20457 tail_recurse:
20458 if (depth > 100)
20459 elt = build_string ("*too-deep*");
20460
20461 depth++;
20462
20463 switch (XTYPE (elt))
20464 {
20465 case Lisp_String:
20466 {
20467 /* A string: output it and check for %-constructs within it. */
20468 unsigned char c;
20469 ptrdiff_t offset = 0;
20470
20471 if (SCHARS (elt) > 0
20472 && (!NILP (props) || risky))
20473 {
20474 Lisp_Object oprops, aelt;
20475 oprops = Ftext_properties_at (make_number (0), elt);
20476
20477 /* If the starting string's properties are not what
20478 we want, translate the string. Also, if the string
20479 is risky, do that anyway. */
20480
20481 if (NILP (Fequal (props, oprops)) || risky)
20482 {
20483 /* If the starting string has properties,
20484 merge the specified ones onto the existing ones. */
20485 if (! NILP (oprops) && !risky)
20486 {
20487 Lisp_Object tem;
20488
20489 oprops = Fcopy_sequence (oprops);
20490 tem = props;
20491 while (CONSP (tem))
20492 {
20493 oprops = Fplist_put (oprops, XCAR (tem),
20494 XCAR (XCDR (tem)));
20495 tem = XCDR (XCDR (tem));
20496 }
20497 props = oprops;
20498 }
20499
20500 aelt = Fassoc (elt, mode_line_proptrans_alist);
20501 if (! NILP (aelt) && !NILP (Fequal (props, XCDR (aelt))))
20502 {
20503 /* AELT is what we want. Move it to the front
20504 without consing. */
20505 elt = XCAR (aelt);
20506 mode_line_proptrans_alist
20507 = move_elt_to_front (aelt, mode_line_proptrans_alist);
20508 }
20509 else
20510 {
20511 Lisp_Object tem;
20512
20513 /* If AELT has the wrong props, it is useless.
20514 so get rid of it. */
20515 if (! NILP (aelt))
20516 mode_line_proptrans_alist
20517 = Fdelq (aelt, mode_line_proptrans_alist);
20518
20519 elt = Fcopy_sequence (elt);
20520 Fset_text_properties (make_number (0), Flength (elt),
20521 props, elt);
20522 /* Add this item to mode_line_proptrans_alist. */
20523 mode_line_proptrans_alist
20524 = Fcons (Fcons (elt, props),
20525 mode_line_proptrans_alist);
20526 /* Truncate mode_line_proptrans_alist
20527 to at most 50 elements. */
20528 tem = Fnthcdr (make_number (50),
20529 mode_line_proptrans_alist);
20530 if (! NILP (tem))
20531 XSETCDR (tem, Qnil);
20532 }
20533 }
20534 }
20535
20536 offset = 0;
20537
20538 if (literal)
20539 {
20540 prec = precision - n;
20541 switch (mode_line_target)
20542 {
20543 case MODE_LINE_NOPROP:
20544 case MODE_LINE_TITLE:
20545 n += store_mode_line_noprop (SSDATA (elt), -1, prec);
20546 break;
20547 case MODE_LINE_STRING:
20548 n += store_mode_line_string (NULL, elt, 1, 0, prec, Qnil);
20549 break;
20550 case MODE_LINE_DISPLAY:
20551 n += display_string (NULL, elt, Qnil, 0, 0, it,
20552 0, prec, 0, STRING_MULTIBYTE (elt));
20553 break;
20554 }
20555
20556 break;
20557 }
20558
20559 /* Handle the non-literal case. */
20560
20561 while ((precision <= 0 || n < precision)
20562 && SREF (elt, offset) != 0
20563 && (mode_line_target != MODE_LINE_DISPLAY
20564 || it->current_x < it->last_visible_x))
20565 {
20566 ptrdiff_t last_offset = offset;
20567
20568 /* Advance to end of string or next format specifier. */
20569 while ((c = SREF (elt, offset++)) != '\0' && c != '%')
20570 ;
20571
20572 if (offset - 1 != last_offset)
20573 {
20574 ptrdiff_t nchars, nbytes;
20575
20576 /* Output to end of string or up to '%'. Field width
20577 is length of string. Don't output more than
20578 PRECISION allows us. */
20579 offset--;
20580
20581 prec = c_string_width (SDATA (elt) + last_offset,
20582 offset - last_offset, precision - n,
20583 &nchars, &nbytes);
20584
20585 switch (mode_line_target)
20586 {
20587 case MODE_LINE_NOPROP:
20588 case MODE_LINE_TITLE:
20589 n += store_mode_line_noprop (SSDATA (elt) + last_offset, 0, prec);
20590 break;
20591 case MODE_LINE_STRING:
20592 {
20593 ptrdiff_t bytepos = last_offset;
20594 ptrdiff_t charpos = string_byte_to_char (elt, bytepos);
20595 ptrdiff_t endpos = (precision <= 0
20596 ? string_byte_to_char (elt, offset)
20597 : charpos + nchars);
20598
20599 n += store_mode_line_string (NULL,
20600 Fsubstring (elt, make_number (charpos),
20601 make_number (endpos)),
20602 0, 0, 0, Qnil);
20603 }
20604 break;
20605 case MODE_LINE_DISPLAY:
20606 {
20607 ptrdiff_t bytepos = last_offset;
20608 ptrdiff_t charpos = string_byte_to_char (elt, bytepos);
20609
20610 if (precision <= 0)
20611 nchars = string_byte_to_char (elt, offset) - charpos;
20612 n += display_string (NULL, elt, Qnil, 0, charpos,
20613 it, 0, nchars, 0,
20614 STRING_MULTIBYTE (elt));
20615 }
20616 break;
20617 }
20618 }
20619 else /* c == '%' */
20620 {
20621 ptrdiff_t percent_position = offset;
20622
20623 /* Get the specified minimum width. Zero means
20624 don't pad. */
20625 field = 0;
20626 while ((c = SREF (elt, offset++)) >= '0' && c <= '9')
20627 field = field * 10 + c - '0';
20628
20629 /* Don't pad beyond the total padding allowed. */
20630 if (field_width - n > 0 && field > field_width - n)
20631 field = field_width - n;
20632
20633 /* Note that either PRECISION <= 0 or N < PRECISION. */
20634 prec = precision - n;
20635
20636 if (c == 'M')
20637 n += display_mode_element (it, depth, field, prec,
20638 Vglobal_mode_string, props,
20639 risky);
20640 else if (c != 0)
20641 {
20642 int multibyte;
20643 ptrdiff_t bytepos, charpos;
20644 const char *spec;
20645 Lisp_Object string;
20646
20647 bytepos = percent_position;
20648 charpos = (STRING_MULTIBYTE (elt)
20649 ? string_byte_to_char (elt, bytepos)
20650 : bytepos);
20651 spec = decode_mode_spec (it->w, c, field, &string);
20652 multibyte = STRINGP (string) && STRING_MULTIBYTE (string);
20653
20654 switch (mode_line_target)
20655 {
20656 case MODE_LINE_NOPROP:
20657 case MODE_LINE_TITLE:
20658 n += store_mode_line_noprop (spec, field, prec);
20659 break;
20660 case MODE_LINE_STRING:
20661 {
20662 Lisp_Object tem = build_string (spec);
20663 props = Ftext_properties_at (make_number (charpos), elt);
20664 /* Should only keep face property in props */
20665 n += store_mode_line_string (NULL, tem, 0, field, prec, props);
20666 }
20667 break;
20668 case MODE_LINE_DISPLAY:
20669 {
20670 int nglyphs_before, nwritten;
20671
20672 nglyphs_before = it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
20673 nwritten = display_string (spec, string, elt,
20674 charpos, 0, it,
20675 field, prec, 0,
20676 multibyte);
20677
20678 /* Assign to the glyphs written above the
20679 string where the `%x' came from, position
20680 of the `%'. */
20681 if (nwritten > 0)
20682 {
20683 struct glyph *glyph
20684 = (it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]
20685 + nglyphs_before);
20686 int i;
20687
20688 for (i = 0; i < nwritten; ++i)
20689 {
20690 glyph[i].object = elt;
20691 glyph[i].charpos = charpos;
20692 }
20693
20694 n += nwritten;
20695 }
20696 }
20697 break;
20698 }
20699 }
20700 else /* c == 0 */
20701 break;
20702 }
20703 }
20704 }
20705 break;
20706
20707 case Lisp_Symbol:
20708 /* A symbol: process the value of the symbol recursively
20709 as if it appeared here directly. Avoid error if symbol void.
20710 Special case: if value of symbol is a string, output the string
20711 literally. */
20712 {
20713 register Lisp_Object tem;
20714
20715 /* If the variable is not marked as risky to set
20716 then its contents are risky to use. */
20717 if (NILP (Fget (elt, Qrisky_local_variable)))
20718 risky = 1;
20719
20720 tem = Fboundp (elt);
20721 if (!NILP (tem))
20722 {
20723 tem = Fsymbol_value (elt);
20724 /* If value is a string, output that string literally:
20725 don't check for % within it. */
20726 if (STRINGP (tem))
20727 literal = 1;
20728
20729 if (!EQ (tem, elt))
20730 {
20731 /* Give up right away for nil or t. */
20732 elt = tem;
20733 goto tail_recurse;
20734 }
20735 }
20736 }
20737 break;
20738
20739 case Lisp_Cons:
20740 {
20741 register Lisp_Object car, tem;
20742
20743 /* A cons cell: five distinct cases.
20744 If first element is :eval or :propertize, do something special.
20745 If first element is a string or a cons, process all the elements
20746 and effectively concatenate them.
20747 If first element is a negative number, truncate displaying cdr to
20748 at most that many characters. If positive, pad (with spaces)
20749 to at least that many characters.
20750 If first element is a symbol, process the cadr or caddr recursively
20751 according to whether the symbol's value is non-nil or nil. */
20752 car = XCAR (elt);
20753 if (EQ (car, QCeval))
20754 {
20755 /* An element of the form (:eval FORM) means evaluate FORM
20756 and use the result as mode line elements. */
20757
20758 if (risky)
20759 break;
20760
20761 if (CONSP (XCDR (elt)))
20762 {
20763 Lisp_Object spec;
20764 spec = safe_eval (XCAR (XCDR (elt)));
20765 n += display_mode_element (it, depth, field_width - n,
20766 precision - n, spec, props,
20767 risky);
20768 }
20769 }
20770 else if (EQ (car, QCpropertize))
20771 {
20772 /* An element of the form (:propertize ELT PROPS...)
20773 means display ELT but applying properties PROPS. */
20774
20775 if (risky)
20776 break;
20777
20778 if (CONSP (XCDR (elt)))
20779 n += display_mode_element (it, depth, field_width - n,
20780 precision - n, XCAR (XCDR (elt)),
20781 XCDR (XCDR (elt)), risky);
20782 }
20783 else if (SYMBOLP (car))
20784 {
20785 tem = Fboundp (car);
20786 elt = XCDR (elt);
20787 if (!CONSP (elt))
20788 goto invalid;
20789 /* elt is now the cdr, and we know it is a cons cell.
20790 Use its car if CAR has a non-nil value. */
20791 if (!NILP (tem))
20792 {
20793 tem = Fsymbol_value (car);
20794 if (!NILP (tem))
20795 {
20796 elt = XCAR (elt);
20797 goto tail_recurse;
20798 }
20799 }
20800 /* Symbol's value is nil (or symbol is unbound)
20801 Get the cddr of the original list
20802 and if possible find the caddr and use that. */
20803 elt = XCDR (elt);
20804 if (NILP (elt))
20805 break;
20806 else if (!CONSP (elt))
20807 goto invalid;
20808 elt = XCAR (elt);
20809 goto tail_recurse;
20810 }
20811 else if (INTEGERP (car))
20812 {
20813 register int lim = XINT (car);
20814 elt = XCDR (elt);
20815 if (lim < 0)
20816 {
20817 /* Negative int means reduce maximum width. */
20818 if (precision <= 0)
20819 precision = -lim;
20820 else
20821 precision = min (precision, -lim);
20822 }
20823 else if (lim > 0)
20824 {
20825 /* Padding specified. Don't let it be more than
20826 current maximum. */
20827 if (precision > 0)
20828 lim = min (precision, lim);
20829
20830 /* If that's more padding than already wanted, queue it.
20831 But don't reduce padding already specified even if
20832 that is beyond the current truncation point. */
20833 field_width = max (lim, field_width);
20834 }
20835 goto tail_recurse;
20836 }
20837 else if (STRINGP (car) || CONSP (car))
20838 {
20839 Lisp_Object halftail = elt;
20840 int len = 0;
20841
20842 while (CONSP (elt)
20843 && (precision <= 0 || n < precision))
20844 {
20845 n += display_mode_element (it, depth,
20846 /* Do padding only after the last
20847 element in the list. */
20848 (! CONSP (XCDR (elt))
20849 ? field_width - n
20850 : 0),
20851 precision - n, XCAR (elt),
20852 props, risky);
20853 elt = XCDR (elt);
20854 len++;
20855 if ((len & 1) == 0)
20856 halftail = XCDR (halftail);
20857 /* Check for cycle. */
20858 if (EQ (halftail, elt))
20859 break;
20860 }
20861 }
20862 }
20863 break;
20864
20865 default:
20866 invalid:
20867 elt = build_string ("*invalid*");
20868 goto tail_recurse;
20869 }
20870
20871 /* Pad to FIELD_WIDTH. */
20872 if (field_width > 0 && n < field_width)
20873 {
20874 switch (mode_line_target)
20875 {
20876 case MODE_LINE_NOPROP:
20877 case MODE_LINE_TITLE:
20878 n += store_mode_line_noprop ("", field_width - n, 0);
20879 break;
20880 case MODE_LINE_STRING:
20881 n += store_mode_line_string ("", Qnil, 0, field_width - n, 0, Qnil);
20882 break;
20883 case MODE_LINE_DISPLAY:
20884 n += display_string ("", Qnil, Qnil, 0, 0, it, field_width - n,
20885 0, 0, 0);
20886 break;
20887 }
20888 }
20889
20890 return n;
20891 }
20892
20893 /* Store a mode-line string element in mode_line_string_list.
20894
20895 If STRING is non-null, display that C string. Otherwise, the Lisp
20896 string LISP_STRING is displayed.
20897
20898 FIELD_WIDTH is the minimum number of output glyphs to produce.
20899 If STRING has fewer characters than FIELD_WIDTH, pad to the right
20900 with spaces. FIELD_WIDTH <= 0 means don't pad.
20901
20902 PRECISION is the maximum number of characters to output from
20903 STRING. PRECISION <= 0 means don't truncate the string.
20904
20905 If COPY_STRING is non-zero, make a copy of LISP_STRING before adding
20906 properties to the string.
20907
20908 PROPS are the properties to add to the string.
20909 The mode_line_string_face face property is always added to the string.
20910 */
20911
20912 static int
20913 store_mode_line_string (const char *string, Lisp_Object lisp_string, int copy_string,
20914 int field_width, int precision, Lisp_Object props)
20915 {
20916 ptrdiff_t len;
20917 int n = 0;
20918
20919 if (string != NULL)
20920 {
20921 len = strlen (string);
20922 if (precision > 0 && len > precision)
20923 len = precision;
20924 lisp_string = make_string (string, len);
20925 if (NILP (props))
20926 props = mode_line_string_face_prop;
20927 else if (!NILP (mode_line_string_face))
20928 {
20929 Lisp_Object face = Fplist_get (props, Qface);
20930 props = Fcopy_sequence (props);
20931 if (NILP (face))
20932 face = mode_line_string_face;
20933 else
20934 face = Fcons (face, Fcons (mode_line_string_face, Qnil));
20935 props = Fplist_put (props, Qface, face);
20936 }
20937 Fadd_text_properties (make_number (0), make_number (len),
20938 props, lisp_string);
20939 }
20940 else
20941 {
20942 len = XFASTINT (Flength (lisp_string));
20943 if (precision > 0 && len > precision)
20944 {
20945 len = precision;
20946 lisp_string = Fsubstring (lisp_string, make_number (0), make_number (len));
20947 precision = -1;
20948 }
20949 if (!NILP (mode_line_string_face))
20950 {
20951 Lisp_Object face;
20952 if (NILP (props))
20953 props = Ftext_properties_at (make_number (0), lisp_string);
20954 face = Fplist_get (props, Qface);
20955 if (NILP (face))
20956 face = mode_line_string_face;
20957 else
20958 face = Fcons (face, Fcons (mode_line_string_face, Qnil));
20959 props = Fcons (Qface, Fcons (face, Qnil));
20960 if (copy_string)
20961 lisp_string = Fcopy_sequence (lisp_string);
20962 }
20963 if (!NILP (props))
20964 Fadd_text_properties (make_number (0), make_number (len),
20965 props, lisp_string);
20966 }
20967
20968 if (len > 0)
20969 {
20970 mode_line_string_list = Fcons (lisp_string, mode_line_string_list);
20971 n += len;
20972 }
20973
20974 if (field_width > len)
20975 {
20976 field_width -= len;
20977 lisp_string = Fmake_string (make_number (field_width), make_number (' '));
20978 if (!NILP (props))
20979 Fadd_text_properties (make_number (0), make_number (field_width),
20980 props, lisp_string);
20981 mode_line_string_list = Fcons (lisp_string, mode_line_string_list);
20982 n += field_width;
20983 }
20984
20985 return n;
20986 }
20987
20988
20989 DEFUN ("format-mode-line", Fformat_mode_line, Sformat_mode_line,
20990 1, 4, 0,
20991 doc: /* Format a string out of a mode line format specification.
20992 First arg FORMAT specifies the mode line format (see `mode-line-format'
20993 for details) to use.
20994
20995 By default, the format is evaluated for the currently selected window.
20996
20997 Optional second arg FACE specifies the face property to put on all
20998 characters for which no face is specified. The value nil means the
20999 default face. The value t means whatever face the window's mode line
21000 currently uses (either `mode-line' or `mode-line-inactive',
21001 depending on whether the window is the selected window or not).
21002 An integer value means the value string has no text
21003 properties.
21004
21005 Optional third and fourth args WINDOW and BUFFER specify the window
21006 and buffer to use as the context for the formatting (defaults
21007 are the selected window and the WINDOW's buffer). */)
21008 (Lisp_Object format, Lisp_Object face,
21009 Lisp_Object window, Lisp_Object buffer)
21010 {
21011 struct it it;
21012 int len;
21013 struct window *w;
21014 struct buffer *old_buffer = NULL;
21015 int face_id;
21016 int no_props = INTEGERP (face);
21017 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
21018 Lisp_Object str;
21019 int string_start = 0;
21020
21021 if (NILP (window))
21022 window = selected_window;
21023 CHECK_WINDOW (window);
21024 w = XWINDOW (window);
21025
21026 if (NILP (buffer))
21027 buffer = w->buffer;
21028 CHECK_BUFFER (buffer);
21029
21030 /* Make formatting the modeline a non-op when noninteractive, otherwise
21031 there will be problems later caused by a partially initialized frame. */
21032 if (NILP (format) || noninteractive)
21033 return empty_unibyte_string;
21034
21035 if (no_props)
21036 face = Qnil;
21037
21038 face_id = (NILP (face) || EQ (face, Qdefault)) ? DEFAULT_FACE_ID
21039 : EQ (face, Qt) ? (EQ (window, selected_window)
21040 ? MODE_LINE_FACE_ID : MODE_LINE_INACTIVE_FACE_ID)
21041 : EQ (face, Qmode_line) ? MODE_LINE_FACE_ID
21042 : EQ (face, Qmode_line_inactive) ? MODE_LINE_INACTIVE_FACE_ID
21043 : EQ (face, Qheader_line) ? HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID
21044 : EQ (face, Qtool_bar) ? TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID
21045 : DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
21046
21047 if (XBUFFER (buffer) != current_buffer)
21048 old_buffer = current_buffer;
21049
21050 /* Save things including mode_line_proptrans_alist,
21051 and set that to nil so that we don't alter the outer value. */
21052 record_unwind_protect (unwind_format_mode_line,
21053 format_mode_line_unwind_data
21054 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (window))),
21055 old_buffer, selected_window, 1));
21056 mode_line_proptrans_alist = Qnil;
21057
21058 Fselect_window (window, Qt);
21059 if (old_buffer)
21060 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (buffer));
21061
21062 init_iterator (&it, w, -1, -1, NULL, face_id);
21063
21064 if (no_props)
21065 {
21066 mode_line_target = MODE_LINE_NOPROP;
21067 mode_line_string_face_prop = Qnil;
21068 mode_line_string_list = Qnil;
21069 string_start = MODE_LINE_NOPROP_LEN (0);
21070 }
21071 else
21072 {
21073 mode_line_target = MODE_LINE_STRING;
21074 mode_line_string_list = Qnil;
21075 mode_line_string_face = face;
21076 mode_line_string_face_prop
21077 = (NILP (face) ? Qnil : Fcons (Qface, Fcons (face, Qnil)));
21078 }
21079
21080 push_kboard (FRAME_KBOARD (it.f));
21081 display_mode_element (&it, 0, 0, 0, format, Qnil, 0);
21082 pop_kboard ();
21083
21084 if (no_props)
21085 {
21086 len = MODE_LINE_NOPROP_LEN (string_start);
21087 str = make_string (mode_line_noprop_buf + string_start, len);
21088 }
21089 else
21090 {
21091 mode_line_string_list = Fnreverse (mode_line_string_list);
21092 str = Fmapconcat (intern ("identity"), mode_line_string_list,
21093 empty_unibyte_string);
21094 }
21095
21096 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
21097 return str;
21098 }
21099
21100 /* Write a null-terminated, right justified decimal representation of
21101 the positive integer D to BUF using a minimal field width WIDTH. */
21102
21103 static void
21104 pint2str (register char *buf, register int width, register ptrdiff_t d)
21105 {
21106 register char *p = buf;
21107
21108 if (d <= 0)
21109 *p++ = '0';
21110 else
21111 {
21112 while (d > 0)
21113 {
21114 *p++ = d % 10 + '0';
21115 d /= 10;
21116 }
21117 }
21118
21119 for (width -= (int) (p - buf); width > 0; --width)
21120 *p++ = ' ';
21121 *p-- = '\0';
21122 while (p > buf)
21123 {
21124 d = *buf;
21125 *buf++ = *p;
21126 *p-- = d;
21127 }
21128 }
21129
21130 /* Write a null-terminated, right justified decimal and "human
21131 readable" representation of the nonnegative integer D to BUF using
21132 a minimal field width WIDTH. D should be smaller than 999.5e24. */
21133
21134 static const char power_letter[] =
21135 {
21136 0, /* no letter */
21137 'k', /* kilo */
21138 'M', /* mega */
21139 'G', /* giga */
21140 'T', /* tera */
21141 'P', /* peta */
21142 'E', /* exa */
21143 'Z', /* zetta */
21144 'Y' /* yotta */
21145 };
21146
21147 static void
21148 pint2hrstr (char *buf, int width, ptrdiff_t d)
21149 {
21150 /* We aim to represent the nonnegative integer D as
21151 QUOTIENT.TENTHS * 10 ^ (3 * EXPONENT). */
21152 ptrdiff_t quotient = d;
21153 int remainder = 0;
21154 /* -1 means: do not use TENTHS. */
21155 int tenths = -1;
21156 int exponent = 0;
21157
21158 /* Length of QUOTIENT.TENTHS as a string. */
21159 int length;
21160
21161 char * psuffix;
21162 char * p;
21163
21164 if (1000 <= quotient)
21165 {
21166 /* Scale to the appropriate EXPONENT. */
21167 do
21168 {
21169 remainder = quotient % 1000;
21170 quotient /= 1000;
21171 exponent++;
21172 }
21173 while (1000 <= quotient);
21174
21175 /* Round to nearest and decide whether to use TENTHS or not. */
21176 if (quotient <= 9)
21177 {
21178 tenths = remainder / 100;
21179 if (50 <= remainder % 100)
21180 {
21181 if (tenths < 9)
21182 tenths++;
21183 else
21184 {
21185 quotient++;
21186 if (quotient == 10)
21187 tenths = -1;
21188 else
21189 tenths = 0;
21190 }
21191 }
21192 }
21193 else
21194 if (500 <= remainder)
21195 {
21196 if (quotient < 999)
21197 quotient++;
21198 else
21199 {
21200 quotient = 1;
21201 exponent++;
21202 tenths = 0;
21203 }
21204 }
21205 }
21206
21207 /* Calculate the LENGTH of QUOTIENT.TENTHS as a string. */
21208 if (tenths == -1 && quotient <= 99)
21209 if (quotient <= 9)
21210 length = 1;
21211 else
21212 length = 2;
21213 else
21214 length = 3;
21215 p = psuffix = buf + max (width, length);
21216
21217 /* Print EXPONENT. */
21218 *psuffix++ = power_letter[exponent];
21219 *psuffix = '\0';
21220
21221 /* Print TENTHS. */
21222 if (tenths >= 0)
21223 {
21224 *--p = '0' + tenths;
21225 *--p = '.';
21226 }
21227
21228 /* Print QUOTIENT. */
21229 do
21230 {
21231 int digit = quotient % 10;
21232 *--p = '0' + digit;
21233 }
21234 while ((quotient /= 10) != 0);
21235
21236 /* Print leading spaces. */
21237 while (buf < p)
21238 *--p = ' ';
21239 }
21240
21241 /* Set a mnemonic character for coding_system (Lisp symbol) in BUF.
21242 If EOL_FLAG is 1, set also a mnemonic character for end-of-line
21243 type of CODING_SYSTEM. Return updated pointer into BUF. */
21244
21245 static unsigned char invalid_eol_type[] = "(*invalid*)";
21246
21247 static char *
21248 decode_mode_spec_coding (Lisp_Object coding_system, register char *buf, int eol_flag)
21249 {
21250 Lisp_Object val;
21251 int multibyte = !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters));
21252 const unsigned char *eol_str;
21253 int eol_str_len;
21254 /* The EOL conversion we are using. */
21255 Lisp_Object eoltype;
21256
21257 val = CODING_SYSTEM_SPEC (coding_system);
21258 eoltype = Qnil;
21259
21260 if (!VECTORP (val)) /* Not yet decided. */
21261 {
21262 *buf++ = multibyte ? '-' : ' ';
21263 if (eol_flag)
21264 eoltype = eol_mnemonic_undecided;
21265 /* Don't mention EOL conversion if it isn't decided. */
21266 }
21267 else
21268 {
21269 Lisp_Object attrs;
21270 Lisp_Object eolvalue;
21271
21272 attrs = AREF (val, 0);
21273 eolvalue = AREF (val, 2);
21274
21275 *buf++ = multibyte
21276 ? XFASTINT (CODING_ATTR_MNEMONIC (attrs))
21277 : ' ';
21278
21279 if (eol_flag)
21280 {
21281 /* The EOL conversion that is normal on this system. */
21282
21283 if (NILP (eolvalue)) /* Not yet decided. */
21284 eoltype = eol_mnemonic_undecided;
21285 else if (VECTORP (eolvalue)) /* Not yet decided. */
21286 eoltype = eol_mnemonic_undecided;
21287 else /* eolvalue is Qunix, Qdos, or Qmac. */
21288 eoltype = (EQ (eolvalue, Qunix)
21289 ? eol_mnemonic_unix
21290 : (EQ (eolvalue, Qdos) == 1
21291 ? eol_mnemonic_dos : eol_mnemonic_mac));
21292 }
21293 }
21294
21295 if (eol_flag)
21296 {
21297 /* Mention the EOL conversion if it is not the usual one. */
21298 if (STRINGP (eoltype))
21299 {
21300 eol_str = SDATA (eoltype);
21301 eol_str_len = SBYTES (eoltype);
21302 }
21303 else if (CHARACTERP (eoltype))
21304 {
21305 unsigned char *tmp = alloca (MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH);
21306 int c = XFASTINT (eoltype);
21307 eol_str_len = CHAR_STRING (c, tmp);
21308 eol_str = tmp;
21309 }
21310 else
21311 {
21312 eol_str = invalid_eol_type;
21313 eol_str_len = sizeof (invalid_eol_type) - 1;
21314 }
21315 memcpy (buf, eol_str, eol_str_len);
21316 buf += eol_str_len;
21317 }
21318
21319 return buf;
21320 }
21321
21322 /* Return a string for the output of a mode line %-spec for window W,
21323 generated by character C. FIELD_WIDTH > 0 means pad the string
21324 returned with spaces to that value. Return a Lisp string in
21325 *STRING if the resulting string is taken from that Lisp string.
21326
21327 Note we operate on the current buffer for most purposes,
21328 the exception being w->base_line_pos. */
21329
21330 static char lots_of_dashes[] = "--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------";
21331
21332 static const char *
21333 decode_mode_spec (struct window *w, register int c, int field_width,
21334 Lisp_Object *string)
21335 {
21336 Lisp_Object obj;
21337 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
21338 char *decode_mode_spec_buf = f->decode_mode_spec_buffer;
21339 struct buffer *b = current_buffer;
21340
21341 obj = Qnil;
21342 *string = Qnil;
21343
21344 switch (c)
21345 {
21346 case '*':
21347 if (!NILP (BVAR (b, read_only)))
21348 return "%";
21349 if (BUF_MODIFF (b) > BUF_SAVE_MODIFF (b))
21350 return "*";
21351 return "-";
21352
21353 case '+':
21354 /* This differs from %* only for a modified read-only buffer. */
21355 if (BUF_MODIFF (b) > BUF_SAVE_MODIFF (b))
21356 return "*";
21357 if (!NILP (BVAR (b, read_only)))
21358 return "%";
21359 return "-";
21360
21361 case '&':
21362 /* This differs from %* in ignoring read-only-ness. */
21363 if (BUF_MODIFF (b) > BUF_SAVE_MODIFF (b))
21364 return "*";
21365 return "-";
21366
21367 case '%':
21368 return "%";
21369
21370 case '[':
21371 {
21372 int i;
21373 char *p;
21374
21375 if (command_loop_level > 5)
21376 return "[[[... ";
21377 p = decode_mode_spec_buf;
21378 for (i = 0; i < command_loop_level; i++)
21379 *p++ = '[';
21380 *p = 0;
21381 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21382 }
21383
21384 case ']':
21385 {
21386 int i;
21387 char *p;
21388
21389 if (command_loop_level > 5)
21390 return " ...]]]";
21391 p = decode_mode_spec_buf;
21392 for (i = 0; i < command_loop_level; i++)
21393 *p++ = ']';
21394 *p = 0;
21395 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21396 }
21397
21398 case '-':
21399 {
21400 register int i;
21401
21402 /* Let lots_of_dashes be a string of infinite length. */
21403 if (mode_line_target == MODE_LINE_NOPROP ||
21404 mode_line_target == MODE_LINE_STRING)
21405 return "--";
21406 if (field_width <= 0
21407 || field_width > sizeof (lots_of_dashes))
21408 {
21409 for (i = 0; i < FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF_SIZE (f) - 1; ++i)
21410 decode_mode_spec_buf[i] = '-';
21411 decode_mode_spec_buf[i] = '\0';
21412 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21413 }
21414 else
21415 return lots_of_dashes;
21416 }
21417
21418 case 'b':
21419 obj = BVAR (b, name);
21420 break;
21421
21422 case 'c':
21423 /* %c and %l are ignored in `frame-title-format'.
21424 (In redisplay_internal, the frame title is drawn _before_ the
21425 windows are updated, so the stuff which depends on actual
21426 window contents (such as %l) may fail to render properly, or
21427 even crash emacs.) */
21428 if (mode_line_target == MODE_LINE_TITLE)
21429 return "";
21430 else
21431 {
21432 ptrdiff_t col = current_column ();
21433 wset_column_number_displayed (w, make_number (col));
21434 pint2str (decode_mode_spec_buf, field_width, col);
21435 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21436 }
21437
21438 case 'e':
21439 #ifndef SYSTEM_MALLOC
21440 {
21441 if (NILP (Vmemory_full))
21442 return "";
21443 else
21444 return "!MEM FULL! ";
21445 }
21446 #else
21447 return "";
21448 #endif
21449
21450 case 'F':
21451 /* %F displays the frame name. */
21452 if (!NILP (f->title))
21453 return SSDATA (f->title);
21454 if (f->explicit_name || ! FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
21455 return SSDATA (f->name);
21456 return "Emacs";
21457
21458 case 'f':
21459 obj = BVAR (b, filename);
21460 break;
21461
21462 case 'i':
21463 {
21464 ptrdiff_t size = ZV - BEGV;
21465 pint2str (decode_mode_spec_buf, field_width, size);
21466 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21467 }
21468
21469 case 'I':
21470 {
21471 ptrdiff_t size = ZV - BEGV;
21472 pint2hrstr (decode_mode_spec_buf, field_width, size);
21473 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21474 }
21475
21476 case 'l':
21477 {
21478 ptrdiff_t startpos, startpos_byte, line, linepos, linepos_byte;
21479 ptrdiff_t topline, nlines, height;
21480 ptrdiff_t junk;
21481
21482 /* %c and %l are ignored in `frame-title-format'. */
21483 if (mode_line_target == MODE_LINE_TITLE)
21484 return "";
21485
21486 startpos = XMARKER (w->start)->charpos;
21487 startpos_byte = marker_byte_position (w->start);
21488 height = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w);
21489
21490 /* If we decided that this buffer isn't suitable for line numbers,
21491 don't forget that too fast. */
21492 if (EQ (w->base_line_pos, w->buffer))
21493 goto no_value;
21494 /* But do forget it, if the window shows a different buffer now. */
21495 else if (BUFFERP (w->base_line_pos))
21496 wset_base_line_pos (w, Qnil);
21497
21498 /* If the buffer is very big, don't waste time. */
21499 if (INTEGERP (Vline_number_display_limit)
21500 && BUF_ZV (b) - BUF_BEGV (b) > XINT (Vline_number_display_limit))
21501 {
21502 wset_base_line_pos (w, Qnil);
21503 wset_base_line_number (w, Qnil);
21504 goto no_value;
21505 }
21506
21507 if (INTEGERP (w->base_line_number)
21508 && INTEGERP (w->base_line_pos)
21509 && XFASTINT (w->base_line_pos) <= startpos)
21510 {
21511 line = XFASTINT (w->base_line_number);
21512 linepos = XFASTINT (w->base_line_pos);
21513 linepos_byte = buf_charpos_to_bytepos (b, linepos);
21514 }
21515 else
21516 {
21517 line = 1;
21518 linepos = BUF_BEGV (b);
21519 linepos_byte = BUF_BEGV_BYTE (b);
21520 }
21521
21522 /* Count lines from base line to window start position. */
21523 nlines = display_count_lines (linepos_byte,
21524 startpos_byte,
21525 startpos, &junk);
21526
21527 topline = nlines + line;
21528
21529 /* Determine a new base line, if the old one is too close
21530 or too far away, or if we did not have one.
21531 "Too close" means it's plausible a scroll-down would
21532 go back past it. */
21533 if (startpos == BUF_BEGV (b))
21534 {
21535 wset_base_line_number (w, make_number (topline));
21536 wset_base_line_pos (w, make_number (BUF_BEGV (b)));
21537 }
21538 else if (nlines < height + 25 || nlines > height * 3 + 50
21539 || linepos == BUF_BEGV (b))
21540 {
21541 ptrdiff_t limit = BUF_BEGV (b);
21542 ptrdiff_t limit_byte = BUF_BEGV_BYTE (b);
21543 ptrdiff_t position;
21544 ptrdiff_t distance =
21545 (height * 2 + 30) * line_number_display_limit_width;
21546
21547 if (startpos - distance > limit)
21548 {
21549 limit = startpos - distance;
21550 limit_byte = CHAR_TO_BYTE (limit);
21551 }
21552
21553 nlines = display_count_lines (startpos_byte,
21554 limit_byte,
21555 - (height * 2 + 30),
21556 &position);
21557 /* If we couldn't find the lines we wanted within
21558 line_number_display_limit_width chars per line,
21559 give up on line numbers for this window. */
21560 if (position == limit_byte && limit == startpos - distance)
21561 {
21562 wset_base_line_pos (w, w->buffer);
21563 wset_base_line_number (w, Qnil);
21564 goto no_value;
21565 }
21566
21567 wset_base_line_number (w, make_number (topline - nlines));
21568 wset_base_line_pos (w, make_number (BYTE_TO_CHAR (position)));
21569 }
21570
21571 /* Now count lines from the start pos to point. */
21572 nlines = display_count_lines (startpos_byte,
21573 PT_BYTE, PT, &junk);
21574
21575 /* Record that we did display the line number. */
21576 line_number_displayed = 1;
21577
21578 /* Make the string to show. */
21579 pint2str (decode_mode_spec_buf, field_width, topline + nlines);
21580 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21581 no_value:
21582 {
21583 char* p = decode_mode_spec_buf;
21584 int pad = field_width - 2;
21585 while (pad-- > 0)
21586 *p++ = ' ';
21587 *p++ = '?';
21588 *p++ = '?';
21589 *p = '\0';
21590 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21591 }
21592 }
21593 break;
21594
21595 case 'm':
21596 obj = BVAR (b, mode_name);
21597 break;
21598
21599 case 'n':
21600 if (BUF_BEGV (b) > BUF_BEG (b) || BUF_ZV (b) < BUF_Z (b))
21601 return " Narrow";
21602 break;
21603
21604 case 'p':
21605 {
21606 ptrdiff_t pos = marker_position (w->start);
21607 ptrdiff_t total = BUF_ZV (b) - BUF_BEGV (b);
21608
21609 if (XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos) <= BUF_Z (b) - BUF_ZV (b))
21610 {
21611 if (pos <= BUF_BEGV (b))
21612 return "All";
21613 else
21614 return "Bottom";
21615 }
21616 else if (pos <= BUF_BEGV (b))
21617 return "Top";
21618 else
21619 {
21620 if (total > 1000000)
21621 /* Do it differently for a large value, to avoid overflow. */
21622 total = ((pos - BUF_BEGV (b)) + (total / 100) - 1) / (total / 100);
21623 else
21624 total = ((pos - BUF_BEGV (b)) * 100 + total - 1) / total;
21625 /* We can't normally display a 3-digit number,
21626 so get us a 2-digit number that is close. */
21627 if (total == 100)
21628 total = 99;
21629 sprintf (decode_mode_spec_buf, "%2"pD"d%%", total);
21630 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21631 }
21632 }
21633
21634 /* Display percentage of size above the bottom of the screen. */
21635 case 'P':
21636 {
21637 ptrdiff_t toppos = marker_position (w->start);
21638 ptrdiff_t botpos = BUF_Z (b) - XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos);
21639 ptrdiff_t total = BUF_ZV (b) - BUF_BEGV (b);
21640
21641 if (botpos >= BUF_ZV (b))
21642 {
21643 if (toppos <= BUF_BEGV (b))
21644 return "All";
21645 else
21646 return "Bottom";
21647 }
21648 else
21649 {
21650 if (total > 1000000)
21651 /* Do it differently for a large value, to avoid overflow. */
21652 total = ((botpos - BUF_BEGV (b)) + (total / 100) - 1) / (total / 100);
21653 else
21654 total = ((botpos - BUF_BEGV (b)) * 100 + total - 1) / total;
21655 /* We can't normally display a 3-digit number,
21656 so get us a 2-digit number that is close. */
21657 if (total == 100)
21658 total = 99;
21659 if (toppos <= BUF_BEGV (b))
21660 sprintf (decode_mode_spec_buf, "Top%2"pD"d%%", total);
21661 else
21662 sprintf (decode_mode_spec_buf, "%2"pD"d%%", total);
21663 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21664 }
21665 }
21666
21667 case 's':
21668 /* status of process */
21669 obj = Fget_buffer_process (Fcurrent_buffer ());
21670 if (NILP (obj))
21671 return "no process";
21672 #ifndef MSDOS
21673 obj = Fsymbol_name (Fprocess_status (obj));
21674 #endif
21675 break;
21676
21677 case '@':
21678 {
21679 ptrdiff_t count = inhibit_garbage_collection ();
21680 Lisp_Object val = call1 (intern ("file-remote-p"),
21681 BVAR (current_buffer, directory));
21682 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
21683
21684 if (NILP (val))
21685 return "-";
21686 else
21687 return "@";
21688 }
21689
21690 case 't': /* indicate TEXT or BINARY */
21691 return "T";
21692
21693 case 'z':
21694 /* coding-system (not including end-of-line format) */
21695 case 'Z':
21696 /* coding-system (including end-of-line type) */
21697 {
21698 int eol_flag = (c == 'Z');
21699 char *p = decode_mode_spec_buf;
21700
21701 if (! FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
21702 {
21703 /* No need to mention EOL here--the terminal never needs
21704 to do EOL conversion. */
21705 p = decode_mode_spec_coding (CODING_ID_NAME
21706 (FRAME_KEYBOARD_CODING (f)->id),
21707 p, 0);
21708 p = decode_mode_spec_coding (CODING_ID_NAME
21709 (FRAME_TERMINAL_CODING (f)->id),
21710 p, 0);
21711 }
21712 p = decode_mode_spec_coding (BVAR (b, buffer_file_coding_system),
21713 p, eol_flag);
21714
21715 #if 0 /* This proves to be annoying; I think we can do without. -- rms. */
21716 #ifdef subprocesses
21717 obj = Fget_buffer_process (Fcurrent_buffer ());
21718 if (PROCESSP (obj))
21719 {
21720 p = decode_mode_spec_coding
21721 (XPROCESS (obj)->decode_coding_system, p, eol_flag);
21722 p = decode_mode_spec_coding
21723 (XPROCESS (obj)->encode_coding_system, p, eol_flag);
21724 }
21725 #endif /* subprocesses */
21726 #endif /* 0 */
21727 *p = 0;
21728 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21729 }
21730 }
21731
21732 if (STRINGP (obj))
21733 {
21734 *string = obj;
21735 return SSDATA (obj);
21736 }
21737 else
21738 return "";
21739 }
21740
21741
21742 /* Count up to COUNT lines starting from START_BYTE.
21743 But don't go beyond LIMIT_BYTE.
21744 Return the number of lines thus found (always nonnegative).
21745
21746 Set *BYTE_POS_PTR to 1 if we found COUNT lines, 0 if we hit LIMIT. */
21747
21748 static ptrdiff_t
21749 display_count_lines (ptrdiff_t start_byte,
21750 ptrdiff_t limit_byte, ptrdiff_t count,
21751 ptrdiff_t *byte_pos_ptr)
21752 {
21753 register unsigned char *cursor;
21754 unsigned char *base;
21755
21756 register ptrdiff_t ceiling;
21757 register unsigned char *ceiling_addr;
21758 ptrdiff_t orig_count = count;
21759
21760 /* If we are not in selective display mode,
21761 check only for newlines. */
21762 int selective_display = (!NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display))
21763 && !INTEGERP (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display)));
21764
21765 if (count > 0)
21766 {
21767 while (start_byte < limit_byte)
21768 {
21769 ceiling = BUFFER_CEILING_OF (start_byte);
21770 ceiling = min (limit_byte - 1, ceiling);
21771 ceiling_addr = BYTE_POS_ADDR (ceiling) + 1;
21772 base = (cursor = BYTE_POS_ADDR (start_byte));
21773 while (1)
21774 {
21775 if (selective_display)
21776 while (*cursor != '\n' && *cursor != 015 && ++cursor != ceiling_addr)
21777 ;
21778 else
21779 while (*cursor != '\n' && ++cursor != ceiling_addr)
21780 ;
21781
21782 if (cursor != ceiling_addr)
21783 {
21784 if (--count == 0)
21785 {
21786 start_byte += cursor - base + 1;
21787 *byte_pos_ptr = start_byte;
21788 return orig_count;
21789 }
21790 else
21791 if (++cursor == ceiling_addr)
21792 break;
21793 }
21794 else
21795 break;
21796 }
21797 start_byte += cursor - base;
21798 }
21799 }
21800 else
21801 {
21802 while (start_byte > limit_byte)
21803 {
21804 ceiling = BUFFER_FLOOR_OF (start_byte - 1);
21805 ceiling = max (limit_byte, ceiling);
21806 ceiling_addr = BYTE_POS_ADDR (ceiling) - 1;
21807 base = (cursor = BYTE_POS_ADDR (start_byte - 1) + 1);
21808 while (1)
21809 {
21810 if (selective_display)
21811 while (--cursor != ceiling_addr
21812 && *cursor != '\n' && *cursor != 015)
21813 ;
21814 else
21815 while (--cursor != ceiling_addr && *cursor != '\n')
21816 ;
21817
21818 if (cursor != ceiling_addr)
21819 {
21820 if (++count == 0)
21821 {
21822 start_byte += cursor - base + 1;
21823 *byte_pos_ptr = start_byte;
21824 /* When scanning backwards, we should
21825 not count the newline posterior to which we stop. */
21826 return - orig_count - 1;
21827 }
21828 }
21829 else
21830 break;
21831 }
21832 /* Here we add 1 to compensate for the last decrement
21833 of CURSOR, which took it past the valid range. */
21834 start_byte += cursor - base + 1;
21835 }
21836 }
21837
21838 *byte_pos_ptr = limit_byte;
21839
21840 if (count < 0)
21841 return - orig_count + count;
21842 return orig_count - count;
21843
21844 }
21845
21846
21847 \f
21848 /***********************************************************************
21849 Displaying strings
21850 ***********************************************************************/
21851
21852 /* Display a NUL-terminated string, starting with index START.
21853
21854 If STRING is non-null, display that C string. Otherwise, the Lisp
21855 string LISP_STRING is displayed. There's a case that STRING is
21856 non-null and LISP_STRING is not nil. It means STRING is a string
21857 data of LISP_STRING. In that case, we display LISP_STRING while
21858 ignoring its text properties.
21859
21860 If FACE_STRING is not nil, FACE_STRING_POS is a position in
21861 FACE_STRING. Display STRING or LISP_STRING with the face at
21862 FACE_STRING_POS in FACE_STRING:
21863
21864 Display the string in the environment given by IT, but use the
21865 standard display table, temporarily.
21866
21867 FIELD_WIDTH is the minimum number of output glyphs to produce.
21868 If STRING has fewer characters than FIELD_WIDTH, pad to the right
21869 with spaces. If STRING has more characters, more than FIELD_WIDTH
21870 glyphs will be produced. FIELD_WIDTH <= 0 means don't pad.
21871
21872 PRECISION is the maximum number of characters to output from
21873 STRING. PRECISION < 0 means don't truncate the string.
21874
21875 This is roughly equivalent to printf format specifiers:
21876
21877 FIELD_WIDTH PRECISION PRINTF
21878 ----------------------------------------
21879 -1 -1 %s
21880 -1 10 %.10s
21881 10 -1 %10s
21882 20 10 %20.10s
21883
21884 MULTIBYTE zero means do not display multibyte chars, > 0 means do
21885 display them, and < 0 means obey the current buffer's value of
21886 enable_multibyte_characters.
21887
21888 Value is the number of columns displayed. */
21889
21890 static int
21891 display_string (const char *string, Lisp_Object lisp_string, Lisp_Object face_string,
21892 ptrdiff_t face_string_pos, ptrdiff_t start, struct it *it,
21893 int field_width, int precision, int max_x, int multibyte)
21894 {
21895 int hpos_at_start = it->hpos;
21896 int saved_face_id = it->face_id;
21897 struct glyph_row *row = it->glyph_row;
21898 ptrdiff_t it_charpos;
21899
21900 /* Initialize the iterator IT for iteration over STRING beginning
21901 with index START. */
21902 reseat_to_string (it, NILP (lisp_string) ? string : NULL, lisp_string, start,
21903 precision, field_width, multibyte);
21904 if (string && STRINGP (lisp_string))
21905 /* LISP_STRING is the one returned by decode_mode_spec. We should
21906 ignore its text properties. */
21907 it->stop_charpos = it->end_charpos;
21908
21909 /* If displaying STRING, set up the face of the iterator from
21910 FACE_STRING, if that's given. */
21911 if (STRINGP (face_string))
21912 {
21913 ptrdiff_t endptr;
21914 struct face *face;
21915
21916 it->face_id
21917 = face_at_string_position (it->w, face_string, face_string_pos,
21918 0, it->region_beg_charpos,
21919 it->region_end_charpos,
21920 &endptr, it->base_face_id, 0);
21921 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
21922 it->face_box_p = face->box != FACE_NO_BOX;
21923 }
21924
21925 /* Set max_x to the maximum allowed X position. Don't let it go
21926 beyond the right edge of the window. */
21927 if (max_x <= 0)
21928 max_x = it->last_visible_x;
21929 else
21930 max_x = min (max_x, it->last_visible_x);
21931
21932 /* Skip over display elements that are not visible. because IT->w is
21933 hscrolled. */
21934 if (it->current_x < it->first_visible_x)
21935 move_it_in_display_line_to (it, 100000, it->first_visible_x,
21936 MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_X);
21937
21938 row->ascent = it->max_ascent;
21939 row->height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
21940 row->phys_ascent = it->max_phys_ascent;
21941 row->phys_height = it->max_phys_ascent + it->max_phys_descent;
21942 row->extra_line_spacing = it->max_extra_line_spacing;
21943
21944 if (STRINGP (it->string))
21945 it_charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it);
21946 else
21947 it_charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
21948
21949 /* This condition is for the case that we are called with current_x
21950 past last_visible_x. */
21951 while (it->current_x < max_x)
21952 {
21953 int x_before, x, n_glyphs_before, i, nglyphs;
21954
21955 /* Get the next display element. */
21956 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
21957 break;
21958
21959 /* Produce glyphs. */
21960 x_before = it->current_x;
21961 n_glyphs_before = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
21962 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
21963
21964 nglyphs = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - n_glyphs_before;
21965 i = 0;
21966 x = x_before;
21967 while (i < nglyphs)
21968 {
21969 struct glyph *glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + n_glyphs_before + i;
21970
21971 if (it->line_wrap != TRUNCATE
21972 && x + glyph->pixel_width > max_x)
21973 {
21974 /* End of continued line or max_x reached. */
21975 if (CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (*glyph))
21976 {
21977 /* A wide character is unbreakable. */
21978 if (row->reversed_p)
21979 unproduce_glyphs (it, row->used[TEXT_AREA]
21980 - n_glyphs_before);
21981 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = n_glyphs_before;
21982 it->current_x = x_before;
21983 }
21984 else
21985 {
21986 if (row->reversed_p)
21987 unproduce_glyphs (it, row->used[TEXT_AREA]
21988 - (n_glyphs_before + i));
21989 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = n_glyphs_before + i;
21990 it->current_x = x;
21991 }
21992 break;
21993 }
21994 else if (x + glyph->pixel_width >= it->first_visible_x)
21995 {
21996 /* Glyph is at least partially visible. */
21997 ++it->hpos;
21998 if (x < it->first_visible_x)
21999 row->x = x - it->first_visible_x;
22000 }
22001 else
22002 {
22003 /* Glyph is off the left margin of the display area.
22004 Should not happen. */
22005 abort ();
22006 }
22007
22008 row->ascent = max (row->ascent, it->max_ascent);
22009 row->height = max (row->height, it->max_ascent + it->max_descent);
22010 row->phys_ascent = max (row->phys_ascent, it->max_phys_ascent);
22011 row->phys_height = max (row->phys_height,
22012 it->max_phys_ascent + it->max_phys_descent);
22013 row->extra_line_spacing = max (row->extra_line_spacing,
22014 it->max_extra_line_spacing);
22015 x += glyph->pixel_width;
22016 ++i;
22017 }
22018
22019 /* Stop if max_x reached. */
22020 if (i < nglyphs)
22021 break;
22022
22023 /* Stop at line ends. */
22024 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
22025 {
22026 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
22027 break;
22028 }
22029
22030 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
22031 if (STRINGP (it->string))
22032 it_charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it);
22033 else
22034 it_charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
22035
22036 /* Stop if truncating at the right edge. */
22037 if (it->line_wrap == TRUNCATE
22038 && it->current_x >= it->last_visible_x)
22039 {
22040 /* Add truncation mark, but don't do it if the line is
22041 truncated at a padding space. */
22042 if (it_charpos < it->string_nchars)
22043 {
22044 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
22045 {
22046 int ii, n;
22047
22048 if (it->current_x > it->last_visible_x)
22049 {
22050 if (!row->reversed_p)
22051 {
22052 for (ii = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1; ii > 0; --ii)
22053 if (!CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][ii]))
22054 break;
22055 }
22056 else
22057 {
22058 for (ii = 0; ii < row->used[TEXT_AREA]; ii++)
22059 if (!CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][ii]))
22060 break;
22061 unproduce_glyphs (it, ii + 1);
22062 ii = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - (ii + 1);
22063 }
22064 for (n = row->used[TEXT_AREA]; ii < n; ++ii)
22065 {
22066 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = ii;
22067 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_TRUNCATION);
22068 }
22069 }
22070 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_TRUNCATION);
22071 }
22072 row->truncated_on_right_p = 1;
22073 }
22074 break;
22075 }
22076 }
22077
22078 /* Maybe insert a truncation at the left. */
22079 if (it->first_visible_x
22080 && it_charpos > 0)
22081 {
22082 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
22083 || (row->reversed_p
22084 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
22085 : WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)) == 0)
22086 insert_left_trunc_glyphs (it);
22087 row->truncated_on_left_p = 1;
22088 }
22089
22090 it->face_id = saved_face_id;
22091
22092 /* Value is number of columns displayed. */
22093 return it->hpos - hpos_at_start;
22094 }
22095
22096
22097 \f
22098 /* This is like a combination of memq and assq. Return 1/2 if PROPVAL
22099 appears as an element of LIST or as the car of an element of LIST.
22100 If PROPVAL is a list, compare each element against LIST in that
22101 way, and return 1/2 if any element of PROPVAL is found in LIST.
22102 Otherwise return 0. This function cannot quit.
22103 The return value is 2 if the text is invisible but with an ellipsis
22104 and 1 if it's invisible and without an ellipsis. */
22105
22106 int
22107 invisible_p (register Lisp_Object propval, Lisp_Object list)
22108 {
22109 register Lisp_Object tail, proptail;
22110
22111 for (tail = list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
22112 {
22113 register Lisp_Object tem;
22114 tem = XCAR (tail);
22115 if (EQ (propval, tem))
22116 return 1;
22117 if (CONSP (tem) && EQ (propval, XCAR (tem)))
22118 return NILP (XCDR (tem)) ? 1 : 2;
22119 }
22120
22121 if (CONSP (propval))
22122 {
22123 for (proptail = propval; CONSP (proptail); proptail = XCDR (proptail))
22124 {
22125 Lisp_Object propelt;
22126 propelt = XCAR (proptail);
22127 for (tail = list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
22128 {
22129 register Lisp_Object tem;
22130 tem = XCAR (tail);
22131 if (EQ (propelt, tem))
22132 return 1;
22133 if (CONSP (tem) && EQ (propelt, XCAR (tem)))
22134 return NILP (XCDR (tem)) ? 1 : 2;
22135 }
22136 }
22137 }
22138
22139 return 0;
22140 }
22141
22142 DEFUN ("invisible-p", Finvisible_p, Sinvisible_p, 1, 1, 0,
22143 doc: /* Non-nil if the property makes the text invisible.
22144 POS-OR-PROP can be a marker or number, in which case it is taken to be
22145 a position in the current buffer and the value of the `invisible' property
22146 is checked; or it can be some other value, which is then presumed to be the
22147 value of the `invisible' property of the text of interest.
22148 The non-nil value returned can be t for truly invisible text or something
22149 else if the text is replaced by an ellipsis. */)
22150 (Lisp_Object pos_or_prop)
22151 {
22152 Lisp_Object prop
22153 = (NATNUMP (pos_or_prop) || MARKERP (pos_or_prop)
22154 ? Fget_char_property (pos_or_prop, Qinvisible, Qnil)
22155 : pos_or_prop);
22156 int invis = TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (prop);
22157 return (invis == 0 ? Qnil
22158 : invis == 1 ? Qt
22159 : make_number (invis));
22160 }
22161
22162 /* Calculate a width or height in pixels from a specification using
22163 the following elements:
22164
22165 SPEC ::=
22166 NUM - a (fractional) multiple of the default font width/height
22167 (NUM) - specifies exactly NUM pixels
22168 UNIT - a fixed number of pixels, see below.
22169 ELEMENT - size of a display element in pixels, see below.
22170 (NUM . SPEC) - equals NUM * SPEC
22171 (+ SPEC SPEC ...) - add pixel values
22172 (- SPEC SPEC ...) - subtract pixel values
22173 (- SPEC) - negate pixel value
22174
22175 NUM ::=
22176 INT or FLOAT - a number constant
22177 SYMBOL - use symbol's (buffer local) variable binding.
22178
22179 UNIT ::=
22180 in - pixels per inch *)
22181 mm - pixels per 1/1000 meter *)
22182 cm - pixels per 1/100 meter *)
22183 width - width of current font in pixels.
22184 height - height of current font in pixels.
22185
22186 *) using the ratio(s) defined in display-pixels-per-inch.
22187
22188 ELEMENT ::=
22189
22190 left-fringe - left fringe width in pixels
22191 right-fringe - right fringe width in pixels
22192
22193 left-margin - left margin width in pixels
22194 right-margin - right margin width in pixels
22195
22196 scroll-bar - scroll-bar area width in pixels
22197
22198 Examples:
22199
22200 Pixels corresponding to 5 inches:
22201 (5 . in)
22202
22203 Total width of non-text areas on left side of window (if scroll-bar is on left):
22204 '(space :width (+ left-fringe left-margin scroll-bar))
22205
22206 Align to first text column (in header line):
22207 '(space :align-to 0)
22208
22209 Align to middle of text area minus half the width of variable `my-image'
22210 containing a loaded image:
22211 '(space :align-to (0.5 . (- text my-image)))
22212
22213 Width of left margin minus width of 1 character in the default font:
22214 '(space :width (- left-margin 1))
22215
22216 Width of left margin minus width of 2 characters in the current font:
22217 '(space :width (- left-margin (2 . width)))
22218
22219 Center 1 character over left-margin (in header line):
22220 '(space :align-to (+ left-margin (0.5 . left-margin) -0.5))
22221
22222 Different ways to express width of left fringe plus left margin minus one pixel:
22223 '(space :width (- (+ left-fringe left-margin) (1)))
22224 '(space :width (+ left-fringe left-margin (- (1))))
22225 '(space :width (+ left-fringe left-margin (-1)))
22226
22227 */
22228
22229 #define NUMVAL(X) \
22230 ((INTEGERP (X) || FLOATP (X)) \
22231 ? XFLOATINT (X) \
22232 : - 1)
22233
22234 static int
22235 calc_pixel_width_or_height (double *res, struct it *it, Lisp_Object prop,
22236 struct font *font, int width_p, int *align_to)
22237 {
22238 double pixels;
22239
22240 #define OK_PIXELS(val) ((*res = (double)(val)), 1)
22241 #define OK_ALIGN_TO(val) ((*align_to = (int)(val)), 1)
22242
22243 if (NILP (prop))
22244 return OK_PIXELS (0);
22245
22246 eassert (FRAME_LIVE_P (it->f));
22247
22248 if (SYMBOLP (prop))
22249 {
22250 if (SCHARS (SYMBOL_NAME (prop)) == 2)
22251 {
22252 char *unit = SSDATA (SYMBOL_NAME (prop));
22253
22254 if (unit[0] == 'i' && unit[1] == 'n')
22255 pixels = 1.0;
22256 else if (unit[0] == 'm' && unit[1] == 'm')
22257 pixels = 25.4;
22258 else if (unit[0] == 'c' && unit[1] == 'm')
22259 pixels = 2.54;
22260 else
22261 pixels = 0;
22262 if (pixels > 0)
22263 {
22264 double ppi;
22265 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
22266 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
22267 && (ppi = (width_p
22268 ? FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (it->f)->resx
22269 : FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (it->f)->resy),
22270 ppi > 0))
22271 return OK_PIXELS (ppi / pixels);
22272 #endif
22273
22274 if ((ppi = NUMVAL (Vdisplay_pixels_per_inch), ppi > 0)
22275 || (CONSP (Vdisplay_pixels_per_inch)
22276 && (ppi = (width_p
22277 ? NUMVAL (XCAR (Vdisplay_pixels_per_inch))
22278 : NUMVAL (XCDR (Vdisplay_pixels_per_inch))),
22279 ppi > 0)))
22280 return OK_PIXELS (ppi / pixels);
22281
22282 return 0;
22283 }
22284 }
22285
22286 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
22287 if (EQ (prop, Qheight))
22288 return OK_PIXELS (font ? FONT_HEIGHT (font) : FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (it->f));
22289 if (EQ (prop, Qwidth))
22290 return OK_PIXELS (font ? FONT_WIDTH (font) : FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it->f));
22291 #else
22292 if (EQ (prop, Qheight) || EQ (prop, Qwidth))
22293 return OK_PIXELS (1);
22294 #endif
22295
22296 if (EQ (prop, Qtext))
22297 return OK_PIXELS (width_p
22298 ? window_box_width (it->w, TEXT_AREA)
22299 : WINDOW_BOX_HEIGHT_NO_MODE_LINE (it->w));
22300
22301 if (align_to && *align_to < 0)
22302 {
22303 *res = 0;
22304 if (EQ (prop, Qleft))
22305 return OK_ALIGN_TO (window_box_left_offset (it->w, TEXT_AREA));
22306 if (EQ (prop, Qright))
22307 return OK_ALIGN_TO (window_box_right_offset (it->w, TEXT_AREA));
22308 if (EQ (prop, Qcenter))
22309 return OK_ALIGN_TO (window_box_left_offset (it->w, TEXT_AREA)
22310 + window_box_width (it->w, TEXT_AREA) / 2);
22311 if (EQ (prop, Qleft_fringe))
22312 return OK_ALIGN_TO (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (it->w)
22313 ? WINDOW_LEFT_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (it->w)
22314 : window_box_right_offset (it->w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA));
22315 if (EQ (prop, Qright_fringe))
22316 return OK_ALIGN_TO (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (it->w)
22317 ? window_box_right_offset (it->w, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA)
22318 : window_box_right_offset (it->w, TEXT_AREA));
22319 if (EQ (prop, Qleft_margin))
22320 return OK_ALIGN_TO (window_box_left_offset (it->w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA));
22321 if (EQ (prop, Qright_margin))
22322 return OK_ALIGN_TO (window_box_left_offset (it->w, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA));
22323 if (EQ (prop, Qscroll_bar))
22324 return OK_ALIGN_TO (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (it->w)
22325 ? 0
22326 : (window_box_right_offset (it->w, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA)
22327 + (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (it->w)
22328 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
22329 : 0)));
22330 }
22331 else
22332 {
22333 if (EQ (prop, Qleft_fringe))
22334 return OK_PIXELS (WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w));
22335 if (EQ (prop, Qright_fringe))
22336 return OK_PIXELS (WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w));
22337 if (EQ (prop, Qleft_margin))
22338 return OK_PIXELS (WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN_WIDTH (it->w));
22339 if (EQ (prop, Qright_margin))
22340 return OK_PIXELS (WINDOW_RIGHT_MARGIN_WIDTH (it->w));
22341 if (EQ (prop, Qscroll_bar))
22342 return OK_PIXELS (WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (it->w));
22343 }
22344
22345 prop = buffer_local_value_1 (prop, it->w->buffer);
22346 if (EQ (prop, Qunbound))
22347 prop = Qnil;
22348 }
22349
22350 if (INTEGERP (prop) || FLOATP (prop))
22351 {
22352 int base_unit = (width_p
22353 ? FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it->f)
22354 : FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (it->f));
22355 return OK_PIXELS (XFLOATINT (prop) * base_unit);
22356 }
22357
22358 if (CONSP (prop))
22359 {
22360 Lisp_Object car = XCAR (prop);
22361 Lisp_Object cdr = XCDR (prop);
22362
22363 if (SYMBOLP (car))
22364 {
22365 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
22366 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
22367 && valid_image_p (prop))
22368 {
22369 ptrdiff_t id = lookup_image (it->f, prop);
22370 struct image *img = IMAGE_FROM_ID (it->f, id);
22371
22372 return OK_PIXELS (width_p ? img->width : img->height);
22373 }
22374 #endif
22375 if (EQ (car, Qplus) || EQ (car, Qminus))
22376 {
22377 int first = 1;
22378 double px;
22379
22380 pixels = 0;
22381 while (CONSP (cdr))
22382 {
22383 if (!calc_pixel_width_or_height (&px, it, XCAR (cdr),
22384 font, width_p, align_to))
22385 return 0;
22386 if (first)
22387 pixels = (EQ (car, Qplus) ? px : -px), first = 0;
22388 else
22389 pixels += px;
22390 cdr = XCDR (cdr);
22391 }
22392 if (EQ (car, Qminus))
22393 pixels = -pixels;
22394 return OK_PIXELS (pixels);
22395 }
22396
22397 car = buffer_local_value_1 (car, it->w->buffer);
22398 if (EQ (car, Qunbound))
22399 car = Qnil;
22400 }
22401
22402 if (INTEGERP (car) || FLOATP (car))
22403 {
22404 double fact;
22405 pixels = XFLOATINT (car);
22406 if (NILP (cdr))
22407 return OK_PIXELS (pixels);
22408 if (calc_pixel_width_or_height (&fact, it, cdr,
22409 font, width_p, align_to))
22410 return OK_PIXELS (pixels * fact);
22411 return 0;
22412 }
22413
22414 return 0;
22415 }
22416
22417 return 0;
22418 }
22419
22420 \f
22421 /***********************************************************************
22422 Glyph Display
22423 ***********************************************************************/
22424
22425 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
22426
22427 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
22428
22429 void
22430 dump_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
22431 {
22432 fprintf (stderr, "glyph string\n");
22433 fprintf (stderr, " x, y, w, h = %d, %d, %d, %d\n",
22434 s->x, s->y, s->width, s->height);
22435 fprintf (stderr, " ybase = %d\n", s->ybase);
22436 fprintf (stderr, " hl = %d\n", s->hl);
22437 fprintf (stderr, " left overhang = %d, right = %d\n",
22438 s->left_overhang, s->right_overhang);
22439 fprintf (stderr, " nchars = %d\n", s->nchars);
22440 fprintf (stderr, " extends to end of line = %d\n",
22441 s->extends_to_end_of_line_p);
22442 fprintf (stderr, " font height = %d\n", FONT_HEIGHT (s->font));
22443 fprintf (stderr, " bg width = %d\n", s->background_width);
22444 }
22445
22446 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
22447
22448 /* Initialize glyph string S. CHAR2B is a suitably allocated vector
22449 of XChar2b structures for S; it can't be allocated in
22450 init_glyph_string because it must be allocated via `alloca'. W
22451 is the window on which S is drawn. ROW and AREA are the glyph row
22452 and area within the row from which S is constructed. START is the
22453 index of the first glyph structure covered by S. HL is a
22454 face-override for drawing S. */
22455
22456 #ifdef HAVE_NTGUI
22457 #define OPTIONAL_HDC(hdc) HDC hdc,
22458 #define DECLARE_HDC(hdc) HDC hdc;
22459 #define ALLOCATE_HDC(hdc, f) hdc = get_frame_dc ((f))
22460 #define RELEASE_HDC(hdc, f) release_frame_dc ((f), (hdc))
22461 #endif
22462
22463 #ifndef OPTIONAL_HDC
22464 #define OPTIONAL_HDC(hdc)
22465 #define DECLARE_HDC(hdc)
22466 #define ALLOCATE_HDC(hdc, f)
22467 #define RELEASE_HDC(hdc, f)
22468 #endif
22469
22470 static void
22471 init_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s,
22472 OPTIONAL_HDC (hdc)
22473 XChar2b *char2b, struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row,
22474 enum glyph_row_area area, int start, enum draw_glyphs_face hl)
22475 {
22476 memset (s, 0, sizeof *s);
22477 s->w = w;
22478 s->f = XFRAME (w->frame);
22479 #ifdef HAVE_NTGUI
22480 s->hdc = hdc;
22481 #endif
22482 s->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (s->f);
22483 s->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (s->f);
22484 s->char2b = char2b;
22485 s->hl = hl;
22486 s->row = row;
22487 s->area = area;
22488 s->first_glyph = row->glyphs[area] + start;
22489 s->height = row->height;
22490 s->y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, row->y);
22491 s->ybase = s->y + row->ascent;
22492 }
22493
22494
22495 /* Append the list of glyph strings with head H and tail T to the list
22496 with head *HEAD and tail *TAIL. Set *HEAD and *TAIL to the result. */
22497
22498 static inline void
22499 append_glyph_string_lists (struct glyph_string **head, struct glyph_string **tail,
22500 struct glyph_string *h, struct glyph_string *t)
22501 {
22502 if (h)
22503 {
22504 if (*head)
22505 (*tail)->next = h;
22506 else
22507 *head = h;
22508 h->prev = *tail;
22509 *tail = t;
22510 }
22511 }
22512
22513
22514 /* Prepend the list of glyph strings with head H and tail T to the
22515 list with head *HEAD and tail *TAIL. Set *HEAD and *TAIL to the
22516 result. */
22517
22518 static inline void
22519 prepend_glyph_string_lists (struct glyph_string **head, struct glyph_string **tail,
22520 struct glyph_string *h, struct glyph_string *t)
22521 {
22522 if (h)
22523 {
22524 if (*head)
22525 (*head)->prev = t;
22526 else
22527 *tail = t;
22528 t->next = *head;
22529 *head = h;
22530 }
22531 }
22532
22533
22534 /* Append glyph string S to the list with head *HEAD and tail *TAIL.
22535 Set *HEAD and *TAIL to the resulting list. */
22536
22537 static inline void
22538 append_glyph_string (struct glyph_string **head, struct glyph_string **tail,
22539 struct glyph_string *s)
22540 {
22541 s->next = s->prev = NULL;
22542 append_glyph_string_lists (head, tail, s, s);
22543 }
22544
22545
22546 /* Get face and two-byte form of character C in face FACE_ID on frame F.
22547 The encoding of C is returned in *CHAR2B. DISPLAY_P non-zero means
22548 make sure that X resources for the face returned are allocated.
22549 Value is a pointer to a realized face that is ready for display if
22550 DISPLAY_P is non-zero. */
22551
22552 static inline struct face *
22553 get_char_face_and_encoding (struct frame *f, int c, int face_id,
22554 XChar2b *char2b, int display_p)
22555 {
22556 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, face_id);
22557
22558 if (face->font)
22559 {
22560 unsigned code = face->font->driver->encode_char (face->font, c);
22561
22562 if (code != FONT_INVALID_CODE)
22563 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b, (code >> 8), (code & 0xFF));
22564 else
22565 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b, 0, 0);
22566 }
22567
22568 /* Make sure X resources of the face are allocated. */
22569 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
22570 if (display_p)
22571 #endif
22572 {
22573 eassert (face != NULL);
22574 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (f, face);
22575 }
22576
22577 return face;
22578 }
22579
22580
22581 /* Get face and two-byte form of character glyph GLYPH on frame F.
22582 The encoding of GLYPH->u.ch is returned in *CHAR2B. Value is
22583 a pointer to a realized face that is ready for display. */
22584
22585 static inline struct face *
22586 get_glyph_face_and_encoding (struct frame *f, struct glyph *glyph,
22587 XChar2b *char2b, int *two_byte_p)
22588 {
22589 struct face *face;
22590
22591 eassert (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH);
22592 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, glyph->face_id);
22593
22594 if (two_byte_p)
22595 *two_byte_p = 0;
22596
22597 if (face->font)
22598 {
22599 unsigned code;
22600
22601 if (CHAR_BYTE8_P (glyph->u.ch))
22602 code = CHAR_TO_BYTE8 (glyph->u.ch);
22603 else
22604 code = face->font->driver->encode_char (face->font, glyph->u.ch);
22605
22606 if (code != FONT_INVALID_CODE)
22607 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b, (code >> 8), (code & 0xFF));
22608 else
22609 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b, 0, 0);
22610 }
22611
22612 /* Make sure X resources of the face are allocated. */
22613 eassert (face != NULL);
22614 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (f, face);
22615 return face;
22616 }
22617
22618
22619 /* Get glyph code of character C in FONT in the two-byte form CHAR2B.
22620 Return 1 if FONT has a glyph for C, otherwise return 0. */
22621
22622 static inline int
22623 get_char_glyph_code (int c, struct font *font, XChar2b *char2b)
22624 {
22625 unsigned code;
22626
22627 if (CHAR_BYTE8_P (c))
22628 code = CHAR_TO_BYTE8 (c);
22629 else
22630 code = font->driver->encode_char (font, c);
22631
22632 if (code == FONT_INVALID_CODE)
22633 return 0;
22634 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b, (code >> 8), (code & 0xFF));
22635 return 1;
22636 }
22637
22638
22639 /* Fill glyph string S with composition components specified by S->cmp.
22640
22641 BASE_FACE is the base face of the composition.
22642 S->cmp_from is the index of the first component for S.
22643
22644 OVERLAPS non-zero means S should draw the foreground only, and use
22645 its physical height for clipping. See also draw_glyphs.
22646
22647 Value is the index of a component not in S. */
22648
22649 static int
22650 fill_composite_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s, struct face *base_face,
22651 int overlaps)
22652 {
22653 int i;
22654 /* For all glyphs of this composition, starting at the offset
22655 S->cmp_from, until we reach the end of the definition or encounter a
22656 glyph that requires the different face, add it to S. */
22657 struct face *face;
22658
22659 eassert (s);
22660
22661 s->for_overlaps = overlaps;
22662 s->face = NULL;
22663 s->font = NULL;
22664 for (i = s->cmp_from; i < s->cmp->glyph_len; i++)
22665 {
22666 int c = COMPOSITION_GLYPH (s->cmp, i);
22667
22668 /* TAB in a composition means display glyphs with padding space
22669 on the left or right. */
22670 if (c != '\t')
22671 {
22672 int face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, base_face->ascii_face, c,
22673 -1, Qnil);
22674
22675 face = get_char_face_and_encoding (s->f, c, face_id,
22676 s->char2b + i, 1);
22677 if (face)
22678 {
22679 if (! s->face)
22680 {
22681 s->face = face;
22682 s->font = s->face->font;
22683 }
22684 else if (s->face != face)
22685 break;
22686 }
22687 }
22688 ++s->nchars;
22689 }
22690 s->cmp_to = i;
22691
22692 if (s->face == NULL)
22693 {
22694 s->face = base_face->ascii_face;
22695 s->font = s->face->font;
22696 }
22697
22698 /* All glyph strings for the same composition has the same width,
22699 i.e. the width set for the first component of the composition. */
22700 s->width = s->first_glyph->pixel_width;
22701
22702 /* If the specified font could not be loaded, use the frame's
22703 default font, but record the fact that we couldn't load it in
22704 the glyph string so that we can draw rectangles for the
22705 characters of the glyph string. */
22706 if (s->font == NULL)
22707 {
22708 s->font_not_found_p = 1;
22709 s->font = FRAME_FONT (s->f);
22710 }
22711
22712 /* Adjust base line for subscript/superscript text. */
22713 s->ybase += s->first_glyph->voffset;
22714
22715 /* This glyph string must always be drawn with 16-bit functions. */
22716 s->two_byte_p = 1;
22717
22718 return s->cmp_to;
22719 }
22720
22721 static int
22722 fill_gstring_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s, int face_id,
22723 int start, int end, int overlaps)
22724 {
22725 struct glyph *glyph, *last;
22726 Lisp_Object lgstring;
22727 int i;
22728
22729 s->for_overlaps = overlaps;
22730 glyph = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + start;
22731 last = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + end;
22732 s->cmp_id = glyph->u.cmp.id;
22733 s->cmp_from = glyph->slice.cmp.from;
22734 s->cmp_to = glyph->slice.cmp.to + 1;
22735 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
22736 lgstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
22737 s->font = XFONT_OBJECT (LGSTRING_FONT (lgstring));
22738 glyph++;
22739 while (glyph < last
22740 && glyph->u.cmp.automatic
22741 && glyph->u.cmp.id == s->cmp_id
22742 && s->cmp_to == glyph->slice.cmp.from)
22743 s->cmp_to = (glyph++)->slice.cmp.to + 1;
22744
22745 for (i = s->cmp_from; i < s->cmp_to; i++)
22746 {
22747 Lisp_Object lglyph = LGSTRING_GLYPH (lgstring, i);
22748 unsigned code = LGLYPH_CODE (lglyph);
22749
22750 STORE_XCHAR2B ((s->char2b + i), code >> 8, code & 0xFF);
22751 }
22752 s->width = composition_gstring_width (lgstring, s->cmp_from, s->cmp_to, NULL);
22753 return glyph - s->row->glyphs[s->area];
22754 }
22755
22756
22757 /* Fill glyph string S from a sequence glyphs for glyphless characters.
22758 See the comment of fill_glyph_string for arguments.
22759 Value is the index of the first glyph not in S. */
22760
22761
22762 static int
22763 fill_glyphless_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s, int face_id,
22764 int start, int end, int overlaps)
22765 {
22766 struct glyph *glyph, *last;
22767 int voffset;
22768
22769 eassert (s->first_glyph->type == GLYPHLESS_GLYPH);
22770 s->for_overlaps = overlaps;
22771 glyph = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + start;
22772 last = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + end;
22773 voffset = glyph->voffset;
22774 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
22775 s->font = s->face->font ? s->face->font : FRAME_FONT (s->f);
22776 s->nchars = 1;
22777 s->width = glyph->pixel_width;
22778 glyph++;
22779 while (glyph < last
22780 && glyph->type == GLYPHLESS_GLYPH
22781 && glyph->voffset == voffset
22782 && glyph->face_id == face_id)
22783 {
22784 s->nchars++;
22785 s->width += glyph->pixel_width;
22786 glyph++;
22787 }
22788 s->ybase += voffset;
22789 return glyph - s->row->glyphs[s->area];
22790 }
22791
22792
22793 /* Fill glyph string S from a sequence of character glyphs.
22794
22795 FACE_ID is the face id of the string. START is the index of the
22796 first glyph to consider, END is the index of the last + 1.
22797 OVERLAPS non-zero means S should draw the foreground only, and use
22798 its physical height for clipping. See also draw_glyphs.
22799
22800 Value is the index of the first glyph not in S. */
22801
22802 static int
22803 fill_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s, int face_id,
22804 int start, int end, int overlaps)
22805 {
22806 struct glyph *glyph, *last;
22807 int voffset;
22808 int glyph_not_available_p;
22809
22810 eassert (s->f == XFRAME (s->w->frame));
22811 eassert (s->nchars == 0);
22812 eassert (start >= 0 && end > start);
22813
22814 s->for_overlaps = overlaps;
22815 glyph = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + start;
22816 last = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + end;
22817 voffset = glyph->voffset;
22818 s->padding_p = glyph->padding_p;
22819 glyph_not_available_p = glyph->glyph_not_available_p;
22820
22821 while (glyph < last
22822 && glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
22823 && glyph->voffset == voffset
22824 /* Same face id implies same font, nowadays. */
22825 && glyph->face_id == face_id
22826 && glyph->glyph_not_available_p == glyph_not_available_p)
22827 {
22828 int two_byte_p;
22829
22830 s->face = get_glyph_face_and_encoding (s->f, glyph,
22831 s->char2b + s->nchars,
22832 &two_byte_p);
22833 s->two_byte_p = two_byte_p;
22834 ++s->nchars;
22835 eassert (s->nchars <= end - start);
22836 s->width += glyph->pixel_width;
22837 if (glyph++->padding_p != s->padding_p)
22838 break;
22839 }
22840
22841 s->font = s->face->font;
22842
22843 /* If the specified font could not be loaded, use the frame's font,
22844 but record the fact that we couldn't load it in
22845 S->font_not_found_p so that we can draw rectangles for the
22846 characters of the glyph string. */
22847 if (s->font == NULL || glyph_not_available_p)
22848 {
22849 s->font_not_found_p = 1;
22850 s->font = FRAME_FONT (s->f);
22851 }
22852
22853 /* Adjust base line for subscript/superscript text. */
22854 s->ybase += voffset;
22855
22856 eassert (s->face && s->face->gc);
22857 return glyph - s->row->glyphs[s->area];
22858 }
22859
22860
22861 /* Fill glyph string S from image glyph S->first_glyph. */
22862
22863 static void
22864 fill_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
22865 {
22866 eassert (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH);
22867 s->img = IMAGE_FROM_ID (s->f, s->first_glyph->u.img_id);
22868 eassert (s->img);
22869 s->slice = s->first_glyph->slice.img;
22870 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, s->first_glyph->face_id);
22871 s->font = s->face->font;
22872 s->width = s->first_glyph->pixel_width;
22873
22874 /* Adjust base line for subscript/superscript text. */
22875 s->ybase += s->first_glyph->voffset;
22876 }
22877
22878
22879 /* Fill glyph string S from a sequence of stretch glyphs.
22880
22881 START is the index of the first glyph to consider,
22882 END is the index of the last + 1.
22883
22884 Value is the index of the first glyph not in S. */
22885
22886 static int
22887 fill_stretch_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s, int start, int end)
22888 {
22889 struct glyph *glyph, *last;
22890 int voffset, face_id;
22891
22892 eassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
22893
22894 glyph = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + start;
22895 last = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + end;
22896 face_id = glyph->face_id;
22897 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
22898 s->font = s->face->font;
22899 s->width = glyph->pixel_width;
22900 s->nchars = 1;
22901 voffset = glyph->voffset;
22902
22903 for (++glyph;
22904 (glyph < last
22905 && glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
22906 && glyph->voffset == voffset
22907 && glyph->face_id == face_id);
22908 ++glyph)
22909 s->width += glyph->pixel_width;
22910
22911 /* Adjust base line for subscript/superscript text. */
22912 s->ybase += voffset;
22913
22914 /* The case that face->gc == 0 is handled when drawing the glyph
22915 string by calling PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY. */
22916 eassert (s->face);
22917 return glyph - s->row->glyphs[s->area];
22918 }
22919
22920 static struct font_metrics *
22921 get_per_char_metric (struct font *font, XChar2b *char2b)
22922 {
22923 static struct font_metrics metrics;
22924 unsigned code = (XCHAR2B_BYTE1 (char2b) << 8) | XCHAR2B_BYTE2 (char2b);
22925
22926 if (! font || code == FONT_INVALID_CODE)
22927 return NULL;
22928 font->driver->text_extents (font, &code, 1, &metrics);
22929 return &metrics;
22930 }
22931
22932 /* EXPORT for RIF:
22933 Set *LEFT and *RIGHT to the left and right overhang of GLYPH on
22934 frame F. Overhangs of glyphs other than type CHAR_GLYPH are
22935 assumed to be zero. */
22936
22937 void
22938 x_get_glyph_overhangs (struct glyph *glyph, struct frame *f, int *left, int *right)
22939 {
22940 *left = *right = 0;
22941
22942 if (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
22943 {
22944 struct face *face;
22945 XChar2b char2b;
22946 struct font_metrics *pcm;
22947
22948 face = get_glyph_face_and_encoding (f, glyph, &char2b, NULL);
22949 if (face->font && (pcm = get_per_char_metric (face->font, &char2b)))
22950 {
22951 if (pcm->rbearing > pcm->width)
22952 *right = pcm->rbearing - pcm->width;
22953 if (pcm->lbearing < 0)
22954 *left = -pcm->lbearing;
22955 }
22956 }
22957 else if (glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH)
22958 {
22959 if (! glyph->u.cmp.automatic)
22960 {
22961 struct composition *cmp = composition_table[glyph->u.cmp.id];
22962
22963 if (cmp->rbearing > cmp->pixel_width)
22964 *right = cmp->rbearing - cmp->pixel_width;
22965 if (cmp->lbearing < 0)
22966 *left = - cmp->lbearing;
22967 }
22968 else
22969 {
22970 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (glyph->u.cmp.id);
22971 struct font_metrics metrics;
22972
22973 composition_gstring_width (gstring, glyph->slice.cmp.from,
22974 glyph->slice.cmp.to + 1, &metrics);
22975 if (metrics.rbearing > metrics.width)
22976 *right = metrics.rbearing - metrics.width;
22977 if (metrics.lbearing < 0)
22978 *left = - metrics.lbearing;
22979 }
22980 }
22981 }
22982
22983
22984 /* Return the index of the first glyph preceding glyph string S that
22985 is overwritten by S because of S's left overhang. Value is -1
22986 if no glyphs are overwritten. */
22987
22988 static int
22989 left_overwritten (struct glyph_string *s)
22990 {
22991 int k;
22992
22993 if (s->left_overhang)
22994 {
22995 int x = 0, i;
22996 struct glyph *glyphs = s->row->glyphs[s->area];
22997 int first = s->first_glyph - glyphs;
22998
22999 for (i = first - 1; i >= 0 && x > -s->left_overhang; --i)
23000 x -= glyphs[i].pixel_width;
23001
23002 k = i + 1;
23003 }
23004 else
23005 k = -1;
23006
23007 return k;
23008 }
23009
23010
23011 /* Return the index of the first glyph preceding glyph string S that
23012 is overwriting S because of its right overhang. Value is -1 if no
23013 glyph in front of S overwrites S. */
23014
23015 static int
23016 left_overwriting (struct glyph_string *s)
23017 {
23018 int i, k, x;
23019 struct glyph *glyphs = s->row->glyphs[s->area];
23020 int first = s->first_glyph - glyphs;
23021
23022 k = -1;
23023 x = 0;
23024 for (i = first - 1; i >= 0; --i)
23025 {
23026 int left, right;
23027 x_get_glyph_overhangs (glyphs + i, s->f, &left, &right);
23028 if (x + right > 0)
23029 k = i;
23030 x -= glyphs[i].pixel_width;
23031 }
23032
23033 return k;
23034 }
23035
23036
23037 /* Return the index of the last glyph following glyph string S that is
23038 overwritten by S because of S's right overhang. Value is -1 if
23039 no such glyph is found. */
23040
23041 static int
23042 right_overwritten (struct glyph_string *s)
23043 {
23044 int k = -1;
23045
23046 if (s->right_overhang)
23047 {
23048 int x = 0, i;
23049 struct glyph *glyphs = s->row->glyphs[s->area];
23050 int first = (s->first_glyph - glyphs) + (s->cmp ? 1 : s->nchars);
23051 int end = s->row->used[s->area];
23052
23053 for (i = first; i < end && s->right_overhang > x; ++i)
23054 x += glyphs[i].pixel_width;
23055
23056 k = i;
23057 }
23058
23059 return k;
23060 }
23061
23062
23063 /* Return the index of the last glyph following glyph string S that
23064 overwrites S because of its left overhang. Value is negative
23065 if no such glyph is found. */
23066
23067 static int
23068 right_overwriting (struct glyph_string *s)
23069 {
23070 int i, k, x;
23071 int end = s->row->used[s->area];
23072 struct glyph *glyphs = s->row->glyphs[s->area];
23073 int first = (s->first_glyph - glyphs) + (s->cmp ? 1 : s->nchars);
23074
23075 k = -1;
23076 x = 0;
23077 for (i = first; i < end; ++i)
23078 {
23079 int left, right;
23080 x_get_glyph_overhangs (glyphs + i, s->f, &left, &right);
23081 if (x - left < 0)
23082 k = i;
23083 x += glyphs[i].pixel_width;
23084 }
23085
23086 return k;
23087 }
23088
23089
23090 /* Set background width of glyph string S. START is the index of the
23091 first glyph following S. LAST_X is the right-most x-position + 1
23092 in the drawing area. */
23093
23094 static inline void
23095 set_glyph_string_background_width (struct glyph_string *s, int start, int last_x)
23096 {
23097 /* If the face of this glyph string has to be drawn to the end of
23098 the drawing area, set S->extends_to_end_of_line_p. */
23099
23100 if (start == s->row->used[s->area]
23101 && s->area == TEXT_AREA
23102 && ((s->row->fill_line_p
23103 && (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT
23104 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
23105 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN))
23106 || s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE))
23107 s->extends_to_end_of_line_p = 1;
23108
23109 /* If S extends its face to the end of the line, set its
23110 background_width to the distance to the right edge of the drawing
23111 area. */
23112 if (s->extends_to_end_of_line_p)
23113 s->background_width = last_x - s->x + 1;
23114 else
23115 s->background_width = s->width;
23116 }
23117
23118
23119 /* Compute overhangs and x-positions for glyph string S and its
23120 predecessors, or successors. X is the starting x-position for S.
23121 BACKWARD_P non-zero means process predecessors. */
23122
23123 static void
23124 compute_overhangs_and_x (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int backward_p)
23125 {
23126 if (backward_p)
23127 {
23128 while (s)
23129 {
23130 if (FRAME_RIF (s->f)->compute_glyph_string_overhangs)
23131 FRAME_RIF (s->f)->compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s);
23132 x -= s->width;
23133 s->x = x;
23134 s = s->prev;
23135 }
23136 }
23137 else
23138 {
23139 while (s)
23140 {
23141 if (FRAME_RIF (s->f)->compute_glyph_string_overhangs)
23142 FRAME_RIF (s->f)->compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s);
23143 s->x = x;
23144 x += s->width;
23145 s = s->next;
23146 }
23147 }
23148 }
23149
23150
23151
23152 /* The following macros are only called from draw_glyphs below.
23153 They reference the following parameters of that function directly:
23154 `w', `row', `area', and `overlap_p'
23155 as well as the following local variables:
23156 `s', `f', and `hdc' (in W32) */
23157
23158 #ifdef HAVE_NTGUI
23159 /* On W32, silently add local `hdc' variable to argument list of
23160 init_glyph_string. */
23161 #define INIT_GLYPH_STRING(s, char2b, w, row, area, start, hl) \
23162 init_glyph_string (s, hdc, char2b, w, row, area, start, hl)
23163 #else
23164 #define INIT_GLYPH_STRING(s, char2b, w, row, area, start, hl) \
23165 init_glyph_string (s, char2b, w, row, area, start, hl)
23166 #endif
23167
23168 /* Add a glyph string for a stretch glyph to the list of strings
23169 between HEAD and TAIL. START is the index of the stretch glyph in
23170 row area AREA of glyph row ROW. END is the index of the last glyph
23171 in that glyph row area. X is the current output position assigned
23172 to the new glyph string constructed. HL overrides that face of the
23173 glyph; e.g. it is DRAW_CURSOR if a cursor has to be drawn. LAST_X
23174 is the right-most x-position of the drawing area. */
23175
23176 /* SunOS 4 bundled cc, barfed on continuations in the arg lists here
23177 and below -- keep them on one line. */
23178 #define BUILD_STRETCH_GLYPH_STRING(START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
23179 do \
23180 { \
23181 s = alloca (sizeof *s); \
23182 INIT_GLYPH_STRING (s, NULL, w, row, area, START, HL); \
23183 START = fill_stretch_glyph_string (s, START, END); \
23184 append_glyph_string (&HEAD, &TAIL, s); \
23185 s->x = (X); \
23186 } \
23187 while (0)
23188
23189
23190 /* Add a glyph string for an image glyph to the list of strings
23191 between HEAD and TAIL. START is the index of the image glyph in
23192 row area AREA of glyph row ROW. END is the index of the last glyph
23193 in that glyph row area. X is the current output position assigned
23194 to the new glyph string constructed. HL overrides that face of the
23195 glyph; e.g. it is DRAW_CURSOR if a cursor has to be drawn. LAST_X
23196 is the right-most x-position of the drawing area. */
23197
23198 #define BUILD_IMAGE_GLYPH_STRING(START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
23199 do \
23200 { \
23201 s = alloca (sizeof *s); \
23202 INIT_GLYPH_STRING (s, NULL, w, row, area, START, HL); \
23203 fill_image_glyph_string (s); \
23204 append_glyph_string (&HEAD, &TAIL, s); \
23205 ++START; \
23206 s->x = (X); \
23207 } \
23208 while (0)
23209
23210
23211 /* Add a glyph string for a sequence of character glyphs to the list
23212 of strings between HEAD and TAIL. START is the index of the first
23213 glyph in row area AREA of glyph row ROW that is part of the new
23214 glyph string. END is the index of the last glyph in that glyph row
23215 area. X is the current output position assigned to the new glyph
23216 string constructed. HL overrides that face of the glyph; e.g. it
23217 is DRAW_CURSOR if a cursor has to be drawn. LAST_X is the
23218 right-most x-position of the drawing area. */
23219
23220 #define BUILD_CHAR_GLYPH_STRINGS(START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
23221 do \
23222 { \
23223 int face_id; \
23224 XChar2b *char2b; \
23225 \
23226 face_id = (row)->glyphs[area][START].face_id; \
23227 \
23228 s = alloca (sizeof *s); \
23229 char2b = alloca ((END - START) * sizeof *char2b); \
23230 INIT_GLYPH_STRING (s, char2b, w, row, area, START, HL); \
23231 append_glyph_string (&HEAD, &TAIL, s); \
23232 s->x = (X); \
23233 START = fill_glyph_string (s, face_id, START, END, overlaps); \
23234 } \
23235 while (0)
23236
23237
23238 /* Add a glyph string for a composite sequence to the list of strings
23239 between HEAD and TAIL. START is the index of the first glyph in
23240 row area AREA of glyph row ROW that is part of the new glyph
23241 string. END is the index of the last glyph in that glyph row area.
23242 X is the current output position assigned to the new glyph string
23243 constructed. HL overrides that face of the glyph; e.g. it is
23244 DRAW_CURSOR if a cursor has to be drawn. LAST_X is the right-most
23245 x-position of the drawing area. */
23246
23247 #define BUILD_COMPOSITE_GLYPH_STRING(START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
23248 do { \
23249 int face_id = (row)->glyphs[area][START].face_id; \
23250 struct face *base_face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, face_id); \
23251 ptrdiff_t cmp_id = (row)->glyphs[area][START].u.cmp.id; \
23252 struct composition *cmp = composition_table[cmp_id]; \
23253 XChar2b *char2b; \
23254 struct glyph_string *first_s = NULL; \
23255 int n; \
23256 \
23257 char2b = alloca (cmp->glyph_len * sizeof *char2b); \
23258 \
23259 /* Make glyph_strings for each glyph sequence that is drawable by \
23260 the same face, and append them to HEAD/TAIL. */ \
23261 for (n = 0; n < cmp->glyph_len;) \
23262 { \
23263 s = alloca (sizeof *s); \
23264 INIT_GLYPH_STRING (s, char2b, w, row, area, START, HL); \
23265 append_glyph_string (&(HEAD), &(TAIL), s); \
23266 s->cmp = cmp; \
23267 s->cmp_from = n; \
23268 s->x = (X); \
23269 if (n == 0) \
23270 first_s = s; \
23271 n = fill_composite_glyph_string (s, base_face, overlaps); \
23272 } \
23273 \
23274 ++START; \
23275 s = first_s; \
23276 } while (0)
23277
23278
23279 /* Add a glyph string for a glyph-string sequence to the list of strings
23280 between HEAD and TAIL. */
23281
23282 #define BUILD_GSTRING_GLYPH_STRING(START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
23283 do { \
23284 int face_id; \
23285 XChar2b *char2b; \
23286 Lisp_Object gstring; \
23287 \
23288 face_id = (row)->glyphs[area][START].face_id; \
23289 gstring = (composition_gstring_from_id \
23290 ((row)->glyphs[area][START].u.cmp.id)); \
23291 s = alloca (sizeof *s); \
23292 char2b = alloca (LGSTRING_GLYPH_LEN (gstring) * sizeof *char2b); \
23293 INIT_GLYPH_STRING (s, char2b, w, row, area, START, HL); \
23294 append_glyph_string (&(HEAD), &(TAIL), s); \
23295 s->x = (X); \
23296 START = fill_gstring_glyph_string (s, face_id, START, END, overlaps); \
23297 } while (0)
23298
23299
23300 /* Add a glyph string for a sequence of glyphless character's glyphs
23301 to the list of strings between HEAD and TAIL. The meanings of
23302 arguments are the same as those of BUILD_CHAR_GLYPH_STRINGS. */
23303
23304 #define BUILD_GLYPHLESS_GLYPH_STRING(START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
23305 do \
23306 { \
23307 int face_id; \
23308 \
23309 face_id = (row)->glyphs[area][START].face_id; \
23310 \
23311 s = alloca (sizeof *s); \
23312 INIT_GLYPH_STRING (s, NULL, w, row, area, START, HL); \
23313 append_glyph_string (&HEAD, &TAIL, s); \
23314 s->x = (X); \
23315 START = fill_glyphless_glyph_string (s, face_id, START, END, \
23316 overlaps); \
23317 } \
23318 while (0)
23319
23320
23321 /* Build a list of glyph strings between HEAD and TAIL for the glyphs
23322 of AREA of glyph row ROW on window W between indices START and END.
23323 HL overrides the face for drawing glyph strings, e.g. it is
23324 DRAW_CURSOR to draw a cursor. X and LAST_X are start and end
23325 x-positions of the drawing area.
23326
23327 This is an ugly monster macro construct because we must use alloca
23328 to allocate glyph strings (because draw_glyphs can be called
23329 asynchronously). */
23330
23331 #define BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS(START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
23332 do \
23333 { \
23334 HEAD = TAIL = NULL; \
23335 while (START < END) \
23336 { \
23337 struct glyph *first_glyph = (row)->glyphs[area] + START; \
23338 switch (first_glyph->type) \
23339 { \
23340 case CHAR_GLYPH: \
23341 BUILD_CHAR_GLYPH_STRINGS (START, END, HEAD, TAIL, \
23342 HL, X, LAST_X); \
23343 break; \
23344 \
23345 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH: \
23346 if (first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic) \
23347 BUILD_GSTRING_GLYPH_STRING (START, END, HEAD, TAIL, \
23348 HL, X, LAST_X); \
23349 else \
23350 BUILD_COMPOSITE_GLYPH_STRING (START, END, HEAD, TAIL, \
23351 HL, X, LAST_X); \
23352 break; \
23353 \
23354 case STRETCH_GLYPH: \
23355 BUILD_STRETCH_GLYPH_STRING (START, END, HEAD, TAIL, \
23356 HL, X, LAST_X); \
23357 break; \
23358 \
23359 case IMAGE_GLYPH: \
23360 BUILD_IMAGE_GLYPH_STRING (START, END, HEAD, TAIL, \
23361 HL, X, LAST_X); \
23362 break; \
23363 \
23364 case GLYPHLESS_GLYPH: \
23365 BUILD_GLYPHLESS_GLYPH_STRING (START, END, HEAD, TAIL, \
23366 HL, X, LAST_X); \
23367 break; \
23368 \
23369 default: \
23370 abort (); \
23371 } \
23372 \
23373 if (s) \
23374 { \
23375 set_glyph_string_background_width (s, START, LAST_X); \
23376 (X) += s->width; \
23377 } \
23378 } \
23379 } while (0)
23380
23381
23382 /* Draw glyphs between START and END in AREA of ROW on window W,
23383 starting at x-position X. X is relative to AREA in W. HL is a
23384 face-override with the following meaning:
23385
23386 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT draw normally
23387 DRAW_CURSOR draw in cursor face
23388 DRAW_MOUSE_FACE draw in mouse face.
23389 DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO draw in mode line face
23390 DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN draw an image with a sunken relief around it
23391 DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED draw an image with a raised relief around it
23392
23393 If OVERLAPS is non-zero, draw only the foreground of characters and
23394 clip to the physical height of ROW. Non-zero value also defines
23395 the overlapping part to be drawn:
23396
23397 OVERLAPS_PRED overlap with preceding rows
23398 OVERLAPS_SUCC overlap with succeeding rows
23399 OVERLAPS_BOTH overlap with both preceding/succeeding rows
23400 OVERLAPS_ERASED_CURSOR overlap with erased cursor area
23401
23402 Value is the x-position reached, relative to AREA of W. */
23403
23404 static int
23405 draw_glyphs (struct window *w, int x, struct glyph_row *row,
23406 enum glyph_row_area area, ptrdiff_t start, ptrdiff_t end,
23407 enum draw_glyphs_face hl, int overlaps)
23408 {
23409 struct glyph_string *head, *tail;
23410 struct glyph_string *s;
23411 struct glyph_string *clip_head = NULL, *clip_tail = NULL;
23412 int i, j, x_reached, last_x, area_left = 0;
23413 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
23414 DECLARE_HDC (hdc);
23415
23416 ALLOCATE_HDC (hdc, f);
23417
23418 /* Let's rather be paranoid than getting a SEGV. */
23419 end = min (end, row->used[area]);
23420 start = max (0, start);
23421 start = min (end, start);
23422
23423 /* Translate X to frame coordinates. Set last_x to the right
23424 end of the drawing area. */
23425 if (row->full_width_p)
23426 {
23427 /* X is relative to the left edge of W, without scroll bars
23428 or fringes. */
23429 area_left = WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (w);
23430 last_x = WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (w) + WINDOW_TOTAL_WIDTH (w);
23431 }
23432 else
23433 {
23434 area_left = window_box_left (w, area);
23435 last_x = area_left + window_box_width (w, area);
23436 }
23437 x += area_left;
23438
23439 /* Build a doubly-linked list of glyph_string structures between
23440 head and tail from what we have to draw. Note that the macro
23441 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS will modify its start parameter. That's
23442 the reason we use a separate variable `i'. */
23443 i = start;
23444 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (i, end, head, tail, hl, x, last_x);
23445 if (tail)
23446 x_reached = tail->x + tail->background_width;
23447 else
23448 x_reached = x;
23449
23450 /* If there are any glyphs with lbearing < 0 or rbearing > width in
23451 the row, redraw some glyphs in front or following the glyph
23452 strings built above. */
23453 if (head && !overlaps && row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p)
23454 {
23455 struct glyph_string *h, *t;
23456 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
23457 int mouse_beg_col IF_LINT (= 0), mouse_end_col IF_LINT (= 0);
23458 int check_mouse_face = 0;
23459 int dummy_x = 0;
23460
23461 /* If mouse highlighting is on, we may need to draw adjacent
23462 glyphs using mouse-face highlighting. */
23463 if (area == TEXT_AREA && row->mouse_face_p)
23464 {
23465 struct glyph_row *mouse_beg_row, *mouse_end_row;
23466
23467 mouse_beg_row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row);
23468 mouse_end_row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row);
23469
23470 if (row >= mouse_beg_row && row <= mouse_end_row)
23471 {
23472 check_mouse_face = 1;
23473 mouse_beg_col = (row == mouse_beg_row)
23474 ? hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col : 0;
23475 mouse_end_col = (row == mouse_end_row)
23476 ? hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col
23477 : row->used[TEXT_AREA];
23478 }
23479 }
23480
23481 /* Compute overhangs for all glyph strings. */
23482 if (FRAME_RIF (f)->compute_glyph_string_overhangs)
23483 for (s = head; s; s = s->next)
23484 FRAME_RIF (f)->compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s);
23485
23486 /* Prepend glyph strings for glyphs in front of the first glyph
23487 string that are overwritten because of the first glyph
23488 string's left overhang. The background of all strings
23489 prepended must be drawn because the first glyph string
23490 draws over it. */
23491 i = left_overwritten (head);
23492 if (i >= 0)
23493 {
23494 enum draw_glyphs_face overlap_hl;
23495
23496 /* If this row contains mouse highlighting, attempt to draw
23497 the overlapped glyphs with the correct highlight. This
23498 code fails if the overlap encompasses more than one glyph
23499 and mouse-highlight spans only some of these glyphs.
23500 However, making it work perfectly involves a lot more
23501 code, and I don't know if the pathological case occurs in
23502 practice, so we'll stick to this for now. --- cyd */
23503 if (check_mouse_face
23504 && mouse_beg_col < start && mouse_end_col > i)
23505 overlap_hl = DRAW_MOUSE_FACE;
23506 else
23507 overlap_hl = DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT;
23508
23509 j = i;
23510 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (j, start, h, t,
23511 overlap_hl, dummy_x, last_x);
23512 start = i;
23513 compute_overhangs_and_x (t, head->x, 1);
23514 prepend_glyph_string_lists (&head, &tail, h, t);
23515 clip_head = head;
23516 }
23517
23518 /* Prepend glyph strings for glyphs in front of the first glyph
23519 string that overwrite that glyph string because of their
23520 right overhang. For these strings, only the foreground must
23521 be drawn, because it draws over the glyph string at `head'.
23522 The background must not be drawn because this would overwrite
23523 right overhangs of preceding glyphs for which no glyph
23524 strings exist. */
23525 i = left_overwriting (head);
23526 if (i >= 0)
23527 {
23528 enum draw_glyphs_face overlap_hl;
23529
23530 if (check_mouse_face
23531 && mouse_beg_col < start && mouse_end_col > i)
23532 overlap_hl = DRAW_MOUSE_FACE;
23533 else
23534 overlap_hl = DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT;
23535
23536 clip_head = head;
23537 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (i, start, h, t,
23538 overlap_hl, dummy_x, last_x);
23539 for (s = h; s; s = s->next)
23540 s->background_filled_p = 1;
23541 compute_overhangs_and_x (t, head->x, 1);
23542 prepend_glyph_string_lists (&head, &tail, h, t);
23543 }
23544
23545 /* Append glyphs strings for glyphs following the last glyph
23546 string tail that are overwritten by tail. The background of
23547 these strings has to be drawn because tail's foreground draws
23548 over it. */
23549 i = right_overwritten (tail);
23550 if (i >= 0)
23551 {
23552 enum draw_glyphs_face overlap_hl;
23553
23554 if (check_mouse_face
23555 && mouse_beg_col < i && mouse_end_col > end)
23556 overlap_hl = DRAW_MOUSE_FACE;
23557 else
23558 overlap_hl = DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT;
23559
23560 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (end, i, h, t,
23561 overlap_hl, x, last_x);
23562 /* Because BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS updates the first argument,
23563 we don't have `end = i;' here. */
23564 compute_overhangs_and_x (h, tail->x + tail->width, 0);
23565 append_glyph_string_lists (&head, &tail, h, t);
23566 clip_tail = tail;
23567 }
23568
23569 /* Append glyph strings for glyphs following the last glyph
23570 string tail that overwrite tail. The foreground of such
23571 glyphs has to be drawn because it writes into the background
23572 of tail. The background must not be drawn because it could
23573 paint over the foreground of following glyphs. */
23574 i = right_overwriting (tail);
23575 if (i >= 0)
23576 {
23577 enum draw_glyphs_face overlap_hl;
23578 if (check_mouse_face
23579 && mouse_beg_col < i && mouse_end_col > end)
23580 overlap_hl = DRAW_MOUSE_FACE;
23581 else
23582 overlap_hl = DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT;
23583
23584 clip_tail = tail;
23585 i++; /* We must include the Ith glyph. */
23586 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (end, i, h, t,
23587 overlap_hl, x, last_x);
23588 for (s = h; s; s = s->next)
23589 s->background_filled_p = 1;
23590 compute_overhangs_and_x (h, tail->x + tail->width, 0);
23591 append_glyph_string_lists (&head, &tail, h, t);
23592 }
23593 if (clip_head || clip_tail)
23594 for (s = head; s; s = s->next)
23595 {
23596 s->clip_head = clip_head;
23597 s->clip_tail = clip_tail;
23598 }
23599 }
23600
23601 /* Draw all strings. */
23602 for (s = head; s; s = s->next)
23603 FRAME_RIF (f)->draw_glyph_string (s);
23604
23605 #ifndef HAVE_NS
23606 /* When focus a sole frame and move horizontally, this sets on_p to 0
23607 causing a failure to erase prev cursor position. */
23608 if (area == TEXT_AREA
23609 && !row->full_width_p
23610 /* When drawing overlapping rows, only the glyph strings'
23611 foreground is drawn, which doesn't erase a cursor
23612 completely. */
23613 && !overlaps)
23614 {
23615 int x0 = clip_head ? clip_head->x : (head ? head->x : x);
23616 int x1 = (clip_tail ? clip_tail->x + clip_tail->background_width
23617 : (tail ? tail->x + tail->background_width : x));
23618 x0 -= area_left;
23619 x1 -= area_left;
23620
23621 notice_overwritten_cursor (w, TEXT_AREA, x0, x1,
23622 row->y, MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row));
23623 }
23624 #endif
23625
23626 /* Value is the x-position up to which drawn, relative to AREA of W.
23627 This doesn't include parts drawn because of overhangs. */
23628 if (row->full_width_p)
23629 x_reached = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_X (w, x_reached);
23630 else
23631 x_reached -= area_left;
23632
23633 RELEASE_HDC (hdc, f);
23634
23635 return x_reached;
23636 }
23637
23638 /* Expand row matrix if too narrow. Don't expand if area
23639 is not present. */
23640
23641 #define IT_EXPAND_MATRIX_WIDTH(it, area) \
23642 { \
23643 if (!fonts_changed_p \
23644 && (it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] \
23645 < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])) \
23646 { \
23647 it->w->ncols_scale_factor++; \
23648 fonts_changed_p = 1; \
23649 } \
23650 }
23651
23652 /* Store one glyph for IT->char_to_display in IT->glyph_row.
23653 Called from x_produce_glyphs when IT->glyph_row is non-null. */
23654
23655 static inline void
23656 append_glyph (struct it *it)
23657 {
23658 struct glyph *glyph;
23659 enum glyph_row_area area = it->area;
23660
23661 eassert (it->glyph_row);
23662 eassert (it->char_to_display != '\n' && it->char_to_display != '\t');
23663
23664 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] + it->glyph_row->used[area];
23665 if (glyph < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])
23666 {
23667 /* If the glyph row is reversed, we need to prepend the glyph
23668 rather than append it. */
23669 if (it->glyph_row->reversed_p && area == TEXT_AREA)
23670 {
23671 struct glyph *g;
23672
23673 /* Make room for the additional glyph. */
23674 for (g = glyph - 1; g >= it->glyph_row->glyphs[area]; g--)
23675 g[1] = *g;
23676 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area];
23677 }
23678 glyph->charpos = CHARPOS (it->position);
23679 glyph->object = it->object;
23680 if (it->pixel_width > 0)
23681 {
23682 glyph->pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
23683 glyph->padding_p = 0;
23684 }
23685 else
23686 {
23687 /* Assure at least 1-pixel width. Otherwise, cursor can't
23688 be displayed correctly. */
23689 glyph->pixel_width = 1;
23690 glyph->padding_p = 1;
23691 }
23692 glyph->ascent = it->ascent;
23693 glyph->descent = it->descent;
23694 glyph->voffset = it->voffset;
23695 glyph->type = CHAR_GLYPH;
23696 glyph->avoid_cursor_p = it->avoid_cursor_p;
23697 glyph->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
23698 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
23699 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
23700 glyph->overlaps_vertically_p = (it->phys_ascent > it->ascent
23701 || it->phys_descent > it->descent);
23702 glyph->glyph_not_available_p = it->glyph_not_available_p;
23703 glyph->face_id = it->face_id;
23704 glyph->u.ch = it->char_to_display;
23705 glyph->slice.img = null_glyph_slice;
23706 glyph->font_type = FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
23707 if (it->bidi_p)
23708 {
23709 glyph->resolved_level = it->bidi_it.resolved_level;
23710 if ((it->bidi_it.type & 7) != it->bidi_it.type)
23711 abort ();
23712 glyph->bidi_type = it->bidi_it.type;
23713 }
23714 else
23715 {
23716 glyph->resolved_level = 0;
23717 glyph->bidi_type = UNKNOWN_BT;
23718 }
23719 ++it->glyph_row->used[area];
23720 }
23721 else
23722 IT_EXPAND_MATRIX_WIDTH (it, area);
23723 }
23724
23725 /* Store one glyph for the composition IT->cmp_it.id in
23726 IT->glyph_row. Called from x_produce_glyphs when IT->glyph_row is
23727 non-null. */
23728
23729 static inline void
23730 append_composite_glyph (struct it *it)
23731 {
23732 struct glyph *glyph;
23733 enum glyph_row_area area = it->area;
23734
23735 eassert (it->glyph_row);
23736
23737 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] + it->glyph_row->used[area];
23738 if (glyph < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])
23739 {
23740 /* If the glyph row is reversed, we need to prepend the glyph
23741 rather than append it. */
23742 if (it->glyph_row->reversed_p && it->area == TEXT_AREA)
23743 {
23744 struct glyph *g;
23745
23746 /* Make room for the new glyph. */
23747 for (g = glyph - 1; g >= it->glyph_row->glyphs[it->area]; g--)
23748 g[1] = *g;
23749 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[it->area];
23750 }
23751 glyph->charpos = it->cmp_it.charpos;
23752 glyph->object = it->object;
23753 glyph->pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
23754 glyph->ascent = it->ascent;
23755 glyph->descent = it->descent;
23756 glyph->voffset = it->voffset;
23757 glyph->type = COMPOSITE_GLYPH;
23758 if (it->cmp_it.ch < 0)
23759 {
23760 glyph->u.cmp.automatic = 0;
23761 glyph->u.cmp.id = it->cmp_it.id;
23762 glyph->slice.cmp.from = glyph->slice.cmp.to = 0;
23763 }
23764 else
23765 {
23766 glyph->u.cmp.automatic = 1;
23767 glyph->u.cmp.id = it->cmp_it.id;
23768 glyph->slice.cmp.from = it->cmp_it.from;
23769 glyph->slice.cmp.to = it->cmp_it.to - 1;
23770 }
23771 glyph->avoid_cursor_p = it->avoid_cursor_p;
23772 glyph->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
23773 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
23774 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
23775 glyph->overlaps_vertically_p = (it->phys_ascent > it->ascent
23776 || it->phys_descent > it->descent);
23777 glyph->padding_p = 0;
23778 glyph->glyph_not_available_p = 0;
23779 glyph->face_id = it->face_id;
23780 glyph->font_type = FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
23781 if (it->bidi_p)
23782 {
23783 glyph->resolved_level = it->bidi_it.resolved_level;
23784 if ((it->bidi_it.type & 7) != it->bidi_it.type)
23785 abort ();
23786 glyph->bidi_type = it->bidi_it.type;
23787 }
23788 ++it->glyph_row->used[area];
23789 }
23790 else
23791 IT_EXPAND_MATRIX_WIDTH (it, area);
23792 }
23793
23794
23795 /* Change IT->ascent and IT->height according to the setting of
23796 IT->voffset. */
23797
23798 static inline void
23799 take_vertical_position_into_account (struct it *it)
23800 {
23801 if (it->voffset)
23802 {
23803 if (it->voffset < 0)
23804 /* Increase the ascent so that we can display the text higher
23805 in the line. */
23806 it->ascent -= it->voffset;
23807 else
23808 /* Increase the descent so that we can display the text lower
23809 in the line. */
23810 it->descent += it->voffset;
23811 }
23812 }
23813
23814
23815 /* Produce glyphs/get display metrics for the image IT is loaded with.
23816 See the description of struct display_iterator in dispextern.h for
23817 an overview of struct display_iterator. */
23818
23819 static void
23820 produce_image_glyph (struct it *it)
23821 {
23822 struct image *img;
23823 struct face *face;
23824 int glyph_ascent, crop;
23825 struct glyph_slice slice;
23826
23827 eassert (it->what == IT_IMAGE);
23828
23829 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
23830 eassert (face);
23831 /* Make sure X resources of the face is loaded. */
23832 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (it->f, face);
23833
23834 if (it->image_id < 0)
23835 {
23836 /* Fringe bitmap. */
23837 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = 0;
23838 it->descent = it->phys_descent = 0;
23839 it->pixel_width = 0;
23840 it->nglyphs = 0;
23841 return;
23842 }
23843
23844 img = IMAGE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->image_id);
23845 eassert (img);
23846 /* Make sure X resources of the image is loaded. */
23847 prepare_image_for_display (it->f, img);
23848
23849 slice.x = slice.y = 0;
23850 slice.width = img->width;
23851 slice.height = img->height;
23852
23853 if (INTEGERP (it->slice.x))
23854 slice.x = XINT (it->slice.x);
23855 else if (FLOATP (it->slice.x))
23856 slice.x = XFLOAT_DATA (it->slice.x) * img->width;
23857
23858 if (INTEGERP (it->slice.y))
23859 slice.y = XINT (it->slice.y);
23860 else if (FLOATP (it->slice.y))
23861 slice.y = XFLOAT_DATA (it->slice.y) * img->height;
23862
23863 if (INTEGERP (it->slice.width))
23864 slice.width = XINT (it->slice.width);
23865 else if (FLOATP (it->slice.width))
23866 slice.width = XFLOAT_DATA (it->slice.width) * img->width;
23867
23868 if (INTEGERP (it->slice.height))
23869 slice.height = XINT (it->slice.height);
23870 else if (FLOATP (it->slice.height))
23871 slice.height = XFLOAT_DATA (it->slice.height) * img->height;
23872
23873 if (slice.x >= img->width)
23874 slice.x = img->width;
23875 if (slice.y >= img->height)
23876 slice.y = img->height;
23877 if (slice.x + slice.width >= img->width)
23878 slice.width = img->width - slice.x;
23879 if (slice.y + slice.height > img->height)
23880 slice.height = img->height - slice.y;
23881
23882 if (slice.width == 0 || slice.height == 0)
23883 return;
23884
23885 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = glyph_ascent = image_ascent (img, face, &slice);
23886
23887 it->descent = slice.height - glyph_ascent;
23888 if (slice.y == 0)
23889 it->descent += img->vmargin;
23890 if (slice.y + slice.height == img->height)
23891 it->descent += img->vmargin;
23892 it->phys_descent = it->descent;
23893
23894 it->pixel_width = slice.width;
23895 if (slice.x == 0)
23896 it->pixel_width += img->hmargin;
23897 if (slice.x + slice.width == img->width)
23898 it->pixel_width += img->hmargin;
23899
23900 /* It's quite possible for images to have an ascent greater than
23901 their height, so don't get confused in that case. */
23902 if (it->descent < 0)
23903 it->descent = 0;
23904
23905 it->nglyphs = 1;
23906
23907 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
23908 {
23909 if (face->box_line_width > 0)
23910 {
23911 if (slice.y == 0)
23912 it->ascent += face->box_line_width;
23913 if (slice.y + slice.height == img->height)
23914 it->descent += face->box_line_width;
23915 }
23916
23917 if (it->start_of_box_run_p && slice.x == 0)
23918 it->pixel_width += eabs (face->box_line_width);
23919 if (it->end_of_box_run_p && slice.x + slice.width == img->width)
23920 it->pixel_width += eabs (face->box_line_width);
23921 }
23922
23923 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
23924
23925 /* Automatically crop wide image glyphs at right edge so we can
23926 draw the cursor on same display row. */
23927 if ((crop = it->pixel_width - (it->last_visible_x - it->current_x), crop > 0)
23928 && (it->hpos == 0 || it->pixel_width > it->last_visible_x / 4))
23929 {
23930 it->pixel_width -= crop;
23931 slice.width -= crop;
23932 }
23933
23934 if (it->glyph_row)
23935 {
23936 struct glyph *glyph;
23937 enum glyph_row_area area = it->area;
23938
23939 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] + it->glyph_row->used[area];
23940 if (glyph < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])
23941 {
23942 glyph->charpos = CHARPOS (it->position);
23943 glyph->object = it->object;
23944 glyph->pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
23945 glyph->ascent = glyph_ascent;
23946 glyph->descent = it->descent;
23947 glyph->voffset = it->voffset;
23948 glyph->type = IMAGE_GLYPH;
23949 glyph->avoid_cursor_p = it->avoid_cursor_p;
23950 glyph->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
23951 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
23952 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
23953 glyph->overlaps_vertically_p = 0;
23954 glyph->padding_p = 0;
23955 glyph->glyph_not_available_p = 0;
23956 glyph->face_id = it->face_id;
23957 glyph->u.img_id = img->id;
23958 glyph->slice.img = slice;
23959 glyph->font_type = FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
23960 if (it->bidi_p)
23961 {
23962 glyph->resolved_level = it->bidi_it.resolved_level;
23963 if ((it->bidi_it.type & 7) != it->bidi_it.type)
23964 abort ();
23965 glyph->bidi_type = it->bidi_it.type;
23966 }
23967 ++it->glyph_row->used[area];
23968 }
23969 else
23970 IT_EXPAND_MATRIX_WIDTH (it, area);
23971 }
23972 }
23973
23974
23975 /* Append a stretch glyph to IT->glyph_row. OBJECT is the source
23976 of the glyph, WIDTH and HEIGHT are the width and height of the
23977 stretch. ASCENT is the ascent of the glyph (0 <= ASCENT <= HEIGHT). */
23978
23979 static void
23980 append_stretch_glyph (struct it *it, Lisp_Object object,
23981 int width, int height, int ascent)
23982 {
23983 struct glyph *glyph;
23984 enum glyph_row_area area = it->area;
23985
23986 eassert (ascent >= 0 && ascent <= height);
23987
23988 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] + it->glyph_row->used[area];
23989 if (glyph < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])
23990 {
23991 /* If the glyph row is reversed, we need to prepend the glyph
23992 rather than append it. */
23993 if (it->glyph_row->reversed_p && area == TEXT_AREA)
23994 {
23995 struct glyph *g;
23996
23997 /* Make room for the additional glyph. */
23998 for (g = glyph - 1; g >= it->glyph_row->glyphs[area]; g--)
23999 g[1] = *g;
24000 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area];
24001 }
24002 glyph->charpos = CHARPOS (it->position);
24003 glyph->object = object;
24004 glyph->pixel_width = width;
24005 glyph->ascent = ascent;
24006 glyph->descent = height - ascent;
24007 glyph->voffset = it->voffset;
24008 glyph->type = STRETCH_GLYPH;
24009 glyph->avoid_cursor_p = it->avoid_cursor_p;
24010 glyph->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
24011 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
24012 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
24013 glyph->overlaps_vertically_p = 0;
24014 glyph->padding_p = 0;
24015 glyph->glyph_not_available_p = 0;
24016 glyph->face_id = it->face_id;
24017 glyph->u.stretch.ascent = ascent;
24018 glyph->u.stretch.height = height;
24019 glyph->slice.img = null_glyph_slice;
24020 glyph->font_type = FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
24021 if (it->bidi_p)
24022 {
24023 glyph->resolved_level = it->bidi_it.resolved_level;
24024 if ((it->bidi_it.type & 7) != it->bidi_it.type)
24025 abort ();
24026 glyph->bidi_type = it->bidi_it.type;
24027 }
24028 else
24029 {
24030 glyph->resolved_level = 0;
24031 glyph->bidi_type = UNKNOWN_BT;
24032 }
24033 ++it->glyph_row->used[area];
24034 }
24035 else
24036 IT_EXPAND_MATRIX_WIDTH (it, area);
24037 }
24038
24039 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
24040
24041 /* Produce a stretch glyph for iterator IT. IT->object is the value
24042 of the glyph property displayed. The value must be a list
24043 `(space KEYWORD VALUE ...)' with the following KEYWORD/VALUE pairs
24044 being recognized:
24045
24046 1. `:width WIDTH' specifies that the space should be WIDTH *
24047 canonical char width wide. WIDTH may be an integer or floating
24048 point number.
24049
24050 2. `:relative-width FACTOR' specifies that the width of the stretch
24051 should be computed from the width of the first character having the
24052 `glyph' property, and should be FACTOR times that width.
24053
24054 3. `:align-to HPOS' specifies that the space should be wide enough
24055 to reach HPOS, a value in canonical character units.
24056
24057 Exactly one of the above pairs must be present.
24058
24059 4. `:height HEIGHT' specifies that the height of the stretch produced
24060 should be HEIGHT, measured in canonical character units.
24061
24062 5. `:relative-height FACTOR' specifies that the height of the
24063 stretch should be FACTOR times the height of the characters having
24064 the glyph property.
24065
24066 Either none or exactly one of 4 or 5 must be present.
24067
24068 6. `:ascent ASCENT' specifies that ASCENT percent of the height
24069 of the stretch should be used for the ascent of the stretch.
24070 ASCENT must be in the range 0 <= ASCENT <= 100. */
24071
24072 void
24073 produce_stretch_glyph (struct it *it)
24074 {
24075 /* (space :width WIDTH :height HEIGHT ...) */
24076 Lisp_Object prop, plist;
24077 int width = 0, height = 0, align_to = -1;
24078 int zero_width_ok_p = 0;
24079 int ascent = 0;
24080 double tem;
24081 struct face *face = NULL;
24082 struct font *font = NULL;
24083
24084 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
24085 int zero_height_ok_p = 0;
24086
24087 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
24088 {
24089 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
24090 font = face->font ? face->font : FRAME_FONT (it->f);
24091 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (it->f, face);
24092 }
24093 #endif
24094
24095 /* List should start with `space'. */
24096 eassert (CONSP (it->object) && EQ (XCAR (it->object), Qspace));
24097 plist = XCDR (it->object);
24098
24099 /* Compute the width of the stretch. */
24100 if ((prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCwidth), !NILP (prop))
24101 && calc_pixel_width_or_height (&tem, it, prop, font, 1, 0))
24102 {
24103 /* Absolute width `:width WIDTH' specified and valid. */
24104 zero_width_ok_p = 1;
24105 width = (int)tem;
24106 }
24107 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
24108 else if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
24109 && (prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCrelative_width), NUMVAL (prop) > 0))
24110 {
24111 /* Relative width `:relative-width FACTOR' specified and valid.
24112 Compute the width of the characters having the `glyph'
24113 property. */
24114 struct it it2;
24115 unsigned char *p = BYTE_POS_ADDR (IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
24116
24117 it2 = *it;
24118 if (it->multibyte_p)
24119 it2.c = it2.char_to_display = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (p, it2.len);
24120 else
24121 {
24122 it2.c = it2.char_to_display = *p, it2.len = 1;
24123 if (! ASCII_CHAR_P (it2.c))
24124 it2.char_to_display = BYTE8_TO_CHAR (it2.c);
24125 }
24126
24127 it2.glyph_row = NULL;
24128 it2.what = IT_CHARACTER;
24129 x_produce_glyphs (&it2);
24130 width = NUMVAL (prop) * it2.pixel_width;
24131 }
24132 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
24133 else if ((prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCalign_to), !NILP (prop))
24134 && calc_pixel_width_or_height (&tem, it, prop, font, 1, &align_to))
24135 {
24136 if (it->glyph_row == NULL || !it->glyph_row->mode_line_p)
24137 align_to = (align_to < 0
24138 ? 0
24139 : align_to - window_box_left_offset (it->w, TEXT_AREA));
24140 else if (align_to < 0)
24141 align_to = window_box_left_offset (it->w, TEXT_AREA);
24142 width = max (0, (int)tem + align_to - it->current_x);
24143 zero_width_ok_p = 1;
24144 }
24145 else
24146 /* Nothing specified -> width defaults to canonical char width. */
24147 width = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it->f);
24148
24149 if (width <= 0 && (width < 0 || !zero_width_ok_p))
24150 width = 1;
24151
24152 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
24153 /* Compute height. */
24154 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
24155 {
24156 if ((prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCheight), !NILP (prop))
24157 && calc_pixel_width_or_height (&tem, it, prop, font, 0, 0))
24158 {
24159 height = (int)tem;
24160 zero_height_ok_p = 1;
24161 }
24162 else if (prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCrelative_height),
24163 NUMVAL (prop) > 0)
24164 height = FONT_HEIGHT (font) * NUMVAL (prop);
24165 else
24166 height = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
24167
24168 if (height <= 0 && (height < 0 || !zero_height_ok_p))
24169 height = 1;
24170
24171 /* Compute percentage of height used for ascent. If
24172 `:ascent ASCENT' is present and valid, use that. Otherwise,
24173 derive the ascent from the font in use. */
24174 if (prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCascent),
24175 NUMVAL (prop) > 0 && NUMVAL (prop) <= 100)
24176 ascent = height * NUMVAL (prop) / 100.0;
24177 else if (!NILP (prop)
24178 && calc_pixel_width_or_height (&tem, it, prop, font, 0, 0))
24179 ascent = min (max (0, (int)tem), height);
24180 else
24181 ascent = (height * FONT_BASE (font)) / FONT_HEIGHT (font);
24182 }
24183 else
24184 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
24185 height = 1;
24186
24187 if (width > 0 && it->line_wrap != TRUNCATE
24188 && it->current_x + width > it->last_visible_x)
24189 {
24190 width = it->last_visible_x - it->current_x;
24191 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
24192 /* Subtract one more pixel from the stretch width, but only on
24193 GUI frames, since on a TTY each glyph is one "pixel" wide. */
24194 width -= FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f);
24195 #endif
24196 }
24197
24198 if (width > 0 && height > 0 && it->glyph_row)
24199 {
24200 Lisp_Object o_object = it->object;
24201 Lisp_Object object = it->stack[it->sp - 1].string;
24202 int n = width;
24203
24204 if (!STRINGP (object))
24205 object = it->w->buffer;
24206 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
24207 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
24208 append_stretch_glyph (it, object, width, height, ascent);
24209 else
24210 #endif
24211 {
24212 it->object = object;
24213 it->char_to_display = ' ';
24214 it->pixel_width = it->len = 1;
24215 while (n--)
24216 tty_append_glyph (it);
24217 it->object = o_object;
24218 }
24219 }
24220
24221 it->pixel_width = width;
24222 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
24223 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
24224 {
24225 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = ascent;
24226 it->descent = it->phys_descent = height - it->ascent;
24227 it->nglyphs = width > 0 && height > 0 ? 1 : 0;
24228 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
24229 }
24230 else
24231 #endif
24232 it->nglyphs = width;
24233 }
24234
24235 /* Get information about special display element WHAT in an
24236 environment described by IT. WHAT is one of IT_TRUNCATION or
24237 IT_CONTINUATION. Maybe produce glyphs for WHAT if IT has a
24238 non-null glyph_row member. This function ensures that fields like
24239 face_id, c, len of IT are left untouched. */
24240
24241 static void
24242 produce_special_glyphs (struct it *it, enum display_element_type what)
24243 {
24244 struct it temp_it;
24245 Lisp_Object gc;
24246 GLYPH glyph;
24247
24248 temp_it = *it;
24249 temp_it.object = make_number (0);
24250 memset (&temp_it.current, 0, sizeof temp_it.current);
24251
24252 if (what == IT_CONTINUATION)
24253 {
24254 /* Continuation glyph. For R2L lines, we mirror it by hand. */
24255 if (it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L)
24256 SET_GLYPH_FROM_CHAR (glyph, '/');
24257 else
24258 SET_GLYPH_FROM_CHAR (glyph, '\\');
24259 if (it->dp
24260 && (gc = DISP_CONTINUE_GLYPH (it->dp), GLYPH_CODE_P (gc)))
24261 {
24262 /* FIXME: Should we mirror GC for R2L lines? */
24263 SET_GLYPH_FROM_GLYPH_CODE (glyph, gc);
24264 spec_glyph_lookup_face (XWINDOW (it->window), &glyph);
24265 }
24266 }
24267 else if (what == IT_TRUNCATION)
24268 {
24269 /* Truncation glyph. */
24270 SET_GLYPH_FROM_CHAR (glyph, '$');
24271 if (it->dp
24272 && (gc = DISP_TRUNC_GLYPH (it->dp), GLYPH_CODE_P (gc)))
24273 {
24274 /* FIXME: Should we mirror GC for R2L lines? */
24275 SET_GLYPH_FROM_GLYPH_CODE (glyph, gc);
24276 spec_glyph_lookup_face (XWINDOW (it->window), &glyph);
24277 }
24278 }
24279 else
24280 abort ();
24281
24282 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
24283 /* On a GUI frame, when the right fringe (left fringe for R2L rows)
24284 is turned off, we precede the truncation/continuation glyphs by a
24285 stretch glyph whose width is computed such that these special
24286 glyphs are aligned at the window margin, even when very different
24287 fonts are used in different glyph rows. */
24288 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (temp_it.f)
24289 /* init_iterator calls this with it->glyph_row == NULL, and it
24290 wants only the pixel width of the truncation/continuation
24291 glyphs. */
24292 && temp_it.glyph_row
24293 /* insert_left_trunc_glyphs calls us at the beginning of the
24294 row, and it has its own calculation of the stretch glyph
24295 width. */
24296 && temp_it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] > 0
24297 && (temp_it.glyph_row->reversed_p
24298 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (temp_it.w)
24299 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (temp_it.w)) == 0)
24300 {
24301 int stretch_width = temp_it.last_visible_x - temp_it.current_x;
24302
24303 if (stretch_width > 0)
24304 {
24305 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (temp_it.f, temp_it.face_id);
24306 struct font *font =
24307 face->font ? face->font : FRAME_FONT (temp_it.f);
24308 int stretch_ascent =
24309 (((temp_it.ascent + temp_it.descent)
24310 * FONT_BASE (font)) / FONT_HEIGHT (font));
24311
24312 append_stretch_glyph (&temp_it, make_number (0), stretch_width,
24313 temp_it.ascent + temp_it.descent,
24314 stretch_ascent);
24315 }
24316 }
24317 #endif
24318
24319 temp_it.dp = NULL;
24320 temp_it.what = IT_CHARACTER;
24321 temp_it.len = 1;
24322 temp_it.c = temp_it.char_to_display = GLYPH_CHAR (glyph);
24323 temp_it.face_id = GLYPH_FACE (glyph);
24324 temp_it.len = CHAR_BYTES (temp_it.c);
24325
24326 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (&temp_it);
24327 it->pixel_width = temp_it.pixel_width;
24328 it->nglyphs = temp_it.pixel_width;
24329 }
24330
24331 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
24332
24333 /* Calculate line-height and line-spacing properties.
24334 An integer value specifies explicit pixel value.
24335 A float value specifies relative value to current face height.
24336 A cons (float . face-name) specifies relative value to
24337 height of specified face font.
24338
24339 Returns height in pixels, or nil. */
24340
24341
24342 static Lisp_Object
24343 calc_line_height_property (struct it *it, Lisp_Object val, struct font *font,
24344 int boff, int override)
24345 {
24346 Lisp_Object face_name = Qnil;
24347 int ascent, descent, height;
24348
24349 if (NILP (val) || INTEGERP (val) || (override && EQ (val, Qt)))
24350 return val;
24351
24352 if (CONSP (val))
24353 {
24354 face_name = XCAR (val);
24355 val = XCDR (val);
24356 if (!NUMBERP (val))
24357 val = make_number (1);
24358 if (NILP (face_name))
24359 {
24360 height = it->ascent + it->descent;
24361 goto scale;
24362 }
24363 }
24364
24365 if (NILP (face_name))
24366 {
24367 font = FRAME_FONT (it->f);
24368 boff = FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (it->f);
24369 }
24370 else if (EQ (face_name, Qt))
24371 {
24372 override = 0;
24373 }
24374 else
24375 {
24376 int face_id;
24377 struct face *face;
24378
24379 face_id = lookup_named_face (it->f, face_name, 0);
24380 if (face_id < 0)
24381 return make_number (-1);
24382
24383 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, face_id);
24384 font = face->font;
24385 if (font == NULL)
24386 return make_number (-1);
24387 boff = font->baseline_offset;
24388 if (font->vertical_centering)
24389 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, it->f) - boff;
24390 }
24391
24392 ascent = FONT_BASE (font) + boff;
24393 descent = FONT_DESCENT (font) - boff;
24394
24395 if (override)
24396 {
24397 it->override_ascent = ascent;
24398 it->override_descent = descent;
24399 it->override_boff = boff;
24400 }
24401
24402 height = ascent + descent;
24403
24404 scale:
24405 if (FLOATP (val))
24406 height = (int)(XFLOAT_DATA (val) * height);
24407 else if (INTEGERP (val))
24408 height *= XINT (val);
24409
24410 return make_number (height);
24411 }
24412
24413
24414 /* Append a glyph for a glyphless character to IT->glyph_row. FACE_ID
24415 is a face ID to be used for the glyph. FOR_NO_FONT is nonzero if
24416 and only if this is for a character for which no font was found.
24417
24418 If the display method (it->glyphless_method) is
24419 GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM or GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE, LEN is a
24420 length of the acronym or the hexadecimal string, UPPER_XOFF and
24421 UPPER_YOFF are pixel offsets for the upper part of the string,
24422 LOWER_XOFF and LOWER_YOFF are for the lower part.
24423
24424 For the other display methods, LEN through LOWER_YOFF are zero. */
24425
24426 static void
24427 append_glyphless_glyph (struct it *it, int face_id, int for_no_font, int len,
24428 short upper_xoff, short upper_yoff,
24429 short lower_xoff, short lower_yoff)
24430 {
24431 struct glyph *glyph;
24432 enum glyph_row_area area = it->area;
24433
24434 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] + it->glyph_row->used[area];
24435 if (glyph < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])
24436 {
24437 /* If the glyph row is reversed, we need to prepend the glyph
24438 rather than append it. */
24439 if (it->glyph_row->reversed_p && area == TEXT_AREA)
24440 {
24441 struct glyph *g;
24442
24443 /* Make room for the additional glyph. */
24444 for (g = glyph - 1; g >= it->glyph_row->glyphs[area]; g--)
24445 g[1] = *g;
24446 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area];
24447 }
24448 glyph->charpos = CHARPOS (it->position);
24449 glyph->object = it->object;
24450 glyph->pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
24451 glyph->ascent = it->ascent;
24452 glyph->descent = it->descent;
24453 glyph->voffset = it->voffset;
24454 glyph->type = GLYPHLESS_GLYPH;
24455 glyph->u.glyphless.method = it->glyphless_method;
24456 glyph->u.glyphless.for_no_font = for_no_font;
24457 glyph->u.glyphless.len = len;
24458 glyph->u.glyphless.ch = it->c;
24459 glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_xoff = upper_xoff;
24460 glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_yoff = upper_yoff;
24461 glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_xoff = lower_xoff;
24462 glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_yoff = lower_yoff;
24463 glyph->avoid_cursor_p = it->avoid_cursor_p;
24464 glyph->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
24465 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
24466 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
24467 glyph->overlaps_vertically_p = (it->phys_ascent > it->ascent
24468 || it->phys_descent > it->descent);
24469 glyph->padding_p = 0;
24470 glyph->glyph_not_available_p = 0;
24471 glyph->face_id = face_id;
24472 glyph->font_type = FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
24473 if (it->bidi_p)
24474 {
24475 glyph->resolved_level = it->bidi_it.resolved_level;
24476 if ((it->bidi_it.type & 7) != it->bidi_it.type)
24477 abort ();
24478 glyph->bidi_type = it->bidi_it.type;
24479 }
24480 ++it->glyph_row->used[area];
24481 }
24482 else
24483 IT_EXPAND_MATRIX_WIDTH (it, area);
24484 }
24485
24486
24487 /* Produce a glyph for a glyphless character for iterator IT.
24488 IT->glyphless_method specifies which method to use for displaying
24489 the character. See the description of enum
24490 glyphless_display_method in dispextern.h for the detail.
24491
24492 FOR_NO_FONT is nonzero if and only if this is for a character for
24493 which no font was found. ACRONYM, if non-nil, is an acronym string
24494 for the character. */
24495
24496 static void
24497 produce_glyphless_glyph (struct it *it, int for_no_font, Lisp_Object acronym)
24498 {
24499 int face_id;
24500 struct face *face;
24501 struct font *font;
24502 int base_width, base_height, width, height;
24503 short upper_xoff, upper_yoff, lower_xoff, lower_yoff;
24504 int len;
24505
24506 /* Get the metrics of the base font. We always refer to the current
24507 ASCII face. */
24508 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id)->ascii_face;
24509 font = face->font ? face->font : FRAME_FONT (it->f);
24510 it->ascent = FONT_BASE (font) + font->baseline_offset;
24511 it->descent = FONT_DESCENT (font) - font->baseline_offset;
24512 base_height = it->ascent + it->descent;
24513 base_width = font->average_width;
24514
24515 /* Get a face ID for the glyph by utilizing a cache (the same way as
24516 done for `escape-glyph' in get_next_display_element). */
24517 if (it->f == last_glyphless_glyph_frame
24518 && it->face_id == last_glyphless_glyph_face_id)
24519 {
24520 face_id = last_glyphless_glyph_merged_face_id;
24521 }
24522 else
24523 {
24524 /* Merge the `glyphless-char' face into the current face. */
24525 face_id = merge_faces (it->f, Qglyphless_char, 0, it->face_id);
24526 last_glyphless_glyph_frame = it->f;
24527 last_glyphless_glyph_face_id = it->face_id;
24528 last_glyphless_glyph_merged_face_id = face_id;
24529 }
24530
24531 if (it->glyphless_method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_THIN_SPACE)
24532 {
24533 it->pixel_width = THIN_SPACE_WIDTH;
24534 len = 0;
24535 upper_xoff = upper_yoff = lower_xoff = lower_yoff = 0;
24536 }
24537 else if (it->glyphless_method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_EMPTY_BOX)
24538 {
24539 width = CHAR_WIDTH (it->c);
24540 if (width == 0)
24541 width = 1;
24542 else if (width > 4)
24543 width = 4;
24544 it->pixel_width = base_width * width;
24545 len = 0;
24546 upper_xoff = upper_yoff = lower_xoff = lower_yoff = 0;
24547 }
24548 else
24549 {
24550 char buf[7];
24551 const char *str;
24552 unsigned int code[6];
24553 int upper_len;
24554 int ascent, descent;
24555 struct font_metrics metrics_upper, metrics_lower;
24556
24557 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, face_id);
24558 font = face->font ? face->font : FRAME_FONT (it->f);
24559 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (it->f, face);
24560
24561 if (it->glyphless_method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM)
24562 {
24563 if (! STRINGP (acronym) && CHAR_TABLE_P (Vglyphless_char_display))
24564 acronym = CHAR_TABLE_REF (Vglyphless_char_display, it->c);
24565 if (CONSP (acronym))
24566 acronym = XCAR (acronym);
24567 str = STRINGP (acronym) ? SSDATA (acronym) : "";
24568 }
24569 else
24570 {
24571 eassert (it->glyphless_method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE);
24572 sprintf (buf, "%0*X", it->c < 0x10000 ? 4 : 6, it->c);
24573 str = buf;
24574 }
24575 for (len = 0; str[len] && ASCII_BYTE_P (str[len]) && len < 6; len++)
24576 code[len] = font->driver->encode_char (font, str[len]);
24577 upper_len = (len + 1) / 2;
24578 font->driver->text_extents (font, code, upper_len,
24579 &metrics_upper);
24580 font->driver->text_extents (font, code + upper_len, len - upper_len,
24581 &metrics_lower);
24582
24583
24584
24585 /* +4 is for vertical bars of a box plus 1-pixel spaces at both side. */
24586 width = max (metrics_upper.width, metrics_lower.width) + 4;
24587 upper_xoff = upper_yoff = 2; /* the typical case */
24588 if (base_width >= width)
24589 {
24590 /* Align the upper to the left, the lower to the right. */
24591 it->pixel_width = base_width;
24592 lower_xoff = base_width - 2 - metrics_lower.width;
24593 }
24594 else
24595 {
24596 /* Center the shorter one. */
24597 it->pixel_width = width;
24598 if (metrics_upper.width >= metrics_lower.width)
24599 lower_xoff = (width - metrics_lower.width) / 2;
24600 else
24601 {
24602 /* FIXME: This code doesn't look right. It formerly was
24603 missing the "lower_xoff = 0;", which couldn't have
24604 been right since it left lower_xoff uninitialized. */
24605 lower_xoff = 0;
24606 upper_xoff = (width - metrics_upper.width) / 2;
24607 }
24608 }
24609
24610 /* +5 is for horizontal bars of a box plus 1-pixel spaces at
24611 top, bottom, and between upper and lower strings. */
24612 height = (metrics_upper.ascent + metrics_upper.descent
24613 + metrics_lower.ascent + metrics_lower.descent) + 5;
24614 /* Center vertically.
24615 H:base_height, D:base_descent
24616 h:height, ld:lower_descent, la:lower_ascent, ud:upper_descent
24617
24618 ascent = - (D - H/2 - h/2 + 1); "+ 1" for rounding up
24619 descent = D - H/2 + h/2;
24620 lower_yoff = descent - 2 - ld;
24621 upper_yoff = lower_yoff - la - 1 - ud; */
24622 ascent = - (it->descent - (base_height + height + 1) / 2);
24623 descent = it->descent - (base_height - height) / 2;
24624 lower_yoff = descent - 2 - metrics_lower.descent;
24625 upper_yoff = (lower_yoff - metrics_lower.ascent - 1
24626 - metrics_upper.descent);
24627 /* Don't make the height shorter than the base height. */
24628 if (height > base_height)
24629 {
24630 it->ascent = ascent;
24631 it->descent = descent;
24632 }
24633 }
24634
24635 it->phys_ascent = it->ascent;
24636 it->phys_descent = it->descent;
24637 if (it->glyph_row)
24638 append_glyphless_glyph (it, face_id, for_no_font, len,
24639 upper_xoff, upper_yoff,
24640 lower_xoff, lower_yoff);
24641 it->nglyphs = 1;
24642 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
24643 }
24644
24645
24646 /* RIF:
24647 Produce glyphs/get display metrics for the display element IT is
24648 loaded with. See the description of struct it in dispextern.h
24649 for an overview of struct it. */
24650
24651 void
24652 x_produce_glyphs (struct it *it)
24653 {
24654 int extra_line_spacing = it->extra_line_spacing;
24655
24656 it->glyph_not_available_p = 0;
24657
24658 if (it->what == IT_CHARACTER)
24659 {
24660 XChar2b char2b;
24661 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
24662 struct font *font = face->font;
24663 struct font_metrics *pcm = NULL;
24664 int boff; /* baseline offset */
24665
24666 if (font == NULL)
24667 {
24668 /* When no suitable font is found, display this character by
24669 the method specified in the first extra slot of
24670 Vglyphless_char_display. */
24671 Lisp_Object acronym = lookup_glyphless_char_display (-1, it);
24672
24673 eassert (it->what == IT_GLYPHLESS);
24674 produce_glyphless_glyph (it, 1, STRINGP (acronym) ? acronym : Qnil);
24675 goto done;
24676 }
24677
24678 boff = font->baseline_offset;
24679 if (font->vertical_centering)
24680 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, it->f) - boff;
24681
24682 if (it->char_to_display != '\n' && it->char_to_display != '\t')
24683 {
24684 int stretched_p;
24685
24686 it->nglyphs = 1;
24687
24688 if (it->override_ascent >= 0)
24689 {
24690 it->ascent = it->override_ascent;
24691 it->descent = it->override_descent;
24692 boff = it->override_boff;
24693 }
24694 else
24695 {
24696 it->ascent = FONT_BASE (font) + boff;
24697 it->descent = FONT_DESCENT (font) - boff;
24698 }
24699
24700 if (get_char_glyph_code (it->char_to_display, font, &char2b))
24701 {
24702 pcm = get_per_char_metric (font, &char2b);
24703 if (pcm->width == 0
24704 && pcm->rbearing == 0 && pcm->lbearing == 0)
24705 pcm = NULL;
24706 }
24707
24708 if (pcm)
24709 {
24710 it->phys_ascent = pcm->ascent + boff;
24711 it->phys_descent = pcm->descent - boff;
24712 it->pixel_width = pcm->width;
24713 }
24714 else
24715 {
24716 it->glyph_not_available_p = 1;
24717 it->phys_ascent = it->ascent;
24718 it->phys_descent = it->descent;
24719 it->pixel_width = font->space_width;
24720 }
24721
24722 if (it->constrain_row_ascent_descent_p)
24723 {
24724 if (it->descent > it->max_descent)
24725 {
24726 it->ascent += it->descent - it->max_descent;
24727 it->descent = it->max_descent;
24728 }
24729 if (it->ascent > it->max_ascent)
24730 {
24731 it->descent = min (it->max_descent, it->descent + it->ascent - it->max_ascent);
24732 it->ascent = it->max_ascent;
24733 }
24734 it->phys_ascent = min (it->phys_ascent, it->ascent);
24735 it->phys_descent = min (it->phys_descent, it->descent);
24736 extra_line_spacing = 0;
24737 }
24738
24739 /* If this is a space inside a region of text with
24740 `space-width' property, change its width. */
24741 stretched_p = it->char_to_display == ' ' && !NILP (it->space_width);
24742 if (stretched_p)
24743 it->pixel_width *= XFLOATINT (it->space_width);
24744
24745 /* If face has a box, add the box thickness to the character
24746 height. If character has a box line to the left and/or
24747 right, add the box line width to the character's width. */
24748 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
24749 {
24750 int thick = face->box_line_width;
24751
24752 if (thick > 0)
24753 {
24754 it->ascent += thick;
24755 it->descent += thick;
24756 }
24757 else
24758 thick = -thick;
24759
24760 if (it->start_of_box_run_p)
24761 it->pixel_width += thick;
24762 if (it->end_of_box_run_p)
24763 it->pixel_width += thick;
24764 }
24765
24766 /* If face has an overline, add the height of the overline
24767 (1 pixel) and a 1 pixel margin to the character height. */
24768 if (face->overline_p)
24769 it->ascent += overline_margin;
24770
24771 if (it->constrain_row_ascent_descent_p)
24772 {
24773 if (it->ascent > it->max_ascent)
24774 it->ascent = it->max_ascent;
24775 if (it->descent > it->max_descent)
24776 it->descent = it->max_descent;
24777 }
24778
24779 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
24780
24781 /* If we have to actually produce glyphs, do it. */
24782 if (it->glyph_row)
24783 {
24784 if (stretched_p)
24785 {
24786 /* Translate a space with a `space-width' property
24787 into a stretch glyph. */
24788 int ascent = (((it->ascent + it->descent) * FONT_BASE (font))
24789 / FONT_HEIGHT (font));
24790 append_stretch_glyph (it, it->object, it->pixel_width,
24791 it->ascent + it->descent, ascent);
24792 }
24793 else
24794 append_glyph (it);
24795
24796 /* If characters with lbearing or rbearing are displayed
24797 in this line, record that fact in a flag of the
24798 glyph row. This is used to optimize X output code. */
24799 if (pcm && (pcm->lbearing < 0 || pcm->rbearing > pcm->width))
24800 it->glyph_row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p = 1;
24801 }
24802 if (! stretched_p && it->pixel_width == 0)
24803 /* We assure that all visible glyphs have at least 1-pixel
24804 width. */
24805 it->pixel_width = 1;
24806 }
24807 else if (it->char_to_display == '\n')
24808 {
24809 /* A newline has no width, but we need the height of the
24810 line. But if previous part of the line sets a height,
24811 don't increase that height */
24812
24813 Lisp_Object height;
24814 Lisp_Object total_height = Qnil;
24815
24816 it->override_ascent = -1;
24817 it->pixel_width = 0;
24818 it->nglyphs = 0;
24819
24820 height = get_it_property (it, Qline_height);
24821 /* Split (line-height total-height) list */
24822 if (CONSP (height)
24823 && CONSP (XCDR (height))
24824 && NILP (XCDR (XCDR (height))))
24825 {
24826 total_height = XCAR (XCDR (height));
24827 height = XCAR (height);
24828 }
24829 height = calc_line_height_property (it, height, font, boff, 1);
24830
24831 if (it->override_ascent >= 0)
24832 {
24833 it->ascent = it->override_ascent;
24834 it->descent = it->override_descent;
24835 boff = it->override_boff;
24836 }
24837 else
24838 {
24839 it->ascent = FONT_BASE (font) + boff;
24840 it->descent = FONT_DESCENT (font) - boff;
24841 }
24842
24843 if (EQ (height, Qt))
24844 {
24845 if (it->descent > it->max_descent)
24846 {
24847 it->ascent += it->descent - it->max_descent;
24848 it->descent = it->max_descent;
24849 }
24850 if (it->ascent > it->max_ascent)
24851 {
24852 it->descent = min (it->max_descent, it->descent + it->ascent - it->max_ascent);
24853 it->ascent = it->max_ascent;
24854 }
24855 it->phys_ascent = min (it->phys_ascent, it->ascent);
24856 it->phys_descent = min (it->phys_descent, it->descent);
24857 it->constrain_row_ascent_descent_p = 1;
24858 extra_line_spacing = 0;
24859 }
24860 else
24861 {
24862 Lisp_Object spacing;
24863
24864 it->phys_ascent = it->ascent;
24865 it->phys_descent = it->descent;
24866
24867 if ((it->max_ascent > 0 || it->max_descent > 0)
24868 && face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
24869 && face->box_line_width > 0)
24870 {
24871 it->ascent += face->box_line_width;
24872 it->descent += face->box_line_width;
24873 }
24874 if (!NILP (height)
24875 && XINT (height) > it->ascent + it->descent)
24876 it->ascent = XINT (height) - it->descent;
24877
24878 if (!NILP (total_height))
24879 spacing = calc_line_height_property (it, total_height, font, boff, 0);
24880 else
24881 {
24882 spacing = get_it_property (it, Qline_spacing);
24883 spacing = calc_line_height_property (it, spacing, font, boff, 0);
24884 }
24885 if (INTEGERP (spacing))
24886 {
24887 extra_line_spacing = XINT (spacing);
24888 if (!NILP (total_height))
24889 extra_line_spacing -= (it->phys_ascent + it->phys_descent);
24890 }
24891 }
24892 }
24893 else /* i.e. (it->char_to_display == '\t') */
24894 {
24895 if (font->space_width > 0)
24896 {
24897 int tab_width = it->tab_width * font->space_width;
24898 int x = it->current_x + it->continuation_lines_width;
24899 int next_tab_x = ((1 + x + tab_width - 1) / tab_width) * tab_width;
24900
24901 /* If the distance from the current position to the next tab
24902 stop is less than a space character width, use the
24903 tab stop after that. */
24904 if (next_tab_x - x < font->space_width)
24905 next_tab_x += tab_width;
24906
24907 it->pixel_width = next_tab_x - x;
24908 it->nglyphs = 1;
24909 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = FONT_BASE (font) + boff;
24910 it->descent = it->phys_descent = FONT_DESCENT (font) - boff;
24911
24912 if (it->glyph_row)
24913 {
24914 append_stretch_glyph (it, it->object, it->pixel_width,
24915 it->ascent + it->descent, it->ascent);
24916 }
24917 }
24918 else
24919 {
24920 it->pixel_width = 0;
24921 it->nglyphs = 1;
24922 }
24923 }
24924 }
24925 else if (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION && it->cmp_it.ch < 0)
24926 {
24927 /* A static composition.
24928
24929 Note: A composition is represented as one glyph in the
24930 glyph matrix. There are no padding glyphs.
24931
24932 Important note: pixel_width, ascent, and descent are the
24933 values of what is drawn by draw_glyphs (i.e. the values of
24934 the overall glyphs composed). */
24935 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
24936 int boff; /* baseline offset */
24937 struct composition *cmp = composition_table[it->cmp_it.id];
24938 int glyph_len = cmp->glyph_len;
24939 struct font *font = face->font;
24940
24941 it->nglyphs = 1;
24942
24943 /* If we have not yet calculated pixel size data of glyphs of
24944 the composition for the current face font, calculate them
24945 now. Theoretically, we have to check all fonts for the
24946 glyphs, but that requires much time and memory space. So,
24947 here we check only the font of the first glyph. This may
24948 lead to incorrect display, but it's very rare, and C-l
24949 (recenter-top-bottom) can correct the display anyway. */
24950 if (! cmp->font || cmp->font != font)
24951 {
24952 /* Ascent and descent of the font of the first character
24953 of this composition (adjusted by baseline offset).
24954 Ascent and descent of overall glyphs should not be less
24955 than these, respectively. */
24956 int font_ascent, font_descent, font_height;
24957 /* Bounding box of the overall glyphs. */
24958 int leftmost, rightmost, lowest, highest;
24959 int lbearing, rbearing;
24960 int i, width, ascent, descent;
24961 int left_padded = 0, right_padded = 0;
24962 int c IF_LINT (= 0); /* cmp->glyph_len can't be zero; see Bug#8512 */
24963 XChar2b char2b;
24964 struct font_metrics *pcm;
24965 int font_not_found_p;
24966 ptrdiff_t pos;
24967
24968 for (glyph_len = cmp->glyph_len; glyph_len > 0; glyph_len--)
24969 if ((c = COMPOSITION_GLYPH (cmp, glyph_len - 1)) != '\t')
24970 break;
24971 if (glyph_len < cmp->glyph_len)
24972 right_padded = 1;
24973 for (i = 0; i < glyph_len; i++)
24974 {
24975 if ((c = COMPOSITION_GLYPH (cmp, i)) != '\t')
24976 break;
24977 cmp->offsets[i * 2] = cmp->offsets[i * 2 + 1] = 0;
24978 }
24979 if (i > 0)
24980 left_padded = 1;
24981
24982 pos = (STRINGP (it->string) ? IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it)
24983 : IT_CHARPOS (*it));
24984 /* If no suitable font is found, use the default font. */
24985 font_not_found_p = font == NULL;
24986 if (font_not_found_p)
24987 {
24988 face = face->ascii_face;
24989 font = face->font;
24990 }
24991 boff = font->baseline_offset;
24992 if (font->vertical_centering)
24993 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, it->f) - boff;
24994 font_ascent = FONT_BASE (font) + boff;
24995 font_descent = FONT_DESCENT (font) - boff;
24996 font_height = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
24997
24998 cmp->font = font;
24999
25000 pcm = NULL;
25001 if (! font_not_found_p)
25002 {
25003 get_char_face_and_encoding (it->f, c, it->face_id,
25004 &char2b, 0);
25005 pcm = get_per_char_metric (font, &char2b);
25006 }
25007
25008 /* Initialize the bounding box. */
25009 if (pcm)
25010 {
25011 width = cmp->glyph_len > 0 ? pcm->width : 0;
25012 ascent = pcm->ascent;
25013 descent = pcm->descent;
25014 lbearing = pcm->lbearing;
25015 rbearing = pcm->rbearing;
25016 }
25017 else
25018 {
25019 width = cmp->glyph_len > 0 ? font->space_width : 0;
25020 ascent = FONT_BASE (font);
25021 descent = FONT_DESCENT (font);
25022 lbearing = 0;
25023 rbearing = width;
25024 }
25025
25026 rightmost = width;
25027 leftmost = 0;
25028 lowest = - descent + boff;
25029 highest = ascent + boff;
25030
25031 if (! font_not_found_p
25032 && font->default_ascent
25033 && CHAR_TABLE_P (Vuse_default_ascent)
25034 && !NILP (Faref (Vuse_default_ascent,
25035 make_number (it->char_to_display))))
25036 highest = font->default_ascent + boff;
25037
25038 /* Draw the first glyph at the normal position. It may be
25039 shifted to right later if some other glyphs are drawn
25040 at the left. */
25041 cmp->offsets[i * 2] = 0;
25042 cmp->offsets[i * 2 + 1] = boff;
25043 cmp->lbearing = lbearing;
25044 cmp->rbearing = rbearing;
25045
25046 /* Set cmp->offsets for the remaining glyphs. */
25047 for (i++; i < glyph_len; i++)
25048 {
25049 int left, right, btm, top;
25050 int ch = COMPOSITION_GLYPH (cmp, i);
25051 int face_id;
25052 struct face *this_face;
25053
25054 if (ch == '\t')
25055 ch = ' ';
25056 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (it->f, face, ch, pos, it->string);
25057 this_face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, face_id);
25058 font = this_face->font;
25059
25060 if (font == NULL)
25061 pcm = NULL;
25062 else
25063 {
25064 get_char_face_and_encoding (it->f, ch, face_id,
25065 &char2b, 0);
25066 pcm = get_per_char_metric (font, &char2b);
25067 }
25068 if (! pcm)
25069 cmp->offsets[i * 2] = cmp->offsets[i * 2 + 1] = 0;
25070 else
25071 {
25072 width = pcm->width;
25073 ascent = pcm->ascent;
25074 descent = pcm->descent;
25075 lbearing = pcm->lbearing;
25076 rbearing = pcm->rbearing;
25077 if (cmp->method != COMPOSITION_WITH_RULE_ALTCHARS)
25078 {
25079 /* Relative composition with or without
25080 alternate chars. */
25081 left = (leftmost + rightmost - width) / 2;
25082 btm = - descent + boff;
25083 if (font->relative_compose
25084 && (! CHAR_TABLE_P (Vignore_relative_composition)
25085 || NILP (Faref (Vignore_relative_composition,
25086 make_number (ch)))))
25087 {
25088
25089 if (- descent >= font->relative_compose)
25090 /* One extra pixel between two glyphs. */
25091 btm = highest + 1;
25092 else if (ascent <= 0)
25093 /* One extra pixel between two glyphs. */
25094 btm = lowest - 1 - ascent - descent;
25095 }
25096 }
25097 else
25098 {
25099 /* A composition rule is specified by an integer
25100 value that encodes global and new reference
25101 points (GREF and NREF). GREF and NREF are
25102 specified by numbers as below:
25103
25104 0---1---2 -- ascent
25105 | |
25106 | |
25107 | |
25108 9--10--11 -- center
25109 | |
25110 ---3---4---5--- baseline
25111 | |
25112 6---7---8 -- descent
25113 */
25114 int rule = COMPOSITION_RULE (cmp, i);
25115 int gref, nref, grefx, grefy, nrefx, nrefy, xoff, yoff;
25116
25117 COMPOSITION_DECODE_RULE (rule, gref, nref, xoff, yoff);
25118 grefx = gref % 3, nrefx = nref % 3;
25119 grefy = gref / 3, nrefy = nref / 3;
25120 if (xoff)
25121 xoff = font_height * (xoff - 128) / 256;
25122 if (yoff)
25123 yoff = font_height * (yoff - 128) / 256;
25124
25125 left = (leftmost
25126 + grefx * (rightmost - leftmost) / 2
25127 - nrefx * width / 2
25128 + xoff);
25129
25130 btm = ((grefy == 0 ? highest
25131 : grefy == 1 ? 0
25132 : grefy == 2 ? lowest
25133 : (highest + lowest) / 2)
25134 - (nrefy == 0 ? ascent + descent
25135 : nrefy == 1 ? descent - boff
25136 : nrefy == 2 ? 0
25137 : (ascent + descent) / 2)
25138 + yoff);
25139 }
25140
25141 cmp->offsets[i * 2] = left;
25142 cmp->offsets[i * 2 + 1] = btm + descent;
25143
25144 /* Update the bounding box of the overall glyphs. */
25145 if (width > 0)
25146 {
25147 right = left + width;
25148 if (left < leftmost)
25149 leftmost = left;
25150 if (right > rightmost)
25151 rightmost = right;
25152 }
25153 top = btm + descent + ascent;
25154 if (top > highest)
25155 highest = top;
25156 if (btm < lowest)
25157 lowest = btm;
25158
25159 if (cmp->lbearing > left + lbearing)
25160 cmp->lbearing = left + lbearing;
25161 if (cmp->rbearing < left + rbearing)
25162 cmp->rbearing = left + rbearing;
25163 }
25164 }
25165
25166 /* If there are glyphs whose x-offsets are negative,
25167 shift all glyphs to the right and make all x-offsets
25168 non-negative. */
25169 if (leftmost < 0)
25170 {
25171 for (i = 0; i < cmp->glyph_len; i++)
25172 cmp->offsets[i * 2] -= leftmost;
25173 rightmost -= leftmost;
25174 cmp->lbearing -= leftmost;
25175 cmp->rbearing -= leftmost;
25176 }
25177
25178 if (left_padded && cmp->lbearing < 0)
25179 {
25180 for (i = 0; i < cmp->glyph_len; i++)
25181 cmp->offsets[i * 2] -= cmp->lbearing;
25182 rightmost -= cmp->lbearing;
25183 cmp->rbearing -= cmp->lbearing;
25184 cmp->lbearing = 0;
25185 }
25186 if (right_padded && rightmost < cmp->rbearing)
25187 {
25188 rightmost = cmp->rbearing;
25189 }
25190
25191 cmp->pixel_width = rightmost;
25192 cmp->ascent = highest;
25193 cmp->descent = - lowest;
25194 if (cmp->ascent < font_ascent)
25195 cmp->ascent = font_ascent;
25196 if (cmp->descent < font_descent)
25197 cmp->descent = font_descent;
25198 }
25199
25200 if (it->glyph_row
25201 && (cmp->lbearing < 0
25202 || cmp->rbearing > cmp->pixel_width))
25203 it->glyph_row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p = 1;
25204
25205 it->pixel_width = cmp->pixel_width;
25206 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = cmp->ascent;
25207 it->descent = it->phys_descent = cmp->descent;
25208 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
25209 {
25210 int thick = face->box_line_width;
25211
25212 if (thick > 0)
25213 {
25214 it->ascent += thick;
25215 it->descent += thick;
25216 }
25217 else
25218 thick = - thick;
25219
25220 if (it->start_of_box_run_p)
25221 it->pixel_width += thick;
25222 if (it->end_of_box_run_p)
25223 it->pixel_width += thick;
25224 }
25225
25226 /* If face has an overline, add the height of the overline
25227 (1 pixel) and a 1 pixel margin to the character height. */
25228 if (face->overline_p)
25229 it->ascent += overline_margin;
25230
25231 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
25232 if (it->ascent < 0)
25233 it->ascent = 0;
25234 if (it->descent < 0)
25235 it->descent = 0;
25236
25237 if (it->glyph_row && cmp->glyph_len > 0)
25238 append_composite_glyph (it);
25239 }
25240 else if (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION)
25241 {
25242 /* A dynamic (automatic) composition. */
25243 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
25244 Lisp_Object gstring;
25245 struct font_metrics metrics;
25246
25247 it->nglyphs = 1;
25248
25249 gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (it->cmp_it.id);
25250 it->pixel_width
25251 = composition_gstring_width (gstring, it->cmp_it.from, it->cmp_it.to,
25252 &metrics);
25253 if (it->glyph_row
25254 && (metrics.lbearing < 0 || metrics.rbearing > metrics.width))
25255 it->glyph_row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p = 1;
25256 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = metrics.ascent;
25257 it->descent = it->phys_descent = metrics.descent;
25258 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
25259 {
25260 int thick = face->box_line_width;
25261
25262 if (thick > 0)
25263 {
25264 it->ascent += thick;
25265 it->descent += thick;
25266 }
25267 else
25268 thick = - thick;
25269
25270 if (it->start_of_box_run_p)
25271 it->pixel_width += thick;
25272 if (it->end_of_box_run_p)
25273 it->pixel_width += thick;
25274 }
25275 /* If face has an overline, add the height of the overline
25276 (1 pixel) and a 1 pixel margin to the character height. */
25277 if (face->overline_p)
25278 it->ascent += overline_margin;
25279 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
25280 if (it->ascent < 0)
25281 it->ascent = 0;
25282 if (it->descent < 0)
25283 it->descent = 0;
25284
25285 if (it->glyph_row)
25286 append_composite_glyph (it);
25287 }
25288 else if (it->what == IT_GLYPHLESS)
25289 produce_glyphless_glyph (it, 0, Qnil);
25290 else if (it->what == IT_IMAGE)
25291 produce_image_glyph (it);
25292 else if (it->what == IT_STRETCH)
25293 produce_stretch_glyph (it);
25294
25295 done:
25296 /* Accumulate dimensions. Note: can't assume that it->descent > 0
25297 because this isn't true for images with `:ascent 100'. */
25298 eassert (it->ascent >= 0 && it->descent >= 0);
25299 if (it->area == TEXT_AREA)
25300 it->current_x += it->pixel_width;
25301
25302 if (extra_line_spacing > 0)
25303 {
25304 it->descent += extra_line_spacing;
25305 if (extra_line_spacing > it->max_extra_line_spacing)
25306 it->max_extra_line_spacing = extra_line_spacing;
25307 }
25308
25309 it->max_ascent = max (it->max_ascent, it->ascent);
25310 it->max_descent = max (it->max_descent, it->descent);
25311 it->max_phys_ascent = max (it->max_phys_ascent, it->phys_ascent);
25312 it->max_phys_descent = max (it->max_phys_descent, it->phys_descent);
25313 }
25314
25315 /* EXPORT for RIF:
25316 Output LEN glyphs starting at START at the nominal cursor position.
25317 Advance the nominal cursor over the text. The global variable
25318 updated_window contains the window being updated, updated_row is
25319 the glyph row being updated, and updated_area is the area of that
25320 row being updated. */
25321
25322 void
25323 x_write_glyphs (struct glyph *start, int len)
25324 {
25325 int x, hpos, chpos = updated_window->phys_cursor.hpos;
25326
25327 eassert (updated_window && updated_row);
25328 /* When the window is hscrolled, cursor hpos can legitimately be out
25329 of bounds, but we draw the cursor at the corresponding window
25330 margin in that case. */
25331 if (!updated_row->reversed_p && chpos < 0)
25332 chpos = 0;
25333 if (updated_row->reversed_p && chpos >= updated_row->used[TEXT_AREA])
25334 chpos = updated_row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
25335
25336 BLOCK_INPUT;
25337
25338 /* Write glyphs. */
25339
25340 hpos = start - updated_row->glyphs[updated_area];
25341 x = draw_glyphs (updated_window, output_cursor.x,
25342 updated_row, updated_area,
25343 hpos, hpos + len,
25344 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, 0);
25345
25346 /* Invalidate old phys cursor if the glyph at its hpos is redrawn. */
25347 if (updated_area == TEXT_AREA
25348 && updated_window->phys_cursor_on_p
25349 && updated_window->phys_cursor.vpos == output_cursor.vpos
25350 && chpos >= hpos
25351 && chpos < hpos + len)
25352 updated_window->phys_cursor_on_p = 0;
25353
25354 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
25355
25356 /* Advance the output cursor. */
25357 output_cursor.hpos += len;
25358 output_cursor.x = x;
25359 }
25360
25361
25362 /* EXPORT for RIF:
25363 Insert LEN glyphs from START at the nominal cursor position. */
25364
25365 void
25366 x_insert_glyphs (struct glyph *start, int len)
25367 {
25368 struct frame *f;
25369 struct window *w;
25370 int line_height, shift_by_width, shifted_region_width;
25371 struct glyph_row *row;
25372 struct glyph *glyph;
25373 int frame_x, frame_y;
25374 ptrdiff_t hpos;
25375
25376 eassert (updated_window && updated_row);
25377 BLOCK_INPUT;
25378 w = updated_window;
25379 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
25380
25381 /* Get the height of the line we are in. */
25382 row = updated_row;
25383 line_height = row->height;
25384
25385 /* Get the width of the glyphs to insert. */
25386 shift_by_width = 0;
25387 for (glyph = start; glyph < start + len; ++glyph)
25388 shift_by_width += glyph->pixel_width;
25389
25390 /* Get the width of the region to shift right. */
25391 shifted_region_width = (window_box_width (w, updated_area)
25392 - output_cursor.x
25393 - shift_by_width);
25394
25395 /* Shift right. */
25396 frame_x = window_box_left (w, updated_area) + output_cursor.x;
25397 frame_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, output_cursor.y);
25398
25399 FRAME_RIF (f)->shift_glyphs_for_insert (f, frame_x, frame_y, shifted_region_width,
25400 line_height, shift_by_width);
25401
25402 /* Write the glyphs. */
25403 hpos = start - row->glyphs[updated_area];
25404 draw_glyphs (w, output_cursor.x, row, updated_area,
25405 hpos, hpos + len,
25406 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, 0);
25407
25408 /* Advance the output cursor. */
25409 output_cursor.hpos += len;
25410 output_cursor.x += shift_by_width;
25411 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
25412 }
25413
25414
25415 /* EXPORT for RIF:
25416 Erase the current text line from the nominal cursor position
25417 (inclusive) to pixel column TO_X (exclusive). The idea is that
25418 everything from TO_X onward is already erased.
25419
25420 TO_X is a pixel position relative to updated_area of
25421 updated_window. TO_X == -1 means clear to the end of this area. */
25422
25423 void
25424 x_clear_end_of_line (int to_x)
25425 {
25426 struct frame *f;
25427 struct window *w = updated_window;
25428 int max_x, min_y, max_y;
25429 int from_x, from_y, to_y;
25430
25431 eassert (updated_window && updated_row);
25432 f = XFRAME (w->frame);
25433
25434 if (updated_row->full_width_p)
25435 max_x = WINDOW_TOTAL_WIDTH (w);
25436 else
25437 max_x = window_box_width (w, updated_area);
25438 max_y = window_text_bottom_y (w);
25439
25440 /* TO_X == 0 means don't do anything. TO_X < 0 means clear to end
25441 of window. For TO_X > 0, truncate to end of drawing area. */
25442 if (to_x == 0)
25443 return;
25444 else if (to_x < 0)
25445 to_x = max_x;
25446 else
25447 to_x = min (to_x, max_x);
25448
25449 to_y = min (max_y, output_cursor.y + updated_row->height);
25450
25451 /* Notice if the cursor will be cleared by this operation. */
25452 if (!updated_row->full_width_p)
25453 notice_overwritten_cursor (w, updated_area,
25454 output_cursor.x, -1,
25455 updated_row->y,
25456 MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (updated_row));
25457
25458 from_x = output_cursor.x;
25459
25460 /* Translate to frame coordinates. */
25461 if (updated_row->full_width_p)
25462 {
25463 from_x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, from_x);
25464 to_x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, to_x);
25465 }
25466 else
25467 {
25468 int area_left = window_box_left (w, updated_area);
25469 from_x += area_left;
25470 to_x += area_left;
25471 }
25472
25473 min_y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
25474 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (min_y, output_cursor.y));
25475 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, to_y);
25476
25477 /* Prevent inadvertently clearing to end of the X window. */
25478 if (to_x > from_x && to_y > from_y)
25479 {
25480 BLOCK_INPUT;
25481 FRAME_RIF (f)->clear_frame_area (f, from_x, from_y,
25482 to_x - from_x, to_y - from_y);
25483 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
25484 }
25485 }
25486
25487 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
25488
25489
25490 \f
25491 /***********************************************************************
25492 Cursor types
25493 ***********************************************************************/
25494
25495 /* Value is the internal representation of the specified cursor type
25496 ARG. If type is BAR_CURSOR, return in *WIDTH the specified width
25497 of the bar cursor. */
25498
25499 static enum text_cursor_kinds
25500 get_specified_cursor_type (Lisp_Object arg, int *width)
25501 {
25502 enum text_cursor_kinds type;
25503
25504 if (NILP (arg))
25505 return NO_CURSOR;
25506
25507 if (EQ (arg, Qbox))
25508 return FILLED_BOX_CURSOR;
25509
25510 if (EQ (arg, Qhollow))
25511 return HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR;
25512
25513 if (EQ (arg, Qbar))
25514 {
25515 *width = 2;
25516 return BAR_CURSOR;
25517 }
25518
25519 if (CONSP (arg)
25520 && EQ (XCAR (arg), Qbar)
25521 && RANGED_INTEGERP (0, XCDR (arg), INT_MAX))
25522 {
25523 *width = XINT (XCDR (arg));
25524 return BAR_CURSOR;
25525 }
25526
25527 if (EQ (arg, Qhbar))
25528 {
25529 *width = 2;
25530 return HBAR_CURSOR;
25531 }
25532
25533 if (CONSP (arg)
25534 && EQ (XCAR (arg), Qhbar)
25535 && RANGED_INTEGERP (0, XCDR (arg), INT_MAX))
25536 {
25537 *width = XINT (XCDR (arg));
25538 return HBAR_CURSOR;
25539 }
25540
25541 /* Treat anything unknown as "hollow box cursor".
25542 It was bad to signal an error; people have trouble fixing
25543 .Xdefaults with Emacs, when it has something bad in it. */
25544 type = HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR;
25545
25546 return type;
25547 }
25548
25549 /* Set the default cursor types for specified frame. */
25550 void
25551 set_frame_cursor_types (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object arg)
25552 {
25553 int width = 1;
25554 Lisp_Object tem;
25555
25556 FRAME_DESIRED_CURSOR (f) = get_specified_cursor_type (arg, &width);
25557 FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f) = width;
25558
25559 /* By default, set up the blink-off state depending on the on-state. */
25560
25561 tem = Fassoc (arg, Vblink_cursor_alist);
25562 if (!NILP (tem))
25563 {
25564 FRAME_BLINK_OFF_CURSOR (f)
25565 = get_specified_cursor_type (XCDR (tem), &width);
25566 FRAME_BLINK_OFF_CURSOR_WIDTH (f) = width;
25567 }
25568 else
25569 FRAME_BLINK_OFF_CURSOR (f) = DEFAULT_CURSOR;
25570 }
25571
25572
25573 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
25574
25575 /* Return the cursor we want to be displayed in window W. Return
25576 width of bar/hbar cursor through WIDTH arg. Return with
25577 ACTIVE_CURSOR arg set to 1 if cursor in window W is `active'
25578 (i.e. if the `system caret' should track this cursor).
25579
25580 In a mini-buffer window, we want the cursor only to appear if we
25581 are reading input from this window. For the selected window, we
25582 want the cursor type given by the frame parameter or buffer local
25583 setting of cursor-type. If explicitly marked off, draw no cursor.
25584 In all other cases, we want a hollow box cursor. */
25585
25586 static enum text_cursor_kinds
25587 get_window_cursor_type (struct window *w, struct glyph *glyph, int *width,
25588 int *active_cursor)
25589 {
25590 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
25591 struct buffer *b = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
25592 int cursor_type = DEFAULT_CURSOR;
25593 Lisp_Object alt_cursor;
25594 int non_selected = 0;
25595
25596 *active_cursor = 1;
25597
25598 /* Echo area */
25599 if (cursor_in_echo_area
25600 && FRAME_HAS_MINIBUF_P (f)
25601 && EQ (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (f), echo_area_window))
25602 {
25603 if (w == XWINDOW (echo_area_window))
25604 {
25605 if (EQ (BVAR (b, cursor_type), Qt) || NILP (BVAR (b, cursor_type)))
25606 {
25607 *width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
25608 return FRAME_DESIRED_CURSOR (f);
25609 }
25610 else
25611 return get_specified_cursor_type (BVAR (b, cursor_type), width);
25612 }
25613
25614 *active_cursor = 0;
25615 non_selected = 1;
25616 }
25617
25618 /* Detect a nonselected window or nonselected frame. */
25619 else if (w != XWINDOW (f->selected_window)
25620 || f != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame)
25621 {
25622 *active_cursor = 0;
25623
25624 if (MINI_WINDOW_P (w) && minibuf_level == 0)
25625 return NO_CURSOR;
25626
25627 non_selected = 1;
25628 }
25629
25630 /* Never display a cursor in a window in which cursor-type is nil. */
25631 if (NILP (BVAR (b, cursor_type)))
25632 return NO_CURSOR;
25633
25634 /* Get the normal cursor type for this window. */
25635 if (EQ (BVAR (b, cursor_type), Qt))
25636 {
25637 cursor_type = FRAME_DESIRED_CURSOR (f);
25638 *width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
25639 }
25640 else
25641 cursor_type = get_specified_cursor_type (BVAR (b, cursor_type), width);
25642
25643 /* Use cursor-in-non-selected-windows instead
25644 for non-selected window or frame. */
25645 if (non_selected)
25646 {
25647 alt_cursor = BVAR (b, cursor_in_non_selected_windows);
25648 if (!EQ (Qt, alt_cursor))
25649 return get_specified_cursor_type (alt_cursor, width);
25650 /* t means modify the normal cursor type. */
25651 if (cursor_type == FILLED_BOX_CURSOR)
25652 cursor_type = HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR;
25653 else if (cursor_type == BAR_CURSOR && *width > 1)
25654 --*width;
25655 return cursor_type;
25656 }
25657
25658 /* Use normal cursor if not blinked off. */
25659 if (!w->cursor_off_p)
25660 {
25661 if (glyph != NULL && glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
25662 {
25663 if (cursor_type == FILLED_BOX_CURSOR)
25664 {
25665 /* Using a block cursor on large images can be very annoying.
25666 So use a hollow cursor for "large" images.
25667 If image is not transparent (no mask), also use hollow cursor. */
25668 struct image *img = IMAGE_FROM_ID (f, glyph->u.img_id);
25669 if (img != NULL && IMAGEP (img->spec))
25670 {
25671 /* Arbitrarily, interpret "Large" as >32x32 and >NxN
25672 where N = size of default frame font size.
25673 This should cover most of the "tiny" icons people may use. */
25674 if (!img->mask
25675 || img->width > max (32, WINDOW_FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (w))
25676 || img->height > max (32, WINDOW_FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (w)))
25677 cursor_type = HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR;
25678 }
25679 }
25680 else if (cursor_type != NO_CURSOR)
25681 {
25682 /* Display current only supports BOX and HOLLOW cursors for images.
25683 So for now, unconditionally use a HOLLOW cursor when cursor is
25684 not a solid box cursor. */
25685 cursor_type = HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR;
25686 }
25687 }
25688 return cursor_type;
25689 }
25690
25691 /* Cursor is blinked off, so determine how to "toggle" it. */
25692
25693 /* First look for an entry matching the buffer's cursor-type in blink-cursor-alist. */
25694 if ((alt_cursor = Fassoc (BVAR (b, cursor_type), Vblink_cursor_alist), !NILP (alt_cursor)))
25695 return get_specified_cursor_type (XCDR (alt_cursor), width);
25696
25697 /* Then see if frame has specified a specific blink off cursor type. */
25698 if (FRAME_BLINK_OFF_CURSOR (f) != DEFAULT_CURSOR)
25699 {
25700 *width = FRAME_BLINK_OFF_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
25701 return FRAME_BLINK_OFF_CURSOR (f);
25702 }
25703
25704 #if 0
25705 /* Some people liked having a permanently visible blinking cursor,
25706 while others had very strong opinions against it. So it was
25707 decided to remove it. KFS 2003-09-03 */
25708
25709 /* Finally perform built-in cursor blinking:
25710 filled box <-> hollow box
25711 wide [h]bar <-> narrow [h]bar
25712 narrow [h]bar <-> no cursor
25713 other type <-> no cursor */
25714
25715 if (cursor_type == FILLED_BOX_CURSOR)
25716 return HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR;
25717
25718 if ((cursor_type == BAR_CURSOR || cursor_type == HBAR_CURSOR) && *width > 1)
25719 {
25720 *width = 1;
25721 return cursor_type;
25722 }
25723 #endif
25724
25725 return NO_CURSOR;
25726 }
25727
25728
25729 /* Notice when the text cursor of window W has been completely
25730 overwritten by a drawing operation that outputs glyphs in AREA
25731 starting at X0 and ending at X1 in the line starting at Y0 and
25732 ending at Y1. X coordinates are area-relative. X1 < 0 means all
25733 the rest of the line after X0 has been written. Y coordinates
25734 are window-relative. */
25735
25736 static void
25737 notice_overwritten_cursor (struct window *w, enum glyph_row_area area,
25738 int x0, int x1, int y0, int y1)
25739 {
25740 int cx0, cx1, cy0, cy1;
25741 struct glyph_row *row;
25742
25743 if (!w->phys_cursor_on_p)
25744 return;
25745 if (area != TEXT_AREA)
25746 return;
25747
25748 if (w->phys_cursor.vpos < 0
25749 || w->phys_cursor.vpos >= w->current_matrix->nrows
25750 || (row = w->current_matrix->rows + w->phys_cursor.vpos,
25751 !(row->enabled_p && row->displays_text_p)))
25752 return;
25753
25754 if (row->cursor_in_fringe_p)
25755 {
25756 row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 0;
25757 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, row, row->reversed_p);
25758 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 0;
25759 return;
25760 }
25761
25762 cx0 = w->phys_cursor.x;
25763 cx1 = cx0 + w->phys_cursor_width;
25764 if (x0 > cx0 || (x1 >= 0 && x1 < cx1))
25765 return;
25766
25767 /* The cursor image will be completely removed from the
25768 screen if the output area intersects the cursor area in
25769 y-direction. When we draw in [y0 y1[, and some part of
25770 the cursor is at y < y0, that part must have been drawn
25771 before. When scrolling, the cursor is erased before
25772 actually scrolling, so we don't come here. When not
25773 scrolling, the rows above the old cursor row must have
25774 changed, and in this case these rows must have written
25775 over the cursor image.
25776
25777 Likewise if part of the cursor is below y1, with the
25778 exception of the cursor being in the first blank row at
25779 the buffer and window end because update_text_area
25780 doesn't draw that row. (Except when it does, but
25781 that's handled in update_text_area.) */
25782
25783 cy0 = w->phys_cursor.y;
25784 cy1 = cy0 + w->phys_cursor_height;
25785 if ((y0 < cy0 || y0 >= cy1) && (y1 <= cy0 || y1 >= cy1))
25786 return;
25787
25788 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 0;
25789 }
25790
25791 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
25792
25793 \f
25794 /************************************************************************
25795 Mouse Face
25796 ************************************************************************/
25797
25798 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
25799
25800 /* EXPORT for RIF:
25801 Fix the display of area AREA of overlapping row ROW in window W
25802 with respect to the overlapping part OVERLAPS. */
25803
25804 void
25805 x_fix_overlapping_area (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row,
25806 enum glyph_row_area area, int overlaps)
25807 {
25808 int i, x;
25809
25810 BLOCK_INPUT;
25811
25812 x = 0;
25813 for (i = 0; i < row->used[area];)
25814 {
25815 if (row->glyphs[area][i].overlaps_vertically_p)
25816 {
25817 int start = i, start_x = x;
25818
25819 do
25820 {
25821 x += row->glyphs[area][i].pixel_width;
25822 ++i;
25823 }
25824 while (i < row->used[area]
25825 && row->glyphs[area][i].overlaps_vertically_p);
25826
25827 draw_glyphs (w, start_x, row, area,
25828 start, i,
25829 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, overlaps);
25830 }
25831 else
25832 {
25833 x += row->glyphs[area][i].pixel_width;
25834 ++i;
25835 }
25836 }
25837
25838 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
25839 }
25840
25841
25842 /* EXPORT:
25843 Draw the cursor glyph of window W in glyph row ROW. See the
25844 comment of draw_glyphs for the meaning of HL. */
25845
25846 void
25847 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row,
25848 enum draw_glyphs_face hl)
25849 {
25850 /* If cursor hpos is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can
25851 happen in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area
25852 glyphs and mini-buffer. */
25853 if ((row->reversed_p
25854 ? (w->phys_cursor.hpos >= 0)
25855 : (w->phys_cursor.hpos < row->used[TEXT_AREA])))
25856 {
25857 int on_p = w->phys_cursor_on_p;
25858 int x1;
25859 int hpos = w->phys_cursor.hpos;
25860
25861 /* When the window is hscrolled, cursor hpos can legitimately be
25862 out of bounds, but we draw the cursor at the corresponding
25863 window margin in that case. */
25864 if (!row->reversed_p && hpos < 0)
25865 hpos = 0;
25866 if (row->reversed_p && hpos >= row->used[TEXT_AREA])
25867 hpos = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
25868
25869 x1 = draw_glyphs (w, w->phys_cursor.x, row, TEXT_AREA, hpos, hpos + 1,
25870 hl, 0);
25871 w->phys_cursor_on_p = on_p;
25872
25873 if (hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
25874 w->phys_cursor_width = x1 - w->phys_cursor.x;
25875 /* When we erase the cursor, and ROW is overlapped by other
25876 rows, make sure that these overlapping parts of other rows
25877 are redrawn. */
25878 else if (hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT && row->overlapped_p)
25879 {
25880 w->phys_cursor_width = x1 - w->phys_cursor.x;
25881
25882 if (row > w->current_matrix->rows
25883 && MATRIX_ROW_OVERLAPS_SUCC_P (row - 1))
25884 x_fix_overlapping_area (w, row - 1, TEXT_AREA,
25885 OVERLAPS_ERASED_CURSOR);
25886
25887 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < window_text_bottom_y (w)
25888 && MATRIX_ROW_OVERLAPS_PRED_P (row + 1))
25889 x_fix_overlapping_area (w, row + 1, TEXT_AREA,
25890 OVERLAPS_ERASED_CURSOR);
25891 }
25892 }
25893 }
25894
25895
25896 /* EXPORT:
25897 Erase the image of a cursor of window W from the screen. */
25898
25899 void
25900 erase_phys_cursor (struct window *w)
25901 {
25902 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
25903 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
25904 int hpos = w->phys_cursor.hpos;
25905 int vpos = w->phys_cursor.vpos;
25906 int mouse_face_here_p = 0;
25907 struct glyph_matrix *active_glyphs = w->current_matrix;
25908 struct glyph_row *cursor_row;
25909 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
25910 enum draw_glyphs_face hl;
25911
25912 /* No cursor displayed or row invalidated => nothing to do on the
25913 screen. */
25914 if (w->phys_cursor_type == NO_CURSOR)
25915 goto mark_cursor_off;
25916
25917 /* VPOS >= active_glyphs->nrows means that window has been resized.
25918 Don't bother to erase the cursor. */
25919 if (vpos >= active_glyphs->nrows)
25920 goto mark_cursor_off;
25921
25922 /* If row containing cursor is marked invalid, there is nothing we
25923 can do. */
25924 cursor_row = MATRIX_ROW (active_glyphs, vpos);
25925 if (!cursor_row->enabled_p)
25926 goto mark_cursor_off;
25927
25928 /* If line spacing is > 0, old cursor may only be partially visible in
25929 window after split-window. So adjust visible height. */
25930 cursor_row->visible_height = min (cursor_row->visible_height,
25931 window_text_bottom_y (w) - cursor_row->y);
25932
25933 /* If row is completely invisible, don't attempt to delete a cursor which
25934 isn't there. This can happen if cursor is at top of a window, and
25935 we switch to a buffer with a header line in that window. */
25936 if (cursor_row->visible_height <= 0)
25937 goto mark_cursor_off;
25938
25939 /* If cursor is in the fringe, erase by drawing actual bitmap there. */
25940 if (cursor_row->cursor_in_fringe_p)
25941 {
25942 cursor_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 0;
25943 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, cursor_row, cursor_row->reversed_p);
25944 goto mark_cursor_off;
25945 }
25946
25947 /* This can happen when the new row is shorter than the old one.
25948 In this case, either draw_glyphs or clear_end_of_line
25949 should have cleared the cursor. Note that we wouldn't be
25950 able to erase the cursor in this case because we don't have a
25951 cursor glyph at hand. */
25952 if ((cursor_row->reversed_p
25953 ? (w->phys_cursor.hpos < 0)
25954 : (w->phys_cursor.hpos >= cursor_row->used[TEXT_AREA])))
25955 goto mark_cursor_off;
25956
25957 /* When the window is hscrolled, cursor hpos can legitimately be out
25958 of bounds, but we draw the cursor at the corresponding window
25959 margin in that case. */
25960 if (!cursor_row->reversed_p && hpos < 0)
25961 hpos = 0;
25962 if (cursor_row->reversed_p && hpos >= cursor_row->used[TEXT_AREA])
25963 hpos = cursor_row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
25964
25965 /* If the cursor is in the mouse face area, redisplay that when
25966 we clear the cursor. */
25967 if (! NILP (hlinfo->mouse_face_window)
25968 && coords_in_mouse_face_p (w, hpos, vpos)
25969 /* Don't redraw the cursor's spot in mouse face if it is at the
25970 end of a line (on a newline). The cursor appears there, but
25971 mouse highlighting does not. */
25972 && cursor_row->used[TEXT_AREA] > hpos && hpos >= 0)
25973 mouse_face_here_p = 1;
25974
25975 /* Maybe clear the display under the cursor. */
25976 if (w->phys_cursor_type == HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR)
25977 {
25978 int x, y, left_x;
25979 int header_line_height = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
25980 int width;
25981
25982 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
25983 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
25984 goto mark_cursor_off;
25985
25986 width = cursor_glyph->pixel_width;
25987 left_x = window_box_left_offset (w, TEXT_AREA);
25988 x = w->phys_cursor.x;
25989 if (x < left_x)
25990 width -= left_x - x;
25991 width = min (width, window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA) - x);
25992 y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height, cursor_row->y));
25993 x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, max (x, left_x));
25994
25995 if (width > 0)
25996 FRAME_RIF (f)->clear_frame_area (f, x, y, width, cursor_row->visible_height);
25997 }
25998
25999 /* Erase the cursor by redrawing the character underneath it. */
26000 if (mouse_face_here_p)
26001 hl = DRAW_MOUSE_FACE;
26002 else
26003 hl = DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT;
26004 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, cursor_row, hl);
26005
26006 mark_cursor_off:
26007 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 0;
26008 w->phys_cursor_type = NO_CURSOR;
26009 }
26010
26011
26012 /* EXPORT:
26013 Display or clear cursor of window W. If ON is zero, clear the
26014 cursor. If it is non-zero, display the cursor. If ON is nonzero,
26015 where to put the cursor is specified by HPOS, VPOS, X and Y. */
26016
26017 void
26018 display_and_set_cursor (struct window *w, int on,
26019 int hpos, int vpos, int x, int y)
26020 {
26021 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
26022 int new_cursor_type;
26023 int new_cursor_width;
26024 int active_cursor;
26025 struct glyph_row *glyph_row;
26026 struct glyph *glyph;
26027
26028 /* This is pointless on invisible frames, and dangerous on garbaged
26029 windows and frames; in the latter case, the frame or window may
26030 be in the midst of changing its size, and x and y may be off the
26031 window. */
26032 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
26033 || FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f)
26034 || vpos >= w->current_matrix->nrows
26035 || hpos >= w->current_matrix->matrix_w)
26036 return;
26037
26038 /* If cursor is off and we want it off, return quickly. */
26039 if (!on && !w->phys_cursor_on_p)
26040 return;
26041
26042 glyph_row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
26043 /* If cursor row is not enabled, we don't really know where to
26044 display the cursor. */
26045 if (!glyph_row->enabled_p)
26046 {
26047 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 0;
26048 return;
26049 }
26050
26051 glyph = NULL;
26052 if (!glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
26053 || (0 <= hpos && hpos < glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA]))
26054 glyph = glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + hpos;
26055
26056 eassert (interrupt_input_blocked);
26057
26058 /* Set new_cursor_type to the cursor we want to be displayed. */
26059 new_cursor_type = get_window_cursor_type (w, glyph,
26060 &new_cursor_width, &active_cursor);
26061
26062 /* If cursor is currently being shown and we don't want it to be or
26063 it is in the wrong place, or the cursor type is not what we want,
26064 erase it. */
26065 if (w->phys_cursor_on_p
26066 && (!on
26067 || w->phys_cursor.x != x
26068 || w->phys_cursor.y != y
26069 || new_cursor_type != w->phys_cursor_type
26070 || ((new_cursor_type == BAR_CURSOR || new_cursor_type == HBAR_CURSOR)
26071 && new_cursor_width != w->phys_cursor_width)))
26072 erase_phys_cursor (w);
26073
26074 /* Don't check phys_cursor_on_p here because that flag is only set
26075 to zero in some cases where we know that the cursor has been
26076 completely erased, to avoid the extra work of erasing the cursor
26077 twice. In other words, phys_cursor_on_p can be 1 and the cursor
26078 still not be visible, or it has only been partly erased. */
26079 if (on)
26080 {
26081 w->phys_cursor_ascent = glyph_row->ascent;
26082 w->phys_cursor_height = glyph_row->height;
26083
26084 /* Set phys_cursor_.* before x_draw_.* is called because some
26085 of them may need the information. */
26086 w->phys_cursor.x = x;
26087 w->phys_cursor.y = glyph_row->y;
26088 w->phys_cursor.hpos = hpos;
26089 w->phys_cursor.vpos = vpos;
26090 }
26091
26092 FRAME_RIF (f)->draw_window_cursor (w, glyph_row, x, y,
26093 new_cursor_type, new_cursor_width,
26094 on, active_cursor);
26095 }
26096
26097
26098 /* Switch the display of W's cursor on or off, according to the value
26099 of ON. */
26100
26101 static void
26102 update_window_cursor (struct window *w, int on)
26103 {
26104 /* Don't update cursor in windows whose frame is in the process
26105 of being deleted. */
26106 if (w->current_matrix)
26107 {
26108 int hpos = w->phys_cursor.hpos;
26109 int vpos = w->phys_cursor.vpos;
26110 struct glyph_row *row;
26111
26112 if (vpos >= w->current_matrix->nrows
26113 || hpos >= w->current_matrix->matrix_w)
26114 return;
26115
26116 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
26117
26118 /* When the window is hscrolled, cursor hpos can legitimately be
26119 out of bounds, but we draw the cursor at the corresponding
26120 window margin in that case. */
26121 if (!row->reversed_p && hpos < 0)
26122 hpos = 0;
26123 if (row->reversed_p && hpos >= row->used[TEXT_AREA])
26124 hpos = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
26125
26126 BLOCK_INPUT;
26127 display_and_set_cursor (w, on, hpos, vpos,
26128 w->phys_cursor.x, w->phys_cursor.y);
26129 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
26130 }
26131 }
26132
26133
26134 /* Call update_window_cursor with parameter ON_P on all leaf windows
26135 in the window tree rooted at W. */
26136
26137 static void
26138 update_cursor_in_window_tree (struct window *w, int on_p)
26139 {
26140 while (w)
26141 {
26142 if (!NILP (w->hchild))
26143 update_cursor_in_window_tree (XWINDOW (w->hchild), on_p);
26144 else if (!NILP (w->vchild))
26145 update_cursor_in_window_tree (XWINDOW (w->vchild), on_p);
26146 else
26147 update_window_cursor (w, on_p);
26148
26149 w = NILP (w->next) ? 0 : XWINDOW (w->next);
26150 }
26151 }
26152
26153
26154 /* EXPORT:
26155 Display the cursor on window W, or clear it, according to ON_P.
26156 Don't change the cursor's position. */
26157
26158 void
26159 x_update_cursor (struct frame *f, int on_p)
26160 {
26161 update_cursor_in_window_tree (XWINDOW (f->root_window), on_p);
26162 }
26163
26164
26165 /* EXPORT:
26166 Clear the cursor of window W to background color, and mark the
26167 cursor as not shown. This is used when the text where the cursor
26168 is about to be rewritten. */
26169
26170 void
26171 x_clear_cursor (struct window *w)
26172 {
26173 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (XFRAME (w->frame)) && w->phys_cursor_on_p)
26174 update_window_cursor (w, 0);
26175 }
26176
26177 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
26178
26179 /* Implementation of draw_row_with_mouse_face for GUI sessions, GPM,
26180 and MSDOS. */
26181 static void
26182 draw_row_with_mouse_face (struct window *w, int start_x, struct glyph_row *row,
26183 int start_hpos, int end_hpos,
26184 enum draw_glyphs_face draw)
26185 {
26186 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
26187 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (XFRAME (w->frame)))
26188 {
26189 draw_glyphs (w, start_x, row, TEXT_AREA, start_hpos, end_hpos, draw, 0);
26190 return;
26191 }
26192 #endif
26193 #if defined (HAVE_GPM) || defined (MSDOS) || defined (WINDOWSNT)
26194 tty_draw_row_with_mouse_face (w, row, start_hpos, end_hpos, draw);
26195 #endif
26196 }
26197
26198 /* Display the active region described by mouse_face_* according to DRAW. */
26199
26200 static void
26201 show_mouse_face (Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo, enum draw_glyphs_face draw)
26202 {
26203 struct window *w = XWINDOW (hlinfo->mouse_face_window);
26204 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
26205
26206 if (/* If window is in the process of being destroyed, don't bother
26207 to do anything. */
26208 w->current_matrix != NULL
26209 /* Don't update mouse highlight if hidden */
26210 && (draw != DRAW_MOUSE_FACE || !hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
26211 /* Recognize when we are called to operate on rows that don't exist
26212 anymore. This can happen when a window is split. */
26213 && hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row < w->current_matrix->nrows)
26214 {
26215 int phys_cursor_on_p = w->phys_cursor_on_p;
26216 struct glyph_row *row, *first, *last;
26217
26218 first = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row);
26219 last = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row);
26220
26221 for (row = first; row <= last && row->enabled_p; ++row)
26222 {
26223 int start_hpos, end_hpos, start_x;
26224
26225 /* For all but the first row, the highlight starts at column 0. */
26226 if (row == first)
26227 {
26228 /* R2L rows have BEG and END in reversed order, but the
26229 screen drawing geometry is always left to right. So
26230 we need to mirror the beginning and end of the
26231 highlighted area in R2L rows. */
26232 if (!row->reversed_p)
26233 {
26234 start_hpos = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col;
26235 start_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x;
26236 }
26237 else if (row == last)
26238 {
26239 start_hpos = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col;
26240 start_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x;
26241 }
26242 else
26243 {
26244 start_hpos = 0;
26245 start_x = 0;
26246 }
26247 }
26248 else if (row->reversed_p && row == last)
26249 {
26250 start_hpos = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col;
26251 start_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x;
26252 }
26253 else
26254 {
26255 start_hpos = 0;
26256 start_x = 0;
26257 }
26258
26259 if (row == last)
26260 {
26261 if (!row->reversed_p)
26262 end_hpos = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col;
26263 else if (row == first)
26264 end_hpos = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col;
26265 else
26266 {
26267 end_hpos = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
26268 if (draw == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
26269 row->fill_line_p = 1; /* Clear to end of line */
26270 }
26271 }
26272 else if (row->reversed_p && row == first)
26273 end_hpos = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col;
26274 else
26275 {
26276 end_hpos = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
26277 if (draw == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
26278 row->fill_line_p = 1; /* Clear to end of line */
26279 }
26280
26281 if (end_hpos > start_hpos)
26282 {
26283 draw_row_with_mouse_face (w, start_x, row,
26284 start_hpos, end_hpos, draw);
26285
26286 row->mouse_face_p
26287 = draw == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE || draw == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
26288 }
26289 }
26290
26291 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
26292 /* When we've written over the cursor, arrange for it to
26293 be displayed again. */
26294 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
26295 && phys_cursor_on_p && !w->phys_cursor_on_p)
26296 {
26297 int hpos = w->phys_cursor.hpos;
26298
26299 /* When the window is hscrolled, cursor hpos can legitimately be
26300 out of bounds, but we draw the cursor at the corresponding
26301 window margin in that case. */
26302 if (!row->reversed_p && hpos < 0)
26303 hpos = 0;
26304 if (row->reversed_p && hpos >= row->used[TEXT_AREA])
26305 hpos = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
26306
26307 BLOCK_INPUT;
26308 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, hpos, w->phys_cursor.vpos,
26309 w->phys_cursor.x, w->phys_cursor.y);
26310 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
26311 }
26312 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
26313 }
26314
26315 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
26316 /* Change the mouse cursor. */
26317 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
26318 {
26319 if (draw == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT
26320 && !EQ (hlinfo->mouse_face_window, f->tool_bar_window))
26321 FRAME_RIF (f)->define_frame_cursor (f, FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->text_cursor);
26322 else if (draw == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
26323 FRAME_RIF (f)->define_frame_cursor (f, FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->hand_cursor);
26324 else
26325 FRAME_RIF (f)->define_frame_cursor (f, FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->nontext_cursor);
26326 }
26327 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
26328 }
26329
26330 /* EXPORT:
26331 Clear out the mouse-highlighted active region.
26332 Redraw it un-highlighted first. Value is non-zero if mouse
26333 face was actually drawn unhighlighted. */
26334
26335 int
26336 clear_mouse_face (Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo)
26337 {
26338 int cleared = 0;
26339
26340 if (!hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden && !NILP (hlinfo->mouse_face_window))
26341 {
26342 show_mouse_face (hlinfo, DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT);
26343 cleared = 1;
26344 }
26345
26346 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
26347 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
26348 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
26349 hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
26350 return cleared;
26351 }
26352
26353 /* Return non-zero if the coordinates HPOS and VPOS on windows W are
26354 within the mouse face on that window. */
26355 static int
26356 coords_in_mouse_face_p (struct window *w, int hpos, int vpos)
26357 {
26358 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
26359
26360 /* Quickly resolve the easy cases. */
26361 if (!(WINDOWP (hlinfo->mouse_face_window)
26362 && XWINDOW (hlinfo->mouse_face_window) == w))
26363 return 0;
26364 if (vpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
26365 || vpos > hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row)
26366 return 0;
26367 if (vpos > hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
26368 && vpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row)
26369 return 1;
26370
26371 if (!MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos)->reversed_p)
26372 {
26373 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row == hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row)
26374 {
26375 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col <= hpos && hpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col)
26376 return 1;
26377 }
26378 else if ((vpos == hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
26379 && hpos >= hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col)
26380 || (vpos == hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
26381 && hpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col))
26382 return 1;
26383 }
26384 else
26385 {
26386 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row == hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row)
26387 {
26388 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col < hpos && hpos <= hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col)
26389 return 1;
26390 }
26391 else if ((vpos == hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
26392 && hpos <= hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col)
26393 || (vpos == hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
26394 && hpos > hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col))
26395 return 1;
26396 }
26397 return 0;
26398 }
26399
26400
26401 /* EXPORT:
26402 Non-zero if physical cursor of window W is within mouse face. */
26403
26404 int
26405 cursor_in_mouse_face_p (struct window *w)
26406 {
26407 int hpos = w->phys_cursor.hpos;
26408 int vpos = w->phys_cursor.vpos;
26409 struct glyph_row *row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
26410
26411 /* When the window is hscrolled, cursor hpos can legitimately be out
26412 of bounds, but we draw the cursor at the corresponding window
26413 margin in that case. */
26414 if (!row->reversed_p && hpos < 0)
26415 hpos = 0;
26416 if (row->reversed_p && hpos >= row->used[TEXT_AREA])
26417 hpos = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
26418
26419 return coords_in_mouse_face_p (w, hpos, vpos);
26420 }
26421
26422
26423 \f
26424 /* Find the glyph rows START_ROW and END_ROW of window W that display
26425 characters between buffer positions START_CHARPOS and END_CHARPOS
26426 (excluding END_CHARPOS). DISP_STRING is a display string that
26427 covers these buffer positions. This is similar to
26428 row_containing_pos, but is more accurate when bidi reordering makes
26429 buffer positions change non-linearly with glyph rows. */
26430 static void
26431 rows_from_pos_range (struct window *w,
26432 ptrdiff_t start_charpos, ptrdiff_t end_charpos,
26433 Lisp_Object disp_string,
26434 struct glyph_row **start, struct glyph_row **end)
26435 {
26436 struct glyph_row *first = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
26437 int last_y = window_text_bottom_y (w);
26438 struct glyph_row *row;
26439
26440 *start = NULL;
26441 *end = NULL;
26442
26443 while (!first->enabled_p
26444 && first < MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix, w))
26445 first++;
26446
26447 /* Find the START row. */
26448 for (row = first;
26449 row->enabled_p && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) <= last_y;
26450 row++)
26451 {
26452 /* A row can potentially be the START row if the range of the
26453 characters it displays intersects the range
26454 [START_CHARPOS..END_CHARPOS). */
26455 if (! ((start_charpos < MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row)
26456 && end_charpos < MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row))
26457 /* See the commentary in row_containing_pos, for the
26458 explanation of the complicated way to check whether
26459 some position is beyond the end of the characters
26460 displayed by a row. */
26461 || ((start_charpos > MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
26462 || (start_charpos == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
26463 && !row->ends_at_zv_p
26464 && !MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (row)))
26465 && (end_charpos > MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
26466 || (end_charpos == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
26467 && !row->ends_at_zv_p
26468 && !MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (row))))))
26469 {
26470 /* Found a candidate row. Now make sure at least one of the
26471 glyphs it displays has a charpos from the range
26472 [START_CHARPOS..END_CHARPOS).
26473
26474 This is not obvious because bidi reordering could make
26475 buffer positions of a row be 1,2,3,102,101,100, and if we
26476 want to highlight characters in [50..60), we don't want
26477 this row, even though [50..60) does intersect [1..103),
26478 the range of character positions given by the row's start
26479 and end positions. */
26480 struct glyph *g = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26481 struct glyph *e = g + row->used[TEXT_AREA];
26482
26483 while (g < e)
26484 {
26485 if (((BUFFERP (g->object) || INTEGERP (g->object))
26486 && start_charpos <= g->charpos && g->charpos < end_charpos)
26487 /* A glyph that comes from DISP_STRING is by
26488 definition to be highlighted. */
26489 || EQ (g->object, disp_string))
26490 *start = row;
26491 g++;
26492 }
26493 if (*start)
26494 break;
26495 }
26496 }
26497
26498 /* Find the END row. */
26499 if (!*start
26500 /* If the last row is partially visible, start looking for END
26501 from that row, instead of starting from FIRST. */
26502 && !(row->enabled_p
26503 && row->y < last_y && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) > last_y))
26504 row = first;
26505 for ( ; row->enabled_p && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) <= last_y; row++)
26506 {
26507 struct glyph_row *next = row + 1;
26508 ptrdiff_t next_start = MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (next);
26509
26510 if (!next->enabled_p
26511 || next >= MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix, w)
26512 /* The first row >= START whose range of displayed characters
26513 does NOT intersect the range [START_CHARPOS..END_CHARPOS]
26514 is the row END + 1. */
26515 || (start_charpos < next_start
26516 && end_charpos < next_start)
26517 || ((start_charpos > MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (next)
26518 || (start_charpos == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (next)
26519 && !next->ends_at_zv_p
26520 && !MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (next)))
26521 && (end_charpos > MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (next)
26522 || (end_charpos == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (next)
26523 && !next->ends_at_zv_p
26524 && !MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (next)))))
26525 {
26526 *end = row;
26527 break;
26528 }
26529 else
26530 {
26531 /* If the next row's edges intersect [START_CHARPOS..END_CHARPOS],
26532 but none of the characters it displays are in the range, it is
26533 also END + 1. */
26534 struct glyph *g = next->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26535 struct glyph *s = g;
26536 struct glyph *e = g + next->used[TEXT_AREA];
26537
26538 while (g < e)
26539 {
26540 if (((BUFFERP (g->object) || INTEGERP (g->object))
26541 && ((start_charpos <= g->charpos && g->charpos < end_charpos)
26542 /* If the buffer position of the first glyph in
26543 the row is equal to END_CHARPOS, it means
26544 the last character to be highlighted is the
26545 newline of ROW, and we must consider NEXT as
26546 END, not END+1. */
26547 || (((!next->reversed_p && g == s)
26548 || (next->reversed_p && g == e - 1))
26549 && (g->charpos == end_charpos
26550 /* Special case for when NEXT is an
26551 empty line at ZV. */
26552 || (g->charpos == -1
26553 && !row->ends_at_zv_p
26554 && next_start == end_charpos)))))
26555 /* A glyph that comes from DISP_STRING is by
26556 definition to be highlighted. */
26557 || EQ (g->object, disp_string))
26558 break;
26559 g++;
26560 }
26561 if (g == e)
26562 {
26563 *end = row;
26564 break;
26565 }
26566 /* The first row that ends at ZV must be the last to be
26567 highlighted. */
26568 else if (next->ends_at_zv_p)
26569 {
26570 *end = next;
26571 break;
26572 }
26573 }
26574 }
26575 }
26576
26577 /* This function sets the mouse_face_* elements of HLINFO, assuming
26578 the mouse cursor is on a glyph with buffer charpos MOUSE_CHARPOS in
26579 window WINDOW. START_CHARPOS and END_CHARPOS are buffer positions
26580 for the overlay or run of text properties specifying the mouse
26581 face. BEFORE_STRING and AFTER_STRING, if non-nil, are a
26582 before-string and after-string that must also be highlighted.
26583 DISP_STRING, if non-nil, is a display string that may cover some
26584 or all of the highlighted text. */
26585
26586 static void
26587 mouse_face_from_buffer_pos (Lisp_Object window,
26588 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo,
26589 ptrdiff_t mouse_charpos,
26590 ptrdiff_t start_charpos,
26591 ptrdiff_t end_charpos,
26592 Lisp_Object before_string,
26593 Lisp_Object after_string,
26594 Lisp_Object disp_string)
26595 {
26596 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
26597 struct glyph_row *first = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
26598 struct glyph_row *r1, *r2;
26599 struct glyph *glyph, *end;
26600 ptrdiff_t ignore, pos;
26601 int x;
26602
26603 eassert (NILP (disp_string) || STRINGP (disp_string));
26604 eassert (NILP (before_string) || STRINGP (before_string));
26605 eassert (NILP (after_string) || STRINGP (after_string));
26606
26607 /* Find the rows corresponding to START_CHARPOS and END_CHARPOS. */
26608 rows_from_pos_range (w, start_charpos, end_charpos, disp_string, &r1, &r2);
26609 if (r1 == NULL)
26610 r1 = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos));
26611 /* If the before-string or display-string contains newlines,
26612 rows_from_pos_range skips to its last row. Move back. */
26613 if (!NILP (before_string) || !NILP (disp_string))
26614 {
26615 struct glyph_row *prev;
26616 while ((prev = r1 - 1, prev >= first)
26617 && MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (prev) == start_charpos
26618 && prev->used[TEXT_AREA] > 0)
26619 {
26620 struct glyph *beg = prev->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26621 glyph = beg + prev->used[TEXT_AREA];
26622 while (--glyph >= beg && INTEGERP (glyph->object));
26623 if (glyph < beg
26624 || !(EQ (glyph->object, before_string)
26625 || EQ (glyph->object, disp_string)))
26626 break;
26627 r1 = prev;
26628 }
26629 }
26630 if (r2 == NULL)
26631 {
26632 r2 = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos));
26633 hlinfo->mouse_face_past_end = 1;
26634 }
26635 else if (!NILP (after_string))
26636 {
26637 /* If the after-string has newlines, advance to its last row. */
26638 struct glyph_row *next;
26639 struct glyph_row *last
26640 = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos));
26641
26642 for (next = r2 + 1;
26643 next <= last
26644 && next->used[TEXT_AREA] > 0
26645 && EQ (next->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]->object, after_string);
26646 ++next)
26647 r2 = next;
26648 }
26649 /* The rest of the display engine assumes that mouse_face_beg_row is
26650 either above mouse_face_end_row or identical to it. But with
26651 bidi-reordered continued lines, the row for START_CHARPOS could
26652 be below the row for END_CHARPOS. If so, swap the rows and store
26653 them in correct order. */
26654 if (r1->y > r2->y)
26655 {
26656 struct glyph_row *tem = r2;
26657
26658 r2 = r1;
26659 r1 = tem;
26660 }
26661
26662 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_y = r1->y;
26663 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (r1, w->current_matrix);
26664 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_y = r2->y;
26665 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (r2, w->current_matrix);
26666
26667 /* For a bidi-reordered row, the positions of BEFORE_STRING,
26668 AFTER_STRING, DISP_STRING, START_CHARPOS, and END_CHARPOS
26669 could be anywhere in the row and in any order. The strategy
26670 below is to find the leftmost and the rightmost glyph that
26671 belongs to either of these 3 strings, or whose position is
26672 between START_CHARPOS and END_CHARPOS, and highlight all the
26673 glyphs between those two. This may cover more than just the text
26674 between START_CHARPOS and END_CHARPOS if the range of characters
26675 strides the bidi level boundary, e.g. if the beginning is in R2L
26676 text while the end is in L2R text or vice versa. */
26677 if (!r1->reversed_p)
26678 {
26679 /* This row is in a left to right paragraph. Scan it left to
26680 right. */
26681 glyph = r1->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26682 end = glyph + r1->used[TEXT_AREA];
26683 x = r1->x;
26684
26685 /* Skip truncation glyphs at the start of the glyph row. */
26686 if (r1->displays_text_p)
26687 for (; glyph < end
26688 && INTEGERP (glyph->object)
26689 && glyph->charpos < 0;
26690 ++glyph)
26691 x += glyph->pixel_width;
26692
26693 /* Scan the glyph row, looking for BEFORE_STRING, AFTER_STRING,
26694 or DISP_STRING, and the first glyph from buffer whose
26695 position is between START_CHARPOS and END_CHARPOS. */
26696 for (; glyph < end
26697 && !INTEGERP (glyph->object)
26698 && !EQ (glyph->object, disp_string)
26699 && !(BUFFERP (glyph->object)
26700 && (glyph->charpos >= start_charpos
26701 && glyph->charpos < end_charpos));
26702 ++glyph)
26703 {
26704 /* BEFORE_STRING or AFTER_STRING are only relevant if they
26705 are present at buffer positions between START_CHARPOS and
26706 END_CHARPOS, or if they come from an overlay. */
26707 if (EQ (glyph->object, before_string))
26708 {
26709 pos = string_buffer_position (before_string,
26710 start_charpos);
26711 /* If pos == 0, it means before_string came from an
26712 overlay, not from a buffer position. */
26713 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
26714 break;
26715 }
26716 else if (EQ (glyph->object, after_string))
26717 {
26718 pos = string_buffer_position (after_string, end_charpos);
26719 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
26720 break;
26721 }
26722 x += glyph->pixel_width;
26723 }
26724 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x = x;
26725 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = glyph - r1->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26726 }
26727 else
26728 {
26729 /* This row is in a right to left paragraph. Scan it right to
26730 left. */
26731 struct glyph *g;
26732
26733 end = r1->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
26734 glyph = end + r1->used[TEXT_AREA];
26735
26736 /* Skip truncation glyphs at the start of the glyph row. */
26737 if (r1->displays_text_p)
26738 for (; glyph > end
26739 && INTEGERP (glyph->object)
26740 && glyph->charpos < 0;
26741 --glyph)
26742 ;
26743
26744 /* Scan the glyph row, looking for BEFORE_STRING, AFTER_STRING,
26745 or DISP_STRING, and the first glyph from buffer whose
26746 position is between START_CHARPOS and END_CHARPOS. */
26747 for (; glyph > end
26748 && !INTEGERP (glyph->object)
26749 && !EQ (glyph->object, disp_string)
26750 && !(BUFFERP (glyph->object)
26751 && (glyph->charpos >= start_charpos
26752 && glyph->charpos < end_charpos));
26753 --glyph)
26754 {
26755 /* BEFORE_STRING or AFTER_STRING are only relevant if they
26756 are present at buffer positions between START_CHARPOS and
26757 END_CHARPOS, or if they come from an overlay. */
26758 if (EQ (glyph->object, before_string))
26759 {
26760 pos = string_buffer_position (before_string, start_charpos);
26761 /* If pos == 0, it means before_string came from an
26762 overlay, not from a buffer position. */
26763 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
26764 break;
26765 }
26766 else if (EQ (glyph->object, after_string))
26767 {
26768 pos = string_buffer_position (after_string, end_charpos);
26769 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
26770 break;
26771 }
26772 }
26773
26774 glyph++; /* first glyph to the right of the highlighted area */
26775 for (g = r1->glyphs[TEXT_AREA], x = r1->x; g < glyph; g++)
26776 x += g->pixel_width;
26777 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x = x;
26778 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = glyph - r1->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26779 }
26780
26781 /* If the highlight ends in a different row, compute GLYPH and END
26782 for the end row. Otherwise, reuse the values computed above for
26783 the row where the highlight begins. */
26784 if (r2 != r1)
26785 {
26786 if (!r2->reversed_p)
26787 {
26788 glyph = r2->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26789 end = glyph + r2->used[TEXT_AREA];
26790 x = r2->x;
26791 }
26792 else
26793 {
26794 end = r2->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
26795 glyph = end + r2->used[TEXT_AREA];
26796 }
26797 }
26798
26799 if (!r2->reversed_p)
26800 {
26801 /* Skip truncation and continuation glyphs near the end of the
26802 row, and also blanks and stretch glyphs inserted by
26803 extend_face_to_end_of_line. */
26804 while (end > glyph
26805 && INTEGERP ((end - 1)->object))
26806 --end;
26807 /* Scan the rest of the glyph row from the end, looking for the
26808 first glyph that comes from BEFORE_STRING, AFTER_STRING, or
26809 DISP_STRING, or whose position is between START_CHARPOS
26810 and END_CHARPOS */
26811 for (--end;
26812 end > glyph
26813 && !INTEGERP (end->object)
26814 && !EQ (end->object, disp_string)
26815 && !(BUFFERP (end->object)
26816 && (end->charpos >= start_charpos
26817 && end->charpos < end_charpos));
26818 --end)
26819 {
26820 /* BEFORE_STRING or AFTER_STRING are only relevant if they
26821 are present at buffer positions between START_CHARPOS and
26822 END_CHARPOS, or if they come from an overlay. */
26823 if (EQ (end->object, before_string))
26824 {
26825 pos = string_buffer_position (before_string, start_charpos);
26826 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
26827 break;
26828 }
26829 else if (EQ (end->object, after_string))
26830 {
26831 pos = string_buffer_position (after_string, end_charpos);
26832 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
26833 break;
26834 }
26835 }
26836 /* Find the X coordinate of the last glyph to be highlighted. */
26837 for (; glyph <= end; ++glyph)
26838 x += glyph->pixel_width;
26839
26840 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x = x;
26841 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = glyph - r2->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26842 }
26843 else
26844 {
26845 /* Skip truncation and continuation glyphs near the end of the
26846 row, and also blanks and stretch glyphs inserted by
26847 extend_face_to_end_of_line. */
26848 x = r2->x;
26849 end++;
26850 while (end < glyph
26851 && INTEGERP (end->object))
26852 {
26853 x += end->pixel_width;
26854 ++end;
26855 }
26856 /* Scan the rest of the glyph row from the end, looking for the
26857 first glyph that comes from BEFORE_STRING, AFTER_STRING, or
26858 DISP_STRING, or whose position is between START_CHARPOS
26859 and END_CHARPOS */
26860 for ( ;
26861 end < glyph
26862 && !INTEGERP (end->object)
26863 && !EQ (end->object, disp_string)
26864 && !(BUFFERP (end->object)
26865 && (end->charpos >= start_charpos
26866 && end->charpos < end_charpos));
26867 ++end)
26868 {
26869 /* BEFORE_STRING or AFTER_STRING are only relevant if they
26870 are present at buffer positions between START_CHARPOS and
26871 END_CHARPOS, or if they come from an overlay. */
26872 if (EQ (end->object, before_string))
26873 {
26874 pos = string_buffer_position (before_string, start_charpos);
26875 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
26876 break;
26877 }
26878 else if (EQ (end->object, after_string))
26879 {
26880 pos = string_buffer_position (after_string, end_charpos);
26881 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
26882 break;
26883 }
26884 x += end->pixel_width;
26885 }
26886 /* If we exited the above loop because we arrived at the last
26887 glyph of the row, and its buffer position is still not in
26888 range, it means the last character in range is the preceding
26889 newline. Bump the end column and x values to get past the
26890 last glyph. */
26891 if (end == glyph
26892 && BUFFERP (end->object)
26893 && (end->charpos < start_charpos
26894 || end->charpos >= end_charpos))
26895 {
26896 x += end->pixel_width;
26897 ++end;
26898 }
26899 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x = x;
26900 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = end - r2->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26901 }
26902
26903 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = window;
26904 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id
26905 = face_at_buffer_position (w, mouse_charpos, 0, 0, &ignore,
26906 mouse_charpos + 1,
26907 !hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden, -1);
26908 show_mouse_face (hlinfo, DRAW_MOUSE_FACE);
26909 }
26910
26911 /* The following function is not used anymore (replaced with
26912 mouse_face_from_string_pos), but I leave it here for the time
26913 being, in case someone would. */
26914
26915 #if 0 /* not used */
26916
26917 /* Find the position of the glyph for position POS in OBJECT in
26918 window W's current matrix, and return in *X, *Y the pixel
26919 coordinates, and return in *HPOS, *VPOS the column/row of the glyph.
26920
26921 RIGHT_P non-zero means return the position of the right edge of the
26922 glyph, RIGHT_P zero means return the left edge position.
26923
26924 If no glyph for POS exists in the matrix, return the position of
26925 the glyph with the next smaller position that is in the matrix, if
26926 RIGHT_P is zero. If RIGHT_P is non-zero, and no glyph for POS
26927 exists in the matrix, return the position of the glyph with the
26928 next larger position in OBJECT.
26929
26930 Value is non-zero if a glyph was found. */
26931
26932 static int
26933 fast_find_string_pos (struct window *w, ptrdiff_t pos, Lisp_Object object,
26934 int *hpos, int *vpos, int *x, int *y, int right_p)
26935 {
26936 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w);
26937 struct glyph_row *r;
26938 struct glyph *best_glyph = NULL;
26939 struct glyph_row *best_row = NULL;
26940 int best_x = 0;
26941
26942 for (r = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
26943 r->enabled_p && r->y < yb;
26944 ++r)
26945 {
26946 struct glyph *g = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26947 struct glyph *e = g + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
26948 int gx;
26949
26950 for (gx = r->x; g < e; gx += g->pixel_width, ++g)
26951 if (EQ (g->object, object))
26952 {
26953 if (g->charpos == pos)
26954 {
26955 best_glyph = g;
26956 best_x = gx;
26957 best_row = r;
26958 goto found;
26959 }
26960 else if (best_glyph == NULL
26961 || ((eabs (g->charpos - pos)
26962 < eabs (best_glyph->charpos - pos))
26963 && (right_p
26964 ? g->charpos < pos
26965 : g->charpos > pos)))
26966 {
26967 best_glyph = g;
26968 best_x = gx;
26969 best_row = r;
26970 }
26971 }
26972 }
26973
26974 found:
26975
26976 if (best_glyph)
26977 {
26978 *x = best_x;
26979 *hpos = best_glyph - best_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26980
26981 if (right_p)
26982 {
26983 *x += best_glyph->pixel_width;
26984 ++*hpos;
26985 }
26986
26987 *y = best_row->y;
26988 *vpos = best_row - w->current_matrix->rows;
26989 }
26990
26991 return best_glyph != NULL;
26992 }
26993 #endif /* not used */
26994
26995 /* Find the positions of the first and the last glyphs in window W's
26996 current matrix that occlude positions [STARTPOS..ENDPOS] in OBJECT
26997 (assumed to be a string), and return in HLINFO's mouse_face_*
26998 members the pixel and column/row coordinates of those glyphs. */
26999
27000 static void
27001 mouse_face_from_string_pos (struct window *w, Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo,
27002 Lisp_Object object,
27003 ptrdiff_t startpos, ptrdiff_t endpos)
27004 {
27005 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w);
27006 struct glyph_row *r;
27007 struct glyph *g, *e;
27008 int gx;
27009 int found = 0;
27010
27011 /* Find the glyph row with at least one position in the range
27012 [STARTPOS..ENDPOS], and the first glyph in that row whose
27013 position belongs to that range. */
27014 for (r = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
27015 r->enabled_p && r->y < yb;
27016 ++r)
27017 {
27018 if (!r->reversed_p)
27019 {
27020 g = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27021 e = g + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
27022 for (gx = r->x; g < e; gx += g->pixel_width, ++g)
27023 if (EQ (g->object, object)
27024 && startpos <= g->charpos && g->charpos <= endpos)
27025 {
27026 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = r - w->current_matrix->rows;
27027 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_y = r->y;
27028 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = g - r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27029 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x = gx;
27030 found = 1;
27031 break;
27032 }
27033 }
27034 else
27035 {
27036 struct glyph *g1;
27037
27038 e = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27039 g = e + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
27040 for ( ; g > e; --g)
27041 if (EQ ((g-1)->object, object)
27042 && startpos <= (g-1)->charpos && (g-1)->charpos <= endpos)
27043 {
27044 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = r - w->current_matrix->rows;
27045 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_y = r->y;
27046 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = g - r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27047 for (gx = r->x, g1 = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]; g1 < g; ++g1)
27048 gx += g1->pixel_width;
27049 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x = gx;
27050 found = 1;
27051 break;
27052 }
27053 }
27054 if (found)
27055 break;
27056 }
27057
27058 if (!found)
27059 return;
27060
27061 /* Starting with the next row, look for the first row which does NOT
27062 include any glyphs whose positions are in the range. */
27063 for (++r; r->enabled_p && r->y < yb; ++r)
27064 {
27065 g = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27066 e = g + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
27067 found = 0;
27068 for ( ; g < e; ++g)
27069 if (EQ (g->object, object)
27070 && startpos <= g->charpos && g->charpos <= endpos)
27071 {
27072 found = 1;
27073 break;
27074 }
27075 if (!found)
27076 break;
27077 }
27078
27079 /* The highlighted region ends on the previous row. */
27080 r--;
27081
27082 /* Set the end row and its vertical pixel coordinate. */
27083 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = r - w->current_matrix->rows;
27084 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_y = r->y;
27085
27086 /* Compute and set the end column and the end column's horizontal
27087 pixel coordinate. */
27088 if (!r->reversed_p)
27089 {
27090 g = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27091 e = g + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
27092 for ( ; e > g; --e)
27093 if (EQ ((e-1)->object, object)
27094 && startpos <= (e-1)->charpos && (e-1)->charpos <= endpos)
27095 break;
27096 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = e - g;
27097
27098 for (gx = r->x; g < e; ++g)
27099 gx += g->pixel_width;
27100 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x = gx;
27101 }
27102 else
27103 {
27104 e = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27105 g = e + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
27106 for (gx = r->x ; e < g; ++e)
27107 {
27108 if (EQ (e->object, object)
27109 && startpos <= e->charpos && e->charpos <= endpos)
27110 break;
27111 gx += e->pixel_width;
27112 }
27113 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = e - r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27114 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x = gx;
27115 }
27116 }
27117
27118 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
27119
27120 /* See if position X, Y is within a hot-spot of an image. */
27121
27122 static int
27123 on_hot_spot_p (Lisp_Object hot_spot, int x, int y)
27124 {
27125 if (!CONSP (hot_spot))
27126 return 0;
27127
27128 if (EQ (XCAR (hot_spot), Qrect))
27129 {
27130 /* CDR is (Top-Left . Bottom-Right) = ((x0 . y0) . (x1 . y1)) */
27131 Lisp_Object rect = XCDR (hot_spot);
27132 Lisp_Object tem;
27133 if (!CONSP (rect))
27134 return 0;
27135 if (!CONSP (XCAR (rect)))
27136 return 0;
27137 if (!CONSP (XCDR (rect)))
27138 return 0;
27139 if (!(tem = XCAR (XCAR (rect)), INTEGERP (tem) && x >= XINT (tem)))
27140 return 0;
27141 if (!(tem = XCDR (XCAR (rect)), INTEGERP (tem) && y >= XINT (tem)))
27142 return 0;
27143 if (!(tem = XCAR (XCDR (rect)), INTEGERP (tem) && x <= XINT (tem)))
27144 return 0;
27145 if (!(tem = XCDR (XCDR (rect)), INTEGERP (tem) && y <= XINT (tem)))
27146 return 0;
27147 return 1;
27148 }
27149 else if (EQ (XCAR (hot_spot), Qcircle))
27150 {
27151 /* CDR is (Center . Radius) = ((x0 . y0) . r) */
27152 Lisp_Object circ = XCDR (hot_spot);
27153 Lisp_Object lr, lx0, ly0;
27154 if (CONSP (circ)
27155 && CONSP (XCAR (circ))
27156 && (lr = XCDR (circ), INTEGERP (lr) || FLOATP (lr))
27157 && (lx0 = XCAR (XCAR (circ)), INTEGERP (lx0))
27158 && (ly0 = XCDR (XCAR (circ)), INTEGERP (ly0)))
27159 {
27160 double r = XFLOATINT (lr);
27161 double dx = XINT (lx0) - x;
27162 double dy = XINT (ly0) - y;
27163 return (dx * dx + dy * dy <= r * r);
27164 }
27165 }
27166 else if (EQ (XCAR (hot_spot), Qpoly))
27167 {
27168 /* CDR is [x0 y0 x1 y1 x2 y2 ...x(n-1) y(n-1)] */
27169 if (VECTORP (XCDR (hot_spot)))
27170 {
27171 struct Lisp_Vector *v = XVECTOR (XCDR (hot_spot));
27172 Lisp_Object *poly = v->contents;
27173 ptrdiff_t n = v->header.size;
27174 ptrdiff_t i;
27175 int inside = 0;
27176 Lisp_Object lx, ly;
27177 int x0, y0;
27178
27179 /* Need an even number of coordinates, and at least 3 edges. */
27180 if (n < 6 || n & 1)
27181 return 0;
27182
27183 /* Count edge segments intersecting line from (X,Y) to (X,infinity).
27184 If count is odd, we are inside polygon. Pixels on edges
27185 may or may not be included depending on actual geometry of the
27186 polygon. */
27187 if ((lx = poly[n-2], !INTEGERP (lx))
27188 || (ly = poly[n-1], !INTEGERP (lx)))
27189 return 0;
27190 x0 = XINT (lx), y0 = XINT (ly);
27191 for (i = 0; i < n; i += 2)
27192 {
27193 int x1 = x0, y1 = y0;
27194 if ((lx = poly[i], !INTEGERP (lx))
27195 || (ly = poly[i+1], !INTEGERP (ly)))
27196 return 0;
27197 x0 = XINT (lx), y0 = XINT (ly);
27198
27199 /* Does this segment cross the X line? */
27200 if (x0 >= x)
27201 {
27202 if (x1 >= x)
27203 continue;
27204 }
27205 else if (x1 < x)
27206 continue;
27207 if (y > y0 && y > y1)
27208 continue;
27209 if (y < y0 + ((y1 - y0) * (x - x0)) / (x1 - x0))
27210 inside = !inside;
27211 }
27212 return inside;
27213 }
27214 }
27215 return 0;
27216 }
27217
27218 Lisp_Object
27219 find_hot_spot (Lisp_Object map, int x, int y)
27220 {
27221 while (CONSP (map))
27222 {
27223 if (CONSP (XCAR (map))
27224 && on_hot_spot_p (XCAR (XCAR (map)), x, y))
27225 return XCAR (map);
27226 map = XCDR (map);
27227 }
27228
27229 return Qnil;
27230 }
27231
27232 DEFUN ("lookup-image-map", Flookup_image_map, Slookup_image_map,
27233 3, 3, 0,
27234 doc: /* Lookup in image map MAP coordinates X and Y.
27235 An image map is an alist where each element has the format (AREA ID PLIST).
27236 An AREA is specified as either a rectangle, a circle, or a polygon:
27237 A rectangle is a cons (rect . ((x0 . y0) . (x1 . y1))) specifying the
27238 pixel coordinates of the upper left and bottom right corners.
27239 A circle is a cons (circle . ((x0 . y0) . r)) specifying the center
27240 and the radius of the circle; r may be a float or integer.
27241 A polygon is a cons (poly . [x0 y0 x1 y1 ...]) where each pair in the
27242 vector describes one corner in the polygon.
27243 Returns the alist element for the first matching AREA in MAP. */)
27244 (Lisp_Object map, Lisp_Object x, Lisp_Object y)
27245 {
27246 if (NILP (map))
27247 return Qnil;
27248
27249 CHECK_NUMBER (x);
27250 CHECK_NUMBER (y);
27251
27252 return find_hot_spot (map,
27253 clip_to_bounds (INT_MIN, XINT (x), INT_MAX),
27254 clip_to_bounds (INT_MIN, XINT (y), INT_MAX));
27255 }
27256
27257
27258 /* Display frame CURSOR, optionally using shape defined by POINTER. */
27259 static void
27260 define_frame_cursor1 (struct frame *f, Cursor cursor, Lisp_Object pointer)
27261 {
27262 /* Do not change cursor shape while dragging mouse. */
27263 if (!NILP (do_mouse_tracking))
27264 return;
27265
27266 if (!NILP (pointer))
27267 {
27268 if (EQ (pointer, Qarrow))
27269 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->nontext_cursor;
27270 else if (EQ (pointer, Qhand))
27271 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->hand_cursor;
27272 else if (EQ (pointer, Qtext))
27273 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->text_cursor;
27274 else if (EQ (pointer, intern ("hdrag")))
27275 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->horizontal_drag_cursor;
27276 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
27277 else if (EQ (pointer, intern ("vdrag")))
27278 cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
27279 #endif
27280 else if (EQ (pointer, intern ("hourglass")))
27281 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->hourglass_cursor;
27282 else if (EQ (pointer, Qmodeline))
27283 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->modeline_cursor;
27284 else
27285 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->nontext_cursor;
27286 }
27287
27288 if (cursor != No_Cursor)
27289 FRAME_RIF (f)->define_frame_cursor (f, cursor);
27290 }
27291
27292 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
27293
27294 /* Take proper action when mouse has moved to the mode or header line
27295 or marginal area AREA of window W, x-position X and y-position Y.
27296 X is relative to the start of the text display area of W, so the
27297 width of bitmap areas and scroll bars must be subtracted to get a
27298 position relative to the start of the mode line. */
27299
27300 static void
27301 note_mode_line_or_margin_highlight (Lisp_Object window, int x, int y,
27302 enum window_part area)
27303 {
27304 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
27305 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
27306 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
27307 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
27308 Display_Info *dpyinfo;
27309 #endif
27310 Cursor cursor = No_Cursor;
27311 Lisp_Object pointer = Qnil;
27312 int dx, dy, width, height;
27313 ptrdiff_t charpos;
27314 Lisp_Object string, object = Qnil;
27315 Lisp_Object pos IF_LINT (= Qnil), help;
27316
27317 Lisp_Object mouse_face;
27318 int original_x_pixel = x;
27319 struct glyph * glyph = NULL, * row_start_glyph = NULL;
27320 struct glyph_row *row IF_LINT (= 0);
27321
27322 if (area == ON_MODE_LINE || area == ON_HEADER_LINE)
27323 {
27324 int x0;
27325 struct glyph *end;
27326
27327 /* Kludge alert: mode_line_string takes X/Y in pixels, but
27328 returns them in row/column units! */
27329 string = mode_line_string (w, area, &x, &y, &charpos,
27330 &object, &dx, &dy, &width, &height);
27331
27332 row = (area == ON_MODE_LINE
27333 ? MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)
27334 : MATRIX_HEADER_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix));
27335
27336 /* Find the glyph under the mouse pointer. */
27337 if (row->mode_line_p && row->enabled_p)
27338 {
27339 glyph = row_start_glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27340 end = glyph + row->used[TEXT_AREA];
27341
27342 for (x0 = original_x_pixel;
27343 glyph < end && x0 >= glyph->pixel_width;
27344 ++glyph)
27345 x0 -= glyph->pixel_width;
27346
27347 if (glyph >= end)
27348 glyph = NULL;
27349 }
27350 }
27351 else
27352 {
27353 x -= WINDOW_LEFT_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (w);
27354 /* Kludge alert: marginal_area_string takes X/Y in pixels, but
27355 returns them in row/column units! */
27356 string = marginal_area_string (w, area, &x, &y, &charpos,
27357 &object, &dx, &dy, &width, &height);
27358 }
27359
27360 help = Qnil;
27361
27362 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
27363 if (IMAGEP (object))
27364 {
27365 Lisp_Object image_map, hotspot;
27366 if ((image_map = Fplist_get (XCDR (object), QCmap),
27367 !NILP (image_map))
27368 && (hotspot = find_hot_spot (image_map, dx, dy),
27369 CONSP (hotspot))
27370 && (hotspot = XCDR (hotspot), CONSP (hotspot)))
27371 {
27372 Lisp_Object plist;
27373
27374 /* Could check XCAR (hotspot) to see if we enter/leave this hot-spot.
27375 If so, we could look for mouse-enter, mouse-leave
27376 properties in PLIST (and do something...). */
27377 hotspot = XCDR (hotspot);
27378 if (CONSP (hotspot)
27379 && (plist = XCAR (hotspot), CONSP (plist)))
27380 {
27381 pointer = Fplist_get (plist, Qpointer);
27382 if (NILP (pointer))
27383 pointer = Qhand;
27384 help = Fplist_get (plist, Qhelp_echo);
27385 if (!NILP (help))
27386 {
27387 help_echo_string = help;
27388 XSETWINDOW (help_echo_window, w);
27389 help_echo_object = w->buffer;
27390 help_echo_pos = charpos;
27391 }
27392 }
27393 }
27394 if (NILP (pointer))
27395 pointer = Fplist_get (XCDR (object), QCpointer);
27396 }
27397 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
27398
27399 if (STRINGP (string))
27400 pos = make_number (charpos);
27401
27402 /* Set the help text and mouse pointer. If the mouse is on a part
27403 of the mode line without any text (e.g. past the right edge of
27404 the mode line text), use the default help text and pointer. */
27405 if (STRINGP (string) || area == ON_MODE_LINE)
27406 {
27407 /* Arrange to display the help by setting the global variables
27408 help_echo_string, help_echo_object, and help_echo_pos. */
27409 if (NILP (help))
27410 {
27411 if (STRINGP (string))
27412 help = Fget_text_property (pos, Qhelp_echo, string);
27413
27414 if (!NILP (help))
27415 {
27416 help_echo_string = help;
27417 XSETWINDOW (help_echo_window, w);
27418 help_echo_object = string;
27419 help_echo_pos = charpos;
27420 }
27421 else if (area == ON_MODE_LINE)
27422 {
27423 Lisp_Object default_help
27424 = buffer_local_value_1 (Qmode_line_default_help_echo,
27425 w->buffer);
27426
27427 if (STRINGP (default_help))
27428 {
27429 help_echo_string = default_help;
27430 XSETWINDOW (help_echo_window, w);
27431 help_echo_object = Qnil;
27432 help_echo_pos = -1;
27433 }
27434 }
27435 }
27436
27437 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
27438 /* Change the mouse pointer according to what is under it. */
27439 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
27440 {
27441 dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
27442 if (STRINGP (string))
27443 {
27444 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->nontext_cursor;
27445
27446 if (NILP (pointer))
27447 pointer = Fget_text_property (pos, Qpointer, string);
27448
27449 /* Change the mouse pointer according to what is under X/Y. */
27450 if (NILP (pointer)
27451 && ((area == ON_MODE_LINE) || (area == ON_HEADER_LINE)))
27452 {
27453 Lisp_Object map;
27454 map = Fget_text_property (pos, Qlocal_map, string);
27455 if (!KEYMAPP (map))
27456 map = Fget_text_property (pos, Qkeymap, string);
27457 if (!KEYMAPP (map))
27458 cursor = dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
27459 }
27460 }
27461 else
27462 /* Default mode-line pointer. */
27463 cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
27464 }
27465 #endif
27466 }
27467
27468 /* Change the mouse face according to what is under X/Y. */
27469 if (STRINGP (string))
27470 {
27471 mouse_face = Fget_text_property (pos, Qmouse_face, string);
27472 if (!NILP (mouse_face)
27473 && ((area == ON_MODE_LINE) || (area == ON_HEADER_LINE))
27474 && glyph)
27475 {
27476 Lisp_Object b, e;
27477
27478 struct glyph * tmp_glyph;
27479
27480 int gpos;
27481 int gseq_length;
27482 int total_pixel_width;
27483 ptrdiff_t begpos, endpos, ignore;
27484
27485 int vpos, hpos;
27486
27487 b = Fprevious_single_property_change (make_number (charpos + 1),
27488 Qmouse_face, string, Qnil);
27489 if (NILP (b))
27490 begpos = 0;
27491 else
27492 begpos = XINT (b);
27493
27494 e = Fnext_single_property_change (pos, Qmouse_face, string, Qnil);
27495 if (NILP (e))
27496 endpos = SCHARS (string);
27497 else
27498 endpos = XINT (e);
27499
27500 /* Calculate the glyph position GPOS of GLYPH in the
27501 displayed string, relative to the beginning of the
27502 highlighted part of the string.
27503
27504 Note: GPOS is different from CHARPOS. CHARPOS is the
27505 position of GLYPH in the internal string object. A mode
27506 line string format has structures which are converted to
27507 a flattened string by the Emacs Lisp interpreter. The
27508 internal string is an element of those structures. The
27509 displayed string is the flattened string. */
27510 tmp_glyph = row_start_glyph;
27511 while (tmp_glyph < glyph
27512 && (!(EQ (tmp_glyph->object, glyph->object)
27513 && begpos <= tmp_glyph->charpos
27514 && tmp_glyph->charpos < endpos)))
27515 tmp_glyph++;
27516 gpos = glyph - tmp_glyph;
27517
27518 /* Calculate the length GSEQ_LENGTH of the glyph sequence of
27519 the highlighted part of the displayed string to which
27520 GLYPH belongs. Note: GSEQ_LENGTH is different from
27521 SCHARS (STRING), because the latter returns the length of
27522 the internal string. */
27523 for (tmp_glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
27524 tmp_glyph > glyph
27525 && (!(EQ (tmp_glyph->object, glyph->object)
27526 && begpos <= tmp_glyph->charpos
27527 && tmp_glyph->charpos < endpos));
27528 tmp_glyph--)
27529 ;
27530 gseq_length = gpos + (tmp_glyph - glyph) + 1;
27531
27532 /* Calculate the total pixel width of all the glyphs between
27533 the beginning of the highlighted area and GLYPH. */
27534 total_pixel_width = 0;
27535 for (tmp_glyph = glyph - gpos; tmp_glyph != glyph; tmp_glyph++)
27536 total_pixel_width += tmp_glyph->pixel_width;
27537
27538 /* Pre calculation of re-rendering position. Note: X is in
27539 column units here, after the call to mode_line_string or
27540 marginal_area_string. */
27541 hpos = x - gpos;
27542 vpos = (area == ON_MODE_LINE
27543 ? (w->current_matrix)->nrows - 1
27544 : 0);
27545
27546 /* If GLYPH's position is included in the region that is
27547 already drawn in mouse face, we have nothing to do. */
27548 if ( EQ (window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window)
27549 && (!row->reversed_p
27550 ? (hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col <= hpos
27551 && hpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col)
27552 /* In R2L rows we swap BEG and END, see below. */
27553 : (hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col <= hpos
27554 && hpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col))
27555 && hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row == vpos )
27556 return;
27557
27558 if (clear_mouse_face (hlinfo))
27559 cursor = No_Cursor;
27560
27561 if (!row->reversed_p)
27562 {
27563 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = hpos;
27564 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x = original_x_pixel
27565 - (total_pixel_width + dx);
27566 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = hpos + gseq_length;
27567 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x = 0;
27568 }
27569 else
27570 {
27571 /* In R2L rows, show_mouse_face expects BEG and END
27572 coordinates to be swapped. */
27573 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = hpos;
27574 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x = original_x_pixel
27575 - (total_pixel_width + dx);
27576 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = hpos + gseq_length;
27577 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x = 0;
27578 }
27579
27580 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = vpos;
27581 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row;
27582 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_y = 0;
27583 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_y = 0;
27584 hlinfo->mouse_face_past_end = 0;
27585 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = window;
27586
27587 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id = face_at_string_position (w, string,
27588 charpos,
27589 0, 0, 0,
27590 &ignore,
27591 glyph->face_id,
27592 1);
27593 show_mouse_face (hlinfo, DRAW_MOUSE_FACE);
27594
27595 if (NILP (pointer))
27596 pointer = Qhand;
27597 }
27598 else if ((area == ON_MODE_LINE) || (area == ON_HEADER_LINE))
27599 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
27600 }
27601 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
27602 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
27603 define_frame_cursor1 (f, cursor, pointer);
27604 #endif
27605 }
27606
27607
27608 /* EXPORT:
27609 Take proper action when the mouse has moved to position X, Y on
27610 frame F as regards highlighting characters that have mouse-face
27611 properties. Also de-highlighting chars where the mouse was before.
27612 X and Y can be negative or out of range. */
27613
27614 void
27615 note_mouse_highlight (struct frame *f, int x, int y)
27616 {
27617 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
27618 enum window_part part = ON_NOTHING;
27619 Lisp_Object window;
27620 struct window *w;
27621 Cursor cursor = No_Cursor;
27622 Lisp_Object pointer = Qnil; /* Takes precedence over cursor! */
27623 struct buffer *b;
27624
27625 /* When a menu is active, don't highlight because this looks odd. */
27626 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK) || defined (HAVE_NS) || defined (MSDOS)
27627 if (popup_activated ())
27628 return;
27629 #endif
27630
27631 if (NILP (Vmouse_highlight)
27632 || !f->glyphs_initialized_p
27633 || f->pointer_invisible)
27634 return;
27635
27636 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = x;
27637 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = y;
27638 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = f;
27639
27640 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_defer)
27641 return;
27642
27643 if (gc_in_progress)
27644 {
27645 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 1;
27646 return;
27647 }
27648
27649 /* Which window is that in? */
27650 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, &part, 1);
27651
27652 /* If displaying active text in another window, clear that. */
27653 if (! EQ (window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window)
27654 /* Also clear if we move out of text area in same window. */
27655 || (!NILP (hlinfo->mouse_face_window)
27656 && !NILP (window)
27657 && part != ON_TEXT
27658 && part != ON_MODE_LINE
27659 && part != ON_HEADER_LINE))
27660 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
27661
27662 /* Not on a window -> return. */
27663 if (!WINDOWP (window))
27664 return;
27665
27666 /* Reset help_echo_string. It will get recomputed below. */
27667 help_echo_string = Qnil;
27668
27669 /* Convert to window-relative pixel coordinates. */
27670 w = XWINDOW (window);
27671 frame_to_window_pixel_xy (w, &x, &y);
27672
27673 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
27674 /* Handle tool-bar window differently since it doesn't display a
27675 buffer. */
27676 if (EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window))
27677 {
27678 note_tool_bar_highlight (f, x, y);
27679 return;
27680 }
27681 #endif
27682
27683 /* Mouse is on the mode, header line or margin? */
27684 if (part == ON_MODE_LINE || part == ON_HEADER_LINE
27685 || part == ON_LEFT_MARGIN || part == ON_RIGHT_MARGIN)
27686 {
27687 note_mode_line_or_margin_highlight (window, x, y, part);
27688 return;
27689 }
27690
27691 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
27692 if (part == ON_VERTICAL_BORDER)
27693 {
27694 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->horizontal_drag_cursor;
27695 help_echo_string = build_string ("drag-mouse-1: resize");
27696 }
27697 else if (part == ON_LEFT_FRINGE || part == ON_RIGHT_FRINGE
27698 || part == ON_SCROLL_BAR)
27699 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->nontext_cursor;
27700 else
27701 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->text_cursor;
27702 #endif
27703
27704 /* Are we in a window whose display is up to date?
27705 And verify the buffer's text has not changed. */
27706 b = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
27707 if (part == ON_TEXT
27708 && EQ (w->window_end_valid, w->buffer)
27709 && w->last_modified == BUF_MODIFF (b)
27710 && w->last_overlay_modified == BUF_OVERLAY_MODIFF (b))
27711 {
27712 int hpos, vpos, dx, dy, area = LAST_AREA;
27713 ptrdiff_t pos;
27714 struct glyph *glyph;
27715 Lisp_Object object;
27716 Lisp_Object mouse_face = Qnil, position;
27717 Lisp_Object *overlay_vec = NULL;
27718 ptrdiff_t i, noverlays;
27719 struct buffer *obuf;
27720 ptrdiff_t obegv, ozv;
27721 int same_region;
27722
27723 /* Find the glyph under X/Y. */
27724 glyph = x_y_to_hpos_vpos (w, x, y, &hpos, &vpos, &dx, &dy, &area);
27725
27726 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
27727 /* Look for :pointer property on image. */
27728 if (glyph != NULL && glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
27729 {
27730 struct image *img = IMAGE_FROM_ID (f, glyph->u.img_id);
27731 if (img != NULL && IMAGEP (img->spec))
27732 {
27733 Lisp_Object image_map, hotspot;
27734 if ((image_map = Fplist_get (XCDR (img->spec), QCmap),
27735 !NILP (image_map))
27736 && (hotspot = find_hot_spot (image_map,
27737 glyph->slice.img.x + dx,
27738 glyph->slice.img.y + dy),
27739 CONSP (hotspot))
27740 && (hotspot = XCDR (hotspot), CONSP (hotspot)))
27741 {
27742 Lisp_Object plist;
27743
27744 /* Could check XCAR (hotspot) to see if we enter/leave
27745 this hot-spot.
27746 If so, we could look for mouse-enter, mouse-leave
27747 properties in PLIST (and do something...). */
27748 hotspot = XCDR (hotspot);
27749 if (CONSP (hotspot)
27750 && (plist = XCAR (hotspot), CONSP (plist)))
27751 {
27752 pointer = Fplist_get (plist, Qpointer);
27753 if (NILP (pointer))
27754 pointer = Qhand;
27755 help_echo_string = Fplist_get (plist, Qhelp_echo);
27756 if (!NILP (help_echo_string))
27757 {
27758 help_echo_window = window;
27759 help_echo_object = glyph->object;
27760 help_echo_pos = glyph->charpos;
27761 }
27762 }
27763 }
27764 if (NILP (pointer))
27765 pointer = Fplist_get (XCDR (img->spec), QCpointer);
27766 }
27767 }
27768 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
27769
27770 /* Clear mouse face if X/Y not over text. */
27771 if (glyph == NULL
27772 || area != TEXT_AREA
27773 || !MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos)->displays_text_p
27774 /* Glyph's OBJECT is an integer for glyphs inserted by the
27775 display engine for its internal purposes, like truncation
27776 and continuation glyphs and blanks beyond the end of
27777 line's text on text terminals. If we are over such a
27778 glyph, we are not over any text. */
27779 || INTEGERP (glyph->object)
27780 /* R2L rows have a stretch glyph at their front, which
27781 stands for no text, whereas L2R rows have no glyphs at
27782 all beyond the end of text. Treat such stretch glyphs
27783 like we do with NULL glyphs in L2R rows. */
27784 || (MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos)->reversed_p
27785 && glyph == MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos)->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]
27786 && glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
27787 && glyph->avoid_cursor_p))
27788 {
27789 if (clear_mouse_face (hlinfo))
27790 cursor = No_Cursor;
27791 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
27792 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f) && NILP (pointer))
27793 {
27794 if (area != TEXT_AREA)
27795 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->nontext_cursor;
27796 else
27797 pointer = Vvoid_text_area_pointer;
27798 }
27799 #endif
27800 goto set_cursor;
27801 }
27802
27803 pos = glyph->charpos;
27804 object = glyph->object;
27805 if (!STRINGP (object) && !BUFFERP (object))
27806 goto set_cursor;
27807
27808 /* If we get an out-of-range value, return now; avoid an error. */
27809 if (BUFFERP (object) && pos > BUF_Z (b))
27810 goto set_cursor;
27811
27812 /* Make the window's buffer temporarily current for
27813 overlays_at and compute_char_face. */
27814 obuf = current_buffer;
27815 current_buffer = b;
27816 obegv = BEGV;
27817 ozv = ZV;
27818 BEGV = BEG;
27819 ZV = Z;
27820
27821 /* Is this char mouse-active or does it have help-echo? */
27822 position = make_number (pos);
27823
27824 if (BUFFERP (object))
27825 {
27826 /* Put all the overlays we want in a vector in overlay_vec. */
27827 GET_OVERLAYS_AT (pos, overlay_vec, noverlays, NULL, 0);
27828 /* Sort overlays into increasing priority order. */
27829 noverlays = sort_overlays (overlay_vec, noverlays, w);
27830 }
27831 else
27832 noverlays = 0;
27833
27834 same_region = coords_in_mouse_face_p (w, hpos, vpos);
27835
27836 if (same_region)
27837 cursor = No_Cursor;
27838
27839 /* Check mouse-face highlighting. */
27840 if (! same_region
27841 /* If there exists an overlay with mouse-face overlapping
27842 the one we are currently highlighting, we have to
27843 check if we enter the overlapping overlay, and then
27844 highlight only that. */
27845 || (OVERLAYP (hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay)
27846 && mouse_face_overlay_overlaps (hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay)))
27847 {
27848 /* Find the highest priority overlay with a mouse-face. */
27849 Lisp_Object overlay = Qnil;
27850 for (i = noverlays - 1; i >= 0 && NILP (overlay); --i)
27851 {
27852 mouse_face = Foverlay_get (overlay_vec[i], Qmouse_face);
27853 if (!NILP (mouse_face))
27854 overlay = overlay_vec[i];
27855 }
27856
27857 /* If we're highlighting the same overlay as before, there's
27858 no need to do that again. */
27859 if (!NILP (overlay) && EQ (overlay, hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay))
27860 goto check_help_echo;
27861 hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay = overlay;
27862
27863 /* Clear the display of the old active region, if any. */
27864 if (clear_mouse_face (hlinfo))
27865 cursor = No_Cursor;
27866
27867 /* If no overlay applies, get a text property. */
27868 if (NILP (overlay))
27869 mouse_face = Fget_text_property (position, Qmouse_face, object);
27870
27871 /* Next, compute the bounds of the mouse highlighting and
27872 display it. */
27873 if (!NILP (mouse_face) && STRINGP (object))
27874 {
27875 /* The mouse-highlighting comes from a display string
27876 with a mouse-face. */
27877 Lisp_Object s, e;
27878 ptrdiff_t ignore;
27879
27880 s = Fprevious_single_property_change
27881 (make_number (pos + 1), Qmouse_face, object, Qnil);
27882 e = Fnext_single_property_change
27883 (position, Qmouse_face, object, Qnil);
27884 if (NILP (s))
27885 s = make_number (0);
27886 if (NILP (e))
27887 e = make_number (SCHARS (object) - 1);
27888 mouse_face_from_string_pos (w, hlinfo, object,
27889 XINT (s), XINT (e));
27890 hlinfo->mouse_face_past_end = 0;
27891 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = window;
27892 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id
27893 = face_at_string_position (w, object, pos, 0, 0, 0, &ignore,
27894 glyph->face_id, 1);
27895 show_mouse_face (hlinfo, DRAW_MOUSE_FACE);
27896 cursor = No_Cursor;
27897 }
27898 else
27899 {
27900 /* The mouse-highlighting, if any, comes from an overlay
27901 or text property in the buffer. */
27902 Lisp_Object buffer IF_LINT (= Qnil);
27903 Lisp_Object disp_string IF_LINT (= Qnil);
27904
27905 if (STRINGP (object))
27906 {
27907 /* If we are on a display string with no mouse-face,
27908 check if the text under it has one. */
27909 struct glyph_row *r = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
27910 ptrdiff_t start = MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (r);
27911 pos = string_buffer_position (object, start);
27912 if (pos > 0)
27913 {
27914 mouse_face = get_char_property_and_overlay
27915 (make_number (pos), Qmouse_face, w->buffer, &overlay);
27916 buffer = w->buffer;
27917 disp_string = object;
27918 }
27919 }
27920 else
27921 {
27922 buffer = object;
27923 disp_string = Qnil;
27924 }
27925
27926 if (!NILP (mouse_face))
27927 {
27928 Lisp_Object before, after;
27929 Lisp_Object before_string, after_string;
27930 /* To correctly find the limits of mouse highlight
27931 in a bidi-reordered buffer, we must not use the
27932 optimization of limiting the search in
27933 previous-single-property-change and
27934 next-single-property-change, because
27935 rows_from_pos_range needs the real start and end
27936 positions to DTRT in this case. That's because
27937 the first row visible in a window does not
27938 necessarily display the character whose position
27939 is the smallest. */
27940 Lisp_Object lim1 =
27941 NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (buffer), bidi_display_reordering))
27942 ? Fmarker_position (w->start)
27943 : Qnil;
27944 Lisp_Object lim2 =
27945 NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (buffer), bidi_display_reordering))
27946 ? make_number (BUF_Z (XBUFFER (buffer))
27947 - XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos))
27948 : Qnil;
27949
27950 if (NILP (overlay))
27951 {
27952 /* Handle the text property case. */
27953 before = Fprevious_single_property_change
27954 (make_number (pos + 1), Qmouse_face, buffer, lim1);
27955 after = Fnext_single_property_change
27956 (make_number (pos), Qmouse_face, buffer, lim2);
27957 before_string = after_string = Qnil;
27958 }
27959 else
27960 {
27961 /* Handle the overlay case. */
27962 before = Foverlay_start (overlay);
27963 after = Foverlay_end (overlay);
27964 before_string = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qbefore_string);
27965 after_string = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qafter_string);
27966
27967 if (!STRINGP (before_string)) before_string = Qnil;
27968 if (!STRINGP (after_string)) after_string = Qnil;
27969 }
27970
27971 mouse_face_from_buffer_pos (window, hlinfo, pos,
27972 NILP (before)
27973 ? 1
27974 : XFASTINT (before),
27975 NILP (after)
27976 ? BUF_Z (XBUFFER (buffer))
27977 : XFASTINT (after),
27978 before_string, after_string,
27979 disp_string);
27980 cursor = No_Cursor;
27981 }
27982 }
27983 }
27984
27985 check_help_echo:
27986
27987 /* Look for a `help-echo' property. */
27988 if (NILP (help_echo_string)) {
27989 Lisp_Object help, overlay;
27990
27991 /* Check overlays first. */
27992 help = overlay = Qnil;
27993 for (i = noverlays - 1; i >= 0 && NILP (help); --i)
27994 {
27995 overlay = overlay_vec[i];
27996 help = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qhelp_echo);
27997 }
27998
27999 if (!NILP (help))
28000 {
28001 help_echo_string = help;
28002 help_echo_window = window;
28003 help_echo_object = overlay;
28004 help_echo_pos = pos;
28005 }
28006 else
28007 {
28008 Lisp_Object obj = glyph->object;
28009 ptrdiff_t charpos = glyph->charpos;
28010
28011 /* Try text properties. */
28012 if (STRINGP (obj)
28013 && charpos >= 0
28014 && charpos < SCHARS (obj))
28015 {
28016 help = Fget_text_property (make_number (charpos),
28017 Qhelp_echo, obj);
28018 if (NILP (help))
28019 {
28020 /* If the string itself doesn't specify a help-echo,
28021 see if the buffer text ``under'' it does. */
28022 struct glyph_row *r
28023 = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
28024 ptrdiff_t start = MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (r);
28025 ptrdiff_t p = string_buffer_position (obj, start);
28026 if (p > 0)
28027 {
28028 help = Fget_char_property (make_number (p),
28029 Qhelp_echo, w->buffer);
28030 if (!NILP (help))
28031 {
28032 charpos = p;
28033 obj = w->buffer;
28034 }
28035 }
28036 }
28037 }
28038 else if (BUFFERP (obj)
28039 && charpos >= BEGV
28040 && charpos < ZV)
28041 help = Fget_text_property (make_number (charpos), Qhelp_echo,
28042 obj);
28043
28044 if (!NILP (help))
28045 {
28046 help_echo_string = help;
28047 help_echo_window = window;
28048 help_echo_object = obj;
28049 help_echo_pos = charpos;
28050 }
28051 }
28052 }
28053
28054 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
28055 /* Look for a `pointer' property. */
28056 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f) && NILP (pointer))
28057 {
28058 /* Check overlays first. */
28059 for (i = noverlays - 1; i >= 0 && NILP (pointer); --i)
28060 pointer = Foverlay_get (overlay_vec[i], Qpointer);
28061
28062 if (NILP (pointer))
28063 {
28064 Lisp_Object obj = glyph->object;
28065 ptrdiff_t charpos = glyph->charpos;
28066
28067 /* Try text properties. */
28068 if (STRINGP (obj)
28069 && charpos >= 0
28070 && charpos < SCHARS (obj))
28071 {
28072 pointer = Fget_text_property (make_number (charpos),
28073 Qpointer, obj);
28074 if (NILP (pointer))
28075 {
28076 /* If the string itself doesn't specify a pointer,
28077 see if the buffer text ``under'' it does. */
28078 struct glyph_row *r
28079 = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
28080 ptrdiff_t start = MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (r);
28081 ptrdiff_t p = string_buffer_position (obj, start);
28082 if (p > 0)
28083 pointer = Fget_char_property (make_number (p),
28084 Qpointer, w->buffer);
28085 }
28086 }
28087 else if (BUFFERP (obj)
28088 && charpos >= BEGV
28089 && charpos < ZV)
28090 pointer = Fget_text_property (make_number (charpos),
28091 Qpointer, obj);
28092 }
28093 }
28094 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
28095
28096 BEGV = obegv;
28097 ZV = ozv;
28098 current_buffer = obuf;
28099 }
28100
28101 set_cursor:
28102
28103 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
28104 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
28105 define_frame_cursor1 (f, cursor, pointer);
28106 #else
28107 /* This is here to prevent a compiler error, about "label at end of
28108 compound statement". */
28109 return;
28110 #endif
28111 }
28112
28113
28114 /* EXPORT for RIF:
28115 Clear any mouse-face on window W. This function is part of the
28116 redisplay interface, and is called from try_window_id and similar
28117 functions to ensure the mouse-highlight is off. */
28118
28119 void
28120 x_clear_window_mouse_face (struct window *w)
28121 {
28122 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
28123 Lisp_Object window;
28124
28125 BLOCK_INPUT;
28126 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
28127 if (EQ (window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window))
28128 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
28129 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
28130 }
28131
28132
28133 /* EXPORT:
28134 Just discard the mouse face information for frame F, if any.
28135 This is used when the size of F is changed. */
28136
28137 void
28138 cancel_mouse_face (struct frame *f)
28139 {
28140 Lisp_Object window;
28141 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
28142
28143 window = hlinfo->mouse_face_window;
28144 if (! NILP (window) && XFRAME (XWINDOW (window)->frame) == f)
28145 {
28146 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
28147 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
28148 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
28149 }
28150 }
28151
28152
28153 \f
28154 /***********************************************************************
28155 Exposure Events
28156 ***********************************************************************/
28157
28158 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
28159
28160 /* Redraw the part of glyph row area AREA of glyph row ROW on window W
28161 which intersects rectangle R. R is in window-relative coordinates. */
28162
28163 static void
28164 expose_area (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, XRectangle *r,
28165 enum glyph_row_area area)
28166 {
28167 struct glyph *first = row->glyphs[area];
28168 struct glyph *end = row->glyphs[area] + row->used[area];
28169 struct glyph *last;
28170 int first_x, start_x, x;
28171
28172 if (area == TEXT_AREA && row->fill_line_p)
28173 /* If row extends face to end of line write the whole line. */
28174 draw_glyphs (w, 0, row, area,
28175 0, row->used[area],
28176 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, 0);
28177 else
28178 {
28179 /* Set START_X to the window-relative start position for drawing glyphs of
28180 AREA. The first glyph of the text area can be partially visible.
28181 The first glyphs of other areas cannot. */
28182 start_x = window_box_left_offset (w, area);
28183 x = start_x;
28184 if (area == TEXT_AREA)
28185 x += row->x;
28186
28187 /* Find the first glyph that must be redrawn. */
28188 while (first < end
28189 && x + first->pixel_width < r->x)
28190 {
28191 x += first->pixel_width;
28192 ++first;
28193 }
28194
28195 /* Find the last one. */
28196 last = first;
28197 first_x = x;
28198 while (last < end
28199 && x < r->x + r->width)
28200 {
28201 x += last->pixel_width;
28202 ++last;
28203 }
28204
28205 /* Repaint. */
28206 if (last > first)
28207 draw_glyphs (w, first_x - start_x, row, area,
28208 first - row->glyphs[area], last - row->glyphs[area],
28209 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, 0);
28210 }
28211 }
28212
28213
28214 /* Redraw the parts of the glyph row ROW on window W intersecting
28215 rectangle R. R is in window-relative coordinates. Value is
28216 non-zero if mouse-face was overwritten. */
28217
28218 static int
28219 expose_line (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, XRectangle *r)
28220 {
28221 eassert (row->enabled_p);
28222
28223 if (row->mode_line_p || w->pseudo_window_p)
28224 draw_glyphs (w, 0, row, TEXT_AREA,
28225 0, row->used[TEXT_AREA],
28226 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, 0);
28227 else
28228 {
28229 if (row->used[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA])
28230 expose_area (w, row, r, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA);
28231 if (row->used[TEXT_AREA])
28232 expose_area (w, row, r, TEXT_AREA);
28233 if (row->used[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA])
28234 expose_area (w, row, r, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA);
28235 draw_row_fringe_bitmaps (w, row);
28236 }
28237
28238 return row->mouse_face_p;
28239 }
28240
28241
28242 /* Redraw those parts of glyphs rows during expose event handling that
28243 overlap other rows. Redrawing of an exposed line writes over parts
28244 of lines overlapping that exposed line; this function fixes that.
28245
28246 W is the window being exposed. FIRST_OVERLAPPING_ROW is the first
28247 row in W's current matrix that is exposed and overlaps other rows.
28248 LAST_OVERLAPPING_ROW is the last such row. */
28249
28250 static void
28251 expose_overlaps (struct window *w,
28252 struct glyph_row *first_overlapping_row,
28253 struct glyph_row *last_overlapping_row,
28254 XRectangle *r)
28255 {
28256 struct glyph_row *row;
28257
28258 for (row = first_overlapping_row; row <= last_overlapping_row; ++row)
28259 if (row->overlapping_p)
28260 {
28261 eassert (row->enabled_p && !row->mode_line_p);
28262
28263 row->clip = r;
28264 if (row->used[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA])
28265 x_fix_overlapping_area (w, row, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA, OVERLAPS_BOTH);
28266
28267 if (row->used[TEXT_AREA])
28268 x_fix_overlapping_area (w, row, TEXT_AREA, OVERLAPS_BOTH);
28269
28270 if (row->used[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA])
28271 x_fix_overlapping_area (w, row, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA, OVERLAPS_BOTH);
28272 row->clip = NULL;
28273 }
28274 }
28275
28276
28277 /* Return non-zero if W's cursor intersects rectangle R. */
28278
28279 static int
28280 phys_cursor_in_rect_p (struct window *w, XRectangle *r)
28281 {
28282 XRectangle cr, result;
28283 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
28284 struct glyph_row *row;
28285
28286 if (w->phys_cursor.vpos >= 0
28287 && w->phys_cursor.vpos < w->current_matrix->nrows
28288 && (row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos),
28289 row->enabled_p)
28290 && row->cursor_in_fringe_p)
28291 {
28292 /* Cursor is in the fringe. */
28293 cr.x = window_box_right_offset (w,
28294 (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
28295 ? RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA
28296 : TEXT_AREA));
28297 cr.y = row->y;
28298 cr.width = WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w);
28299 cr.height = row->height;
28300 return x_intersect_rectangles (&cr, r, &result);
28301 }
28302
28303 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
28304 if (cursor_glyph)
28305 {
28306 /* r is relative to W's box, but w->phys_cursor.x is relative
28307 to left edge of W's TEXT area. Adjust it. */
28308 cr.x = window_box_left_offset (w, TEXT_AREA) + w->phys_cursor.x;
28309 cr.y = w->phys_cursor.y;
28310 cr.width = cursor_glyph->pixel_width;
28311 cr.height = w->phys_cursor_height;
28312 /* ++KFS: W32 version used W32-specific IntersectRect here, but
28313 I assume the effect is the same -- and this is portable. */
28314 return x_intersect_rectangles (&cr, r, &result);
28315 }
28316 /* If we don't understand the format, pretend we're not in the hot-spot. */
28317 return 0;
28318 }
28319
28320
28321 /* EXPORT:
28322 Draw a vertical window border to the right of window W if W doesn't
28323 have vertical scroll bars. */
28324
28325 void
28326 x_draw_vertical_border (struct window *w)
28327 {
28328 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
28329
28330 /* We could do better, if we knew what type of scroll-bar the adjacent
28331 windows (on either side) have... But we don't :-(
28332 However, I think this works ok. ++KFS 2003-04-25 */
28333
28334 /* Redraw borders between horizontally adjacent windows. Don't
28335 do it for frames with vertical scroll bars because either the
28336 right scroll bar of a window, or the left scroll bar of its
28337 neighbor will suffice as a border. */
28338 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (w->frame)))
28339 return;
28340
28341 if (!WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
28342 && !WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
28343 {
28344 int x0, x1, y0, y1;
28345
28346 window_box_edges (w, -1, &x0, &y0, &x1, &y1);
28347 y1 -= 1;
28348
28349 if (WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w) == 0)
28350 x1 -= 1;
28351
28352 FRAME_RIF (f)->draw_vertical_window_border (w, x1, y0, y1);
28353 }
28354 else if (!WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
28355 && !WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
28356 {
28357 int x0, x1, y0, y1;
28358
28359 window_box_edges (w, -1, &x0, &y0, &x1, &y1);
28360 y1 -= 1;
28361
28362 if (WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w) == 0)
28363 x0 -= 1;
28364
28365 FRAME_RIF (f)->draw_vertical_window_border (w, x0, y0, y1);
28366 }
28367 }
28368
28369
28370 /* Redraw the part of window W intersection rectangle FR. Pixel
28371 coordinates in FR are frame-relative. Call this function with
28372 input blocked. Value is non-zero if the exposure overwrites
28373 mouse-face. */
28374
28375 static int
28376 expose_window (struct window *w, XRectangle *fr)
28377 {
28378 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
28379 XRectangle wr, r;
28380 int mouse_face_overwritten_p = 0;
28381
28382 /* If window is not yet fully initialized, do nothing. This can
28383 happen when toolkit scroll bars are used and a window is split.
28384 Reconfiguring the scroll bar will generate an expose for a newly
28385 created window. */
28386 if (w->current_matrix == NULL)
28387 return 0;
28388
28389 /* When we're currently updating the window, display and current
28390 matrix usually don't agree. Arrange for a thorough display
28391 later. */
28392 if (w == updated_window)
28393 {
28394 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
28395 return 0;
28396 }
28397
28398 /* Frame-relative pixel rectangle of W. */
28399 wr.x = WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (w);
28400 wr.y = WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_Y (w);
28401 wr.width = WINDOW_TOTAL_WIDTH (w);
28402 wr.height = WINDOW_TOTAL_HEIGHT (w);
28403
28404 if (x_intersect_rectangles (fr, &wr, &r))
28405 {
28406 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w);
28407 struct glyph_row *row;
28408 int cursor_cleared_p, phys_cursor_on_p;
28409 struct glyph_row *first_overlapping_row, *last_overlapping_row;
28410
28411 TRACE ((stderr, "expose_window (%d, %d, %d, %d)\n",
28412 r.x, r.y, r.width, r.height));
28413
28414 /* Convert to window coordinates. */
28415 r.x -= WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (w);
28416 r.y -= WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_Y (w);
28417
28418 /* Turn off the cursor. */
28419 if (!w->pseudo_window_p
28420 && phys_cursor_in_rect_p (w, &r))
28421 {
28422 x_clear_cursor (w);
28423 cursor_cleared_p = 1;
28424 }
28425 else
28426 cursor_cleared_p = 0;
28427
28428 /* If the row containing the cursor extends face to end of line,
28429 then expose_area might overwrite the cursor outside the
28430 rectangle and thus notice_overwritten_cursor might clear
28431 w->phys_cursor_on_p. We remember the original value and
28432 check later if it is changed. */
28433 phys_cursor_on_p = w->phys_cursor_on_p;
28434
28435 /* Update lines intersecting rectangle R. */
28436 first_overlapping_row = last_overlapping_row = NULL;
28437 for (row = w->current_matrix->rows;
28438 row->enabled_p;
28439 ++row)
28440 {
28441 int y0 = row->y;
28442 int y1 = MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row);
28443
28444 if ((y0 >= r.y && y0 < r.y + r.height)
28445 || (y1 > r.y && y1 < r.y + r.height)
28446 || (r.y >= y0 && r.y < y1)
28447 || (r.y + r.height > y0 && r.y + r.height < y1))
28448 {
28449 /* A header line may be overlapping, but there is no need
28450 to fix overlapping areas for them. KFS 2005-02-12 */
28451 if (row->overlapping_p && !row->mode_line_p)
28452 {
28453 if (first_overlapping_row == NULL)
28454 first_overlapping_row = row;
28455 last_overlapping_row = row;
28456 }
28457
28458 row->clip = fr;
28459 if (expose_line (w, row, &r))
28460 mouse_face_overwritten_p = 1;
28461 row->clip = NULL;
28462 }
28463 else if (row->overlapping_p)
28464 {
28465 /* We must redraw a row overlapping the exposed area. */
28466 if (y0 < r.y
28467 ? y0 + row->phys_height > r.y
28468 : y0 + row->ascent - row->phys_ascent < r.y +r.height)
28469 {
28470 if (first_overlapping_row == NULL)
28471 first_overlapping_row = row;
28472 last_overlapping_row = row;
28473 }
28474 }
28475
28476 if (y1 >= yb)
28477 break;
28478 }
28479
28480 /* Display the mode line if there is one. */
28481 if (WINDOW_WANTS_MODELINE_P (w)
28482 && (row = MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix),
28483 row->enabled_p)
28484 && row->y < r.y + r.height)
28485 {
28486 if (expose_line (w, row, &r))
28487 mouse_face_overwritten_p = 1;
28488 }
28489
28490 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
28491 {
28492 /* Fix the display of overlapping rows. */
28493 if (first_overlapping_row)
28494 expose_overlaps (w, first_overlapping_row, last_overlapping_row,
28495 fr);
28496
28497 /* Draw border between windows. */
28498 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
28499
28500 /* Turn the cursor on again. */
28501 if (cursor_cleared_p
28502 || (phys_cursor_on_p && !w->phys_cursor_on_p))
28503 update_window_cursor (w, 1);
28504 }
28505 }
28506
28507 return mouse_face_overwritten_p;
28508 }
28509
28510
28511
28512 /* Redraw (parts) of all windows in the window tree rooted at W that
28513 intersect R. R contains frame pixel coordinates. Value is
28514 non-zero if the exposure overwrites mouse-face. */
28515
28516 static int
28517 expose_window_tree (struct window *w, XRectangle *r)
28518 {
28519 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
28520 int mouse_face_overwritten_p = 0;
28521
28522 while (w && !FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
28523 {
28524 if (!NILP (w->hchild))
28525 mouse_face_overwritten_p
28526 |= expose_window_tree (XWINDOW (w->hchild), r);
28527 else if (!NILP (w->vchild))
28528 mouse_face_overwritten_p
28529 |= expose_window_tree (XWINDOW (w->vchild), r);
28530 else
28531 mouse_face_overwritten_p |= expose_window (w, r);
28532
28533 w = NILP (w->next) ? NULL : XWINDOW (w->next);
28534 }
28535
28536 return mouse_face_overwritten_p;
28537 }
28538
28539
28540 /* EXPORT:
28541 Redisplay an exposed area of frame F. X and Y are the upper-left
28542 corner of the exposed rectangle. W and H are width and height of
28543 the exposed area. All are pixel values. W or H zero means redraw
28544 the entire frame. */
28545
28546 void
28547 expose_frame (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int w, int h)
28548 {
28549 XRectangle r;
28550 int mouse_face_overwritten_p = 0;
28551
28552 TRACE ((stderr, "expose_frame "));
28553
28554 /* No need to redraw if frame will be redrawn soon. */
28555 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
28556 {
28557 TRACE ((stderr, " garbaged\n"));
28558 return;
28559 }
28560
28561 /* If basic faces haven't been realized yet, there is no point in
28562 trying to redraw anything. This can happen when we get an expose
28563 event while Emacs is starting, e.g. by moving another window. */
28564 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f) == NULL
28565 || FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f)->used < BASIC_FACE_ID_SENTINEL)
28566 {
28567 TRACE ((stderr, " no faces\n"));
28568 return;
28569 }
28570
28571 if (w == 0 || h == 0)
28572 {
28573 r.x = r.y = 0;
28574 r.width = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) * FRAME_COLS (f);
28575 r.height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) * FRAME_LINES (f);
28576 }
28577 else
28578 {
28579 r.x = x;
28580 r.y = y;
28581 r.width = w;
28582 r.height = h;
28583 }
28584
28585 TRACE ((stderr, "(%d, %d, %d, %d)\n", r.x, r.y, r.width, r.height));
28586 mouse_face_overwritten_p = expose_window_tree (XWINDOW (f->root_window), &r);
28587
28588 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window))
28589 mouse_face_overwritten_p
28590 |= expose_window (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window), &r);
28591
28592 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
28593 #ifndef MSDOS
28594 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
28595 if (WINDOWP (f->menu_bar_window))
28596 mouse_face_overwritten_p
28597 |= expose_window (XWINDOW (f->menu_bar_window), &r);
28598 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
28599 #endif
28600 #endif
28601
28602 /* Some window managers support a focus-follows-mouse style with
28603 delayed raising of frames. Imagine a partially obscured frame,
28604 and moving the mouse into partially obscured mouse-face on that
28605 frame. The visible part of the mouse-face will be highlighted,
28606 then the WM raises the obscured frame. With at least one WM, KDE
28607 2.1, Emacs is not getting any event for the raising of the frame
28608 (even tried with SubstructureRedirectMask), only Expose events.
28609 These expose events will draw text normally, i.e. not
28610 highlighted. Which means we must redo the highlight here.
28611 Subsume it under ``we love X''. --gerd 2001-08-15 */
28612 /* Included in Windows version because Windows most likely does not
28613 do the right thing if any third party tool offers
28614 focus-follows-mouse with delayed raise. --jason 2001-10-12 */
28615 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p && !FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
28616 {
28617 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
28618 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
28619 {
28620 int mouse_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x;
28621 int mouse_y = hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y;
28622 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
28623 note_mouse_highlight (f, mouse_x, mouse_y);
28624 }
28625 }
28626 }
28627
28628
28629 /* EXPORT:
28630 Determine the intersection of two rectangles R1 and R2. Return
28631 the intersection in *RESULT. Value is non-zero if RESULT is not
28632 empty. */
28633
28634 int
28635 x_intersect_rectangles (XRectangle *r1, XRectangle *r2, XRectangle *result)
28636 {
28637 XRectangle *left, *right;
28638 XRectangle *upper, *lower;
28639 int intersection_p = 0;
28640
28641 /* Rearrange so that R1 is the left-most rectangle. */
28642 if (r1->x < r2->x)
28643 left = r1, right = r2;
28644 else
28645 left = r2, right = r1;
28646
28647 /* X0 of the intersection is right.x0, if this is inside R1,
28648 otherwise there is no intersection. */
28649 if (right->x <= left->x + left->width)
28650 {
28651 result->x = right->x;
28652
28653 /* The right end of the intersection is the minimum of
28654 the right ends of left and right. */
28655 result->width = (min (left->x + left->width, right->x + right->width)
28656 - result->x);
28657
28658 /* Same game for Y. */
28659 if (r1->y < r2->y)
28660 upper = r1, lower = r2;
28661 else
28662 upper = r2, lower = r1;
28663
28664 /* The upper end of the intersection is lower.y0, if this is inside
28665 of upper. Otherwise, there is no intersection. */
28666 if (lower->y <= upper->y + upper->height)
28667 {
28668 result->y = lower->y;
28669
28670 /* The lower end of the intersection is the minimum of the lower
28671 ends of upper and lower. */
28672 result->height = (min (lower->y + lower->height,
28673 upper->y + upper->height)
28674 - result->y);
28675 intersection_p = 1;
28676 }
28677 }
28678
28679 return intersection_p;
28680 }
28681
28682 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
28683
28684 \f
28685 /***********************************************************************
28686 Initialization
28687 ***********************************************************************/
28688
28689 void
28690 syms_of_xdisp (void)
28691 {
28692 Vwith_echo_area_save_vector = Qnil;
28693 staticpro (&Vwith_echo_area_save_vector);
28694
28695 Vmessage_stack = Qnil;
28696 staticpro (&Vmessage_stack);
28697
28698 DEFSYM (Qinhibit_redisplay, "inhibit-redisplay");
28699
28700 message_dolog_marker1 = Fmake_marker ();
28701 staticpro (&message_dolog_marker1);
28702 message_dolog_marker2 = Fmake_marker ();
28703 staticpro (&message_dolog_marker2);
28704 message_dolog_marker3 = Fmake_marker ();
28705 staticpro (&message_dolog_marker3);
28706
28707 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
28708 defsubr (&Sdump_frame_glyph_matrix);
28709 defsubr (&Sdump_glyph_matrix);
28710 defsubr (&Sdump_glyph_row);
28711 defsubr (&Sdump_tool_bar_row);
28712 defsubr (&Strace_redisplay);
28713 defsubr (&Strace_to_stderr);
28714 #endif
28715 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
28716 defsubr (&Stool_bar_lines_needed);
28717 defsubr (&Slookup_image_map);
28718 #endif
28719 defsubr (&Sformat_mode_line);
28720 defsubr (&Sinvisible_p);
28721 defsubr (&Scurrent_bidi_paragraph_direction);
28722
28723 DEFSYM (Qmenu_bar_update_hook, "menu-bar-update-hook");
28724 DEFSYM (Qoverriding_terminal_local_map, "overriding-terminal-local-map");
28725 DEFSYM (Qoverriding_local_map, "overriding-local-map");
28726 DEFSYM (Qwindow_scroll_functions, "window-scroll-functions");
28727 DEFSYM (Qwindow_text_change_functions, "window-text-change-functions");
28728 DEFSYM (Qredisplay_end_trigger_functions, "redisplay-end-trigger-functions");
28729 DEFSYM (Qinhibit_point_motion_hooks, "inhibit-point-motion-hooks");
28730 DEFSYM (Qeval, "eval");
28731 DEFSYM (QCdata, ":data");
28732 DEFSYM (Qdisplay, "display");
28733 DEFSYM (Qspace_width, "space-width");
28734 DEFSYM (Qraise, "raise");
28735 DEFSYM (Qslice, "slice");
28736 DEFSYM (Qspace, "space");
28737 DEFSYM (Qmargin, "margin");
28738 DEFSYM (Qpointer, "pointer");
28739 DEFSYM (Qleft_margin, "left-margin");
28740 DEFSYM (Qright_margin, "right-margin");
28741 DEFSYM (Qcenter, "center");
28742 DEFSYM (Qline_height, "line-height");
28743 DEFSYM (QCalign_to, ":align-to");
28744 DEFSYM (QCrelative_width, ":relative-width");
28745 DEFSYM (QCrelative_height, ":relative-height");
28746 DEFSYM (QCeval, ":eval");
28747 DEFSYM (QCpropertize, ":propertize");
28748 DEFSYM (QCfile, ":file");
28749 DEFSYM (Qfontified, "fontified");
28750 DEFSYM (Qfontification_functions, "fontification-functions");
28751 DEFSYM (Qtrailing_whitespace, "trailing-whitespace");
28752 DEFSYM (Qescape_glyph, "escape-glyph");
28753 DEFSYM (Qnobreak_space, "nobreak-space");
28754 DEFSYM (Qimage, "image");
28755 DEFSYM (Qtext, "text");
28756 DEFSYM (Qboth, "both");
28757 DEFSYM (Qboth_horiz, "both-horiz");
28758 DEFSYM (Qtext_image_horiz, "text-image-horiz");
28759 DEFSYM (QCmap, ":map");
28760 DEFSYM (QCpointer, ":pointer");
28761 DEFSYM (Qrect, "rect");
28762 DEFSYM (Qcircle, "circle");
28763 DEFSYM (Qpoly, "poly");
28764 DEFSYM (Qmessage_truncate_lines, "message-truncate-lines");
28765 DEFSYM (Qgrow_only, "grow-only");
28766 DEFSYM (Qinhibit_menubar_update, "inhibit-menubar-update");
28767 DEFSYM (Qinhibit_eval_during_redisplay, "inhibit-eval-during-redisplay");
28768 DEFSYM (Qposition, "position");
28769 DEFSYM (Qbuffer_position, "buffer-position");
28770 DEFSYM (Qobject, "object");
28771 DEFSYM (Qbar, "bar");
28772 DEFSYM (Qhbar, "hbar");
28773 DEFSYM (Qbox, "box");
28774 DEFSYM (Qhollow, "hollow");
28775 DEFSYM (Qhand, "hand");
28776 DEFSYM (Qarrow, "arrow");
28777 DEFSYM (Qinhibit_free_realized_faces, "inhibit-free-realized-faces");
28778
28779 list_of_error = Fcons (Fcons (intern_c_string ("error"),
28780 Fcons (intern_c_string ("void-variable"), Qnil)),
28781 Qnil);
28782 staticpro (&list_of_error);
28783
28784 DEFSYM (Qlast_arrow_position, "last-arrow-position");
28785 DEFSYM (Qlast_arrow_string, "last-arrow-string");
28786 DEFSYM (Qoverlay_arrow_string, "overlay-arrow-string");
28787 DEFSYM (Qoverlay_arrow_bitmap, "overlay-arrow-bitmap");
28788
28789 echo_buffer[0] = echo_buffer[1] = Qnil;
28790 staticpro (&echo_buffer[0]);
28791 staticpro (&echo_buffer[1]);
28792
28793 echo_area_buffer[0] = echo_area_buffer[1] = Qnil;
28794 staticpro (&echo_area_buffer[0]);
28795 staticpro (&echo_area_buffer[1]);
28796
28797 Vmessages_buffer_name = build_pure_c_string ("*Messages*");
28798 staticpro (&Vmessages_buffer_name);
28799
28800 mode_line_proptrans_alist = Qnil;
28801 staticpro (&mode_line_proptrans_alist);
28802 mode_line_string_list = Qnil;
28803 staticpro (&mode_line_string_list);
28804 mode_line_string_face = Qnil;
28805 staticpro (&mode_line_string_face);
28806 mode_line_string_face_prop = Qnil;
28807 staticpro (&mode_line_string_face_prop);
28808 Vmode_line_unwind_vector = Qnil;
28809 staticpro (&Vmode_line_unwind_vector);
28810
28811 DEFSYM (Qmode_line_default_help_echo, "mode-line-default-help-echo");
28812
28813 help_echo_string = Qnil;
28814 staticpro (&help_echo_string);
28815 help_echo_object = Qnil;
28816 staticpro (&help_echo_object);
28817 help_echo_window = Qnil;
28818 staticpro (&help_echo_window);
28819 previous_help_echo_string = Qnil;
28820 staticpro (&previous_help_echo_string);
28821 help_echo_pos = -1;
28822
28823 DEFSYM (Qright_to_left, "right-to-left");
28824 DEFSYM (Qleft_to_right, "left-to-right");
28825
28826 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
28827 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-stretch-cursor", x_stretch_cursor_p,
28828 doc: /* Non-nil means draw block cursor as wide as the glyph under it.
28829 For example, if a block cursor is over a tab, it will be drawn as
28830 wide as that tab on the display. */);
28831 x_stretch_cursor_p = 0;
28832 #endif
28833
28834 DEFVAR_LISP ("show-trailing-whitespace", Vshow_trailing_whitespace,
28835 doc: /* Non-nil means highlight trailing whitespace.
28836 The face used for trailing whitespace is `trailing-whitespace'. */);
28837 Vshow_trailing_whitespace = Qnil;
28838
28839 DEFVAR_LISP ("nobreak-char-display", Vnobreak_char_display,
28840 doc: /* Control highlighting of non-ASCII space and hyphen chars.
28841 If the value is t, Emacs highlights non-ASCII chars which have the
28842 same appearance as an ASCII space or hyphen, using the `nobreak-space'
28843 or `escape-glyph' face respectively.
28844
28845 U+00A0 (no-break space), U+00AD (soft hyphen), U+2010 (hyphen), and
28846 U+2011 (non-breaking hyphen) are affected.
28847
28848 Any other non-nil value means to display these characters as a escape
28849 glyph followed by an ordinary space or hyphen.
28850
28851 A value of nil means no special handling of these characters. */);
28852 Vnobreak_char_display = Qt;
28853
28854 DEFVAR_LISP ("void-text-area-pointer", Vvoid_text_area_pointer,
28855 doc: /* The pointer shape to show in void text areas.
28856 A value of nil means to show the text pointer. Other options are `arrow',
28857 `text', `hand', `vdrag', `hdrag', `modeline', and `hourglass'. */);
28858 Vvoid_text_area_pointer = Qarrow;
28859
28860 DEFVAR_LISP ("inhibit-redisplay", Vinhibit_redisplay,
28861 doc: /* Non-nil means don't actually do any redisplay.
28862 This is used for internal purposes. */);
28863 Vinhibit_redisplay = Qnil;
28864
28865 DEFVAR_LISP ("global-mode-string", Vglobal_mode_string,
28866 doc: /* String (or mode line construct) included (normally) in `mode-line-format'. */);
28867 Vglobal_mode_string = Qnil;
28868
28869 DEFVAR_LISP ("overlay-arrow-position", Voverlay_arrow_position,
28870 doc: /* Marker for where to display an arrow on top of the buffer text.
28871 This must be the beginning of a line in order to work.
28872 See also `overlay-arrow-string'. */);
28873 Voverlay_arrow_position = Qnil;
28874
28875 DEFVAR_LISP ("overlay-arrow-string", Voverlay_arrow_string,
28876 doc: /* String to display as an arrow in non-window frames.
28877 See also `overlay-arrow-position'. */);
28878 Voverlay_arrow_string = build_pure_c_string ("=>");
28879
28880 DEFVAR_LISP ("overlay-arrow-variable-list", Voverlay_arrow_variable_list,
28881 doc: /* List of variables (symbols) which hold markers for overlay arrows.
28882 The symbols on this list are examined during redisplay to determine
28883 where to display overlay arrows. */);
28884 Voverlay_arrow_variable_list
28885 = Fcons (intern_c_string ("overlay-arrow-position"), Qnil);
28886
28887 DEFVAR_INT ("scroll-step", emacs_scroll_step,
28888 doc: /* The number of lines to try scrolling a window by when point moves out.
28889 If that fails to bring point back on frame, point is centered instead.
28890 If this is zero, point is always centered after it moves off frame.
28891 If you want scrolling to always be a line at a time, you should set
28892 `scroll-conservatively' to a large value rather than set this to 1. */);
28893
28894 DEFVAR_INT ("scroll-conservatively", scroll_conservatively,
28895 doc: /* Scroll up to this many lines, to bring point back on screen.
28896 If point moves off-screen, redisplay will scroll by up to
28897 `scroll-conservatively' lines in order to bring point just barely
28898 onto the screen again. If that cannot be done, then redisplay
28899 recenters point as usual.
28900
28901 If the value is greater than 100, redisplay will never recenter point,
28902 but will always scroll just enough text to bring point into view, even
28903 if you move far away.
28904
28905 A value of zero means always recenter point if it moves off screen. */);
28906 scroll_conservatively = 0;
28907
28908 DEFVAR_INT ("scroll-margin", scroll_margin,
28909 doc: /* Number of lines of margin at the top and bottom of a window.
28910 Recenter the window whenever point gets within this many lines
28911 of the top or bottom of the window. */);
28912 scroll_margin = 0;
28913
28914 DEFVAR_LISP ("display-pixels-per-inch", Vdisplay_pixels_per_inch,
28915 doc: /* Pixels per inch value for non-window system displays.
28916 Value is a number or a cons (WIDTH-DPI . HEIGHT-DPI). */);
28917 Vdisplay_pixels_per_inch = make_float (72.0);
28918
28919 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
28920 DEFVAR_INT ("debug-end-pos", debug_end_pos, doc: /* Don't ask. */);
28921 #endif
28922
28923 DEFVAR_LISP ("truncate-partial-width-windows",
28924 Vtruncate_partial_width_windows,
28925 doc: /* Non-nil means truncate lines in windows narrower than the frame.
28926 For an integer value, truncate lines in each window narrower than the
28927 full frame width, provided the window width is less than that integer;
28928 otherwise, respect the value of `truncate-lines'.
28929
28930 For any other non-nil value, truncate lines in all windows that do
28931 not span the full frame width.
28932
28933 A value of nil means to respect the value of `truncate-lines'.
28934
28935 If `word-wrap' is enabled, you might want to reduce this. */);
28936 Vtruncate_partial_width_windows = make_number (50);
28937
28938 DEFVAR_BOOL ("mode-line-inverse-video", mode_line_inverse_video,
28939 doc: /* When nil, display the mode-line/header-line/menu-bar in the default face.
28940 Any other value means to use the appropriate face, `mode-line',
28941 `header-line', or `menu' respectively. */);
28942 mode_line_inverse_video = 1;
28943
28944 DEFVAR_LISP ("line-number-display-limit", Vline_number_display_limit,
28945 doc: /* Maximum buffer size for which line number should be displayed.
28946 If the buffer is bigger than this, the line number does not appear
28947 in the mode line. A value of nil means no limit. */);
28948 Vline_number_display_limit = Qnil;
28949
28950 DEFVAR_INT ("line-number-display-limit-width",
28951 line_number_display_limit_width,
28952 doc: /* Maximum line width (in characters) for line number display.
28953 If the average length of the lines near point is bigger than this, then the
28954 line number may be omitted from the mode line. */);
28955 line_number_display_limit_width = 200;
28956
28957 DEFVAR_BOOL ("highlight-nonselected-windows", highlight_nonselected_windows,
28958 doc: /* Non-nil means highlight region even in nonselected windows. */);
28959 highlight_nonselected_windows = 0;
28960
28961 DEFVAR_BOOL ("multiple-frames", multiple_frames,
28962 doc: /* Non-nil if more than one frame is visible on this display.
28963 Minibuffer-only frames don't count, but iconified frames do.
28964 This variable is not guaranteed to be accurate except while processing
28965 `frame-title-format' and `icon-title-format'. */);
28966
28967 DEFVAR_LISP ("frame-title-format", Vframe_title_format,
28968 doc: /* Template for displaying the title bar of visible frames.
28969 \(Assuming the window manager supports this feature.)
28970
28971 This variable has the same structure as `mode-line-format', except that
28972 the %c and %l constructs are ignored. It is used only on frames for
28973 which no explicit name has been set \(see `modify-frame-parameters'). */);
28974
28975 DEFVAR_LISP ("icon-title-format", Vicon_title_format,
28976 doc: /* Template for displaying the title bar of an iconified frame.
28977 \(Assuming the window manager supports this feature.)
28978 This variable has the same structure as `mode-line-format' (which see),
28979 and is used only on frames for which no explicit name has been set
28980 \(see `modify-frame-parameters'). */);
28981 Vicon_title_format
28982 = Vframe_title_format
28983 = listn (CONSTYPE_PURE, 3,
28984 intern_c_string ("multiple-frames"),
28985 build_pure_c_string ("%b"),
28986 listn (CONSTYPE_PURE, 4,
28987 empty_unibyte_string,
28988 intern_c_string ("invocation-name"),
28989 build_pure_c_string ("@"),
28990 intern_c_string ("system-name")));
28991
28992 DEFVAR_LISP ("message-log-max", Vmessage_log_max,
28993 doc: /* Maximum number of lines to keep in the message log buffer.
28994 If nil, disable message logging. If t, log messages but don't truncate
28995 the buffer when it becomes large. */);
28996 Vmessage_log_max = make_number (100);
28997
28998 DEFVAR_LISP ("window-size-change-functions", Vwindow_size_change_functions,
28999 doc: /* Functions called before redisplay, if window sizes have changed.
29000 The value should be a list of functions that take one argument.
29001 Just before redisplay, for each frame, if any of its windows have changed
29002 size since the last redisplay, or have been split or deleted,
29003 all the functions in the list are called, with the frame as argument. */);
29004 Vwindow_size_change_functions = Qnil;
29005
29006 DEFVAR_LISP ("window-scroll-functions", Vwindow_scroll_functions,
29007 doc: /* List of functions to call before redisplaying a window with scrolling.
29008 Each function is called with two arguments, the window and its new
29009 display-start position. Note that these functions are also called by
29010 `set-window-buffer'. Also note that the value of `window-end' is not
29011 valid when these functions are called.
29012
29013 Warning: Do not use this feature to alter the way the window
29014 is scrolled. It is not designed for that, and such use probably won't
29015 work. */);
29016 Vwindow_scroll_functions = Qnil;
29017
29018 DEFVAR_LISP ("window-text-change-functions",
29019 Vwindow_text_change_functions,
29020 doc: /* Functions to call in redisplay when text in the window might change. */);
29021 Vwindow_text_change_functions = Qnil;
29022
29023 DEFVAR_LISP ("redisplay-end-trigger-functions", Vredisplay_end_trigger_functions,
29024 doc: /* Functions called when redisplay of a window reaches the end trigger.
29025 Each function is called with two arguments, the window and the end trigger value.
29026 See `set-window-redisplay-end-trigger'. */);
29027 Vredisplay_end_trigger_functions = Qnil;
29028
29029 DEFVAR_LISP ("mouse-autoselect-window", Vmouse_autoselect_window,
29030 doc: /* Non-nil means autoselect window with mouse pointer.
29031 If nil, do not autoselect windows.
29032 A positive number means delay autoselection by that many seconds: a
29033 window is autoselected only after the mouse has remained in that
29034 window for the duration of the delay.
29035 A negative number has a similar effect, but causes windows to be
29036 autoselected only after the mouse has stopped moving. \(Because of
29037 the way Emacs compares mouse events, you will occasionally wait twice
29038 that time before the window gets selected.\)
29039 Any other value means to autoselect window instantaneously when the
29040 mouse pointer enters it.
29041
29042 Autoselection selects the minibuffer only if it is active, and never
29043 unselects the minibuffer if it is active.
29044
29045 When customizing this variable make sure that the actual value of
29046 `focus-follows-mouse' matches the behavior of your window manager. */);
29047 Vmouse_autoselect_window = Qnil;
29048
29049 DEFVAR_LISP ("auto-resize-tool-bars", Vauto_resize_tool_bars,
29050 doc: /* Non-nil means automatically resize tool-bars.
29051 This dynamically changes the tool-bar's height to the minimum height
29052 that is needed to make all tool-bar items visible.
29053 If value is `grow-only', the tool-bar's height is only increased
29054 automatically; to decrease the tool-bar height, use \\[recenter]. */);
29055 Vauto_resize_tool_bars = Qt;
29056
29057 DEFVAR_BOOL ("auto-raise-tool-bar-buttons", auto_raise_tool_bar_buttons_p,
29058 doc: /* Non-nil means raise tool-bar buttons when the mouse moves over them. */);
29059 auto_raise_tool_bar_buttons_p = 1;
29060
29061 DEFVAR_BOOL ("make-cursor-line-fully-visible", make_cursor_line_fully_visible_p,
29062 doc: /* Non-nil means to scroll (recenter) cursor line if it is not fully visible. */);
29063 make_cursor_line_fully_visible_p = 1;
29064
29065 DEFVAR_LISP ("tool-bar-border", Vtool_bar_border,
29066 doc: /* Border below tool-bar in pixels.
29067 If an integer, use it as the height of the border.
29068 If it is one of `internal-border-width' or `border-width', use the
29069 value of the corresponding frame parameter.
29070 Otherwise, no border is added below the tool-bar. */);
29071 Vtool_bar_border = Qinternal_border_width;
29072
29073 DEFVAR_LISP ("tool-bar-button-margin", Vtool_bar_button_margin,
29074 doc: /* Margin around tool-bar buttons in pixels.
29075 If an integer, use that for both horizontal and vertical margins.
29076 Otherwise, value should be a pair of integers `(HORZ . VERT)' with
29077 HORZ specifying the horizontal margin, and VERT specifying the
29078 vertical margin. */);
29079 Vtool_bar_button_margin = make_number (DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_MARGIN);
29080
29081 DEFVAR_INT ("tool-bar-button-relief", tool_bar_button_relief,
29082 doc: /* Relief thickness of tool-bar buttons. */);
29083 tool_bar_button_relief = DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
29084
29085 DEFVAR_LISP ("tool-bar-style", Vtool_bar_style,
29086 doc: /* Tool bar style to use.
29087 It can be one of
29088 image - show images only
29089 text - show text only
29090 both - show both, text below image
29091 both-horiz - show text to the right of the image
29092 text-image-horiz - show text to the left of the image
29093 any other - use system default or image if no system default.
29094
29095 This variable only affects the GTK+ toolkit version of Emacs. */);
29096 Vtool_bar_style = Qnil;
29097
29098 DEFVAR_INT ("tool-bar-max-label-size", tool_bar_max_label_size,
29099 doc: /* Maximum number of characters a label can have to be shown.
29100 The tool bar style must also show labels for this to have any effect, see
29101 `tool-bar-style'. */);
29102 tool_bar_max_label_size = DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_LABEL_SIZE;
29103
29104 DEFVAR_LISP ("fontification-functions", Vfontification_functions,
29105 doc: /* List of functions to call to fontify regions of text.
29106 Each function is called with one argument POS. Functions must
29107 fontify a region starting at POS in the current buffer, and give
29108 fontified regions the property `fontified'. */);
29109 Vfontification_functions = Qnil;
29110 Fmake_variable_buffer_local (Qfontification_functions);
29111
29112 DEFVAR_BOOL ("unibyte-display-via-language-environment",
29113 unibyte_display_via_language_environment,
29114 doc: /* Non-nil means display unibyte text according to language environment.
29115 Specifically, this means that raw bytes in the range 160-255 decimal
29116 are displayed by converting them to the equivalent multibyte characters
29117 according to the current language environment. As a result, they are
29118 displayed according to the current fontset.
29119
29120 Note that this variable affects only how these bytes are displayed,
29121 but does not change the fact they are interpreted as raw bytes. */);
29122 unibyte_display_via_language_environment = 0;
29123
29124 DEFVAR_LISP ("max-mini-window-height", Vmax_mini_window_height,
29125 doc: /* Maximum height for resizing mini-windows (the minibuffer and the echo area).
29126 If a float, it specifies a fraction of the mini-window frame's height.
29127 If an integer, it specifies a number of lines. */);
29128 Vmax_mini_window_height = make_float (0.25);
29129
29130 DEFVAR_LISP ("resize-mini-windows", Vresize_mini_windows,
29131 doc: /* How to resize mini-windows (the minibuffer and the echo area).
29132 A value of nil means don't automatically resize mini-windows.
29133 A value of t means resize them to fit the text displayed in them.
29134 A value of `grow-only', the default, means let mini-windows grow only;
29135 they return to their normal size when the minibuffer is closed, or the
29136 echo area becomes empty. */);
29137 Vresize_mini_windows = Qgrow_only;
29138
29139 DEFVAR_LISP ("blink-cursor-alist", Vblink_cursor_alist,
29140 doc: /* Alist specifying how to blink the cursor off.
29141 Each element has the form (ON-STATE . OFF-STATE). Whenever the
29142 `cursor-type' frame-parameter or variable equals ON-STATE,
29143 comparing using `equal', Emacs uses OFF-STATE to specify
29144 how to blink it off. ON-STATE and OFF-STATE are values for
29145 the `cursor-type' frame parameter.
29146
29147 If a frame's ON-STATE has no entry in this list,
29148 the frame's other specifications determine how to blink the cursor off. */);
29149 Vblink_cursor_alist = Qnil;
29150
29151 DEFVAR_BOOL ("auto-hscroll-mode", automatic_hscrolling_p,
29152 doc: /* Allow or disallow automatic horizontal scrolling of windows.
29153 If non-nil, windows are automatically scrolled horizontally to make
29154 point visible. */);
29155 automatic_hscrolling_p = 1;
29156 DEFSYM (Qauto_hscroll_mode, "auto-hscroll-mode");
29157
29158 DEFVAR_INT ("hscroll-margin", hscroll_margin,
29159 doc: /* How many columns away from the window edge point is allowed to get
29160 before automatic hscrolling will horizontally scroll the window. */);
29161 hscroll_margin = 5;
29162
29163 DEFVAR_LISP ("hscroll-step", Vhscroll_step,
29164 doc: /* How many columns to scroll the window when point gets too close to the edge.
29165 When point is less than `hscroll-margin' columns from the window
29166 edge, automatic hscrolling will scroll the window by the amount of columns
29167 determined by this variable. If its value is a positive integer, scroll that
29168 many columns. If it's a positive floating-point number, it specifies the
29169 fraction of the window's width to scroll. If it's nil or zero, point will be
29170 centered horizontally after the scroll. Any other value, including negative
29171 numbers, are treated as if the value were zero.
29172
29173 Automatic hscrolling always moves point outside the scroll margin, so if
29174 point was more than scroll step columns inside the margin, the window will
29175 scroll more than the value given by the scroll step.
29176
29177 Note that the lower bound for automatic hscrolling specified by `scroll-left'
29178 and `scroll-right' overrides this variable's effect. */);
29179 Vhscroll_step = make_number (0);
29180
29181 DEFVAR_BOOL ("message-truncate-lines", message_truncate_lines,
29182 doc: /* If non-nil, messages are truncated instead of resizing the echo area.
29183 Bind this around calls to `message' to let it take effect. */);
29184 message_truncate_lines = 0;
29185
29186 DEFVAR_LISP ("menu-bar-update-hook", Vmenu_bar_update_hook,
29187 doc: /* Normal hook run to update the menu bar definitions.
29188 Redisplay runs this hook before it redisplays the menu bar.
29189 This is used to update submenus such as Buffers,
29190 whose contents depend on various data. */);
29191 Vmenu_bar_update_hook = Qnil;
29192
29193 DEFVAR_LISP ("menu-updating-frame", Vmenu_updating_frame,
29194 doc: /* Frame for which we are updating a menu.
29195 The enable predicate for a menu binding should check this variable. */);
29196 Vmenu_updating_frame = Qnil;
29197
29198 DEFVAR_BOOL ("inhibit-menubar-update", inhibit_menubar_update,
29199 doc: /* Non-nil means don't update menu bars. Internal use only. */);
29200 inhibit_menubar_update = 0;
29201
29202 DEFVAR_LISP ("wrap-prefix", Vwrap_prefix,
29203 doc: /* Prefix prepended to all continuation lines at display time.
29204 The value may be a string, an image, or a stretch-glyph; it is
29205 interpreted in the same way as the value of a `display' text property.
29206
29207 This variable is overridden by any `wrap-prefix' text or overlay
29208 property.
29209
29210 To add a prefix to non-continuation lines, use `line-prefix'. */);
29211 Vwrap_prefix = Qnil;
29212 DEFSYM (Qwrap_prefix, "wrap-prefix");
29213 Fmake_variable_buffer_local (Qwrap_prefix);
29214
29215 DEFVAR_LISP ("line-prefix", Vline_prefix,
29216 doc: /* Prefix prepended to all non-continuation lines at display time.
29217 The value may be a string, an image, or a stretch-glyph; it is
29218 interpreted in the same way as the value of a `display' text property.
29219
29220 This variable is overridden by any `line-prefix' text or overlay
29221 property.
29222
29223 To add a prefix to continuation lines, use `wrap-prefix'. */);
29224 Vline_prefix = Qnil;
29225 DEFSYM (Qline_prefix, "line-prefix");
29226 Fmake_variable_buffer_local (Qline_prefix);
29227
29228 DEFVAR_BOOL ("inhibit-eval-during-redisplay", inhibit_eval_during_redisplay,
29229 doc: /* Non-nil means don't eval Lisp during redisplay. */);
29230 inhibit_eval_during_redisplay = 0;
29231
29232 DEFVAR_BOOL ("inhibit-free-realized-faces", inhibit_free_realized_faces,
29233 doc: /* Non-nil means don't free realized faces. Internal use only. */);
29234 inhibit_free_realized_faces = 0;
29235
29236 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
29237 DEFVAR_BOOL ("inhibit-try-window-id", inhibit_try_window_id,
29238 doc: /* Inhibit try_window_id display optimization. */);
29239 inhibit_try_window_id = 0;
29240
29241 DEFVAR_BOOL ("inhibit-try-window-reusing", inhibit_try_window_reusing,
29242 doc: /* Inhibit try_window_reusing display optimization. */);
29243 inhibit_try_window_reusing = 0;
29244
29245 DEFVAR_BOOL ("inhibit-try-cursor-movement", inhibit_try_cursor_movement,
29246 doc: /* Inhibit try_cursor_movement display optimization. */);
29247 inhibit_try_cursor_movement = 0;
29248 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
29249
29250 DEFVAR_INT ("overline-margin", overline_margin,
29251 doc: /* Space between overline and text, in pixels.
29252 The default value is 2: the height of the overline (1 pixel) plus 1 pixel
29253 margin to the character height. */);
29254 overline_margin = 2;
29255
29256 DEFVAR_INT ("underline-minimum-offset",
29257 underline_minimum_offset,
29258 doc: /* Minimum distance between baseline and underline.
29259 This can improve legibility of underlined text at small font sizes,
29260 particularly when using variable `x-use-underline-position-properties'
29261 with fonts that specify an UNDERLINE_POSITION relatively close to the
29262 baseline. The default value is 1. */);
29263 underline_minimum_offset = 1;
29264
29265 DEFVAR_BOOL ("display-hourglass", display_hourglass_p,
29266 doc: /* Non-nil means show an hourglass pointer, when Emacs is busy.
29267 This feature only works when on a window system that can change
29268 cursor shapes. */);
29269 display_hourglass_p = 1;
29270
29271 DEFVAR_LISP ("hourglass-delay", Vhourglass_delay,
29272 doc: /* Seconds to wait before displaying an hourglass pointer when Emacs is busy. */);
29273 Vhourglass_delay = make_number (DEFAULT_HOURGLASS_DELAY);
29274
29275 hourglass_atimer = NULL;
29276 hourglass_shown_p = 0;
29277
29278 DEFSYM (Qglyphless_char, "glyphless-char");
29279 DEFSYM (Qhex_code, "hex-code");
29280 DEFSYM (Qempty_box, "empty-box");
29281 DEFSYM (Qthin_space, "thin-space");
29282 DEFSYM (Qzero_width, "zero-width");
29283
29284 DEFSYM (Qglyphless_char_display, "glyphless-char-display");
29285 /* Intern this now in case it isn't already done.
29286 Setting this variable twice is harmless.
29287 But don't staticpro it here--that is done in alloc.c. */
29288 Qchar_table_extra_slots = intern_c_string ("char-table-extra-slots");
29289 Fput (Qglyphless_char_display, Qchar_table_extra_slots, make_number (1));
29290
29291 DEFVAR_LISP ("glyphless-char-display", Vglyphless_char_display,
29292 doc: /* Char-table defining glyphless characters.
29293 Each element, if non-nil, should be one of the following:
29294 an ASCII acronym string: display this string in a box
29295 `hex-code': display the hexadecimal code of a character in a box
29296 `empty-box': display as an empty box
29297 `thin-space': display as 1-pixel width space
29298 `zero-width': don't display
29299 An element may also be a cons cell (GRAPHICAL . TEXT), which specifies the
29300 display method for graphical terminals and text terminals respectively.
29301 GRAPHICAL and TEXT should each have one of the values listed above.
29302
29303 The char-table has one extra slot to control the display of a character for
29304 which no font is found. This slot only takes effect on graphical terminals.
29305 Its value should be an ASCII acronym string, `hex-code', `empty-box', or
29306 `thin-space'. The default is `empty-box'. */);
29307 Vglyphless_char_display = Fmake_char_table (Qglyphless_char_display, Qnil);
29308 Fset_char_table_extra_slot (Vglyphless_char_display, make_number (0),
29309 Qempty_box);
29310 }
29311
29312
29313 /* Initialize this module when Emacs starts. */
29314
29315 void
29316 init_xdisp (void)
29317 {
29318 current_header_line_height = current_mode_line_height = -1;
29319
29320 CHARPOS (this_line_start_pos) = 0;
29321
29322 if (!noninteractive)
29323 {
29324 struct window *m = XWINDOW (minibuf_window);
29325 Lisp_Object frame = m->frame;
29326 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
29327 Lisp_Object root = FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f);
29328 struct window *r = XWINDOW (root);
29329 int i;
29330
29331 echo_area_window = minibuf_window;
29332
29333 wset_top_line (r, make_number (FRAME_TOP_MARGIN (f)));
29334 wset_total_lines
29335 (r, make_number (FRAME_LINES (f) - 1 - FRAME_TOP_MARGIN (f)));
29336 wset_total_cols (r, make_number (FRAME_COLS (f)));
29337 wset_top_line (m, make_number (FRAME_LINES (f) - 1));
29338 wset_total_lines (m, make_number (1));
29339 wset_total_cols (m, make_number (FRAME_COLS (f)));
29340
29341 scratch_glyph_row.glyphs[TEXT_AREA] = scratch_glyphs;
29342 scratch_glyph_row.glyphs[TEXT_AREA + 1]
29343 = scratch_glyphs + MAX_SCRATCH_GLYPHS;
29344
29345 /* The default ellipsis glyphs `...'. */
29346 for (i = 0; i < 3; ++i)
29347 default_invis_vector[i] = make_number ('.');
29348 }
29349
29350 {
29351 /* Allocate the buffer for frame titles.
29352 Also used for `format-mode-line'. */
29353 int size = 100;
29354 mode_line_noprop_buf = xmalloc (size);
29355 mode_line_noprop_buf_end = mode_line_noprop_buf + size;
29356 mode_line_noprop_ptr = mode_line_noprop_buf;
29357 mode_line_target = MODE_LINE_DISPLAY;
29358 }
29359
29360 help_echo_showing_p = 0;
29361 }
29362
29363 /* Since w32 does not support atimers, it defines its own implementation of
29364 the following three functions in w32fns.c. */
29365 #ifndef WINDOWSNT
29366
29367 /* Platform-independent portion of hourglass implementation. */
29368
29369 /* Cancel a currently active hourglass timer, and start a new one. */
29370 void
29371 start_hourglass (void)
29372 {
29373 #if defined (HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM)
29374 EMACS_TIME delay;
29375
29376 cancel_hourglass ();
29377
29378 if (INTEGERP (Vhourglass_delay)
29379 && XINT (Vhourglass_delay) > 0)
29380 delay = make_emacs_time (min (XINT (Vhourglass_delay),
29381 TYPE_MAXIMUM (time_t)),
29382 0);
29383 else if (FLOATP (Vhourglass_delay)
29384 && XFLOAT_DATA (Vhourglass_delay) > 0)
29385 delay = EMACS_TIME_FROM_DOUBLE (XFLOAT_DATA (Vhourglass_delay));
29386 else
29387 delay = make_emacs_time (DEFAULT_HOURGLASS_DELAY, 0);
29388
29389 hourglass_atimer = start_atimer (ATIMER_RELATIVE, delay,
29390 show_hourglass, NULL);
29391 #endif
29392 }
29393
29394
29395 /* Cancel the hourglass cursor timer if active, hide a busy cursor if
29396 shown. */
29397 void
29398 cancel_hourglass (void)
29399 {
29400 #if defined (HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM)
29401 if (hourglass_atimer)
29402 {
29403 cancel_atimer (hourglass_atimer);
29404 hourglass_atimer = NULL;
29405 }
29406
29407 if (hourglass_shown_p)
29408 hide_hourglass ();
29409 #endif
29410 }
29411 #endif /* ! WINDOWSNT */